HTML 5

勧告案の非公式和訳(原文出版日) 2008年8月25日

みなさんにも作業にご参加いただけます。 作業部会の議論用メイリング・リストに参加してください。

Web デザイナー! みなさんのための FAQ掲示板ヘルプ用メイリング・リストがあります!

この文書は、 WHATWG HTML5 仕様書の日本語訳です。 HTML5 の正式な仕様書は英語版だけであり、 この日本語訳はあくまで参考としてご利用ください。

This document is a Japanese translation of the WHATWG HTML5 specification. Note that the only normative specification for the HTML5 is the original English version and this Japanese translation is non‐normative.

日本語訳は Web 界面を使って編集できます。 編集結果はおよそ3時間おきに反映されます。 また、原文の変更には毎日自動的に追随しています。

The Japanese text can be edited using the Web interface. Any modifications will be reflected to this translation in about three hours. Note that any changes to the original specification will automatically be incorporated to this translation every day.

原文の多頁版:
http://whatwg.org/html5
原文の単一頁版:
http://www.whatwg.org/specs/web-apps/current-work/
原文の PDF 印刷版:
A4: http://www.whatwg.org/specs/web-apps/current-work/html5-a4.pdf
手紙: http://www.whatwg.org/specs/web-apps/current-work/html5-letter.pdf
原文の改版履歴:
Twitter メッセージ (編集上の変更以外): http://twitter.com/WHATWG
Commit-Watchers メイリング・リスト: http://lists.whatwg.org/listinfo.cgi/commit-watchers-whatwg.org
対話的 Web 界面: http://html5.org/tools/web-apps-tracker
Subversion 界面: http://svn.whatwg.org/
Subversion 上の最新版との HTML 差分: http://whatwg.org/specs/web-apps/current-work/index-diff
問題:
フィードバックの送信先: whatwg@whatwg.org
フィードバックの閲覧・投票: http://www.whatwg.org/issues/
編集者:
Ian Hickson, Google, ian@hixie.ch

概要

この仕様書は、 Web ベースのアプリケーションの制作の簡単化のために HTML やそれに関係する API を拡張します。 新たに文脈メニュー、直接モード図形画布、全二重クライアント鯖型通信路、 更なる意味、音声や動画、オフライン Web アプリケーションのための各種機能、 砂箱化 iframe、範囲指定スタイル付けなどの機能を追加します。 また、既存の旧来の利用者エージェントに対する言語の後方互換性を維持し、 既存の旧来の文書に対する利用者エージェントの後方互換性を維持することに特に留意しています。

この文書の状態

この文書は作業中です! この文書は、コメントへの対応や通常の開発の過程として、 毎時毎分とは言い過ぎですが毎日のペースで変更されています。 コメントは非常に歓迎していますので、 whatwg@whatwg.org へお送りください。よろしくお願いします。

現在の焦点は未解決のフィードバックへの対応です。 (現在の進捗を示したグラフもあります。)

実装者は、この仕様書が安定していないことに注意するべきです。 実装者は議論に参加しておかないと、 仕様がその実装とは非互換に変更されてしまうかもしれません。 この仕様書がいずれ実装呼び掛けの段階に達するのよりも前にこの仕様を実装したい販売者は、 WHATWG メイリング・リストに参加し、 議論に加わるべきです。

この仕様書は W3C HTML WG によっても出版されています。2つの仕様書の目次以降は同一です。

この仕様書は、従来 HTML4、XHTML 1.x、DOM2 HTML の仕様書にあったものを置き換える (その新しい版となる) ことを意図しています。

安定性

この仕様書の各部分はそれぞれ異なる成熟度にあります。

Some of the more major known issues are marked like this. There are many other issues that have been raised as well; the issues given in this document are not the only known issues! Also, firing of events needs to be unified (right now some bubble, some don't, they all use different text to fire events, etc).

目次


1. はじめに

1.1 背景

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

World Wide Web のマーク付け言語は、いつもずっと HTML でした。 HTML は主に意味的に記述された科学的な文書のための言語として設計されましたが、 一般性を持った設計になっていたことと長年にわたる適応化が行われたことから、 それ以外の様々な種類の文書の記述にも使えるようになりました。

HTML がこれまで十分に取り扱わなかった分野としては、主に、Web アプリケーションと大まかに括られる分野が挙げられます。 この仕様書は、この状況を是正しようと試みると共に、 過去数年間に取り上げられた問題を解決するべく、 HTML 仕様書を更新するものです。

1.2 適用範囲

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書は、静的な文書から動的なアプリケーションまで、 Web のアクセス性の高い頁を著述するための、 意味レベルのマーク付け言語とそれに関連付けられた意味レベルのスクリプト API を提供することに限定されています。

この仕様書の適用範囲には、提示の媒体特有のカスタム化のための機構の提供は含みません (ただし、 Web ブラウザの既定のレンダリング規則がこの仕様書の最後に含まれており、 CSS に引っ掛けるための仕組みもいくつか言語の一部として提供します)。

この仕様書の適用範囲には、 Web ブラウザで提供されるすべての HTML や DOM の機能の文書化は含みません。ブラウザは、アクセス可能性的に非常に悪いか、 その他の理由で不適切と考えられる機能に多く対応しています。例えば、 blink 要素は明らかに提示的であり、 著者は文章を点滅させたい時には代わりに CSS を使うべきです。

この仕様書の適用範囲には、オペレーティング・システム全体を記述することは含みません。 特に、ハードウェア設定ソフトウェア、画像操作ツール、高級ワークステーションでの日常用途向けアプリケーションは適用範囲外です。 この仕様書は、アプリケーションに関しては、時たま利用するか、日常的ながらも様々な場所から利用するような、 しかも CPU に対する要求の低いアプリケーションを特に対象としています。 例えば、オンライン購入システム、検索システム、ゲーム (特に多プレイヤー・オンライン・ゲーム)、 公衆電話帳・住所録、通信ソフトウェア (電子メイル・クライアント、 即席メッセージ・クライアント、議論ソフトウェア)、 文書編集ソフトウェアなどです。

洗練された多環境対応アプリケーションについては、独占的な解決策が既にいくつか存在します (Mozilla の XUL、 Adobe の Flash、 Microsoft の Silverlight など)。 これらの解決策は標準化過程よりも速く進化しており、 要求も更に速いスピードで高まっています。これらのシステムは、 この文書で説明している解決策よりも甚だ複雑で規定しがたく、 相互運用性の達成も桁違いに難しいものです。 洗練されたアプリケーションのための環境特有の解決策 (例えば Mac OS X 中核 API) は更にそれ以上です。

1.3 歴史

元々 HTML5 に関する作業は2003年の暮れに、 XForms 1.0 が導入した機能の多くは既存の HTML Web 頁と非互換なレンダリング・エンジンをブラウザに実装させずとも HTML4 のフォームの拡張によって提供できることの実証としてはじまりました。 この早い段階の作業は、原案は既に公開されていましたし、意見は既にあらゆる方面から募られていましたが、 仕様書は Opera Software の著作権のもとにのみ置かれていました。

2004年のはじめ、この作業の根底にある原理の一部やフォーム関連の機能のみを扱った早期の原案提案を Mozilla と Opera が共同で W3C に対して Web における Web アプリケーションの将来を議論する会議において示しました。 この提案は以前選ばれた Webの発展の方向と矛盾しているとの理由で却下されました。

そのすぐ後、 Apple と Mozilla と Opera はこの作業を継続する意思を共同で発表しました。 公開のメイリング・リストが作成され、原案は WHATWG サイトに移されました。 それ以後著作権はこれら3販売者が共同で所有し、仕様書の再利用を認めるように改定されました。

2006年には、 W3C はこの仕様書に対する興味を示し、 HTML5 仕様書の開発を WHATWG と共に行うことを憲章に含めた作業部会を作成しました。作業部会は2007年に開始しました。 Apple と Mozilla と Opera は W3C が仕様書を W3C の著作権のもとで出版することを認めつつ、 WHATWG サイトでより制限のゆるいライセンスの版を提供し続けています。

それ以後、両部会は共同で作業を続けています。

1.4 他の仕様書との関係

1.4.1 HTML 4.01 や DOM2 HTML との関係

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書は HTML4 の新しい版であり、それに対応する DOM2 HTML API の新しい版です。この仕様書は後方互換性を残すことに注意を払っていますので、 ほとんどの場合、 HTML4 からこの仕様書で説明する書式や API への移行は簡単なはずです。[HTML4] [DOM2HTML]

1.4.2 XHTML 1.x との関係

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書は、 HTML 語彙の XML 直列化の規定的定義としての XHTML 1.0 を置き換えることを意図しています。 [XHTML10]

この仕様書は XHTML モジュール化 1.1 で定義され XHTML 1.1 で使われている語彙の意味と要件を更新することを意図していますが、 これらの仕様書 (やその他の仕様書) で定義され使用されているモジュール化手法の置き換えを提供しようとはしていませんので、 これらの完全なる置き換えとはいえません。 [XHTMLMOD] [XHTML11]

従って、当該モジュール化手法が必要ない著者や実装者にとってはこの仕様書を XHTML 1.x を置き換えるものと考えることができますが、それが必要な人は XHTML 1.1 系列の仕様書を使い続けることをお勧めします。

1.4.3 XHTML2 との関係

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

XHTML2 [XHTML2] は、 ハイパーリンク、多媒体内容、文書の編集の注釈付け、豊富なメタデータ、 宣言的対話的フォーム、詩など人文学的作品や科学的論文の意味の記述などのためのよりよい機能を持つ、 新しい HTML 語彙を定義しています。

しかし、 XHTML2 は Web でよく見られる、文書以外の種類の内容の多くの意味を表現する要素に欠いています。 例えば、掲示板サイト、オークション・サイト、検索エンジン、オンライン店舗などは、 文書のメタファーに十分なじまないので、 XHTML2 でカバーされていません。

この仕様書は、 HTML を拡張し、これらの文脈でも適切なものとなることを目指します。

XHTML2 とこの仕様書は異なる名前空間を使用していますので、 同じ XML 処理器でどちらをも実装することができます。

1.4.4 Web Forms 2.0 や XForms との関係

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書はゆくゆくは Web Forms 2.0 に取って代わることになります。 その時までは、現在の Web Forms 2.0 はこの仕様書の一部であると考えることができます。 Web Forms 2.0 の機能はゆくゆくはこの仕様書と併合されます。 [WF2]

現時点では、この仕様書は XForms とは無関係で、直交したものです。 HTML4 と Web Forms 2.0 で定義されたフォーム機能がこの仕様書に併合された折には、 Web Forms 2.0 案で説明している XForms との関係がこの仕様書についても適用されます。[XForms]

1.4.5 XUL、Flash、Silverlight など独占的利用者界面言語との関係

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書は、各種販売者が提供する各種独占的利用者界面言語とは独立です。 HTML は、開放的で販売者に対して中立な言語として、 特定販売者への囲い込みの危険のない解決策を同じ問題に対して提供します。

1.5 HTML 対 XHTML

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書は、文書とアプリケーションを記述するための抽象言語と、 その言語を用いた資源の記憶装置内表現と対話する API をいくつか定義します。

記憶装置内表現は「DOM5 HTML」、あるいは略して「DOM」と呼ばれます。

この抽象言語を用いた資源を転送するために使用できる具象構文はいろいろありますが、 この仕様書ではそのうちの2つを定義します。

1つ目の具象構文は「HTML5」です。これは、ほとんどの著者に推奨する書式です。 この具象構文はすべての遺物 Web ブラウザと互換性があります。 文書が MIME 型 text/html で転送される場合、 Web ブラウザはこれを「HTML5」 として処理します。

2つ目の具象構文は XML を使い、「XHTML5」と呼ばれます。文書が XML MIME 型、例えば application/xhtml+xml で転送される時には、 Web ブラウザは XML 処理器によりこれを処理し、「XHTML5」文書として扱います。 著者は、 XML と HTML の処理が異なることに注意する必要があります。 特に、 XML 文書は小さな構文誤りによってさえ完全には表示されなくなってしまいます。 一方の「HTML5」構文では小さな誤りは無視されます。

「DOM5 HTML」、「HTML5」、「XHTML5」の各表現は、 すべてが同じ内容を表現できるわけではありません。例えば、 名前空間は「HTML5」では表現できませんが、「DOM5 HTML」と「XHTML5」 は対応しています。同様に、 noscript 機能を用いた文書は「HTML5」 を使って表現できますが、「XHTML5」や「DOM5 HTML」では表現できません。 文字列「-->」を含む注釈は「DOM5 HTML」 では表現できますが、「HTML5」や「XHTML5」では表現できません。 他にもあります。

1.6 この仕様書の構造

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書は次の大きな章で構成されています。

共通基盤
適合性級、算法、定義、仕様書の残りの部分の共通の土台です。
DOM
文書は要素により構築されます。要素は DOM を使って木を形成します。 この章は DOM の機能を定義すると共に、 すべての要素に共通な機能と要素を定義するために用いる概念を導入します。
要素
各要素はあらかじめ定義された意味を持っており、それをこの章で説明します。 各要素をどう取り扱うかに関する利用者エージェント要件や、 著者が要素をどう使うかの規則も与えます。
Web ブラウザ
HTML 文書は単独で存在するのではありません。この章は、 複数の頁や頁間のリンクやスクリプトの実行を処理する、 環境に影響する機能の多くを定義します。
利用者対話
HTML 文書は利用者と対話したり利用者が内容を編集したりするための数々の仕組みを提供でき、 この章ではそれについて説明します。
通信 API
HTML で書かれたアプリケーションでは、よく遠隔鯖と通信したり、 同じクライアント上で図指している異なるドメインの他のアプリケーションと通信する仕組みが必要になります。
反復雛形
フォーム中の反復節に対応するための仕組み。
言語構文
これらの機能はすべて、直列化された形式で表現して他の人に送ることができなければ、 意味がありません。この章では、 HTML の構文と、 HTML の構文解析の方法に関する規則を定義します。

この仕様書には、 Web ブラウザのレンダリング規則を定義する附属書やこの仕様書の適用範囲外の分野を列挙する附属書もあります。

1.6.1 この仕様書の読み方

この仕様書は、他のすべての仕様書と同じように読むべきです。 まず、最初から最後まで、何回も読むべきです。 次に、最低1回は後ろから読むべきです。 その次に、目次から無作為に節を選び、すべての相互参照をたどりながら読むべきです。

1.6.2 活字的規約

これは定義や要件や説明です。

これは注意書きです。

これは例です。

これは未解決の問題です。

これは警告です。

用語の定義を行う実現値はこのようにマーク付けされます。この用語を使う場合は、このように、あるいはこのようにマーク付けされます。

要素、属性、API を定義する実現値は、 このようにマーク付けされます。 この要素、属性、API への参照はこのようにマーク付けされます。

その他の符号素片は、このようにマーク付けされます。

変数はこのようにマーク付けされます。

interface  {
  // これは IDL 定義です。
};

2. 共通基盤

2.1 用語

この仕様書では、よく、同じ文脈で HTML や XML の属性と DOM の属性の両方に言及します。 いずれの属性を指しているのかが明確でない場合には、 HTML や XML の属性を内容属性、 DOM の属性を DOM 属性と呼びます。 同様に、用語「特性」は ECMAScript のオブジェクト特性と CSS の特性の両方に使います。 いずれを指すか曖昧な場合には、それぞれオブジェクト特性や CSS 特性のように修飾して使います。

用語 HTML 文書は時々 XML 文書と対比させて使いますが、 (XML 構文解析器を使って構文解析されたものや純粋に DOM を使って作られたものに対して) HTML 構文解析器を使って構文解析された文書を意味します。

一般に、この仕様書が HTML か XHTML に適用される機能を述べる時には、 他方についても含んでいます。ある機能がこの2つの言語のうちのいずれかにのみに特に適用される時は、 それがわかるように、他方の書式には適用されないことを明記します。

この仕様書では、短く静的な文書であっても豊かな多媒体を用いた長い随筆や報告書であっても、 はたまた本格的な対話的アプリケーションであったとしても、 あらゆる HTML の利用方法をも含めて、すべて用語文書によって表します。

簡単のため、文書が利用者に対してレンダリングされる方法に言及する時に示す表示する可視などの用語を使うことがあります。 このような用語は特に視覚媒体を暗示しているわけではありません。 他の媒体であってもこれらの用語が等価な方法で適用されるものと考えなければなりません

この仕様書にある算法のうちのいくつかは、歴史的な理由により、何らかの条件が満たされるまでの間、 利用者エージェントが一時停止することを要求しています。 利用者エージェントは、一時停止している間、スクリプト (事象取扱器やタイマーなど) が実行されないようにしなければなりません。 しかし、一時停止中利用者エージェントは、 スクリプトの呼び出しに関わってくるような Web 頁との対話を利用者にさせないでおきながらも、 利用者の入力に応答的であり続けるべきです

2.1.1 XML

HTML から XHTML への移行を簡単にするために、 この仕様書に適合する利用者エージェントは、 少なくても DOM と CSS に関しては、 HTML の要素を http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml 名前空間に置きます。 この仕様書では、用語「HTML 名前空間の要素」、 略して「HTML 要素」は、 HTML と XHTML の両方の要素を指します。

特に断らない場合、 この仕様書で定義または言及するすべての要素は http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml 名前空間にあり、 この仕様書で定義または言及するすべての属性は名前空間を持ちません (要素毎区画にあります)。

XML の名前 (属性名や要素名など) を prefix:localName の形表す場合 (例えば xml:idsvg:rect) には、局所名が localName であり、 名前空間は接頭辞によって次の表で定義する通りであるような名前を表します。

xml
http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace
html
http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml
svg
http://www.w3.org/2000/svg

属性名が XML 互換であるとは、 XML で定義されている Name 生成規則に一致し、 U+003A COLON (:) 文字を含まず、最初の3文字が ASCII 大文字・小文字不区別で文字列「xml」に一致しないことをいいます。 [XML]

2.1.2 DOM 木

用語根要素は、 文書の根要素と明示的に修飾していない時は、 当該節点の最遠の祖先要素節点か、祖先を持たない場合にはその節点自体を意味します。 節点が文書の一部である時には、これは文書の根要素となります。 しかし、節点がその時点で文書木の一部でない場合は、 根要素は孤児節点となります。

要素が文書に挿入されるというのは、その根要素が変化し、新しく文書の根要素となった時です。

用語木順は、関係 DOM 節点の (parentNode/childNodes 関係を通じた) 行きがけ順幅優先探索を表します。

要素や属性が無視される、他の値であるとして扱う、 何か他のものであるかのように扱うと述べられている時は、その節点が DOM に入った後の処理についてのみ言及しています。利用者エージェントは、そのような状況で DOM を変異させてはなりません

用語テキスト節点は、任意の Text 節点を指し、 CDATASection 節点を含みます。 厳密には、節点型が TEXT_NODE (3) か CDATA_SECTION_NODE (4) の任意の Node を指します。 [DOM3CORE]

2.1.3 スクリプティング

Foo オブジェクト」という構文 (Foo は実際には界面) を時々使いますが、より正確な「界面 Foo を実装しているオブジェクト」の代わりに用いています。

DOM 属性は、その値が (例えば著者のスクリプトにより) 取り出される時取得されるといい、 新しい値がその属性に割り当てられる時設定されるといいます。

DOM オブジェクトが生きているという場合、 そのオブジェクトを返す属性は常に同じオブジェクトを返さなければならない (毎回新しいオブジェクトを返すのではなく) 上に、 そのオブジェクトの属性やメソッドがそのオブジェクトの裏にある実際のデータのスナップ写真ではなく、 データそのものに対して操作されなければならないことを意味します。

用語発火発送は、 DOM 事象仕様書にある通り、 事象の文脈では交換可能なものとして使います。 [DOM3EVENTS]

2.1.4 プラグイン

用語プラグインは、任意の内容取扱器を意味して使います。 典型的には利用者エージェントが生で対応していない Web 内容型のためや DOM を晒さない内容型のための、第3者による内容取扱器で、 利用者エージェントの界面の一部として内容をレンダリングすることに対応しているものです。

プラグインの一例は、利用者が PDF ファイルに操縦した時に閲覧文脈中に実現値化される PDF 表示器です。この場合、PDF 表示器部品が利用者エージェント自体と同じ者により実装されたかどうかを問わず、 プラグインと考えます。しかし、 PDF 表示器アプリケーションが利用者エージェントとは (同じ界面を使わずに) 別に起動する場合には、この定義ではプラグインではありません。

この仕様書は、プラグインと対話する仕組みを定義しません。そのような仕組みは利用者エージェントや環境に依存すると思われるからです。 ある利用者エージェントは Netscape プラグイン API のようなプラグインの仕組みに対応したいかもしれません。 他の利用者エージェントは遠隔内容変換器を使ったり、ある型については組み込みで対応したりするかもしれません。

ブラウザは、プラグインを想定した外部の内容と対話する時に特に十分な注意を払うべきです。 第3者ソフトウェアが利用者エージェント自体と同じ特権で走る時は、 第3者ソフトウェアの脆弱性が利用者エージェントの脆弱性と同じくらい危険となります。

2.2 適合性要件

この仕様書のすべての図、例示、注意書き、ならびに規定の一部ではないと明記したすべての節は、 規定の一部ではありません。 この仕様書のそれ以外の部分はすべて規定の一部です。

この文書の規定の部分にあるキーワード「しなければなりません」、 「してはなりません」、 「必須です」、するべきです」、 「するべきではありません」、 「推奨します」、「して構いません」、 「任意です」は、 RFC 2119 で説明されているように解釈します。 この仕様書の原文では、 可読性の観点から、 これらの語の原語のすべて大文字による表記は行っていません。 [RFC2119]

算法の一部として動作の指示の形で (原文では命令形で) 記述された要件 (例えば「先頭の間隔文字をすべて除去します」や「偽を返し、これらの段階を停止します」) は、算法を紹介するに当たって使われたキーワード (しなければなりませんするべきですして構いませんなど) の意味により解釈します。

この仕様書は、利用者エージェントに対する適合性基準 (実装者に関係するもの) と文書に対する適合性基準 (著者や著述ツール実装者に関係するもの) を説明します。

文書適合性要件と実装適合性要件の間には暗示的な関係もありません。 利用者エージェントは不適合の文書を好きなように取り扱ってよいわけではありません。 入力文書の適合性の如何を問わず、この仕様書で説明する処理モデルが適用されます。

利用者エージェントは異なった適合性要件を持つ複数の (重なり合った) 範疇に分類できます。

Web ブラウザその他の対話的利用者エージェント

XHTML に対応する Web ブラウザは、 XML 文書中に見える HTML 名前空間の要素や属性をこの仕様書で説明するように処理することにより、 利用者がそれらと対話できるようにしなければなりません。ただし、 それらの要素の意味が他の仕様書により上書きされている場合を除きます。

適合 XHTML 処理器は、 XML 文書中で XHTML script 要素を見つけた際に、その要素に含まれるスクリプトを実行することになります。しかし、 その要素が XSLT 変形シート中に見える場合には (利用者エージェントが XSLT にも対応しているとすると)、処理器は通常の処理の代わりに script 要素を変形の一部を形成する不透明な要素として扱うことになります。

HTML に対応する Web ブラウザは、 text/html と札付けされた文書をこの仕様書で説明するように処理することにより、 利用者がそれらと対話できるようにしなければなりません

非対話的提示利用者エージェント

HTML 文書と XHTML 文書を純粋にその非対話的な版をレンダリングするために処理する利用者エージェントは、 利用者との対話に関する要件を除き、 Web ブラウザと同じ基準に従わなければなりません

非対話的提示利用者エージェントの典型的な例は印刷機 (静的利用者エージェント) や頭上表示機 (動的利用者エージェント) です。ほとんどの静的非対話的提示利用者エージェントはスクリプティング対応を欠くことをも選ぶと思われます。

それでも、非対話的ながら動的な提示の利用者エージェントはスクリプトを実行し、 フォームを動的に提出することを許すなどすることでしょう。しかし、 利用者が文書に対話できない時には「焦点」の概念は無関係となるので、 利用者エージェントは焦点に関係する DOM API のいずれにも対応する必要がありません。

スクリプティングに対応しない利用者エージェント

スクリプティングに対応しない (またはスクリプティング機能が完全に無効化されている) 実装は、この仕様書で言及している事象や DOM 界面への対応を免除されます。 この仕様書で事象モデルや DOM を用いて定義されている部分に関しては、 この種の利用者エージェントもやはり事象や DOM に対応しているかのように動作しなければなりません

スクリプティングはアプリケーションの不可分の部分を形成することがあります。 スクリプティングに対応しない、またはスクリプティングを無効化された利用者エージェントは、 著者の意図を完全に伝えることができないかもしれません。

適合性検査器

適合性検査器は、文書がこの仕様書中で説明する適用可能な適合性基準に適合するかを検証しなければなりません。 自動化された適合性検査器については、著者の意図の解釈が必要な誤りの検出を免除します (例えば、 blockquote 要素の内容が引用ではない文書は不適合ですが、 人間の判断の入力なしで走っている適合性検査器は blockquote 要素が引用されたものだけを含むかを検査しなくてかまいません)。

適合性検査器は、閲覧文脈なしの時に (つまりスクリプトが走らず、 構文解析器のスクリプティング旗が無効化された状態で) 入力文書が適合するかを検査しなければならず、スクリプトを実行する閲覧文脈中で構文解析する時に入力文書が適合するか、 スクリプトが決して不適合状態を引き起こさないか (スクリプト自体の実行中の過渡状態を除きます。) も検査するべきです。 (これは不可能であると証明されているので、 「するべき」要件であり、「しなければならない」要件ではありません。 [HALTINGPROBLEM])

用語「HTML5 妥当性検査器」は、それ自体がこの仕様書の適用可能な要件に適合する適合性検査器を指して使うことができます。

XML DTD はこの仕様書のすべての適合性要件を表現することができません。 従って、妥当性を検証する XML 処理器 と DTD は適合性検査器が適合性検査器を構成することはできません。 また、この仕様書が定義する2つの著述書式のどちらも SGML の応用ではありませんから、 妥当性を検証する SGML システムが適合性検査器を構成することはできません。

別の言い方をすると、適合性基準には次の3種類があります。

  1. DTD で表現できる基準
  2. DTD で表現できないが、それでも機械で検査できる基準
  3. 人間だけが検査できる基準

適合性検査器ははじめの2つを検査しなければなりません。 単純な DTD を基にした妥当性検証器は1つ目の級の誤りしか検査しませんから、 この仕様書による適合妥当性検証器ではありません。

データ・マイニング・ツール

文書のレンダリングや適合性の検査以外の理由で HTML 文書や XHTML 文書を処理するアプリケーションやツールは、その処理する文書の意味に従って作用するべきです

文書の輪郭を生成するツールで、 入れ子の水準を段落毎に増加させ、章節毎には増加させないものは、 適合しません。

著述ツールとマーク付け生成器

著述ツールとマーク付け生成器は、適合文書を生成しなければなりません。 著者に適用される適合性基準は著述ツールにも適当なら適用されます。

著述ツールは要素をその指定された目的のみに用いるという厳密な要件を免除されますが、 これは著述ツールがまだ著者の意図を判断することができない範囲内に限ります。

例えば、 address 要素を任意の連絡先情報に使うことは適合しません。 この要素は文書や章節の著者の連絡先情報のマーク付けにのみ使うことができます。 しかし、著述ツールはこの違いを判断できないでしょうから、 著述ツールはこの要件を免除されます。

このため、適合性検査に関しては、編集器は適合性検査器が検証できるのと同程度に適合する文書を出力されることが要求されます。

著述ツールを不適合の文書を編集するために用いる時には、 その編集セッションで編集しなかった文書中の部分の適合性誤りを保持して構いません (つまり、編集ツールは誤った内容を往復することが認められます)。しかし、 著述ツールは誤りが保持される場合に出力が適合していると主張してはなりません

著述ツールは2つに大きく分けられると思われます。1つは構造・意味的なデータに対して働くもので、 もう1つは見たままな感じの媒体指定の編集 (WYSIWYG) に基づき働くものです。

前者は原始構造中の構造を HTML のどの要素や属性が最も適切かに関して十分な選択を行うために使うことができるので、 HTML を著述するツールにはより好ましい仕組みです。

しかし、 WYSIWYG ツールは合法です。 WYSIWYG ツールは適切であると知っている要素を使うべきで、 適切ではないと知っている要素を使うべきではありません。 これは、極端な場合に、使用する流れ要素を divbispan のような少数の要素に制限し、 style 属性を使いまくるようにすることを意味するかもしれません。

すべての著述ツールは、 WYSIWYG か否かに関わらず、 よく構造化され、意味的に豊かな、媒体非依存の内容を利用者が作成できるようにするため、 最大限の努力を行うべきです

いくつかの適合性要件は属性やメソッドやオブジェクトの要件として説明されています。 そのような要件は、2つの範疇に分類されます。1つは内容モデルの制限を説明するもので、 もう1つは実装の動作を説明するものです。前者の範疇の要件は文書や著述ツールの要件です。 後者の範疇は利用者エージェントの要件です。

算法や特定の段階として説明されている適合性要件は、 最終的な結果が等価である限り、任意の方法で実装して構いません。 (特に、この仕様書で定義されている算法は追うのを簡単にしており、 高性能であることを目指してはいません。)

利用者エージェントは、サービス拒否攻撃を防ぐため、 記憶容量を使い尽くすことを防ぐため、 あるいは環境特有の制限に対応するためなどの目的で、 別段の制約のない入力に対して実装特有の制限を設けて構いません

既存の内容や以前の仕様書との互換性のため、この仕様書は2つの著述書式を説明します。 1つは XML に基づくもので (XHTML5 と呼びます)、もう1つは SGML に着想を得たカスタム書式を使うもの (HTML5 と呼びます) です。実装者はこれら2つの書式の1つだけに対応して構いませんが、 両方に対応することをおすすめします。

XHTML 文書 (XML 文書で、 HTML 名前空間の要素を用いるもの) であって、 この仕様書が説明する新しい機能を使い、 ネットワークを通じて (例えば HTTP で) 供給されるものは、 application/xmlapplication/xhtml+xml のような XML MIME 型を使って送られなければならずtext/html として供給されてはなりません[RFC3023]

そのような XML 文書は、望ましければ DOCTYPE を含んで構いませんが、この仕様書に適合するために必要なわけではありません。

XML 仕様書によれば、 XML 処理器が DOCTYPE 中で参照されている外部 DTD 部分集合を処理することは保証されていません。これは、例えば XHTML 文書中で文字を参照するために実体参照を使うことは (<>&"' を除き) 安全ではないことを意味しています。

HTML 文書は、ネットワークを通じて (例えば HTTP で) 供給される場合、 text/html MIME 型と札付けされなければなりません

この仕様書の言語は、利用者エージェントがすべての実体参照を展開し、 従って DOM 中には実体参照節点が含まれないことを仮定しています。 利用者エージェントが DOM 中に実体参照節点を含めるという場合には、 利用者エージェントはこの仕様書を実装する時には実体参照節点が完全に展開されているかのように取り扱わなければなりません。 例えば、ある要件が要素の子供テキスト節点について反している場合には、 その要素の子供の実体参照の子供であるテキスト節点も同じように使われることになります。 未知の実体に対する実体参照は、この仕様書で定義する算法に関しては、 単に空のテキスト節点を含むかのように扱わなければなりません

2.2.1 依存性

この仕様書は、他のいくつかの下位の仕様書に依存しています。

XML

XHTML5 に対応する実装は、 XML のいずれかの版と、 それに対応する名前空間仕様書に対応しなければなりません。 XHTML5 は名前空間を用いた XML 直列化を使います。 [XML] [XMLNAMES]

DOM

文書オブジェクト・モデル (DOM) は、文書とその内容の表現 (モデル) です。 DOM は単なる API ではなく、この仕様書では HTML 実装の適合性基準を DOM 上の操作として定義しています。 [DOM3CORE]

実装は、 DOM 中核と DOM 事象のそれぞれのいずれかの版に対応しなければなりません。 この仕様書は DOM を使って定義を行っていますし、この仕様書で定義するいくつかの機能は DOM 中核界面に対する拡張となっています。 [DOM3CORE] [DOM3EVENTS]

ECMAScript

この仕様書で定義する API を実装するために ECMAScript を使用する実装は、 Web IDL 仕様書で定義されている ECMAScript 束縛と整合的な方法で実装しなければなりません。 この仕様書は Web IDL 仕様書の用語法を使っているからです。 [WebIDL]

媒体照会

実装は、媒体照会言語のいずれかの版を実装しなければなりません[MQ]

この仕様書は、特定のネットワーク輸送プロトコル、スタイル・シート言語、 スクリプティング言語の仕様書への対応を要求しませんし、 ここまでに述べた内容以上には DOM や WebAPI の仕様書への対応も要求しません。 しかし、この仕様書で説明する言語は、 スタイル付け言語として CSS、スクリプティング言語として ECMAScript、 ネットワーク・プロトコルとして HTTP に偏向しており、 いくつかの機能はこれらの言語やプロトコルが使われることを想定しています。

この仕様書は、文字符号化、画像書式、音声書式、動画書式に関して、 それぞれに関する節で追加の要件を示すかもしれません。

2.2.2 Features defined in other specifications

this section will be removed at some point

Some elements are defined in terms of their DOM textContent attribute. This is an attribute defined on the Node interface in DOM3 Core. [DOM3CORE]

The interface DOMTimeStamp is defined in DOM3 Core. [DOM3CORE]

The term activation behavior is used as defined in the DOM3 Events specification. [DOM3EVENTS] At the time of writing, DOM3 Events hadn't yet been updated to define that phrase.

The rules for handling alternative style sheets are defined in the CSS object model specification. [CSSOM]

See http://dev.w3.org/cvsweb/~checkout~/csswg/cssom/Overview.html?content-type=text/html;%20charset=utf-8

2.2.3 Common conformance requirements for APIs exposed to JavaScript

This section will eventually be removed in favour of WebIDL.

A lot of arrays/lists/collections in this spec assume zero-based indexes but use the term "indexth" liberally. We should define those to be zero-based and be clearer about this.

Unless otherwise specified, if a DOM attribute that is a floating point number type (float) is assigned an Infinity or Not-a-Number value, a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception must be raised.

Unless otherwise specified, if a method with an argument that is a floating point number type (float) is passed an Infinity or Not-a-Number value, a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception must be raised.

Unless otherwise specified, if a method is passed fewer arguments than is defined for that method in its IDL definition, a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception must be raised.

Unless otherwise specified, if a method is passed more arguments than is defined for that method in its IDL definition, the excess arguments must be ignored.

2.3 大文字と小文字の区別

この仕様書は文字列に対する比較演算子をいくつか定義します。

2つの文字列を大文字・小文字を区別する方法で比較するとは、 両者を正確に、符号位置それぞれについて比較することを意味します。

2つの文字列を ASCII 大文字・小文字を区別しない方法で比較するとは、 両者を正確に、符号位置それぞれについて比較しますが、範囲 U+0041 ~ U+005A (つまり LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A から LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z) の文字と範囲 U+0061 ~ U+007A (つまり LATIN SMALL LETTER A から LATIN SMALL LETTER Z) の対応する文字も一致するものと考えることを意味します。

2つの文字列を大文字・小文字互換性不区別な方法で比較するとは、 2つの文字列の比較に Unicode 大文字・小文字互換性不区別演算を使うことを意味します。 [UNICODECASE]

文字列を大文字に変換するとは、 範囲 U+0061 ~ U+007A (つまり LATIN SMALL LETTER A から LATIN SMALL LETTER Z) の文字をすべて範囲 U+0041 ~ U+005A (つまり LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A から LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z) の対応する文字に置き換えることを意味します。

文字列を小文字に変換するとは、範囲 U+0041 ~ U+005A (つまり LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A から LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z) の文字をすべて範囲 U+0061 ~ U+007A (つまり LATIN SMALL LETTER A から LATIN SMALL LETTER Z) の対応する文字に置き換えることを意味します。

2.4 共通マイクロ構文

HTML 中のいろいろな場所で、日付や数値のような特定のデータ型を使うことができます。 この節では、そのような書式の内容の適合基準は何か、 どう構文解析するかを説明します。

仕様書全体について、すべての属性値がマイクロ構文を使ってか他の仕様書を使ってか「文章」などとして定義されるようにする必要があります。

2.4.1 構文解析器共通慣用句

間隔文字は、 この仕様書においては、 U+0020 SPACE, U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab)、U+000A LINE FEED (LF)、U+000C FORM FEED (FF)、 U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) です。

The White_Space characters are those that have the Unicode property "White_Space". [UNICODE]

これ以降で説明するマイクロ構文解析器のいくつかは、構文解析される文字列を保持する input 変数を持ち、 input 中で次に構文解析する文字を指す position 変数を持つというパターンに従っています。

このパターンに従う構文解析器において、利用者エージェントが文字列を集めることを要求している段階は、 次の算法を、 characters が収集できる文字の集合であるとして実行しなければならないことを意味しています。

  1. inputposition を、これらの段階を呼び出した算法中の同名の変数と同じものとします。

  2. result を空文字列とします。

  3. positioninput の終わりの更に先を指しておらず、 position の文字が characters のうちの1つである間、 その文字を result の終わりに追加し、 positioninput の次の文字に進めます。

  4. result を返します。

The step skip whitespace means that the user agent must collect a sequence of characters that are space characters. The step skip White_Space characters means that the user agent must collect a sequence of characters that are White_Space characters. In both cases, the collected characters are not used. [UNICODE]

2.4.2 ブール型属性

HTML5 の数々の属性はブール型属性です。要素にブール型属性が存在すると真の値を表し、 存在しないと偽の値を表します。

属性が存在する場合、その値は空文字列か、または ASCII 大文字・小文字不区別で属性の正準名と一致するような (先頭にも末尾にも空白がない) 値のいずれかでなければなりません

2.4.3 数値

2.4.3.1. 符号無し整数

文字列は、範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字1文字以上で構成される場合、妥当な非負整数です。

非負整数を構文解析する規則は次の算法で与えられるものです。 この算法が呼び出された時には、与えられた順に段階に従い、 値を返す最初の段階で中断しなければなりません。 この算法は零か正整数か誤りを返します。 先頭の間隔は無視されます。末尾の空白、というかごみ文字列はすべて無視されます。

  1. input を構文解析される文字列とします。

  2. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  3. value を値 0 にします。

  4. 空白を読み飛ばします

  5. positioninput の終わりを過ぎていれば、誤りを返します。

  6. 次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) 〜 U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) のうちの1つでない場合、誤りを返します。

  7. 次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) 〜 U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) のうちの1つである場合:

    1. value を10倍します。
    2. 現在の文字の値 (0〜9) を value に加えます。
    3. position を次の文字に進めます。
    4. positioninput の終わりを過ぎていなければ、 算法全体の段階 7 (これらの部分段階自体が含まれている段階) の先頭に返ります。
  8. value を返します。

2.4.3.2. 符号付き整数

文字列は、範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字1文字以上で構成され、任意選択で接頭辞として U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-") 文字がある場合、妥当な整数です。

整数を構文解析する規則は、非負整数用の規則と似ており、 次の算法により与えられます。これらの段階は、呼び出された場合、 与えられた順序に従い実行し、初めて値を返す段階で停止しなければなりません。 この算法は整数か誤りのいずれかを返します。先頭の間隔は無視されます。 末尾の間隔や末尾のごみ文字は無視されます。

  1. input を構文解析される文字列とします。

  2. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  3. value を値 0 にします。

  4. sign を、「正」という値を持つようにします。

  5. 空白を読み飛ばします

  6. positioninput の終わりを過ぎていれば、誤りを返します。

  7. position が示す文字 (最初の文字) が U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-") 文字である場合、

    1. sign を「負」とします。
    2. position を次の文字に進めます。
    3. positioninput の終わりを過ぎていれば、誤りを返します。
  8. 次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) 〜 U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) のうちの1つでない場合、誤りを返します。

  9. 次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) 〜 U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) のうちの1つである場合:

    1. value を10倍します。
    2. 現在の文字の値 (0〜9) を value に加えます。
    3. position を次の文字に進めます。
    4. positioninput の終わりを過ぎていなければ、 算法全体の段階 9 (これらの部分段階自体が含まれている段階) の先頭に返ります。
  10. sign が「正」の場合、 value を返します。そうでない場合、 0-value を返します。

2.4.3.3. 実数

文字列は、範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字1文字以上で構成され、 任意選択で U+002E FULL STOP (".") 文字1文字がどこか (数字の前か、 2つの数字の間か、数字の後のいずれか) を含み、その全体について任意選択で接頭辞として U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-") 文字がある場合、妥当な浮動小数点数です。

浮動小数点数値を構文解析する規則は次の算法により与えられる通りです。 前述の算法と同様で、この算法が呼び出された時も、 与えられた順序に従い実行し、値を返す最初の段階で停止しなければなりません。 この算法は、数か誤りのいずれかを返します。先頭の間隔は無視されます。 末尾の間隔とごみ文字は無視されます。

  1. input を構文解析される文字列とします。

  2. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  3. value を値 0 にします。

  4. sign を、「正」という値を持つようにします。

  5. 空白を読み飛ばします

  6. positioninput の終わりを過ぎていれば、誤りを返します。

  7. position が示す文字 (最初の文字) が U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-") 文字である場合、

    1. sign を「負」とします。
    2. position を次の文字に進めます。
    3. positioninput の終わりを過ぎていれば、誤りを返します。
  8. 次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) か U+002E FULL STOP (".") のいずれかでなければ、 誤りを返します。

  9. 次の文字が U+002E FULL STOP (".") でありながら、 これが最後の文字であるか、またはその次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) のいずれかではない場合、 誤りを返します。

  10. 次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) 〜 U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) のうちの1つである場合:

    1. value を10倍します。
    2. 現在の文字の値 (0〜9) を value に加えます。
    3. position を次の文字に進めます。
    4. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合には、 sign が「正」であるなら value を返し、そうでないなら 0-value を返します。
    5. そうでない場合、全体の算法の段階 10 (これら部分段階が含まれている段階) の先頭に戻ります。
  11. そうでない場合、次の文字が U+002E FULL STOP (".") でない場合には、 sign が「正」であるなら value を返し、そうでないなら 0-value を返します。

  12. 次の文字は U+002E FULL STOP (".") です。 position をその次の文字に進めます。

  13. divisor を 1 とします。

  14. 次の文字が U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) 〜 U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) のうちの1つである場合:

    1. divisor に 10 を掛けます。
    2. 現在の文字の値 (0~9) を divisor で割った値を、value に加えます。
    3. position を次の文字に進めます。
    4. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合には、 sign が「正」であるなら value を返し、そうでないなら 0-value を返します。
    5. そうでない場合、全体の算法の段階 14 (これら部分段階が含まれている段階) の先頭に戻ります。
  15. そうでない場合、 sign が「正」であるなら value を返し、そうでないなら 0-value を返します。

2.4.3.4. 比率

この節で説明する算法は、 progress 要素と meter 要素で使います。

妥当な分母句読点文字は、 次の表の文字のいずれかです。次の表に示すように、各分母句読点文字には関連付けられた値があります。
分母句読点文字
U+0025 PERCENT SIGN % 100
U+066A ARABIC PERCENT SIGN ٪ 100
U+FE6A SMALL PERCENT SIGN 100
U+FF05 FULLWIDTH PERCENT SIGN 100
U+2030 PER MILLE SIGN 1000
U+2031 PER TEN THOUSAND SIGN 10000

文字列中の比率の1つか2つの数字を探す段階は、次の通りです。

  1. 文字列が空である場合、何も返さず、これらの段階を停止します。
  2. 後述の算法に従い、文字列のはじめから開始して数を探します
  3. 段階 2 の部分算法が何も返さなかったか、誤り条件を返した場合には、 何も返さず、これらの段階を停止します。
  4. number1 を、段階 2 の部分算法が返した数とします。
  5. Starting with the character immediately after the last one examined by the sub-algorithm in step 2, skip all White_Space characters in the string (this might match zero characters).
  6. 文字列中に更に文字がまだある場合で、文字列中の次の文字が妥当な分母句読点文字である場合には、 denominator をその文字に設定します。
  7. 文字列が範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE の文字をまだ他に含んでいる場合で、 段階 6 で denominator に値が与えられた場合には、 何も返さず、これらの段階を停止します。
  8. そうでない場合、 denominator が段階 6 で値を与えられた場合には、 number1denominator を返し、これらの段階を停止します。
  9. 文字列中を更に数を探しますが、 段階 2 の部分算法で調べた最後の文字の直後からはじめます。
  10. If the sub-algorithm in step 9 returned nothing or an error condition, return number1 and abort these steps.
  11. number2 を、段階 9 の部分算法が返した数とします。
  12. Starting with the character immediately after the last one examined by the sub-algorithm in step 9, skip all White_Space characters in the string (this might match zero characters).
  13. 文字列中に更に文字がまだある場合で、文字列中の次の文字が妥当な分母句読点文字である場合、 何も返さず、これらの段階を停止します。
  14. 文字列が範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE の文字をまだ他に含んでいる場合、 何も返さず、これらの段階を停止します。
  15. そうでない場合、 number1number2 を返します。

数を探すための算法は次の通りです。 この算法は、文字列と開始位置を与えられ、 何も返さないか、数を返すか、誤り条件を返すかのいずれかです。

  1. 与えられた開始位置からはじめ、 U+002E FULL STOP か、範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE の10文字のいずれかであるような最初の文字まで、 その文字列中のすべての文字を無視します。
  2. そのような文字がない場合には、何も返さず、これらの段階を停止します。
  3. 段階 1 で一致した文字からはじめ、 U+002E FULL STOP か、範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE の10文字のいずれかであるような連続した文字群をすべて集め、 この1文字以上の文字からなる文字列を string に代入します。
  4. string が単一の U+002E FULL STOP 文字のみで構成される場合や、複数の U+002E FULL STOP 文字を含む場合は、誤り状態を返し、 これらの段階を停止します。
  5. string浮動小数点数値を構文解析する規則により構文解析し、 number を得ます。この段階は失敗しません (string妥当な浮動小数点数であることが保証されています)。
  6. number を返します。
2.4.3.5. 百分率と寸法

valid positive non-zero integers rules for parsing dimension values (only used by height/width on img, embed, object — lengths in css pixels or percentages)

2.4.3.6. 整数のリスト

妥当な整数の並びは、 U+002C COMMA 文字で分離された数々の妥当な整数であって、 他の文字を含まない (例えば間隔文字を含まない) ものです。 加えて、与えられる整数の数や認められる値の範囲に制限が設けられることがあります。

整数のリストを構文解析する規則は次の通りです。

  1. input を構文解析される文字列とします。

  2. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  3. numbers を、初期状態として、空の整数のリストとします。 このリストは、この算法の結果となります。

  4. 文字列 input の位置 position に文字があり、これが U+0020 SPACE、U+002C COMMA、 U+003B SEMICOLON のいずれかの文字であれば、 positioninput 中の次の文字に進めるか、それ以上文字がないのであれば文字列の終わりを過ぎたとします。

  5. positioninput の終わりを過ぎた先を指していれば、 numbers を返し、停止します。

  6. 文字列 input の位置 position が U+0020 SPACE、U+002C COMMA、U+003B SEMICOLON のいずれかの文字であれば、段階 4 に戻ります。

  7. negated を偽とします。

  8. value を 0 とします。

  9. started を偽とします。この変数は、 構文解析器が数か「-」文字を見たときに真に設定されます。

  10. got number を偽とします。この変数は構文解析器が数を見たときに真に設定されます。

  11. finished を偽とします。この変数は構文解析器が次の分離子まで文字を無視するモードに切り替わったとき真に設定されます。

  12. bogus を偽とします。

  13. 構文解析器: 文字列 input 位置 position の文字が、

    U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS 文字の場合

    次の部分段階に従います。

    1. got number が真である場合、 finished を真とします。
    2. finished が真であれる場合、全体の段階の集合のうちの次の段階に飛びます。
    3. started が真である場合、 negated を偽とします。
    4. そうでない場合、started が偽であり、 bogus が偽である場合、 negated を真とします。
    5. started を真とします。
    範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE の文字の場合

    次の部分段階に従います。

    1. finished が真であれる場合、全体の段階の集合のうちの次の段階に飛びます。
    2. value を10倍します。
    3. 数字を十進数で解釈した場合の値を value に加えます。
    4. started を真とします。
    5. got number を真とします。
    U+0020 SPACE 文字の場合
    U+002C COMMA 文字の場合
    U+003B SEMICOLON 文字の場合

    次の部分段階に従います。

    1. got number が偽の場合、 numbers リストを返し、停止します。 これは、「1,2,x,4」のようにリスト中の項目が数字を持たない場合に起こります。
    2. negated が真の場合、 value を負にします。
    3. valuenumbers リストの末尾に追加します。
    4. 全体の段階の集合のうちの段階 4 に飛びます。
    U+002E FULL STOP 文字の場合

    次の部分段階に従います。

    1. got number が真である場合、 finished を真とします。
    2. finished が真であれる場合、全体の段階の集合のうちの次の段階に飛びます。
    3. negated を偽とします。
    その他の文字の場合

    次の部分段階に従います。

    1. finished が真であれる場合、全体の段階の集合のうちの次の段階に飛びます。
    2. negated を偽とします。
    3. bogus を真とします。
    4. started が真の場合、 numbers リストを返し、停止します。 (value の値はリストに最初に追加されてはいません。 捨てられます。)
  14. positioninput 中の次の文字に進めるか、それ以上文字がないのであれば文字列の終わりを過ぎたとします。

  15. position が文字を指す場合 (で input の終わりを過ぎていない場合)、 先の大段階構文解析器に飛びます。

  16. negated が真の場合、 value を負にします。

  17. got number が真の場合、 valuenumbers リストの最後に追加します。

  18. numbers リストを返し、停止します。

2.4.4 日付と時刻

後述の算法において、year の月 month の日の数は、 month が 1、3、5、7、8、10、12 のいずれかであれば 31month が 4、6、9、11 のいずれかであれば 30month が 2 で year が 400 で割り切れる数であるか、 year が 4 で割り切れるものの 100 では割り切れない数であれば 29、 いずれでもなければ 28 です。これはグレゴリオ暦の閏年を考慮しています。 [GREGORIAN]

2.4.4.1. 特定の時刻

文字列が妥当な日時であるとは、4つの数字 (年を表します。)、ハイフン文字、2つの数字 (月を表します。)、 ハイフン文字、2つの数字 (日を表します。)、任意選択でいくらかの間隔、 文字 T または間隔、任意選択でいくらかの間隔、 2つの数字 (時)、コロン、2つの数字 (分)、 任意選択で秒 (これが含まれる場合、再度コロンの後に2つの数字 (秒の整数部)、任意選択で小数点の後に1つ以上の数字 (秒の小数部) で構成されなければなりません。)、 任意選択でいくらかの間隔、そして最後に Z 文字 (時間帯が UTC であることを示します。) か、または正符号か負符号、2つの数字、コロン、2つの数字 (それぞれ時差の符号、 時、分) の並びのいずれか、これらを持つことをいいます。 ただし、月と日の組み合わせが当該年のグレゴリオ暦に照らして妥当な日付であり、 時の値 (h) が範囲 0 ≤ h ≤ 23 に、分の値 (m) が範囲 0 ≤ m ≤ 59 に、秒の値 (s) が範囲 0 ≤ h < 60 にあることとします。 [GREGORIAN]

数字は範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字でなければならず、ハイフンは U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS 文字でなければならず、 T は U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T でなければならず、 コロンは U+003A COLON 文字でなければならず、 小数点は U+002E FULL STOP でなければならず、 Z は U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z でなければならず、 正符号は U+002B PLUS SIGN、負符号は U+002D (ハイフンと同じ) でなければなりません

次に示すのは、妥当な日時として書かれた日付の例です。

0037-12-13 00:00 Z
ネロ (ローマ皇帝) の誕生日の UTC における真夜中
1979-10-14T12:00:00.001-04:00
北米大陸東海岸の夏時刻適用中における1979年10月14日の正午の1ミリ秒後
8592-01-01 T 02:09 +02:09
8592年1月1日の UC にける真夜中。 時間帯は UTC から2時間9分進んだもの。

これらの日付に関して、いくつか注意点があります。

適合性検査器は時刻が妥当な時刻かどうかを決定するために後述の算法を使うことができます。

利用者エージェントは、 文字列を日時値として構文解析する際に文字列に次の算法を適用しなければなりません。 この算法は UTC での時刻と往復変換や表示のための関連付けられた時間帯の情報を返すか、 何も返さないことによって値が妥当な日時でないことを示すかのいずれかです。 算法が「失敗」といった時点で、何も返さないことを意味します。

  1. input を構文解析される文字列とします。

  2. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  3. 範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が丁度4文字の長さでない場合は、失敗です。 そうでない場合、得られた列を十進整数として解釈します。 この数を year とします。

  4. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合や position の位置の文字が U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS 文字でない場合、 失敗です。そうでない場合、 position を1文字先へ進めます。

  5. 範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が丁度2文字の長さでない場合、失敗です。 そうでない場合、得られた列を十進整数として解釈します。 この数を month とします。

  6. month が範囲 1 ≤ month ≤ 12 の数でない場合、失敗します。
  7. maxday を、year の月 month の日の数とします。

  8. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合や position の位置の文字が U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS 文字でない場合、 失敗です。そうでない場合、 position を1文字先へ進めます。

  9. 範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が丁度2文字の長さでない場合、失敗です。 そうでない場合、得られた列を十進整数として解釈します。 この数を day とします。

  10. day が範囲 1 ≤ month ≤ maxday の数でない場合、失敗します。

  11. U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T 文字であるか、または間隔文字である文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が零文字長の場合、または複数の U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T 文字を含む場合、失敗します。

  12. 範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が丁度2文字の長さでない場合、失敗です。 そうでない場合、得られた列を十進整数として解釈します。 この数を hour とします。

  13. hour が範囲 0 ≤ hour ≤ 23 の数でない場合、失敗します。
  14. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合、 または position の文字が U+003A COLON 文字でない場合、失敗します。 そうでない場合、 position を1文字先へ進めます。

  15. 範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が丁度2文字の長さでない場合、失敗です。 そうでない場合、得られた列を十進整数として解釈します。 この数を minute とします。

  16. minute が範囲 0 ≤ minute ≤ 59 の数でない場合、失敗します。
  17. second を、値「0」の文字列とします。

  18. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合、失敗します。

  19. position の文字が U+003A COLON の場合、

    1. positioninput 中の次の文字へ進めます。

    2. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合や、 input の最後の文字の位置にある場合や、 input 中の position から始まる次の2つの文字が共に範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字2つではない場合、失敗します。

    3. Collect a sequence of characters that are either characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) or U+002E FULL STOP characters. If the collected sequence has more than one U+002E FULL STOP characters, or if the last character in the sequence is a U+002E FULL STOP character, then fail. Otherwise, let the collected string be second instead of its previous value.

  20. Interpret second as a base-ten number (possibly with a fractional part). Let that number be second instead of the string version.

  21. If second is not a number in the range 0 ≤ second < 60, then fail. (The values 60 and 61 are not allowed: leap seconds cannot be represented by datetime values.)
  22. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合、失敗します。

  23. 空白を読み飛ばします

  24. If the character at position is a U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z, then:

    1. Let timezonehours be 0.

    2. Let timezoneminutes be 0.

    3. positioninput 中の次の文字へ進めます。

  25. Otherwise, if the character at position is either a U+002B PLUS SIGN ("+") or a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-"), then:

    1. If the character at position is a U+002B PLUS SIGN ("+"), let sign be "positive". Otherwise, it's a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-"); let sign be "negative".

    2. positioninput 中の次の文字へ進めます。

    3. 範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が丁度2文字の長さでない場合、失敗です。 そうでない場合、得られた列を十進整数として解釈します。 この数を timezonehours とします。

    4. If timezonehours is not a number in the range 0 ≤ timezonehours ≤ 23, then fail.
    5. If sign is "negative", then negate timezonehours.
    6. positioninput の終わりを過ぎている場合、 または position の文字が U+003A COLON 文字でない場合、失敗します。 そうでない場合、 position を1文字先へ進めます。

    7. 範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) の文字の列を集めます。 集めた列が丁度2文字の長さでない場合、失敗です。 そうでない場合、得られた列を十進整数として解釈します。 この数を timezoneminutes とします。

    8. If timezoneminutes is not a number in the range 0 ≤ timezoneminutes ≤ 59, then fail.
    9. If sign is "negative", then negate timezoneminutes.
  26. If position is not beyond the end of input, then fail.

  27. Let time be the moment in time at year year, month month, day day, hours hour, minute minute, second second, subtracting timezonehours hours and timezoneminutes minutes. That moment in time is a moment in the UTC timezone.

  28. Let timezone be timezonehours hours and timezoneminutes minutes from UTC.

  29. Return time and timezone.

2.4.4.2. より曖昧な時刻

この節は日付か時刻の文字列を定義します。 これは2種類あり、1つは内容中の日付か時刻の文字列で、 もう1つは属性中の日付か時刻の文字列です。 違いは空白文字の取扱いだけです。

利用者エージェントは、日付か時刻の文字列を構文解析する際、 次の算法を使わなければなりません日付か時刻の文字列は、 次の算法を文字列上で走らせた時に文字列が非妥当であると言われなければ、 妥当な日付か時刻の文字列です。

算法は何も返さないかもしれません (その場合文字列は非妥当です) し、日付や時刻や日付と時刻や日付と時刻と時間帯を返すかもしれません。 算法がいくつかの値を返した場合であっても、 文字列は非妥当であることもあります。

  1. input を構文解析される文字列とします。

  2. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  3. results を、 返される結果 (日付、時刻、時間帯の1つ以上) の集成で、 はじめは空とします。 算法が途中で停止した場合、その時点で results に入っているものが何であれ算法の結果として返されなければなりません

  4. For the "in content" variant: skip White_Space characters; for the "in attributes" variant: skip whitespace.

  5. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9). If the collected sequence is empty, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.

  6. Let the sequence of characters collected in the last step be s.

  7. If position is past the end of input, the string is invalid; abort these steps.

  8. If the character at position is not a U+003A COLON character, then:

    1. If the character at position is not a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-") character either, then the string is invalid, abort these steps.

    2. If the sequence s is not exactly four digits long, then the string is invalid. (This does not stop the algorithm, however.)

    3. Interpret the sequence of characters collected in step 5 as a base-ten integer, and let that number be year.

    4. Advance position past the U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-") character.

    5. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9). If the collected sequence is empty, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.

    6. If the sequence collected in the last step is not exactly two digits long, then the string is invalid.

    7. Interpret the sequence of characters collected two steps ago as a base-ten integer, and let that number be month.

    8. If month is not a number in the range 1 ≤ month ≤ 12, then the string is invalid, abort these steps.
    9. maxday を、year の月 month の日の数とします。

    10. If position is past the end of input, or if the character at position is not a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-") character, then the string is invalid, abort these steps. Otherwise, advance position to the next character.

    11. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9). If the collected sequence is empty, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.

    12. If the sequence collected in the last step is not exactly two digits long, then the string is invalid.

    13. Interpret the sequence of characters collected two steps ago as a base-ten integer, and let that number be day.

    14. If day is not a number in the range 1 ≤ day ≤ maxday, then the string is invalid, abort these steps.

    15. Add the date represented by year, month, and day to the results.

    16. For the "in content" variant: skip White_Space characters; for the "in attributes" variant: skip whitespace.

    17. If the character at position is a U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T, then move position forwards one character.

    18. For the "in content" variant: skip White_Space characters; for the "in attributes" variant: skip whitespace.

    19. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9). If the collected sequence is empty, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.

    20. Let s be the sequence of characters collected in the last step.

  9. If s is not exactly two digits long, then the string is invalid.

  10. Interpret the sequence of characters collected two steps ago as a base-ten integer, and let that number be hour.

  11. If hour is not a number in the range 0 ≤ hour ≤ 23, then the string is invalid, abort these steps.

  12. If position is past the end of input, or if the character at position is not a U+003A COLON character, then the string is invalid, abort these steps. Otherwise, advance position to the next character.

  13. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9). If the collected sequence is empty, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.

  14. If the sequence collected in the last step is not exactly two digits long, then the string is invalid.

  15. Interpret the sequence of characters collected two steps ago as a base-ten integer, and let that number be minute.

  16. If minute is not a number in the range 0 ≤ minute ≤ 59, then the string is invalid, abort these steps.

  17. Let second be 0. It might be changed to another value in the next step.

  18. If position is not past the end of input and the character at position is a U+003A COLON character, then:

    1. Collect a sequence of characters that are either characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9) or are U+002E FULL STOP. If the collected sequence is empty, or contains more than one U+002E FULL STOP character, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.

    2. If the first character in the sequence collected in the last step is not in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9), then the string is invalid.

    3. Interpret the sequence of characters collected two steps ago as a base-ten number (possibly with a fractional part), and let that number be second.

    4. If second is not a number in the range 0 ≤ minute < 60, then the string is invalid, abort these steps.

  19. Add the time represented by hour, minute, and second to the results.

  20. If results has both a date and a time, then:

    1. For the "in content" variant: skip White_Space characters; for the "in attributes" variant: skip whitespace.

    2. If position is past the end of input, then skip to the next step in the overall set of steps.

    3. Otherwise, if the character at position is a U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z, then:

      1. Add the timezone corresponding to UTC (zero offset) to the results.

      2. positioninput 中の次の文字へ進めます。

      3. Skip to the next step in the overall set of steps.

    4. Otherwise, if the character at position is either a U+002B PLUS SIGN ("+") or a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-"), then:

      1. If the character at position is a U+002B PLUS SIGN ("+"), let sign be "positive". Otherwise, it's a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("-"); let sign be "negative".

      2. positioninput 中の次の文字へ進めます。

      3. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9). If the collected sequence is not exactly two characters long, then the string is invalid.

      4. Interpret the sequence collected in the last step as a base-ten number, and let that number be timezonehours.

      5. If timezonehours is not a number in the range 0 ≤ timezonehours ≤ 23, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.
      6. If sign is "negative", then negate timezonehours.
      7. If position is beyond the end of input or if the character at position is not a U+003A COLON character, then the string is invalid; abort these steps. Otherwise, move position forwards one character.

      8. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) to U+0039 DIGIT NINE (9). If the collected sequence is not exactly two characters long, then the string is invalid.

      9. Interpret the sequence collected in the last step as a base-ten number, and let that number be timezoneminutes.

      10. If timezoneminutes is not a number in the range 0 ≤ timezoneminutes ≤ 59, then the string is invalid; abort these steps.
      11. Add the timezone corresponding to an offset of timezonehours hours and timezoneminutes minutes to the results.

      12. Skip to the next step in the overall set of steps.

    5. Otherwise, the string is invalid; abort these steps.

  21. For the "in content" variant: skip White_Space characters; for the "in attributes" variant: skip whitespace.

  22. If position is not past the end of input, then the string is invalid.

  23. Abort these steps (the string is parsed).

2.4.5 Time offsets

valid time offset, rules for parsing time offsets, time offset serialization rules; in the format "5d4h3m2s1ms" or "3m 9.2s" or "00:00:00.00" or similar.

2.4.6 Tokens

A set of space-separated tokens is a set of zero or more words separated by one or more space characters, where words consist of any string of one or more characters, none of which are space characters.

A string containing a set of space-separated tokens may have leading or trailing space characters.

An unordered set of unique space-separated tokens is a set of space-separated tokens where none of the words are duplicated.

An ordered set of unique space-separated tokens is a set of space-separated tokens where none of the words are duplicated but where the order of the tokens is meaningful.

Sets of space-separated tokens sometimes have a defined set of allowed values. When a set of allowed values is defined, the tokens must all be from that list of allowed values; other values are non-conforming. If no such set of allowed values is provided, then all values are conforming.

When a user agent has to split a string on spaces, it must use the following algorithm:

  1. input を構文解析される文字列とします。

  2. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  3. Let tokens be a list of tokens, initially empty.

  4. Skip whitespace

  5. While position is not past the end of input:

    1. Collect a sequence of characters that are not space characters.

    2. Add the string collected in the previous step to tokens.

    3. Skip whitespace

  6. Return tokens.

When a user agent has to remove a token from a string, it must use the following algorithm:

  1. Let input be the string being modified.

  2. Let token be the token being removed. It will not contain any space characters.

  3. Let output be the output string, initially empty.

  4. positioninput 中の指示子とし、初期位置を文字列の始めとします。

  5. If position is beyond the end of input, set the string being modified to output, and abort these steps.

  6. If the character at position is a space character:

    1. Append the character at position to the end of output.

    2. Increment position so it points at the next character in input.

    3. 手順 5 in the overall set of steps に戻ります。

  7. Otherwise, the character at position is the first character of a token. Collect a sequence of characters that are not space characters, and let that be s.

  8. If s is exactly equal to token, then:

    1. Skip whitespace (in input).

    2. Remove any space characters currently at the end of output.

    3. If position is not past the end of input, and output is not the empty string, append a single U+0020 SPACE character at the end of output.

  9. Otherwise, append s to the end of output.

  10. 手順 6 in the overall set of steps に戻ります。

This causes any occurrences of the token to be removed from the string, and any spaces that were surrounding the token to be collapsed to a single space, except at the start and end of the string, where such spaces are removed.

2.4.7 Keywords and enumerated attributes

Some attributes are defined as taking one of a finite set of keywords. Such attributes are called enumerated attributes. The keywords are each defined to map to a particular state (several keywords might map to the same state, in which case some of the keywords are synonyms of each other; additionally, some of the keywords can be said to be non-conforming, and are only in the specification for historical reasons). In addition, two default states can be given. The first is the invalid value default, the second is the missing value default.

If an enumerated attribute is specified, the attribute's value must be an ASCII case-insensitive match for one of the given keywords that are not said to be non-conforming, with no leading or trailing whitespace.

When the attribute is specified, if its value is an ASCII case-insensitively match for one of the given keywords then that keyword's state is the state that the attribute represents. If the attribute value matches none of the given keywords, but the attribute has an invalid value default, then the attribute represents that state. Otherwise, if the attribute value matches none of the keywords but there is a missing value default state defined, then that is the state represented by the attribute. Otherwise, there is no default, and invalid values must be ignored.

When the attribute is not specified, if there is a missing value default state defined, then that is the state represented by the (missing) attribute. Otherwise, the absence of the attribute means that there is no state represented.

The empty string can be one of the keywords in some cases. For example the contenteditable attribute has two states: true, matching the true keyword and the empty string, false, matching false and all other keywords (it's the invalid value default). It could further be thought of as having a third state inherit, which would be the default when the attribute is not specified at all (the missing value default), but for various reasons that isn't the way this specification actually defines it.

2.4.8 References

A valid hash-name reference to an element of type type is a string consisting of a U+0023 NUMBER SIGN (#) character followed by a string which exactly matches the value of the name attribute of an element in the document with type type.

The rules for parsing a hash-name reference to an element of type type are as follows:

  1. If the string being parsed does not contain a U+0023 NUMBER SIGN character, or if the first such character in the string is the last character in the string, then return null and abort these steps.

  2. Let s be the string from the character immediately after the first U+0023 NUMBER SIGN character in the string being parsed up to the end of that string.

  3. Return the first element of type type that has an id or name attribute whose value is a compatibility caseless match for s.

2.5 URL

この仕様書は、用語 URL を定義し、 URL を処理する各種算法を定義します。というのは、歴史的理由により、 URI や IRI の仕様書で定義されている規則は Web 内容との互換性のために HTML 利用者エージェントが実装する必要があるものの完全な説明となっていないからです。

2.5.1 用語

URL は資源を識別するために使われる文字列です。URL は常に Document と関連付けられています。この関連付けは URL が作成されるか定義される時に明示的になされるか、 または DOM 節点を通じてなされる (この場合、関連付けられた Document は節点の Document です。) か、スクリプトを通じてなされます (この場合、関連付けられた Document はスクリプトのスクリプト文書文脈です。)。

URL は、次の条件の最低1つが満たされる場合、 妥当な URL です。

この仕様書中の用語「URL」は、 RFC 3986 で与えられている正確な技術的な意味と異なった形で使われています。 RFC 3986 に精通した読者にとっては、ここでの用語「URL」が何か全く別の呼ばれ方をしたものであると思った方がこの仕様書を読むのが楽になるでしょう。

2.5.2 URL の構文解析

利用者エージェントは、 url という URL を構文解析して各部品部分に分ける際に、 次の段階を使わなければなりません

  1. url から先頭と末尾の間隔文字を除去します。

  2. url を RFC 3986 で定義された方法で構文解析します。 ただし、次の例外に従います。

  3. ABNF 定義に前述の変更を加えた後であっても url が <URI-reference> 生成規則に一致しない場合は、 URL の構文解析は誤りにより失敗とします。 [RFC3986]

    そうでない場合、 url の構文解析は成功です。 URL の部品は次の通り定義される url の各部分文字列です。

    <scheme>

    <scheme> 生成規則に一致する部分文字列 (あれば)。

    <host>

    <host> 生成規則に一致する部分文字列 (あれば)。

    <port>

    <port> 生成規則に一致する部分文字列 (あれば)。

    <hostport>

    <scheme> 部品と <port> 部品があり、 <port> 部品により与えられるポートが <scheme> 部品により与えられるプロトコルに対して定義された既定のポートと異なる場合、 <hostport> は <host> 生成規則に一致する部分文字列で始まり、 <port> 生成規則に一致する部分文字列で終わり、両者の間のコロンを含む部分文字列です。 そうでない場合、 <host> 部品と同じです。

    <path>

    次の生成規則のいずれかに一致する部分文字列 (いずれかが一致する場合)。

    • <path-abempty>
    • <path-absolute>
    • <path-noscheme>
    • <path-rootless>
    • <path-empty>
    <query>

    <query> 生成規則に一致する部分文字列 (あれば)。

    <fragment>

    <fragment> 生成規則に一致する部分文字列 (あれば)。

2.5.3 URL の解決

相対 URL は基底 URL に対して相対的に解決されます。 URL基底 URLは、次のようにして得られる絶対 URL です。

解決する URL が API に渡された場合

基底 URL は、そのスクリプトのスクリプト文書文脈文書基底 URL です。

解決する URL が内容属性の値に由来する場合

基底 URL は、 XML 基底仕様書によって定義される、その属性の属する要素の基底 URI です。ここで、文書実体の基底 URI は、その要素を所有する Document文書基底 URL として定義されます。

利用者エージェントは、 XML 基底仕様書の範囲に関しては、すべての Document オブジェクトが XML 文書を表現するかのように作用しなければなりません

xml:base 属性は、 HTML 素片中であっても出現することがあります。なぜなら、スクリプトを作って動的にこの属性を追加することができるからです。 (しかし、 xml:base 属性は HTML 文書中では認められていないので、 そのようなスクリプトは適合しません。)

解決する URL がオフライン・アプリケーション・キャッシュ・マニフェスト中に現れた場合

基底 URL は、 アプリケーション・キャッシュマニフェストの URL です。

Document文書基底 URL は、次の段階を走らせて得られる絶対 URL です。

  1. 文書 head 要素の子供であり、かつ href 属性を持つ base 要素がない場合、 文書基底 URL文書の番地です。

  2. そうでない場合、 url をそのような最初の要素の href 属性の値とします。

  3. url URL を、文書の番地基底 URL として解決します (ですので、 base href 属性は xml:base 属性に影響されません)。

  4. 文書基底 URL は前の段階が成功した場合にはその結果、 そうでない場合には文書の番地です。

利用者エージェントは、URL を解決して絶対 URL にするために次の段階を使わなければなりません。 URL の解決は誤りに終わるかもしれませんが、その場合 URL は解決可能ではありません。

  1. url を、解決する URL とします。

  2. document を、url関連付けられている Document とします。

  3. encoding を、 document文字符号化とします。

  4. encoding が UTF-16 の場合、これを UTF-8 に変更します。

  5. base を、 url基底 URL とします。 (これは絶対 URL です。)

  6. url を各部分部品に構文解析します。

  7. url の構文解析の結果 <host> 部品が得られた場合、 url 中のそれに一致した部分文字列を、その部品中で百分率符号化されたオクテット列であって妥当な UTF-8 列である部分を UTF-8 で定義されているようにして Unicode 文字に置き換えた文字列によって置き換えます。

    この部品中の百分率符号化されたオクテットが妥当な UTF-8 列でない場合は、 誤りを返し、これらの段階を停止します。

    IDNA ToASCII 算法を、 AllowUnassigned 旗と UseSTD3ASCIIRules 旗の両方を設定した上で、一致した部分文字列に適用します。一致した部分文字列を、 ToASCII 算法の結果により置き換えます。

    ToASCIIが文字列の部品のいずれかの変換に失敗した場合 (例えば部品が長すぎる場合や非妥当な文字を含む場合)、 誤りを返し、これらの段階を停止します。 [RFC3490]

  8. url の構文解析の結果 <path> 部品が得られた場合、 url の一致した部分文字列を、 RFC 3986 で定義されている元々の <path> 生成規則に一致しない U+0025 PERCENT SIGN (%) 以外の文字それぞれに次の段階を適用した結果の文字列により置き換えます。

    1. 文字を、 UTF-8 で定義されているようにしてオクテット列に符号化します。
    2. 文字を、そのオクテット列の百分率符号化した形で置き換えます。 [RFC3986]

    例えば、 url が「//example.com/a^b☺c%FFd%z/?e」である場合、 <path> 部品の部分文字列は「/a^b☺c%FFd%z/」で、 逃避されなければならない2つの文字は「^」と「」です。 従って、この段階を適用した結果、url は「//example.com/a%5Eb%E2%98%BAc%FFd%z/?e」となります。

  9. url の構文解析の結果 <query> 部品が得られた場合、 url の一致した部分文字列を、 RFC 3986 で定義されている元々の <path> 生成規則に一致しない U+0025 PERCENT SIGN (%) 以外の文字それぞれに次の段階を適用した結果の文字列により置き換えます。

    1. 当該文字が符号化 encoding で表現できない場合、 これを単一の 0x3F オクテット (ASCII 疑問符) で置き換え、 この文字についての残りの部分段階を飛ばします。
    2. 文字を、符号化 encoding で定義されているようにしてオクテット列に符号化します。
    3. 文字を、そのオクテット列の百分率符号化した形で置き換えます。 [RFC3986]
  10. RFC 3986 5.2 節 相対解決で説明されている算法を適用します。ここで、 url を潜在的相対 URI 参照 (R)、 base を基底 URI (Base) とします。 [RFC3986]

  11. RFC 3986 と RFC 3987 の関係する適合性基準を適用し、 適切であれば、誤りを返し、これらの段階を停止します。 [RFC3986] [RFC3987]

    例えば、前述の算法で返される絶対 URI がその scheme に特有の制限に違反している場合、 具体例としては data: URI が「//」鯖型命名局構文を使っている場合、 利用者エージェントは代わりにこれを誤りとして扱うことになります。

  12. result を、相対解決算法で返される対象 URI (T) とします。

  13. result が鯖型命名局の scheme を使っている場合、 result 中のすべての U+005C REVERSE SOLIDUS (\) 文字を U+002F SOLIDUS (/) 文字に置き換えます。

  14. result を返します。

URL は、これを解決しても誤りとならずに同じ URL が得られる場合、絶対 URL です。

2.5.4 基底 URL に対する動的な変更

xml:base 属性が変化した時、その属性の要素と、すべての子孫要素は、 基底 URL の変更に影響されます

文書の文書基底 URL が変化した時、 文書中のすべての要素は基底 URL の変更に影響されます

要素がある文書から別の文書へと移動された時、 2つの文書が異なる基底 URL を持つ場合、 その要素とすべての子孫は基底 URL の変更に影響されます

要素が基底 URL の変更に影響される時、 次の並びで説明するように作用しなければなりません

要素がハイパーリンク要素である場合

当該ハイパーリンクにより識別される絶対 URL が利用者に示される場合に、あるいはその URL に由来する何らかのデータが表示に影響する場合に、 href 属性は再解決され、 利用者界面は適切に更新されるべきです

例えば、 CSS :link/:visited 擬似クラスが影響を受けるかもしれません。

ハイパーリンクが ping 属性を持ち、その絶対 URL (群) が利用者に示される場合に、 ping 属性の字句は再解決され、 利用者界面は適切に更新されるべきです

要素が blockquoteqinsdel のいずれかの要素であって、 cite 属性を持つ場合

cite 属性により識別される絶対 URL が利用者に示される場合に、あるいはその URL に由来する何らかのデータが表示に影響する場合に、 再解決され、 利用者界面は適切に更新されるべきです

その他の場合

要素は直接影響されません。

基底 URL を変更しても img 要素が表示する画像には影響しません。 ただし、以後スクリプトから src 属性にアクセスすると表示中の画像とは対応しなくなった新しい絶対 URL が返されるようになります。

2.5.5 URL 操作用界面

URL 分解属性を持つ界面は、 次の定義による7つの属性を持ちます。

           attribute DOMString protocol;
           attribute DOMString host;
           attribute DOMString hostname;
           attribute DOMString port;
           attribute DOMString pathname;
           attribute DOMString search;
           attribute DOMString hash;

URL 分解属性として定義される属性は、この節の中の同じ対応する名前の属性について説明されているように作用しなければなりません

加えて、 URL 分解属性を実装する界面は入力共通設定器作用を定義しますが、 前者はこれは属性が作用する対象の URL で、 後者はいずれかの属性の設定器が呼び出された時に呼び出される段階の集合です。

7つの URL 分解属性は似た要件を持ちます。

取得時、利用者エージェントは、 入力が後述の表の該当属性に対応する「取得器条件」の列に与えられた条件を満たす場合、 「部品」の列で与えられる入力 URL の一部分を、「接頭辞」の列で指定された接頭辞をその文字列のはじめに適切に追加し、 「接尾辞」の列で指定された接尾辞をその文字列の終わりに適切に追加した上で、 返さなければなりません。 そうでない場合、属性は空文字列を返さなければなりません

設定時、新しい値はまず「設定器前処理器」の列で説明されるように変異し、 次に新しい値の中の文字で「部品」の列で与えられる関係する部品において妥当でないものをすべて %逃避により変異しなければなりません。その後、 変異結果の新しい値が「設定器条件」の列に与えられた条件を満たす場合、利用者エージェントは、 入力 URL 中の、 「部品」の列で与えられる URL 中の部品を、 新しい値によって置き換えた新しい文字列 output を作らなければなりません。 そうでない場合、利用者エージェントは、 output入力と等しくしなければなりません。 最後に、利用者エージェントは、値 output により共通設定器作用を呼び出さなければなりません

URL 中の部品を置き換える時、その部品が URL 構文中で1文字の後にその部品が続くような任意選択の群の一部である場合には、 その部品 (と接頭辞文字) は、新しい値が空文字列であっても含めなければなりません

前の段落は、特に <port> 部品の前の「:」、 <query> 部品の前の「?」、 <fragment> 部品の前の「#」に適用されます。

先の定義に関しては、 URL はこの仕様書で定義する URL 構文解析規則を使って構文解析されなければなりません
属性部品取得器条件接頭辞接尾辞設定器前処理器設定器条件
protocol <scheme> U+003A COLON (":") 末尾のすべての U+003A COLON (":") 文字を削除新しい値は空文字列ではない
host <hostport> 入力は階層的で、 鯖型命名局を使っている
hostname <host> 入力は階層的で、 鯖型命名局を使っている先頭のすべての U+002F SOLIDUS ("/") 文字を削除
port <port> 入力は階層的で、 鯖型命名局を使っており、 <port> 部品を (空であったとしても) 含んでいる新しい値の中の範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE 以外の文字をすべて削除。 その結果の文字列が空の場合、単一の U+0030 DIGIT ZERO character ('0' に設定。
pathname <path> 入力が階層的先頭が U+002F SOLIDUS ("/") 文字ではない場合、 新しい値の前に U+002F SOLIDUS ("/") 文字を追加
search <query> 入力は階層的で、 <query> 部品を (空であったとしても) 含んでいるU+003F QUESTION MARK ("?") 先頭に U+003F QUESTION MARK ("?") 文字があれば、これを1つ削除
hash <fragment> 入力は階層的で、 <fragment> 部品を (空であったとしても) 含んでいるU+0023 NUMBER SIGN ("#") 先頭に U+0023 NUMBER SIGN ("#") 文字があれば、 これを1つ削除

次の表は、 search の取得器条件が元々の URL の正確な構文の違いによってどのように結果が変化するかを示しています。

入力 URLsearch説明
http://example.com/ 空文字列入力中に <query> 部品がありません。
http://example.com/? ? <query> 部品がありますが、 空です。結果の値の疑問符は接頭辞です。
http://example.com/?test ?test <query> 部品は値「test」を持ちます。
http://example.com/?test# ?test (空の) <fragment> 部品は <query> 部品の一部ではありません。

2.6 Fetching resources

When a user agent is to fetch a resource, the following steps must be run:

  1. If the resource is identified by a URL, then immediately resolve that URL.

  2. If the resulting absolute URL is about:blank, then return the empty string and abort these steps.

  3. Perform the remaining steps asynchronously.

  4. If the resource identified by the resulting absolute URL is already being downloaded for other reasons (e.g. another invocation of this algorithm), and the resource is to be obtained using a idempotent action (such as an HTTP GET or equivalent), and the user agent is configured such that it is to reuse the data from the existing download instead of initiating a new one, then use the results of the existing download instead of starting a new one.

    Otherwise, at a time convenient to the user and the user agent, download the resource, applying the semantics of the relevant specifications (e.g. performing an HTTP GET or POST operation, or reading the file from disk, following redirects, dereferencing javascript: URLs, etc).

  5. When the resource is available, queue a task that uses the resource as appropriate. If the resource can be processed incrementally, as, for instance, with a progressively interlaced JPEG or an HTML file, multiple tasks may be queued to process the data as it is downloaded. The task source for these tasks is the networking task source.

The offline application cache processing model introduces some changes to the networking model to handle the returning of cached resources.

The navigation processing model handles redirects itself, overriding the redirection handling that would be done by the fetching algorithm.

Whether the type sniffing rules apply to the fetched resource depends on the algorithm that invokes the rules — they are not always applicable.

2.7 Determining the type of a resource

It is imperative that the rules in this section be followed exactly. When a user agent uses different heuristics for content type detection than the server expects, security problems can occur. For example, if a server believes that the client will treat a contributed file as an image (and thus treat it as benign), but a Web browser believes the content to be HTML (and thus execute any scripts contained therein), the end user can be exposed to malicious content, making the user vulnerable to cookie theft attacks and other cross-site scripting attacks.

2.7.1 Content-Type metadata

What explicit Content-Type metadata is associated with the resource (the resource's type information) depends on the protocol that was used to fetch the resource.

For HTTP resources, only the first Content-Type HTTP header, if any, contributes any type information; the explicit type of the resource is then the value of that header, interpreted as described by the HTTP specifications. If the Content-Type HTTP header is present but the value of the first such header cannot be interpreted as described by the HTTP specifications (e.g. because its value doesn't contain a U+002F SOLIDUS ('/') character), then the resource has no type information (even if there are multiple Content-Type HTTP headers and one of the other ones is syntactically correct). [HTTP]

For resources fetched from the file system, user agents should use platform-specific conventions, e.g. operating system extension/type mappings.

Extensions must not be used for determining resource types for resources fetched over HTTP.

For resources fetched over most other protocols, e.g. FTP, there is no type information.

The algorithm for extracting an encoding from a Content-Type, given a string s, is as follows. It either returns an encoding or nothing.

  1. Find the first seven characters in s that are an ASCII case-insensitive match for the word "charset". If no such match is found, return nothing.

  2. Skip any U+0009, U+000A, U+000C, U+000D, or U+0020 characters that immediately follow the word 'charset' (there might not be any).

  3. If the next character is not a U+003D EQUALS SIGN ('='), return nothing.

  4. Skip any U+0009, U+000A, U+000C, U+000D, or U+0020 characters that immediately follow the equals sign (there might not be any).

  5. Process the next character as follows:

    If it is a U+0022 QUOTATION MARK ('"') and there is a later U+0022 QUOTATION MARK ('"') in s
    If it is a U+0027 APOSTROPHE ("'") and there is a later U+0027 APOSTROPHE ("'") in s

    Return the string between this character and the next earliest occurrence of this character.

    If it is an unmatched U+0022 QUOTATION MARK ('"')
    If it is an unmatched U+0027 APOSTROPHE ("'")
    If there is no next character

    Return nothing.

    その他の場合

    Return the string from this character to the first U+0009, U+000A, U+000C, U+000D, U+0020, or U+003B character or the end of s, whichever comes first.

The above algorithm is a willful violation of the HTTP specification. [RFC2616]

2.7.2 Content-Type sniffing: Web pages

The sniffed type of a resource must be found as follows:

  1. If the user agent is configured to strictly obey Content-Type headers for this resource, then jump to the last step in this set of steps.

  2. If the resource was fetched over an HTTP protocol and there is an HTTP Content-Type header and the value of the first such header has bytes that exactly match one of the following lines:

    Bytes in Hexadecimal Textual representation
    74 65 78 74 2f 70 6c 61 69 6e text/plain
    74 65 78 74 2f 70 6c 61 69 6e 3b 20 63 68 61 72 73 65 74 3d 49 53 4f 2d 38 38 35 39 2d 31 text/plain; charset=ISO-8859-1
    74 65 78 74 2f 70 6c 61 69 6e 3b 20 63 68 61 72 73 65 74 3d 69 73 6f 2d 38 38 35 39 2d 31 text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
    74 65 78 74 2f 70 6c 61 69 6e 3b 20 63 68 61 72 73 65 74 3d 55 54 46 2d 38 text/plain; charset=UTF-8

    ...then jump to the text or binary section below.

  3. Let official type be the type given by the Content-Type metadata for the resource, ignoring parameters. If there is no such type, jump to the unknown type step below. Comparisons with this type, as defined by MIME specifications, are done in an ASCII case-insensitive manner. [RFC2046]

  4. If official type is "unknown/unknown" or "application/unknown", jump to the unknown type step below.

  5. If official type ends in "+xml", or if it is either "text/xml" or "application/xml", then the sniffed type of the resource is official type; return that and abort these steps.

  6. If official type is an image type supported by the user agent (e.g. "image/png", "image/gif", "image/jpeg", etc), then jump to the images section below, passing it the official type.

  7. If official type is "text/html", then jump to the feed or HTML section below.

  8. The sniffed type of the resource is official type.

2.7.3 Content-Type sniffing: text or binary

  1. The user agent may wait for 512 or more bytes of the resource to be available.

  2. Let n be the smaller of either 512 or the number of bytes already available.

  3. If n is 4 or more, and the first bytes of the resource match one of the following byte sets:

    Bytes in Hexadecimal Description
    FE FF UTF-16BE BOM
    FF FE UTF-16LE BOM
    EF BB BF UTF-8 BOM

    ...then the sniffed type of the resource is "text/plain". Abort these steps.

  4. If none of the first n bytes of the resource are binary data bytes then the sniffed type of the resource is "text/plain". Abort these steps.

  5. If the first bytes of the resource match one of the byte sequences in the "pattern" column of the table in the unknown type section below, ignoring any rows whose cell in the "security" column says "scriptable" (or "n/a"), then the sniffed type of the resource is the type given in the corresponding cell in the "sniffed type" column on that row; abort these steps.

    It is critical that this step not ever return a scriptable type (e.g. text/html), as otherwise that would allow a privilege escalation attack.

  6. Otherwise, the sniffed type of the resource is "application/octet-stream".

Bytes covered by the following ranges are binary data bytes:

2.7.4 Content-Type sniffing: unknown type

  1. The user agent may wait for 512 or more bytes of the resource to be available.

  2. Let stream length be the smaller of either 512 or the number of bytes already available.

  3. For each row in the table below:

    If the row has no "WS" bytes:
    1. Let pattern length be the length of the pattern (number of bytes described by the cell in the second column of the row).
    2. If stream length is smaller than pattern length then skip this row.
    3. Apply the "and" operator to the first pattern length bytes of the resource and the given mask (the bytes in the cell of first column of that row), and let the result be the data.
    4. If the bytes of the data matches the given pattern bytes exactly, then the sniffed type of the resource is the type given in the cell of the third column in that row; abort these steps.
    If the row has a "WS" byte:
    1. Let indexpattern be an index into the mask and pattern byte strings of the row.

    2. Let indexstream be an index into the byte stream being examined.

    3. Loop: If indexstream points beyond the end of the byte stream, then this row doesn't match, skip this row.

    4. Examine the indexstreamth byte of the byte stream as follows:

      If the indexpatternth byte of the pattern is a normal hexadecimal byte and not a "WS" byte:

      If the "and" operator, applied to the indexstreamth byte of the stream and the indexpatternth byte of the mask, yield a value different that the indexpatternth byte of the pattern, then skip this row.

      Otherwise, increment indexpattern to the next byte in the mask and pattern and indexstream to the next byte in the byte stream.

      Otherwise, if the indexpatternth byte of the pattern is a "WS" byte:

      "WS" means "whitespace", and allows insignificant whitespace to be skipped when sniffing for a type signature.

      If the indexstreamth byte of the stream is one of 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), or 0x20 (ASCII space), then increment only the indexstream to the next byte in the byte stream.

      Otherwise, increment only the indexpattern to the next byte in the mask and pattern.

    5. If indexpattern does not point beyond the end of the mask and pattern byte strings, then jump back to the loop step in this algorithm.

    6. Otherwise, the sniffed type of the resource is the type given in the cell of the third column in that row; abort these steps.

  4. If none of the first n bytes of the resource are binary data bytes then the sniffed type of the resource is "text/plain". Abort these steps.

  5. Otherwise, the sniffed type of the resource is "application/octet-stream".

The table used by the above algorithm is:
Bytes in Hexadecimal Sniffed type Security Comment
Mask Pattern
FF FF DF DF DF DF DF DF DF FF DF DF DF DF 3C 21 44 4F 43 54 59 50 45 20 48 54 4D 4C text/html Scriptable The string "<!DOCTYPE HTML" in US-ASCII or compatible encodings, case-insensitively.
FF FF DF DF DF DF WS 3C 48 54 4D 4C text/html Scriptable The string "<HTML" in US-ASCII or compatible encodings, case-insensitively, possibly with leading spaces.
FF FF DF DF DF DF WS 3C 48 45 41 44 text/html Scriptable The string "<HEAD" in US-ASCII or compatible encodings, case-insensitively, possibly with leading spaces.
FF FF DF DF DF DF DF DF WS 3C 53 43 52 49 50 54 text/html Scriptable The string "<SCRIPT" in US-ASCII or compatible encodings, case-insensitively, possibly with leading spaces.
FF FF FF FF FF 25 50 44 46 2D application/pdf Scriptable The string "%PDF-", the PDF signature.
FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF 25 21 50 53 2D 41 64 6F 62 65 2D application/postscript Safe The string "%!PS-Adobe-", the PostScript signature.
FF FF 00 00 FE FF 00 00 text/plain n/a UTF-16BE BOM
FF FF 00 00 FF FF 00 00 text/plain n/a UTF-16LE BOM
FF FF FF 00 EF BB BF 00 text/plain n/a UTF-8 BOM
FF FF FF FF FF FF 47 49 46 38 37 61 image/gif Safe The string "GIF87a", a GIF signature.
FF FF FF FF FF FF 47 49 46 38 39 61 image/gif Safe The string "GIF89a", a GIF signature.
FF FF FF FF FF FF FF FF 89 50 4E 47 0D 0A 1A 0A image/png Safe The PNG signature.
FF FF FF FF D8 FF image/jpeg Safe A JPEG SOI marker followed by the first byte of another marker.
FF FF 42 4D image/bmp Safe The string "BM", a BMP signature.
FF FF FF FF 00 00 01 00 image/vnd.microsoft.icon Safe A 0 word following by a 1 word, a Windows Icon file format signature.

I'd like to add types like MPEG, AVI, Flash, Java, etc, to the above table.

User agents may support further types if desired, by implicitly adding to the above table. However, user agents should not use any other patterns for types already mentioned in the table above, as this could then be used for privilege escalation (where, e.g., a server uses the above table to determine that content is not HTML and thus safe from XSS attacks, but then a user agent detects it as HTML anyway and allows script to execute).

The column marked "security" is used by the algorithm in the "text or binary" section, to avoid sniffing text/plain content as a type that can be used for a privilege escalation attack.

2.7.5 Content-Type sniffing: image

If the resource's official type is "image/svg+xml", then the sniffed type of the resource is its official type (an XML type).

Otherwise, if the first bytes of the resource match one of the byte sequences in the first column of the following table, then the sniffed type of the resource is the type given in the corresponding cell in the second column on the same row:
Bytes in Hexadecimal Sniffed type Comment
47 49 46 38 37 61 image/gif The string "GIF87a", a GIF signature.
47 49 46 38 39 61 image/gif The string "GIF89a", a GIF signature.
89 50 4E 47 0D 0A 1A 0A image/png The PNG signature.
FF D8 FF image/jpeg A JPEG SOI marker followed by the first byte of another marker.
42 4D image/bmp The string "BM", a BMP signature.
00 00 01 00 image/vnd.microsoft.icon A 0 word following by a 1 word, a Windows Icon file format signature.

Otherwise, the sniffed type of the resource is the same as its official type.

2.7.6 Content-Type sniffing: feed or HTML

  1. The user agent may wait for 512 or more bytes of the resource to be available.

  2. Let s be the stream of bytes, and let s[i] represent the byte in s with position i, treating s as zero-indexed (so the first byte is at i=0).

  3. If at any point this algorithm requires the user agent to determine the value of a byte in s which is not yet available, or which is past the first 512 bytes of the resource, or which is beyond the end of the resource, the user agent must stop this algorithm, and assume that the sniffed type of the resource is "text/html".

    User agents are allowed, by the first step of this algorithm, to wait until the first 512 bytes of the resource are available.

  4. Initialise pos to 0.

  5. If s[0] is 0xEF, s[1] is 0xBB, and s[2] is 0xBF, then set pos to 3. (This skips over a leading UTF-8 BOM, if any.)

  6. Loop start: Examine s[pos].

    If it is 0x09 (ASCII tab), 0x20 (ASCII space), 0x0A (ASCII LF), or 0x0D (ASCII CR)
    Increase pos by 1 and repeat this step.
    If it is 0x3C (ASCII "<")
    Increase pos by 1 and go to the next step.
    If it is anything else
    The sniffed type of the resource is "text/html". Abort these steps.
  7. If the bytes with positions pos to pos+2 in s are exactly equal to 0x21, 0x2D, 0x2D respectively (ASCII for "!--"), then:

    1. Increase pos by 3.
    2. If the bytes with positions pos to pos+2 in s are exactly equal to 0x2D, 0x2D, 0x3E respectively (ASCII for "-->"), then increase pos by 3 and jump back to the previous step (the step labeled loop start) in the overall algorithm in this section.
    3. Otherwise, increase pos by 1.
    4. 手順 2 in these substeps に戻ります。
  8. If s[pos] is 0x21 (ASCII "!"):

    1. Increase pos by 1.
    2. If s[pos] equal 0x3E, then increase pos by 1 and jump back to the step labeled loop start in the overall algorithm in this section.
    3. Otherwise, return to step 1 in these substeps.
  9. If s[pos] is 0x3F (ASCII "?"):

    1. Increase pos by 1.
    2. If s[pos] and s[pos+1] equal 0x3F and 0x3E respectively, then increase pos by 1 and jump back to the step labeled loop start in the overall algorithm in this section.
    3. Otherwise, return to step 1 in these substeps.
  10. Otherwise, if the bytes in s starting at pos match any of the sequences of bytes in the first column of the following table, then the user agent must follow the steps given in the corresponding cell in the second column of the same row.

    Bytes in Hexadecimal Requirement Comment
    72 73 73 The sniffed type of the resource is "application/rss+xml"; abort these steps The three ASCII characters "rss"
    66 65 65 64 The sniffed type of the resource is "application/atom+xml"; abort these steps The four ASCII characters "feed"
    72 64 66 3A 52 44 46 Continue to the next step in this algorithm The ASCII characters "rdf:RDF"

    If none of the byte sequences above match the bytes in s starting at pos, then the sniffed type of the resource is "text/html". Abort these steps.

  11. If, before the next ">", you find two xmlns* attributes with http://www.w3.org/1999/02/22-rdf-syntax-ns# and http://purl.org/rss/1.0/ as the namespaces, then the sniffed type of the resource is "application/rss+xml", abort these steps. (maybe we only need to check for http://purl.org/rss/1.0/ actually)

  12. Otherwise, the sniffed type of the resource is "text/html".

For efficiency reasons, implementations may wish to implement this algorithm and the algorithm for detecting the character encoding of HTML documents in parallel.

2.8 Common DOM interfaces

2.8.1 Reflecting content attributes in DOM attributes

Some DOM attributes are defined to reflect a particular content attribute. This means that on getting, the DOM attribute returns the current value of the content attribute, and on setting, the DOM attribute changes the value of the content attribute to the given value.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a DOMString attribute whose content attribute is defined to contain a URL, then on getting, the DOM attribute must resolve the value of the content attribute and return the resulting absolute URL if that was successful, or the empty string otherwise; and on setting, must set the content attribute to the specified literal value. If the content attribute is absent, the DOM attribute must return the default value, if the content attribute has one, or else the empty string.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a DOMString attribute whose content attribute is defined to contain one or more URLs, then on getting, the DOM attribute must split the content attribute on spaces and return the concatenation of resolving each token URL to an absolute URL, with a single U+0020 SPACE character between each URL, ignoring any tokens that did not resolve successfully. If the content attribute is absent, the DOM attribute must return the default value, if the content attribute has one, or else the empty string. On setting, the DOM attribute must set the content attribute to the specified literal value.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a DOMString whose content attribute is an enumerated attribute, and the DOM attribute is limited to only known values, then, on getting, the DOM attribute must return the conforming value associated with the state the attribute is in (in its canonical case), or the empty string if the attribute is in a state that has no associated keyword value; and on setting, if the new value is an ASCII case-insensitive match for one of the keywords given for that attribute, then the content attribute must be set to the conforming value associated with the state that the attribute would be in if set to the given new value, otherwise, if the new value is the empty string, then the content attribute must be removed, otherwise, the setter must raise a SYNTAX_ERR exception.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a DOMString but doesn't fall into any of the above categories, then the getting and setting must be done in a transparent, case-preserving manner.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a boolean attribute, then on getting the DOM attribute must return true if the attribute is set, and false if it is absent. On setting, the content attribute must be removed if the DOM attribute is set to false, and must be set to have the same value as its name if the DOM attribute is set to true. (This corresponds to the rules for boolean content attributes.)

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a signed integer type (long) then, on getting, the content attribute must be parsed according to the rules for parsing signed integers, and if that is successful, the resulting value must be returned. If, on the other hand, it fails, or if the attribute is absent, then the default value must be returned instead, or 0 if there is no default value. On setting, the given value must be converted to the shortest possible string representing the number as a valid integer in base ten and then that string must be used as the new content attribute value.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is an unsigned integer type (unsigned long) then, on getting, the content attribute must be parsed according to the rules for parsing unsigned integers, and if that is successful, the resulting value must be returned. If, on the other hand, it fails, or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be returned instead, or 0 if there is no default value. On setting, the given value must be converted to the shortest possible string representing the number as a valid non-negative integer in base ten and then that string must be used as the new content attribute value.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is an unsigned integer type (unsigned long) that is limited to only positive non-zero numbers, then the behavior is similar to the previous case, but zero is not allowed. On getting, the content attribute must first be parsed according to the rules for parsing unsigned integers, and if that is successful, the resulting value must be returned. If, on the other hand, it fails, or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be returned instead, or 1 if there is no default value. On setting, if the value is zero, the user agent must fire an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception. Otherwise, the given value must be converted to the shortest possible string representing the number as a valid non-negative integer in base ten and then that string must be used as the new content attribute value.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a floating point number type (float) and the content attribute is defined to contain a time offset, then, on getting, the content attribute must be parsed according to the rules for parsing time offsets, and if that is successful, the resulting value, in seconds, must be returned. If that fails, or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be returned, or the not-a-number value (NaN) if there is no default value. On setting, the given value, interpreted as a time offset in seconds, must be converted to a string using the time offset serialization rules, and that string must be used as the new content attribute value.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is a floating point number type (float) and it doesn't fall into one of the earlier categories, then, on getting, the content attribute must be parsed according to the rules for parsing floating point number values, and if that is successful, the resulting value must be returned. If, on the other hand, it fails, or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be returned instead, or 0.0 if there is no default value. On setting, the given value must be converted to the shortest possible string representing the number as a valid floating point number in base ten and then that string must be used as the new content attribute value.

If a reflecting DOM attribute is of the type DOMTokenList, then on getting it must return a DOMTokenList object whose underlying string is the element's corresponding content attribute. When the DOMTokenList object mutates its underlying string, the content attribute must itself be immediately mutated. When the attribute is absent, then the string represented by the DOMTokenList object is the empty string; when the object mutates this empty string, the user agent must first add the corresponding content attribute, and then mutate that attribute instead. DOMTokenList attributes are always read-only. The same DOMTokenList object must be returned every time for each attribute.

If a reflecting DOM attribute has the type HTMLElement, or an interface that descends from HTMLElement, then, on getting, it must run the following algorithm (stopping at the first point where a value is returned):

  1. If the corresponding content attribute is absent, then the DOM attribute must return null.
  2. Let candidate be the element that the document.getElementById() method would find if it was passed as its argument the current value of the corresponding content attribute.
  3. If candidate is null, or if it is not type-compatible with the DOM attribute, then the DOM attribute must return null.
  4. Otherwise, it must return candidate.

On setting, if the given element has an id attribute, then the content attribute must be set to the value of that id attribute. Otherwise, the DOM attribute must be set to the empty string.

2.8.2 Collections

The HTMLCollection, HTMLFormControlsCollection, and HTMLOptionsCollection interfaces represent various lists of DOM nodes. Collectively, objects implementing these interfaces are called collections.

When a collection is created, a filter and a root are associated with the collection.

For example, when the HTMLCollection object for the document.images attribute is created, it is associated with a filter that selects only img elements, and rooted at the root of the document.

The collection then represents a live view of the subtree rooted at the collection's root, containing only nodes that match the given filter. The view is linear. In the absence of specific requirements to the contrary, the nodes within the collection must be sorted in tree order.

The rows list is not in tree order.

An attribute that returns a collection must return the same object every time it is retrieved.

2.8.2.1. HTMLCollection

HTMLCollection 界面は、一般的な要素の集成を表します。

interface HTMLCollection {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] Element item(in unsigned long index);
  [NameGetter] Element namedItem(in DOMString name);
};

length 属性は集成が表現する節点の数を返さなければなりません

item(index) メソッドは集成中の index 番目の節点を返さなければなりません。 集成中の index 番目の節点が存在しない場合は、 メソッドは null を返さなければなりません。

namedItem(key) メソッドは、 集成中で次のいずれかの要件に一致する最初の節点を返さなければなりません

そのような要素が存在しない場合、メソッドは null を返さなければなりません

2.8.2.2. HTMLFormControlsCollection

HTMLFormControlsCollection 界面はフォーム制御子の集成を表します。

interface HTMLFormControlsCollection {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] HTMLElement item(in unsigned long index);
  [NameGetter] Object namedItem(in DOMString name);
};

length 属性は集成が表現する節点の数を返さなければなりません

item(index) メソッドは集成中の index 番目の節点を返さなければなりません。集成中に index 番目の節点が存在しなければ、メソッドは null を返さなければなりません。

namedItem(key) メソッドは次の算法に従って動作しなければなりません

  1. メソッド呼び出しの時点において、集成中に id 属性または name 属性のいずれかが key と等しい節点が丁度1つ存在するなら、 その節点を返し、算法を停止します。
  2. それ以外の場合で、集成中に id 属性または name 属性が key と等しい節点が存在しない場合は、 null を返し、算法を停止します。
  3. それ以外の場合、その HTMLFormControlsCollection オブジェクトの生きた表示であって、 id 属性または name 属性のいずれかが key と等しい節点だけが含まれるような NodeList オブジェクトを作成します。この NodeList オブジェクトに含まれる節点は木順で整列されていなければなりません
  4. その NodeList オブジェクトを返します。
2.8.2.3. HTMLOptionsCollection

The HTMLOptionsCollection interface represents a list of option elements.

interface HTMLOptionsCollection {
           attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] HTMLOptionElement item(in unsigned long index);
  [NameGetter] Object namedItem(in DOMString name);
};

On getting, the length attribute must return the number of nodes represented by the collection.

On setting, the behavior depends on whether the new value is equal to, greater than, or less than the number of nodes represented by the collection at that time. If the number is the same, then setting the attribute must do nothing. If the new value is greater, then n new option elements with no attributes and no child nodes must be appended to the select element on which the HTMLOptionsCollection is rooted, where n is the difference between the two numbers (new value minus old value). If the new value is lower, then the last n nodes in the collection must be removed from their parent nodes, where n is the difference between the two numbers (old value minus new value).

Setting length never removes or adds any optgroup elements, and never adds new children to existing optgroup elements (though it can remove children from them).

The item(index) method must return the indexth node in the collection. If there is no indexth node in the collection, then the method must return null.

The namedItem(key) method must act according to the following algorithm:

  1. メソッド呼び出しの時点において、集成中に id 属性または name 属性のいずれかが key と等しい節点が丁度1つ存在するなら、 その節点を返し、算法を停止します。
  2. それ以外の場合で、集成中に id 属性または name 属性が key と等しい節点が存在しない場合は、 null を返し、算法を停止します。
  3. Otherwise, create a NodeList object representing a live view of the HTMLOptionsCollection object, further filtered so that the only nodes in the NodeList object are those that have either an id attribute or a name attribute equal to key. The nodes in the NodeList object must be sorted in tree order.
  4. その NodeList オブジェクトを返します。

We may want to add add() and remove() methods here too because IE implements HTMLSelectElement and HTMLOptionsCollection on the same object, and so people use them almost interchangeably in the wild.

2.8.3 DOMTokenList

The DOMTokenList interface represents an interface to an underlying string that consists of an unordered set of unique space-separated tokens.

Which string underlies a particular DOMTokenList object is defined when the object is created. It might be a content attribute (e.g. the string that underlies the classList object is the class attribute), or it might be an anonymous string (e.g. when a DOMTokenList object is passed to an author-implemented callback in the datagrid APIs).

[Stringifies] interface DOMTokenList {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] DOMString item(in unsigned long index);
  boolean has(in DOMString token);
  void add(in DOMString token);
  void remove(in DOMString token);
  boolean toggle(in DOMString token);
};

The length attribute must return the number of unique tokens that result from splitting the underlying string on spaces.

The item(index) method must split the underlying string on spaces, sort the resulting list of tokens by Unicode codepoint, remove exact duplicates, and then return the indexth item in this list. If index is equal to or greater than the number of tokens, then the method must return null.

The has(token) method must run the following algorithm:

  1. If the token argument contains any space characters, then raise an INVALID_CHARACTER_ERR exception and stop the algorithm.
  2. Otherwise, split the underlying string on spaces to get the list of tokens in the object's underlying string.
  3. If the token indicated by token is one of the tokens in the object's underlying string then return true and stop this algorithm.
  4. Otherwise, return false.

The add(token) method must run the following algorithm:

  1. If the token argument contains any space characters, then raise an INVALID_CHARACTER_ERR exception and stop the algorithm.
  2. Otherwise, split the underlying string on spaces to get the list of tokens in the object's underlying string.
  3. If the given token is already one of the tokens in the DOMTokenList object's underlying string then stop the algorithm.
  4. Otherwise, if the DOMTokenList object's underlying string is not the empty string and the last character of that string is not a space character, then append a U+0020 SPACE character to the end of that string.
  5. Append the value of token to the end of the DOMTokenList object's underlying string.

The remove(token) method must run the following algorithm:

  1. If the token argument contains any space characters, then raise an INVALID_CHARACTER_ERR exception and stop the algorithm.
  2. Otherwise, remove the given token from the underlying string.

The toggle(token) method must run the following algorithm:

  1. If the token argument contains any space characters, then raise an INVALID_CHARACTER_ERR exception and stop the algorithm.
  2. Otherwise, split the underlying string on spaces to get the list of tokens in the object's underlying string.
  3. If the given token is already one of the tokens in the DOMTokenList object's underlying string then remove the given token from the underlying string, and stop the algorithm, returning false.
  4. Otherwise, if the DOMTokenList object's underlying string is not the empty string and the last character of that string is not a space character, then append a U+0020 SPACE character to the end of that string.
  5. Append the value of token to the end of the DOMTokenList object's underlying string.
  6. Return true.

Objects implementing the DOMTokenList interface must stringify to the object's underlying string representation.

2.8.4 DOMStringMap

The DOMStringMap interface represents a set of name-value pairs. When a DOMStringMap object is instanced, it is associated with three algorithms, one for getting values from names, one for setting names to certain values, and one for deleting names.

The names of the methods on this interface are temporary and will be fixed when the Web IDL / "Language Bindings for DOM Specifications" spec is ready to handle this case.

interface DOMStringMap {
  [NameGetter] DOMString XXX1(in DOMString name); 
  [NameSetter] void XXX2(in DOMString name, in DOMString value); 
  [XXX] boolean XXX3(in DOMString name); 
};

The XXX1(name) method must call the algorithm for getting values from names, passing name as the name, and must return the corresponding value, or null if name has no corresponding value.

The XXX2(name, value) method must call the algorithm for setting names to certain values, passing name as the name and value as the value.

The XXX3(name) method must call the algorithm for deleting names, passing name as the name, and must return true.

2.8.5 DOM feature strings

DOM3 Core defines mechanisms for checking for interface support, and for obtaining implementations of interfaces, using feature strings. [DOM3CORE]

A DOM application can use the hasFeature(feature, version) method of the DOMImplementation interface with parameter values "HTML" and "5.0" (respectively) to determine whether or not this module is supported by the implementation. In addition to the feature string "HTML", the feature string "XHTML" (with version string "5.0") can be used to check if the implementation supports XHTML. User agents should respond with a true value when the hasFeature method is queried with these values. Authors are cautioned, however, that UAs returning true might not be perfectly compliant, and that UAs returning false might well have support for features in this specification; in general, therefore, use of this method is discouraged.

The values "HTML" and "XHTML" (both with version "5.0") should also be supported in the context of the getFeature() and isSupported() methods, as defined by DOM3 Core.

The interfaces defined in this specification are not always supersets of the interfaces defined in DOM2 HTML; some features that were formerly deprecated, poorly supported, rarely used or considered unnecessary have been removed. Therefore it is not guaranteed that an implementation that supports "HTML" "5.0" also supports "HTML" "2.0".

3. HTML 文書の意味と構造

3.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

An introduction to marking up a document.

3.2 文書

HTML 利用者エージェントにおけるすべての XML や HTML の文書は Document オブジェクトにより表現されます。 [DOM3CORE]

3.2.1 DOM 中の文書

Document オブジェクトは、作成された時に HTML 文書であると旗付けされていなければ、 XML 文書であると見なします。 文書が HTML 文書であるか XML 文書であるかは、 いくつかの API の動作や CSS のレンダリング規則の一部に影響します。 [CSS21]

DOMImplementation 上の createDocument() API により作成された Document オブジェクトははじめ XML 文書ですが、 document.open() を呼び出すことにより HTML 文書にすることができます。

(この仕様書を実装する利用書エージェントにおける) すべての Document オブジェクトは、 HTMLDocument 界面をも実装し、 束縛規定の方式により利用可能としなければなりません。 (これは当該文書が HTML 文書であるか否かや、 そもそも HTML 要素を含んでいるか否かによらずのことです。) Document オブジェクトは、文書中に現れ、利用者エージェントが対応している、 他の名前空間の文書水準の界面をも実装しなければなりません。 例えば、 HTML 実装が SVG にも対応している場合、 Document オブジェクトは HTMLDocumentSVGDocument を実装しなければなりません

HTMLDocument 界面は現在では単純に文書オブジェクトの主たる界面であるとするのではなく、 束縛規定の型変換方式を使って得るものとしているので、 最早 Document から継承するとは定義していません。

interface HTMLDocument {
  // resource metadata management
  [PutForwards=href] readonly attribute Location location;
  readonly attribute DOMString URL;
           attribute DOMString domain;
  readonly attribute DOMString referrer;
           attribute DOMString cookie;
  readonly attribute DOMString lastModified;
  readonly attribute DOMString compatMode;
           attribute DOMString charset;
  readonly attribute DOMString characterSet;
  readonly attribute DOMString defaultCharset;
  readonly attribute DOMString readyState;

  // DOM tree accessors
           attribute DOMString title;
           attribute DOMString dir;
           attribute HTMLElement body;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection images;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection embeds;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection plugins;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection links;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection forms;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection anchors;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection scripts;
  NodeList getElementsByName(in DOMString elementName);
  NodeList getElementsByClassName(in DOMString classNames);

  // dynamic markup insertion
           attribute DOMString innerHTML;
  HTMLDocument open();
  HTMLDocument open(in DOMString type);
  HTMLDocument open(in DOMString type, in DOMString replace);
  Window open(in DOMString url, in DOMString name, in DOMString features);
  Window open(in DOMString url, in DOMString name, in DOMString features, in boolean replace);
  void close();
  void write([Variadic] in DOMString text);
  void writeln([Variadic] in DOMString text);

  // user interaction
  Selection getSelection();
  readonly attribute Element activeElement;
  boolean hasFocus();
           attribute boolean designMode;
  boolean execCommand(in DOMString commandId);
  boolean execCommand(in DOMString commandId, in boolean showUI);
  boolean execCommand(in DOMString commandId, in boolean showUI, in DOMString value);
  boolean queryCommandEnabled(in DOMString commandId);
  boolean queryCommandIndeterm(in DOMString commandId);
  boolean queryCommandState(in DOMString commandId);
  boolean queryCommandSupported(in DOMString commandId);
  DOMString queryCommandValue(in DOMString commandId);
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection commands;
};

HTMLDocument 界面は色々な機能に関係するメソッドや属性を持っていますので、 この界面の構成員はそれぞれの節で説明します。

3.2.2 保安性

利用者エージェントは、 HTMLDocument オブジェクトの構成員のいずれかが、 実効スクリプト起源Document実効スクリプト起源同じではないスクリプトからアクセスされる場合に、 常に、 保安性例外を発生させなければなりません

3.2.3 資源メタデータ管理

URL 属性は文書の番地を返さなければなりません

referrer 属性は、操縦が開始された時点での原始閲覧文脈活性文書 (閲覧文脈を現在の文書に操縦した頁) の番地か、 または、そのような元々の頁がない場合、利用者エージェントがこの場合に参照子を報告しないように設定されている場合、 操縦が noreferrer キーワードのあるハイパーリンクについて初期化された場合には空文字列、 このいずれかを返さなければなりません

HTTP の場合、 referrer DOM 属性は現在の頁を取ってくる時に送られた Referer (ママ) 頭部と一致します。

通常、利用者エージェントは、参照子が暗号化プロトコルを使っており、 現在の頁がそうではない場合 (例えば https: 頁から http: 頁へと操縦した時) には参照子を報告しないように設定されています。


cookie 属性は、資源のクッキーを表します。

取得時、砂箱起源閲覧文脈旗が文書の閲覧文脈に設定されている場合には、 利用者エージェントは保安性例外を発生させなければなりません。 そうでない場合、文書の番地で示される資源を HTTP によって取ってくる場合に RFC 2109 4.3.4 節やより新しい仕様書に従って含まれるであろう Cookie HTTP 頭部の値と同じ文字列を返さなければなりません[RFC2109] [RFC2965]

設定時、砂箱起源閲覧文脈旗が文書の閲覧文脈に設定されている場合には、 利用者エージェントは保安性例外を発生させなければなりません。 そうでない場合、利用者エージェントは、 文書の番地で示される資源を HTTP によって取ってこようとし、 値が指定された値である Set-Cookie 頭部がある応答を受信した場合にクッキーを処理する時と同じように、 RFC 2109 4.3.1 節、4.3.2 節、4.3.3. 節やより新しい仕様書に従い作用しなければなりません[RFC2109] [RFC2965]

cookie 属性はフレームをまたいでアクセス可能ですので、 クッキーの経路制限はクッキーがサイト上のどの部分に送られるかを管理することを助けるための道具に過ぎず、 保安性のための機能では決してありません。


lastModified 属性は、取得時、 Document の原始ファイルの最終修正の日時を、 利用者の地方時において、次の書式で返さなければなりません

  1. 日付の月の部品。
  2. U+002F SOLIDUS 文字 ('/')。
  3. 日付の日の部品。
  4. U+002F SOLIDUS 文字 ('/')。
  5. 日付の年の部品。
  6. U+0020 SPACE 文字。
  7. 時刻の時の部品。
  8. U+003A COLON 文字 (':')。
  9. 時刻の分の部品。
  10. U+003A COLON 文字 (':')。
  11. 時刻の秒の部品。

前述の数値の部品のうち年以外のすべては、範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE の2つの数字によって十進数を表す、 必要なら零埋めしたものとして与えなければなりません

Document の原始ファイルの最終修正日時は、 使用されているネットワークのプロトコルの関係する機能、例えば文書の HTTP Last-Modified 頭部から、または局所ファイルのファイル・システムのメタデータから得たものでなければなりません。 最終修正日時がわからない場合は、この属性は文字列 01/01/1970 00:00:00 を返さなければなりません

Document は常に3つのモードのいずれかに設定されています。無奇癖モードは既定値です。奇癖モードは、 普通、遺物文書に使われます。制限奇癖モードは、「ほぼ標準」モードとも呼ばれます。 このモードは HTML 構文解析器によってのみ、 DOCTYPE 文字列が存在するか存在しないかやその値に基づいて既定値から変更されます。

compatMode DOM 属性は、生の文字列「CSS1Compat」を返さなければなりません。 ただし、文書が HTML 構文解析器により奇癖モードに設定されている場合には、 代わりに名前の文字列「BackCompat」を返さなければなりません

As far as parsing goes, the quirks I know of are:

文書は文字符号化と関連付けられています。 Document オブジェクトが作成された時、文書の文字符号化は UTF-16 に初期化されなければなりません。 頁の読み込みの間の色々な算法や charset 設定子がこの値を変化させます。 [IANACHARSET]

charset DOM 属性は、取得時、文書の文字符号化の優先 MIME 名を返さなければなりません。設定時、 新しい値がある文字符号化の IANA に登録された別名である場合、文書の文字符号化をその文字符号化に設定しなければなりません。 (それ以外の場合、何も起きません。)

characterSet DOM 属性は、取得時、文書の文字符号化の優先 MIME 名を返さなければなりません

defaultCharset DOM 属性は、取得時、文字符号化の優先 MIME 名を返さなければなりません。 この文字符号化は利用者の既定の符号化でもいいですし、 利用者の現在の地理的位置に関連付けられた符号化でもいいですし、 その他任意の符号化名でもあり得ます。

Each document has a current document readiness. When a Document object is created, it must have its current document readiness set to the string "loading". Various algorithms during page loading affect this value. When the value is set, the user agent must fire a simple event called readystatechanged at the Document object.

The readyState DOM attribute must, on getting, return the current document readiness.

3.2.4 DOM 木アクセス器

文書の文書 html 要素は、 その文書の根要素があり、それが html 要素である場合はその要素、それ以外の場合には null です。

文書の文書 head 要素は、 文書 html 要素の子供である最初の head 要素がある場合はその要素、 そうでない場合は null です。

文書の文書 title 要素は文書の (木順で) 最初の title 要素がある場合はその要素、 そうでない場合は null です。

title 属性は、 取得時、次の算法を走らせなければなりません

  1. 根要素が 「http://www.w3.org/2000/svg」名前空間の svg 要素であり、利用者エージェントが SVG に対応している場合、取得器は SVGDocument 界面の同名の DOM 属性が返す値を返さなければなりません

  2. そうでない場合、文書 title 要素のすべての子供テキスト節点のデータを木順に連結したものを返すか、 文書 title 要素が null の場合には殻文字列を返さなければなりません

設定時、次の算法を走らせなければなりません

  1. 根要素が 「http://www.w3.org/2000/svg」名前空間の svg 要素で利用者エージェントが SVG に対応している場合、 設定器は SVGDocument 界面の同名の DOM 属性の設定器に委ねなければなりません (それが読み取り専用である場合、例外を発生させることとなります)。算法をここで停止します。

  2. 文書 title 要素が null で文書 head 要素が null の場合、属性は何もしてはなりません。算法をここで停止します。
  3. 文書 title 要素が null の場合、新しい title 要素を作成し、 文書 head 要素の最後に追加しなければなりません
  4. 文書 title 要素の子供を (あれば) すべて削除しなければなりません
  5. データが指定された新しい値である1つの Text 節点を 文書 title 要素の最後に追加しなければなりません

利用者エージェントが HTML と SVG の両方に対応する時には、 HTMLDocument 界面の title 属性が SVGDocument 界面の同名の属性を隠すべきです

The body element of a document is the first child of the html element that is either a body element or a frameset element. If there is no such element, it is null. If the body element is null, then when the specification requires that events be fired at "the body element", they must instead be fired at the Document object.

The body attribute, on getting, must return the body element of the document (either a body element, a frameset element, or null). On setting, the following algorithm must be run:

  1. If the new value is not a body or frameset element, then raise a HIERARCHY_REQUEST_ERR exception and abort these steps.
  2. Otherwise, if the new value is the same as the body element, do nothing. Abort these steps.
  3. Otherwise, if the body element is not null, then replace that element with the new value in the DOM, as if the root element's replaceChild() method had been called with the new value and the incumbent body element as its two arguments respectively, then abort these steps.
  4. Otherwise, the the body element is null. Append the new value to the root element.

The images attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only img elements.

The embeds attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only embed elements.

The plugins attribute must return the same object as that returned by the embeds attribute.

The links attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only a elements with href attributes and area elements with href attributes.

The forms attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only form elements.

The anchors attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only a elements with name attributes.

The scripts attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only script elements.

The getElementsByName(name) method takes a string name, and must return a live NodeList containing all the a, applet, button, form, iframe, img, input, map, meta, object, select, and textarea elements in that document that have a name attribute whose value is equal to the name argument (in a case-sensitive manner), in tree order.

The getElementsByClassName(classNames) method takes a string that contains an unordered set of unique space-separated tokens representing classes. When called, the method must return a live NodeList object containing all the elements in the document, in tree order, that have all the classes specified in that argument, having obtained the classes by splitting a string on spaces. If there are no tokens specified in the argument, then the method must return an empty NodeList. If the document is in quirks mode, then the comparisons for the classes must be done in an ASCII case-insensitive manner, otherwise, the comparisons must be done in a case-sensitive manner.

The getElementsByClassName() method on the HTMLElement interface must return a live NodeList with the nodes that the HTMLDocument getElementsByClassName() method would return when passed the same argument(s), excluding any elements that are not descendants of the HTMLElement object on which the method was invoked.

HTML, SVG, and MathML elements define which classes they are in by having an attribute in the per-element partition with the name class containing a space-separated list of classes to which the element belongs. Other specifications may also allow elements in their namespaces to be labeled as being in specific classes.

Given the following XHTML fragment:

<div id="example">
 <p id="p1" class="aaa bbb"/>
 <p id="p2" class="aaa ccc"/>
 <p id="p3" class="bbb ccc"/>
</div>

A call to document.getElementById('example').getElementsByClassName('aaa') would return a NodeList with the two paragraphs p1 and p2 in it.

A call to getElementsByClassName('ccc bbb') would only return one node, however, namely p3. A call to document.getElementById('example').getElementsByClassName('bbb  ccc ') would return the same thing.

A call to getElementsByClassName('aaa,bbb') would return no nodes; none of the elements above are in the "aaa,bbb" class.

The dir attribute on the HTMLDocument interface is defined along with the dir content attribute.

3.3 要素

3.3.1 Semantics

Elements, attributes, and attribute values in HTML are defined (by this specification) to have certain meanings (semantics). For example, the ol element represents an ordered list, and the lang attribute represents the language of the content.

Authors must not use elements, attributes, and attribute values for purposes other than their appropriate intended semantic purpose.

For example, the following document is non-conforming, despite being syntactically correct:

<!DOCTYPE html>
<html lang="en-GB">
 <head> <title> Demonstration </title> </head>
 <body>
  <table>
   <tr> <td> My favourite animal is the cat. </td> </tr>
   <tr>
    <td>
     —<a href="http://example.org/~ernest/"><cite>Ernest</cite></a>,
     in an essay from 1992
    </td>
   </tr>
  </table>
 </body>
</html>

...because the data placed in the cells is clearly not tabular data (and the cite element mis-used). A corrected version of this document might be:

<!DOCTYPE html>
<html lang="en-GB">
 <head> <title> Demonstration </title> </head>
 <body>
  <blockquote>
   <p> My favourite animal is the cat. </p>
  </blockquote>
  <p>
   —<a href="http://example.org/~ernest/">Ernest</a>,
   in an essay from 1992
  </p>
 </body>
</html>

This next document fragment, intended to represent the heading of a corporate site, is similarly non-conforming because the second line is not intended to be a heading of a subsection, but merely a subheading or subtitle (a subordinate heading for the same section).

<body>
 <h1>ABC Company</h1>
 <h2>Leading the way in widget design since 1432</h2>
 ...

The header element should be used in these kinds of situations:

<body>
 <header>
  <h1>ABC Company</h1>
  <h2>Leading the way in widget design since 1432</h2>
 </header>
 ...

Through scripting and using other mechanisms, the values of attributes, text, and indeed the entire structure of the document may change dynamically while a user agent is processing it. The semantics of a document at an instant in time are those represented by the state of the document at that instant in time, and the semantics of a document can therefore change over time. User agents must update their presentation of the document as this occurs.

HTML has a progress element that describes a progress bar. If its "value" attribute is dynamically updated by a script, the UA would update the rendering to show the progress changing.

3.3.2 Elements in the DOM

The nodes representing HTML elements in the DOM must implement, and expose to scripts, the interfaces listed for them in the relevant sections of this specification. This includes HTML elements in XML documents, even when those documents are in another context (e.g. inside an XSLT transform).

Elements in the DOM represent things; that is, they have intrinsic meaning, also known as semantics.

For example, an ol element represents an ordered list.

basic interface, from which all the HTML elements' interfaces inherit, and which must be used by elements that have no additional requirements, is the HTMLElement 界面。

interface HTMLElement : Element {
  // DOM tree accessors
  NodeList getElementsByClassName(in DOMString classNames);

  // dynamic markup insertion
           attribute DOMString innerHTML;
           attribute DOMString outerHTML;
  void insertAdjacentHTML(in DOMString position, in DOMString text);

  // metadata attributes
           attribute DOMString id;
           attribute DOMString title;
           attribute DOMString lang;
           attribute DOMString dir;
           attribute DOMString className;
  readonly attribute DOMTokenList classList;
  readonly attribute DOMStringMap dataset;

  // user interaction
           attribute boolean irrelevant;
  void click();
  void scrollIntoView();
  void scrollIntoView(in boolean top);
           attribute long tabIndex;
  void focus();
  void blur();
           attribute boolean draggable;
           attribute DOMString contentEditable;
  readonly attribute boolean isContentEditable;
           attribute HTMLMenuElement contextMenu;

  // styling
  readonly attribute CSSStyleDeclaration style;

  // data templates
           attribute DOMString template;
  readonly attribute HTMLDataTemplateElement templateElement;
           attribute DOMString ref;
  readonly attribute Node refNode;
           attribute DOMString registrationMark;
  readonly attribute DocumentFragment originalContent;

  // event handler DOM attributes
           attribute EventListener onabort;
           attribute EventListener onbeforeunload;
           attribute EventListener onblur;
           attribute EventListener onchange;
           attribute EventListener onclick;
           attribute EventListener oncontextmenu;
           attribute EventListener ondblclick;
           attribute EventListener ondrag;
           attribute EventListener ondragend;
           attribute EventListener ondragenter;
           attribute EventListener ondragleave;
           attribute EventListener ondragover;
           attribute EventListener ondragstart;
           attribute EventListener ondrop;
           attribute EventListener onerror;
           attribute EventListener onfocus;
           attribute EventListener onhashchange;
           attribute EventListener onkeydown;
           attribute EventListener onkeypress;
           attribute EventListener onkeyup;
           attribute EventListener onload;
           attribute EventListener onmessage;
           attribute EventListener onmousedown;
           attribute EventListener onmousemove;
           attribute EventListener onmouseout;
           attribute EventListener onmouseover;
           attribute EventListener onmouseup;
           attribute EventListener onmousewheel;
           attribute EventListener onresize;
           attribute EventListener onscroll;
           attribute EventListener onselect;
           attribute EventListener onstorage;
           attribute EventListener onsubmit;
           attribute EventListener onunload;

};

The HTMLElement interface holds methods and attributes related to a number of disparate features, and the members of this interface are therefore described in various different sections of this specification.

3.3.3 Global attributes

The following attributes are common to and may be specified on all HTML elements (even those not defined in this specification):

Global attributes:
class
contenteditable
contextmenu
dir
draggable
id
irrelevant
lang
ref
registrationmark
style
tabindex
template
title

In addition, the following event handler content attributes may be specified on any HTML element:

Event handler content attributes:
onabort
onbeforeunload
onblur
onchange
onclick
oncontextmenu
ondblclick
ondrag
ondragend
ondragenter
ondragleave
ondragover
ondragstart
ondrop
onerror
onfocus
onhashchange
onkeydown
onkeypress
onkeyup
onload
onmessage
onmousedown
onmousemove
onmouseout
onmouseover
onmouseup
onmousewheel
onresize
onscroll
onselect
onstorage
onsubmit
onunload

Also, custom data attributes (e.g. data-foldername or data-msgid) can be specified on any HTML element, to store custom data specific to the page.

In HTML documents, elements in the HTML namespace may have an xmlns attribute specified, if, and only if, it has the exact value "http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml". This does not apply to XML documents.

In HTML, the xmlns attribute has absolutely no effect. It is basically a talisman. It is allowed merely to make migration to and from XHTML mildly easier. When parsed by an HTML parser, the attribute ends up in no namespace, not the "http://www.w3.org/2000/xmlns/" namespace like namespace declaration attributes in XML do.

In XML, an xmlns attribute is part of the namespace declaration mechanism, and an element cannot actually have an xmlns attribute in no namespace specified.

3.3.3.1. id 属性

id 属性は、 その要素の固有識別子を表します。値はその要素が現れる部分木中で固有でなければならず、 最低1文字含まなければなりません。 値は間隔文字を含んではなりません

利用者エージェントは、値が空文字列でない場合、 その要素が現れる部分木中で ID 一致を行うために (例えば CSS の選択子や DOM の getElementById() メソッドのために)、 その要素に指定された値を (間隔文字も含めてそのまま) 関連付けなければなりません

識別子は不透明な文字列です。特定の意味を id 属性の値から見出すべきではありません

この仕様書は、他の仕組み (例えば DOM 中核のメソッド) によって id 属性と矛盾しない形で要素の ID を設定することができる場合に、要素が複数の ID を持つことを禁じていません。

id DOM 属性は id 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

3.3.3.2. title 属性

title 属性は、 要素に関する助言情報、例えばツールチップとして適切なものなどを表します。 例えば、リンクにおいては、対象資源の題名や説明とすることができます。 画像では、画像のクレジットや説明とすることができます。 段落では、出典に関する追加情報とすることができます。 値は文章です。

ある要素でこの属性が省略されている場合、最も近い title 属性が設定された祖先 HTML 要素title 属性がその要素にも関係することを暗示しています。 属性を設定することでこれが上書きされ、祖先の助言情報がこの要素に関係しないと明示することとなります。 この属性を空文字列に設定すると、その要素が助言情報を持たないことが示されます。

title 属性の値が U+000A LINE FEED (LF) 文字を含んでいる場合、 内容は複数行に分割されます。 U+000A LINE FEED (LF) 文字それぞれが改行を表します。

link 要素や abbr 要素など、いくつかの要素は、 title 属性について、 前述のような意味以上の追加の意味を定義しています。

title DOM 属性は title 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

3.3.3.3. The lang and xml:lang (XML only) attributes

lang 属性は、 その要素の内容と文章を含むその要素の属性についての主たる言語を指定します。 値は妥当な RFC 3066 言語符号または空文字列でなければなりません[RFC3066]

The xml:lang attribute (that is, the lang attribute with the xml prefix in the http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace namespace) is defined in XML. [XML]

これらの属性が要素から省略されている場合、その要素の言語は親要素の言語と同じであることを暗示しています。 これらの属性を空文字列に設定することは、 主たる言語が不明であることを示します。

The lang attribute may be used on any HTML element.

The xml:lang attribute may be used on HTML elements in XML documents, as well as elements in other namespaces if the relevant specifications allow it (in particular, MathML and SVG allow xml:lang attributes to be specified on their elements). If both the lang attribute and the xml:lang attribute are specified on the same element, they must have exactly the same value when compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner.

Authors must not use the xml:lang attribute (that is, the lang attribute with the xml prefix in the http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace namespace) in HTML documents. To ease migration to and from XHTML, authors may specify an attribute in no namespace with no prefix and with the localname xml:lang on HTML elements in HTML documents, but such attributes must only be specified if a lang attribute is also specified, and both attributes must have the same value when compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner.


利用者エージェントは、ある節点の言語を決定する場合、 xml:lang 属性が設定されているか、 HTML 要素であって lang 属性が設定されている直近の祖先要素 (当該節点が要素である場合、その要素自体を含みます。) を見なければなりません。その属性が、当該節点の言語を指定します。

利用者エージェントは、 xml:lang 属性と lang 属性が共にある要素に設定されている場合、 xml:lang 属性を使用しなければならずlang 属性は要素の言語の決定においては無視しなければなりません

If no explicit language is given for the root element, but there is a document-wide default language set, then that is the language of the node.

If there is no document-wide default language, then language information from a higher-level protocol (such as HTTP), if any, must be used as the final fallback language. In the absence of any language information, the default value is unknown (the empty string).

If the resulting value is not a recognised language code, then it must be treated as an unknown language (as if the value was the empty string).


利用者エージェントは、要素の言語情報を適切な処理やレンダリングの決定 (例えば適切なフォントや句読点の選択や辞書の選択) のために使って構いません

lang DOM 属性は lang 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

3.3.3.4. xml:base 属性 (XML のみ)

xml:base 属性は XML 基底で定義されています。 [XMLBASE]

xml:base 属性は XML 文書の要素で使って構いません。 著者は xml:base 属性を HTML 文書で使用してはなりません

3.3.3.5. dir 属性

The dir attribute specifies the element's text directionality. The attribute is an enumerated attribute with the keyword ltr mapping to the state ltr, and the keyword rtl mapping to the state rtl. The attribute has no defaults.

The processing of this attribute is primarily performed by the presentation layer. For example, CSS 2.1 defines a mapping from this attribute to the CSS 'direction' and 'unicode-bidi' properties, and defines rendering in terms of those properties.

The directionality of an element, which is used in particular by the canvas element's text rendering API, is either 'ltr' or 'rtl'. If the user agent supports CSS and the 'direction' property on this element has a computed value of either 'ltr' or 'rtl', then that is the directionality of the element. Otherwise, if the element is being rendered, then the directionality of the element is the directionality used by the presentation layer, potentially determined from the value of the dir attribute on the element. Otherwise, if the element's dir attribute has the state ltr, the element's directionality is 'ltr' (left-to-right); if the attribute has the state rtl, the element's directionality is 'rtl' (right-to-left); and oherwise, the element's directionality is the same as its parent element, or 'ltr' if there is no parent element.

The dir DOM attribute on an element must reflect the dir content attribute of that element, limited to only known values.

The dir DOM attribute on HTMLDocument objects must reflect the dir content attribute of the html element, if any, limited to only known values. If there is no such element, then the attribute must return the empty string and do nothing on setting.

3.3.3.6. class 属性

Every HTML element may have a class attribute specified.

The attribute, if specified, must have a value that is an unordered set of unique space-separated tokens representing the various classes that the element belongs to.

The classes that an HTML element has assigned to it consists of all the classes returned when the value of the class attribute is split on spaces.

Assigning classes to an element affects class matching in selectors in CSS, the getElementsByClassName() method in the DOM, and other such features.

Authors may use any value in the class attribute, but are encouraged to use the values that describe the nature of the content, rather than values that describe the desired presentation of the content.

The className and classList DOM attributes must both reflect the class content attribute.

3.3.3.7. style 属性

All elements may have the style content attribute set. If specified, the attribute must contain only a list of zero or more semicolon-separated (;) CSS declarations. [CSS21]

The attribute, if specified, must be parsed and treated as the body (the part inside the curly brackets) of a declaration block in a rule whose selector matches just the element on which the attribute is set. For the purposes of the CSS cascade, the attribute must be considered to be a 'style' attribute at the author level.

Documents that use style attributes on any of their elements must still be comprehensible and usable if those attributes were removed.

In particular, using the style attribute to hide and show content, or to convey meaning that is otherwise not included in the document, is non-conforming.

The style DOM attribute must return a CSSStyleDeclaration whose value represents the declarations specified in the attribute, if present. Mutating the CSSStyleDeclaration object must create a style attribute on the element (if there isn't one already) and then change its value to be a value representing the serialized form of the CSSStyleDeclaration object. [CSSOM]

In the following example, the words that refer to colors are marked up using the span element and the style attribute to make those words show up in the relevant colors in visual media.

<p>My sweat suit is <span style="color: green; background:
transparent">green</span> and my eyes are <span style="color: blue;
background: transparent">blue</span>.</p>
3.3.3.8. カスタム不可視データの埋め込み

A custom data attribute is an attribute whose name starts with the string "data-", has at least one character after the hyphen, is XML-compatible, has no namespace, and contains no characters in the range U+0041 .. U+005A (LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z).

All attributes in HTML documents get lowercased automatically, so the restriction on uppercase letters doesn't affect such documents.

カスタム・データ属性は、 より適切な要素や属性がないような頁や応用の私的なカスタム・データを蓄積することを想定しています。

すべての HTML 要素には、 任意の値のカスタム・データ属性を任意の個数指定して構いません

dataset DOM 属性は、要素のすべての data-* 属性の便宜アクセス子を提供します。 dataset DOM 属性は、取得時、 次の3つの算法 (要素のすべての data-* 属性を露出させます。) と関連付けられた DOMStringMap オブジェクトを返さなければなりません

名前から値を取得する算法
  1. Let name be the concatenation of the string data- and the name passed to the algorithm, converted to lowercase.
  2. 要素が名前 name の属性を有しない場合は、 その名前は対応する値を持たず、停止します。
  3. そうでない場合、名前 name の属性の値を返します。
名前をある値に設定する算法
  1. Let name be the concatenation of the string data- and the name passed to the algorithm, converted to lowercase.
  2. value を、算法に渡された値とします。
  3. 名前 name の属性の値を値 value に設定します。ここで、属性が既に存在する場合、元の値は置き換えられます。 setAttribute() が名前 name の属性を設定しようとした時に例外を発生させるような場合には、 これも同じ例外を発生させなければなりません
名前を削除する算法
  1. Let name be the concatenation of the string data- and the name passed to the algorithm, converted to lowercase.
  2. 名前 name の属性が存在すれば、これを削除します。 存在しない場合は、なにもしません。

Web 頁に宇宙船を表す要素が必要な場合 (例えばゲーム中で)、 class 属性と共に data-* 属性を使う必要が生じることでしょう。

<div class="spaceship" data-id="92432"
     data-weapons="laser 2" data-shields="50%"
     data-x="30" data-y="10" data-z="90">
 <button class="fire"
         onclick="spaceships[this.parentNode.dataset.id].fire()">
  Fire
 </button>
</div>

著者は、このような拡張を設計する際、この属性が無視され、関連付けられた CSS が除去されたとしても、なおその頁が利用可能であるよう、注意するべきです

利用者エージェントは、これらの属性や値によって実装の動作を決めてはなりません。 利用者エージェントを想定した仕様書は、 これらの属性が意味のある値を持つように定義してはなりません

3.4 Content models

All the elements in this specification have a defined content model, which describes what nodes are allowed inside the elements, and thus what the structure of an HTML document or fragment must look like.

As noted in the conformance and terminology sections, for the purposes of determining if an element matches its content model or not, CDATASection nodes in the DOM are treated as equivalent to Text nodes, and entity reference nodes are treated as if they were expanded in place.

The space characters are always allowed between elements. User agents represent these characters between elements in the source markup as text nodes in the DOM. Empty text nodes and text nodes consisting of just sequences of those characters are considered inter-element whitespace.

Inter-element whitespace, comment nodes, and processing instruction nodes must be ignored when establishing whether an element matches its content model or not, and must be ignored when following algorithms that define document and element semantics.

An element A is said to be preceded or followed by a second element B if A and B have the same parent node and there are no other element nodes or text nodes (other than inter-element whitespace) between them.

Authors must not use elements in the HTML namespace anywhere except where they are explicitly allowed, as defined for each element, or as explicitly required by other specifications. For XML compound documents, these contexts could be inside elements from other namespaces, if those elements are defined as providing the relevant contexts.

The SVG specification defines the SVG foreignObject element as allowing foreign namespaces to be included, thus allowing compound documents to be created by inserting subdocument content under that element. This specification defines the XHTML html element as being allowed where subdocument fragments are allowed in a compound document. Together, these two definitions mean that placing an XHTML html element as a child of an SVG foreignObject element is conforming. [SVG]

The Atom specification defines the Atom content element, when its type attribute has the value xhtml, as requiring that it contains a single HTML div element. Thus, a div element is allowed in that context, even though this is not explicitly normatively stated by this specification. [ATOM]

In addition, elements in the HTML namespace may be orphan nodes (i.e. without a parent node).

For example, creating a td element and storing it in a global variable in a script is conforming, even though td elements are otherwise only supposed to be used inside tr elements.

var data = {
  name: "Banana",
  cell: document.createElement('td'), 
};

3.4.1 Kinds of content

Each element in HTML falls into zero or more categories that group elements with similar characteristics together. The following categories are used in this specification:

Some elements have unique requirements and do not fit into any particular category.

3.4.1.1. Metadata content

Metadata content is content that sets up the presentation or behavior of the rest of the content, or that sets up the relationship of the document with other documents, or that conveys other "out of band" information.

Elements from other namespaces whose semantics are primarily metadata-related (e.g. RDF) are also metadata content.

3.4.1.2. Flow content

Most elements that are used in the body of documents and applications are categorized as flow content.

As a general rule, elements whose content model allows any flow content should have either at least one descendant text node that is not inter-element whitespace, or at least one descendant element node that is embedded content. For the purposes of this requirement, del elements and their descendants must not be counted as contributing to the ancestors of the del element.

This requirement is not a hard requirement, however, as there are many cases where an element can be empty legitimately, for example when it is used as a placeholder which will later be filled in by a script, or when the element is part of a template and would on most pages be filled in but on some pages is not relevant.

3.4.1.3. Sectioning content

Sectioning content is content that defines the scope of headers, footers, and contact information.

Each sectioning content element potentially has a heading. See the section on headings and sections for further details.

3.4.1.4. Heading content

Heading content defines the header of a section (whether explicitly marked up using sectioning content elements, or implied by the heading content itself).

3.4.1.5. Phrasing content

Phrasing content is the text of the document, as well as elements that mark up that text at the intra-paragraph level. Runs of phrasing content form paragraphs.

All phrasing content is also flow content. Any content model that expects flow content also expects phrasing content.

As a general rule, elements whose content model allows any phrasing content should have either at least one descendant text node that is not inter-element whitespace, or at least one descendant element node that is embedded content. For the purposes of this requirement, nodes that are descendants of del elements must not be counted as contributing to the ancestors of the del element.

Most elements that are categorized as phrasing content can only contain elements that are themselves categorized as phrasing content, not any flow content.

Text nodes that are not inter-element whitespace are phrasing content.

3.4.1.6. Embedded content

Embedded content is content that imports another resource into the document, or content from another vocabulary that is inserted into the document.

All embedded content is also phrasing content (and flow content). Any content model that expects phrasing content (or flow content) also expects embedded content.

Elements that are from namespaces other than the HTML namespace and that convey content but not metadata, are embedded content for the purposes of the content models defined in this specification. (For example, MathML, or SVG.)

Some embedded content elements can have fallback content: content that is to be used when the external resource cannot be used (e.g. because it is of an unsupported format). The element definitions state what the fallback is, if any.

3.4.1.7. Interactive content

Parts of this section should eventually be moved to DOM3 Events.

Interactive content is content that is specifically intended for user interaction.

Certain elements in HTML can be activated, for instance a elements, button elements, or input elements when their type attribute is set to radio. Activation of those elements can happen in various (UA-defined) ways, for instance via the mouse or keyboard.

When activation is performed via some method other than clicking the pointing device, the default action of the event that triggers the activation must, instead of being activating the element directly, be to fire a click event on the same element.

The default action of this click event, or of the real click event if the element was activated by clicking a pointing device, must be to fire a further DOMActivate event at the same element, whose own default action is to go through all the elements the DOMActivate event bubbled through (starting at the target node and going towards the Document node), looking for an element with an activation behavior; the first element, in reverse tree order, to have one, must have its activation behavior executed.

The above doesn't happen for arbitrary synthetic events dispatched by author script. However, the click() method can be used to make it happen programmatically.

For certain form controls, this process is complicated further by changes that must happen around the click event. [WF2]

3.4.2 Transparent content models

Some elements are described as transparent; they have "transparent" as their content model. Some elements are described as semi-transparent; this means that part of their content model is "transparent" but that is not the only part of the content model that must be satisfied.

When a content model includes a part that is "transparent", those parts must not contain content that would not be conformant if all transparent and semi-transparent elements in the tree were replaced, in their parent element, by the children in the "transparent" part of their content model, retaining order.

When a transparent or semi-transparent element has no parent, then the part of its content model that is "transparent" must instead be treated as accepting any flow content.

3.5 Paragraphs

A paragraph is typically a block of text with one or more sentences that discuss a particular topic, as in typography, but can also be used for more general thematic grouping. For instance, an address is also a paragraph, as is a part of a form, a byline, or a stanza in a poem.

Paragraphs in flow content are defined relative to what the document looks like without the a, ins and del elements complicating matters, since those elements, with their hybrid content models, can straddle paragraph boundaries.

Let view be a view of the DOM that replaces all a, ins and del elements in the document with their contents. Then, in view, for each run of phrasing content uninterrupted by other types of content, in an element that accepts content other than phrasing content, let first be the first node of the run, and let last be the last node of the run. For each run, a paragraph exists in the original DOM from immediately before first to immediately after last. (Paragraphs can thus span across a, ins and del elements.)

A paragraph is also formed explicitly by p elements.

The p element can be used to wrap individual paragraphs when there would otherwise not be any content other than phrasing content to separate the paragraphs from each other.

In the following example, there are two paragraphs in a section. There is also a header, which contains phrasing content that is not a paragraph. Note how the comments and intra-element whitespace do not form paragraphs.

<section>
  <h1>Example of paragraphs</h1>
  This is the <em>first</em> paragraph in this example.
  <p>This is the second.</p>
  <!-- This is not a paragraph. -->
</section>

The following example takes that markup and puts ins and del elements around some of the markup to show that the text was changed (though in this case, the changes don't really make much sense, admittedly). Notice how this example has exactly the same paragraphs as the previous one, despite the ins and del elements.

<section>
  <ins><h1>Example of paragraphs</h1>
  This is the <em>first</em> paragraph in</ins> this example<del>.
  <p>This is the second.</p></del>
  <!-- This is not a paragraph. -->
</section>

In the following example, the link spans half of the first paragraph, all of the header separating the two paragraphs, and half of the second paragraph.

<aside>
 Welcome!
 <a href="about.html">
  This is home of...
  <h1>The Falcons!</h1>
  The Lockheed Martin multirole jet fighter aircraft!
 </a>
 This page discusses the F-16 Fighting Falcon's innermost secrets.
</aside>

Here is another way of marking this up, this time showing the paragraphs explicitly, and splitting the one link element into three:

<aside>
 <p>Welcome! <a href="about.html">This is home of...</a></p>
 <h1><a href="about.html">The Falcons!</a></h1>
 <p><a href="about.html">The Lockheed Martin multirole jet
 fighter aircraft!</a> This page discusses the F-16 Fighting
 Falcon's innermost secrets.</p>
</aside>

Generally, having elements straddle paragraph boundaries is best avoided. Maintaining such markup can be difficult.

3.6 APIs in HTML documents

For HTML documents, and for HTML elements in HTML documents, certain APIs defined in DOM3 Core become case-insensitive or case-changing, as sometimes defined in DOM3 Core, and as summarized or required below. [DOM3CORE].

This does not apply to XML documents or to elements that are not in the HTML namespace despite being in HTML documents.

Element.tagName and Node.nodeName

These attributes must return element names converted to uppercase, regardless of the case with which they were created.

Document.createElement()

The canonical form of HTML markup is all-lowercase; thus, this method will lowercase the argument before creating the requisite element. Also, the element created must be in the HTML namespace.

This doesn't apply to Document.createElementNS(). Thus, it is possible, by passing this last method a tag name in the wrong case, to create an element that claims to have the tag name of an element defined in this specification, but doesn't support its interfaces, because it really has another tag name not accessible from the DOM APIs.

Element.setAttributeNode()

When an Attr node is set on an HTML element, it must have its name converted to lowercase before the element is affected.

This doesn't apply to Document.setAttributeNodeNS().

Element.setAttribute()

When an attribute is set on an HTML element, the name argument must be converted to lowercas before the element is affected.

This doesn't apply to Document.setAttributeNS().

Document.getElementsByTagName() and Element.getElementsByTagName()

These methods (but not their namespaced counterparts) must compare the given argument in an ASCII case-insensitive manner when looking at HTML elements, and in a case-sensitive manner otherwise.

Thus, in an HTML document with nodes in multiple namespaces, these methods will be both case-sensitive and case-insensitive at the same time.

Document.renameNode()

If the new namespace is the HTML namespace, then the new qualified name must be converted to lowercase before the rename takes place.

3.7 Dynamic markup insertion

APIs for dynamically inserting markup into the document interact with the parser, and thus their behavior varies depending on whether they are used with HTML documents (and the HTML parser) or XHTML in XML documents (and the XML parser). The following table cross-references the various versions of these APIs.
For documents that are HTML documents For documents that are XML documents
document.open() document.open()
document.write() document.write() in HTML not supported
innerHTML innerHTML in HTML innerHTML in XML
outerHTML outerHTML in HTML not supported
insertAdjacentHTML() insertAdjacentHTML() in HTML not supported

Regardless of the parsing mode, the document.writeln(...) method must call the document.write() method with the same argument(s), plus an extra argument consisting of a string containing a single line feed character (U+000A).

The innerHTML attribute applies to both Element nodes as well as Document nodes. The outerHTML and insertAdjacentHTML() members, on the other hand, only apply to Element nodes.

When inserted using the document.write() method, script elements execute (typically synchronously), but when inserted using innerHTML and outerHTML attributes, they do not execute at all.

3.7.1 Controlling the input stream

The open() method comes in several variants with different numbers of arguments.

When called with two or fewer arguments, the method must act as follows:

  1. Let type be the value of the first argument, if there is one, or "text/html" otherwise.

  2. Let replace be true if there is a second argument and it is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the value "replace", and false otherwise.

  3. If the document has an active parser that isn't a script-created parser, and the insertion point associated with that parser's input stream is not undefined (that is, it does point to somewhere in the input stream), then the method does nothing. Abort these steps and return the Document object on which the method was invoked.

    This basically causes document.open() to be ignored when it's called in an inline script found during the parsing of data sent over the network, while still letting it have an effect when called asynchronously or on a document that is itself being spoon-fed using these APIs.

  4. onbeforeunload, onunload, reset timers, empty event queue, kill any pending transactions, XMLHttpRequests, etc

  5. If the document has an active parser, then stop that parser, and throw away any pending content in the input stream. what about if it doesn't, because it's either like a text/plain, or Atom, or PDF, or XHTML, or image document, or something?

  6. Remove all child nodes of the document.

  7. Change the document's character encoding to UTF-16.

  8. Create a new HTML parser and associate it with the document. This is a script-created parser (meaning that it can be closed by the document.open() and document.close() methods, and that the tokeniser will wait for an explicit call to document.close() before emitting an end-of-file token).

  9. Mark the document as being an HTML document (it might already be so-marked).
  10. If the type string contains a U+003B SEMICOLON (;) character, remove the first such character and all characters from it up to the end of the string.

    Strip all leading and trailing space characters from type.

    If type is not now an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "text/html", then act as if the tokeniser had emitted a start tag token with the tag name "pre", then set the HTML parser's tokenization stage's content model flag to PLAINTEXT.

    All other values are treated as text/html.

  11. If replace is false, then:

    1. Remove all the entries in the browsing context's session history after the current entry in its Document's History object
    2. Remove any earlier entries that share the same Document
    3. Add a new entry just before the last entry that is associated with the text that was parsed by the previous parser associated with the Document object, as well as the state of the document at the start of these steps. (This allows the user to step backwards in the session history to see the page before it was blown away by the document.open() call.)
  12. Finally, set the insertion point to point at just before the end of the input stream (which at this point will be empty).

  13. Return the Document on which the method was invoked.

When called with three or more arguments, the open() method on the HTMLDocument object must call the open() method on the Window interface of the object returned by the defaultView attribute of the DocumentView interface of the HTMLDocument object, with the same arguments as the original call to the open() method, and return whatever that method returned. If the defaultView attribute of the DocumentView interface of the HTMLDocument object is null, then the method must raise an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception.

The close() method must do nothing if there is no script-created parser associated with the document. If there is such a parser, then, when the method is called, the user agent must insert an explicit "EOF" character at the insertion point of the parser's input stream.

3.7.2 Dynamic markup insertion in HTML

In HTML, the document.write(...) method must act as follows:

  1. If the insertion point is undefined, the open() method must be called (with no arguments) on the document object. The insertion point will point at just before the end of the (empty) input stream.

  2. The string consisting of the concatenation of all the arguments to the method must be inserted into the input stream just before the insertion point.

  3. If there is a pending external script, then the method must now return without further processing of the input stream.

  4. Otherwise, the tokeniser must process the characters that were inserted, one at a time, processing resulting tokens as they are emitted, and stopping when the tokeniser reaches the insertion point or when the processing of the tokeniser is aborted by the tree construction stage (this can happen if a script start tag token is emitted by the tokeniser).

    If the document.write() method was called from script executing inline (i.e. executing because the parser parsed a set of script tags), then this is a reentrant invocation of the parser.

  5. Finally, the method must return.


On getting, the innerHTML DOM attribute must return the result of running the HTML fragment serialization algorithm on the node.

On setting, if the node is a document, the innerHTML DOM attribute must run the following algorithm:

  1. If the document has an active parser, then stop that parser, and throw away any pending content in the input stream. what about if it doesn't, because it's either like a text/plain, or Atom, or PDF, or XHTML, or image document, or something?

  2. Remove the children nodes of the Document whose innerHTML attribute is being set.

  3. Create a new HTML parser, in its initial state, and associate it with the Document node.

  4. Place into the input stream for the HTML parser just created the string being assigned into the innerHTML attribute.

  5. Start the parser and let it run until it has consumed all the characters just inserted into the input stream. (The Document node will have been populated with elements and a load event will have fired on its body element.)

Otherwise, if the node is an element, then setting the innerHTML DOM attribute must cause the following algorithm to run instead:

  1. Invoke the HTML fragment parsing algorithm, with the element whose innerHTML attribute is being set as the context element, and the string being assigned into the innerHTML attribute as the input. Let new children be the result of this algorithm.

  2. Remove the children of the element whose innerHTML attribute is being set.

  3. Let target document be the ownerDocument of the Element node whose innerHTML attribute is being set.

  4. Set the ownerDocument of all the nodes in new children to the target document.

  5. Append all the new children nodes to the node whose innerHTML attribute is being set, preserving their order.


On getting, the outerHTML DOM attribute must return the result of running the HTML fragment serialization algorithm on a fictional node whose only child is the node on which the attribute was invoked.

On setting, the outerHTML DOM attribute must cause the following algorithm to run:

  1. Let target be the element whose outerHTML attribute is being set.

  2. If target has no parent node, then abort these steps. There would be no way to obtain a reference to the nodes created even if the remaining steps were run.

  3. If target's parent node is a Document object, throw a NO_MODIFICATION_ALLOWED_ERR exception and abort these steps.

  4. Let parent be target's parent node, unless that is a DocumentFragment node, in which case let parent be an arbitrary body element.

  5. Invoke the HTML fragment parsing algorithm, with parent as the context element and the string being assigned into the outerHTML attribute as the input. Let new children be the result of this algorithm.

  6. Let target document be the ownerDocument of target.

  7. Set the ownerDocument of all the nodes in new children to the target document.

  8. Remove target from its parent node and insert in its place all the new children nodes, preserving their order.


The insertAdjacentHTML(position, text) method, when invoked, must run the following steps:

  1. Let position and text be the method's first and second arguments, respectively.

  2. Let target be the element on which the method was invoked.

  3. Use the first matching item from this list:

    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "beforebegin"
    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "afterend"

    If target has no parent node, then abort these steps.

    If target's parent node is a Document object, then throw a NO_MODIFICATION_ALLOWED_ERR exception and abort these steps.

    Otherwise, let context be the parent node of target.

    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "afterbegin"
    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "beforeend"

    Let context be the same as target.

    その他の場合

    Throw a SYNTAX_ERR exception.

  4. Invoke the HTML fragment parsing algorithm, with the context element being that selected by the previous step, and input being the method's text argument. Let new children be the result of this algorithm.

  5. Let target document be the ownerDocument of target.

  6. Set the ownerDocument of all the nodes in new children to the target document.

  7. Use the first matching item from this list:

    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "beforebegin"

    Insert all the new children nodes immediately before target, preserving their order.

    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "afterbegin"

    Insert all the new children nodes before the first child of target, if there is one, preserving their order. If there is no such child, append them all to target, preserving their order.

    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "beforeend"

    Append all the new children nodes to target, preserving their order.

    If position is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "afterend"

    Insert all the new children nodes immediately after target, preserving their order.

3.7.3 Dynamic markup insertion in XML

In an XML context, the innerHTML DOM attribute on HTMLElements must return a string in the form of an internal general parsed entity, and on HTMLDocuments must return a string in the form of a document entity. The string returned must be XML namespace-well-formed and must be an isomorphic serialization of all of that node's child nodes, in document order. User agents may adjust prefixes and namespace declarations in the serialization (and indeed might be forced to do so in some cases to obtain namespace-well-formed XML). For the innerHTML attribute on HTMLElement objects, if any of the elements in the serialization are in no namespace, the default namespace in scope for those elements must be explicitly declared as the empty string. (This doesn't apply to the innerHTML attribute on HTMLDocument objects.) [XML] [XMLNS]

If any of the following cases are found in the DOM being serialized, the user agent must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception:

These are the only ways to make a DOM unserializable. The DOM enforces all the other XML constraints; for example, trying to set an attribute with a name that contains an equals sign (=) will raised an INVALID_CHARACTER_ERR exception.

On setting, in an XML context, the innerHTML DOM attribute on HTMLElements and HTMLDocuments must run the following algorithm:

  1. The user agent must create a new XML parser.

  2. If the innerHTML attribute is being set on an element, the user agent must feed the parser just created the string corresponding to the start tag of that element, declaring all the namespace prefixes that are in scope on that element in the DOM, as well as declaring the default namespace (if any) that is in scope on that element in the DOM.

  3. The user agent must feed the parser just created the string being assigned into the innerHTML attribute.

  4. If the innerHTML attribute is being set on an element, the user agent must feed the parser the string corresponding to the end tag of that element.

  5. If the parser found a well-formedness error, the attribute's setter must raise a SYNTAX_ERR exception and abort these steps.

  6. The user agent must remove the children nodes of the node whose innerHTML attribute is being set.

  7. If the attribute is being set on a Document node, let new children be the children of the document, preserving their order. Otherwise, the attribute is being set on an Element node; let new children be the children of the document's root element, preserving their order.

  8. If the attribute is being set on a Document node, let target document be that Document node. Otherwise, the attribute is being set on an Element node; let target document be the ownerDocument of that Element.

  9. Set the ownerDocument of all the nodes in new children to the target document.

  10. Append all the new children nodes to the node whose innerHTML attribute is being set, preserving their order.


In an XML context, the document.write() and insertAdjacentHTML() methods, and the outerHTML attribute on both getting and setting, must raise an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception.

4. HTML の要素

4.1 根要素

4.1.1 html 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
文書の根要素として。
複合文書中で部分文書素片が認められる時に。
内容モデル:
head 要素と、その後に body 要素。
要素固有属性:
manifest
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

html 要素は HTML 文書の根を表します。

manifest 属性は、 文書のアプリケーション・キャッシュマニフェストがある場合、その番地を与えます。 この属性がある場合、その属性値は妥当な URL でなければなりません

manifest 属性は文書の読み込みの早い段階でのみ影響を持ちます。 この属性を動的に変更しても、影響はありません (ので、 DOM API はこの属性には提供しません)。

後の base 要素は、それが見られるよりも前に manifest 属性が処理されるので、相対 URL の解決には影響しません。

4.2 文書メタデータ

4.2.1 head 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
html 要素の最初の要素として。
内容モデル:
1つ以上のメタデータ内容要素、 ただし、そのうちの丁度1つは title 要素。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

head 要素は文書のメタデータを集めています。

4.2.2 title 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
他に title 要素を含まない head 要素の中。
内容モデル:
テキスト。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

title 要素は文書の題や名前を表します。 著者は、文書が文脈外、例えば利用者の履歴や栞、あるいは検索結果で使われた場合であっても、 その文書を識別できるような題名を使うべきです。 文書の題は最初の見出しと異なることもよくあります。 最初の見出しは文脈外で単独で使えるものでなくてもよいからです。

文書中に複数の title 要素があってはなりません

title 要素は要素を含んではなりません

次に示すのは、適切な題名の例です。 同じ頁の最上位で使い得る見出しと比べてください。

  <title>Introduction to The Mating Rituals of Bees</title>
    ...
  <h1>Introduction</h1>
  <p>This companion guide to the highly successful
  <cite>Introduction to Medieval Bee-Keeping</cite> book is...

次の頁は同じサイトの中にありそうなものです。 題名が話題を曖昧なく説明している一方で、 最初の見出しは読者が文脈をわかっていることを前提にしていて、 踊りがサルサなのかワルツなのか困らないものと思っていることに注意してください。

  <title>Dances used during bee mating rituals</title>
    ...
  <h1>The Dances</h1>

string to use as the document's title is given by the document.title DOM attribute. User agents should use the document's title when referring to the document in their user 界面。

4.2.3 base 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
他に base 要素を含まない head 要素の中で。
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
href
target
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLBaseElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString href;
           attribute DOMString target;
};

base 要素を使うと、 著者は相対 URL を解決する際の文書基底 URLハイパーリンクをたどる際の既定の閲覧文脈の名前を指定することができます。

文書中に複数の base 要素があってはなりません

base 要素は href 属性と target 属性のいずれか、または両方を持たなければなりません

href 内容属性は、指定された場合、妥当な URL を含まなければなりません

base 要素は、href 属性を持つ場合、 URL を取ると定義されている属性を持つ他の要素のうち、 html 要素以外より木上で前に来なければなりません (html 要素の manifest 属性は base 要素に影響されません)。

href 属性のある base 要素が複数存在する場合、最初の要素以外はすべて無視されます。

target 属性は、 指定された場合、妥当な閲覧文脈の名前かキーワードを含まなければなりません。 利用者エージェントはハイパーリンクをたどる際にこの名前を使います。

base 要素は、 target 属性を持つ場合、ハイパーリンクを表す要素よりも木上で前に来なければなりません

target 属性を持つ base 要素が複数存在する場合、 最初の要素以外はすべて無視されます。

DOM 属性 href, target は同じ名前の内容属性を反映しなければなりません

分類
メタデータ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
メタデータ内容が期待される場所。
head 要素の子供である noscript 要素の中。
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
href
rel
media
hreflang
type
sizes
また、 title 属性はこの要素では特別な意味を持ちます。
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLLinkElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute boolean disabled;
           attribute DOMString href;
           attribute DOMString rel;
  readonly attribute DOMTokenList relList;
           attribute DOMString media;
           attribute DOMString hreflang;
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute DOMString sizes;
};

LinkStyle 界面もこの要素に実装されなければなりません。 その方法はスタイル付け処理モデルで定義します。 [CSSOM]

link 要素を使うと、 文書から他の資源へリンクすることができます。

リンクの終点は href 属性により与えられます。この属性は存在しなければならず妥当な URL を含まなければなりませんhref 属性が存在しない場合、その要素はリンクを定義しません。

示されたリンクの型 (関係) は rel 属性の値により与えられます。この属性は存在しなければならず間隔区切字句集合であるような値を持たなければなりません認められている値とその意味は後の節で定義します。 rel 属性が存在しないか、 この仕様書の定義に照らして認められていない値である場合は、 その要素はリンクを定義しません。

link 要素を使って作成できるリンクは2種類あります。 外部資源へのリンクは、現在の文書を補うために使われる資源へのリンクで、 ハイパーリンク・リンク他の文書へのリンクです。 リンク型の節で、あるリンク型が外部資源なのかハイパーリンクなのかを定義します。 ある要素は複数のリンクを作成できます (そのうちいくつかは外部資源リンクで、 いくつかはハイパーリンクであっても構いません)。どのリンクが何個作成されるかは rel 属性に与えられたキーワードに依存します。 利用者エージェントはリンクを、要素毎ではなく、リンク毎に処理しなければなりません

外部資源へのリンクの正確な動作は、関係がどうであるかに依存し、 各リンク型についてそれぞれ定義します。いくつかの属性は外部資源が適用されるかどうかを制御します (後で定義します)。 DOM で表される外部資源 (例えばスタイル・シート) については、 資源が適用されない場合であっても、 DOM 表現が利用可能とされなければなりません。 (しかし、利用者エージェントは適用されない外部資源をすべて予め取ってくる必要はなく、 必要になった時にだけそのような資源を取ってくることとしても構いません。)

外部資源を取ってくる際には、使用されるプロトコル (例えば HTTP) の意味に従わなければなりません。 (例えば、リダイレクトに従わなければなりませんし、 404 応答があると外部資源は適用されなくしなければなりません。)

Interactive user agents should provide users with a means to follow the hyperlinks created using the link element, somewhere within their user interface. The exact interface is not defined by this specification, but it should include the following information (obtained from the element's attributes, again as defined below), in some form or another (possibly simplified), for each hyperlink created with each link element in the document:

User agents may also include other information, such as the type of the resource (as given by the type attribute).

Hyperlinks created with the link element and its rel attribute apply to the whole page. This contrasts with the rel attribute of a and area elements, which indicates the type of a link whose context is given by the link's location within the document.

The media attribute says which media the resource applies to. The value must be a valid media query. [MQ]

If the link is a hyperlink then the media attribute is purely advisory, and describes for which media the document in question was designed.

However, if the link is an external resource link, then the media attribute is prescriptive. The user agent must apply the external resource to views while their state match the listed media and the other relevant conditions apply, and must not apply them otherwise.

The default, if the media attribute is omitted, is all, meaning that by default links apply to all media.

The hreflang attribute on the link element has the same semantics as the hreflang attribute on hyperlink elements.

The type attribute gives the MIME type of the linked resource. It is purely advisory. The value must be a valid MIME type, optionally with parameters. [RFC2046]

For external resource links, the type attribute is used as a hint to user agents so that they can avoid fetching resources they do not support. If the attribute is present, then the user agent must assume that the resource is of the given type. If the attribute is omitted, but the external resource link type has a default type defined, then the user agent must assume that the resource is of that type. If the UA does not support the given MIME type for the given link relationship, then the UA should not fetch the resource; if the UA does support the given MIME type for the given link relationship, then the UA should fetch the resource. If the attribute is omitted, and the external resource link type does not have a default type defined, but the user agent would fetch the resource if the type was known and supported, then the user agent should fetch the resource under the assumption that it will be supported.

User agents must not consider the type attribute authoritative — upon fetching the resource, user agents must not use the type attribute to determine its actual type. Only the actual type (as defined in the next paragraph) is used to determine whether to apply the resource, not the aforementioned assumed type.

Once the user agent has established the type of the resource, the user agent must apply the resource if it is of a supported type and the other relevant conditions apply, and must ignore the resource otherwise.

If a document contains style sheet links labeled as follows:

<link rel="stylesheet" href="A" type="text/plain">
<link rel="stylesheet" href="B" type="text/css">
<link rel="stylesheet" href="C">

...then a compliant UA that supported only CSS style sheets would fetch the B and C files, and skip the A file (since text/plain is not the MIME type for CSS style sheets).

For files B and C, it would then check the actual types returned by the server. For those that are sent as text/css, it would apply the styles, but for those labeled as text/plain, or any other type, it would not.

If one the two files was returned without a Content-Type metadata, or with a syntactically incorrect type like Content-Type: "null", then the default type for stylesheet links would kick in. Since that default type is text/css, the style sheet would nonetheless be applied.

The title attribute gives the title of the link. With one exception, it is purely advisory. The value is text. The exception is for style sheet links, where the title attribute defines alternative style sheet sets.

The title attribute on link elements differs from the global title attribute of most other elements in that a link without a title does not inherit the title of the parent element: it merely has no title.

The sizes attribute is used with the icon link type. The attribute must not be specified on link elements that do not have a rel attribute that specifies the icon keyword.

Some versions of HTTP defined a Link: header, to be processed like a series of link elements. If supported, for the purposes of ordering links defined by HTTP headers must be assumed to come before any links in the document, in the order that they were given in the HTTP entity header. (URIs in these headers are to be processed and resolved according to the rules given in HTTP; the rules of this specification don't apply.) [RFC2616] [RFC2068]

The DOM attributes href, rel, media, hreflang, and type, and sizes each must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

The DOM attribute relList must reflect the rel content attribute.

The DOM attribute disabled only applies to style sheet links. When the link element defines a style sheet link, then the disabled attribute behaves as defined for the alternative style sheets DOM. For all other link elements it always return false and does nothing on setting.

4.2.5 meta 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
If the charset attribute is present, or if the element is in the Encoding declaration state: as the first element in a head element.
If the http-equiv attribute is present, and the element is not in the Encoding declaration state: in a head element.
If the http-equiv attribute is present, and the element is not in the Encoding declaration state: in a noscript element that is a child of a head element.
If the name attribute is present: where metadata content is expected.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
name
http-equiv
content
charset (HTML only)
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLMetaElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString content;
           attribute DOMString name;
           attribute DOMString httpEquiv;
};

The meta element represents various kinds of metadata that cannot be expressed using the title, base, link, style, and script elements.

The meta element can represent document-level metadata with the name attribute, pragma directives with the http-equiv attribute, and the file's character encoding declaration when an HTML document is serialized to string form (e.g. for transmission over the network or for disk storage) with the charset attribute.

Exactly one of the name, http-equiv, and charset attributes must be specified.

If either name or http-equiv is specified, then the content attribute must also be specified. Otherwise, it must be omitted.

The charset attribute specifies the character encoding used by the document. This is called a character encoding declaration.

The charset attribute may be specified in HTML documents only, it must not be used in XML documents. If the charset attribute is specified, the element must be the first element in the head element of the file.

The content attribute gives the value of the document metadata or pragma directive when the element is used for those purposes. The allowed values depend on the exact context, as described in subsequent sections of this specification.

If a meta element has a name attribute, it sets document metadata. Document metadata is expressed in terms of name/value pairs, the name attribute on the meta element giving the name, and the content attribute on the same element giving the value. The name specifies what aspect of metadata is being set; valid names and the meaning of their values are described in the following sections. If a meta element has no content attribute, then the value part of the metadata name/value pair is the empty string.

If a meta element has the http-equiv attribute specified, it must be either in a head element or in a noscript element that itself is in a head element. If a meta element does not have the http-equiv attribute specified, it must be in a head element.

The DOM attributes name and content must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name. The DOM attribute httpEquiv must reflect the content attribute http-equiv.

4.2.5.1. Standard metadata names

This specification defines a few names for the name attribute of the meta element.

application-name

The value must be a short free-form string that giving the name of the Web application that the page represents. If the page is not a Web application, the application-name metadata name must not be used. User agents may use the application name in UI in preference to the page's title, since the title might include status messages and the like relevant to the status of the page at a particular moment in time instead of just being the name of the application.

description

The value must be a free-form string that describes the page. The value must be appropriate for use in a directory of pages, e.g. in a search engine.

generator

The value must be a free-form string that identifies the software used to generate the document. This value must not be used on hand-authored pages.

4.2.5.2. その他のメタデータ名

Extensions to the predefined set of metadata names may be registered in the WHATWG Wiki MetaExtensions page.

Anyone is free to edit the WHATWG Wiki MetaExtensions page at any time to add a type. These new names must be specified with the following information:

Keyword

The actual name being defined. The name should not be confusingly similar to any other defined name (e.g. differing only in case).

Brief description

A short description of what the metadata name's meaning is, including the format the value is required to be in.

Link to more details
A link to a more detailed description of the metadata name's semantics and requirements. It could be another page on the Wiki, or a link to an external page.
Synonyms

A list of other names that have exactly the same processing requirements. Authors should not use the names defined to be synonyms, they are only intended to allow user agents to support legacy content.

Status

One of the following:

Proposal
The name has not received wide peer review and approval. Someone has proposed it and is using it.
Accepted
The name has received wide peer review and approval. It has a specification that unambiguously defines how to handle pages that use the name, including when they use it in incorrect ways.
Unendorsed
The metadata name has received wide peer review and it has been found wanting. Existing pages are using this keyword, but new pages should avoid it. The "brief description" and "link to more details" entries will give details of what authors should use instead, if anything.

If a metadata name is added with the "proposal" status and found to be redundant with existing values, it should be removed and listed as a synonym for the existing value.

Conformance checkers must use the information given on the WHATWG Wiki MetaExtensions page to establish if a value not explicitly defined in this specification is allowed or not. When an author uses a new type not defined by either this specification or the Wiki page, conformance checkers should offer to add the value to the Wiki, with the details described above, with the "proposal" status.

This specification does not define how new values will get approved. It is expected that the Wiki will have a community that addresses this.

Metadata names whose values are to be URLs must not be proposed or accepted. Links must be represented using the link element, not the meta element.

4.2.5.3. Pragma directives

When the http-equiv attribute is specified on a meta element, the element is a pragma directive.

The http-equiv attribute is an enumerated attribute. The following table lists the keywords defined for this attribute. The states given in the first cell of the rows with keywords give the states to which those keywords map.

State Keywords
Content Language Content-Language
Encoding declaration Content-Type
Default style default-style
Refresh refresh

When a meta element is inserted into the document, if its http-equiv attribute is present and represents one of the above states, then the user agent must run the algorithm appropriate for that state, as described in the following list:

Content language

This pragma sets the document-wide default language. Until the pragma is successfully processed, there is no document-wide default language.

  1. If another meta element in the Content Language state has already been successfully processed (i.e. when it was inserted the user agent processed it and reached the last step of this list of steps), then abort these steps.

  2. If the meta element has no content attribute, or if that attribute's value is the empty string, then abort these steps.

  3. Let input be the value of the element's content attribute.

  4. Let position point at the first character of input.

  5. 空白を読み飛ばします

  6. Collect a sequence of characters that are neither space characters nor a U+002C COMMA character (",").

  7. Let the document-wide default language be the string that resulted from the previous step.

For meta elements in the Content Language state, the content attribute must have a value consisting of a valid RFC 3066 language code. [RFC3066]

This pragma is not exactly equivalent to the HTTP Content-Language header, for instance it only supports one language. [RFC2616]

Encoding declaration state

The Encoding declaration state's user agent requirements are all handled by the parsing section of the specification. The state is just an alternative form of setting the charset attribute: it is a character encoding declaration.

For meta elements in the Encoding declaration state, the content attribute must have a value that is an ASCII case-insensitive match for a string that consists of: the literal string "text/html;", optionally followed by any number of space characters, followed by the literal string "charset=", followed by the character encoding name of the character encoding declaration.

If the document contains a meta element in the Encoding declaration state then that element must be the first element in the document's head element, and the document must not contain a meta element with the charset attribute present.

The Encoding declaration state may be used in HTML documents only, elements in that state must not be used in XML documents.

Default style state
  1. ...
Refresh state
  1. If another meta element in the Refresh state has already been successfully processed (i.e. when it was inserted the user agent processed it and reached the last step of this list of steps), then abort these steps.

  2. If the meta element has no content attribute, or if that attribute's value is the empty string, then abort these steps.

  3. Let input be the value of the element's content attribute.

  4. Let position point at the first character of input.

  5. 空白を読み飛ばします

  6. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO to U+0039 DIGIT NINE, and parse the resulting string using the rules for parsing non-negative integers. If the sequence of characters collected is the empty string, then no number will have been parsed; abort these steps. Otherwise, let time be the parsed number.

  7. Collect a sequence of characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO to U+0039 DIGIT NINE and U+002E FULL STOP ("."). Ignore any collected characters.

  8. 空白を読み飛ばします

  9. Let url be the address of the current page.

  10. If the character in input pointed to by position is a U+003B SEMICOLON (";"), then advance position to the next character. Otherwise, jump to the last step.

  11. 空白を読み飛ばします

  12. If the character in input pointed to by position is one of U+0055 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER U or U+0075 LATIN SMALL LETTER U, then advance position to the next character. Otherwise, jump to the last step.

  13. If the character in input pointed to by position is one of U+0052 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER R or U+0072 LATIN SMALL LETTER R, then advance position to the next character. Otherwise, jump to the last step.

  14. If the character in input pointed to by position is one of U+004C LATIN CAPITAL LETTER L or U+006C LATIN SMALL LETTER L, then advance position to the next character. Otherwise, jump to the last step.

  15. 空白を読み飛ばします

  16. If the character in input pointed to by position is a U+003D EQUALS SIGN ("="), then advance position to the next character. Otherwise, jump to the last step.

  17. 空白を読み飛ばします

  18. Let url be equal to the substring of input from the character at position to the end of the string.

  19. Strip any trailing space characters from the end of url.

  20. Strip any U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), and U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) characters from url.

  21. Resolve the url value to an absolute URL. (For the purposes of determining the base URL, the url value comes from the value of a content attribute of the meta element.) If this fails, abort these steps.

  22. Perform one or more of the following steps:

    • Set a timer so that in time seconds, adjusted to take into account user or user agent preferences, if the user has not canceled the redirect, the user agent navigates the document's browsing context to url, with replacement enabled, and with the document's browsing context as the source browsing context.

    • Provide the user with an interface that, when selected, navigates a browsing context to url, with the document's browsing context as the source browsing context.

    • Do nothing.

    In addition, the user agent may, as with anything, inform the user of any and all aspects of its operation, including the state of any timers, the destinations of any timed redirects, and so forth.

For meta elements in the Refresh state, the content attribute must have a value consisting either of:

In the former case, the integer represents a number of seconds before the page is to be reloaded; in the latter case the integer represents a number of seconds before the page is to be replaced by the page at the given URL.

There must not be more than one meta element with any particular state in the document at a time.

4.2.5.4. Specifying the document's character encoding

A character encoding declaration is a mechanism by which the character encoding used to store or transmit a document is specified.

The following restrictions apply to character encoding declarations:

If the document does not start with a BOM, and if its encoding is not explicitly given by Content-Type metadata, then the character encoding used must be an ASCII-compatible character encoding, and, in addition, if that encoding isn't US-ASCII itself, then the encoding must be specified using a meta element with a charset attribute or a meta element in the Encoding declaration state.

If the document contains a meta element with a charset attribute or a meta element in the Encoding declaration state, then the character encoding used must be an ASCII-compatible character encoding.

An ASCII-compatible character encoding is one that is a superset of US-ASCII (specifically, ANSI_X3.4-1968) for bytes in the set 0x09, 0x0A, 0x0C, 0x0D, 0x20 - 0x22, 0x26, 0x27, 0x2C - 0x3F, 0x41 - 0x5A, and 0x61 - 0x7A.

Authors should not use JIS_X0212-1990, x-JIS0208, and encodings based on EBCDIC. Authors should not use UTF-32. Authors must not use the CESU-8, UTF-7, BOCU-1 and SCSU encodings. [CESU8] [UTF7] [BOCU1] [SCSU]

Authors are encouraged to use UTF-8. Conformance checkers may advise against authors using legacy encodings.

In XHTML, the XML declaration should be used for inline character encoding information, if necessary.

4.2.6 style 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
If the scoped attribute is present: flow content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
If the scoped attribute is absent: where metadata content is expected.
If the scoped attribute is absent: in a noscript element that is a child of a head element.
If the scoped attribute is present: where flow content is expected, but before any other flow content other than other style elements and inter-element whitespace.
内容モデル:
Depends on the value of the type attribute.
要素固有属性:
media
type
scoped
Also, the title attribute has special semantics on this element.
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLStyleElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute boolean disabled;
           attribute DOMString media;
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute boolean scoped;
};

LinkStyle 界面もこの要素に実装されなければなりません。 その方法はスタイル付け処理モデルで定義します。 [CSSOM]

The style element allows authors to embed style information in their documents. The style element is one of several inputs to the styling processing model.

If the type attribute is given, it must contain a valid MIME type, optionally with parameters, that designates a styling language. [RFC2046] If the attribute is absent, the type defaults to text/css. [RFC2138]

When examining types to determine if they support the language, user agents must not ignore unknown MIME parameters — types with unknown parameters must be assumed to be unsupported.

The media attribute says which media the styles apply to. The value must be a valid media query. [MQ] User agents must apply the styles to views while their state match the listed media, and must not apply them otherwise. [DOM3VIEWS]

The default, if the media attribute is omitted, is all, meaning that by default styles apply to all media.

The scoped attribute is a boolean attribute. If the attribute is present, then the user agent must apply the specified style information only to the style element's parent element (if any), and that element's child nodes. Otherwise, the specified styles must, if applied, be applied to the entire document.

The title attribute on style elements defines alternative style sheet sets. If the style element has no title attribute, then it has no title; the title attribute of ancestors does not apply to the style element.

The title attribute on style elements, like the title attribute on link elements, differs from the global title attribute in that a style block without a title does not inherit the title of the parent element: it merely has no title.

All descendant elements must be processed, according to their semantics, before the style element itself is evaluated. For styling languages that consist of pure text, user agents must evaluate style elements by passing the concatenation of the contents of all the text nodes that are direct children of the style element (not any other nodes such as comments or elements), in tree order, to the style system. For XML-based styling languages, user agents must pass all the children nodes of the style element to the style system.

This specification does not specify a style system, but CSS is expected to be supported by most Web browsers. [CSS21]

The media, type and scoped DOM attributes must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

The DOM disabled attribute behaves as defined for the alternative style sheets DOM.

4.2.7 Styling

The link and style elements can provide styling information for the user agent to use when rendering the document. The DOM Styling specification specifies what styling information is to be used by the user agent and how it is to be used. [CSSOM]

The style and link elements implement the LinkStyle interface. [CSSOM]

For style elements, if the user agent does not support the specified styling language, then the sheet attribute of the element's LinkStyle interface must return null. Similarly, link elements that do not represent external resource links that contribute to the styling processing model (i.e. that do not have a stylesheet keyword in their rel attribute), and link elements whose specified resource has not yet been fetched, or is not in a supported styling language, must have their LinkStyle interface's sheet attribute return null.

Otherwise, the LinkStyle interface's sheet attribute must return a StyleSheet object with the attributes implemented as follows: [CSSOM]

The content type (type DOM attribute)

The content type must be the same as the style's specified type. For style elements, this is the same as the type content attribute's value, or text/css if that is omitted. For link elements, this is the Content-Type metadata of the specified resource.

The location (href DOM attribute)

For link elements, the location must be the result of resolving the URL given by the element's href content attribute, or the empty string if that fails. For style elements, there is no location.

The intended destination media for style information (media DOM attribute)

The media must be the same as the value of the element's media content attribute.

The style sheet title (title DOM attribute)

The title must be the same as the value of the element's title content attribute. If the attribute is absent, then the style sheet does not have a title. The title is used for defining alternative style sheet sets.

The disabled DOM attribute on link and style elements must return false and do nothing on setting, if the sheet attribute of their LinkStyle interface is null. Otherwise, it must return the value of the StyleSheet interface's disabled attribute on getting, and forward the new value to that same attribute on setting.

4.3 Sections

Some elements, for example address elements, are scoped to their nearest ancestor sectioning content. For such elements x, the elements that apply to a sectioning content element e are all the x elements whose nearest sectioning content ancestor is e.

4.3.1 body 要素

分類
Sectioning content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As the second element in an html element.
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLBodyElement : HTMLElement {};

The body element represents the main content of the document.

In conforming documents, there is only one body element. The document.body DOM attribute provides scripts with easy access to a document's body element.

Some DOM operations (for example, parts of the drag and drop model) are defined in terms of "the body element". This refers to a particular element in the DOM, as per the definition of the term, and not any arbitrary body element.

4.3.2 section 要素

分類
流れ内容
Sectioning content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The section element represents a generic document or application section. A section, in this context, is a thematic grouping of content, typically with a header, possibly with a footer.

Examples of sections would be chapters, the various tabbed pages in a tabbed dialog box, or the numbered sections of a thesis. A Web site's home page could be split into sections for an introduction, news items, contact information.

4.3.3 nav 要素

分類
流れ内容
Sectioning content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The nav element represents a section of a page that links to other pages or to parts within the page: a section with navigation links. Not all groups of links on a page need to be in a nav element — only sections that consist of primary navigation blocks are appropriate for the nav element. In particular, it is common for footers to have a list of links to various key parts of a site, but the footer element is more appropriate in such cases.

In the following example, the page has several places where links are present, but only one of those places is considered a navigation section.

<body>
 <header>
  <h1>Wake up sheeple!</h1>
  <p><a href="news.html">News</a> -
     <a href="blog.html">Blog</a> -
     <a href="forums.html">Forums</a></p>
 </header>
 <nav>
  <h1>Navigation</h1>
  <ul>
   <li><a href="articles.html">Index of all articles</a><li>
   <li><a href="today.html">Things sheeple need to wake up for today</a><li>
   <li><a href="successes.html">Sheeple we have managed to wake</a><li>
  </ul>
 </nav>
 <article>
  <p>...page content would be here...</p>
 </article>
 <footer>
  <p>Copyright © 2006 The Example Company</p>
  <p><a href="about.html">About</a> -
     <a href="policy.html">Privacy Policy</a> -
     <a href="contact.html">Contact Us</a></p>
 </footer>
</body>

4.3.4 article 要素

分類
流れ内容
Sectioning content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The article element represents a section of a page that consists of a composition that forms an independent part of a document, page, or site. This could be a forum post, a magazine or newspaper article, a Web log entry, a user-submitted comment, or any other independent item of content.

An article element is "independent" in that its contents could stand alone, for example in syndication. However, the element is still associated with its ancestors; for instance, contact information that applies to a parent body element still covers the article as well.

When article elements are nested, the inner article elements represent articles that are in principle related to the contents of the outer article. For instance, a Web log entry on a site that accepts user-submitted comments could represent the comments as article elements nested within the article element for the Web log entry.

Author information associated with an article element (q.v. the address element) does not apply to nested article elements.

4.3.5 aside 要素

分類
流れ内容
Sectioning content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The aside element represents a section of a page that consists of content that is tangentially related to the content around the aside element, and which could be considered separate from that content. Such sections are often represented as sidebars in printed typography.

The following example shows how an aside is used to mark up background material on Switzerland in a much longer news story on Europe.

<aside>
 <h1>Switzerland</h1>
 <p>Switzerland, a land-locked country in the middle of geographic
 Europe, has not joined the geopolitical European Union, though it is
 a signatory to a number of European treaties.</p>
</aside>

The following example shows how an aside is used to mark up a pull quote in a longer article.

...

<p>He later joined a large company, continuing on the same work.
<q>I love my job. People ask me what I do for fun when I'm not at
work. But I'm paid to do my hobby, so I never know what to
answer. Some people wonder what they would do if they didn't have to
work... but I know what I would do, because I was unemployed for a
year, and I filled that time doing exactly what I do
now.</q></p>

<aside>
 <q> People ask me what I do for fun when I'm not at work. But I'm
 paid to do my hobby, so I never know what to answer. </q>
</aside>

<p>Of course his work — or should that be hobby? —
isn't his only passion. He also enjoys other pleasures.</p>

...

4.3.6 h1h2h3h4h5h6 要素

分類
流れ内容
見出し内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

これらの要素は、その章節の見出しを定義します。

これらの要素の意味は見出しと章節の節で定義します。

これらの要素は、その名前中の数字により与えられる階数を持ちます。 h1 要素は最高の階数を持つといい、 h6 要素は最低の階数を持ち、 同じ名前の2つの要素は等しい階数を持ちます。

4.3.7 header 要素

分類
流れ内容
見出し内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容で、最低1つの見出し内容の子孫を含み、 章節付け内容である子孫、header 要素である子孫、footer 要素である子孫を含まない。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

header 要素は、 章節の見出しを表します。この要素は、普通、 h1h6 要素の集合を群化し、頁の題名と副題や謳い文句をマーク付けするために使います。しかし、 header 要素は純粋に章節の見出しや副見出しではないものも含んで構いません。 例えば、版履歴情報も見出しに含めるのが適当かもしれません。

For the purposes of document summaries, outlines, and the like, the text of header elements is defined to be the text of the highest ranked h1h6 element descendant of the header element, if there are any such elements, and the first such element if there are multiple elements with that rank. If there are no such elements, then the text of the header element is the empty string.

header 要素中の他の見出し要素は副見出しや副題を表します。

header 要素の階数は、 h1 要素のものと同じ (最高の階数) です。

見出しと章節の節で、 header 要素が個々の章節にどう割り当てられるかを定義します。

次に示すのは、妥当な見出しの例です。それぞれの場合で、 強調した文章が、見出しデータを取り出し、副見出しを無視する応用で見出しとして使われる文章を表します。

<header>
 <h1>The reality dysfunction</h1>
 <h2>Space is not the only void</h2>
</header>
<header>
 <h1>Dr. Strangelove</h1>
 <h2>Or: How I Learned to Stop Worrying and Love the Bomb</h2>
</header>
<header>
 <p>Welcome to...</p>
 <h1>Voidwars!</h1>
</header>
<header>
 <h1>Scalable Vector Graphics (SVG) 1.2</h1>
 <h2>W3C Working Draft 27 October 2004</h2>
 <dl>
  <dt>This version:</dt>
  <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20041027/">http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20041027/</a></dd>
  <dt>Previous version:</dt>
  <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20040510/">http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20040510/</a></dd>
  <dt>Latest version of SVG 1.2:</dt>
  <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG12/">http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG12/</a></dd>
  <dt>Latest SVG Recommendation:</dt>
  <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG/">http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG/</a></dd>
  <dt>Editor:</dt>
  <dd>Dean Jackson, W3C, <a href="mailto:dean@w3.org">dean@w3.org</a></dd>
  <dt>Authors:</dt>
  <dd>See <a href="#authors">Author List</a></dd>
 </dl>
 <p class="copyright"><a href="http://www.w3.org/Consortium/Legal/ipr-notic ...
</header>
分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ要素、ただし見出し内容である子孫、章節内容である子孫、footer 要素である子孫を含まない。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

footer 要素は、それが適用される章節の足部を表します。 足部は、一般的に、その章節に関する情報、例えば誰が書いたか、 関係する文書へのリンク、著作権データなどを含みます。

footer 中で与えられる章節の連絡先情報は、 address 要素を使ってマーク付けするべきです

足部は、通常は章節の終わりに現れますが、必ずしもそうである必要はありません。

次に示すのは、2つの足部がある頁です。2つは同じ内容で、1つは上にあり、 もう1つは下にあります。

<body>
 <footer><a href="../">Back to index...</a></footer>
 <h1>Lorem ipsum</h1>
 <p>A dolor sit amet, consectetur adipisicing elit, sed do eiusmod
 tempor incididunt ut labore et dolore magna aliqua. Ut enim ad minim
 veniam, quis nostrud exercitation ullamco laboris nisi ut aliquip ex
 ea commodo consequat. Duis aute irure dolor in reprehenderit in
 voluptate velit esse cillum dolore eu fugiat nulla
 pariatur. Excepteur sint occaecat cupidatat non proident, sunt in
 culpa qui officia deserunt mollit anim id est laborum.</p>
 <footer><a href="../">Back to index...</a></footer>
</body>

4.3.9 address 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Flow content, but with no heading content descendants, no sectioning content descendants, no footer element descendants, and no address element descendants.
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The address element represents the contact information for the section it applies to. If it applies to the body element, then it instead applies to the document as a whole.

For example, a page at the W3C Web site related to HTML might include the following contact information:

<ADDRESS>
 <A href="../People/Raggett/">Dave Raggett</A>, 
 <A href="../People/Arnaud/">Arnaud Le Hors</A>, 
 contact persons for the <A href="Activity">W3C HTML Activity</A>
</ADDRESS>

The address element must not be used to represent arbitrary addresses (e.g. postal addresses), unless those addresses are contact information for the section. (The p element is the appropriate element for marking up such addresses.)

The address element must not contain information other than contact information.

For example, the following is non-conforming use of the address element:

<ADDRESS>Last Modified: 1999/12/24 23:37:50</ADDRESS>

Typically, the address element would be included with other information in a footer element.

To determine the contact information for a sectioning content element (such as a document's body element, which would give the contact information for the page), UAs must collect all the address elements that apply to that sectioning content element and its ancestor sectioning content elements. The contact information is the collection of all the information given by those elements.

Contact information for one sectioning content element, e.g. an aside element, does not apply to its ancestor elements, e.g. the page's body.

4.3.10 Headings and sections

The h1h6 elements and the header element are headings.

The first element of heading content in an element of sectioning content gives the header for that section. Subsequent headers of equal or higher rank start new (implied) sections, headers of lower rank start subsections that are part of the previous one.

Sectioning content elements are always considered subsections of their nearest ancestor element of sectioning content, regardless of what implied sections other headings may have created.

Certain elements are said to be sectioning roots, including blockquote and td elements. These elements can have their own outlines, but the sections and headers inside these elements do not contribute to the outlines of their ancestors.

For the following fragment:

<body>
 <h1>Foo</h1>
 <h2>Bar</h2>
 <blockquote>
  <h3>Bla</h3>
 </blockquote>
 <p>Baz</p>
 <h2>Quux</h2>
 <section>
  <h3>Thud</h3>
 </section>
 <p>Grunt</p>
</body>

...the structure would be:

  1. Foo (heading of explicit body section, containing the "Grunt" paragraph)
    1. Bar (heading starting implied section, containing a block quote and the "Baz" paragraph)
    2. Quux (heading starting implied section)
    3. Thud (heading of explicit section section)

Notice how the section ends the earlier implicit section so that a later paragraph ("Grunt") is back at the top level.

Sections may contain headers of any rank, but authors are strongly encouraged to either use only h1 elements, or to use elements of the appropriate rank for the section's nesting level.

Authors are also encouraged to explicitly wrap sections in elements of sectioning content, instead of relying on the implicit sections generated by having multiple heading in one element of sectioning content.

For example, the following is correct:

<body>
 <h4>Apples</h4>
 <p>Apples are fruit.</p>
 <section>
  <h2>Taste</h2>
  <p>They taste lovely.</p>
  <h6>Sweet</h6>
  <p>Red apples are sweeter than green ones.</p>
  <h1>Color</h1>
  <p>Apples come in various colors.</p>
 </section>
</body>

However, the same document would be more clearly expressed as:

<body>
 <h1>Apples</h1>
 <p>Apples are fruit.</p>
 <section>
  <h2>Taste</h2>
  <p>They taste lovely.</p>
  <section>
   <h3>Sweet</h3>
   <p>Red apples are sweeter than green ones.</p>
  </section>
 </section>
 <section>
  <h2>Color</h2>
  <p>Apples come in various colors.</p>
 </section>
</body>

Both of the documents above are semantically identical and would produce the same outline in compliant user agents.

4.3.10.1. Creating an outline

This section defines an algorithm for creating an outline for a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element. It is defined in terms of a walk over the nodes of a DOM tree, in tree order, with each node being visited when it is entered and when it is exited during the walk.

The outline for a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element consists of a list of one or more potentially nested sections. A section is a container that corresponds to some nodes in the original DOM tree. Each section can have one heading associated with it, and can contain any number of further nested sections. The algorithm for the outline also associates each node in the DOM tree with a particular section and potentially a heading. (The sections in the outline aren't section elements, though some may correspond to such elements — they are merely conceptual sections.)

The following markup fragment:

<body>
 <h1>A</h1>
 <p>B</p>
 <h2>C</h2>
 <p>D</p>
 <h2>E</h2>
 <p>F</p>
</body>

...results in the following outline being created for the body node (and thus the entire document):

  1. Section created for body node.

    Associated with heading "A".

    Also associated with paragraph "B".

    Nested sections:

    1. Section implied for first h2 element.

      Associated with heading "C".

      Also associated with paragraph "D".

      No nested sections.

    2. Section implied for second h2 element.

      Associated with heading "E".

      Also associated with paragraph "F".

      No nested sections.

The algorithm that must be followed during a walk of a DOM subtree rooted at a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element to determine that element's outline is as follows:

  1. Let current outlinee be null. (It holds the element whose outline is being created.)

  2. Let current section be null. (It holds a pointer to a section, so that elements in the DOM can all be associated with a section.)

  3. Create a stack to hold elements, which is used to handle nesting. Initialize this stack to empty.

  4. As you walk over the DOM in tree order, trigger the first relevant step below for each element as you enter and exit it.

    If the top of the stack is an element, and you are exiting that element

    The element being exited is a heading content element.

    Pop that element from the stack.

    If the top of the stack is a heading content element

    Do nothing.

    When entering a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element

    If current outlinee is not null, push current outlinee onto the stack.

    Let current outlinee be the element that is being entered.

    Let current section be a newly created section for the current outlinee element.

    Let there be a new outline for the new current outlinee, initialized with just the new current section as the only section in the outline.

    When exiting a sectioning content element, if the stack is not empty

    Pop the top element from the stack, and let the current outlinee be that element.

    Let current section be the last section in the outline of the current outlinee element.

    Append the outline of the sectioning content element being exited to the current section. (This does not change which section is the last section in the outline.)

    When exiting a sectioning root element, if the stack is not empty

    Run these steps:

    1. Pop the top element from the stack, and let the current outlinee be that element.

    2. Let current section be the last section in the outline of the current outlinee element.

    3. Finding the deepest child: If current section has no child sections, stop these steps.

    4. Let current section be the last child section of the current current section.

    5. Go back to the substep labeled finding the deepest child.

    When exiting a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element

    The current outlinee is the element being exited.

    Let current section be the first section in the outline of the current outlinee element.

    Skip to the next step in the overall set of steps. (The walk is over.)

    If the current outlinee is null.

    Do nothing.

    When entering a heading content element

    If the current section has no heading, let the element being entered be the heading for the current section.

    Otherwise, if the element being entered has a rank equal to or greater than the heading of the last section of the outline of the current outlinee, then create a new section and append it to the outline of the current outlinee element, so that this new section is the new last section of that outline. Let current section be that new section. Let the element being entered be the new heading for the current section.

    Otherwise, run these substeps:

    1. Let candidate section be current section.

    2. If the element being entered has a rank lower than the rank of the heading of the candidate section, then create a new section, and append it to candidate section. (This does not change which section is the last section in the outline.) Let current section be this new section. Let the element being entered be the new heading for the current section. Abort these substeps.

    3. Let new candidate section be the section that contains candidate section in the outline of current outlinee.

    4. Let candidate section be new candidate section.

    5. 手順 2 に戻ります。

    Push the element being entered onto the stack. (This causes the algorithm to skip any descendants of the element.)

    Recall that h1 has the highest rank, and h6 has the lowest rank.

    その他の場合

    Do nothing.

    In addition, whenever you exit a node, after doing the steps above, if current section is not null, associate the node with the section current section.

  5. If the current outlinee is null, then there was no sectioning content element or sectioning root element in the DOM. There is no outline. Abort these steps.

  6. Associate any nodes that were not associated a section in the steps above with current outlinee as their section.

  7. Associate all nodes with the heading of the section with which they are associated, if any.

  8. If current outlinee is the body element, then the outline created for that element is the outline of the entire document.

The tree of sections created by the algorithm above, or a proper subset thereof, must be used when generating document outlines, for example when generating tables of contents.

When creating an interactive table of contents, entries should jump the user to the relevant sectioning content element, if the section was created for a real element in the original document, or to the relevant heading content element, if the section in the tree was generated for a heading in the above process.

Selecting the first section of the document therefore always takes the user to the top of the document, regardless of where the first header in the body is to be found.

The following JavaScript function shows how the tree walk could be implemented. The root argument is the root of the tree to walk, and the enter and exit arguments are callbacks that are called with the nodes as they are entered and exited. [ECMA262]

function (root, enter, exit) {
  var node = root;
  start: while (node) {
    enter(node);
    if (node.firstChild) {
      node = node.firstChild;
      continue start;
    }
    while (node) {
      exit(node);
      if (node.nextSibling) {
        node = node.nextSibling;
        continue start;
      }
      if (node == root)
        node = null;
      else
        node = node.parentNode;
    }
  }
}
4.3.10.2. Distinguishing site-wide headings from page headings

Given the outline of a document, but ignoring any sections created for nav and aside elements, and any of their descendants, if the only root of the tree is the body element's section, and it has only a single subsection which is created by an article element, then the heading of the body element should be assumed to be a site-wide heading, and the heading of the article element should be assumed to be the page's heading.

If a page starts with a heading that is common to the whole site, the document must be authored such that, in the document's outline, ignoring any sections created for nav and aside elements and any of their descendants, the tree has only one root section, the body element's section, its heading is the site-wide heading, the body element has just one subsection, that subsection is created by an article element, and that article's heading is the page heading.

If a page does not contain a site-wide heading, then the page must be authored such that, in the document's outline, ignoring any sections created for nav and aside elements and any of their descendants, either the body element has no subsections, or it has more than one subsection, or it has a single subsection but that subsection is not created by an article element, or there is more than one section at the root of the outline.

Conceptually, a site is thus a document with many articles — when those articles are split into many pages, the heading of the original single page becomes the heading of the site, repeated on every page.

4.4 Grouping content

4.4.1 p 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The p element represents a paragraph.

The following examples are conforming HTML fragments:

<p>The little kitten gently seated himself on a piece of
carpet. Later in his life, this would be referred to as the time the
cat sat on the mat.</p>
<fieldset>
 <legend>Personal information</legend>
 <p>
   <label>Name: <input name="n"></label>
   <label><input name="anon" type="checkbox"> Hide from other users</label>
 </p>
 <p><label>Address: <textarea name="a"></textarea></label></p>
</fieldset>
<p>There was once an example from Femley,<br>
Whose markup was of dubious quality.<br>
The validator complained,<br>
So the author was pained,<br>
To move the error from the markup to the rhyming.</p>

The p element should not be used when a more specific element is more appropriate.

The following example is technically correct:

<section>
 <!-- ... -->
 <p>Last modified: 2001-04-23</p>
 <p>Author: fred@example.com</p>
</section>

However, it would be better marked-up as:

<section>
 <!-- ... -->
 <footer>Last modified: 2001-04-23</footer>
 <address>Author: fred@example.com</address>
</section>

Or:

<section>
 <!-- ... -->
 <footer>
  <p>Last modified: 2001-04-23</p>
  <address>Author: fred@example.com</address>
 </footer>
</section>

4.4.2 hr 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The hr element represents a paragraph-level thematic break, e.g. a scene change in a story, or a transition to another topic within a section of a reference book.

4.4.3 br 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The br element represents a line break.

br elements must be empty. Any content inside br elements must not be considered part of the surrounding text.

br elements must be used only for line breaks that are actually part of the content, as in poems or addresses.

The following example is correct usage of the br element:

<p>P. Sherman<br>
42 Wallaby Way<br>
Sydney</p>

br elements must not be used for separating thematic groups in a paragraph.

The following examples are non-conforming, as they abuse the br element:

<p><a ...>34 comments.</a><br>
<a ...>Add a comment.<a></p>
<p>Name: <input name="name"><br>
Address: <input name="address"></p>

Here are alternatives to the above, which are correct:

<p><a ...>34 comments.</a></p>
<p><a ...>Add a comment.<a></p>
<p>Name: <input name="name"></p>
<p>Address: <input name="address"></p>

If a paragraph consists of nothing but a single br element, it represents a placeholder blank line (e.g. as in a template). Such blank lines must not be used for presentation purposes.

4.4.4 pre 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The pre element represents a block of preformatted text, in which structure is represented by typographic conventions rather than by elements.

In the HTML serialization, a leading newline character immediately following the pre element start tag is stripped.

Some examples of cases where the pre element could be used:

To represent a block of computer code, the pre element can be used with a code element; to represent a block of computer output the pre element can be used with a samp element. Similarly, the kbd element can be used within a pre element to indicate text that the user is to enter.

In the following snippet, a sample of computer code is presented.

<p>This is the <code>Panel</code> constructor:</p>
<pre><code>function Panel(element, canClose, closeHandler) {
  this.element = element;
  this.canClose = canClose;
  this.closeHandler = function () { if (closeHandler) closeHandler() };
}</code></pre>

In the following snippet, samp and kbd elements are mixed in the contents of a pre element to show a session of Zork I.

<pre><samp>You are in an open field west of a big white house with a boarded
front door.
There is a small mailbox here.

></samp> <kbd>open mailbox</kbd>

<samp>Opening the mailbox reveals:
A leaflet.

></samp></pre>

The following shows a contemporary poem that uses the pre element to preserve its unusual formatting, which forms an intrinsic part of the poem itself.

<pre>                maxling

it is with a          heart
               heavy

that i admit loss of a feline
        so           loved

a friend lost to the
        unknown
                                (night)

~cdr 11dec07</pre>

4.4.5 dialog 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Zero or more pairs of one dt element followed by one dd element.
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The dialog element represents a conversation.

Each part of the conversation must have an explicit talker (or speaker) given by a dt element, and a discourse (or quote) given by a dd element.

This example demonstrates this using an extract from Abbot and Costello's famous sketch, Who's on first:

<dialog>
 <dt> Costello
 <dd> Look, you gotta first baseman?
 <dt> Abbott
 <dd> Certainly.
 <dt> Costello
 <dd> Who's playing first?
 <dt> Abbott
 <dd> That's right.
 <dt> Costello
 <dd> When you pay off the first baseman every month, who gets the money?
 <dt> Abbott
 <dd> Every dollar of it. 
</dialog>

Text in a dt element in a dialog element is implicitly the source of the text given in the following dd element, and the contents of the dd element are implicitly a quote from that speaker. There is thus no need to include cite, q, or blockquote elements in this markup. Indeed, a q element inside a dd element in a conversation would actually imply the people talking were themselves quoting another work. See the cite, q, and blockquote elements for other ways to cite or quote.

4.4.6 blockquote 要素

分類
流れ内容
Sectioning root.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
cite
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLQuoteElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString cite;
};

The HTMLQuoteElement interface is also used by the q element.

The blockquote element represents a section that is quoted from another source.

Content inside a blockquote must be quoted from another source, whose address, if it has one, should be cited in the cite attribute.

If the cite attribute is present, it must be a valid URL. User agents should allow users to follow such citation links.

If a blockquote element is preceded or followed by a single paragraph that contains a single cite element and that is itself not preceded or followed by another blockquote element and does not itself have a q element descendant, then, the title of the work given by that cite element gives the source of the quotation contained in the blockquote element.

cite DOM 属性は element's cite 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The best way to represent a conversation is not with the cite and blockquote elements, but with the dialog element.

4.4.7 ol 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
0個以上の li 要素。
要素固有属性:
reversed
start
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLOListElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute boolean reversed;
           attribute long start;
};

The ol element represents a list of items, where the items have been intentionally ordered, such that changing the order would change the meaning of the document.

The items of the list are the li element child nodes of the ol element, in tree order.

The reversed attribute is a boolean attribute. If present, it indicates that the list is a descending list (..., 3, 2, 1). If the attribute is omitted, the list is an ascending list (1, 2, 3, ...).

The start attribute, if present, must be a valid integer giving the ordinal value of the first list item.

If the start attribute is present, user agents must parse it as an integer, in order to determine the attribute's value. The default value, used if the attribute is missing or if the value cannot be converted to a number according to the referenced algorithm, is 1 if the element has no reversed attribute, and is the number of child li elements otherwise.

The first item in the list has the ordinal value given by the ol element's start attribute, unless that li element has a value attribute with a value that can be successfully parsed, in which case it has the ordinal value given by that value attribute.

Each subsequent item in the list has the ordinal value given by its value attribute, if it has one, or, if it doesn't, the ordinal value of the previous item, plus one if the reversed is absent, or minus one if it is present.

reversed DOM 属性は value of the reversed 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

start DOM 属性は value of the start 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The following markup shows a list where the order matters, and where the ol element is therefore appropriate. Compare this list to the equivalent list in the ul section to see an example of the same items using the ul element.

<p>I have lived in the following countries (given in the order of when
I first lived there):</p>
<ol>
 <li>Switzerland
 <li>United Kingdom
 <li>United States
 <li>Norway
</ol>

Note how changing the order of the list changes the meaning of the document. In the following example, changing the relative order of the first two items has changed the birthplace of the author:

<p>I have lived in the following countries (given in the order of when
I first lived there):</p>
<ol>
 <li>United Kingdom
 <li>Switzerland
 <li>United States
 <li>Norway
</ol>

4.4.8 ul 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
0個以上の li 要素。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

ul 湯素は、項目の並びを表します。 ただし、項目の順序は重要ではない、 つまり順序変更が実質的に文書の意味を変更しない並びを表します。

並び中の項目は、 ul 要素中の li 要素である子供節点です。

次のマーク付けは、順序が重要ではないので ul 要素が適切であるような並びを示しています。 この並びと、 ol の節にある、 同じ項目で ol 要素を使った同じような並びを比べてみてください。

<p>私は次の国に住んでいました:</p>
<ul>
 <li>ノルウェイ
 <li>スイス
 <li>イギリス
 <li>アメリカ
</ul>

並びの順序を変えても文書の意味が変わらないことに注意してください。 先の例の項目は逆五十音順でしたが、次の例は2007年の経常収支の大きさの順です。 しかし、文書の意味は変わっていません。

<p>私は次の国に住んでいました:</p>
<ul>
 <li>スイス
 <li>ノルウェイ
 <li>イギリス
 <li>アメリカ
</ul>

4.4.9 li 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Inside ol elements.
Inside ul elements.
Inside menu elements.
内容モデル:
When the element is a child of a menu element: phrasing content.
その他の場合: 流れ内容
要素固有属性:
If the element is a child of an ol element: value
If the element is not the child of an ol element: None.
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLLIElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute long value;
};

The li element represents a list item. If its parent element is an ol, ul, or menu element, then the element is an item of the parent element's list, as defined for those elements. Otherwise, the list item has no defined list-related relationship to any other li element.

The value attribute, if present, must be a valid integer giving the ordinal value of the list item.

If the value attribute is present, user agents must parse it as an integer, in order to determine the attribute's value. If the attribute's value cannot be converted to a number, the attribute must be treated as if it was absent. The attribute has no default value.

The value attribute is processed relative to the element's parent ol element (q.v.), if there is one. If there is not, the attribute has no effect.

value DOM 属性は value of the value 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The following example, the top ten movies are listed (in reverse order). Note the way the list is given a title by using a figure element and its legend.

<figure>
 <legend>The top 10 movies of all time</legend>
 <ol>
  <li value="10"><cite>Josie and the Pussycats</cite>, 2001</li>
  <li value="9"><cite lang="sh">Црна мачка, бели мачор</cite>, 1998</li>
  <li value="8"><cite>A Bug's Life</cite>, 1998</li>
  <li value="7"><cite>Toy Story</cite>, 1995</li>
  <li value="6"><cite>Monsters, Inc</cite>, 2001</li>
  <li value="5"><cite>Cars</cite>, 2006</li>
  <li value="4"><cite>Toy Story 2</cite>, 1999</li>
  <li value="3"><cite>Finding Nemo</cite>, 2003</li>
  <li value="2"><cite>The Incredibles</cite>, 2004</li>
  <li value="1"><cite>Ratatouille</cite>, 2007</li>
 </ol>
</figure>

The markup could also be written as follows, using the reversed attribute on the ol element:

<figure>
 <legend>The top 10 movies of all time</legend>
 <ol reversed>
  <li><cite>Josie and the Pussycats</cite>, 2001</li>
  <li><cite lang="sh">Црна мачка, бели мачор</cite>, 1998</li>
  <li><cite>A Bug's Life</cite>, 1998</li>
  <li><cite>Toy Story</cite>, 1995</li>
  <li><cite>Monsters, Inc</cite>, 2001</li>
  <li><cite>Cars</cite>, 2006</li>
  <li><cite>Toy Story 2</cite>, 1999</li>
  <li><cite>Finding Nemo</cite>, 2003</li>
  <li><cite>The Incredibles</cite>, 2004</li>
  <li><cite>Ratatouille</cite>, 2007</li>
 </ol>
</figure>

If the li element is the child of a menu element and itself has a child that defines a command, then the li element must match the :enabled and :disabled pseudo-classes in the same way as the first such child element does.

4.4.10 dl 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Zero or more groups each consisting of one or more dt elements followed by one or more dd elements.
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The dl element introduces an association list consisting of zero or more name-value groups (a description list). Each group must consist of one or more names (dt elements) followed by one or more values (dd elements).

Name-value groups may be terms and definitions, metadata topics and values, or any other groups of name-value data.

The values within a group are alternatives; multiple paragraphs forming part of the same value must all be given within the same dd element.

The order of the list of groups, and of the names and values within each group, may be significant.

If a dl element is empty, it contains no groups.

If a dl element contains non-whitespace text nodes, or elements other than dt and dd, then those elements or text nodes do not form part of any groups in that dl.

If a dl element contains only dt elements, then it consists of one group with names but no values.

If a dl element contains only dd elements, then it consists of one group with values but no names.

If a dl element starts with one or more dd elements, then the first group has no associated name.

If a dl element ends with one or more dt elements, then the last group has no associated value.

When a dl element doesn't match its content model, it is often due to accidentally using dd elements in the place of dt elements and vice versa. Conformance checkers can spot such mistakes and might be able to advise authors how to correctly use the markup.

In the following example, one entry ("Authors") is linked to two values ("John" and "Luke").

<dl>
 <dt> Authors
 <dd> John
 <dd> Luke
 <dt> Editor
 <dd> Frank
</dl>

In the following example, one definition is linked to two terms.

<dl>
 <dt lang="en-US"> <dfn>color</dfn> </dt>
 <dt lang="en-GB"> <dfn>colour</dfn> </dt>
 <dd> A sensation which (in humans) derives from the ability of
 the fine structure of the eye to distinguish three differently
 filtered analyses of a view. </dd>
</dl>

The following example illustrates the use of the dl element to mark up metadata of sorts. At the end of the example, one group has two metadata labels ("Authors" and "Editors") and two values ("Robert Rothman" and "Daniel Jackson").

<dl>
 <dt> Last modified time </dt>
 <dd> 2004-12-23T23:33Z </dd>
 <dt> Recommended update interval </dt>
 <dd> 60s </dd>
 <dt> Authors </dt>
 <dt> Editors </dt>
 <dd> Robert Rothman </dd>
 <dd> Daniel Jackson </dd>
</dl>

The following example shows the dl element used to give a set of instructions. The order of the instructions here is important (in the other examples, the order of the blocks was not important).

<p>Determine the victory points as follows (use the
first matching case):</p>
<dl>
 <dt> If you have exactly five gold coins </dt>
 <dd> You get five victory points </dd>
 <dt> If you have one or more gold coins, and you have one or more silver coins </dt>
 <dd> You get two victory points </dd>
 <dt> If you have one or more silver coins </dt>
 <dd> You get one victory point </dd>
 <dt> Otherwise </dt>
 <dd> You get no victory points </dd>
</dl>

The following snippet shows a dl element being used as a glossary. Note the use of dfn to indicate the word being defined.

<dl>
 <dt><dfn>Apartment</dfn>, n.</dt>
 <dd>An execution context grouping one or more threads with one or
 more COM objects.</dd>
 <dt><dfn>Flat</dfn>, n.</dt>
 <dd>A deflated tire.</dd>
 <dt><dfn>Home</dfn>, n.</dt>
 <dd>The user's login directory.</dd>
</dl>

The dl element is inappropriate for marking up dialogue, since dialogue is ordered (each speaker/line pair comes after the next). For an example of how to mark up dialogue, see the dialog element.

4.4.11 dt 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
dl 要素中の dd 要素か dt 要素の前。
dialog 要素中の dd 要素の前。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

dt 要素は、説明並び (dl 要素) 中の用語・説明の群の一部として、 用語や名前を表し、会話 (dialog 要素) 中の話者・談話の組の一部として、 話者を表します。

dt 要素自体は、 dl 要素中で用いられた場合にも、 その内容が定義される用語であると示してはいませんが、 dfn 要素を使ってそうであると示すことができます。

dt 要素が dialog 要素の子供である場合で、かつ更に time 要素を含んでいる場合、その time 要素は関連付けられた談話 (dd 要素) が話された時刻印を表し、話者の名前の一部ではありません。

次の抜粋は、即席メッセージの会話記録をどうマーク付けできるかを示しています。

<dialog>
 <dt> <time>14:22</time> egof
 <dd> I'm not that nerdy, I've only seen 30% of the star trek episodes
 <dt> <time>14:23</time> kaj
 <dd> if you know what percentage of the star trek episodes you have seen, you are inarguably nerdy
 <dt> <time>14:23</time> egof
 <dd> it's unarguably
 <dt> <time>14:24</time> kaj
 <dd> you are not helping your case
</dialog>

4.4.12 dd 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
dl 要素中の dt 要素か dd 要素の後。
dialog 要素中の dt 要素の後。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

dd 要素は、説明並び (dl 要素) 中の用語・説明の群の一部として説明や定義や値を表し、 会話 (dialog 要素) の一部として談話や引用を表します。

4.5 文章水準の意味

4.5.1 a 要素

分類
対話的内容
要素が語句付け内容を含む時: 語句付け内容
その他の場合: 流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Transparent, but there must be no interactive content descendant.
要素固有属性:
href
target
ping
rel
media
hreflang
type
DOM 界面:
[Stringifies=href] interface HTMLAnchorElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString href;
           attribute DOMString target;
           attribute DOMString ping;
           attribute DOMString rel;
  readonly attribute DOMTokenList relList;
           attribute DOMString media;
           attribute DOMString hreflang;
           attribute DOMString type;
};

Command 界面もこの要素に実装しなければなりません

a 要素が href 属性を持つ場合、 ハイパーリンクを表します。

a 要素が href 属性を持たない場合、その要素は、もし関係があったとするとリンクが置かれていたであろう場所に場所持ち子です。

The target, ping, rel, media, hreflang, and type attributes must be omitted if the href attribute is not present.

あるサイトが各頁で共通の誘導ツールバーを用いている場合、 通常はその頁自体にリンクしているリンクは a 要素を用いてマーク付けすることができます。

<nav>
 <ul>
  <li> <a href="/">家</a> </li>
  <li> <a href="/news">おしらせ</a> </li>
  <li> <a>例</a> </li>
  <li> <a href="/legal">法的事項</a> </li>
 </ul>
</nav>

Interactive user agents should allow users to follow hyperlinks created using the a element. The href, target and ping attributes decide how the link is followed. The rel, media, hreflang, and type attributes may be used to indicate to the user the likely nature of the target resource before the user follows the link.

ハイパーリンクを表す a 要素の活性化動作は、 次の段階を動作させることです。

  1. 当該 DOMActivate 事象が信用できない場合 (つまり、 click() メソッド呼び出しが事象の発送の理由である場合) で、 a 要素の target 属性が ... である場合、 INVALID_ACCESS_ERR 例外を発生させ、これらの段階を停止します。

  2. DOMActivate 事象の対象が img 要素で、その ismap 属性が指定されている場合、 鯖側画像写像処理を次のように行わなければなりません

    1. DOMActivate 事象が、現実に指示装置が誘発した img 要素上の click 事象の結果として発送された場合、 x を画像の左辺からクリックの位置までの CSS 画素による距離とし、 y を画像の上辺からクリックの位置までの CSS 画素による距離とします。 それ以外の場合、 xy を零とします。
    2. ハイパーリンク接尾辞をU+003F QUESTION MARK 文字、 x の値の ASCII 数字 (U+0030 DIGIT ZERO から U+0039 DIGIT NINE) を使った十進整数表現、 U+002C COMMA 文字、 y の値の ASCII 数字を使った十進整数表現とします。
  3. 最後に、利用者エージェントは a 要素で定義されるハイパーリンクをたどらなければなりません。 先の段階がハイパーリンク接尾辞を定義している場合、 これをハイパーリンクをたどる時に考慮に入れます。

One way that a user agent can enable users to follow hyperlinks is by allowing a elements to be clicked, or focussed and activated by the keyboard. This will cause the aforementioned activation behavior to be invoked.

DOM 属性 href, ping, target, rel, media, hreflang, type は、それぞれ同じ名前の内容属性を反映しなければなりません

DOM 属性 relListrel 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The a element may be wrapped around entire paragraphs, lists, tables, and so forth, even entire sections, so long as there is no interactive content within (e.g. buttons or other links). This example shows how this can be used to make an entire advertising block into a link:

<aside class="advertising">
 <h1>Advertising</h1>
 <a href="http://ad.example.com/?adid=1929&amp;pubid=1422">
  <section>
   <h1>Mellblomatic 9000!</h1>
   <p>Turn all your widgets into mellbloms!</p>
   <p>Only $9.99 plus shipping and handling.</p>
  </section>
 </a>
 <a href="http://ad.example.com/?adid=375&amp;pubid=1422">
  <section>
   <h1>The Mellblom Browser</h1>
   <p>Web browsing at the speed of light.</p>
   <p>No other browser goes faster!</p>
  </section>
 </a>
</aside>

4.5.2 q 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
cite
DOM 界面:
q element uses the HTMLQuoteElement 界面。

The q element represents some phrasing content quoted from another source.

Quotation punctuation (such as quotation marks), if any, must be placed inside the q element.

Content inside a q element must be quoted from another source, whose address, if it has one, should be cited in the cite attribute.

If the cite attribute is present, it must be a valid URL. User agents should allow users to follow such citation links.

If a q element is contained (directly or indirectly) in a paragraph that contains a single cite element and has no other q element descendants, then, the title of the work given by that cite element gives the source of the quotation contained in the q element.

Here is a simple example of the use of the q element:

<p>The man said <q>"Things that are impossible just take
longer"</q>. I disagreed with him.</p>

Here is an example with both an explicit citation link in the q element, and an explicit citation outside:

<p>The W3C page <cite>About W3C</cite> says the W3C's
mission is <q cite="http://www.w3.org/Consortium/">"To lead the
World Wide Web to its full potential by developing protocols and
guidelines that ensure long-term growth for the Web"</q>. I
disagree with this mission.</p>

In the following example, the quotation itself contains a quotation:

<p>In <cite>Example One</cite>, he writes <q>"The man
said <q>'Things that are impossible just take longer'</q>. I
disagreed with him"</q>. Well, I disagree even more!</p>

In the following example, there are no quotation marks:

<p>His best argument: <q>I disagree!</q></p>

4.5.3 cite 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The cite element represents the title of a work (e.g. a book, a paper, an essay, a poem, a score, a song, a script, a film, a TV show, a game, a sculpture, a painting, a theatre production, a play, an opera, a musical, an exhibition, etc). This can be a work that is being quoted or referenced in detail (i.e. a citation), or it can just be a work that is mentioned in passing.

A person's name is not the title of a work — even if people call that person a piece of work — and the element must therefore not be used to mark up people's names. (In some cases, the b element might be appropriate for names; e.g. in a gossip article where the names of famous people are keywords rendered with a different style to draw attention to them. In other cases, if an element is really needed, the span element can be used.)

A ship is similarly not a work, and the element must not be used to mark up ship names (the i element can be used for that purpose).

This next example shows a typical use of the cite element:

<p>My favourite book is <cite>The Reality Dysfunction</cite> by
Peter F. Hamilton. My favourite comic is <cite>Pearls Before
Swine</cite> by Stephan Pastis. My favourite track is <cite>Jive
Samba</cite> by the Cannonball Adderley Sextet.</p>

This is correct usage:

<p>According to the Wikipedia article <cite>HTML</cite>, as it
stood in mid-February 2008, leaving attribute values unquoted is
unsafe. This is obviously an over-simplification.</p>

The following, however, is incorrect usage, as the cite element here is containing far more than the title of the work:

<!-- do not copy this example, it is an example of bad usage! -->
<p>According to <cite>the Wikipedia article on HTML</cite>, as it
stood in mid-February 2008, leaving attribute values unquoted is
unsafe. This is obviously an over-simplification.</p>

The cite element is obviously a key part of any citation in a bibliography, but it is only used to mark the title:

<p><cite>Universal Declaration of Human Rights</cite>, United Nations,
December 1948.  Adopted by General Assembly resolution 217 A (III).</p>

A citation is not a quote (for which the q element is appropriate).

This is incorrect usage, because cite is not for quotes:

<p><cite>This is wrong!</cite>, said Ian.</p>

This is also incorrect usage, because a person is not a work:

<p><q>This is still wrong!</q>, said <cite>Ian</cite>.</p>

The correct usage does not use a cite element:

<p><q>This is correct</q>, said Ian.</p>

As mentioned above, the b element might be relevant for marking names as being keywords in certain kinds of documents:

<p>And then <b>Ian</b> said <q>this might be right, in a
gossip column, maybe!</q>.</p>

The cite element can apply to blockquote and q elements in certain cases described in the definitions of those elements.

This next example shows the use of cite alongside blockquote:

<p>His next piece was the aptly named <cite>Sonnet 130</cite>:</p>
<blockquote>
  <p>My mistress' eyes are nothing like the sun,<br>
  Coral is far more red, than her lips red,
  ...

4.5.4 em 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The em element represents stress emphasis of its contents.

The level of emphasis that a particular piece of content has is given by its number of ancestor em elements.

The placement of emphasis changes the meaning of the sentence. The element thus forms an integral part of the content. The precise way in which emphasis is used in this way depends on the language.

These examples show how changing the emphasis changes the meaning. First, a general statement of fact, with no emphasis:

<p>Cats are cute animals.</p>

By emphasizing the first word, the statement implies that the kind of animal under discussion is in question (maybe someone is asserting that dogs are cute):

<p><em>Cats</em> are cute animals.</p>

Moving the emphasis to the verb, one highlights that the truth of the entire sentence is in question (maybe someone is saying cats are not cute):

<p>Cats <em>are</em> cute animals.</p>

By moving it to the adjective, the exact nature of the cats is reasserted (maybe someone suggested cats were mean animals):

<p>Cats are <em>cute</em> animals.</p>

Similarly, if someone asserted that cats were vegetables, someone correcting this might emphasize the last word:

<p>Cats are cute <em>animals</em>.</p>

By emphasizing the entire sentence, it becomes clear that the speaker is fighting hard to get the point across. This kind of emphasis also typically affects the punctuation, hence the exclamation mark here.

<p><em>Cats are cute animals!</em></p>

Anger mixed with emphasizing the cuteness could lead to markup such as:

<p><em>Cats are <em>cute</em> animals!</em></p>

4.5.5 strong 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The strong element represents strong importance for its contents.

The relative level of importance of a piece of content is given by its number of ancestor strong elements; each strong element increases the importance of its contents.

Changing the importance of a piece of text with the strong element does not change the meaning of the sentence.

Here is an example of a warning notice in a game, with the various parts marked up according to how important they are:

<p><strong>Warning.</strong> This dungeon is dangerous.
<strong>Avoid the ducks.</strong> Take any gold you find.
<strong><strong>Do not take any of the diamonds</strong>,
they are explosive and <strong>will destroy anything within
ten meters.</strong></strong> You have been warned.</p>

4.5.6 small 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The small element represents small print (part of a document often describing legal restrictions, such as copyrights or other disadvantages), or other side comments.

The small element does not "de-emphasize" or lower the importance of text emphasised by the em element or marked as important with the strong element.

In this example the footer contains contact information and a copyright.

<footer>
 <address>
  For more details, contact
  <a href="mailto:js@example.com">John Smith</a>.
 </address>
 <p><small>© copyright 2038 Example Corp.</small></p>
</footer>

In this second example, the small element is used for a side comment.

<p>Example Corp today announced record profits for the
second quarter <small>(Full Disclosure: Foo News is a subsidiary of
Example Corp)</small>, leading to speculation about a third quarter
merger with Demo Group.</p>

In this last example, the small element is marked as being important small print.

<p><strong><small>Continued use of this service will result in a kiss.</small></strong></p>

4.5.7 mark 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The mark element represents a run of text in one document marked or highlighted for reference purposes, due to its relevance in another context. When used in a quotation or other block of text referred to from the prose, it indicates a highlight that was not originally present but which has been added to bring the reader's attention to a part of the text that might not have been considered important by the original author when the block was originally written, but which is now under previously unexpected scrutiny. When used in the main prose of a document, it indicates a part of the document that has been highlighted due to its likely relevance to the user's current activity.

The rendering section will eventually suggest that user agents provide a way to let users jump between mark elements. Suggested rendering is a neon yellow background highlight, though UAs maybe should allow this to be toggled.

This example shows how the mark example can be used to bring attention to a particular part of a quotation:

<p lang="en-US">Consider the following quote:</p>
<blockquote lang="en-GB">
 <p>Look around and you will find, no-one's really
 <mark>colour</mark> blind.</p>
</blockquote>
<p lang="en-US">As we can tell from the <em>spelling</em> of the word,
the person writing this quote is clearly not American.</p>

Another example of the mark element is highlighting parts of a document that are matching some search string. If someone looked at a document, and the server knew that the user was searching for the word "kitten", then the server might return the document with one paragraph modified as follows:

<p>I also have some <mark>kitten</mark>s who are visiting me
these days. They're really cute. I think they like my garden! Maybe I
should adopt a <mark>kitten</mark>.</p>

In the following snippet, a paragraph of text refers to a specific part of a code fragment.

<p>The highlighted part below is where the error lies:</p>
<pre><code>var i: Integer;
begin
   i := <mark>1.1</mark>;
end.</code></pre>

This is another example showing the use of mark to highlight a part of quoted text that was originally not emphasised. In this example, common typographic conventions have led the author to explicitly style mark elements in quotes to render in italics.

<article>
 <style>
  blockquote mark, q mark {
    font: inherit; font-style: italic;
    text-decoration: none;
    background: transparent; color: inherit;
  }
  .bubble em {
    font: inherit; font-size: larger;
    text-decoration: underline;
  }
 </style>
 <h1>She knew</h1>
 <p>Did you notice the subtle joke in the joke on panel 4?</p>
 <blockquote>
  <p class="bubble">I didn't <em>want</em> to believe. <mark>Of course
  on some level I realized it was a known-plaintext attack.</mark> But I
  couldn't admit it until I saw for myself.</p>
 </blockquote>
 <p>(Emphasis mine.) I thought that was great. It's so pedantic, yet it
 explains everything neatly.</p>
</article>

Note, incidentally, the distinction between the em element in this example, which is part of the original text being quoted, and the mark element, which is highlighting a part for comment.

The following example shows the difference between denoting the importance of a span of text (strong) as opposed to denoting the relevance of a span of text (mark). It is an extract from a textbook, where the extract has had the parts relevant to the exam highlighted. The safety warnings, important though they may be, are apparently not relevant to the exam.

<h3>Wormhole Physics Introduction</h3>

<p><mark>A wormhole in normal conditions can be held open for a
maximum of just under 39 minutes.</mark> Conditions that can increase
the time include a powerful energy source coupled to one or both of
the gates connecting the wormhole, and a large gravity well (such as a
black hole).</p>

<p><mark>Momentum is preserved across the wormhole. Electromagnetic
radiation can travel in both directions through a wormhole,
but matter cannot.</mark></p>

<p>When a wormhole is created, a vortex normally forms.
<strong>Warning: The vortex caused by the wormhole opening will
annihilate anything in its path.</strong> Vortexes can be avoided when
using sufficiently advanced dialing technology.</p>

<p><mark>An obstruction in a gate will prevent it from accepting a
wormhole connection.</mark></p>

4.5.8 dfn 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Phrasing content, but there must be no descendant dfn elements.
要素固有属性:
None, but the title attribute has special semantics on this element.
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The dfn element represents the defining instance of a term. The paragraph, description list group, or section that is the nearest ancestor of the dfn element must also contain the definition(s) for the term given by the dfn element.

Defining term: If the dfn element has a title attribute, then the exact value of that attribute is the term being defined. Otherwise, if it contains exactly one element child node and no child text nodes, and that child element is an abbr element with a title attribute, then the exact value of that attribute is the term being defined. Otherwise, it is the exact textContent of the dfn element that gives the term being defined.

If the title attribute of the dfn element is present, then it must contain only the term being defined.

The title attribute of ancestor elements does not affect dfn elements.

An a element that links to a dfn element represents an instance of the term defined by the dfn element.

In the following fragment, the term "GDO" is first defined in the first paragraph, then used in the second.

<p>The <dfn><abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr></dfn>
is a device that allows off-world teams to open the iris.</p>
<!-- ... later in the document: -->
<p>Teal'c activated his <abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr>
and so Hammond ordered the iris to be opened.</p>

With the addition of an a element, the reference can be made explicit:

<p>The <dfn id=gdo><abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr></dfn>
is a device that allows off-world teams to open the iris.</p>
<!-- ... later in the document: -->
<p>Teal'c activated his <a href=#gdo><abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr></a>
and so Hammond ordered the iris to be opened.</p>

4.5.9 abbr 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
None, but the title attribute has special semantics on this element.
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The abbr element represents an abbreviation or acronym, optionally with its expansion. The title attribute may be used to provide an expansion of the abbreviation. The attribute, if specified, must contain an expansion of the abbreviation, and nothing else.

The paragraph below contains an abbreviation marked up with the abbr element. This paragraph defines the term "Web Hypertext Application Technology Working Group".

<p>The <dfn id=whatwg><abbr title="Web Hypertext Application
Technology Working Group">WHATWG</abbr></dfn> is a loose
unofficial collaboration of Web browser manufacturers and interested
parties who wish to develop new technologies designed to allow authors
to write and deploy Applications over the World Wide Web.</p>

This paragraph has two abbreviations. Notice how only one is defined; the other, with no expansion associated with it, does not use the abbr element.

<p>The <abbr title="Web Hypertext Application Technology Working
Group">WHATWG</abbr> started working on HTML5 in 2004.</p>

This paragraph links an abbreviation to its definition.

<p>The <a href="#whatwg"><abbr title="Web Hypertext Application
Technology Working Group">WHATWG</abbr></a> community does not
have much representation from Asia.</p>

This paragraph marks up an abbreviation without giving an expansion, possibly as a hook to apply styles for abbreviations (e.g. smallcaps).

<p>Philip` and Dashiva both denied that they were going to
get the issue counts from past revisions of the specification to
backfill the <abbr>WHATWG</abbr> issue graph.</p>

If an abbreviation is pluralized, the expansion's grammatical number (plural vs singular) must match the grammatical number of the contents of the element.

Here the plural is outside the element, so the expansion is in the singular:

<p>Two <abbr title="Working Group">WG</abbr>s worked on
this specification: the <abbr>WHATWG</abbr> and the
<abbr>HTMLWG</abbr>.</p>

Here the plural is inside the element, so the expansion is in the plural:

<p>Two <abbr title="Working Groups">WGs</abbr> worked on
this specification: the <abbr>WHATWG</abbr> and the
<abbr>HTMLWG</abbr>.</p>

4.5.10 time 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
datetime
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLTimeElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString dateTime;
  readonly attribute DOMTimeStamp date;
  readonly attribute DOMTimeStamp time;
  readonly attribute DOMTimeStamp timezone;
};

The time element represents a date and/or a time.

The datetime attribute, if present, must contain a date or time string that identifies the date or time being specified.

If the datetime attribute is not present, then the date or time must be specified in the content of the element, such that parsing the element's textContent according to the rules for parsing date or time strings in content successfully extracts a date or time.

dateTime DOM 属性は datetime 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

User agents, to obtain the date, time, and timezone represented by a time element, must follow these steps:

  1. If the datetime attribute is present, then parse it according to the rules for parsing date or time strings in attributes, and let the result be result.
  2. Otherwise, parse the element's textContent according to the rules for parsing date or time strings in content, and let the result be result.
  3. If result is empty (because the parsing failed), then the date is unknown, the time is unknown, and the timezone is unknown.
  4. Otherwise: if result contains a date, then that is the date; if result contains a time, then that is the time; and if result contains a timezone, then the timezone is the element's timezone. (A timezone can only be present if both a date and a time are also present.)

The date DOM attribute must return null if the date is unknown, and otherwise must return the time corresponding to midnight UTC (i.e. the first second) of the given date.

The time DOM attribute must return null if the time is unknown, and otherwise must return the time corresponding to the given time of 1970-01-01, with the timezone UTC.

The timezone DOM attribute must return null if the timezone is unknown, and otherwise must return the time corresponding to 1970-01-01 00:00 UTC in the given timezone, with the timezone set to UTC (i.e. the time corresponding to 1970-01-01 at 00:00 UTC plus the offset corresponding to the timezone).

In the following snippet:

<p>Our first date was <time datetime="2006-09-23">a Saturday</time>.</p>

...the time element's date attribute would have the value 1,158,969,600,000ms, and the time and timezone attributes would return null.

In the following snippet:

<p>We stopped talking at <time datetime="2006-09-24 05:00 -7">5am the next morning</time>.</p>

...the time element's date attribute would have the value 1,159,056,000,000ms, the time attribute would have the value 18,000,000ms, and the timezone attribute would return −25,200,000ms. To obtain the actual time, the three attributes can be added together, obtaining 1,159,048,800,000, which is the specified date and time in UTC.

Finally, in the following snippet:

<p>Many people get up at <time>08:00</time>.</p>

...the time element's date attribute would have the value null, the time attribute would have the value 28,800,000ms, and the timezone attribute would return null.

These APIs may be suboptimal. Comments on making them more useful to JS authors are welcome. The primary use cases for these elements are for marking up publication dates e.g. in blog entries, and for marking event dates in hCalendar markup. Thus the DOM APIs are likely to be used as ways to generate interactive calendar widgets or some such.

4.5.11 progress 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
value
max
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLProgressElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute float value;
           attribute float max;
  readonly attribute float position;
};

The progress element represents the completion progress of a task. The progress is either indeterminate, indicating that progress is being made but that it is not clear how much more work remains to be done before the task is complete (e.g. because the task is waiting for a remote host to respond), or the progress is a number in the range zero to a maximum, giving the fraction of work that has so far been completed.

There are two attributes that determine the current task completion represented by the element.

The value attribute specifies how much of the task has been completed, and the max attribute specifies how much work the task requires in total. The units are arbitrary and not specified.

Instead of using the attributes, authors are recommended to include the current value and the maximum value inline as text inside the element.

Here is a snippet of a Web application that shows the progress of some automated task:

<section>
 <h2>Task Progress</h2>
 <p>Progress: <progress><span id="p">0</span>%</progress></p>
 <script>
  var progressBar = document.getElementById('p');
  function updateProgress(newValue) {
    progressBar.textContent = newValue;
  }
 </script>
</section>

(The updateProgress() method in this example would be called by some other code on the page to update the actual progress bar as the task progressed.)

Author requirements: The max and value attributes, when present, must have values that are valid floating point numbers. The max attribute, if present, must have a value greater than zero. The value attribute, if present, must have a value equal to or greater than zero, and less than or equal to the value of the max attribute, if present.

The progress element is the wrong element to use for something that is just a gauge, as opposed to task progress. For instance, indicating disk space usage using progress would be inappropriate. Instead, the meter element is available for such use cases.

User agent requirements: User agents must parse the max and value attributes' values according to the rules for parsing floating point number values.

If the value attribute is omitted, then user agents must also parse the textContent of the progress element in question using the steps for finding one or two numbers of a ratio in a string. These steps will return nothing, one number, one number with a denominator punctuation character, or two numbers.

Using the results of this processing, user agents must determine whether the progress bar is an indeterminate progress bar, or whether it is a determinate progress bar, and in the latter case, what its current and maximum values are, all as follows:

  1. If the max attribute is omitted, and the value is omitted, and the results of parsing the textContent was nothing, then the progress bar is an indeterminate progress bar. Abort these steps.
  2. Otherwise, it is a determinate progress bar.
  3. If the max attribute is included, then, if a value could be parsed out of it, then the maximum value is that value.
  4. Otherwise, if the max attribute is absent but the value attribute is present, or, if the max attribute is present but no value could be parsed from it, then the maximum is 1.
  5. Otherwise, if neither attribute is included, then, if the textContent contained one number with an associated denominator punctuation character, then the maximum value is the value associated with that denominator punctuation character; otherwise, if the textContent contained two numbers, the maximum value is the higher of the two values; otherwise, the maximum value is 1.
  6. If the value attribute is present on the element and a value could be parsed out of it, that value is the current value of the progress bar. Otherwise, if the attribute is present but no value could be parsed from it, the current value is zero.
  7. Otherwise if the value attribute is absent and the max attribute is present, then, if the textContent was parsed and found to contain just one number, with no associated denominator punctuation character, then the current value is that number. Otherwise, if the value attribute is absent and the max attribute is present then the current value is zero.
  8. Otherwise, if neither attribute is present, then the current value is the lower of the one or two numbers that were found in the textContent of the element.
  9. If the maximum value is less than or equal to zero, then it is reset to 1.
  10. If the current value is less than zero, then it is reset to zero.
  11. Finally, if the current value is greater than the maximum value, then the current value is reset to the maximum value.

UA requirements for showing the progress bar: When representing a progress element to the user, the UA should indicate whether it is a determinate or indeterminate progress bar, and in the former case, should indicate the relative position of the current value relative to the maximum value.

The max and value DOM attributes must reflect the elements' content attributes of the same name. When the relevant content attributes are absent, the DOM attributes must return zero. The value parsed from the textContent never affects the DOM values.

Would be cool to have the value DOM attribute update the textContent in-line...

If the progress bar is an indeterminate progress bar, then the position DOM attribute must return −1. Otherwise, it must return the result of dividing the current value by the maximum value.

4.5.12 meter 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
value
min
low
high
max
optimum
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLMeterElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute float value;
           attribute float min;
           attribute float max;
           attribute float low;
           attribute float high;
           attribute float optimum;
};

The meter element represents a scalar measurement within a known range, or a fractional value; for example disk usage, the relevance of a query result, or the fraction of a voting population to have selected a particular candidate.

This is also known as a gauge.

The meter element should not be used to indicate progress (as in a progress bar). For that role, HTML provides a separate progress element.

The meter element also does not represent a scalar value of arbitrary range — for example, it would be wrong to use this to report a weight, or height, unless there is a known maximum value.

There are six attributes that determine the semantics of the gauge represented by the element.

The min attribute specifies the lower bound of the range, and the max attribute specifies the upper bound. The value attribute specifies the value to have the gauge indicate as the "measured" value.

The other three attributes can be used to segment the gauge's range into "low", "medium", and "high" parts, and to indicate which part of the gauge is the "optimum" part. The low attribute specifies the range that is considered to be the "low" part, and the high attribute specifies the range that is considered to be the "high" part. The optimum attribute gives the position that is "optimum"; if that is higher than the "high" value then this indicates that the higher the value, the better; if it's lower than the "low" mark then it indicates that lower values are better, and naturally if it is in between then it indicates that neither high nor low values are good.

Authoring requirements: The recommended way of giving the value is to include it as contents of the element, either as two numbers (the higher number represents the maximum, the other number the current value, and the minimum is assumed to be zero), or as a percentage or similar (using one of the characters such as "%"), or as a fraction.

The value, min, low, high, max, and optimum attributes are all optional. When present, they must have values that are valid floating point numbers, and their values must satisfy the following inequalities:

All meter elements must have a value specified somehow, either using the value attribute or by including a number in the contents of the element.

If no minimum or maximum is specified, then the range is assumed to be 0..1, and the value thus has to be within that range.

The following examples all represent a measurement of three quarters (of the maximum of whatever is being measured):

<meter>75%</meter>
<meter>750‰</meter>
<meter>3/4</meter>
<meter>6 blocks used (out of 8 total)</meter>
<meter>max: 100; current: 75</meter>
<meter><object data="graph75.png">0.75</object></meter>
<meter min="0" max="100" value="75"></meter>

The following example is incorrect use of the element, because it doesn't give a range (and since the default maximum is 1, both of the gauges would end up looking maxed out):

<p>The grapefruit pie had a radius of <meter>12cm</meter>
and a height of <meter>2cm</meter>.</p> <!-- BAD! -->

Instead, one would either not include the meter element, or use the meter element with a defined range to give the dimensions in context compared to other pies:

<p>The grapefruit pie had a radius of 12cm and a height of
2cm.</p>
<dl>
 <dt>Radius: <dd> <meter min=0 max=20 value=12>12cm</meter>
 <dt>Height: <dd> <meter min=0 max=10 value=2>2cm</meter>
</dl>

There is no explicit way to specify units in the meter element, but the units may be specified in the title attribute in free-form text.

The example above could be extended to mention the units:

<dl>
 <dt>Radius: <dd> <meter min=0 max=20 value=12 title="centimeters">12cm</meter>
 <dt>Height: <dd> <meter min=0 max=10 value=2 title="centimeters">2cm</meter>
</dl>

利用者エージェント要件: 利用者エージェントは、属性 minmaxvaluelowhighoptimum浮動小数点値を構文解析する規則を使って構文解析しなければなりません

利用者エージェントは、 value 属性が省略されている場合、 要素の textContent をも文字列中の比率の1つか2つの数字を探す段階に従い処理しなければなりません。 この段階は何も返さないか、1つの数を返すか、1つの数と分母句読点文字を返すか、 2つの数を返します。

利用者エージェントは、その後、これらすべての数を、 計器の6点の値を得るために次のように使わなければなりません。 (これらが評価される順序は重要です。ある値が前の値を参照していたりします。)

最小値

If the min attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then the minimum value is that value. Otherwise, the minimum value is zero.

最大値

If the max attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, the maximum value is that value.

Otherwise, if the max attribute is specified but no value could be parsed out of it, or if it was not specified, but either or both of the min or value attributes were specified, then the maximum value is 1.

Otherwise, none of the max, min, and value attributes were specified. If the result of processing the textContent of the element was either nothing or just one number with no denominator punctuation character, then the maximum value is 1; if the result was one number but it had an associated denominator punctuation character, then the maximum value is the value associated with that denominator punctuation character; and finally, if there were two numbers parsed out of the textContent, then the maximum is the higher of those two numbers.

If the above machinations result in a maximum value less than the minimum value, then the maximum value is actually the same as the minimum value.

実際値

If the value attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then that value is the actual value.

If the value attribute is not specified but the max attribute is specified and the result of processing the textContent of the element was one number with no associated denominator punctuation character, then that number is the actual value.

If neither of the value and max attributes are specified, then, if the result of processing the textContent of the element was one number (with or without an associated denominator punctuation character), then that is the actual value, and if the result of processing the textContent of the element was two numbers, then the actual value is the lower of the two numbers found.

Otherwise, if none of the above apply, the actual value is zero.

If the above procedure results in an actual value less than the minimum value, then the actual value is actually the same as the minimum value.

If, on the other hand, the result is an actual value greater than the maximum value, then the actual value is the maximum value.

下界

If the low attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then the low boundary is that value. Otherwise, the low boundary is the same as the minimum value.

If the above results in a low boundary that is less than the minimum value, the low boundary is the minimum value.

上界

If the high attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then the high boundary is that value. Otherwise, the high boundary is the same as the maximum value.

If the above results in a high boundary that is higher than the maximum value, the high boundary is the maximum value.

最適点

If the optimum attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then the optimum point is that value. Otherwise, the optimum point is the midpoint between the minimum value and the maximum value.

If the optimum point is then less than the minimum value, then the optimum point is actually the same as the minimum value. Similarly, if the optimum point is greater than the maximum value, then it is actually the maximum value instead.

All of which should result in the following inequalities all being true:

UA requirements for regions of the gauge: If the optimum point is equal to the low boundary or the high boundary, or anywhere in between them, then the region between the low and high boundaries of the gauge must be treated as the optimum region, and the low and high parts, if any, must be treated as suboptimal. Otherwise, if the optimum point is less than the low boundary, then the region between the minimum value and the low boundary must be treated as the optimum region, the region between the low boundary and the high boundary must be treated as a suboptimal region, and the region between the high boundary and the maximum value must be treated as an even less good region. Finally, if the optimum point is higher than the high boundary, then the situation is reversed; the region between the high boundary and the maximum value must be treated as the optimum region, the region between the high boundary and the low boundary must be treated as a suboptimal region, and the remaining region between the low boundary and the minimum value must be treated as an even less good region.

UA requirements for showing the gauge: When representing a meter element to the user, the UA should indicate the relative position of the actual value to the minimum and maximum values, and the relationship between the actual value and the three regions of the gauge.

次に示すマーク付けは・・・

<h3>Suggested groups</h3>
<menu type="toolbar">
 <a href="?cmd=hsg" onclick="hideSuggestedGroups()">Hide suggested groups</a>
</menu>
<ul>
 <li>
  <p><a href="/group/comp.infosystems.www.authoring.stylesheets/view">comp.infosystems.www.authoring.stylesheets</a> -
     <a href="/group/comp.infosystems.www.authoring.stylesheets/subscribe">join</a></p>
  <p>Group description: <strong>Layout/presentation on the WWW.</strong></p>
  <p><meter value="0.5">Moderate activity,</meter> Usenet, 618 subscribers</p>
 </li>
 <li>
  <p><a href="/group/netscape.public.mozilla.xpinstall/view">netscape.public.mozilla.xpinstall</a> -
     <a href="/group/netscape.public.mozilla.xpinstall/subscribe">join</a></p>
  <p>Group description: <strong>Mozilla XPInstall discussion.</strong></p>
  <p><meter value="0.25">Low activity,</meter> Usenet, 22 subscribers</p>
 </li>
 <li>
  <p><a href="/group/mozilla.dev.general/view">mozilla.dev.general</a> -
     <a href="/group/mozilla.dev.general/subscribe">join</a></p>
  <p><meter value="0.25">Low activity,</meter> Usenet, 66 subscribers</p>
 </li>
</ul>

次のようにレンダリングされましょう。

<meter> 要素が可変長の行内緑棒としてレンダリングされています。

User agents may combine the value of the title attribute and the other attributes to provide context-sensitive help or inline text detailing the actual values.

For example, the following snippet:

<meter min=0 max=60 value=23.2 title=seconds></meter>

...might cause the user agent to display a gauge with a tooltip saying "Value: 23.2 out of 60." on one line and "seconds" on a second line.

The min, max, value, low, high, and optimum DOM attributes must reflect the elements' content attributes of the same name. When the relevant content attributes are absent, the DOM attributes must return zero. The value parsed from the textContent never affects the DOM values.

Would be cool to have the value DOM attribute update the textContent in-line...

4.5.13 code 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The code element represents a fragment of computer code. This could be an XML element name, a filename, a computer program, or any other string that a computer would recognize.

Although there is no formal way to indicate the language of computer code being marked up, authors who wish to mark code elements with the language used, e.g. so that syntax highlighting scripts can use the right rules, may do so by adding a class prefixed with "language-" to the element.

The following example shows how the element can be used in a paragraph to mark up element names and computer code, including punctuation.

<p>The <code>code</code> element represents a fragment of computer
code.</p>

<p>When you call the <code>activate()</code> method on the
<code>robotSnowman</code> object, the eyes glow.</p>

<p>The example below uses the <code>begin</code> keyword to indicate
the start of a statement block. It is paired with an <code>end</code>
keyword, which is followed by the <code>.</code> punctuation character
(full stop) to indicate the end of the program.</p>

The following example shows how a block of code could be marked up using the pre and code elements.

<pre><code class="language-pascal">var i: Integer;
begin
   i := 1;
end.</code></pre>

A class is used in that example to indicate the language used.

See the pre element for more details.

4.5.14 var 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The var element represents a variable. This could be an actual variable in a mathematical expression or programming context, or it could just be a term used as a placeholder in prose.

In the paragraph below, the letter "n" is being used as a variable in prose:

<p>If there are <var>n</var> pipes leading to the ice
cream factory then I expect at <em>least</em> <var>n</var>
flavours of ice cream to be available for purchase!</p>

4.5.15 samp 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The samp element represents (sample) output from a program or computing system.

See the pre and kbd elements for more details.

This example shows the samp element being used inline:

<p>The computer said <samp>Too much cheese in tray
two</samp> but I didn't know what that meant.</p>

This second example shows a block of sample output. Nested samp and kbd elements allow for the styling of specific elements of the sample output using a style sheet.

<pre><samp><samp class="prompt">jdoe@mowmow:~$</samp> <kbd>ssh demo.example.com</kbd>
Last login: Tue Apr 12 09:10:17 2005 from mowmow.example.com on pts/1
Linux demo 2.6.10-grsec+gg3+e+fhs6b+nfs+gr0501+++p3+c4a+gr2b-reslog-v6.189 #1 SMP Tue Feb 1 11:22:36 PST 2005 i686 unknown

<samp class="prompt">jdoe@demo:~$</samp> <samp class="cursor">_</samp></samp></pre>

4.5.16 kbd 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The kbd element represents user input (typically keyboard input, although it may also be used to represent other input, such as voice commands).

When the kbd element is nested inside a samp element, it represents the input as it was echoed by the system.

When the kbd element contains a samp element, it represents input based on system output, for example invoking a menu item.

When the kbd element is nested inside another kbd element, it represents an actual key or other single unit of input as appropriate for the input mechanism.

Here the kbd element is used to indicate keys to press:

<p>To make George eat an apple, press <kbd><kbd>Shift</kbd>+<kbd>F3</kbd></kbd></p>

In this second example, the user is told to pick a particular menu item. The outer kbd element marks up a block of input, with the inner kbd elements representing each individual step of the input, and the samp elements inside them indicating that the steps are input based on something being displayed by the system, in this case menu labels:

<p>To make George eat an apple, select
    <kbd><kbd><samp>File</samp></kbd>|<kbd><samp>Eat Apple...</samp></kbd></kbd>
</p>

4.5.17 The sub and sup elements

分類
語句付け内容
これらの要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The sup element represents a superscript and the sub element represents a subscript.

These elements must be used only to mark up typographical conventions with specific meanings, not for typographical presentation for presentation's sake. For example, it would be inappropriate for the sub and sup elements to be used in the name of the LaTeX document preparation system. In general, authors should use these elements only if the absence of those elements would change the meaning of the content.

When the sub element is used inside a var element, it represents the subscript that identifies the variable in a family of variables.

<p>The coordinate of the <var>i</var>th point is
(<var>x<sub><var>i</var></sub></var>, <var>y<sub><var>i</var></sub></var>).
For example, the 10th point has coordinate
(<var>x<sub>10</sub></var>, <var>y<sub>10</sub></var>).</p>

In certain languages, superscripts are part of the typographical conventions for some abbreviations.

<p>The most beautiful women are
<span lang="fr"><abbr>M<sup>lle</sup></abbr> Gwendoline</span> and 
<span lang="fr"><abbr>M<sup>me</sup></abbr> Denise</span>.</p>

Mathematical expressions often use subscripts and superscripts. Authors are encouraged to use MathML for marking up mathematics, but authors may opt to use sub and sup if detailed mathematical markup is not desired. [MathML]

<var>E</var>=<var>m</var><var>c</var><sup>2</sup>
f(<var>x</var>, <var>n</var>) = log<sub>4</sub><var>x</var><sup><var>n</var></sup>

4.5.18 span 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Phrasing content.
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The span element doesn't mean anything on its own, but can be useful when used together with other attributes, e.g. class, lang, or dir.

4.5.19 i 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The i element represents a span of text in an alternate voice or mood, or otherwise offset from the normal prose, such as a taxonomic designation, a technical term, an idiomatic phrase from another language, a thought, a ship name, or some other prose whose typical typographic presentation is italicized.

Terms in languages different from the main text should be annotated with lang attributes (xml:lang in XML).

The examples below show uses of the i element:

<p>The <i class="taxonomy">Felis silvestris catus</i> is cute.</p>
<p>The term <i>prose content</i> is defined above.</p>
<p>There is a certain <i lang="fr">je ne sais quoi</i> in the air.</p>

In the following example, a dream sequence is marked up using i elements.

<p>Raymond tried to sleep.</p>
<p><i>The ship sailed away on Thursday</i>, he
dreamt. <i>The ship had many people aboard, including a beautiful
princess called Carey. He watched her, day-in, day-out, hoping she
would notice him, but she never did.</i></p>
<p><i>Finally one night he picked up the courage to speak with
her—</i></p>
<p>Raymond woke with a start as the fire alarm rang out.</p>

The i element should be used as a last resort when no other element is more appropriate. In particular, citations should use the cite element, defining instances of terms should use the dfn element, stress emphasis should use the em element, importance should be denoted with the strong element, quotes should be marked up with the q element, and small print should use the small element.

Authors are encouraged to use the class attribute on the i element to identify why the element is being used, so that if the style of a particular use (e.g. dream sequences as opposed to taxonomic terms) is to be changed at a later date, the author doesn't have to go through the entire document (or series of related documents) annotating each use.

Style sheets can be used to format i elements, just like any other element can be restyled. Thus, it is not the case that content in i elements will necessarily be italicized.

4.5.20 b 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The b element represents a span of text to be stylistically offset from the normal prose without conveying any extra importance, such as key words in a document abstract, product names in a review, or other spans of text whose typical typographic presentation is boldened.

The following example shows a use of the b element to highlight key words without marking them up as important:

<p>The <b>frobonitor</b> and <b>barbinator</b> components are fried.</p>

In the following example, objects in a text adventure are highlighted as being special by use of the b element.

<p>You enter a small room. Your <b>sword</b> glows
brighter. A <b>rat</b> scurries past the corner wall.</p>

Another case where the b element is appropriate is in marking up the lede (or lead) sentence or paragraph. The following example shows how a BBC article about kittens adopting a rabbit as their own could be marked up using HTML5 elements:

<article>
 <h2>Kittens 'adopted' by pet rabbit</h2>
 <p><b>Six abandoned kittens have found an unexpected new
 mother figure — a pet rabbit.</b></p>
 <p>Veterinary nurse Melanie Humble took the three-week-old
 kittens to her Aberdeen home.</p>
[...]

The b element should be used as a last resort when no other element is more appropriate. In particular, headers should use the h1 to h6 elements, stress emphasis should use the em element, importance should be denoted with the strong element, and text marked or highlighted should use the mark element.

The following would be incorrect usage:

<p><b>WARNING!</b> Do not frob the barbinator!</p>

In the previous example, the correct element to use would have been strong, not b.

Style sheets can be used to format b elements, just like any other element can be restyled. Thus, it is not the case that content in b elements will necessarily be boldened.

4.5.21 bdo 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
None, but the dir global attribute has special requirements on this element.
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The bdo element allows authors to override the Unicode bidi algorithm by explicitly specifying a direction override. [BIDI]

Authors must specify the dir attribute on this element, with the value ltr to specify a left-to-right override and with the value rtl to specify a right-to-left override.

If the element has the dir attribute set to the exact value ltr, then for the purposes of the bidi algorithm, the user agent must act as if there was a U+202D LEFT-TO-RIGHT OVERRIDE character at the start of the element, and a U+202C POP DIRECTIONAL FORMATTING at the end of the element.

If the element has the dir attribute set to the exact value rtl, then for the purposes of the bidi algorithm, the user agent must act as if there was a U+202E RIGHT-TO-LEFT OVERRIDE character at the start of the element, and a U+202C POP DIRECTIONAL FORMATTING at the end of the element.

The requirements on handling the bdo element for the bidi algorithm may be implemented indirectly through the style layer. For example, an HTML+CSS user agent should implement these requirements by implementing the CSS unicode-bidi property. [CSS21]

4.5.22 ruby 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
次の群を1つ以上: 語句付け内容の後に、 rt 要素が1つか、または rp 要素と rt 要素と別の rp 要素、のいずれかが続く。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

ruby 要素は、 1つ以上の語句付け内容の範囲にルビ注釈を付すことができます。

ruby 要素は、すべての子供 rt 要素・rp 要素とその子孫を無視したときの、 当該要素に含まれる語句付け内容の範囲(群)を表します。 語句付け内容の範囲(群)は、 rt 要素を使って作成される、関連付けられた注釈を持ちます。

次の例では、斎藤信男という語中のそれぞれの漢字に読みを注釈付けしています。

... <ruby>
 斎 <rt> さい </rt>
 藤 <rt> とう </rt>
 信 <rt> のぶ </rt>
 男 <rt> お         </rt>
</ruby> ...

これは、次のようにレンダリングされましょう。

4つの主たる漢字があり、それぞれの読みの注釈が小さなフォントで漢字の上にレンダリングされています。

4.5.23 rt 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
ruby 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

rt 要素は、ルビ注釈のルビ文部分を示します。

ruby 要素の子供である rt 要素は、 当該 ruby 要素中で (rp 要素を無視した時) 直前にある零個以上の語句付け内容の節点に対する注釈 (子供により与えられます。) を表します。

ruby 要素の子供ではない rt 要素は、 その子供と同じものを表します。

4.5.24 rp 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
ruby 要素の子供として、 rt 要素の直前または直後に。
内容モデル:
rp 要素が別の rp 要素の直後にある rt 要素の直後の場合: Unicode 文字クラス Pe から1文字。
それ以外の場合: Unicode 文字クラス Ps から1文字。
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

rp 要素は、 ルビ注釈に対応していない利用者エージェントが示す、 ルビ注釈のルビ文部分の周囲の括弧を提供するために使うことができます。

ruby 要素の子供である rp 要素は、何も表さず、 その要素と内容は無視されなければなりません。親要素が ruby 要素でない rp 要素は、その子供と同じものを表します。

前掲の斎藤信男という語中で漢字に読みが注釈付けされている例では、 遺物利用者エージェントが読みを括弧中に示すようにするため、 rp も更に使うことができます。

... <ruby>
 斎 <rp>(</rp><rt>さい</rt><rp>)</rp>
 藤 <rp>(</rp><rt>とう</rt><rp>)</rp>
 信 <rp>(</rp><rt>のぶ</rt><rp>)</rp>
 男 <rp>(</rp><rt>お</rt><rp>)</rp>
</ruby> ...

適合容赦エージェントでのレンダリングは先のようになりますが、 ルビに対応していない利用者エージェントでは、 レンダリングは次のようになります。

... 斎 (さい) 藤 (とう) 信 (のぶ) 男 (お) ...

4.5.25 利用法のまとめ

We need to summarize the various elements, in particular to distinguish b/i/em/strong/var/q/mark/cite.

4.5.26 脚注

HTML は脚注をマーク付けするための専用の仕組みを持っていません。 ここでは、推奨される代替法を紹介します。

短い行内注釈については、 title 属性を使うべきです

次の例では、対話の2つの部分が注釈付けされています。

<dialog>
 <dt>Customer
 <dd>Hello! I wish to register a complaint. Hello. Miss?
 <dt>Shopkeeper
 <dd><span title="Colloquial pronunciation of 'What do you'"
 >Watcha</span> mean, miss?
 <dt>Customer
 <dd>Uh, I'm sorry, I have a cold. I wish to make a complaint.
 <dt>Shopkeeper
 <dd>Sorry, <span title="This is, of course, a lie.">we're
 closing for lunch</span>.
</dialog>

より長い注釈については、 a を使って、文書の後の要素を指すようにするべきです。 慣習的にはリンクの内容は数字を四角括弧で括ったものです。

次の例では、対話中の脚注が対話の後の段落へのリンクとなっています。 その段落の方は逆に対話へ逆リンクしており、 利用者が脚注の場所へ返れるようになっています。

<dialog>
 <dt>Announcer
 <dd>Number 16: The <i>hand</i>.
 <dt>Interviewer
 <dd>Good evening. I have with me in the studio tonight Mr
 Norman St John Polevaulter, who for the past few years has
 been contradicting people. Mr Polevaulter, why <em>do</em>
 you contradict people?
 <dt>Norman
 <dd>I don't. <a href="#fn1" id="r1">[1]</a>
 <dt>Interviewer
 <dd>You told me you did!
</dialog>
<section>
 <p id="fn1"><a href="#r1">[1]</a> This is, naturally, a lie,
 but paradoxically if it were true he could not say so without
 contradicting the interviewer and thus making it false.</p>
</section>

傍注 (文章中の特定の語や文に対してだけではなく、節全体に適用される、 より長い注釈) には、 aside 要素を使うべきです

次の例では、対話の後に傍注があり、対話の背景を説明しています。

<dialog>
 <dt>Customer
 <dd>I will not buy this record, it is scratched.
 <dt>Shopkeeper
 <dd>I'm sorry?
 <dt>Customer
 <dd>I will not buy this record, it is scratched.
 <dt>Shopkeeper
 <dd>No no no, this's'a tobacconist's.
</dialog>
<aside>
 <p>In 1970, the British Empire lay in ruins, and foreign
 nationalists frequented the streets — many of them Hungarians
 (not the streets — the foreign nationals). Sadly, Alexander
 Yalt has been publishing incompetently-written phrase books.
</aside>

4.6 編集

ins 要素と del 要素は文書に対する編集を表します。

4.6.1 ins 要素

分類
要素が語句付け内容を含む時: 語句付け内容
その他の場合: 流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
透過
要素固有属性:
cite
datetime
DOM 界面:
HTMLModElement 界面を使用します。

ins 要素は文書に対する追加を表します。

次の例は、段落1つの追加を表します。

<aside>
 <ins>
  <p> 果物が好きです。 </p>
 </ins>
</aside>

次の場合もそうで、 aside 要素の中のものはすべて語句付け内容とみなされ、段落が1つだけ追加されています。

<aside>
 <ins>
  林檎は<em>おいしい</em>。
 </ins>
 <ins>
  梨も。
 </ins>
</aside>

ins 要素は暗示段落の境界を越えるべきではありません

次の例は2つの段落の追加を表しています。 2つ目の段落は2つの部分で挿入されています。 この例の1つ目の ins 要素は段落の境界を越えているので、 悪い形と考えられます。

<aside>
 <ins datetime="2005-03-16T00:00Z">
  <p> 果物が好きです。 </p>
  林檎は<em>おいしい</em>。
 </ins>
 <ins datetime="2007-12-19T00:00Z">
  梨も。
 </ins>
</aside>

こちらは同じことをマーク付けするよりよい方法です。 こちらはより多くの要素を使っていますが、 どの要素も暗示段落境界は超えていません。

<aside>
 <ins datetime="2005-03-16T00:00Z">
  <p> 果物が好きです。 </p>
 </ins>
 <ins datetime="2005-03-16T00:00Z">
  林檎は<em>おいしい</em>。
 </ins>
 <ins datetime="2007-12-19T00:00Z">
  梨も。
 </ins>
</aside>

4.6.2 del 要素

分類
要素が語句付け内容を含む時: 語句付け内容
その他の場合: 流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
透過
要素固有属性:
cite
datetime
DOM 界面:
HTMLModElement 界面を使用します。

The del element represents a removal from the document.

del elements should not cross implied paragraph boundaries.

4.6.3 Attributes common to ins and del elements

The cite attribute may be used to specify the address of a document that explains the change. When that document is long, for instance the minutes of a meeting, authors are encouraged to include a fragment identifier pointing to the specific part of that document that discusses the change.

If the cite attribute is present, it must be a valid URL that explains the change. User agents should allow users to follow such citation links.

The datetime attribute may be used to specify the time and date of the change.

If present, the datetime attribute must be a valid datetime value.

User agents must parse the datetime attribute according to the parse a string as a datetime value algorithm. If that doesn't return a time, then the modification has no associated timestamp (the value is non-conforming; it is not a valid datetime). Otherwise, the modification is marked as having been made at the given datetime. User agents should use the associated timezone information to determine which timezone to present the given datetime in.

The ins and del elements must implement the HTMLModElement interface:

interface HTMLModElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString cite;
           attribute DOMString dateTime;
};

cite DOM attribute must reflect the element's cite content attribute. The dateTime DOM 属性は element's datetime 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

4.6.4 Edits and paragraphs

Since the ins and del elements do not affect paragraphing, it is possible, in some cases where paragraphs are implied (without explicit p elements), for an ins or del element to span both an entire paragraph or other non-phrasing content elements and part of another paragraph.

For example:

<section>
 <ins>
  <p>
   This is a paragraph that was inserted.
  </p>
  This is another paragraph whose first sentence was inserted
  at the same time as the paragraph above.
 </ins>
 This is a second sentence, which was there all along.
</section>

By only wrapping some paragraphs in p elements, one can even get the end of one paragraph, a whole second paragraph, and the start of a third paragraph to be covered by the same ins or del element (though this is very confusing, and not considered good practice):

<section>
 This is the first paragraph. <ins>This sentence was
 inserted.
 <p>This second paragraph was inserted.</p>
 This sentence was inserted too.</ins> This is the
 third paragraph in this example.
</section>

However, due to the way implied paragraphs are defined, it is not possible to mark up the end of one paragraph and the start of the very next one using the same ins or del element. You instead have to use one (or two) p element(s) and two ins or del elements:

For example:

<section>
 <p>This is the first paragraph. <del>This sentence was
 deleted.</del></p>
 <p><del>This sentence was deleted too.</del> That
 sentence needed a separate &lt;del&gt; element.</p>
</section>

Partly because of the confusion described above, authors are strongly recommended to always mark up all paragraphs with the p element, and to not have any ins or del elements that cross across any implied paragraphs.

4.6.5 Edits and lists

The content models of the ol and ul elements do not allow ins and del elements as children. Lists always represent all their items, including items that would otherwise have been marked as deleted.

To indicate that an item is inserted or deleted, an ins or del element can be wrapped around the contents of the li element. To indicate that an item has been replaced by another, a single li element can have one or more del elements followed by one or more ins elements.

In the following example, a list that started empty had items added and removed from it over time. The bits in the example that have been emphasised show the parts that are the "current" state of the list. The list item numbers don't take into account the edits, though.

<h1>Stop-ship bugs</h1>
<ol>
 <li><ins datetime="2008-02-12 15:20 Z">Bug 225: Rain detector
 doesn't work in snow</ins></li>
 <li><del datetime="2008-03-01 20:22 Z"><ins datetime="2008-02-14 
 12:02 Z">Bug 228: Water buffer overflows in April</ins></del></li>
 <li><ins datetime="2008-02-16 13:50 Z">Bug 230: Water heater
 doesn't use renewable fuels</ins></li>
 <li><del datetime="2008-02-20 21:15 Z"><ins datetime="2008-02-16
 14:25 Z">Bug 232: Carbon dioxide emissions detected after
 startup</ins></del></li>
</ol>

In the following example, a list that started with just fruit was replaced by a list with just colors.

<h1>List of <del>fruits</del><ins>colors</ins></h1>
<ul>
 <li><del>Lime</del><ins>Green</ins></li>
 <li><del>Apple</del></li>
 <li>Orange</li>
 <li><del>Pear</del></li>
 <li><ins>Teal</ins></li>
 <li><del>Lemon</del><ins>Yellow</ins></li>
 <li>Olive</li>
 <li><ins>Purple</ins>
</ul>

4.7 Embedded content

4.7.1 figure 要素

分類
流れ内容
Sectioning root.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Either: one legend element followed by flow content.
Or: Flow content followed by one legend element.
Or: Flow content.
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The figure element represents some flow content, optionally with a caption, which can be moved away from the main flow of the document without affecting the document's meaning.

The element can thus be used to annotate illustrations, diagrams, photos, code listings, etc, that are referred to from the main content of the document, but that could, without affecting the flow of the document, be moved away from that primary content, e.g. to the side of the page, to dedicated pages, or to an appendix.

The first legend element child of the element, if any, represents the caption of the figure element's contents. If there is no child legend element, then there is no caption.

The remainder of the element's contents, if any, represents the content.

This example shows the figure element to mark up a code listing.

<p>In <a href="#l4">listing 4</a> we see the primary core interface
API declaration.</p>
<figure id="l4">
 <legend>Listing 4. The primary core interface API declaration.</legend>
 <pre><code>interface PrimaryCore {
  boolean verifyDataLine();
  void sendData(in sequence&lt;byte> data);
  void initSelfDestruct();
}</code></pre>
</figure>
<p>The API is designed to use UTF-8.</p>

Here we see a figure element to mark up a photo.

<figure>
 <img src="bubbles-work.jpeg"
      alt="Bubbles, sitting in his office chair, works on his
           latest project intently.">
 <legend>Bubbles at work</legend>
</figure>

In this example, we see an image that is not a figure, as well as an image and a video that are.

<h2>Malinko's comics</h2>

<p>This case centered on some sort of "intellectual property"
infringement related to a comic (see Exhibit A). The suit started
after a trailer ending with these words:</p>

<img src="promblem-packed-action.png" alt="ROUGH COPY! Promblem-Packed Action!">

<p>...was aired. A lawyer, armed with a Bigger Notebook, launched a
preemptive strike using snowballs. A complete copy of the trailer is
included with Exhibit B.</p>

<figure>
 <img src="ex-a.png" alt="Two squiggles on a dirty piece of paper.">
 <legend>Exhibit A. The alleged <cite>rough copy</cite> comic.</legend>
</figure>

<figure>
 <video src="ex-b.mov"></video>
 <legend>Exhibit A. The alleged <cite>rough copy</cite> comic.</legend>
</figure>

<p>The case was resolved out of court.</p>

Here, a part of a poem is marked up using figure.

<figure>
 <p>'Twas brillig, and the slithy toves<br>
Did gyre and gimble in the wabe;<br>
All mimsy were the borogoves,<br>
And the mome raths outgrabe.</p>
 <legend><cite>Jabberwocky</cite> (first verse). Lewis Carroll, 1832-98</legend>
</figure>

In this example, which could be part of a much larger work discussing a castle, the figure has three images in it.

<figure>
 <img src="castle1423.jpeg" title="Etching. Anonymous, ca. 1423."
      alt="The castle has one tower, and a tall wall around it.">
 <img src="castle1858.jpeg" title="Oil-based paint on canvas. Maria Towle, 1858."
      alt="The castle now has two towers and two walls.">
 <img src="castle1999.jpeg" title="Film photograph. Peter Jankle, 1999."
      alt="The castle lies in ruins, the original tower all that remains in one piece.">
 <legend>The castle through the ages: 1423, 1858, and 1999 respectively.</legend>
</figure>

4.7.2 img 要素

分類
Embedded content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where embedded content is expected.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
alt
src
usemap
ismap
width
height
DOM 界面:
[NamedConstructor=Image(),
 NamedConstructor=Image(in unsigned long width),
 NamedConstructor=Image(in unsigned long width, in unsigned long height)]
interface HTMLImageElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString alt;
           attribute DOMString src;
           attribute DOMString useMap;
           attribute boolean isMap;
           attribute unsigned long width;
           attribute unsigned long height;
  readonly attribute boolean complete;
};

An img element represents an image.

The image given by the src attribute is the embedded content, and the value of the alt attribute is the img element's fallback content.

The src attribute must be present, and must contain a valid URL referencing a non-interactive, optionally animated, image resource that is neither paged nor scripted.

Images can thus be static bitmaps (e.g. PNGs, GIFs, JPEGs), single-page vector documents (single-page PDFs, XML files with an SVG root element), animated bitmaps (APNGs, animated GIFs), animated vector graphics (XML files with an SVG root element that use declarative SMIL animation), and so forth. However, this also precludes SVG files with script, multipage PDF files, interactive MNG files, HTML documents, plain text documents, and so forth.

The requirements on the alt attribute's value are described in the next section.

There has been some suggestion that the longdesc attribute from HTML4, or some other mechanism that is more powerful than alt="", should be included. This has not yet been considered.

The img must not be used as a layout tool. In particular, img elements should not be used to display fully transparent images, as they rarely convey meaning and rarely add anything useful to the document.


When an img is created with a src attribute, and whenever the src attribute is set subsequently, the user agent must fetch the resource specifed by the src attribute's value, unless the user agent cannot support images, or its support for images has been disabled, or the user agent only fetches elements on demand.

Fetching the image must delay the load event.

This, unfortunately, can be used to perform a rudimentary port scan of the user's local network (especially in conjunction with scripting, though scripting isn't actually necessary to carry out such an attack). User agents may implement cross-origin access control policies that mitigate this attack.

If the image's type is a supported image type, and the image is a valid image of that type, then the image is said to be available (this affects exactly what the element represents, as defined below). This can be true even before the image is completely downloaded, if the user agent supports incremental rendering of images; in such cases, each task that is queued by the networking task source while the image is being fetched must update the presentation of the image appropriately.

Whether the image is fetched successfully or not (e.g. whether the response code was a 2xx code or equivalent) must be ignored when determining the image's type and whether it is a valid image.

This allows servers to return images with error responses, and have them displayed.

The user agents should apply the image sniffing rules to determine the type of the image, with the image's associated Content-Type headers giving the official type. If these rules are not applied, then the type of the image must be the type given by the image's associated Content-Type headers.

User agents must not support non-image resources with the img element (e.g. XML files whose root element is an HTML element). User agents must not run executable code (e.g. scripts) embedded in the image resource. User agents must only display the first page of a multipage resource (e.g. a PDF file). User agents must not allow the resource to act in an interactive fashion, but should honour any animation in the resource.

This specification does not specify which image types are to be supported.

The task that is queued by the networking task source once the resource has been fetched, must, if the download was successful and the image is available, queue a task to fire a load event on the img element (this happens after complete starts returning true); and otherwise, if the fetching process fails without a response from the remote server, or completes but the image is not a valid or supported image, queue a task to fire an error event on the img element.


What an img element represents depends on the src attribute and the alt attribute.

If the src attribute is set and the alt attribute is set to the empty string

The image is either decorative or supplemental to the rest of the content, redundant with some other information in the document.

If the image is available and the user agent is configured to display that image, then the element represents the image specified by the src attribute.

Otherwise, the element represents nothing, and may be omitted completely from the rendering. User agents may provide the user with a notification that an image is present but has been omitted from the rendering.

If the src attribute is set and the alt attribute is set to a string whose first character is a U+007B LEFT CURLY BRACKET character ({) and whose last character is a U+007D RIGHT CURLY BRACKET character (})

The image is a key part of the content, and there is no textual equivalent of the image available. The string consisting of all the characters between the first and the last character of the value of the alt attribute gives the kind of image (e.g. photo, diagram, user-uploaded image). If that value is the empty string (i.e. the attribute is just "{}"), then even the kind of image being shown is not known.

If the image is available, the element represents the image specified by the src attribute.

If the image is not available or if the user agent is not configured to display the image, then the user agent should display some sort of indicator that the image is not being rendered, and, if possible, provide to the user the information regarding the kind of image that is (as derived from the alt attribute).

If the src attribute is set and the alt attribute is set to a value that isn't matched by the previous two entries (not empty, not "{...}")

The image is a key part of the content; the alt attribute gives a textual equivalent or replacement for the image.

If the image is available and the user agent is configured to display that image, then the element represents the image specified by the src attribute.

Otherwise, the element represents the text given by the alt attribute. User agents may provide the user with a notification that an image is present but has been omitted from the rendering.

If the src attribute is set and the alt attribute is not

The image's role in the document is unknown.

If the image is available, the element represents the image specified by the src attribute.

If the image is not available or if the user agent is not configured to display the image, then the user agent may display some sort of indicator that the image is not being rendered.

If the src attribute is not set and the alt attribute is set to a string whose first character is a U+007B LEFT CURLY BRACKET character ({) and whose last character is a U+007D RIGHT CURLY BRACKET character (})

The user agent should display some sort of indicator that an image is missing, providing to the user the information regarding the kind of image that it would be (as derived from the alt attribute).

If the src attribute is not set and either the alt attribute is set to the empty string or the alt attribute is not set at all

The element represents nothing.

その他の場合

The element represents the text given by the alt attribute.

The alt attribute does not represent advisory information. User agents must not present the contents of the alt attribute in the same way as content of the title attribute.

User agents may always provide the user with the option to display any image, or to prevent any image from being displayed. User agents may also apply image analysis heuristics to help the user make sense of the image when the user is unable to make direct use of the image, e.g. due to a visual disability or because they are using a text terminal with no graphics capabilities.

The contents of img elements, if any, are ignored for the purposes of rendering.


The usemap attribute, if present, can indicate that the image has an associated image map.

The ismap attribute, when used on an element that is a descendant of an a element with an href attribute, indicates by its presence that the element provides access to a server-side image map. This affects how events are handled on the corresponding a element.

The ismap attribute is a boolean attribute. The attribute must not be specified on an element that does not have an ancestor a element with an href attribute.

The img element supports dimension attributes.

The DOM attributes alt, src, useMap, and isMap each must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

The DOM attributes width and height must return the rendered width and height of the image, in CSS pixels, if the image is being rendered, and is being rendered to a visual medium; or else the intrinsic with and height of the image, in CSS pixels, if the image is available but not being rendered to a visual medium; or else 0, if the image is not available or its dimensions are not known. [CSS21]

The DOM attribute complete must return true if the user agent has fetched the image specified in the src attribute, and it is a valid image, even if the final task queued by the networking task source for the fetching of the image resource has not yet been processed. Otherwise, the attribute must return false.

The value of complete can thus change while a script is executing.

Three constructors are provided for creating HTMLImageElement objects (in addition to the factory methods from DOM Core such as createElement()): Image(), Image(width), and Image(width, height). When invoked as constructors, these must return a new HTMLImageElement object (a new img element). If the width argument is present, the new object's width content attribute must be set to width. If the height argument is also present, the new object's height content attribute must be set to height.

A single image can have different appropriate alternative text depending on the context.

In each of the following cases, the same image is used, yet the alt text is different each time. The image is the coat of arms of the Canton Geneva in Switzerland.

Here it is used as a supplementary icon:

<p>I lived in <img src="carouge.svg" alt=""> Carouge.</p>

Here it is used as an icon representing the town:

<p>Home town: <img src="carouge.svg" alt="Carouge"></p>

Here it is used as part of a text on the town:

<p>Carouge has a coat of arms.</p>
<p><img src="carouge.svg" alt="The coat of arms depicts a lion, sitting in front of a tree."></p>
<p>It is used as decoration all over the town.</p>

Here it is used as a way to support a similar text where the description is given as well as, instead of as an alternative to, the image:

<p>Carouge has a coat of arms.</p>
<p><img src="carouge.svg" alt=""></p>
<p>The coat of arms depicts a lion, sitting in front of a tree.
It is used as decoration all over the town.</p>

Here it is used as part of a story:

<p>He picked up the folder and a piece of paper fell out.</p>
<p><img src="carouge.svg" alt="Shaped like a shield, the paper had a
red background, a green tree, and a yellow lion with its tongue
hanging out and whose tail was shaped like an S."></p>
<p>He stared at the folder. S! The answer he had been looking for all
this time was simply the letter S! How had he not seen that before? It all
came together now. The phone call where Hector had referred to a lion's tail,
the time Marco had stuck his tongue out...</p>

Here it is not known at the time of publication what the image will be, only that it will be a coat of arms of some kind, and thus no replacement text can be provided, and instead only the kind of image is provided:

<p>The last user to have uploaded a coat of arms uploaded this one:</p>
<p><img src="last-uploaded-coat-of-arms.cgi" alt="{user-uploaded coat of arms}"></p>

Ideally, the author would find a way to provide real replacement text even in this case, e.g. by asking the previous user. Not providing replacement text makes the document more difficult to use for people who are unable to view images, e.g. blind users, or users or very low-bandwidth connections or who pay by the byte, or users who are forced to use a text-only Web browser.

Here are some more examples showing the same picture used in different contexts, with different appropriate alternate texts each time.

<article>
 <h1>My cats</h1>
 <h2>Fluffy</h2>
 <p>Fluffy is my favourite.</p>
 <img src="fluffy.jpg" alt="She likes playing with a ball of yarn.">
 <p>She's just too cute.</p>
 <h2>Miles</h2>
 <p>My other cat, Miles just eats and sleeps.</p>
</article>
<article>
 <h1>Photography</h1>
 <h2>Shooting moving targets indoors</h2>
 <p>The trick here is to know how to anticipate; to know at what speed and
 what distance the subject will pass by.</p>
 <img src="fluffy.jpg" alt="A cat flying by, chasing a ball of yarn, can be
 photographed quite nicely using this technique.">
 <h2>Nature by night</h2>
 <p>To achieve this, you'll need either an extremely sensitive film, or
 immense flash lights.</p>
</article>
<article>
 <h1>About me</h1>
 <h2>My pets</h2>
 <p>I've got a cat named Fluffy and a dog named Miles.</p>
 <img src="fluffy.jpg" alt="Fluffy, my cat, tends to keep itself busy.">
 <p>My dog Miles and I like go on long walks together.</p>
 <h2>music</h2>
 <p>After our walks, having emptied my mind, I like listening to Bach.</p>
</article>
<article>
 <h1>Fluffy and the Yarn</h1>
 <p>Fluffy was a cat who liked to play with yarn. He also liked to jump.</p>
 <aside><img src="fluffy.jpg" alt="" title="Fluffy"></aside>
 <p>He would play in the morning, he would play in the evening.</p>
</article>
4.7.2.1. Requirements for providing text to act as an alternative for images

The requirements for the alt attribute depend on what the image is intended to represent, as described in the following sections.

A general requirement that applies in all cases is that the alt attribute's value must not start with a U+007B LEFT CURLY BRACKET character ({) and end with a U+007D RIGHT CURLY BRACKET character (}), unless the attribute is giving the kind of image rather than replacement text.

When an a element that is a hyperlink, or a button element, has no textual content but contains one or more images, the alt attributes must contain text that together convey the purpose of the link or button.

In this example, a user is asked to pick his preferred color from a list of three. Each color is given by an image, but for users who have configured their user agent not to display images, the color names are used instead:

<h1>Pick your color</h1>
<ul>
 <li><a href="green.html"><img src="green.jpeg" alt="Green"></a></li>
 <li><a href="blue.html"><img src="blue.jpeg" alt="Blue"></a></li>
 <li><a href="red.html"><img src="red.jpeg" alt="Red"></a></li>
</ul>

In this example, each button has a set of images to indicate the kind of color output desired by the user. The first image is used in each case to give the alternative text.

<button name="rgb"><img src="red" alt="RGB"><img src="green" alt=""><img src="blue" alt=""></button>
<button name="cmyk"><img src="cyan" alt="CMYK"><img src="magenta" alt=""><img src="yellow" alt=""><img src="black" alt=""></button>

Since each image represents one part of the text, it could also be written like this:

<button name="rgb"><img src="red" alt="R"><img src="green" alt="G"><img src="blue" alt="B"></button>
<button name="cmyk"><img src="cyan" alt="C"><img src="magenta" alt="M"><img src="yellow" alt="Y"><img src="black" alt="K"></button>

However, with other alternative text, this might not work, and putting all the alternative text into one image in each case might make more sense:

<button name="rgb"><img src="red" alt="sRGB profile"><img src="green" alt=""><img src="blue" alt=""></button>
<button name="cmyk"><img src="cyan" alt="CMYK profile"><img src="magenta" alt=""><img src="yellow" alt=""><img src="black" alt=""></button>
4.7.2.1.2. A phrase or paragraph with an alternative graphical representation: charts, diagrams, graphs, maps, illustrations

Sometimes something can be more clearly stated in graphical form, for example as a flowchart, a diagram, a graph, or a simple map showing directions. In such cases, an image can be given using the img element, but the lesser textual version must still be given, so that users who are unable to view the image (e.g. because they have a very slow connection, or because they are using a text-only browser, or because they are listening to the page being read out by a hands-free automobile voice Web browser, or simply because they are blind) are still able to understand the message being conveyed.

The text must be given in the alt attribute, and must convey the same message as the image specified in the src attribute.

It is important to realize that the alternative text is a replacement for the image, not a description of the image.

In the following example we have a flowchart in image form, with text in the alt attribute rephrasing the flowchart in prose form:

<p>In the common case, the data handled by the tokenization stage
comes from the network, but it can also come from script.</p>
<p><img src="images/parsing-model-overview.png" alt="The network
passes data to the Tokeniser stage, which passes data to the Tree
Construction stage. From there, data goes to both the DOM and to
Script Execution. Script Execution is linked to the DOM, and, using
document.write(), passes data to the Tokeniser."></p>

Here's another example, showing a good solution and a bad solution to the problem of including an image in a description.

First, here's the good solution. This sample shows how the alternative text should just be what you would have put in the prose if the image had never existed.

<!-- This is the correct way to do things. -->
<p>
 You are standing in an open field west of a house.
 <img src="house.jpeg" alt="The house is white, with a boarded front door.">
 There is a small mailbox here.
</p>

Second, here's the bad solution. In this incorrect way of doing things, the alternative text is simply a description of the image, instead of a textual replacement for the image. It's bad because when the image isn't shown, the text doesn't flow as well as in the first example.

<!-- This is the wrong way to do things. -->
<p>
 You are standing in an open field west of a house.
 <img src="house.jpeg" alt="A white house, with a boarded front door.">
 There is a small mailbox here.
</p>
4.7.2.1.3. A short phrase or label with an alternative graphical representation: icons, logos

A document can contain information in iconic form. The icon is intended to help users of visual browsers to recognize features at a glance.

In some cases, the icon is supplemental to a text label conveying the same meaning. In those cases, the alt attribute must be present but must be empty.

Here the icons are next to text that conveys the same meaning, so they have an empty alt attribute:

<nav>
 <p><a href="/help/"><img src="/icons/help.png" alt=""> Help</a></p>
 <p><a href="/configure/"><img src="/icons/configuration.png" alt="">
 Configuration Tools</a></p>
</nav>

In other cases, the icon has no text next to it describing what it means; the icon is supposed to be self-explanatory. In those cases, an equivalent textual label must be given in the alt attribute.

Here, posts on a news site are labeled with an icon indicating their topic.

<body>
 <article>
  <header>
   <h1>Ratatouille wins <i>Best Movie of the Year</i> award</h1>
   <p><img src="movies.png" alt="Movies"></p>
  </header>
  <p>Pixar has won yet another <i>Best Movie of the Year</i> award,
  making this its 8th win in the last 12 years.</p>
 </article>
 <article>
  <header>
   <h1>Latest TWiT episode is online</h1>
   <p><img src="podcasts.png" alt="Podcasts"></p>
  </header>
  <p>The latest TWiT episode has been posted, in which we hear
  several tech news stories as well as learning much more about the
  iPhone. This week, the panelists compare how reflective their
  iPhones' Apple logos are.</p>
 </article>
</body>

Many pages include logos, insignia, flags, or emblems, which stand for a particular entity such as a company, organization, project, band, software package, country, or some such.

If the logo is being used to represent the entity, e.g. as a page header, the alt attribute must contain the name of the entity being represented by the logo. The alt attribute must not contain text like the word "logo", as it is not the fact that it is a logo that is being conveyed, it's the entity itself.

If the logo is being used next to the name of the entity that it represents, then the logo is supplemental, and its alt attribute must instead be empty.

If the logo is merely used as decorative material (as branding, or, for example, as a side image in an article that mentions the entity to which the logo belongs), then the entry below on purely decorative images applies. If the logo is actually being discussed, then it is being used as a phrase or paragraph (the description of the logo) with an alternative graphical representation (the logo itself), and the first entry above applies.

In the following snippets, all four of the above cases are present. First, we see a logo used to represent a company:

<h1><img src="XYZ.gif" alt="The XYZ company"></h1>

Next, we see a paragraph which uses a logo right next to the company name, and so doesn't have any alternative text:

<article>
 <h2>News</h2>
 <p>We have recently been looking at buying the <img src="alpha.gif"
 alt=""> ΑΒΓ company, a small Greek company
 specializing in our type of product.</p>

In this third snippet, we have a logo being used in an aside, as part of the larger article discussing the acquisition:

 <aside><p><img src="alpha-large.gif" alt=""></p></aside>
 <p>The ΑΒΓ company has had a good quarter, and our
 pie chart studies of their accounts suggest a much bigger blue slice
 than its green and orange slices, which is always a good sign.</p>
</article>

Finally, we have an opinion piece talking about a logo, and the logo is therefore described in detail in the alternative text.

<p>Consider for a moment their logo:</p>

<p><img src="/images/logo" alt="It consists of a green circle with a
green question mark centered inside it."></p>

<p>How unoriginal can you get? I mean, oooooh, a question mark, how
<em>revolutionary</em>, how utterly <em>ground-breaking</em>, I'm
sure everyone will rush to adopt those specifications now! They could
at least have tried for some sort of, I don't know, sequence of
rounded squares with varying shades of green and bold white outlines,
at least that would look good on the cover of a blue book.</p>

This example shows how the alternative text should be written such that if the image isn't available, and the text is used instead, the text flows seamlessly into the surrounding text, as if the image had never been there in the first place.

4.7.2.1.4. Text that has been rendered to a graphic for typographical effect

Sometimes, an image just consists of text, and the purpose of the image is not to highlight the actual typographic effects used to render the text, but just to convey the text itself.

In such cases, the alt attribute must be present but must consist of the same text as written in the image itself.

Consider a graphic containing the text "Earth Day", but with the letters all decorated with flowers and plants. If the text is merely being used as a header, to spice up the page for graphical users, then the correct alternative text is just the same text "Earth Day", and no mention need be made of the decorations:

<h1><img src="earthdayheader.png" alt="Earth Day"></h1>
4.7.2.1.5. A graphical representation of some of the surrounding text

In many cases, the image is actually just supplementary, and its presence merely reinforces the surrounding text. In these cases, the alt attribute must be present but its value must be the empty string.

In general, an image falls into this category if removing the image doesn't make the page any less useful, but including the image makes it a lot easier for users of visual browsers to understand the concept.

A flowchart that repeats the previous paragraph in graphical form:

<p>The network passes data to the Tokeniser stage, which
passes data to the Tree Construction stage. From there, data goes
to both the DOM and to Script Execution. Script Execution is
linked to the DOM, and, using document.write(), passes data to
the Tokeniser.</p>
<p><img src="images/parsing-model-overview.png" alt=""></p>

In these cases, it would be wrong to include alternative text that consists of just a caption. If a caption is to be included, then either the title attribute can be used, or the figure and legend elements can be used. In the latter case, the image would in fact be a phrase or paragraph with an alternative graphical representation, and would thus require alternative text.

<!-- Using the title="" attribute -->
<p>The network passes data to the Tokeniser stage, which
passes data to the Tree Construction stage. From there, data goes
to both the DOM and to Script Execution. Script Execution is
linked to the DOM, and, using document.write(), passes data to
the Tokeniser.</p>
<p><img src="images/parsing-model-overview.png" alt=""
        title="Flowchart representation of the parsing model."></p>
<!-- Using <figure> and <legend> -->
<p>The network passes data to the Tokeniser stage, which
passes data to the Tree Construction stage. From there, data goes
to both the DOM and to Script Execution. Script Execution is
linked to the DOM, and, using document.write(), passes data to
the Tokeniser.</p>
<figure>
 <img src="images/parsing-model-overview.png" alt="The Network leads
 to the Tokeniser, which leads to the Tree Construction. The Tree
 Construction leads to two items. The first is Script Execution, which
 leads via document.write() back to the Tokeniser. The second item
 from which Tree Construction leads is the DOM. The DOM is related to
 the Script Execution.">
 <legend>Flowchart representation of the parsing model.</legend>
</figure>
<!-- This is WRONG. Do not do this. Instead, do what the above examples do. -->
<p>The network passes data to the Tokeniser stage, which
passes data to the Tree Construction stage. From there, data goes
to both the DOM and to Script Execution. Script Execution is
linked to the DOM, and, using document.write(), passes data to
the Tokeniser.</p>
<p><img src="images/parsing-model-overview.png"
        alt="Flowchart representation of the parsing model."></p>
<!-- Never put the image's caption in the alt="" attribute! -->

A graph that repeats the previous paragraph in graphical form:

<p>According to a study covering several billion pages,
about 62% of documents on the Web in 2007 triggered the Quirks
rendering mode of Web browsers, about 30% triggered the Almost
Standards mode, and about 9% triggered the Standards mode.</p>
<p><img src="rendering-mode-pie-chart.png" alt=""></p>
4.7.2.1.6. A purely decorative image that doesn't add any information but is still specific to the surrounding content

In general, if an image is decorative but isn't especially page-specific, for example an image that forms part of a site-wide design scheme, the image should be specified in the site's CSS, not in the markup of the document.

However, a decorative image that isn't discussed by the surrounding text still has some relevance can be included in a page using the img element. Such images are decorative, but still form part of the content. In these cases, the alt attribute must be present but its value must be the empty string.

Examples where the image is purely decorative despite being relevant would include things like a photo of the Black Rock City landscape in a blog post about an event at Burning Man, or an image of a painting inspired by a poem, on a page reciting that poem. The following snippet shows an example of the latter case (only the first verse is included in this snippet):

<h1>The Lady of Shalott</h1>
<p><img src="shalott.jpeg" alt=""></p>
<p>On either side the river lie<br>
Long fields of barley and of rye,<br>
That clothe the wold and meet the sky;<br>
And through the field the road run by<br>
To many-tower'd Camelot;<br>
And up and down the people go,<br>
Gazing where the lilies blow<br>
Round an island there below,<br>
The island of Shalott.</p>
4.7.2.1.7. A group of images that form a single larger picture with no links

When a picture has been sliced into smaller image files that are then displayed together to form the complete picture again, one of the images must have its alt attribute set as per the relevant rules that would be appropriate for the picture as a whole, and then all the remaining images must have their alt attribute set to the empty string.

In the following example, a picture representing a company logo for XYZ Corp has been split into two pieces, the first containing the letters "XYZ" and the second with the word "Corp". The alternative text ("XYZ Corp") is all in the first image.

<h1><img src="logo1.png" alt="XYZ Corp"><img src="logo2.png" alt=""></h1>

In the following example, a rating is shown as three filled stars and two empty stars. While the alternative text could have been "★★★☆☆", the author has instead decided to more helpfully give the rating in the form "3/5". That is the alternative text of the first image, and the rest have blank alternative text.

<p>Rating: <meter max=5 value=3><img src="1" alt="3/5"
  ><img src="1" alt=""><img src="1" alt=""><img src="0" alt=""
  ><img src="0" alt=""></meter></p>
4.7.2.1.8. A group of images that form a single larger picture with links

Generally, image maps should be used instead of slicing an image for links.

However, if an image is indeed sliced and any of the components of the sliced picture are the sole contents of links, then one image per link must have alternative text in its alt attribute representing the purpose of the link.

In the following example, a picture representing the flying spaghetti monster emblem, with each of the left noodly appendages and the right noodly appendages in different images, so that the user can pick the left side or the right side in an adventure.

<h1>The Church</h1>
<p>You come across a flying spaghetti monster. Which side of His
Noodliness do you wish to reach out for?</p>
<p><a href="?go=left" ><img src="fsm-left.png"  alt="Left side. "></a
  ><img src="fsm-middle.png"  alt=""
  ><a href="?go=right"><img src="fsm-right.png" alt="Right side."></a></p>
4.7.2.1.9. A key part of the content

In some cases, the image is a critical part of the content. This could be the case, for instance, on a page that is part of a photo gallery. The image is the whole point of the page containing it.

How to provide alternative text for an image that is a key part of the content depends on the image's provenance.

The general case

When it is possible for detailed alternative text to be provided, for example if the image is part of a series of screenshots in a magazine review, or part of a comic strip, or is a photograph in a blog entry about that photograph, text that conveys can serve as a substitute for the image must be given as the contents of the alt attribute.

A screenshot in a gallery of screenshots for a new OS, with some alternative text:

<figure>
 <img src="KDE%20Light%20desktop.png"
      alt="The desktop is blue, with icons along the left hand side in
           two columns, reading System, Home, K-Mail, etc. A window is
           open showing that menus wrap to a second line if they
           cannot fit in the window. The window has a list of icons
           along the top, with an address bar below it, a list of
           icons for tabs along the left edge, a status bar on the
           bottom, and two panes in the middle. The desktop has a bar
           at the bottom of the screen with a few buttons, a pager, a
           list of open applications, and a clock.">
 <legend>Screenshot of a KDE desktop.</legend>
</figure>

A graph in a financial report:

<img src="sales.gif"
     title="Sales graph"
     alt="From 1998 to 2005, sales increased by the following percentages
     with each year: 624%, 75%, 138%, 40%, 35%, 9%, 21%">

Note that "sales graph" would be inadequate alternative text for a sales graph. Text that would be a good caption is not generally suitable as replacement text.

Images that defy a complete description

In certain cases, the nature of the image might be such that providing thorough alternative text is impractical. For example, the image could be indistinct, or could be a complex fractal, or could be a detailed topographical map.

In these cases, the alt attribute must contain some suitable alternative text, but it may be somewhat brief.

Sometimes there simply is no text that can do justice to an image. For example, there is little that can be said to usefully describe a Rorschach inkblot test. However, a description, even if brief, is still better than nothing:

<figure>
 <img src="/commons/a/a7/Rorschach1.jpg" alt="A shape with left-right
 symmetry with indistinct edges, with a small gap in the center, two
 larger gaps offset slightly from the center, with two similar gaps
 under them. The outline is wider in the top half than the bottom
 half, with the sides extending upwards higher than the center, and
 the center extending below the sides.">
 <legend>A black outline of the first of the ten cards
 in the Rorschach inkblot test.</legend>
</figure>

Note that the following would be a very bad use of alternative text:

<!-- This example is wrong. Do not copy it. -->
<figure>
 <img src="/commons/a/a7/Rorschach1.jpg" alt="A black outline
 of the first of the ten cards in the Rorschach inkblot test.">
 <legend>A black outline of the first of the ten cards
 in the Rorschach inkblot test.</legend>
</figure>

Including the caption in the alternative text like this isn't useful because it effectively duplicates the caption for users who don't have images, taunting them twice yet not helping them any more than if they had only read or heard the caption once.

Another example of an image that defies full description is a fractal, which, by definition, is infinite in complexity.

The following example shows one possible way of providing alternative text for the full view of an image of the Mandelbrot set.

<img src="ms1.jpeg" alt="The Mandelbrot set appears as a cardioid with
its cusp on the real axis in the positive direction, with a smaller
bulb aligned along the same center line, touching it in the negative
direction, and with these two shapes being surrounded by smaller bulbs
of various sizes.">
Images whose contents are not known

In some unfortunate cases, there might be no alternative text available at all, either because the image is obtained in some automated fashion without any associated alternative text (e.g. a Webcam), or because the page is being generated by a script using user-provided images where the user did not provide suitable or usable alternative text (e.g. photograph sharing sites), or because the author does not himself know what the images represent (e.g. a blind photographer sharing an image on his blog).

In such cases, the alt attribute's value must be a description of the kind of image, surrounded by braces ("{" and "}"), if that is known. The kind of image is something along the lines of "photo", "diagram", "painting", "user-uploaded image", etc. If even the kind of image cannot be determined, then the string {} must be used.

Such cases are to be kept to an absolute minimum. If there is even the slightest possibility of the author having the ability to provide real alternative text, then it would not be acceptable to provide the "{...}"-style value.

A photo on a photo-sharing site, if the site received the image with no metadata other than the caption:

<figure>
 <img src="1100670787_6a7c664aef.jpg" alt="{photo}">
 <legend>Bubbles traveled everywhere with us.</legend>
</figure>

In this case, though, it would be better if a detailed description of the important parts of the image obtained from the user and included on the page.

A blind user's blog in which a photo taken by the user is shown. Initially, the user might not have any idea what the photo he took shows:

<article>
 <h1>I took a photo</h1>
 <p>I went out today and took a photo!</p>
 <figure>
  <img src="photo2.jpeg" alt="{photograph}">
  <legend>A photograph taken blindly from my front porch.</legend>
 </figure>
</article>

Eventually though, the user might obtain a description of the image from his friends and could then include alternative text:

<article>
 <h1>I took a photo</h1>
 <p>I went out today and took a photo!</p>
 <figure>
  <img src="photo2.jpeg" alt="The photograph shows my hummingbird
  feeder hanging from the edge of my roof. It is half full, but there
  are no birds around. In the background, out-of-focus trees fill the
  shot. The feeder is made of wood with a metal grate, and it contains
  peanuts. The edge of the roof is wooden too, and is painted white
  with light blue streaks.">
  <legend>A photograph taken blindly from my front porch.</legend>
 </figure>
</article>

Sometimes the entire point of the image is that a textual description is not available, and the user is to provide the description. For instance, the point of a CAPTCHA image is to see if the user can literally read the graphic. Here is one way to mark up a CAPTCHA:

<p><label>What does this image say?
<img src="captcha.cgi?id=8934" alt="{captcha}">
<input type=text name=captcha></label>
(If you cannot see the image, you can use an <a
href="?audio">audio</a> test instead.)</p>

Another example would be software that displays images and asks for alternative text precisely for the purpose of then writing a page with correct alternative text. Such a page could have a table of images, like this:

<table>
 <thead>
  <tr> <th> Images <th> Descriptions
 <tbody>
  <tr>
   <td> <img src="2421.png" alt="{}">
   <td> <input name="alt2421">
  <tr>
   <td> <img src="2422.png" alt="{}">
   <td> <input name="alt2422">
</table>

The values given in the "{...}" syntax are intended for the user, they are not keywords. So, for instance, in a Finnish document, they would be in Finnish. The following snippet shows how a photo might be marked up on a Finnish-language photo upload site, when the user has not provided any replacement text:

<html lang="fi">
 ...
 <img src="v3525.jpeg" alt="{valokuva}">

Since some users cannot use images at all (e.g. because they have a very slow connection, or because they are using a text-only browser, or because they are listening to the page being read out by a hands-free automobile voice Web browser, or simply because they are blind), the alt attribute is only allowed to contain the kind of image rather than replacement text when no alternative text is available and none can be made available, e.g. on automated image gallery sites.

4.7.2.1.10. An image not intended for the user

Generally authors should avoid using img elements for purposes other than showing images.

If an img element is being used for purposes other than showing an image, e.g. as part of a service to count page views, then the alt attribute must be the empty string.

4.7.2.1.11. An image in an e-mail or document intended for a specific person who is known to be able to view images

When an image is included in a communication (such as an HTML e-mail) aimed at someone who is known to be able to view images, the alt attribute may be omitted. However, even in such cases it is strongly recommended that alternative text be included (as appropriate according to the kind of image involved, as described in the above entries), so that the e-mail is still usable should the user use a mail client that does not support images, or should the e-mail be forwarded on to other users whose abilities might not include easily seeing images.

4.7.2.1.12. General guidelines

The most general rule for writing alternative text is that the intent is that replacing every image with the text of its alt attribute not change the meaning of the page.

So, in general, alternative text can be written by considering what one would have written had one not been able to include the image.

A corollary to this is that the alt attribute's value should never contain text that could be considered the image's caption, title, or legend. It is supposed to contain replacement text that could be used by users instead of the image; it is not meant to supplement the image. The title attribute can be used for supplemental information.

4.7.3 iframe 要素

分類
Embedded content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where embedded content is expected.
内容モデル:
Text that conforms to the requirements given in the prose.
要素固有属性:
src
name
sandbox
seamless
width
height
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLIFrameElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString src;
           attribute DOMString name;
           attribute DOMString sandbox;
           attribute boolean seamless;
           attribute unsigned long width;
           attribute unsigned long height;
};

Objects implementing the HTMLIFrameElement interface must also implement the EmbeddingElement interface defined in the Window Object specification. [WINDOW]

The iframe element introduces a new nested browsing context.

The src attribute gives the address of a page that the nested browsing context is to contain. The attribute, if present, must be a valid URL. When the browsing context is created, if the attribute is present, the user agent must navigate the element's browsing context to the given URL, with replacement enabled, and with the iframe element's document's browsing context as the source browsing context. If the user navigates away from this page, the iframe's corresponding Window object will reference new Document objects, but the src attribute will not change.

Whenever the src attribute is set, the nested browsing context must be navigated to the URL given by that attribute's value, with the iframe element's document's browsing context as the source browsing context.

If the src attribute is not set when the element is created, the browsing context will remain at the initial about:blank page.

The name attribute, if present, must be a valid browsing context name. When the browsing context is created, if the attribute is present, the browsing context name must be set to the value of this attribute; otherwise, the browsing context name must be set to the empty string.

Whenever the name attribute is set, the nested browsing context's name must be changed to the new value. If the attribute is removed, the browsing context name must be set to the empty string.

When content loads in an iframe, after any load events are fired within the content itself, the user agent must fire a load event at the iframe element. When content fails to load (e.g. due to a network error), then the user agent must fire an error event at the element instead.

When there is an active parser in the iframe, and when anything in the iframe that is delaying the load event in the iframe's browsing context, the iframe must delay the load event.

If, during the handling of the load event, the browsing context in the iframe is again navigated, that will further delay the load event.


The sandbox attribute, when specified, enables a set of extra restrictions on any content hosted by the iframe. Its value must be an unordered set of unique space-separated tokens. The allowed values are allow-same-origin, allow-forms, and allow-scripts.

While the sandbox attribute is specified, the iframe element's nested browsing context, and all the browsing contexts nested within it (either directly or indirectly through other nested browsing contexts) must have the following flags set:

The sandboxed navigation browsing context flag

This flag prevents content from navigating browsing contexts other than the sandboxed browsing context itself (or browsing contexts further nested inside it).

This flag also prevents content from creating new auxiliary browsing contexts, e.g. using the target attribute or the window.open() method.

The sandboxed plugins browsing context flag

This flag prevents content from instantiating plugins, whether using the embed element, the object element, the applet element, or through navigation of a nested browsing context.

The sandboxed annoyances browsing context flag

This flag prevents content from showing notifications outside of the nested browsing context.

The sandboxed origin browsing context flag, unless the sandbox attribute's value, when split on spaces, is found to have the allow-same-origin keyword set

This flag forces content into a unique origin for the purposes of the same-origin policy.

This flag also prevents script from reading the document.cookies DOM attribute.

The allow-same-origin attribute is intended for two cases.

First, it can be used to allow content from the same site to be sandboxed to disable scripting, while still allowing access to the DOM of the sandboxed content.

Second, it can be used to embed content from a third-party site, sandboxed to prevent that site from opening popup windows, etc, without preventing the embedded page from communicating back to its originating site, using the database APIs to store data, etc.

The sandboxed forms browsing context flag, unless the sandbox attribute's value, when split on spaces, is found to have the allow-forms keyword set

This flag blocks form submission.

The sandboxed scripts browsing context flag, unless the sandbox attribute's value, when split on spaces, is found to have the allow-scripts keyword set

This flag blocks script execution.

These flags must not be set unless the conditions listed above define them as being set.

In this example, some completely-unknown, potentially hostile, user-provided HTML content is embedded in a page. Because it is sandboxed, it is treated by the user agent as being from a unique origin, despite the content being served from the same site. Thus it is affected by all the normal cross-site restrictions. In addition, the embedded page has scripting disabled, plugins disabled, forms disabled, and it cannot navigate any frames or windows other than itself (or any frames or windows it itself embeds).

<p>We're not scared of you! Here is your content, unedited:</p>
<iframe sandbox src="getusercontent.cgi?id=12193"></iframe>

Note that cookies are still send to the server in the getusercontent.cgi request, though they are not visible in the document.cookies DOM attribute.

In this example, a gadget from another site is embedded. The gadget has scripting and forms enabled, and the origin sandbox restrictions are lifted, allowing the gadget to communicate with its originating server. The sandbox is still useful, however, as it disables plugins and popups, thus reducing the risk of the user being exposed to malware and other annoyances.

<iframe sandbox="allow-same-origin allow-forms allow-scripts"
        src="http://maps.example.com/embedded.html"></iframe>

The seamless attribute is a boolean attribute. When specified, it indicates that the iframe element's browsing context is to be rendered in a manner that makes it appear to be part of the containing document (seamlessly included in the parent document). Specifically, when the attribute is set on an element and while the browsing context's active document has the same origin as the iframe element's document, or the browsing context's active document's address has the same origin as the iframe element's document, the following requirements apply:

Parts of the above might get moved into the rendering section at some point.

If the attribute is not specified, or if the origin conditions listed above are not met, then the user agent should render the nested browsing context in a manner that is clearly distinguishable as a separate browsing context, and the seamless browsing context flag must be set to false for that browsing context.

It is important that user agents recheck the above conditions whenever the active document of the nested browsing context of the iframe changes, such that the seamless browsing context flag gets unset if the nested browsing context is navigated to another origin.

In this example, the site's navigation is embedded using a client-side include using an iframe. Any links in the iframe will, in new user agents, be automatically opened in the iframe's parent browsing context; for legacy user agents, the site could also include a base element with a target attribute with the value _parent. Similarly, in new user agents the styles of the parent page will be automatically applied to the contents of the frame, but to support legacy user agents authors might wish to include the styles explicitly.

<nav><iframe seamless src="nav.include.html"></iframe></nav>

The iframe element supports dimension attributes for cases where the embedded content has specific dimensions (e.g. ad units have well-defined dimensions).

An iframe element never has fallback content, as it will always create a nested browsing context, regardless of whether the specified initial contents are successfully used.

Descendants of iframe elements represent nothing. (In legacy user agents that do not support iframe elements, the contents would be parsed as markup that could act as fallback content.)

The content model of iframe elements is text, except that the text must be such that ... anyone have any bright ideas?

The HTML parser treats markup inside iframe elements as text.

The DOM attributes src, name, sandbox, and seamless must reflect the content attributes of the same name.

4.7.4 embed 要素

分類
Embedded content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where embedded content is expected.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
src
type
width
height
Any other attribute that has no namespace (see prose).
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLEmbedElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString src;
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute unsigned long width;
           attribute unsigned long height;
};

Depending on the type of content instantiated by the embed element, the node may also support other interfaces.

The embed element represents an integration point for an external (typically non-HTML) application or interactive content.

The src attribute gives the address of the resource being embedded. The attribute, if present, must contain a valid URL.

The type attribute, if present, gives the MIME type of the plugin to instantiate. The value must be a valid MIME type, optionally with parameters. If both the type attribute and the src attribute are present, then the type attribute must specify the same type as the explicit Content-Type metadata of the resource given by the src attribute. [RFC2046]

When the element is created with neither a src attribute nor a type attribute, and when attributes are removed such that neither attribute is present on the element anymore, any plugins instantiated for the element must be removed, and the embed element represents nothing.

When the sandboxed plugins browsing context flag is set on the browsing context for which the embed element's document is the active document, then the user agent must render the embed element in a manner that conveys that the plugin was disabled. The user agent may offer the user the option to override the sandbox and instantiate the plugin anyway; if the user invokes such an option, the user agent must act as if the sandboxed plugins browsing context flag was not set for the purposes of this element.

Plugins are disabled in sandboxed browsing contexts because they might not honor the restrictions imposed by the sandbox (e.g. they might allow scripting even when scripting in the sandbox is disabled). User agents should convey the danger of overriding the sandbox to the user if an option to do so is provided.

When the element is created with a src attribute, and whenever the src attribute is subsequently set, and whenever the type attribute is set or removed while the element has a src attribute, if the element is not in a sandboxed browsing context, user agents should fetch the specified resource, find and instantiate an appropriate plugin based on the content's type, and hand that plugin the content of the resource, replacing any previously instantiated plugin for the element.

Fetching the resource must delay the load event.

The type of the content being embedded is defined as follows:

  1. If the element has a type attribute, then the value of the type attribute is the content's type.

  2. Otherwise, if the <path> component of the URL of the specified resource matches a pattern that a plugin supports, then the content's type is the type that that plugin can handle.

    For example, a plugin might say that it can handle resources with <path> components that end with the four character string ".swf".

    It would be better if browsers didn't do extension sniffing like this, and only based their decision on the actual contents of the resource. Couldn't we just apply the sniffed type of a resource steps?

  3. Otherwise, if the specified resource has explicit Content-Type metadata, then that is the content's type.

  4. Otherwise, the content has no type and there can be no appropriate plugin for it.

Whether the resource is fetched successfully or not (e.g. whether the response code was a 2xx code or equivalent) must be ignored when determining the resource's type and when handing the resource to the plugin.

This allows servers to return data for plugins even with error responses (e.g. HTTP 500 Internal Server Error codes can still contain plugin data).

When the element is created with a type attribute and no src attribute, and whenever the type attribute is subsequently set, so long as no src attribute is set, and whenever the src attribute is removed when the element has a type attribute, if the element is not in a sandboxed browsing context, user agents should find and instantiate an appropriate plugin based on the value of the type attribute.

Any (namespace-less) attribute may be specified on the embed element, so long as its name is XML-compatible and contains no characters in the range U+0041 .. U+005A (LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z).

All attributes in HTML documents get lowercased automatically, so the restriction on uppercase letters doesn't affect such documents.

The user agent should pass the names and values of all the attributes of the embed element that have no namespace to the plugin used, when it is instantiated.

If the plugin instantiated for the embed element supports a scriptable interface, the HTMLEmbedElement object representing the element should expose that interface while the element is instantiated.

The embed element has no fallback content. If the user agent can't find a suitable plugin, then the user agent must use a default plugin. (This default could be as simple as saying "Unsupported Format".)

The embed element supports dimension attributes.

The DOM attributes src and type each must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

4.7.5 object 要素

分類
Embedded content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where embedded content is expected.
内容モデル:
Zero or more param elements, then, transparent.
要素固有属性:
data
type
name
usemap
width
height
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLObjectElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString data;
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute DOMString name;
           attribute DOMString useMap;
           attribute unsigned long width;
           attribute unsigned long height;
};

Objects implementing the HTMLObjectElement interface must also implement the EmbeddingElement interface defined in the Window Object specification. [WINDOW]

Depending on the type of content instantiated by the object element, the node may also support other interfaces.

The object element can represent an external resource, which, depending on the type of the resource, will either be treated as an image, as a nested browsing context, or as an external resource to be processed by a plugin.

The data attribute, if present, specifies the address of the resource. If present, the attribute must be a valid URL.

The type attribute, if present, specifies the type of the resource. If present, the attribute must be a valid MIME type, optionally with parameters. [RFC2046]

One or both of the data and type attributes must be present.

The name attribute, if present, must be a valid browsing context name.

When the element is created, and subsequently whenever the classid attribute changes or is removed, or, if the classid attribute is not present, whenever the data attribute changes or is removed, or, if neither classid attribute nor the data attribute are present, whenever the type attribute changes or is removed, the user agent must run the following steps to determine what the object element represents:

  1. If the classid attribute is present, and has a value that isn't the empty string, then: if the user agent can find a plugin suitable according to the value of the classid attribute, and plugins aren't being sandboxed, then that plugin should be used, and the value of the data attribute, if any, should be passed to the plugin. If no suitable plugin can be found, or if the plugin reports an error, jump to the last step in the overall set of steps (fallback).

  2. If the data attribute is present, then:

    1. If the type attribute is present and its value is not a type that the user agent supports, and is not a type that the user agent can find a plugin for, then the user agent may jump to the last step in the overall set of steps (fallback) without fetching the content to examine its real type.

    2. Fetch the resource specified by the data attribute.

      The fetching of the resource must delay the load event.

    3. If the resource is not yet available (e.g. because the resource was not available in the cache, so that loading the resource required making a request over the network), then jump to the last step in the overall set of steps (fallback). When the resource becomes available, or if the load fails, restart this algorithm from this step. Resources can load incrementally; user agents may opt to consider a resource "available" whenever enough data has been obtained to begin processing the resource.

    4. If the load failed (e.g. an HTTP 404 error, a DNS error), fire an error event at the element, then jump to the last step in the overall set of steps (fallback).

    5. Determine the resource type, as follows:

      1. Let the resource type be unknown.

      2. If the resource has associated Content-Type metadata, then let the resource type be the type specified in the resource's Content-Type metadata.

      3. If the resource type is unknown or "application/octet-stream" and there is a type attribute present on the object element, then change the resource type to instead be the type specified in that type attribute.

        Otherwise, if the resource type is "application/octet-stream" but there is no type attribute on the object element, then change the resource type to be unknown, so that the sniffing rules in the next step are invoked.

      4. If the resource type is still unknown, then change the resource type to instead be the sniffed type of the resource.

    6. Handle the content as given by the first of the following cases that matches:

      If the resource type can be handled by a plugin and plugins aren't being sandboxed

      The user agent should use that plugin and pass the content of the resource to that plugin. If the plugin reports an error, then jump to the last step in the overall set of steps (fallback).

      If the resource type is an XML MIME type
      If the resource type is HTML
      If the resource type does not start with "image/"

      The object element must be associated with a nested browsing context, if it does not already have one. The element's nested browsing context must then be navigated to the given resource, with replacement enabled, and with the object element's document's browsing context as the source browsing context. (The data attribute of the object element doesn't get updated if the browsing context gets further navigated to other locations.)

      If the name attribute is present, the browsing context name must be set to the value of this attribute; otherwise, the browsing context name must be set to the empty string.

      navigation might end up treating it as something else, because it can do sniffing. how should we handle that?

      If the resource type starts with "image/", and support for images has not been disabled

      Apply the image sniffing rules to determine the type of the image.

      The object element represents the specified image. The image is not a nested browsing context.

      If the image cannot be rendered, e.g. because it is malformed or in an unsupported format, jump to the last step in the overall set of steps (fallback).

      その他の場合

      The given resource type is not supported. Jump to the last step in the overall set of steps (fallback).

    7. The element's contents are not part of what the object element represents.

    8. Once the resource is completely loaded, fire a load event at the element.

  3. If the data attribute is absent but the type attribute is present, plugins aren't being sandboxed, and the user agent can find a plugin suitable according to the value of the type attribute, then that plugin should be used. If no suitable plugin can be found, or if the plugin reports an error, jump to the next step (fallback).

  4. (Fallback.) The object element represents what the element's contents represent, ignoring any leading param element children. This is the element's fallback content.

When the algorithm above instantiates a plugin, the user agent should pass the names and values of all the parameters given by param elements that are children of the object element to the plugin used. If the plugin supports a scriptable interface, the HTMLObjectElement object representing the element should expose that interface. The plugin is not a nested browsing context.

If the sandboxed plugins browsing context flag is set on the browsing context for which the object element's document is the active document, then the steps above must always act as if they had failed to find a plugin, even if one would otherwise have been used.

Due to the algorithm above, the contents of object elements act as fallback content, used only when referenced resources can't be shown (e.g. because it returned a 404 error). This allows multiple object elements to be nested inside each other, targeting multiple user agents with different capabilities, with the user agent picking the first one it supports.

Whenever the name attribute is set, if the object element has a nested browsing context, its name must be changed to the new value. If the attribute is removed, if the object element has a browsing context, the browsing context name must be set to the empty string.

The usemap attribute, if present while the object element represents an image, can indicate that the object has an associated image map. The attribute must be ignored if the object element doesn't represent an image.

The object element supports dimension attributes.

The DOM attributes data, type, name, and useMap each must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

In the following example, a Java applet is embedded in a page using the object element. (Generally speaking, it is better to avoid using applets like these and instead use native JavaScript and HTML to provide the functionality, since that way the application will work on all Web browsers without requiring a third-party plugin. Many devices, especially embedded devices, do not support third-party technologies like Java.)

<figure>
 <object type="application/x-java-applet">
  <param name="code" value="MyJavaClass">
  <p>You do not have Java available, or it is disabled.</p>
 </object>
 <legend>My Java Clock</legend>
</figure>

In this example, an HTML page is embedded in another using the object element.

<figure>
 <object data="clock.html"></object>
 <legend>My HTML Clock</legend>
</figure>

4.7.6 param 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As a child of an object element, before any flow content.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
name
value
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLParamElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString name;
           attribute DOMString value;
};

The param element defines parameters for plugins invoked by object elements.

The name attribute gives the name of the parameter.

The value attribute gives the value of the parameter.

Both attributes must be present. They may have any value.

If both attributes are present, and if the parent element of the param is an object element, then the element defines a parameter with the given name/value pair.

The DOM attributes name and value must both reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

4.7.7 video 要素

分類
Embedded content.
If the element has a controls attribute: Interactive content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where embedded content is expected.
内容モデル:
If the element has a src attribute: transparent.
If the element does not have a src attribute: one or more source elements, then, transparent.
要素固有属性:
src
poster
autoplay
start
loopstart
loopend
end
playcount
controls
width
height
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLVideoElement : HTMLMediaElement {
           attribute unsigned long width;
           attribute unsigned long height;
  readonly attribute unsigned long videoWidth;
  readonly attribute unsigned long videoHeight;
           attribute DOMString poster;
};

A video element represents a video or movie.

Content may be provided inside the video element. User agents should not show this content to the user; it is intended for older Web browsers which do not support video, so that legacy video plugins can be tried, or to show text to the users of these older browser informing them of how to access the video contents.

In particular, this content is not fallback content intended to address accessibility concerns. To make video content accessible to the blind, deaf, and those with other physical or cognitive disabilities, authors are expected to provide alternative media streams and/or to embed accessibility aids (such as caption or subtitle tracks) into their media streams.

The video element is a media element whose media data is ostensibly video data, possibly with associated audio data.

The src, autoplay, start, loopstart, loopend, end, playcount, and controls attributes are the attributes common to all media elements.

The poster attribute gives the address of an image file that the user agent can show while no video data is available. The attribute, if present, must contain a valid URL. If the specified resource is to be used, it must be fetched when the element is created or when the poster attribute is set. The poster frame is then the image obtained from that resource, if any.

The image given by the poster attribute, the poster frame, is intended to be a representative frame of the video (typically one of the first non-blank frames) that gives the user an idea of what the video is like.

poster DOM 属性は poster 内容属性を反映しなければなりません


When no video data is available (the element's networkState attribute is either EMPTY, LOADING, or LOADED_METADATA), video elements represent either the poster frame, or nothing.

When a video element is paused and the current playback position is the first frame of video, the element represents either the frame of video corresponding to the current playback position or the poster frame, at the discretion of the user agent.

Notwithstanding the above, the poster frame should be preferred over nothing, but the poster frame should not be shown again after a frame of video has been shown.

When a video element is paused at any other position, the element represents the frame of video corresponding to the current playback position, or, if that is not yet available (e.g. because the video is seeking or buffering), the last frame of the video to have been rendered.

When a video element is actively playing, it represents the frame of video at the continuously increasing "current" position. When the current playback position changes such that the last frame rendered is no longer the frame corresponding to the current playback position in the video, the new frame must be rendered. Similarly, any audio associated with the video must, if played, be played synchronized with the current playback position, at the specified volume with the specified mute state.

When a video element is neither actively playing nor paused (e.g. when seeking or stalled), the element represents the last frame of the video to have been rendered.

Which frame in a video stream corresponds to a particular playback position is defined by the video stream's format.

In addition to the above, the user agent may provide messages to the user (such as "buffering", "no video loaded", "error", or more detailed information) by overlaying text or icons on the video or other areas of the element's playback area, or in another appropriate manner.

User agents that cannot render the video may instead make the element represent a link to an external video playback utility or to the video data itself.


The intrinsic width and height of the video are the aspect-ratio corrected dimensions given by the video data itself: the intrinsic width is the number of pixels per line of the video data multiplied by the pixel ratio given by the resource, multiplied by the resolution of the resource; the intrinsic height is the number of pixels per column of the video data multiplied by the resolution of the resource. The resolution of the resource is the physical distance intended for each pixel of video data, and assumes square pixels, with the resource's pixel ratio then adjusting the width of the pixels to the actual aspect-ratio-corrected width. In the absence of resolution information defining the mapping of pixels in the video to physical dimensions, user agents should assume that one pixel in the video corresponds to one CSS pixel. The pixel ratio of the resource is the corrected aspect ratio of the video divided by the ratio of the number of pixels per line to the number of pixels per column. In the absence of pixel ratio information in the resource, user agents should assume a default of 1.0 (square pixels).

The videoWidth DOM attribute must return the intrinsic width of the video in CSS pixels. The videoHeight DOM attribute must return the intrinsic height of the video in CSS pixels. If no video data is available, then the attributes must return 0.

If the video's pixel ratio override's is none, then the video's adjusted width is the same as the video's intrinsic width. If the video has a pixel ratio override other than none, then the adjusted width of the video is the number of pixels per line of the video data multiplied by the video's pixel ratio override, multiplied by the resolution of the resource; the pixel ratio of the resource is thus ignored.

The video's adjusted height is the same as the video's intrinsic height.

The adjusted aspect ratio of a video is the ratio of its adjusted width to its adjusted height.

User agents may adjust the adjusted width and height of the video to ensure that each pixel of video data corresponds to at least one device pixel, so long as this doesn't affect the adjusted aspect ratio (this is especially relevant for pixel ratios that are less than 1.0).

The video element supports dimension attributes.

Video content should be rendered inside the element's playback area such that the video content is shown centered in the playback area at the largest possible size that fits completely within it, with the video content's adjusted aspect ratio being preserved. Thus, if the aspect ratio of the playback area does not match the adjusted aspect ratio of the video, the video will be shown letterboxed. Areas of the element's playback area that do not contain the video represent nothing.

The intrinsic width of a video element's playback area is the adjusted width of the video resource, if that is available; otherwise it is the intrinsic width of the poster frame, if that is available; otherwise it is 300 CSS pixels.

The intrinsic height of a video element's playback area is the intrinsic height of the video resource, if that is available; otherwise it is the intrinsic height of the poster frame, if that is available; otherwise it is 150 CSS pixels.

The poster frame is not affected by the pixel ratio conversions.


User agents should provide controls to enable or disable the display of closed captions associated with the video stream, though such features should, again, not interfere with the page's normal rendering.

User agents may allow users to view the video content in manners more suitable to the user (e.g. full-screen or in an independent resizable window). As for the other user interface features, controls to enable this should not interfere with the page's normal rendering unless the user agent is exposing a user interface. In such an independent context, however, user agents may make full user interfaces visible, with, e.g., play, pause, seeking, and volume controls, even if the controls attribute is absent.

User agents may allow video playback to affect system features that could interfere with the user's experience; for example, user agents could disable screensavers while video playback is in progress.

User agents should not provide a public API to cause videos to be shown full-screen. A script, combined with a carefully crafted video file, could trick the user into thinking a system-modal dialog had been shown, and prompt the user for a password. There is also the danger of "mere" annoyance, with pages launching full-screen videos when links are clicked or pages navigated. Instead, user-agent specific interface features may be provided to easily allow the user to obtain a full-screen playback mode.

The spec does not currently define the interaction of the "controls" attribute with the "height" and "width" attributes. This will likely be defined in the rendering section based on implementation experience. So far, browsers seem to be making the controls overlay-only, thus somewhat sidestepping the issue.

4.7.7.1. Video and audio codecs for video elements

User agents may support any video and audio codecs and container formats.

It would be helpful for interoperability if all browsers could support the same codecs. However, there are no known codecs that satisfy all the current players: we need a codec that is known to not require per-unit or per-distributor licensing, that is compatible with the open source development model, that is of sufficient quality as to be usable, and that is not an additional submarine patent risk for large companies. This is an ongoing issue and this section will be updated once more information is available.

Certain user agents might support no codecs at all, e.g. text browsers running over SSH connections.

4.7.8 audio 要素

分類
Embedded content.
If the element has a controls attribute: Interactive content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where embedded content is expected.
内容モデル:
If the element has a src attribute: transparent.
If the element does not have a src attribute: one or more source elements, then, transparent.
要素固有属性:
src
autoplay
start
loopstart
loopend
end
playcount
controls
DOM 界面:
[NamedConstructor=Audio(),
 NamedConstructor=Audio(in DOMString url)]
interface HTMLAudioElement : HTMLMediaElement {
  // no members
};

An audio element represents a sound or audio stream.

Content may be provided inside the audio element. User agents should not show this content to the user; it is intended for older Web browsers which do not support audio, so that legacy audio plugins can be tried, or to show text to the users of these older browser informing them of how to access the audio contents.

In particular, this content is not fallback content intended to address accessibility concerns. To make audio content accessible to the deaf or to those with other physical or cognitive disabilities, authors are expected to provide alternative media streams and/or to embed accessibility aids (such as transcriptions) into their media streams.

The audio element is a media element whose media data is ostensibly audio data.

The src, autoplay, start, loopstart, loopend, end, playcount, and controls attributes are the attributes common to all media elements.

When an audio element is actively playing, it must have its audio data played synchronized with the current playback position, at the specified volume with the specified mute state.

When an audio element is not actively playing, audio must not play for the element.

Two constructors are provided for creating HTMLAudioElement objects (in addition to the factory methods from DOM Core such as createElement()): Audio() and Audio(url). When invoked as constructors, these must return a new HTMLAudioElement object (a new audio element). If the src argument is present, the object created must have its src content attribute set to the provided value, and the user agent must invoke the load() method on the object before returning.

4.7.8.1. Audio codecs for audio elements

User agents may support any audio codecs and container formats.

User agents must support the WAVE container format with audio encoded using the PCM format.

4.7.9 source 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As a child of a media element, before any flow content.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
src
type
media
pixelratio
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLSourceElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString src;
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute DOMString media;
           attribute float pixelRatio;
};

The source element allows authors to specify multiple media resources for media elements.

The src attribute gives the address of the media resource. The value must be a valid URL. This attribute must be present.

The type attribute gives the type of the media resource, to help the user agent determine if it can play this media resource before fetching it. Its value must be a MIME type. The codecs parameter may be specified and might be necessary to specify exactly how the resource is encoded. [RFC2046] [RFC4281]

The following list shows some examples of how to use the codecs= MIME parameter in the type attribute.

H.264 Simple baseline profile video (main and extended video compatible) level 3 and Low-Complexity AAC audio in MP4 container
<source src="video.mp4" type="video/mp4; codecs=&quot;avc1.42E01E, mp4a.40.2&quot;">
H.264 Extended profile video (baseline-compatible) level 3 and Low-Complexity AAC audio in MP4 container
<source src="video.mp4" type="video/mp4; codecs=&quot;avc1.58A01E, mp4a.40.2&quot;">
H.264 Main profile video level 3 and Low-Complexity AAC audio in MP4 container
<source src="video.mp4" type="video/mp4; codecs=&quot;avc1.4D401E, mp4a.40.2&quot;">
H.264 "High" profile video (incompatible with main, baseline, or extended profiles) level 3 and Low-Complexity AAC audio in MP4 container
<source src="video.mp4" type="video/mp4; codecs=&quot;avc1.64001E, mp4a.40.2&quot;">
MPEG-4 Visual Simple Profile Level 0 video and Low-Complexity AAC audio in MP4 container
<source src="video.mp4" type="video/mp4; codecs=&quot;mp4v.20.8, mp4a.40.2&quot;">
MPEG-4 Advanced Simple Profile Level 0 video and Low-Complexity AAC audio in MP4 container
<source src="video.mp4" type="video/mp4; codecs=&quot;mp4v.20.240, mp4a.40.2&quot;">
MPEG-4 Visual Simple Profile Level 0 video and AMR audio in 3GPP container
<source src="video.3gp" type="video/3gpp; codecs=&quot;mp4v.20.8, samr&quot;">
Theora video and Vorbis audio in Ogg container
<source src="video.ogv" type="video/ogg; codecs=&quot;theora, vorbis&quot;">
Theora video and Speex audio in Ogg container
<source src="video.ogv" type="video/ogg; codecs=&quot;theora, speex&quot;">
Vorbis audio alone in Ogg container
<source src="audio.ogg" type="audio/ogg; codecs=vorbis">
Speex audio alone in Ogg container
<source src="audio.spx" type="audio/ogg; codecs=speex">
FLAC audio alone in Ogg container
<source src="audio.oga" type="audio/ogg; codecs=flac">
Dirac video and Vorbis audio in Ogg container
<source src="video.ogv" type="video/ogg; codecs=&quot;dirac, vorbis&quot;">
Theora video and Vorbis audio in Matroska container
<source src="video.mkv" type="video/x-matroska; codecs=&quot;theora, vorbis&quot;">

The media attribute gives the intended media type of the media resource, to help the user agent determine if this media resource is useful to the user before fetching it. Its value must be a valid media query. [MQ]

Either the type attribute, the media attribute or both, must be specified, unless this is the last source element child of the parent element.

The pixelratio attribute allows the author to specify the pixel ratio of anamorphic media resources that do not self-describe their pixel ratio. The attribute value, if specified, must be a valid floating point number giving the ratio of the correct rendered width of each pixel to the actual height of each pixel in the image. The default value, if the attribute is omitted or cannot be parsed, is 1.0.

The only way this default is used is in deciding what number the pixelRatio DOM attribute will return if the content attribute is omitted or cannot be parsed. If the content attribute is omitted or cannot be parsed, then the user agent doesn't adjust the intrinsic width of the video at all; the intrinsic dimensions and the pixel ratio of the video are honoured.

If a source element is inserted into a media element that is already in a document and whose networkState is in the EMPTY state, the user agent must queue a task that implicitly invokes the load() method on the media element, and ignores any resulting exceptions. The task source for this task is the media element's own media element new resource task source.

The DOM attributes src, type, and media must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

The DOM attribute pixelRatio must reflect the pixelratio content attribute.

4.7.10 Media elements

Media elements implement the following interface:

interface HTMLMediaElement : HTMLElement {

  // error state
  readonly attribute MediaError error;

  // network state
           attribute DOMString src;
  readonly attribute DOMString currentSrc;
  const unsigned short EMPTY = 0;
  const unsigned short LOADING = 1;
  const unsigned short LOADED_METADATA = 2;
  const unsigned short LOADED_FIRST_FRAME = 3;
  const unsigned short LOADED = 4;
  readonly attribute unsigned short networkState;
  readonly attribute float bufferingRate;
  readonly attribute boolean bufferingThrottled;
  readonly attribute TimeRanges buffered;
  readonly attribute ByteRanges bufferedBytes;
  readonly attribute unsigned long totalBytes;
  void load();

  // ready state
  const unsigned short DATA_UNAVAILABLE = 0;
  const unsigned short CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME = 1;
  const unsigned short CAN_PLAY = 2;
  const unsigned short CAN_PLAY_THROUGH = 3;
  readonly attribute unsigned short readyState;
  readonly attribute boolean seeking;

  // playback state
           attribute float currentTime;
  readonly attribute float duration;
  readonly attribute boolean paused;
           attribute float defaultPlaybackRate;
           attribute float playbackRate;
  readonly attribute TimeRanges played;
  readonly attribute TimeRanges seekable;
  readonly attribute boolean ended;
           attribute boolean autoplay;
  void play();
  void pause();

  // looping
           attribute float start;
           attribute float end;
           attribute float loopStart;
           attribute float loopEnd;
           attribute unsigned long playCount;
           attribute unsigned long currentLoop;

  // cue ranges
  void addCueRange(in DOMString className, in DOMString id, in float start, in float end, in boolean pauseOnExit, in CueRangeCallback enterCallback, in CueRangeCallback exitCallback);
  void removeCueRanges(in DOMString className);

  // controls
           attribute boolean controls;
           attribute float volume;
           attribute boolean muted;
};

The media element attributes, src, autoplay, start, loopstart, loopend, end, playcount, and controls, apply to all media elements. They are defined in this section.

Media elements are used to present audio data, or video and audio data, to the user. This is referred to as media data in this section, since this section applies equally to media elements for audio or for video. The term media resource is used to refer to the complete set of media data, e.g. the complete video file, or complete audio file.

Media elements use two task queues, the media element event task source for asynchronous events and callbacks, and the media element new resource task source for handling implicit loads. Unless otherwise specified, the task source for all the tasks queued in this section and its subsections is the media element event task source.

4.7.10.1. Error codes

All media elements have an associated error status, which records the last error the element encountered since the load() method was last invoked. The error attribute, on getting, must return the MediaError object created for this last error, or null if there has not been an error.

interface MediaError {
  const unsigned short MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED = 1;
  const unsigned short MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK = 2;
  const unsigned short MEDIA_ERR_DECODE = 3;
  readonly attribute unsigned short code;
};

The code attribute of a MediaError object must return the code for the error, which must be one of the following:

MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED (数値 1)
The fetching process for the media resource was aborted by the user agent at the user's request.
MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK (数値 2)
A network error of some description caused the user agent to stop fetching the media resource.
MEDIA_ERR_DECODE (数値 3)
An error of some description occurred while decoding the media resource.
4.7.10.2. Location of the media resource

The src content attribute on media elements gives the address of the media resource (video, audio) to show. The attribute, if present, must contain a valid URL.

If the src attribute of a media element that is already in a document and whose networkState is in the EMPTY state is added, changed, or removed, the user agent must queue a task that implicitly invokes the load() method on the media element, and ignores any resulting exceptions. The task source for this task is the media element's own media element new resource task source.

If a src attribute is specified, the resource it specifies is the media resource that will be used. Otherwise, the resource specified by the first suitable source element child of the media element is the one used.

The src DOM attribute on media elements must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

To pick a media resource for a media element, a user agent must use the following steps:

  1. Let the chosen resource's pixel ratio override be none.

  2. If the media element has a src attribute, then resolve the URL given in that attribute. If that is successful, then the resulting absolute URL is the address of the media resource; jump to the last step.

  3. Otherwise, let candidate be the first source element child in the media element, or null if there is no such child.

  4. Loop: this is the start of the loop that looks at the source elements.

  5. If candidate is not null and it has a pixelratio attribute, and the result of applying the rules for parsing floating point number values to the value of that attribute is not an error, then let the chosen resource's pixel ratio override be that result; otherwise, reset it back to none.

  6. If either:

    ...then the candidate is not suitable; go to the next step.

    Otherwise, the result of resolving the URL given in that candidate element's src attribute is the address of the media resource; jump to the last step.

  7. Let candidate be the next source element child in the media element, or null if there are no more such children.

  8. If candidate is not null, return to the step labeled loop.

  9. There is no media resource. Abort these steps.

  10. Let the address of the chosen media resource be the absolute URL that was found before jumping to this step, and let its pixel ratio override be the value of the chosen resource's pixel ratio override.

The currentSrc DOM attribute must return the empty string if the media element's networkState has the value EMPTY, and the absolute URL that is the address of the chosen media resource otherwise.

4.7.10.3. ネットワーク状態

媒体要素がネットワークと対話するに当たっては、 いくつかの状態を経ることとなります。networkState 属性は、取得時、要素の現在のネットワーク状態を返さなければなりません。 その状態は、次の値のいずれか1つでなければなりません

EMPTY (数値 0)
要素は、まだ初期化されていません。すべての属性は、それぞれの初期状態にあります。
LOADING (数値 1)
要素は媒体資源を選定しました (選択された媒体資源currentSrc 属性から利用可能です。) が、 メタデータはまだまったく取得されておらず、従って他の属性もまだすべて初期状態にあります。
LOADED_METADATA (数値 2)
資源のうちメタデータ属性を初期化するのに十分な部分が取得されました (例えば、長さがわかりました)。 API を使用しても、もう例外を発生させません。
LOADED_FIRST_FRAME (数値 3)
実際の媒体データが取得されました。動画の場合、 これは動画のフレームが利用可能となり、提示できることを特に意味します。
LOADED (数値 4)
媒体資源の全体が取得され、 利用者エージェントに局所的に利用可能となりました。ネットワーク接続性が失われたとしても、 媒体の再生に影響することはありません。

後に定義する load() メソッドの算法で、正確にいつ networkState 属性の値が変化するかを説明しています。

4.7.10.4. Loading the media resource

All media elements have a begun flag, which must begin in the false state, a loaded-first-frame flag, which must begin in the false state, and an autoplaying flag, which must begin in the true state.

When the load() method on a media element is invoked, the user agent must run the following steps. Note that this algorithm might get aborted, e.g. if the load() method itself is invoked again.

  1. If there are any tasks from the media element's media element new resource task source or its media element event task source in one of the task queues, then remove those tasks.

    Basically, pending events, callbacks, and loads for the media element are discarded when the media element starts loading a new resource.

  2. Any already-running instance of this algorithm for this element must be aborted. If those method calls have not yet returned, they must finish the step they are on, and then immediately return. This is not blocking; this algorithm must not wait for the earlier instances to abort before continuing.

  3. If the element's begun flag is true, then the begun flag must be set to false, the error attribute must be set to a new MediaError object whose code attribute is set to MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED, and the user agent must synchronously fire a progress event called abort at the media element.

  4. The error attribute must be set to null, the loaded-first-frame flag must be set to false, and the autoplaying flag must be set to true.

  5. The playbackRate attribute must be set to the value of the defaultPlaybackRate attribute.

  6. If the media element's networkState is not set to EMPTY, then the following substeps must be followed:

    1. The networkState attribute must be set to EMPTY.
    2. If readyState is not set to DATA_UNAVAILABLE, it must be set to that state.
    3. If the paused attribute is false, it must be set to true.
    4. If seeking is true, it must be set to false.
    5. The current playback position must be set to 0.
    6. The currentLoop DOM attribute must be set to 0.
    7. The user agent must synchronously fire a simple event called emptied at the media element.
  7. The user agent must pick a media resource for the media element. If that fails, the method must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception, and abort these steps.

  8. The networkState attribute must be set to LOADING.

  9. The currentSrc attribute starts returning the new value.

  10. The user agent must then set the begun flag to true and synchronously fire a progress event called loadstart at the media element.

  11. The method must return, but these steps must continue.

  12. Playback of any previously playing media resource for this element stops.

  13. If a fetching process is in progress for the media element, the user agent should stop it.

  14. The user agent must then begin to fetch the chosen media resource. The rate of the download may be throttled, however, in response to user preferences (including throttling it to zero until the user indicates that the download can start), or to balance the download with other connections sharing the same bandwidth.

  15. While the fetching process is progressing, the user agent must queue a task to fire a progress event called progress at the element every 350ms (±200ms) or for every byte received, whichever is least frequent.

    If at any point the user agent has received no data for more than about three seconds, the user agent must queue a task to fire a progress event called stalled at the element.

    User agents may allow users to selectively block or slow media data downloads. When a media element's download has been blocked, the user agent must act as if it was stalled (as opposed to acting as if the connection was closed).

    The user agent may use whatever means necessary to fetch the resource (within the constraints put forward by this and other specifications); for example, reconnecting to the server in the face of network errors, using HTTP partial range requests, or switching to a streaming protocol. The user agent must consider a resource erroneous only if it has given up trying to fetch it.

    The networking task source tasks to process the data as it is being fetched must, when appropriate, include the relevant substeps from the following list:

    If the media data cannot be fetched at all, due to network errors, causing the user agent to give up trying to fetch the resource

    DNS errors and HTTP 4xx and 5xx errors (and equivalents in other protocols) must cause the user agent to execute the following steps. User agents may also follow these steps in response to other network errors of similar severity.

    1. The user agent should cancel the fetching process.
    2. The error attribute must be set to a new MediaError object whose code attribute is set to MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK.
    3. The begun flag must be set to false and the user agent must queue a task to fire a progress event called error at the media element.
    4. The element's networkState attribute must be switched to the EMPTY value and the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called emptied at the element.
    5. These steps must be aborted.
    If the media data can be fetched but is in an unsupported format, or can otherwise not be rendered at all

    The server returning a file of the wrong kind (e.g. one that that turns out to not be pure audio when the media element is an audio element), or the file using unsupported codecs for all the data, must cause the user agent to execute the following steps. User agents may also execute these steps in response to other codec-related fatal errors, such as the file requiring more resources to process than the user agent can provide in real time.

    1. The user agent should cancel the fetching process.
    2. The error attribute must be set to a new MediaError object whose code attribute is set to MEDIA_ERR_DECODE.
    3. The begun flag must be set to false and the user agent must queue a task to fire a progress event called error at the media element.
    4. The element's networkState attribute must be switched to the EMPTY value and the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called emptied at the element.
    5. These steps must be aborted.
    If the media data fetching process is aborted by the user

    The fetching process is aborted by the user, e.g. because the user navigated the browsing context to another page, the user agent must execute the following steps. These steps are not followed if the load() method itself is reinvoked, as the steps above handle that particular kind of abort.

    1. The user agent should cancel the fetching process.
    2. The error attribute must be set to a new MediaError object whose code attribute is set to MEDIA_ERR_ABORT.
    3. The begun flag must be set to false and the user agent must queue a task to fire a progress event called abort at the media element.
    4. If the media element's networkState attribute has the value LOADING, the element's networkState attribute must be switched to the EMPTY value and the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called emptied at the element. (If the networkState attribute has a value greater than LOADING, then this doesn't happen; the available data, if any, will be playable.)
    5. These steps must be aborted.
    If the media data can be fetched but has non-fatal errors or uses, in part, codecs that are unsupported, preventing the user agent from rendering the content completely correctly but not preventing playback altogether

    The server returning data that is partially usable but cannot be optimally rendered must cause the user agent to execute the following steps.

    1. Should we fire a 'warning' event? Set the 'error' flag to 'MEDIA_ERR_SUBOPTIMAL' or something?
    Once enough of the media data has been fetched to determine the duration of the media resource, its dimensions, and other metadata

    The user agent must follow these substeps:

    1. The current playback position must be set to the effective start.

    2. The networkState attribute must be set to LOADED_METADATA.

    3. A number of attributes, including duration, buffered, and played, become available.

    4. The user agent will queue a task to fire a simple event called durationchange at the element at this point.

    5. The user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called loadedmetadata at the element.

    Once enough of the media data has been fetched to enable the user agent to display the frame at the effective start of the media resource

    The user agent must follow these substeps:

    1. The networkState attribute must be set to LOADED_FIRST_FRAME.

    2. The readyState attribute must change to CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME.

    3. The loaded-first-frame flag must be set to true.

    4. The user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called loadedfirstframe at the element.

    5. The user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called canshowcurrentframe at the element.

    When the user agent has completely fetched of the entire media resource, it must move on to the next step.

  16. If the fetching process completes without errors, the begun flag must be set to false, the networkState attribute must be set to LOADED, and the user agent must queue a task to fire a progress event called load at the element.

If a media element whose networkState has the value EMPTY is inserted into a document, the user agent must queue a task that implicitly invokes the load() method on the media element, and ignores any resulting exceptions. The task source for this task is the media element's own media element new resource task source.

The bufferingRate attribute must return the average number of bits received per second for the current download over the past few seconds. If there is no download in progress, the attribute must return 0.

The bufferingThrottled attribute must return true if the user agent is intentionally throttling the bandwidth used by the download (including when throttling to zero to pause the download altogether), and false otherwise.

The buffered attribute must return a static normalized TimeRanges object that represents the ranges of the media resource, if any, that the user agent has buffered, at the time the attribute is evaluated.

Typically this will be a single range anchored at the zero point, but if, e.g. the user agent uses HTTP range requests in response to seeking, then there could be multiple ranges.

The bufferedBytes attribute must return a static normalized ByteRanges object that represents the ranges of the media resource, if any, that the user agent has buffered, at the time the attribute is evaluated.

The totalBytes attribute must return the length of the media resource, in bytes, if it is known and finite. If it is not known, is infinite (e.g. streaming radio), or if no media data is available, the attribute must return 0.

User agents may discard previously buffered data.

Thus, a time or byte position included within a range of the objects return by the buffered or bufferedBytes attributes at one time can end up being not included in the range(s) of objects returned by the same attributes at a later time.

4.7.10.5. Offsets into the media resource

The duration attribute must return the length of the media resource, in seconds. If no media data is available, then the attributes must return 0. If media data is available but the length is not known, the attribute must return the Not-a-Number (NaN) value. If the media resource is known to be unbounded (e.g. a streaming radio), then the attribute must return the positive Infinity value.

When the length of the media resource changes (e.g. from being unknown to known, or from indeterminate to known, or from a previously established length to a new length) the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called durationchange at the media element.

Media elements have a current playback position, which must initially be zero. The current position is a time.

The currentTime attribute must, on getting, return the current playback position, expressed in seconds. On setting, the user agent must seek to the new value (which might raise an exception).

The start content attribute gives the offset into the media resource at which playback is to begin. The default value is the default start position of the media resource, or 0 if not enough media data has been obtained yet to determine the default start position or if the resource doesn't specify a default start position.

The effective start is the smaller of the start DOM attribute and the end of the media resource.

The loopstart content attribute gives the offset into the media resource at which playback is to begin when looping a clip. The default value of the loopstart content attribute is the value of the start DOM attribute.

The effective loop start is the smaller of the loopStart DOM attribute and the end of the media resource.

The loopend content attribute gives an offset into the media resource at which playback is to jump back to the loopstart, when looping the clip. The default value of the loopend content attribute is the value of the end DOM attribute.

The effective loop end is the greater of the start, loopStart, and loopEnd DOM attributes, except if that is greater than the end of the media resource, in which case that's its value.

The end content attribute gives an offset into the media resource at which playback is to end. The default value is infinity.

The effective end is the greater of the start, loopStart, and end DOM attributes, except if that is greater than the end of the media resource, in which case that's its value.

The start, loopstart, loopend, and end attributes must, if specified, contain value time offsets. To get the time values they represent, user agents must use the rules for parsing time offsets.

The start, loopStart, loopEnd, and end DOM attributes must reflect the start, loopstart, loopend, and end content attributes on the media element respectively.

The playcount content attribute gives the number of times to play the clip. The default value is 1.

The playCount DOM attribute must reflect the playcount content attribute on the media element. The value must be limited to only positive non-zero numbers.

The currentLoop attribute must initially have the value 0. It gives the index of the current loop. It is changed during playback as described below.

When any of the start, loopStart, loopEnd, end, playCount, and currentLoop DOM attributes change value (either through content attribute mutations reflecting into the DOM attribute, if applicable, or through direct mutations of the DOM attribute), the user agent must apply the following steps:

  1. If the playCount DOM attribute's value is less than or equal to the currentLoop DOM attribute's value, then the currentLoop DOM attribute's value must be set to playCount-1 (which will make the current loop the last loop).

  2. If the media element's networkState is in the EMPTY state or the LOADING state, then the user agent must at this point abort these steps.

  3. If the currentLoop is zero, and the current playback position is before the effective start, the user agent must seek to the effective start.

  4. If the currentLoop is greater than zero, and the current playback position is before the effective loop start, the user agent must seek to the effective loop start.

  5. If the currentLoop is less than playCount-1, and the current playback position is after the effective loop end, the user agent must seek to the effective loop start, and increase currentLoop by 1.

  6. If the currentLoop is equal to playCount-1, and the current playback position is after the effective end, the user agent must seek to the effective end and then the looping will end.

4.7.10.6. The ready states

Media elements have a ready state, which describes to what degree they are ready to be rendered at the current playback position. The possible values are as follows; the ready state of a media element at any particular time is the greatest value describing the state of the element:

DATA_UNAVAILABLE (数値 0)
No data for the current playback position is available. Media elements whose networkState attribute is less than LOADED_FIRST_FRAME are always in the DATA_UNAVAILABLE state.
CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME (数値 1)
Data for the immediate current playback position is available, but not enough data is available that the user agent could successfully advance the current playback position at all without immediately reverting to the DATA_UNAVAILABLE state. In video, this corresponds to the user agent having data from the current frame, but not the next frame. In audio, this corresponds to the user agent only having audio up to the current playback position, but no further.
CAN_PLAY (数値 2)
Data for the immediate current playback position is available, as well as enough data for the user agent to advance the current playback position at least a little without immediately reverting to the DATA_UNAVAILABLE state. In video, this corresponds to the user agent having data for the current frame and the next frame. In audio, this corresponds to the user agent having data beyond the current playback position.
CAN_PLAY_THROUGH (数値 3)
Data for the immediate current playback position is available, as well as enough data for the user agent to advance the current playback position at least a little without immediately reverting to the DATA_UNAVAILABLE state, and, in addition, the user agent estimates that data is being fetched at a rate where the current playback position, if it were to advance at the rate given by the defaultPlaybackRate attribute, would not overtake the available data before playback reaches the effective end of the media resource on the last loop.

When the ready state of a media element whose networkState is not EMPTY changes, the user agent must follow the steps given below:

If the new ready state is DATA_UNAVAILABLE

The user agent must fire a simple event called dataunavailable at the element.

If the new ready state is CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME

If the element's loaded-first-frame flag is true, the user agent must fire a simple event called canshowcurrentframe event.

The first time the networkState attribute switches to this value, the loaded-first-frame flag is false, and the event is fired by the algorithm described above for the load() method, in conjunction with other steps.

If the new ready state is CAN_PLAY

The user agent must fire a simple event called canplay.

If the new ready state is CAN_PLAY_THROUGH

The user agent must fire a simple event called canplaythrough event. If the autoplaying flag is true, and the paused attribute is true, and the media element has an autoplay attribute specified, then the user agent must also set the paused attribute to false and fire a simple event called play.

It is possible for the ready state of a media element to jump between these states discontinuously. For example, the state of a media element whose loaded-first-frame flag is false can jump straight from DATA_UNAVAILABLE to CAN_PLAY_THROUGH without passing through the CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME and CAN_PLAY states, and thus without firing the canshowcurrentframe and canplay events. The only state that is guaranteed to be reached is the CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME state, which is reached as part of the load() method's processing.

The readyState DOM attribute must, on getting, return the value described above that describes the current ready state of the media element.

The autoplay attribute is a boolean attribute. When present, the algorithm described herein will cause the user agent to automatically begin playback of the media resource as soon as it can do so without stopping.

The autoplay DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

4.7.10.7. Playing the media resource

The paused attribute represents whether the media element is paused or not. The attribute must initially be true.

A media element is said to be actively playing when its paused attribute is false, the readyState attribute is either CAN_PLAY or CAN_PLAY_THROUGH, the element has not ended playback, playback has not stopped due to errors, and the element has not paused for user interaction.

A media element is said to have ended playback when the element's networkState attribute is LOADED_METADATA or greater, the current playback position is equal to the effective end of the media resource, and the currentLoop attribute is equal to playCount-1.

A media element is said to have stopped due to errors when the element's networkState attribute is LOADED_METADATA or greater, and the user agent encounters a non-fatal error during the processing of the media data, and due to that error, is not able to play the content at the current playback position.

A media element is said to have paused for user interaction when its paused attribute is false, the readyState attribute is either CAN_PLAY or CAN_PLAY_THROUGH and the user agent has reached a point in the media resource where the user has to make a selection for the resource to continue.

It is possible for a media element to have both ended playback and paused for user interaction at the same time.

When a media element is actively playing and its owner Document is an active document, its current playback position must increase monotonically at playbackRate units of media time per unit time of wall clock time. If this value is not 1, the user agent may apply pitch adjustments to any audio component of the media resource.

This specification doesn't define how the user agent achieves the appropriate playback rate — depending on the protocol and media available, it is plausible that the user agent could negotiate with the server to have the server provide the media data at the appropriate rate, so that (except for the period between when the rate is changed and when the server updates the stream's playback rate) the client doesn't actually have to drop or interpolate any frames.

Media resources might be internally scripted or interactive. Thus, a media element could play in a non-linear fashion. If this happens, the user agent must act as if the algorithm for seeking was used whenever the current playback position changes in a discontinuous fashion (so that the relevant events fire).

When a media element that is actively playing stops playing because its readyState attribute changes to a value lower than CAN_PLAY, without the element having ended playback, or playback having stopped due to errors, or playback having paused for user interaction, or the seeking algorithm being invoked, the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called timeupdate at the element, and queue a task to fire a simple event called waiting at the element.

When a media element that is actively playing stops playing because it has paused for user interaction, the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called timeupdate at the element.

When currentLoop is less than playCount-1 and the current playback position reaches the effective loop end, then the user agent must increase currentLoop by 1 and seek to the effective loop start.

When currentLoop is equal to the playCount-1 and the current playback position reaches the effective end, then the user agent must follow these steps:

  1. The user agent must stop playback.

  2. The ended attribute becomes true.

  3. The user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called timeupdate at the element.

  4. The user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called ended at the element.

The defaultPlaybackRate attribute gives the desired speed at which the media resource is to play, as a multiple of its intrinsic speed. The attribute is mutable, but on setting, if the new value is 0.0, a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception must be raised instead of the value being changed. It must initially have the value 1.0.

The playbackRate attribute gives the speed at which the media resource plays, as a multiple of its intrinsic speed. If it is not equal to the defaultPlaybackRate, then the implication is that the user is using a feature such as fast forward or slow motion playback. The attribute is mutable, but on setting, if the new value is 0.0, a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception must be raised instead of the value being changed. Otherwise, the playback must change speed (if the element is actively playing). It must initially have the value 1.0.

When the defaultPlaybackRate or playbackRate attributes change value (either by being set by script or by being changed directly by the user agent, e.g. in response to user control) the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called ratechange at the media element.


When the play() method on a media element is invoked, the user agent must run the following steps.

  1. If the media element's networkState attribute has the value EMPTY, then the user agent must invoke the load() method and wait for it to return. If that raises an exception, that exception must be reraised by the play() method.

  2. If the playback has ended, then the user agent must set currentLoop to zero and seek to the effective start.

    If this involved a seek, the user agent will queue a task to fire a simple event called timeupdate at the media element.

  3. The playbackRate attribute must be set to the value of the defaultPlaybackRate attribute.

    If this caused the playbackRate attribute to change value, the user agent will queue a task to fire a simple event called ratechange at the media element.

  4. If the media element's paused attribute is true, it must be set to false.

  5. The media element's autoplaying flag must be set to false.

  6. The method must then return.

  7. If the fourth step above changed the value of paused, the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called play at the element.

利用者エージェントは、 pause() メソッドが呼び出された時、 次の段階を走らせなければなりません

  1. If the media element's networkState attribute has the value EMPTY, then the user agent must invoke the load() method and wait for it to return. If that raises an exception, that exception must be reraised by the pause() method.

  2. If the media element's paused attribute is false, it must be set to true.

  3. The media element's autoplaying flag must be set to false.

  4. The method must then return.

  5. If the second step above changed the value of paused, then the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called timeupdate at the element, and queue a task to fire a simple event called pause at the element.

When a media element is removed from a Document, if the media element's networkState attribute has a value other than EMPTY then the user agent must act as if the pause() method had been invoked.

Media elements that are actively playing while not in a Document must not play any video, but should play any audio component. Media elements must not stop playing just because all references to them have been removed; only once a media element to which no references exist has reached a point where no further audio remains to be played for that element (e.g. because the element is paused or because the end of the clip has been reached) may the element be garbage collected.

If the media element's ownerDocument stops being an active document, then the playback will stop until the document is active again.

The ended attribute must return true if the media element has ended playback, and false otherwise.

The played attribute must return a static normalized TimeRanges object that represents the ranges of the media resource, if any, that the user agent has so far rendered, at the time the attribute is evaluated.

4.7.10.8. Seeking

The seeking attribute must initially have the value false.

When the user agent is required to seek to a particular new playback position in the media resource, it means that the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. If the media element's networkState is less than LOADED_METADATA, then the user agent must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception (if the seek was in response to a DOM method call or setting of a DOM attribute), and abort these steps.

  2. If currentLoop is 0, let min be the effective start. Otherwise, let it be the effective loop start.

  3. If currentLoop is equal to playCount-1, let max be the effective end. Otherwise, let it be the effective loop end.

  4. If the new playback position is more than max, let it be max.

  5. If the new playback position is less than min, let it be min.

  6. If the (possibly now changed) new playback position is not in one of the ranges given in the seekable attribute, then the user agent must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception (if the seek was in response to a DOM method call or setting of a DOM attribute), and abort these steps.

  7. The current playback position must be set to the given new playback position.

  8. The seeking DOM attribute must be set to true.

  9. The user agent must queue a task to queue a task to fire a simple event called timeupdate at the element.

  10. If the media element was actively playing immediately before it started seeking, but seeking caused its readyState attribute to change to a value lower than CAN_PLAY, the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called waiting at the element.

  11. If, when it reaches this step, the user agent has still not established whether or not the media data for the new playback position is available, and, if it is, decoded enough data to play back that position, the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called seeking at the element.

  12. If the seek was in response to a DOM method call or setting of a DOM attribute, then continue the script. The remainder of these steps must be run asynchronously.

  13. The user agent must wait until it has established whether or not the media data for the new playback position is available, and, if it is, until it has decoded enough data to play back that position.

  14. The seeking DOM attribute must be set to false.

  15. The user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called seeked at the element.

The seekable attribute must return a static normalized TimeRanges object that represents the ranges of the media resource, if any, that the user agent is able to seek to, at the time the attribute is evaluated, notwithstanding the looping attributes (i.e. the effective start and effective end, etc, don't affect the seekable attribute).

If the user agent can seek to anywhere in the media resource, e.g. because it a simple movie file and the user agent and the server support HTTP Range requests, then the attribute would return an object with one range, whose start is the time of the first frame (typically zero), and whose end is the same as the time of the first frame plus the duration attribute's value (which would equal the time of the last frame).

4.7.10.9. Cue ranges

Media elements have a set of cue ranges. Each cue range is made up of the following information:

A class name
A group of related ranges can be given the same class name so that they can all be removed at the same time.
An identifier
A string can be assigned to each cue range for identification by script. The string need not be unique and can contain any value.
A start time
An end time
The actual time range, using the same timeline as the media resource itself.
A "pause" boolean
A flag indicating whether to pause playback on exit.
An "enter" callback
A callback that is called when the current playback position enters the range.
An "exit" callback
A callback that is called when the current playback position exits the range.
An "active" boolean
A flag indicating whether the range is active or not.

The addCueRange(className, id, start, end, pauseOnExit, enterCallback, exitCallback) method must, when called, add a cue range to the media element, that cue range having the class name className, the identifier id, the start time start (in seconds), the end time end (in seconds), the "pause" boolean with the same value as pauseOnExit, the "enter" callback enterCallback, the "exit" callback exitCallback, and an "active" boolean that is true if the current playback position is equal to or greater than the start time and less than the end time, and false otherwise.

The removeCueRanges(className) method must, when called, remove all the cue ranges of the media element which have the class name className.

When the current playback position of a media element changes (e.g. due to playback or seeking), the user agent must run the following steps. If the current playback position changes while the steps are running, then the user agent must wait for the steps to complete, and then must immediately rerun the steps. (These steps are thus run as often as possible or needed — if one iteration takes a long time, this can cause certain ranges to be skipped over as the user agent rushes ahead to "catch up".)

  1. Let current ranges be an ordered list of cue ranges, initialized to contain all the cue ranges of the media element whose start times are less than or equal to the current playback position and whose end times are greater than the current playback position, in the order they were added to the element.

  2. Let other ranges be an ordered list of cue ranges, initialized to contain all the cue ranges of the media element that are not present in current ranges, in the order they were added to the element.

  3. If none of the cue ranges in current ranges have their "active" boolean set to "false" (inactive) and none of the cue ranges in other ranges have their "active" boolean set to "true" (active), then abort these steps.

  4. If the time was reached through the usual monotonic increase of the current playback position during normal playback, the user agent must then queue a task to fire a simple event called timeupdate at the element. (In the other cases, such as explicit seeks, relevant events get fired as part of the overall process of changing the current playback position.)

  5. If the time was reached through the usual monotonic increase of the current playback position during normal playback, and there are cue ranges in other ranges that have both their "active" boolean and their "pause" boolean set to "true", then immediately act as if the element's pause() method had been invoked. (In the other cases, such as explicit seeks, playback is not paused by exiting a cue range, even if that cue range has its "pause" boolean set to "true".)

  6. For each non-null "exit" callback of the cue ranges in other ranges that have their "active" boolean set to "true" (active), in list order, queue a task that invokes the callback, passing the cue range's identifier as the callback's only argument.

  7. For each non-null "enter" callback of the cue ranges in current ranges that have their "active" boolean set to "false" (inactive), in list order, queue a task that invokes the callback, passing the cue range's identifier as the callback's only argument.

  8. Set the "active" boolean of all the cue ranges in the current ranges list to "true" (active), and the "active" boolean of all the cue ranges in the other ranges list to "false" (inactive).

Invoking a callback (an object implementing one of the following two interfaces) means calling its handleEvent() method.

interface VoidCallback {
  void handleEvent();
};

interface CueRangeCallback {
  void handleEvent(in DOMString id);
};

The handleEvent method of objects implementing these interfaces is the entry point for the callback represented by the object.

4.7.10.10. User interface

The controls attribute is a boolean attribute. If the attribute is present, or if the media element is without script, then the user agent should expose a user interface to the user. This user interface should include features to begin playback, pause playback, seek to an arbitrary position in the content (if the content supports arbitrary seeking), change the volume, and show the media content in manners more suitable to the user (e.g. full-screen video or in an independent resizable window). Other controls may also be made available.

If the attribute is absent, then the user agent should avoid making a user interface available that could conflict with an author-provided user interface. User agents may make the following features available, however, even when the attribute is absent:

User agents may provide controls to affect playback of the media resource (e.g. play, pause, seeking, and volume controls), but such features should not interfere with the page's normal rendering. For example, such features could be exposed in the media element's context menu.

Where possible (specifically, for starting, stopping, pausing, and unpausing playback, for muting or changing the volume of the audio, and for seeking), user interface features exposed by the user agent must be implemented in terms of the DOM API described above, so that, e.g., all the same events fire.

The controls DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

The volume attribute must return the playback volume of any audio portions of the media element, in the range 0.0 (silent) to 1.0 (loudest). Initially, the volume must be 1.0, but user agents may remember the last set value across sessions, on a per-site basis or otherwise, so the volume may start at other values. On setting, if the new value is in the range 0.0 to 1.0 inclusive, the attribute must be set to the new value and the playback volume must be correspondingly adjusted as soon as possible after setting the attribute, with 0.0 being silent, and 1.0 being the loudest setting, values in between increasing in loudness. The range need not be linear. The loudest setting may be lower than the system's loudest possible setting; for example the user could have set a maximum volume. If the new value is outside the range 0.0 to 1.0 inclusive, then, on setting, an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception must be raised instead.

The muted attribute must return true if the audio channels are muted and false otherwise. Initially, the audio channels should not be muted (false), but user agents may remember the last set value across sessions, on a per-site basis or otherwise, so the muted state may start as muted (true). On setting, the attribute must be set to the new value; if the new value is true, audio playback for this media resource must then be muted, and if false, audio playback must then be enabled.

Whenever either the muted or volume attributes are changed, the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event called volumechange at the media element.

4.7.10.11. Time ranges

Objects implementing the TimeRanges interface represent a list of ranges (periods) of time.

interface TimeRanges {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  float start(in unsigned long index);
  float end(in unsigned long index);
};

The length DOM attribute must return the number of ranges represented by the object.

The start(index) method must return the position of the start of the indexth range represented by the object, in seconds measured from the start of the timeline that the object covers.

The end(index) method must return the position of the end of the indexth range represented by the object, in seconds measured from the start of the timeline that the object covers.

These methods must raise INDEX_SIZE_ERR exceptions if called with an index argument greater than or equal to the number of ranges represented by the object.

When a TimeRanges object is said to be a normalized TimeRanges object, the ranges it represents must obey the following criteria:

In other words, the ranges in such an object are ordered, don't overlap, aren't empty, and don't touch (adjacent ranges are folded into one bigger range).

The timelines used by the objects returned by the buffered, seekable and played DOM attributes of media elements must be the same as that element's media resource's timeline.

4.7.10.12. Byte ranges

Objects implementing the ByteRanges interface represent a list of ranges of bytes.

interface ByteRanges {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  unsigned long start(in unsigned long index);
  unsigned long end(in unsigned long index);
};

The length DOM attribute must return the number of ranges represented by the object.

The start(index) method must return the position of the first byte of the indexth range represented by the object.

The end(index) method must return the position of the byte immediately after the last byte of the indexth range represented by the object. (The byte position returned by this method is not in the range itself. If the first byte of the range is the byte at position 0, and the entire stream of bytes is in the range, then the value of the position of the byte returned by this method for that range will be the same as the number of bytes in the stream.)

These methods must raise INDEX_SIZE_ERR exceptions if called with an index argument greater than or equal to the number of ranges represented by the object.

When a ByteRanges object is said to be a normalized ByteRanges object, the ranges it represents must obey the following criteria:

In other words, the ranges in such an object are ordered, don't overlap, aren't empty, and don't touch (adjacent ranges are folded into one bigger range).

4.7.10.13. Event summary

The following events fire on media elements as part of the processing model described above:
Event name Interface Dispatched when... Preconditions
loadstart ProgressEvent [PROGRESS] The user agent begins fetching the media data, synchronously during the load() method call. networkState equals LOADING
progress ProgressEvent [PROGRESS] The user agent is fetching media data. networkState is more than EMPTY and less than LOADED
loadedmetadata Event The user agent is fetching media data, and the media resource's metadata has just been received. networkState equals LOADED_METADATA
loadedfirstframe Event The user agent is fetching media data, and the media resource's first frame has just been received. networkState equals LOADED_FIRST_FRAME
load ProgressEvent [PROGRESS] The user agent finishes fetching the entire media resource. networkState equals LOADED
abort ProgressEvent [PROGRESS] The user agent stops fetching the media data before it is completely downloaded. This can be fired synchronously during the load() method call. error is an object with the code MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED. networkState equals either EMPTY or LOADED, depending on when the download was aborted.
error ProgressEvent [PROGRESS] An error occurs while fetching the media data. error is an object with the code MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK_ERROR or higher. networkState equals either EMPTY or LOADED, depending on when the download was aborted.
emptied Event A media element whose networkState was previously not in the EMPTY state has just switched to that state (either because of a fatal error during load that's about to be reported, or because the load() method was reinvoked, in which case it is fired synchronously during the load() method call). networkState is EMPTY; all the DOM attributes are in their initial states.
stalled ProgressEvent The user agent is trying to fetch media data, but data is unexpectedly not forthcoming.
play Event Playback has begun. Fired after the play method has returned. paused is newly false.
pause Event Playback has been paused. Fired after the pause method has returned. paused is newly true.
waiting Event Playback has stopped because the next frame is not available, but the user agent expects that frame to become available in due course. readyState is either DATA_UNAVAILABLE or CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME, and paused is false. Either seeking is true, or the current playback position is not contained in any of the ranges in buffered. It is possible for playback to stop for two other reasons without paused being false, but those two reasons do not fire this event: maybe playback ended, or playback stopped due to errors.
seeking Event The seeking DOM attribute changed to true and the seek operation is taking long enough that the user agent has time to fire the event.
seeked Event The seeking DOM attribute changed to false.
timeupdate Event The current playback position changed in an interesting way, for example discontinuously.
ended Event Playback has stopped because the end of the media resource was reached. currentTime equals the effective end; ended is true.
dataunavailable Event The user agent cannot render the data at the current playback position because data for the current frame is not immediately available. The readyState attribute is newly equal to DATA_UNAVAILABLE.
canshowcurrentframe Event The user agent cannot render the data after the current playback position because data for the next frame is not immediately available. The readyState attribute is newly equal to CAN_SHOW_CURRENT_FRAME.
canplay Event The user agent can resume playback of the media data, but estimates that if playback were to be started now, the media resource could not be rendered at the current playback rate up to its end without having to stop for further buffering of content. The readyState attribute is newly equal to CAN_PLAY.
canplaythrough Event The user agent estimates that if playback were to be started now, the media resource could be rendered at the current playback rate all the way to its end without having to stop for further buffering. The readyState attribute is newly equal to CAN_PLAY_THROUGH.
ratechange Event Either the defaultPlaybackRate or the playbackRate attribute has just been updated.
durationchange Event The duration attribute has just been updated.
volumechange Event Either the volume attribute or the muted attribute has changed. Fired after the relevant attribute's setter has returned.

4.7.10.14. Security and privacy considerations

Talk about making sure interactive media files (e.g. SVG) don't have access to the container DOM (XSS potential); talk about not exposing any sensitive data like metadata from tracks in the media files (intranet snooping risk)

4.7.11 canvas 要素

分類
Embedded content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where embedded content is expected.
内容モデル:
透過
要素固有属性:
width
height
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLCanvasElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute unsigned long width;
           attribute unsigned long height;

  DOMString toDataURL();
  DOMString toDataURL(in DOMString type, [Variadic] in any args);

  DOMObject getContext(in DOMString contextId);
};

The canvas element represents a resolution-dependent bitmap canvas, which can be used for rendering graphs, game graphics, or other visual images on the fly.

Authors should not use the canvas element in a document when a more suitable element is available. For example, it is inappropriate to use a canvas element to render a page heading: if the desired presentation of the heading is graphically intense, it should be marked up using appropriate elements (typically h1) and then styled using CSS and supporting technologies such as XBL.

When authors use the canvas element, they should also provide content that, when presented to the user, conveys essentially the same function or purpose as the bitmap canvas. This content may be placed as content of the canvas element. The contents of the canvas element, if any, are the element's fallback content.

In interactive visual media, if the canvas element is with script, the canvas element represents an embedded element with a dynamically created image.

In non-interactive, static, visual media, if the canvas element has been previously painted on (e.g. if the page was viewed in an interactive visual medium and is now being printed, or if some script that ran during the page layout process painted on the element), then the canvas element represents embedded content with the current image and size. Otherwise, the element represents its fallback content instead.

In non-visual media, and in visual media if the canvas element is without script, the canvas element represents its fallback content instead.

The canvas element has two attributes to control the size of the coordinate space: width and height. These attributes, when specified, must have values that are valid non-negative integers. The rules for parsing non-negative integers must be used to obtain their numeric values. If an attribute is missing, or if parsing its value returns an error, then the default value must be used instead. The width attribute defaults to 300, and the height attribute defaults to 150.

The intrinsic dimensions of the canvas element equal the size of the coordinate space, with the numbers interpreted in CSS pixels. However, the element can be sized arbitrarily by a style sheet. During rendering, the image is scaled to fit this layout size.

The size of the coordinate space does not necessarily represent the size of the actual bitmap that the user agent will use internally or during rendering. On high-definition displays, for instance, the user agent may internally use a bitmap with two device pixels per unit in the coordinate space, so that the rendering remains at high quality throughout.

Whenever the width and height attributes are set (whether to a new value or to the previous value), the bitmap and any associated contexts must be cleared back to their initial state and reinitialized with the newly specified coordinate space dimensions.

DOM 属性 width, height は同じ名前の内容属性を反映しなければなりません

Only one square appears to be drawn in the following example:

  // canvas is a reference to a <canvas> element
  var context = canvas.getContext('2d');
  context.fillRect(0,0,50,50);
  canvas.setAttribute('width', '300'); // clears the canvas
  context.fillRect(0,100,50,50);
  canvas.width = canvas.width; // clears the canvas
  context.fillRect(100,0,50,50); // only this square remains

When the canvas is initialized it must be set to fully transparent black.

To draw on the canvas, authors must first obtain a reference to a context using the getContext(contextId) method of the canvas element.

This specification only defines one context, with the name "2d". If getContext() is called with that exact string for its contextId argument, then the UA must return a reference to an object implementing CanvasRenderingContext2D. Other specifications may define their own contexts, which would return different objects.

Vendors may also define experimental contexts using the syntax vendorname-context, for example, moz-3d.

When the UA is passed an empty string or a string specifying a context that it does not support, then it must return null. String comparisons must be case-sensitive.

Arguments other than the contextId must be ignored.

A future version of this specification will probably define a 3d context (probably based on the OpenGL ES API).

The toDataURL() method must, when called with no arguments, return a data: URL containing a representation of the image as a PNG file. [PNG].

If the canvas has no pixels (i.e. either its horizontal dimension or its vertical dimension is zero) then the method must return the string "data:,". (This is the shortest data: URL; it represents the empty string in a text/plain resource.)

The toDataURL(type) method (when called with one or more arguments) must return a data: URL containing a representation of the image in the format given by type. The possible values are MIME types with no parameters, for example image/png, image/jpeg, or even maybe image/svg+xml if the implementation actually keeps enough information to reliably render an SVG image from the canvas.

For image types that do not support an alpha channel, the image must be composited onto a solid black background using the source-over operator, and the resulting image must be the one used to create the data: URL.

Only support for image/png is required. User agents may support other types. If the user agent does not support the requested type, it must return the image using the PNG format.

User agents must convert the provided type to lower case before establishing if they support that type and before creating the data: URL.

When trying to use types other than image/png, authors can check if the image was really returned in the requested format by checking to see if the returned string starts with one the exact strings "data:image/png," or "data:image/png;". If it does, the image is PNG, and thus the requested type was not supported. (The one exception to this is if the canvas has either no height or no width, in which case the result might simply be "data:,".)

If the method is invoked with the first argument giving a type corresponding to one of the types given in the first column of the following table, and the user agent supports that type, then the subsequent arguments, if any, must be treated as described in the second cell of that row.
Type Other arguments
image/jpeg The second argument, if it is a number between 0.0 and 1.0, must be treated as the desired quality level. If it is not a number or is outside that range, the user agent must use its default value, as if the argument had been omitted.

Other arguments must be ignored and must not cause the user agent to raise an exception. A future version of this specification will probably define other parameters to be passed to toDataURL() to allow authors to more carefully control compression settings, image metadata, etc.

4.7.11.1. The 2D context

When the getContext() method of a canvas element is invoked with 2d as the argument, a CanvasRenderingContext2D object is returned.

There is only one CanvasRenderingContext2D object per canvas, so calling the getContext() method with the 2d argument a second time must return the same object.

The 2D context represents a flat Cartesian surface whose origin (0,0) is at the top left corner, with the coordinate space having x values increasing when going right, and y values increasing when going down.

interface CanvasRenderingContext2D {

  // back-reference to the canvas
  readonly attribute HTMLCanvasElement canvas;

  // state
  void save(); // push state on state stack
  void restore(); // pop state stack and restore state

  // transformations (default transform is the identity matrix)
  void scale(in float x, in float y);
  void rotate(in float angle);
  void translate(in float x, in float y);
  void transform(in float m11, in float m12, in float m21, in float m22, in float dx, in float dy);
  void setTransform(in float m11, in float m12, in float m21, in float m22, in float dx, in float dy);

  // compositing
           attribute float globalAlpha; // (default 1.0)
           attribute DOMString globalCompositeOperation; // (default source-over)

  // colors and styles
           attribute DOMObject strokeStyle; // (default black)
           attribute DOMObject fillStyle; // (default black)
  CanvasGradient createLinearGradient(in float x0, in float y0, in float x1, in float y1);
  CanvasGradient createRadialGradient(in float x0, in float y0, in float r0, in float x1, in float y1, in float r1);
  CanvasPattern createPattern(in HTMLImageElement image, in DOMString repetition);
  CanvasPattern createPattern(in HTMLCanvasElement image, in DOMString repetition);

  // line caps/joins
           attribute float lineWidth; // (default 1)
           attribute DOMString lineCap; // "butt", "round", "square" (default "butt")
           attribute DOMString lineJoin; // "round", "bevel", "miter" (default "miter")
           attribute float miterLimit; // (default 10)

  // shadows
           attribute float shadowOffsetX; // (default 0)
           attribute float shadowOffsetY; // (default 0)
           attribute float shadowBlur; // (default 0)
           attribute DOMString shadowColor; // (default transparent black)

  // rects
  void clearRect(in float x, in float y, in float w, in float h);
  void fillRect(in float x, in float y, in float w, in float h);
  void strokeRect(in float x, in float y, in float w, in float h);

  // path API
  void beginPath();
  void closePath();
  void moveTo(in float x, in float y);
  void lineTo(in float x, in float y);
  void quadraticCurveTo(in float cpx, in float cpy, in float x, in float y);
  void bezierCurveTo(in float cp1x, in float cp1y, in float cp2x, in float cp2y, in float x, in float y);
  void arcTo(in float x1, in float y1, in float x2, in float y2, in float radius);
  void rect(in float x, in float y, in float w, in float h);
  void arc(in float x, in float y, in float radius, in float startAngle, in float endAngle, in boolean anticlockwise);
  void fill();
  void stroke();
  void clip();
  boolean isPointInPath(in float x, in float y);

  // text
           attribute DOMString font; // (default 10px sans-serif)
           attribute DOMString textAlign; // "start", "end", "left", "right", "center" (default: "start")
           attribute DOMString textBaseline; // "top", "hanging", "middle", "alphabetic", "ideographic", "bottom" (default: "alphabetic")
  void fillText(in DOMString text, in float x, in float y);
  void fillText(in DOMString text, in float x, in float y, in float maxWidth);
  void strokeText(in DOMString text, in float x, in float y);
  void strokeText(in DOMString text, in float x, in float y, in float maxWidth);
  TextMetrics measureText(in DOMString text);

  // drawing images
  void drawImage(in HTMLImageElement image, in float dx, in float dy);
  void drawImage(in HTMLImageElement image, in float dx, in float dy, in float dw, in float dh);
  void drawImage(in HTMLImageElement image, in float sx, in float sy, in float sw, in float sh, in float dx, in float dy, in float dw, in float dh);
  void drawImage(in HTMLCanvasElement image, in float dx, in float dy);
  void drawImage(in HTMLCanvasElement image, in float dx, in float dy, in float dw, in float dh);
  void drawImage(in HTMLCanvasElement image, in float sx, in float sy, in float sw, in float sh, in float dx, in float dy, in float dw, in float dh);

  // pixel manipulation
  ImageData createImageData(in float sw, in float sh);
  ImageData getImageData(in float sx, in float sy, in float sw, in float sh);
  void putImageData(in ImageData imagedata, in float dx, in float dy);
  void putImageData(in ImageData imagedata, in float dx, in float dy, in float dirtyX, in float dirtyY, in float dirtyWidth, in float dirtyHeight);
};

interface CanvasGradient {
  // opaque object
  void addColorStop(in float offset, in DOMString color);
};

interface CanvasPattern {
  // opaque object
};

interface TextMetrics {
  readonly attribute float width;
};

interface ImageData {
  readonly attribute unsigned long int width;
  readonly attribute unsigned long int height;
  readonly attribute CanvasPixelArray data;
};

interface CanvasPixelArray {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] octet XXX5(in unsigned long index); 
  [IndexSetter] void XXX6(in unsigned long index, in octet value); 
};

The canvas attribute must return the canvas element that the context paints on.

Unless otherwise stated, for the 2D context interface, any method call with a numeric argument whose value is infinite or a NaN value must be ignored.

Whenever the CSS value currentColor is used as a color in this API, the "computed value of the 'color' property" for the purposes of determining the computed value of the currentColor keyword is the computed value of the 'color' property on the element in question at the time that the color is specified (e.g. when the appropriate attribute is set, or when the method is called; not when the color is rendered or otherwise used). If the computed value of the 'color' property is undefined for a particular case (e.g. because the element is not in a document), then the "computed value of the 'color' property" for the purposes of determining the computed value of the currentColor keyword is fully opaque black. [CSS3COLOR]

4.7.11.1.1. The canvas state

Each context maintains a stack of drawing states. Drawing states consist of:

The current path and the current bitmap are not part of the drawing state. The current path is persistent, and can only be reset using the beginPath() method. The current bitmap is a property of the canvas, not the context.

The save() method must push a copy of the current drawing state onto the drawing state stack.

The restore() method must pop the top entry in the drawing state stack, and reset the drawing state it describes. If there is no saved state, the method must do nothing.

4.7.11.1.2. Transformations

The transformation matrix is applied to coordinates when creating shapes and paths.

When the context is created, the transformation matrix must initially be the identity transform. It may then be adjusted using the transformation methods.

The transformations must be performed in reverse order. For instance, if a scale transformation that doubles the width is applied, followed by a rotation transformation that rotates drawing operations by a quarter turn, and a rectangle twice as wide as it is tall is then drawn on the canvas, the actual result will be a square.

The scale(x, y) method must add the scaling transformation described by the arguments to the transformation matrix. The x argument represents the scale factor in the horizontal direction and the y argument represents the scale factor in the vertical direction. The factors are multiples.

The rotate(angle) method must add the rotation transformation described by the argument to the transformation matrix. The angle argument represents a clockwise rotation angle expressed in radians.

The translate(x, y) method must add the translation transformation described by the arguments to the transformation matrix. The x argument represents the translation distance in the horizontal direction and the y argument represents the translation distance in the vertical direction. The arguments are in coordinate space units.

The transform(m11, m12, m21, m22, dx, dy) method must multiply the current transformation matrix with the matrix described by:
m11 m21 dx
m12 m22 dy
0 0 1

The setTransform(m11, m12, m21, m22, dx, dy) method must reset the current transform to the identity matrix, and then invoke the transform(m11, m12, m21, m22, dx, dy) method with the same arguments.

4.7.11.1.3. Compositing

All drawing operations are affected by the global compositing attributes, globalAlpha and globalCompositeOperation.

The globalAlpha attribute gives an alpha value that is applied to shapes and images before they are composited onto the canvas. The value must be in the range from 0.0 (fully transparent) to 1.0 (no additional transparency). If an attempt is made to set the attribute to a value outside this range, the attribute must retain its previous value. When the context is created, the globalAlpha attribute must initially have the value 1.0.

The globalCompositeOperation attribute sets how shapes and images are drawn onto the existing bitmap, once they have had globalAlpha and the current transformation matrix applied. It must be set to a value from the following list. In the descriptions below, the source image, A, is the shape or image being rendered, and the destination image, B, is the current state of the bitmap.

source-atop
A atop B. Display the source image wherever both images are opaque. Display the destination image wherever the destination image is opaque but the source image is transparent. Display transparency elsewhere.
source-in
A in B. Display the source image wherever both the source image and destination image are opaque. Display transparency elsewhere.
source-out
A out B. Display the source image wherever the source image is opaque and the destination image is transparent. Display transparency elsewhere.
source-over (default)
A over B. Display the source image wherever the source image is opaque. Display the destination image elsewhere.
destination-atop
B atop A. Same as source-atop but using the destination image instead of the source image and vice versa.
destination-in
B in A. Same as source-in but using the destination image instead of the source image and vice versa.
destination-out
B out A. Same as source-out but using the destination image instead of the source image and vice versa.
destination-over
B over A. Same as source-over but using the destination image instead of the source image and vice versa.
lighter
A plus B. Display the sum of the source image and destination image, with color values approaching 1 as a limit.
copy
A (B is ignored). Display the source image instead of the destination image.
xor
A xor B. Exclusive OR of the source image and destination image.
vendorName-operationName
Vendor-specific extensions to the list of composition operators should use this syntax.

These values are all case-sensitive — they must be used exactly as shown. User agents must not recognize values that are not a case-sensitive match for one of the values given above.

The operators in the above list must be treated as described by the Porter-Duff operator given at the start of their description (e.g. A over B). [PORTERDUFF]

On setting, if the user agent does not recognize the specified value, it must be ignored, leaving the value of globalCompositeOperation unaffected.

When the context is created, the globalCompositeOperation attribute must initially have the value source-over.

4.7.11.1.4. Colors and styles

The strokeStyle attribute represents the color or style to use for the lines around shapes, and the fillStyle attribute represents the color or style to use inside the shapes.

Both attributes can be either strings, CanvasGradients, or CanvasPatterns. On setting, strings must be parsed as CSS <color> values and the color assigned, and CanvasGradient and CanvasPattern objects must be assigned themselves. [CSS3COLOR] If the value is a string but is not a valid color, or is neither a string, a CanvasGradient, nor a CanvasPattern, then it must be ignored, and the attribute must retain its previous value.

On getting, if the value is a color, then the serialization of the color must be returned. Otherwise, if it is not a color but a CanvasGradient or CanvasPattern, then the respective object must be returned. (Such objects are opaque and therefore only useful for assigning to other attributes or for comparison to other gradients or patterns.)

The serialization of a color for a color value is a string, computed as follows: if it has alpha equal to 1.0, then the string is a lowercase six-digit hex value, prefixed with a "#" character (U+0023 NUMBER SIGN), with the first two digits representing the red component, the next two digits representing the green component, and the last two digits representing the blue component, the digits being in the range 0-9 a-f (U+0030 to U+0039 and U+0061 to U+0066). Otherwise, the color value has alpha less than 1.0, and the string is the color value in the CSS rgba() functional-notation format: the literal string rgba (U+0072 U+0067 U+0062 U+0061) followed by a U+0028 LEFT PARENTHESIS, a base-ten integer in the range 0-255 representing the red component (using digits 0-9, U+0030 to U+0039, in the shortest form possible), a literal U+002C COMMA and U+0020 SPACE, an integer for the green component, a comma and a space, an integer for the blue component, another comma and space, a U+0030 DIGIT ZERO, a U+002E FULL STOP (representing the decimal point), one or more digits in the range 0-9 (U+0030 to U+0039) representing the fractional part of the alpha value, and finally a U+0029 RIGHT PARENTHESIS.

When the context is created, the strokeStyle and fillStyle attributes must initially have the string value #000000.

There are two types of gradients, linear gradients and radial gradients, both represented by objects implementing the opaque CanvasGradient interface.

Once a gradient has been created (see below), stops are placed along it to define how the colors are distributed along the gradient. The color of the gradient at each stop is the color specified for that stop. Between each such stop, the colors and the alpha component must be linearly interpolated over the RGBA space without premultiplying the alpha value to find the color to use at that offset. Before the first stop, the color must be the color of the first stop. After the last stop, the color must be the color of the last stop. When there are no stops, the gradient is transparent black.

The addColorStop(offset, color) method on the CanvasGradient interface adds a new stop to a gradient. If the offset is less than 0, greater than 1, infinite, or NaN, then an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception must be raised. If the color cannot be parsed as a CSS color, then a SYNTAX_ERR exception must be raised. Otherwise, the gradient must have a new stop placed, at offset offset relative to the whole gradient, and with the color obtained by parsing color as a CSS <color> value. If multiple stops are added at the same offset on a gradient, they must be placed in the order added, with the first one closest to the start of the gradient, and each subsequent one infinitesimally further along towards the end point (in effect causing all but the first and last stop added at each point to be ignored).

The createLinearGradient(x0, y0, x1, y1) method takes four arguments that represent the start point (x0, y0) and end point (x1, y1) of the gradient. If any of the arguments to createLinearGradient() are infinite or NaN, the method must raise a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception. Otherwise, the method must return a linear CanvasGradient initialized with the specified line.

Linear gradients must be rendered such that all points on a line perpendicular to the line that crosses the start and end points have the color at the point where those two lines cross (with the colors coming from the interpolation and extrapolation described above). The points in the linear gradient must be transformed as described by the current transformation matrix when rendering.

If x0 = x1 and y0 = y1, then the linear gradient must paint nothing.

The createRadialGradient(x0, y0, r0, x1, y1, r1) method takes six arguments, the first three representing the start circle with origin (x0, y0) and radius r0, and the last three representing the end circle with origin (x1, y1) and radius r1. The values are in coordinate space units. If any of the arguments are infinite or NaN, a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception must be raised. If either of r0 or r1 are negative, an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception must be raised. Otherwise, the method must return a radial CanvasGradient initialized with the two specified circles.

Radial gradients must be rendered by following these steps:

  1. If x0 = x1 and y0 = y1 and r0 = r1, then the radial gradient must paint nothing. Abort these steps.

  2. Let x(ω) = (x1-x0)ω + x0

    Let y(ω) = (y1-y0)ω + y0

    Let r(ω) = (r1-r0)ω + r0

    Let the color at ω be the color at that position on the gradient (with the colors coming from the interpolation and extrapolation described above).

  3. For all values of ω where r(ω) > 0, starting with the value of ω nearest to positive infinity and ending with the value of ω nearest to negative infinity, draw the circumference of the circle with radius r(ω) at position (x(ω), y(ω)), with the color at ω, but only painting on the parts of the canvas that have not yet been painted on by earlier circles in this step for this rendering of the gradient.

This effectively creates a cone, touched by the two circles defined in the creation of the gradient, with the part of the cone before the start circle (0.0) using the color of the first offset, the part of the cone after the end circle (1.0) using the color of the last offset, and areas outside the cone untouched by the gradient (transparent black).

Gradients must be painted only where the relevant stroking or filling effects requires that they be drawn.

The points in the radial gradient must be transformed as described by the current transformation matrix when rendering.

Patterns are represented by objects implementing the opaque CanvasPattern interface.

To create objects of this type, the createPattern(image, repetition) method is used. The first argument gives the image to use as the pattern (either an HTMLImageElement or an HTMLCanvasElement). Modifying this image after calling the createPattern() method must not affect the pattern. The second argument must be a string with one of the following values: repeat, repeat-x, repeat-y, no-repeat. If the empty string or null is specified, repeat must be assumed. If an unrecognized value is given, then the user agent must raise a SYNTAX_ERR exception. User agents must recognize the four values described above exactly (e.g. they must not do case folding). The method must return a CanvasPattern object suitably initialized.

引数 imageHTMLImageElement または HTMLCanvasElement の実現値でなければなりませんimage が誤った型や null である場合、実装は TYPE_MISMATCH_ERR 例外を発生させなければなりません

image 引数が HTMLImageElement であって complete 属性が偽である場合、 実装は INVALID_STATE_ERR 例外を発生させなければなりません

If the image argument is an HTMLCanvasElement object with either a horizontal dimension or a vertical dimension equal to zero, then the implementation must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception.

Patterns must be painted so that the top left of the first image is anchored at the origin of the coordinate space, and images are then repeated horizontally to the left and right (if the repeat-x string was specified) or vertically up and down (if the repeat-y string was specified) or in all four directions all over the canvas (if the repeat string was specified). The images are not scaled by this process; one CSS pixel of the image must be painted on one coordinate space unit. Of course, patterns must actually be painted only where the stroking or filling effect requires that they be drawn, and are affected by the current transformation matrix.

When the createPattern() method is passed, as its image argument, an animated image, the poster frame of the animation, or the first frame of the animation if there is no poster frame, must be used.

4.7.11.1.5. Line styles

The lineWidth attribute gives the width of lines, in coordinate space units. On setting, zero, negative, infinite, and NaN values must be ignored, leaving the value unchanged.

When the context is created, the lineWidth attribute must initially have the value 1.0.

The lineCap attribute defines the type of endings that UAs will place on the end of lines. The three valid values are butt, round, and square. The butt value means that the end of each line has a flat edge perpendicular to the direction of the line (and that no additional line cap is added). The round value means that a semi-circle with the diameter equal to the width of the line must then be added on to the end of the line. The square value means that a rectangle with the length of the line width and the width of half the line width, placed flat against the edge perpendicular to the direction of the line, must be added at the end of each line. On setting, any other value than the literal strings butt, round, and square must be ignored, leaving the value unchanged.

When the context is created, the lineCap attribute must initially have the value butt.

The lineJoin attribute defines the type of corners that UAs will place where two lines meet. The three valid values are bevel, round, and miter.

On setting, any other value than the literal strings bevel, round, and miter must be ignored, leaving the value unchanged.

When the context is created, the lineJoin attribute must initially have the value miter.

A join exists at any point in a subpath shared by two consecutive lines. When a subpath is closed, then a join also exists at its first point (equivalent to its last point) connecting the first and last lines in the subpath.

In addition to the point where the join occurs, two additional points are relevant to each join, one for each line: the two corners found half the line width away from the join point, one perpendicular to each line, each on the side furthest from the other line.

A filled triangle connecting these two opposite corners with a straight line, with the third point of the triangle being the join point, must be rendered at all joins. The lineJoin attribute controls whether anything else is rendered. The three aforementioned values have the following meanings:

The bevel value means that this is all that is rendered at joins.

The round value means that a filled arc connecting the two aforementioned corners of the join, abutting (and not overlapping) the aforementioned triangle, with the diameter equal to the line width and the origin at the point of the join, must be rendered at joins.

The miter value means that a second filled triangle must (if it can given the miter length) be rendered at the join, with one line being the line between the two aforementioned corners, abutting the first triangle, and the other two being continuations of the outside edges of the two joining lines, as long as required to intersect without going over the miter length.

The miter length is the distance from the point where the lines touch on the inside of the join to the intersection of the line edges on the outside of the join. The miter limit ratio is the maximum allowed ratio of the miter length to half the line width. If the miter length would cause the miter limit ratio to be exceeded, this second triangle must not be rendered.

The miter limit ratio can be explicitly set using the miterLimit attribute. On setting, zero, negative, infinite, and NaN values must be ignored, leaving the value unchanged.

When the context is created, the miterLimit attribute must initially have the value 10.0.

4.7.11.1.6. Shadows

All drawing operations are affected by the four global shadow attributes.

The shadowColor attribute sets the color of the shadow.

When the context is created, the shadowColor attribute initially must be fully-transparent black.

On getting, the serialization of the color must be returned.

On setting, the new value must be parsed as a CSS <color> value and the color assigned. If the value is not a valid color, then it must be ignored, and the attribute must retain its previous value. [CSS3COLOR]

The shadowOffsetX and shadowOffsetY attributes specify the distance that the shadow will be offset in the positive horizontal and positive vertical distance respectively. Their values are in coordinate space units. They are not affected by the current transformation matrix.

When the context is created, the shadow offset attributes must initially have the value 0.

On getting, they must return their current value. On setting, the attribute being set must be set to the new value, except if the value is infinite or NaN, in which case the new value must be ignored.

The shadowBlur attribute specifies the size of the blurring effect. (The units do not map to coordinate space units, and are not affected by the current transformation matrix.)

When the context is created, the shadowBlur attribute must initially have the value 0.

On getting, the attribute must return its current value. On setting the attribute must be set to the new value, except if the value is negative, infinite or NaN, in which case the new value must be ignored.

When shadows are drawn, they must be rendered as follows:

  1. Let A be the source image for which a shadow is being created.

  2. Let B be an infinite transparent black bitmap, with a coordinate space and an origin identical to A.

  3. Copy the alpha channel of A to B, offset by shadowOffsetX in the positive x direction, and shadowOffsetY in the positive y direction.

  4. If shadowBlur is greater than 0:

    1. If shadowBlur is less than 8, let σ be half the value of shadowBlur; otherwise, let σ be the square root of multiplying the value of shadowBlur by 2.

    2. Perform a 2D Gaussian Blur on B, using σ as the standard deviation.

    User agents may limit values of σ to an implementation-specific maximum value to avoid exceeding hardware limitations during the Gaussian blur operation.

  5. Set the red, green, and blue components of every pixel in B to the red, green, and blue components (respectively) of the color of shadowColor.

  6. Multiply the alpha component of every pixel in B by the alpha component of the color of shadowColor.

  7. The shadow is in the bitmap B, and is rendered as part of the drawing model described below.

4.7.11.1.7. Simple shapes (rectangles)

There are three methods that immediately draw rectangles to the bitmap. They each take four arguments; the first two give the x and y coordinates of the top left of the rectangle, and the second two give the width w and height h of the rectangle, respectively.

The current transformation matrix must be applied to the following four coordinates, which form the path that must then be closed to get the specified rectangle: (x, y), (x+w, y), (x+w, y+h), (x, y+h).

Shapes are painted without affecting the current path, and are subject to the clipping region, and, with the exception of clearRect(), also shadow effects, global alpha, and global composition operators.

The clearRect(x, y, w, h) method must clear the pixels in the specified rectangle that also intersect the current clipping region to a fully transparent black, erasing any previous image. If either height or width are zero, this method has no effect.

The fillRect(x, y, w, h) method must paint the specified rectangular area using the fillStyle. If either height or width are zero, this method has no effect.

The strokeRect(x, y, w, h) method must stroke the specified rectangle's path using the strokeStyle, lineWidth, lineJoin, and (if appropriate) miterLimit attributes. If both height and width are zero, this method has no effect, since there is no path to stroke (it's a point). If only one of the two is zero, then the method will draw a line instead (the path for the outline is just a straight line along the non-zero dimension).

4.7.11.1.8. Complex shapes (paths)

The context always has a current path. There is only one current path, it is not part of the drawing state.

A path has a list of zero or more subpaths. Each subpath consists of a list of one or more points, connected by straight or curved lines, and a flag indicating whether the subpath is closed or not. A closed subpath is one where the last point of the subpath is connected to the first point of the subpath by a straight line. Subpaths with fewer than two points are ignored when painting the path.

Initially, the context's path must have zero subpaths.

The points and lines added to the path by these methods must be transformed according to the current transformation matrix as they are added.

The beginPath() method must empty the list of subpaths so that the context once again has zero subpaths.

The moveTo(x, y) method must create a new subpath with the specified point as its first (and only) point.

The closePath() method must do nothing if the context has no subpaths. Otherwise, it must mark the last subpath as closed, create a new subpath whose first point is the same as the previous subpath's first point, and finally add this new subpath to the path. (If the last subpath had more than one point in its list of points, then this is equivalent to adding a straight line connecting the last point back to the first point, thus "closing" the shape, and then repeating the last moveTo() call.)

New points and the lines connecting them are added to subpaths using the methods described below. In all cases, the methods only modify the last subpath in the context's paths.

The lineTo(x, y) method must do nothing if the context has no subpaths. Otherwise, it must connect the last point in the subpath to the given point (x, y) using a straight line, and must then add the given point (x, y) to the subpath.

The quadraticCurveTo(cpx, cpy, x, y) method must do nothing if the context has no subpaths. Otherwise it must connect the last point in the subpath to the given point (x, y) using a quadratic Bézier curve with control point (cpx, cpy), and must then add the given point (x, y) to the subpath. [BEZIER]

The bezierCurveTo(cp1x, cp1y, cp2x, cp2y, x, y) method must do nothing if the context has no subpaths. Otherwise, it must connect the last point in the subpath to the given point (x, y) using a cubic Bézier curve with control points (cp1x, cp1y) and (cp2x, cp2y). Then, it must add the point (x, y) to the subpath. [BEZIER]

The arcTo(x1, y1, x2, y2, radius) method must do nothing if the context has no subpaths. If the context does have a subpath, then the behavior depends on the arguments and the last point in the subpath.

Negative values for radius must cause the implementation to raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

Let the point (x0, y0) be the last point in the subpath.

If the point (x0, y0) is equal to the point (x1, y1), or if the point (x1, y1) is equal to the point (x2, y2), or if the radius radius is zero, then the method must add the point (x1, y1) to the subpath, and connect that point to the previous point (x0, y0) by a straight line.

Otherwise, if the points (x0, y0), (x1, y1), and (x2, y2) all lie on a single straight line, then: if the direction from (x0, y0) to (x1, y1) is the same as the direction from (x1, y1) to (x2, y2), then the method must add the point (x1, y1) to the subpath, and connect that point to the previous point (x0, y0) by a straight line; otherwise, the direction from (x0, y0) to (x1, y1) is the opposite of the direction from (x1, y1) to (x2, y2), and the method must add a point (x, y) to the subpath, and connect that point to the previous point (x0, y0) by a straight line, where (x, y) is the point that is infinitely far away from (x1, y1), that lies on the same line as (x0, y0), (x1, y1), and (x2, y2), and that is on the same side of (x1, y1) on that line as (x2, y2).

Otherwise, let The Arc be the shortest arc given by circumference of the circle that has radius radius, and that has one point tangent to the half-infinite line that crosses the point (x0, y0) and ends at the point (x1, y1), and that has a different point tangent to the half-infinite line that ends at the point (x1, y1) and crosses the point (x2, y2). The points at which this circle touches these two lines are called the start and end tangent points respectively.

The method must connect the point (x0, y0) to the start tangent point by a straight line, adding the start tangent point to the subpath, and then must connect the start tangent point to the end tangent point by The Arc, adding the end tangent point to the subpath.

The arc(x, y, radius, startAngle, endAngle, anticlockwise) method draws an arc. If the context has any subpaths, then the method must add a straight line from the last point in the subpath to the start point of the arc. In any case, it must draw the arc between the start point of the arc and the end point of the arc, and add the start and end points of the arc to the subpath. The arc and its start and end points are defined as follows:

Consider a circle that has its origin at (x, y) and that has radius radius. The points at startAngle and endAngle along this circle's circumference, measured in radians clockwise from the positive x-axis, are the start and end points respectively.

If the anticlockwise argument is false and endAngle-startAngle is equal to or greater than , or, if the anticlockwise argument is true and startAngle-endAngle is equal to or greater than , then the arc is the whole circumference of this circle.

Otherwise, the arc is the path along the circumference of this circle from the start point to the end point, going anti-clockwise if the anticlockwise argument is true, and clockwise otherwise. Since the points are on the circle, as opposed to being simply angles from zero, the arc can never cover an angle greater than radians. If the two points are the same, or if the radius is zero, then the arc is defined as being of zero length in both directions.

Negative values for radius must cause the implementation to raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

The rect(x, y, w, h) method must create a new subpath containing just the four points (x, y), (x+w, y), (x+w, y+h), (x, y+h), with those four points connected by straight lines, and must then mark the subpath as closed. It must then create a new subpath with the point (x, y) as the only point in the subpath.

The fill() method must fill all the subpaths of the current path, using fillStyle, and using the non-zero winding number rule. Open subpaths must be implicitly closed when being filled (without affecting the actual subpaths).

Thus, if two overlapping but otherwise independent subpaths have opposite windings, they cancel out and result in no fill. If they have the same winding, that area just gets painted once.

The stroke() method must calculate the strokes of all the subpaths of the current path, using the lineWidth, lineCap, lineJoin, and (if appropriate) miterLimit attributes, and then fill the combined stroke area using the strokeStyle attribute.

Since the subpaths are all stroked as one, overlapping parts of the paths in one stroke operation are treated as if their union was what was painted.

Paths, when filled or stroked, must be painted without affecting the current path, and must be subject to shadow effects, global alpha, the clipping region, and global composition operators. (Transformations affect the path when the path is created, not when it is painted, though the stroke style is still affected by the transformation during painting.)

Zero-length line segments must be pruned before stroking a path. Empty subpaths must be ignored.

The clip() method must create a new clipping region by calculating the intersection of the current clipping region and the area described by the current path, using the non-zero winding number rule. Open subpaths must be implicitly closed when computing the clipping region, without affecting the actual subpaths. The new clipping region replaces the current clipping region.

When the context is initialized, the clipping region must be set to the rectangle with the top left corner at (0,0) and the width and height of the coordinate space.

The isPointInPath(x, y) method must return true if the point given by the x and y coordinates passed to the method, when treated as coordinates in the canvas coordinate space unaffected by the current transformation, is inside the current path as determined by the non-zero winding number rule; and must return false otherwise. Points on the path itself are considered to be inside the path. If either of the arguments is infinite or NaN, then the method must return false.

4.7.11.1.9. Text

The font DOM attribute, on setting, must be parsed the same way as the 'font' property of CSS (but without supporting property-independent stylesheet syntax like 'inherit'), and the resulting font must be assigned to the context, with the 'line-height' component forced to 'normal'. [CSS]

Font names must be interpreted in the context of the canvas element's stylesheets; any fonts embedded using @font-face must therefore be available. [CSSWEBFONTS]

Only vector fonts should be used by the user agent; if a user agent were to use bitmap fonts then transformations would likely make the font look very ugly.

On getting, the font attribute must return the serialized form of the current font of the context. [CSSOM]

When the context is created, the font of the context must be set to 10px sans-serif. When the 'font-size' component is set to lengths using percentages, 'em' or 'ex' units, or the 'larger' or 'smaller' keywords, these must be interpreted relative to the computed value of the 'font-size' property of the corresponding canvas element at the time that the attribute is set. When the 'font-weight' component is set to the relative values 'bolder' and 'lighter', these must be interpreted relative to the computed value of the 'font-weight' property of the corresponding canvas element at the time that the attribute is set. If the computed values are undefined for a particular case (e.g. because the canvas element is not in a document), then the relative keywords must be interpreted relative to the normal-weight 10px sans-serif default.

The textAlign DOM attribute, on getting, must return the current value. On setting, if the value is one of start, end, left, right, or center, then the value must be changed to the new value. Otherwise, the new value must be ignored. When the context is created, the textAlign attribute must initially have the value start.

The textBaseline DOM attribute, on getting, must return the current value. On setting, if the value is one of top, hanging, middle, alphabetic, ideographic, or bottom, then the value must be changed to the new value. Otherwise, the new value must be ignored. When the context is created, the textBaseline attribute must initially have the value alphabetic.

The textBaseline attribute's allowed keywords correspond to alignment points in the font:

The top of the em square is roughly at the top of the glyphs
   in a font, the hanging baseline is where some glyphs like आ are
   anchored, the middle is half-way between the top of the em square and the
   bottom of the em square, the alphabetic baseline is where characters like
   Á, ÿ, f, and Ω are anchored, the ideographic
   baseline is where glyphs like 私 and 達 are anchored, and the
   bottom of the em square is roughly at the bottom of the glyphs in a font.
   The top and bottom of the bounding box can be far from these baselines,
   due to glyphs extending far outside the em square.

The keywords map to these alignment points as follows:

top
The top of the em square
hanging
The hanging baseline
middle
The middle of the em square
alphabetic
The alphabetic baseline
ideographic
The ideographic baseline
bottom
The bottom of the em square

The fillText() and strokeText() methods take three or four arguments, text, x, y, and optionally maxWidth, and render the given text at the given (x, y) coordinates ensuring that the text isn't wider than maxWidth if specified, using the current font, textAlign, and textBaseline values. Specifically, when the methods are called, the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. Let font be the current font of the browsing context, as given by the font attribute.

  2. Replace all the space characters in text with U+0020 SPACE characters.

  3. Form a hypothetical infinitely wide CSS line box containing a single inline box containing the text text, with all the properties at their initial values except the 'font' property of the inline box set to font and the 'direction' property of the inline box set to the directionality of the canvas element. [CSS]

  4. If the maxWidth argument was specified and the hypothetical width of the inline box in the hypothetical line box is greater than maxWidth CSS pixels, then change font to have a more condensed font (if one is available or if a reasonably readable one can be synthesized by applying a horizontal scale factor to the font) or a smaller font, and return to the previous step.

  5. Let the anchor point be a point on the inline box, determined by the textAlign and textBaseline values, as follows:

    Horizontal position:

    If textAlign is left
    If textAlign is start and the directionality of the canvas element is 'ltr'
    If textAlign is end and the directionality of the canvas element is 'rtl'
    Let the anchor point's horizontal position be the left edge of the inline box.
    If textAlign is right
    If textAlign is end and the directionality of the canvas element is 'ltr'
    If textAlign is start and the directionality of the canvas element is 'rtl'
    Let the anchor point's horizontal position be the right edge of the inline box.
    If textAlign is center
    Let the anchor point's horizontal position be half way between the left and right edges of the inline box.

    Vertical position:

    If textBaseline is top
    Let the anchor point's vertical position be the top of the em box of the first available font of the inline box.
    If textBaseline is hanging
    Let the anchor point's vertical position be the hanging baseline of the first available font of the inline box.
    If textBaseline is middle
    Let the anchor point's vertical position be half way between the bottom and the top of the em box of the first available font of the inline box.
    If textBaseline is alphabetic
    Let the anchor point's vertical position be the alphabetic baseline of the first available font of the inline box.
    If textBaseline is ideographic
    Let the anchor point's vertical position be the ideographic baseline of the first available font of the inline box.
    If textBaseline is bottom
    Let the anchor point's vertical position be the bottom of the em box of the first available font of the inline box.
  6. Paint the hypothetical inline box as the shape given by the text's glyphs, as transformed by the current transformation matrix, and anchored and sized so that before applying the current transformation matrix, the anchor point is at (x, y) and each CSS pixel is mapped to one coordinate space unit.

    For fillText() fillStyle must be applied to the glyphs and strokeStyle must be ignored. For strokeText() the reverse holds and strokeStyle must be applied to the glyph outlines and fillStyle must be ignored.

    Text is painted without affecting the current path, and is subject to shadow effects, global alpha, the clipping region, and global composition operators.

The measureText() method takes one argument, text. When the method is invoked, the user agent must replace all the space characters in text with U+0020 SPACE characters, and then must form a hypothetical infinitely wide CSS line box containing a single inline box containing the text text, with all the properties at their initial values except the 'font' property of the inline element set to the current font of the browsing context, as given by the font attribute, and must then return a new TextMetrics object with its width attribute set to the width of that inline box, in CSS pixels. [CSS]

The TextMetrics interface is used for the objects returned from measureText(). It has one attribute, width, which is set by the measureText() method.

Glyphs rendered using fillText() and strokeText() can spill out of the box given by the font size (the em square size) and the width returned by measureText() (the text width). This version of the specification does not provide a way to obtain the bounding box dimensions of the text. If the text is to be rendered and removed, care needs to be taken to replace the entire area of the canvas that the clipping region covers, not just the box given by the em square height and measured text width.

A future version of the 2D context API may provide a way to render fragments of documents, rendered using CSS, straight to the canvas. This would be provided in preference to a dedicated way of doing multiline layout.

4.7.11.1.10. 画像

メソッド drawImage は画布上に画像を描画するために使用することができます。

このメソッドは、drawImage(image, dx, dy)drawImage(image, dx, dy, dw, dh)drawImage(image, sx, sy, sw, sh, dx, dy, dw, dh) の3通りに多重定義されています。(実際には 6通りで、3通りのいずれの場合も、 image 引数に HTMLImageElementHTMLCanvasElement のいずれかを指定できます。) 引数 dw および dh は、 指定されていない場合、既定値として、 swsh の値を使用しなければなりません。 その場合、画像中の 1 CSS 画素が画布座標空間上の1単位として処理されることとなります。 引数 sxsyswsh が省略された場合、 それぞれ既定値の 0、0、画像の画素における画像の内在幅、 画像の画素における画像の内在高としなければなりません

引数 imageHTMLImageElement または HTMLCanvasElement の実現値でなければなりませんimage が誤った型や null である場合、実装は TYPE_MISMATCH_ERR 例外を発生させなければなりません

image 引数が HTMLImageElement であって complete 属性が偽である場合、 実装は INVALID_STATE_ERR 例外を発生させなければなりません

原始矩形は、その頂点が4点 (sx, sy), (sx+sw, sy), (sx+sw, sy+sh), (sx, sy+sh) であるような矩形です。

原始矩形が原始画像中に完全に収まっていない場合、 または引数 sw または sh の1つが零である場合、実装は INDEX_SIZE_ERR 例外を発生させなければなりません

目的矩形は、その頂点が4点 (dx, dy), (dx+dw, dy), (dx+dw, dy+dh), (dx, dy+dh) であるような矩形です。

drawImage() が呼び出されたとき、 原始矩形で指定される画像上の領域は、 現在変形行列を目的矩形の点に適用した後、 目的矩形で指定される画布上の領域に塗られなければなりません

画布がそれ自体に塗られるとき、この描画モデルに従うと原始画像は画布上に重ねて描画する以前に複写されなければなりませんから、 画布の一部分をそれと重複する部分に複写することが可能です。

drawImage() メソッドが image 引数にアニメーション画像を引き渡されたとき、 そのアニメーションのポスター枠か、ポスター枠がない場合には最初の枠が使用されなければなりません

画像は現在経路に影響せずに塗られ、影効果大域アルファくり抜き領域大域合成操作の対象でもあります。

4.7.11.1.11. Pixel manipulation

The createImageData(sw, sh) method must return an ImageData object representing a rectangle with a width in CSS pixels equal to the absolute magnitude of sw and a height in CSS pixels equal to the absolute magnitude of sh, filled with transparent black.

The getImageData(sx, sy, sw, sh) method must return an ImageData object representing the underlying pixel data for the area of the canvas denoted by the rectangle whose corners are the four points (sx, sy), (sx+sw, sy), (sx+sw, sy+sh), (sx, sy+sh), in canvas coordinate space units. Pixels outside the canvas must be returned as transparent black. Pixels must be returned as non-premultiplied alpha values.

If any of the arguments to createImageData() or getImageData() are infinite or NaN, the method must instead raise a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception. If either the sw or sh arguments are zero, the method must instead raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

ImageData objects must be initialized so that their width attribute is set to w, the number of physical device pixels per row in the image data, their height attribute is set to h, the number of rows in the image data, and their data attribute is initialized to a CanvasPixelArray object holding the image data. At least one pixel's worth of image data must be returned.

The CanvasPixelArray object provides ordered, indexed access to the color components of each pixel of the image data. The data must be represented in left-to-right order, row by row top to bottom, starting with the top left, with each pixel's red, green, blue, and alpha components being given in that order for each pixel. Each component of each device pixel represented in this array must be in the range 0..255, representing the 8 bit value for that component. The components must be assigned consecutive indices starting with 0 for the top left pixel's red component.

The CanvasPixelArray object thus represents h×w×4 integers. The length attribute of a CanvasPixelArray object must return this number.

The XXX5(index) method must return the value of the indexth component in the array.

The XXX6(index, value) method must set the value of the indexth component in the array to value. JS undefined values must be converted to zero. Other values must first be converted to numbers using JavaScript's ToNumber algorithm, and if the result is a NaN value, then the value be must converted to zero. If the result is less than 0, it must be clamped to zero. If the result is more than 255, it must be clamped to 255. If the number is not an integer, it should be rounded to the nearest integer using the IEEE 754r convertToIntegerTiesToEven rounding mode. [ECMA262] [IEEE754R]

The above is not intended to cause these methods to get any unusual behaviour, it's just supposed to be the normal behaviour for passing values to a method expecting an octet type.

The width and height (w and h) might be different from the sw and sh arguments to the above methods, e.g. if the canvas is backed by a high-resolution bitmap, or if the sw and sh arguments are negative.

The putImageData(imagedata, dx, dy) and putImageData(imagedata, dx, dy, dirtyX, dirtyY, dirtyWidth, dirtyHeight) methods write data from ImageData structures back to the canvas.

If any of the arguments to the method are infinite or NaN, the method must raise a NOT_SUPPORTED_ERR exception.

If the first argument to the method is null or not an ImageData object then the putImageData() method must raise a TYPE_MISMATCH_ERR exception.

When the last four arguments are omitted, they must be assumed to have the values 0, 0, the width member of the imagedata structure, and the height member of the imagedata structure, respectively.

When invoked with arguments that do not, per the last few paragraphs, cause an exception to be raised, the putImageData() method must act as follows:

  1. Let dxdevice be the x-coordinate of the device pixel in the underlying pixel data of the canvas corresponding to the dx coordinate in the canvas coordinate space.

    Let dydevice be the y-coordinate of the device pixel in the underlying pixel data of the canvas corresponding to the dy coordinate in the canvas coordinate space.

  2. If dirtyWidth is negative, let dirtyX be dirtyX+dirtyWidth, and let dirtyWidth be equal to the absolute magnitude of dirtyWidth.

    If dirtyHeight is negative, let dirtyY be dirtyY+dirtyHeight, and let dirtyHeight be equal to the absolute magnitude of dirtyHeight.

  3. If dirtyX is negative, let dirtyWidth be dirtyWidth+dirtyX, and let dirtyX be zero.

    If dirtyY is negative, let dirtyHeight be dirtyHeight+dirtyY, and let dirtyY be zero.

  4. If dirtyX+dirtyWidth is greater than the width attribute of the imagedata argument, let dirtyWidth be the value of that width attribute, minus the value of dirtyX.

    If dirtyY+dirtyHeight is greater than the height attribute of the imagedata argument, let dirtyHeight be the value of that height attribute, minus the value of dirtyY.

  5. If, after those changes, either dirtyWidth or dirtyHeight is negative or zero, stop these steps without affecting the canvas.

  6. Otherwise, for all integer values of x and y where dirtyX ≤ x < dirtyX+dirtyWidth and dirtyY ≤ y < dirtyY+dirtyHeight, copy the four channels of the pixel with coordinate (x, y) in the imagedata data structure to the pixel with coordinate (dxdevice+x, dydevice+y) in the underlying pixel data of the canvas.

The handling of pixel rounding when the specified coordinates do not exactly map to the device coordinate space is not defined by this specification, except that the following must result in no visible changes to the rendering:

context.putImageData(context.getImageData(x, y, w, h), x, y);

...for any value of x, y, w, and h, and the following two calls:

context.createImageData(w, h);
context.getImageData(0, 0, w, h);

...must return ImageData objects with the same dimensions, for any value of w and h. In other words, while user agents may round the arguments of these methods so that they map to device pixel boundaries, any rounding performed must be performed consistently for all of the createImageData(), getImageData() and putImageData() operations.

The current path, transformation matrix, shadow attributes, global alpha, the clipping region, and global composition operator must not affect the getImageData() and putImageData() methods.

The data returned by getImageData() is at the resolution of the canvas backing store, which is likely to not be one device pixel to each CSS pixel if the display used is a high resolution display.

In the following example, the script generates an ImageData object so that it can draw onto it.

// canvas is a reference to a <canvas> element
var context = canvas.getContext('2d');

// create a blank slate
var data = context.createImageData(canvas.width, canvas.height);

// create some plasma
FillPlasma(data, 'green'); // green plasma

// add a cloud to the plasma
AddCloud(data, data.width/2, data.height/2); // put a cloud in the middle

// paint the plasma+cloud on the canvas
context.putImageData(data, 0, 0);

// support methods
function FillPlasma(data, color) { ... }
function AddCloud(data, x, y) { ... }

Here is an example of using getImageData() and putImageData() to implement an edge detection filter.

<!DOCTYPE HTML>
<html>
 <head>
  <title>Edge detection demo</title>
  <script>
   var image = new Image();
   function init() {
     image.onload = demo;
     image.src = "image.jpeg";
   }
   function demo() {
     var canvas = document.getElementsByTagName('canvas')[0];
     var context = canvas.getContext('2d');

     // draw the image onto the canvas
     context.drawImage(image, 0, 0);

     // get the image data to manipulate
     var input = context.getImageData(0, 0, canvas.width, canvas.height);

     // get an empty slate to put the data into
     var output = context.crateImageData(canvas.width, canvas.height);

     // alias some variables for convenience
     // notice that we are using input.width and input.height here
     // as they might not be the same as canvas.width and canvas.height
     // (in particular, they might be different on high-res displays)
     var w = input.width, h = input.height;
     var inputData = input.data;
     var outputData = output.data;

     // edge detection
     for (var y = 1; y < h-1; y += 1) {
       for (var x = 1; x < w-1; x += 1) {
         for (var c = 0; c < 3; c += 1) {
           var i = (y*w + x)*4 + c;
           outputData[i] = 127 + -inputData[i - w*4 - 4] -   inputData[i - w*4] - inputData[i - w*4 + 4] +
                                 -inputData[i - 4]       + 8*inputData[i]       - inputData[i + 4] +
                                 -inputData[i + w*4 - 4] -   inputData[i + w*4] - inputData[i + w*4 + 4];
         }
         outputData[(y*w + x)*4 + 3] = 255; // alpha
       }
     }

     // put the image data back after manipulation
     context.putImageData(output, 0, 0);
   }
  </script>
 </head>
 <body onload="init()">
  <canvas></canvas>
 </body>
</html>
4.7.11.1.12. Drawing model

When a shape or image is painted, user agents must follow these steps, in the order given (or act as if they do):

  1. Render the shape or image, creating image A, as described in the previous sections. For shapes, the current fill, stroke, and line styles must be honored, and the stroke must itself also be subjected to the current transformation matrix.

  2. Render the shadow from image A, using the current shadow styles, creating image B.

  3. Multiply the alpha component of every pixel in B by globalAlpha.

  4. Within the clipping region, composite B over the current canvas bitmap using the current composition operator.

  5. Multiply the alpha component of every pixel in A by globalAlpha.

  6. Within the clipping region, composite A over the current canvas bitmap using the current composition operator.

4.7.11.2. Color spaces and color correction

The canvas APIs must perform color correction at only two points: when rendering images with their own gamma correction and color space information onto the canvas, to convert the image to the color space used by the canvas (e.g. using the drawImage() method with an HTMLImageElement object), and when rendering the actual canvas bitmap to the output device.

Thus, in the 2D context, colors used to draw shapes onto the canvas will exactly match colors obtained through the getImageData() method.

The toDataURL() method must not include color space information in the resource returned. Where the output format allows it, the color of pixels in resources created by toDataURL() must match those returned by the getImageData() method.

In user agents that support CSS, the color space used by a canvas element must match the color space used for processing any colors for that element in CSS.

The gamma correction and color space information of images must be handled in such a way that an image rendered directly using an img element would use the same colors as one painted on a canvas element that is then itself rendered. Furthermore, the rendering of images that have no color correction information (such as those returned by the toDataURL() method) must be rendered with no color correction.

Thus, in the 2D context, calling the drawImage() method to render the output of the toDataURL() method to the canvas, given the appropriate dimensions, has no visible effect.

4.7.11.3. Security with canvas elements

Information leakage can occur if scripts from one origin can access information (e.g. read pixels) from images from another origin (one that isn't the same).

To mitigate this, canvas elements are defined to have a flag indicating whether they are origin-clean. All canvas elements must start with their origin-clean set to true. The flag must be set to false if any of the following actions occur:

Whenever the toDataURL() method of a canvas element whose origin-clean flag is set to false is called, the method must raise a security exception.

Whenever the getImageData() method of the 2D context of a canvas element whose origin-clean flag is set to false is called with otherwise correct arguments, the method must raise a security exception.

Even resetting the canvas state by changing its width or height attributes doesn't reset the origin-clean flag.

4.7.12 map 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
name
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLMapElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString name;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection areas;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection images;
};

The map element, in conjunction with any area element descendants, defines an image map.

The name attribute gives the map a name so that it can be referenced. The attribute must be present and must have a non-empty value. Whitespace is significant in this attribute's value. If the id attribute is also specified, both attributes must have the same value.

The areas attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the map element, whose filter matches only area elements.

The images attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only img and object elements that are associated with this map element according to the image map processing model.

The DOM attribute name must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

4.7.13 area 要素

分類
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
Where phrasing content is expected, but only if there is a map element ancestor.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
alt
coords
shape
href
target
ping
rel
media
hreflang
type
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLAreaElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString alt;
           attribute DOMString coords;
           attribute DOMString shape;
           attribute DOMString href;
           attribute DOMString target;
           attribute DOMString ping;
           attribute DOMString rel;
  readonly attribute DOMTokenList relList;
           attribute DOMString media;
           attribute DOMString hreflang;
           attribute DOMString type;
};

The area element represents either a hyperlink with some text and a corresponding area on an image map, or a dead area on an image map.

If the area element has an href attribute, then the area element represents a hyperlink. In this case, the alt attribute must be present. It specifies the text of the hyperlink. Its value must be text that, when presented with the texts specified for the other hyperlinks of the image map, and with the alternative text of the image, but without the image itself, provides the user with the same kind of choice as the hyperlink would when used without its text but with its shape applied to the image. The alt attribute may be left blank if there is another area element in the same image map that points to the same resource and has a non-blank alt attribute.

If the area element has no href attribute, then the area represented by the element cannot be selected, and the alt attribute must be omitted.

In both cases, the shape and coords attributes specify the area.

The shape attribute is an enumerated attribute. The following table lists the keywords defined for this attribute. The states given in the first cell of the rows with keywords give the states to which those keywords map. Some of the keywords are non-conforming, as noted in the last column.
State Keywords Notes
Circle state circ Non-conforming
circle
Default state default
Polygon state poly
polygon Non-conforming
Rectangle state rect
rectangle Non-conforming

The attribute may be omitted. The missing value default is the rectangle state.

The coords attribute must, if specified, contain a valid list of integers. This attribute gives the coordinates for the shape described by the shape attribute. The processing for this attribute is described as part of the image map processing model.

In the circle state, area elements must have a coords attribute present, with three integers, the last of which must be non-negative. The first integer must be the distance in CSS pixels from the left edge of the image to the center of the circle, the second integer must be the distance in CSS pixels from the top edge of the image to the center of the circle, and the third integer must be the radius of the circle, again in CSS pixels.

In the default state state, area elements must not have a coords attribute.

In the polygon state, area elements must have a coords attribute with at least six integers, and the number of integers must be even. Each pair of integers must represent a coordinate given as the distances from the left and the top of the image in CSS pixels respectively, and all the coordinates together must represent the points of the polygon, in order.

In the rectangle state, area elements must have a coords attribute with exactly four integers, the first of which must be less than the third, and the second of which must be less than the fourth. The four points must represent, respectively, the distance from the left edge of the image to the left side of the rectangle, the distance from the top edge to the top side, the distance from the left edge to the right side, and the distance from the top edge to the bottom side, all in CSS pixels.

When user agents allow users to follow hyperlinks created using the area element, as described in the next section, the href, target and ping attributes decide how the link is followed. The rel, media, hreflang, and type attributes may be used to indicate to the user the likely nature of the target resource before the user follows the link.

The target, ping, rel, media, hreflang, and type attributes must be omitted if the href attribute is not present.

The activation behavior of area elements is to run the following steps:

  1. If the DOMActivate event in question is not trusted (i.e. a click() method call was the reason for the event being dispatched), and the area element's target attribute is ... then raise an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception.
  2. Otherwise, the user agent must follow the hyperlink defined by the area element, if any.

One way that a user agent can enable users to follow hyperlinks is by allowing area elements to be clicked, or focussed and activated by the keyboard. This will cause the aforementioned activation behavior to be invoked.

The DOM attributes alt, coords, href, target, ping, rel, media, hreflang, and type, each must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

The DOM attribute shape must reflect the shape content attribute, limited to only known values.

The DOM attribute relList must reflect the rel content attribute.

4.7.14 Image maps

4.7.14.1. Authoring

An image map allows geometric areas on an image to be associated with hyperlinks.

An image, in the form of an img element or an object element representing an image, may be associated with an image map (in the form of a map element) by specifying a usemap attribute on the img or object element. The usemap attribute, if specified, must be a valid hash-name reference to a map element.

Consider an image that looks as follows:

A line with four shapes in it, equally spaced: a red hollow
    box, a green circle, a blue triangle, and a yellow four-pointed star.

If we wanted just the coloured areas to be clickable, we could do it as follows:

<p>
 Please select a shape:
 <img src="shapes.png" usemap="#shapes"
      alt="Four shapes are available: a red hollow box, a green circle, a blue triangle, and a yellow four-pointed star.">
 <map name="shapes">
  <area shape=rect coords="50,50,100,100"> <!-- the hole in the red box -->
  <area shape=rect coords="25,25,125,125" href="red.html" alt="Red box.">
  <area shape=circle coords="200,75,50" href="green.html" alt="Green circle.">
  <area shape=poly coords="325,25,262,125,388,125" href="blue.html" alt="Blue triangle.">
  <area shape=poly coords="450,25,435,60,400,75,435,90,450,125,465,90,500,75,465,60"
        href="yellow.html" alt="Yellow star.">
 </map>
</p>
4.7.14.2. 処理モデル

If an img element or an object element representing an image has a usemap attribute specified, user agents must process it as follows:

  1. First, rules for parsing a hash-name reference to a map element must be followed. This will return either an element (the map) or null.

  2. If that returned null, then abort these steps. The image is not associated with an image map after all.

  3. Otherwise, the user agent must collect all the area elements that are descendants of the map. Let those be the areas.

Having obtained the list of area elements that form the image map (the areas), interactive user agents must process the list in one of two ways.

If the user agent intends to show the text that the img element represents, then it must use the following steps.

In user agents that do not support images, or that have images disabled, object elements cannot represent images, and thus this section never applies (the fallback content is shown instead). The following steps therefore only apply to img elements.

  1. Remove all the area elements in areas that have no href attribute.

  2. Remove all the area elements in areas that have no alt attribute, or whose alt attribute's value is the empty string, if there is another area element in areas with the same value in the href attribute and with a non-empty alt attribute.

  3. Each remaining area element in areas represents a hyperlink. Those hyperlinks should all be made available to the user in a manner associated with the text of the img.

    In this context, user agents may represent area and img elements with no specified alt attributes, or whose alt attributes are the empty string or some other non-visible text, in a user-agent-defined fashion intended to indicate the lack of suitable author-provided text.

If the user agent intends to show the image and allow interaction with the image to select hyperlinks, then the image must be associated with a set of layered shapes, taken from the area elements in areas, in reverse tree order (so the last specified area element in the map is the bottom-most shape, and the first element in the map, in tree order, is the top-most shape).

Each area element in areas must be processed as follows to obtain a shape to layer onto the image:

  1. Find the state that the element's shape attribute represents.

  2. Use the rules for parsing a list of integers to parse the element's coords attribute, if it is present, and let the result be the coords list. If the attribute is absent, let the coords list be the empty list.

  3. If the number of items in the coords list is less than the minimum number given for the area element's current state, as per the following table, then the shape is empty; abort these steps.

    State Minimum number of items
    Circle state 3
    Default state 0
    Polygon state 6
    Rectangle state 4
  4. Check for excess items in the coords list as per the entry in the following list corresponding to the shape attribute's state:

    Circle state
    Drop any items in the list beyond the third.
    Default state
    Drop all items in the list.
    Polygon state
    Drop the last item if there's an odd number of items.
    Rectangle state
    Drop any items in the list beyond the fourth.
  5. If the shape attribute represents the rectangle state, and the first number in the list is numerically less than the third number in the list, then swap those two numbers around.

  6. If the shape attribute represents the rectangle state, and the second number in the list is numerically less than the fourth number in the list, then swap those two numbers around.

  7. If the shape attribute represents the circle state, and the third number in the list is less than or equal to zero, then the shape is empty; abort these steps.

  8. Now, the shape represented by the element is the one described for the entry in the list below corresponding to the state of the shape attribute:

    Circle state

    Let x be the first number in coords, y be the second number, and r be the third number.

    The shape is a circle whose center is x CSS pixels from the left edge of the image and x CSS pixels from the top edge of the image, and whose radius is r pixels.

    Default state

    The shape is a rectangle that exactly covers the entire image.

    Polygon state

    Let xi be the (2i)th entry in coords, and yi be the (2i+1)th entry in coords (the first entry in coords being the one with index 0).

    Let the coordinates be (xi, yi), interpreted in CSS pixels measured from the top left of the image, for all integer values of i from 0 to (N/2)-1, where N is the number of items in coords.

    The shape is a polygon whose vertices are given by the coordinates, and whose interior is established using the even-odd rule. [GRAPHICS]

    Rectangle state

    Let x1 be the first number in coords, y1 be the second number, x2 be the third number, and y2 be the fourth number.

    The shape is a rectangle whose top-left corner is given by the coordinate (x1, y1) and whose bottom right corner is given by the coordinate (x2, y2), those coordinates being interpreted as CSS pixels from the top left corner of the image.

    For historical reasons, the coordinates must be interpreted relative to the displayed image, even if it stretched using CSS or the image element's width and height attributes.

Mouse clicks on an image associated with a set of layered shapes per the above algorithm must be dispatched to the top-most shape covering the point that the pointing device indicated (if any), and then, must be dispatched again (with a new Event object) to the image element itself. User agents may also allow individual area elements representing hyperlinks to be selected and activated (e.g. using a keyboard); events from this are not also propagated to the image.

Because a map element (and its area elements) can be associated with multiple img and object elements, it is possible for an area element to correspond to multiple focusable areas of the document.

Image maps are live; if the DOM is mutated, then the user agent must act as if it had rerun the algorithms for image maps.

4.7.15 MathML

The math element from the MathML namespace falls into the embedded content category for the purposes of the content models in this specification.

User agents must handle text other than inter-element whitespace found in MathML elements whose content models do not allow raw text by pretending for the purposes of MathML content models, layout, and rendering that that text is actually wrapped in an mtext element in the MathML namespace. (Such text is not, however, conforming.)

User agents must act as if any MathML element whose contents does not match the element's content model was replaced, for the purposes of MathML layout and rendering, by an merror element in the MathML namespace containing some appropriate error message.

To enable authors to use MathML tools that only accept MathML in its XML form, interactive HTML user agents are encouraged to provide a way to export any MathML fragment as a namespace-well-formed XML fragment.

4.7.16 SVG

The svg element from the SVG namespace falls into the embedded content category for the purposes of the content models in this specification.

To enable authors to use SVG tools that only accept SVG in its XML form, interactive HTML user agents are encouraged to provide a way to export any SVG fragment as a namespace-well-formed XML fragment.

4.7.17 Dimension attributes

The width and height attributes on img, embed, object, and video elements may be specified to give the dimensions of the visual content of the element (the width and height respectively, relative to the nominal direction of the output medium), in CSS pixels. The attributes, if specified, must have values that are valid positive non-zero integers.

The specified dimensions given may differ from the dimensions specified in the resource itself, since the resource may have a resolution that differs from the CSS pixel resolution. (On screens, CSS pixels have a resolution of 96ppi, but in general the CSS pixel resolution depends on the reading distance.) If both attributes are specified, then the ratio of the specified width to the specified height must be the same as the ratio of the intrinsic width to the intrinsic height in the resource, or alternatively, in the case of the video element, the same as the adjusted ratio. The two attributes must be omitted if the resource in question does not have both an intrinsic width and an intrinsic height.

To parse the attributes, user agents must use the rules for parsing dimension values. This will return either an integer length, a percentage value, or nothing. The user agent requirements for processing the values obtained from parsing these attributes are described in the rendering section. If one of these attributes, when parsing, returns no value, it must be treated, for the purposes of those requirements, as if it was not specified.

The width and height DOM attributes on the embed, object, and video elements must reflect the content attributes of the same name.

4.8 Tabular data

4.8.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

...examples, how to write tables accessibly, a brief mention of the table model, etc...

4.8.2 table 要素

分類
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
In this order: optionally a caption element, followed by either zero or more colgroup elements, followed optionally by a thead element, followed optionally by a tfoot element, followed by either zero or more tbody elements or one or more tr elements, followed optionally by a tfoot element (but there can only be one tfoot element child in total).
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLTableElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute HTMLTableCaptionElement caption;
  HTMLElement createCaption();
  void deleteCaption();
           attribute HTMLTableSectionElement tHead;
  HTMLElement createTHead();
  void deleteTHead();
           attribute HTMLTableSectionElement tFoot;
  HTMLElement createTFoot();
  void deleteTFoot();
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection tBodies;
  HTMLElement createTBody();
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection rows;
  HTMLElement insertRow(in long index);
  void deleteRow(in long index);
};

The table element represents data with more than one dimension (a table).

we need some editorial text on how layout tables are bad practice and non-conforming

The children of a table element must be, in order:

  1. Zero or one caption elements.

  2. Zero or more colgroup elements.

  3. Zero or one thead elements.

  4. Zero or one tfoot elements, if the last element in the table is not a tfoot element.

  5. Either:

  6. Zero or one tfoot element, if there are no other tfoot elements in the table.

The table element takes part in the table model.

The caption DOM attribute must return, on getting, the first caption element child of the table element, if any, or null otherwise. On setting, if the new value is a caption element, the first caption element child of the table element, if any, must be removed, and the new value must be inserted as the first node of the table element. If the new value is not a caption element, then a HIERARCHY_REQUEST_ERR DOM exception must be raised instead.

The createCaption() method must return the first caption element child of the table element, if any; otherwise a new caption element must be created, inserted as the first node of the table element, and then returned.

The deleteCaption() method must remove the first caption element child of the table element, if any.

The tHead DOM attribute must return, on getting, the first thead element child of the table element, if any, or null otherwise. On setting, if the new value is a thead element, the first thead element child of the table element, if any, must be removed, and the new value must be inserted immediately before the first element in the table element that is neither a caption element nor a colgroup element, if any, or at the end of the table otherwise. If the new value is not a thead element, then a HIERARCHY_REQUEST_ERR DOM exception must be raised instead.

The createTHead() method must return the first thead element child of the table element, if any; otherwise a new thead element must be created and inserted immediately before the first element in the table element that is neither a caption element nor a colgroup element, if any, or at the end of the table otherwise, and then that new element must be returned.

The deleteTHead() method must remove the first thead element child of the table element, if any.

The tFoot DOM attribute must return, on getting, the first tfoot element child of the table element, if any, or null otherwise. On setting, if the new value is a tfoot element, the first tfoot element child of the table element, if any, must be removed, and the new value must be inserted immediately before the first element in the table element that is neither a caption element, a colgroup element, nor a thead element, if any, or at the end of the table if there are no such elements. If the new value is not a tfoot element, then a HIERARCHY_REQUEST_ERR DOM exception must be raised instead.

The createTFoot() method must return the first tfoot element child of the table element, if any; otherwise a new tfoot element must be created and inserted immediately before the first element in the table element that is neither a caption element, a colgroup element, nor a thead element, if any, or at the end of the table if there are no such elements, and then that new element must be returned.

The deleteTFoot() method must remove the first tfoot element child of the table element, if any.

The tBodies attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the table node, whose filter matches only tbody elements that are children of the table element.

The createTBody() method must create a new tbody element, insert it immediately after the last tbody element in the table element, if any, or at the end of the table element if the table element has no tbody element children, and then must return the new tbody element.

The rows attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the table node, whose filter matches only tr elements that are either children of the table element, or children of thead, tbody, or tfoot elements that are themselves children of the table element. The elements in the collection must be ordered such that those elements whose parent is a thead are included first, in tree order, followed by those elements whose parent is either a table or tbody element, again in tree order, followed finally by those elements whose parent is a tfoot element, still in tree order.

The behavior of the insertRow(index) method depends on the state of the table. When it is called, the method must act as required by the first item in the following list of conditions that describes the state of the table and the index argument:

If index is less than −1 or greater than the number of elements in rows collection:
The method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.
If the rows collection has zero elements in it, and the table has no tbody elements in it:
The method must create a tbody element, then create a tr element, then append the tr element to the tbody element, then append the tbody element to the table element, and finally return the tr element.
If the rows collection has zero elements in it:
The method must create a tr element, append it to the last tbody element in the table, and return the tr element.
If index is equal to −1 or equal to the number of items in rows collection:
The method must create a tr element, and append it to the parent of the last tr element in the rows collection. Then, the newly created tr element must be returned.
それ以外の場合:
The method must create a tr element, insert it immediately before the indexth tr element in the rows collection, in the same parent, and finally must return the newly created tr element.

When the deleteRow(index) method is called, the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. If index is equal to −1, then index must be set to the number if items in the rows collection, minus one.

  2. Now, if index is less than zero, or greater than or equal to the number of elements in the rows collection, the method must instead raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception, and these steps must be aborted.

  3. Otherwise, the method must remove the indexth element in the rows collection from its parent.

4.8.3 caption 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As the first element child of a table element.
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The caption element represents the title of the table that is its parent, if it has a parent and that is a table element.

The caption element takes part in the table model.

4.8.4 colgroup 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As a child of a table element, after any caption elements and before any thead, tbody, tfoot, and tr elements.
内容モデル:
Zero or more col elements.
要素固有属性:
span
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLTableColElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute unsigned long span;
};

The colgroup element represents a group of one or more columns in the table that is its parent, if it has a parent and that is a table element.

If the colgroup element contains no col elements, then the element may have a span content attribute specified, whose value must be a valid non-negative integer greater than zero.

The colgroup element and its span attribute take part in the table model.

The span DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name. The value must be limited to only positive non-zero numbers.

4.8.5 col 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As a child of a colgroup element that doesn't have a span attribute.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
span
DOM 界面:

HTMLTableColElement, same as for colgroup elements. This interface defines one member, span.

If a col element has a parent and that is a colgroup element that itself has a parent that is a table element, then the col element represents one or more columns in the column group represented by that colgroup.

The element may have a span content attribute specified, whose value must be a valid non-negative integer greater than zero.

The col element and its span attribute take part in the table model.

The span DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name. The value must be limited to only positive non-zero numbers.

4.8.6 tbody 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
table element, after any caption, colgroup, and thead elements, but only if there are no tr elements that are children of the table 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
Zero or more tr elements
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLTableSectionElement : HTMLElement {
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection rows;
  HTMLElement insertRow(in long index);
  void deleteRow(in long index);
};

The HTMLTableSectionElement interface is also used for thead and tfoot elements.

The tbody element represents a block of rows that consist of a body of data for the parent table element, if the tbody element has a parent and it is a table.

The tbody element takes part in the table model.

The rows attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the element, whose filter matches only tr elements that are children of the element.

The insertRow(index) method must, when invoked on an element table section, act as follows:

If index is less than −1 or greater than the number of elements in the rows collection, the method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

If index is equal to −1 or equal to the number of items in the rows collection, the method must create a tr element, append it to the element table section, and return the newly created tr element.

Otherwise, the method must create a tr element, insert it as a child of the table section element, immediately before the indexth tr element in the rows collection, and finally must return the newly created tr element.

The deleteRow(index) method must remove the indexth element in the rows collection from its parent. If index is less than zero or greater than or equal to the number of elements in the rows collection, the method must instead raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

4.8.7 thead 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
table element, after any caption, and colgroup elements and before any tbody, tfoot, and tr elements, but only if there are no other thead elements that are children of the table 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
Zero or more tr elements
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLTableSectionElement, as defined for tbody elements.

The thead element represents the block of rows that consist of the column labels (headers) for the parent table element, if the thead element has a parent and it is a table.

The thead element takes part in the table model.

4.8.8 tfoot 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
table element, after any caption, colgroup, and thead elements and before any tbody and tr elements, but only if there are no other tfoot elements that are children of the table 要素の子供として。
table element, after any caption, colgroup, thead, tbody, and tr elements, but only if there are no other tfoot elements that are children of the table 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
Zero or more tr elements
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLTableSectionElement, as defined for tbody elements.

The tfoot element represents the block of rows that consist of the column summaries (footers) for the parent table element, if the tfoot element has a parent and it is a table.

The tfoot element takes part in the table model.

4.8.9 tr 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
thead 要素の子供として。
tbody 要素の子供として。
tfoot 要素の子供として。
table element, after any caption, colgroup, and thead elements, but only if there are no tbody elements that are children of the table 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
Zero or more td or th elements
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLTableRowElement : HTMLElement {
  readonly attribute long rowIndex;
  readonly attribute long sectionRowIndex;
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection cells;
  HTMLElement insertCell(in long index);
  void deleteCell(in long index);
};

The tr element represents a row of cells in a table.

The tr element takes part in the table model.

The rowIndex attribute must, if the element has a parent table element, or a parent tbody, thead, or tfoot element and a grandparent table element, return the index of the tr element in that table element's rows collection. If there is no such table element, then the attribute must return −1.

The sectionRowIndex attribute must, if the element has a parent table, tbody, thead, or tfoot element, return the index of the tr element in the parent element's rows collection (for tables, that's the rows collection; for table sections, that's the rows collection). If there is no such parent element, then the attribute must return −1.

The cells attribute must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the tr element, whose filter matches only td and th elements that are children of the tr element.

The insertCell(index) method must act as follows:

If index is less than −1 or greater than the number of elements in the cells collection, the method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

If index is equal to −1 or equal to the number of items in cells collection, the method must create a td element, append it to the tr element, and return the newly created td element.

Otherwise, the method must create a td element, insert it as a child of the tr element, immediately before the indexth td or th element in the cells collection, and finally must return the newly created td element.

The deleteCell(index) method must remove the indexth element in the cells collection from its parent. If index is less than zero or greater than or equal to the number of elements in the cells collection, the method must instead raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

4.8.10 td 要素

分類
Sectioning root.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
tr 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
colspan
rowspan
headers
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLTableDataCellElement : HTMLTableCellElement {
           attribute DOMString headers;
};

The td element represents a data cell in a table.

The td element may have a headers content attribute specified. The headers attribute, if specified, must contain a string consisting of an unordered set of unique space-separated tokens, each of which must have the value of an ID of a th element taking part in the same table as the td element (as defined by the table model).

The exact effect of the attribute is described in detail in the algorithm for assigning header cells to data cells, which user agents must apply to determine the relationships between data cells and header cells.

The td element and its colspan and rowspan attributes take part in the table model.

The headers DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

4.8.11 th 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
tr 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
colspan
rowspan
scope
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLTableHeaderCellElement : HTMLTableCellElement {
           attribute DOMString scope;
};

The th element represents a header cell in a table.

The th element may have a scope content attribute specified. The scope attribute is an enumerated attribute with five states, four of which have explicit keywords:

The row keyword, which maps to the row state
The row state means the header cell applies to all the remaining cells in the row.
The col keyword, which maps to the column state
The column state means the header cell applies to all the remaining cells in the column.
The rowgroup keyword, which maps to the row group state
The row group state means the header cell applies to all the remaining cells in the row group.
The colgroup keyword, which maps to the column group state
The column group state means the header cell applies to all the remaining cells in the column group.
The auto state
The auto state makes the header cell apply to a set of cells selected based on context.

The scope attribute's missing value default is the auto state.

The exact effect of these values is described in detail in the algorithm for assigning header cells to data cells, which user agents must apply to determine the relationships between data cells and header cells.

The th element and its colspan and rowspan attributes take part in the table model.

The scope DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

4.8.12 Attributes common to td and th elements

The td and th elements may have a colspan content attribute specified, whose value must be a valid non-negative integer greater than zero.

The td and th elements may also have a rowspan content attribute specified, whose value must be a valid non-negative integer.

The td and th elements implement interfaces that inherit from the HTMLTableCellElement interface:

interface HTMLTableCellElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute long colSpan;
           attribute long rowSpan;
  readonly attribute long cellIndex;
};

The colSpan DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name. The value must be limited to only positive non-zero numbers.

The rowSpan DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name. Its default value, which must be used if parsing the attribute as a non-negative integer returns an error, is also 1.

The cellIndex DOM attribute must, if the element has a parent tr element, return the index of the cell's element in the parent element's cells collection. If there is no such parent element, then the attribute must return 0.

4.8.13 処理モデル

The various table elements and their content attributes together define the table model.

A table consists of cells aligned on a two-dimensional grid of slots with coordinates (x, y). The grid is finite, and is either empty or has one or more slots. If the grid has one or more slots, then the x coordinates are always in the range 0 ≤ x < xwidth, and the y coordinates are always in the range 0 ≤ y < yheight. If one or both of xwidth and yheight are zero, then the table is empty (has no slots). Tables correspond to table elements.

A cell is a set of slots anchored at a slot (cellx, celly), and with a particular width and height such that the cell covers all the slots with coordinates (x, y) where cellx ≤ x < cellx+width and celly ≤ y < celly+height. Cells can either be data cells or header cells. Data cells correspond to td elements, and have zero or more associated header cells. Header cells correspond to th elements.

A row is a complete set of slots from x=0 to x=xwidth-1, for a particular value of y. Rows correspond to tr elements.

A column is a complete set of slots from y=0 to y=yheight-1, for a particular value of x. Columns can correspond to col elements, but in the absence of col elements are implied.

A row group is a set of rows anchored at a slot (0, groupy) with a particular height such that the row group covers all the slots with coordinates (x, y) where 0 ≤ x < xwidth and groupy ≤ y < groupy+height. Row groups correspond to tbody, thead, and tfoot elements. Not every row is necessarily in a row group.

A column group is a set of columns anchored at a slot (groupx, 0) with a particular width such that the column group covers all the slots with coordinates (x, y) where groupx ≤ x < groupx+width and 0 ≤ y < yheight. Column groups correspond to colgroup elements. Not every column is necessarily in a column group.

Row groups cannot overlap each other. Similarly, column groups cannot overlap each other.

A cell cannot cover slots that are from two or more row groups. It is, however, possible for a cell to be in multiple column groups. All the slots that form part of one cell are part of zero or one row groups and zero or more column groups.

In addition to cells, columns, rows, row groups, and column groups, tables can have a caption element associated with them. This gives the table a heading, or legend.

A table model error is an error with the data represented by table elements and their descendants. Documents must not have table model errors.

4.8.13.1. Forming a table

To determine which elements correspond to which slots in a table associated with a table element, to determine the dimensions of the table (xwidth and yheight), and to determine if there are any table model errors, user agents must use the following algorithm:

  1. Let xwidth be zero.

  2. Let yheight be zero.

  3. Let pending tfoot elements be a list of tfoot elements, initially empty.

  4. Let the table be the table represented by the table element. The xwidth and yheight variables give the table's dimensions. The table is initially empty.

  5. If the table element has no children elements, then return the table (which will be empty), and abort these steps.

  6. Associate the first caption element child of the table element with the table. If there are no such children, then it has no associated caption element.

  7. Let the current element be the first element child of the table element.

    If a step in this algorithm ever requires the current element to be advanced to the next child of the table when there is no such next child, then the user agent must jump to the step labeled end, near the end of this algorithm.

  8. While the current element is not one of the following elements, advance the current element to the next child of the table:

  9. If the current element is a colgroup, follow these substeps:

    1. Column groups: Process the current element according to the appropriate case below:

      If the current element has any col element children

      Follow these steps:

      1. Let xstart have the value of xwidth.

      2. Let the current column be the first col element child of the colgroup element.

      3. Columns: If the current column col element has a span attribute, then parse its value using the rules for parsing non-negative integers.

        If the result of parsing the value is not an error or zero, then let span be that value.

        Otherwise, if the col element has no span attribute, or if trying to parse the attribute's value resulted in an error, then let span be 1.

      4. Increase xwidth by span.

      5. Let the last span columns in the table correspond to the current column col element.

      6. If current column is not the last col element child of the colgroup element, then let the current column be the next col element child of the colgroup element, and return to the step labeled columns.

      7. Let all the last columns in the table from x=xstart to x=xwidth-1 form a new column group, anchored at the slot (xstart, 0), with width xwidth-xstart, corresponding to the colgroup element.

      If the current element has no col element children
      1. If the colgroup element has a span attribute, then parse its value using the rules for parsing non-negative integers.

        If the result of parsing the value is not an error or zero, then let span be that value.

        Otherwise, if the colgroup element has no span attribute, or if trying to parse the attribute's value resulted in an error, then let span be 1.

      2. Increase xwidth by span.

      3. Let the last span columns in the table form a new column group, anchored at the slot (xwidth-span, 0), with width span, corresponding to the colgroup element.

    2. Advance the current element to the next child of the table.

    3. While the current element is not one of the following elements, advance the current element to the next child of the table:

    4. If the current element is a colgroup element, jump to the step labeled column groups above.

  10. Let ycurrent be zero.

  11. Let the list of downward-growing cells be an empty list.

  12. Rows: While the current element is not one of the following elements, advance the current element to the next child of the table:

  13. If the current element is a tr, then run the algorithm for processing rows, advance the current element to the next child of the table, and return to the step labeled rows.

  14. Run the algorithm for ending a row group.

  15. If the current element is a tfoot, then add that element to the list of pending tfoot elements, advance the current element to the next child of the table, and return to the step labeled rows.

  16. The current element is either a thead or a tbody.

    Run the algorithm for processing row groups.

  17. Advance the current element to the next child of the table.

  18. Return to the step labeled rows.

  19. End: For each tfoot element in the list of pending tfoot elements, in tree order, run the algorithm for processing row groups.

  20. If there exists a row or column in the table the table containing only slots that do not have a cell anchored to them, then this is a table model error.

  21. Return the table.

The algorithm for processing row groups, which is invoked by the set of steps above for processing thead, tbody, and tfoot elements, is:

  1. Let ystart have the value of yheight.

  2. For each tr element that is a child of the element being processed, in tree order, run the algorithm for processing rows.

  3. If yheight > ystart, then let all the last rows in the table from y=ystart to y=yheight-1 form a new row group, anchored at the slot with coordinate (0, ystart), with height yheight-ystart, corresponding to the element being processed.

  4. Run the algorithm for ending a row group.

The algorithm for ending a row group, which is invoked by the set of steps above when starting and ending a block of rows, is:

  1. While ycurrent is less than yheight, follow these steps:

    1. Run the algorithm for growing downward-growing cells.

    2. Increase ycurrent by 1.

  2. Empty the list of downward-growing cells.

The algorithm for processing rows, which is invoked by the set of steps above for processing tr elements, is:

  1. If yheight is equal to ycurrent, then increase yheight by 1. (ycurrent is never greater than yheight.)

  2. Let xcurrent be 0.

  3. Run the algorithm for growing downward-growing cells.

  4. If the tr element being processed has no td or th element children, then increase ycurrent by 1, abort this set of steps, and return to the algorithm above.

  5. Let current cell be the first td or th element in the tr element being processed.

  6. Cells: While xcurrent is less than xwidth and the slot with coordinate (xcurrent, ycurrent) already has a cell assigned to it, increase xcurrent by 1.

  7. If xcurrent is equal to xwidth, increase xwidth by 1. (xcurrent is never greater than xwidth.)

  8. If the current cell has a colspan attribute, then parse that attribute's value, and let colspan be the result.

    If parsing that value failed, or returned zero, or if the attribute is absent, then let colspan be 1, instead.

  9. If the current cell has a rowspan attribute, then parse that attribute's value, and let rowspan be the result.

    If parsing that value failed or if the attribute is absent, then let rowspan be 1, instead.

  10. If rowspan is zero, then let cell grows downward be true, and set rowspan to 1. Otherwise, let cell grows downward be false.

  11. If xwidth < xcurrent+colspan, then let xwidth be xcurrent+colspan.

  12. If yheight < ycurrent+rowspan, then let yheight be ycurrent+rowspan.

  13. Let the slots with coordinates (x, y) such that xcurrent ≤ x < xcurrent+colspan and ycurrent ≤ y < ycurrent+rowspan be covered by a new cell c, anchored at (xcurrent, ycurrent), which has width colspan and height rowspan, corresponding to the current cell element.

    If the current cell element is a th element, let this new cell c be a header cell; otherwise, let it be a data cell. To establish what header cells apply to a data cell, use the algorithm for assigning header cells to data cells described in the next section.

    If any of the slots involved already had a cell covering them, then this is a table model error. Those slots now have two cells overlapping.

  14. If cell grows downward is true, then add the tuple {c, xcurrent, colspan} to the list of downward-growing cells.

  15. Increase xcurrent by colspan.

  16. If current cell is the last td or th element in the tr element being processed, then increase ycurrent by 1, abort this set of steps, and return to the algorithm above.

  17. Let current cell be the next td or th element in the tr element being processed.

  18. Return to the step labelled cells.

When the algorithms above require the user agent to run the algorithm for growing downward-growing cells, the user agent must, for each {cell, cellx, width} tuple in the list of downward-growing cells, if any, extend the cell cell so that it also covers the slots with coordinates (x, ycurrent), where cellx ≤ x < cellx+width.

4.8.13.2. Forming relationships between data cells and header cells

Each data cell can be assigned zero or more header cells. The algorithm for assigning header cells to data cells is as follows.

  1. For each header cell in the table, in tree order, run these substeps:

    1. Let (headerx, headery) be the coordinate of the slot to which the header cell is anchored.

    2. Let headerwidth be the width of the header cell.

    3. Let headerheight be the height of the header cell.

    4. Let data cells be a list of data cells, initially empty.

    5. Examine the scope attribute of the th element corresponding to the header cell, and, based on its state, apply the appropriate substep:

      If it is in the row state

      Add all the data cells that cover slots with coordinates (slotx, sloty), where headerx+headerwidth ≤ slotx < xwidth and headery ≤ sloty < headery+headerheight, to the data cells list.

      If it is in the column state

      Add all the data cells that cover slots with coordinates (slotx, sloty), where headerx ≤ slotx < headerx+headerwidth and headery+headerheight ≤ sloty < yheight, to the data cells list.

      If it is in the row group state

      If the header cell is not in a row group, then do nothing.

      Otherwise, let (0, groupy) be the slot at which the row group is anchored, let height be the number of rows in the row group, and add all the data cells that cover slots with coordinates (slotx, sloty), where headerx ≤ slotx < xwidth and headery ≤ sloty < groupy+height, to the data cells list.

      If it is in the column group state

      If the header cell is not anchored in a column group, then do nothing.

      Otherwise, let (groupx, 0) be the slot at which that column group is anchored, let width be the number of columns in the column group, and add all the data cells that cover slots with coordinates (slotx, sloty), where headerx ≤ slotx < groupx+width and headery ≤ sloty < yheight, to the data cells list.

      Otherwise, it is in the auto state

      Run these steps:

      1. If the header cell is equivalent to a wide cell, let headerwidth equal xwidth-headerx.

      2. Let x equal headerx+headerwidth.

      3. Let y equal headery+headerheight.

      4. Horizontal: If x is equal to xwidth, then jump down to the step below labeled vertical.

      5. If there is a header cell anchored at (x, headery) with height headerheight, then jump down to the step below labeled vertical.

      6. Add all the data cells that cover slots with coordinates (slotx, sloty), where slotx = x and headery ≤ sloty < headery+headerheight, to the data cells list.

      7. Increase x by 1.

      8. Jump up to the step above labeled horizontal.

      9. Vertical: If y is equal to yheight, then jump to the step below labeled end.

      10. If there is a header cell cell anchored at (headerx, y), then follow these substeps:

        1. If the header cell cell is equivalent to a wide cell, then let width be xwidth-headerx. Otherwise, let width be the width of the header cell cell.

        2. If width is equal to headerwidth, then jump to the step below labeled end.

      11. Add all the data cells that cover slots with coordinates (slotx, sloty), where headerx ≤ slotx < headerx+headerwidth and sloty = y, to the data cells list.

      12. Increase y by 1.

      13. Jump up to the step above labeled vertical.

      14. End: Coalesce all the duplicate entries in the data cells list, so that each data cell is only present once, in tree order.

    6. Assign the header cell to all the data cells in the data cells list that correspond to td elements that do not have a headers attribute specified.

  2. For each data cell in the table, in tree order, run these substeps:

    1. If the data cell corresponds to a td element that does not have a headers attribute specified, then skip these substeps and move on to the next data cell (if any).

    2. Otherwise, take the value of the headers attribute and split it on spaces, letting id list be the list of tokens obtained.

    3. For each token in the id list, run the following steps:

      1. Let id be the token.

      2. If there is a header cell in the table whose corresponding th element has an ID that is equal to the value of id, then assign the first such header cell in tree order to the data cell.

A header cell anchored at (headerx, headery) with width headerwidth and height headerheight is said to be equivalent to a wide cell if all the slots with coordinates (slotx, sloty), where headerx+headerwidth ≤ slotx < xwidth and headery ≤ sloty < headery+headerheight, are all either empty or covered by empty data cells.

A data cell is said to be an empty data cell if it contains no elements and its text content, if any, consists only of White_Space characters.

User agents may remove empty data cells when analyzing data in a table.

4.9 Forms

This section will contain definitions of the form element and so forth.

This section will be a rewrite of the HTML4 Forms and Web Forms 2.0 specifications, with hopefully no normative changes.

4.9.1 form 要素

4.9.2 fieldset 要素

4.9.3 input 要素

4.9.4 button 要素

4.9.5 label 要素

4.9.6 select 要素

4.9.7 datalist 要素

4.9.8 optgroup 要素

4.9.9 option 要素

4.9.10 Constructors

All Window objects must provide the following constructors:

Option()
Option(in DOMString name)
Option(in DOMString name, in DOMString value)

When invoked as constructors, these must return a new HTMLOptionElement object (a new option element). need to define argument processing

4.9.11 textarea 要素

4.9.12 output 要素

4.9.13 処理モデル

See WF2 for now

4.9.13.1. Form submission

See WF2 for now

If a form is in a browsing context whose sandboxed forms browsing context flag is set, it must not be submitted.

4.10 スクリプティング

Scripts allow authors to add interactivity to their documents.

Authors are encouraged to use declarative alternatives to scripting where possible, as declarative mechanisms are often more maintainable, and many users disable scripting.

For example, instead of using script to show or hide a section to show more details, the details element could be used.

Authors are also encouraged to make their applications degrade gracefully in the absence of scripting support.

For example, if an author provides a link in a table header to dynamically resort the table, the link could also be made to function without scripts by requesting the sorted table from the server.

4.10.1 script 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
メタデータ内容が期待される場所。
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
If there is no src attribute, depends on the value of the type attribute.
If there is a src attribute, the element must be empty.
要素固有属性:
src
async
defer
type
charset
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLScriptElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString src;
           attribute boolean async;
           attribute boolean defer;
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute DOMString charset;
           attribute DOMString text;
};

The script element allows authors to include dynamic script and data blocks in their documents.

When used to include dynamic scripts, the scripts may either be embedded inline or may be imported from an external file using the src attribute. If the language is not that described by "text/javascript", then the type attribute must be present. If the type attribute is present, its value must be the type of the script's language.

When used to include data blocks, the data must be embedded inline, the format of the data must be given using the type attribute, and the src attribute must not be specified.

The type attribute gives the language of the script or format of the data. If the attribute is present, its value must be a valid MIME type, optionally with parameters. The charset parameter must not be specified. (The default, which is used if the attribute is absent, is "text/javascript".) [RFC2046]

The src attribute, if specified, gives the address of the external script resource to use. The value of the attribute must be a valid URL identifying a script resource of the type given by the type attribute, if the attribute is present, or of the type "text/javascript", if the attribute is absent.

The charset attribute gives the character encoding of the external script resource. The attribute must not be specified if the src attribute is not present. If the attribute is set, its value must be a valid character encoding name, and must be the preferred name for that encoding. [IANACHARSET]

The encoding specified must be the encoding used by the script resource. If the charset attribute is omitted, the character encoding of the document will be used. If the script resource uses a different encoding than the document, then the attribute must be specified.

The async and defer attributes are boolean attributes that indicate how the script should be executed.

There are three possible modes that can be selected using these attributes. If the async attribute is present, then the script will be executed asynchronously, as soon as it is available. If the async attribute is not present but the defer attribute is present, then the script is executed when the page has finished parsing. If neither attribute is present, then the script is fetched and executed immediately, before the user agent continues parsing the page. The exact processing details for these attributes is described below.

The defer attribute may be specified even if the async attribute is specified, to cause legacy Web browsers that only support defer (and not async) to fall back to the defer behavior instead of the synchronous blocking behavior that is the default.

Changing the src, type, charset, async, and defer attributes dynamically has no direct effect; these attribute are only used at specific times described below (namely, when the element is inserted into the document).

script elements have four associated pieces of metadata. The first is a flag indicating whether or not the script block has been "already executed". Initially, script elements must have this flag unset (script blocks, when created, are not "already executed"). When a script element is cloned, the "already executed" flag, if set, must be propagated to the clone when it is created. The second is a flag indicating whether the element was "parser-inserted". This flag is set by the HTML parser and is used to handle document.write() calls. The third and fourth pieces of metadata are the script's type and the script's character encoding. They are determined when the script is run, based on the attributes on the element at that time.

Running a script: When a script block is inserted into a document, the user agent must act as follows:

  1. If either:

    ...let the script's type for this script element be "text/javascript".

    Otherwise, if the script element has a type attribute, let the script's type for this script element be the value of that attribute.

    Otherwise, the element has a language attribute; let the script's type for this script element be the concatenation of the string "text/" followed by the value of the language attribute.

  2. If the script element has a charset attribute, then let the script's character encoding for this script element be the encoding given by the charset attribute.

    Otherwise, let the script's character encoding for this script element be the same as the encoding of the document itself.

  3. If the script element is without script, or if the script element was created by an XML parser that itself was created as part of the processing of the innerHTML attribute's setter, or if the user agent does not support the scripting language given by the script's type for this script element, or if the script element has its "already executed" flag set, then the user agent must abort these steps at this point. The script is not executed.

  4. The user agent must set the element's "already executed" flag.

  5. If the element has a src attribute, then the specified resource must be fetched.

    For historical reasons, if the URL is a javascript: URL, then the user agent must not, despite the requirements in the definition of the fetching algorithm, actually execute the given script; instead the user agent must act as if it had received an empty HTTP 400 response.

    Once the fetching process has completed, and the script has completed loading, the user agent will have to complete the steps described below. (If the parser is still active at that time, those steps defer to the parser to handle the execution of pending scripts.)

    For performance reasons, user agents may start fetching the script as soon as the attribute is set, instead, in the hope that the element will be inserted into the document. Either way, once the element is inserted into the document, the load must have started. If the UA performs such prefetching, but the element is never inserted in the document, or the src attribute is dynamically changed, then the user agent will not execute the script, and the fetching process will have been effectively wasted.

  6. Then, the first of the following options that describes the situation must be followed:

    If the document is still being parsed, and the element has a defer attribute, and the element does not have an async attribute
    The element must be added to the end of the list of scripts that will execute when the document has finished parsing. This isn't compatible with IE for inline deferred scripts, but then what IE does is pretty hard to pin down exactly. Do we want to keep this like it is? Be more compatible?
    If the element has an async attribute and a src attribute
    The element must be added to the end of the list of scripts that will execute asynchronously.
    If the element has an async attribute but no src attribute, and the list of scripts that will execute asynchronously is not empty
    The element must be added to the end of the list of scripts that will execute asynchronously.
    If the element has a src attribute and has been flagged as "parser-inserted"
    The element is the pending external script. (There can only be one such script at a time.)
    If the element has a src attribute
    The element must be added to the end of the list of scripts that will execute as soon as possible.
    その他の場合
    The user agent must immediately execute the script, even if other scripts are already executing.

When a script completes loading: If the script's element was added to one of the lists mentioned above and the document is still being parsed, then the parser handles it. Otherwise, the UA must run the following steps as the task that the networking task source places on the task queue:

If the script's element was added to the list of scripts that will execute when the document has finished parsing:
  1. If the script's element is not the first element in the list, then do nothing yet. Stop going through these steps.

  2. Otherwise, execute the script (that is, the script associated with the first element in the list).

  3. Remove the script's element from the list (i.e. shift out the first entry in the list).

  4. If there are any more entries in the list, and if the script associated with the element that is now the first in the list is already loaded, then jump back to step two to execute it.

If the script's element was added to the list of scripts that will execute asynchronously:
  1. If the script is not the first element in the list, then do nothing yet. Stop going through these steps.

  2. Execute the script (the script associated with the first element in the list).

  3. Remove the script's element from the list (i.e. shift out the first entry in the list).

  4. If there are any more scripts in the list, and the element now at the head of the list had no src attribute when it was added to the list, or had one, but its associated script has finished loading, then jump back to step two to execute the script associated with this element.

If the script's element was added to the list of scripts that will execute as soon as possible:
  1. Execute the script.

  2. Remove the script's element from the list.

Fetching an external script must delay the load event.

Executing a script block: When the steps above require that the script be executed, the user agent must act as follows:

If the load resulted in an error (for example a DNS error, or an HTTP 404 error)

Executing the script must just consist of firing an error event at the element.

If the load was successful
  1. If the script element's Document is the active document in its browsing context, the user agent must execute the script:

    If the script is from an external file

    That file must be used as the file to execute.

    The file must be interpreted using the character encoding given by the script's character encoding, regardless of any metadata given by the file's Content-Type metadata.

    This means that a UTF-16 document will always assume external scripts are UTF-16...? This applies, e.g., to document's created using createDocument()... It also means changing document.charSet will affect the character encoding used to interpret scripts, is that really what happens?

    If the script is inline

    For scripting languages that consist of pure text, user agents must use the value of the DOM text attribute (defined below) as the script to execute, and for XML-based scripting languages, user agents must use all the child nodes of the script element as the script to execute.

    In any case, the user agent must execute the script according to the semantics defined by the language associated with the script's type (see the scripting languages section below).

    The script execution context of the script must be the Window object of that browsing context.

    The script document context of the script must be the Document object that owns the script element.

    The element's attributes' values might have changed between when the element was inserted into the document and when the script has finished loading, as may its other attributes; similarly, the element itself might have been taken back out of the DOM, or had other changes made. These changes do not in any way affect the above steps; only the values of the attributes at the time the script element is first inserted into the document matter.

  2. Then, the user agent must fire a load event at the script element.

The DOM attributes src, type, charset, async, and defer, each must reflect the respective content attributes of the same name.

The DOM attribute text must return a concatenation of the contents of all the text nodes that are direct children of the script element (ignoring any other nodes such as comments or elements), in tree order. On setting, it must act the same way as the textContent DOM attribute.

In this example, two script elements are used. One embeds an external script, and the other includes some data.

<script src="game-engine.js"></script>
<script type="text/x-game-map">
........U.........e
o............x....e
.....x.....xxx....e
.x..xxx...xxxxx...e
</script>

The data in this case might be used by the script to generate the map of a video game. The data doesn't have to be used that way, though; maybe the map data is actually embedded in other parts of the page's markup, and the data block here is just used by the site's search engine to help users who are looking for particular features in their game maps.

4.10.1.1. Scripting languages

A user agent is said to support the scripting language if the script's type matches the MIME type of a scripting language that the user agent implements.

The following lists some MIME types and the languages to which they refer:

text/javascript
text/javascript1.1
text/javascript1.2
text/javascript1.3
ECMAScript. [ECMA262]
text/javascript;e4x=1
ECMAScript with ECMAScript for XML. [ECMA357]

User agents may support other MIME types and other languages.

When examining types to determine if they support the language, user agents must not ignore unknown MIME parameters — types with unknown parameters must be assumed to be unsupported.

4.10.2 noscript 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
In a head element of an HTML document, if there are no ancestor noscript elements.
Where phrasing content is expected in HTML documents, if there are no ancestor noscript elements.
内容モデル:
Without script, in a head element: in any order, zero or more link elements, zero or more style elements, and zero or more meta elements.
Without script, not in a head element: transparent, but there must be no noscript element descendants.
With script: text that conforms to the requirements given in the prose.
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The noscript element does not represent anything. It is used to present different markup to user agents that support scripting and those that don't support scripting, by affecting how the document is parsed.

The noscript element must not be used in XML documents.

The noscript element is only effective in the HTML serialization, it has no effect in the XML serialization.

When used in HTML documents, the allowed content model is as follows:

In a head element, if the noscript element is without script, then the content model of a noscript element must contain only link, style, and meta elements. If the noscript element is with script, then the content model of a noscript element is text, except that invoking the HTML fragment parsing algorithm with the noscript element as the context element and the text contents as the input must result in a list of nodes that consists only of link, style, and meta elements.

Outside of head elements, if the noscript element is without script, then the content model of a noscript element is transparent, with the additional restriction that a noscript element must not have a noscript element as an ancestor (that is, noscript can't be nested).

Outside of head elements, if the noscript element is with script, then the content model of a noscript element is text, except that the text must be such that running the following algorithm results in a conforming document with no noscript elements and no script elements, and such that no step in the algorithm causes an HTML parser to flag a parse error:

  1. Remove every script element from the document.
  2. Make a list of every noscript element in the document. For every noscript element in that list, perform the following steps:
    1. Let the parent element be the parent element of the noscript element.
    2. Take all the children of the parent element that come before the noscript element, and call these elements the before children.
    3. Take all the children of the parent element that come after the noscript element, and call these elements the after children.
    4. Let s be the concatenation of all the text node children of the noscript element.
    5. Set the innerHTML attribute of the parent element to the value of s. (This, as a side-effect, causes the noscript element to be removed from the document.)
    6. Insert the before children at the start of the parent element, preserving their original relative order.
    7. Insert the after children at the end of the parent element, preserving their original relative order.

The noscript element has no other requirements. In particular, children of the noscript element are not exempt from form submission, scripting, and so forth, even when the element is with script.

All these contortions are required because, for historical reasons, the noscript element is handled differently by the HTML parser based on whether scripting was enabled or not when the parser was invoked. The element is not allowed in XML, because in XML the parser is not affected by such state, and thus the element would not have the desired effect.

The noscript element interacts poorly with the designMode feature. Authors are encouraged to not use noscript elements on pages that will have designMode enabled.

4.10.3 eventsource 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
メタデータ内容が期待される場所。
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
src
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLEventSourceElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString src;
};

The eventsource element represents a target for events generated by a remote server.

The src attribute, if specified, must give a valid URL identifying a resource that uses the text/event-stream format.

When an eventsource element with a src attribute specified is inserted into the document, and when an eventsource element that is already in the document has a src attribute added, the user agent must run the add declared event source algorithm.

While an eventsource element is in a document, if its src attribute is mutated, the user agent must must run the remove declared event source algorithm followed by the add declared event source algorithm.

When an eventsource element with a src attribute specified is removed from a document, and when an eventsource element that is in a document with a src attribute specified has its src attribute removed, the user agent must run the remove declared event source algorithm.

When it is created, an eventsource element must have its current declared event source set to "undefined".

The add declared event source algorithm is as follows:

  1. Resolve the URL specified by the eventsource element's src attribute.
  2. If that fails, then set the element's current declared event source to "undefined" and abort these steps.
  3. Otherwise, act as if the addEventSource() method on the eventsource element had been invoked with the resulting absolute URL.
  4. Let the element's current declared event source be that absolute URL.

The remove declared event source algorithm is as follows:

  1. If the element's current declared event source is "undefined", abort these steps.
  2. Otherwise, act as if the removeEventSource() method on the eventsource element had been invoked with the element's current declared event source.
  3. Let the element's current declared event source be "undefined".

There can be more than one eventsource element per document, but authors should take care to avoid opening multiple connections to the same server as HTTP recommends a limit to the number of simultaneous connections that a user agent can open per server.

The src DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

4.11 Interactive elements

4.11.1 details 要素

分類
流れ内容
対話的内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
One legend element followed by flow content.
要素固有属性:
open
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLDetailsElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute boolean open;
};

The details element represents additional information or controls which the user can obtain on demand.

The details element is not appropriate for footnotes. Please see the section on footnotes for details on how to mark up footnotes.

The first element child of a details element, if it is a legend element, represents the summary of the details.

If the first element is not a legend element, the UA should provide its own legend (e.g. "Details").

The open content attribute is a boolean attribute. If present, it indicates that the details should be shown to the user. If the attribute is absent, the details should not be shown.

If the attribute is removed, then the details should be hidden. If the attribute is added, the details should be shown.

The user should be able to request that the details be shown or hidden. To honor a request for the details to be shown, the user agent must set the open attribute on the element to the value open. To honour a request for the details to be hidden, the user agent must remove the open attribute from the element.

The open attribute must reflect the open content attribute.

Rendering will be described in the Rendering section in due course. Basically CSS :open and :closed match the element, it's a block-level element by default, and when it matches :closed it renders as if it had an XBL binding attached to it whose template was just <template>▶<content includes="legend:first-child">Details</content></template>, and when it's :open it acts as if it had an XBL binding attached to it whose template was just <template>▼<content includes="legend:first-child">Details</content><content/></template> or some such.

4.11.2 datagrid 要素

分類
流れ内容
対話的内容
Sectioning root.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Either: Nothing.
Or: Flow content, but where the first element child node, if any, is not a table, select, or datalist element.
Or: A single table element.
Or: A single select element.
Or: A single datalist element.
要素固有属性:
multiple
disabled
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLDataGridElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DataGridDataProvider data;
  readonly attribute DataGridSelection selection;
           attribute boolean multiple;
           attribute boolean disabled;
  void updateEverything();
  void updateRowsChanged(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long count);
  void updateRowsInserted(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long count);
  void updateRowsRemoved(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long count);
  void updateRowChanged(in RowSpecification row);
  void updateColumnChanged(in unsigned long column);
  void updateCellChanged(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long column);
};

One possible thing to be added is a way to detect when a row/selection has been deleted, activated, etc, by the user (delete key, enter key, etc).

The datagrid element represents an interactive representation of tree, list, or tabular data.

The data being presented can come either from the content, as elements given as children of the datagrid element, or from a scripted data provider given by the data DOM attribute.

The multiple and disabled attributes are boolean attributes. Their effects are described in the processing model sections below.

The multiple and disabled DOM attributes must reflect the multiple and disabled content attributes respectively.

4.11.2.1. The datagrid data model

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

In the datagrid data model, data is structured as a set of rows representing a tree, each row being split into a number of columns. The columns are always present in the data model, although individual columns may be hidden in the presentation.

Each row can have child rows. Child rows may be hidden or shown, by closing or opening (respectively) the parent row.

Rows are referred to by the path along the tree that one would take to reach the row, using zero-based indices. Thus, the first row of a list is row "0", the second row is row "1"; the first child row of the first row is row "0,0", the second child row of the first row is row "0,1"; the fourth child of the seventh child of the third child of the tenth row is "9,2,6,3", etc.

The columns can have captions. Those captions are not considered a row in their own right, they are obtained separately.

Selection of data in a datagrid operates at the row level. If the multiple attribute is present, multiple rows can be selected at once, otherwise the user can only select one row at a time.

The datagrid element can be disabled entirely by setting the disabled attribute.

Columns, rows, and cells can each have specific flags, known as classes, applied to them by the data provider. These classes affect the functionality of the datagrid element, and are also passed to the style system. They are similar in concept to the class attribute, except that they are not specified on elements but are given by scripted data providers.

4.11.2.2. How rows are identified

chains of numbers that give a row's path, or identifier, are represented by objects that implement the RowSpecification 界面。

[NoInterfaceObject] interface RowSpecification {
  // binding-specific interface
};

In ECMAScript, two classes of objects are said to implement this interface: Numbers representing non-negative integers, and homogeneous arrays of Numbers representing non-negative integers. Thus, [1,0,9] is a RowSpecification, as is 1 on its own. However, [1,0.2,9] is not a RowSpecification object, since its second value is not an integer.

User agents must always represent RowSpecifications in ECMAScript by using arrays, even if the path only has one number.

The root of the tree is represented by the empty path; in ECMAScript, this is the empty array ([]). Only the getRowCount() and GetChildAtPosition() methods ever get called with the empty path.

4.11.2.3. data provider 界面

The conformance criteria in this section apply to any implementation of the DataGridDataProvider, including (and most commonly) the content author's implementation(s).

// To be implemented by Web authors as a JS object
[NoInterfaceObject] interface DataGridDataProvider {
  void initialize(in HTMLDataGridElement datagrid);
  unsigned long getRowCount(in RowSpecification row);
  unsigned long getChildAtPosition(in RowSpecification parentRow, in unsigned long position);
  unsigned long getColumnCount();
  DOMString getCaptionText(in unsigned long column);
  void getCaptionClasses(in unsigned long column, in DOMTokenList classes);
  DOMString getRowImage(in RowSpecification row);
  HTMLMenuElement getRowMenu(in RowSpecification row);
  void getRowClasses(in RowSpecification row, in DOMTokenList classes);
  DOMString getCellData(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long column);
  void getCellClasses(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long column, in DOMTokenList classes);
  void toggleColumnSortState(in unsigned long column);
  void setCellCheckedState(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long column, in long state);
  void cycleCell(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long column);
  void editCell(in RowSpecification row, in unsigned long column, in DOMString data);
};

The DataGridDataProvider interface represents the interface that objects must implement to be used as custom data views for datagrid elements.

Not all the methods are required. The minimum number of methods that must be implemented in a useful view is two: the getRowCount() and getCellData() methods.

Once the object is written, it must be hooked up to the datagrid using the data DOM attribute.

The following methods may be usefully implemented:

initialize(datagrid)
Called by the datagrid element (the one given by the datagrid argument) after it has first populated itself. This would typically be used to set the initial selection of the datagrid element when it is first loaded. The data provider could also use this method call to register a select event handler on the datagrid in order to monitor selection changes.
getRowCount(row)
Must return the number of rows that are children of the specified row, including rows that are off-screen. If row is empty, then the number of rows at the top level must be returned. If the value that this method would return for a given row changes, the relevant update methods on the datagrid must be called first. Otherwise, this method must always return the same number. For a list (as opposed to a tree), this method must return 0 whenever it is called with a row identifier that is not empty.
getChildAtPosition(parentRow, position)
Must return the index of the row that is a child of parentRow and that is to be positioned as the positionth row under parentRow when rendering the children of parentRow. If parentRow is empty, then position refers to the positionth row at the top level of the data grid. May be omitted if the rows are always to be sorted in the natural order. (The natural order is the one where the method always returns position.) For a given parentRow, this method must never return the same value for different values of position. The returned value x must be in the range 0 ≤ x < n, where n is the value returned by getRowCount(parentRow).
getColumnCount()
Must return the number of columns currently in the data model (including columns that might be hidden). May be omitted if there is only one column. If the value that this method would return changes, the datagrid's updateEverything() method must be called.
getCaptionText(column)
Must return the caption, or label, for column column. May be omitted if the columns have no captions. If the value that this method would return changes, the datagrid's updateColumnChanged() method must be called with the appropriate column index.
getCaptionClasses(column, classes)
Must add the classes that apply to column column to the classes object. May be omitted if the columns have no special classes. If the classes that this method would add changes, the datagrid's updateColumnChanged() method must be called with the appropriate column index. Some classes have predefined meanings.
getRowImage(row)
Must return a URL giving the address of an image that represents row row, or the empty string if there is no applicable image. May be omitted if no rows have associated images. If the value that this method would return changes, the datagrid's update methods must be called to update the row in question.
getRowMenu(row)
Must return an HTMLMenuElement object that is to be used as a context menu for row row, or null if there is no particular context menu. May be omitted if none of the rows have a special context menu. As this method is called immediately before showing the menu in question, no precautions need to be taken if the return value of this method changes.
getRowClasses(row, classes)
Must add the classes that apply to row row to the classes object. May be omitted if the rows have no special classes. If the classes that this method would add changes, the datagrid's update methods must be called to update the row in question. Some classes have predefined meanings.
getCellData(row, column)
Must return the value of the cell on row row in column column. For text cells, this must be the text to show for that cell. For progress bar cells, this must be either a floating point number in the range 0.0 to 1.0 (converted to a string representation), indicating the fraction of the progress bar to show as full (1.0 meaning complete), or the empty string, indicating an indeterminate progress bar. If the value that this method would return changes, the datagrid's update methods must be called to update the rows that changed. If only one cell changed, the updateCellChanged() method may be used.
getCellClasses(row, column, classes)
Must add the classes that apply to the cell on row row in column column to the classes object. May be omitted if the cells have no special classes. If the classes that this method would add changes, the datagrid's update methods must be called to update the rows or cells in question. Some classes have predefined meanings.
toggleColumnSortState(column)
Called by the datagrid when the user tries to sort the data using a particular column column. The data provider must update its state so that the GetChildAtPosition() method returns the new order, and the classes of the columns returned by getCaptionClasses() represent the new sort status. There is no need to tell the datagrid that it the data has changed, as the datagrid automatically assumes that the entire data model will need updating.
setCellCheckedState(row, column, state)
Called by the datagrid when the user changes the state of a checkbox cell on row row, column column. The checkbox should be toggled to the state given by state, which is a positive integer (1) if the checkbox is to be checked, zero (0) if it is to be unchecked, and a negative number (−1) if it is to be set to the indeterminate state. There is no need to tell the datagrid that the cell has changed, as the datagrid automatically assumes that the given cell will need updating.
cycleCell(row, column)
Called by the datagrid when the user changes the state of a cyclable cell on row row, column column. The data provider should change the state of the cell to the new state, as appropriate. There is no need to tell the datagrid that the cell has changed, as the datagrid automatically assumes that the given cell will need updating.
editCell(row, column, data)
Called by the datagrid when the user edits the cell on row row, column column. The new value of the cell is given by data. The data provider should update the cell accordingly. There is no need to tell the datagrid that the cell has changed, as the datagrid automatically assumes that the given cell will need updating.

The following classes (for rows, columns, and cells) may be usefully used in conjunction with this interface:
Class name Applies to Description
checked Cells The cell has a checkbox and it is checked. (The cyclable and progress classes override this, though.)
cyclable Cells The cell can be cycled through multiple values. (The progress class overrides this, though.)
editable Cells The cell can be edited. (The cyclable, progress, checked, unchecked and indeterminate classes override this, though.)
header Rows The row is a heading, not a data row.
indeterminate Cells The cell has a checkbox, and it can be set to an indeterminate state. If neither the checked nor unchecked classes are present, then the checkbox is in that state, too. (The cyclable and progress classes override this, though.)
initially-hidden Columns The column will not be shown when the datagrid is initially rendered. If this class is not present on the column when the datagrid is initially rendered, the column will be visible if space allows.
initially-closed Rows The row will be closed when the datagrid is initially rendered. If neither this class nor the initially-open class is present on the row when the datagrid is initially rendered, the initial state will depend on platform conventions.
initially-open Rows The row will be opened when the datagrid is initially rendered. If neither this class nor the initially-closed class is present on the row when the datagrid is initially rendered, the initial state will depend on platform conventions.
progress Cells The cell is a progress bar.
reversed Columns If the cell is sorted, the sort direction is descending, instead of ascending.
selectable-separator Rows The row is a normal, selectable, data row, except that instead of having data, it only has a separator. (The header and separator classes override this, though.)
separator Rows The row is a separator row, not a data row. (The header class overrides this, though.)
sortable Columns The data can be sorted by this column.
sorted Columns The data is sorted by this column. Unless the reversed class is also present, the sort direction is ascending.
unchecked Cells The cell has a checkbox and, unless the checked class is present as well, it is unchecked. (The cyclable and progress classes override this, though.)

4.11.2.4. The default data provider

The user agent must supply a default data provider for the case where the datagrid's data attribute is null. It must act as described in this section.

The behavior of the default data provider depends on the nature of the first element child of the datagrid.

While the first element child is a table element

getRowCount(row): The number of rows returned by the default data provider for the root of the tree (when row is empty) must be the total number of tr elements that are children of tbody elements that are children of the table, if there are any such child tbody elements. If there are no such tbody elements then the number of rows returned for the root must be the number of tr elements that are children of the table.

When row is not empty, the number of rows returned must be zero.

The table-based default data provider cannot represent a tree.

Rows in thead elements do not contribute to the number of rows returned, although they do affect the columns and column captions. Rows in tfoot elements are ignored completely by this algorithm.

getChildAtPosition(row, i): The default data provider must return the mapping appropriate to the current sort order.

getColumnCount(): The number of columns returned must be the number of td element children in the first tr element child of the first tbody element child of the table, if there are any such tbody elements. If there are no such tbody elements, then it must be the number of td element children in the first tr element child of the table, if any, or otherwise 1. If the number that would be returned by these rules is 0, then 1 must be returned instead.

getCaptionText(i): If the table has no thead element child, or if its first thead element child has no tr element child, the default data provider must return the empty string for all captions. Otherwise, the value of the textContent attribute of the ith th element child of the first tr element child of the first thead element child of the table element must be returned. If there is no such th element, the empty string must be returned.

getCaptionClasses(i, classes): If the table has no thead element child, or if its first thead element child has no tr element child, the default data provider must not add any classes for any of the captions. Otherwise, each class in the class attribute of the ith th element child of the first tr element child of the first thead element child of the table element must be added to the classes. If there is no such th element, no classes must be added. The user agent must then:

  1. Remove the sorted and reversed classes.
  2. If the table element has a class attribute that includes the sortable class, add the sortable class.
  3. If the column is the one currently being used to sort the data, add the sorted class.
  4. If the column is the one currently being used to sort the data, and it is sorted in descending order, add the reversed class as well.

The various row- and cell- related methods operate relative to a particular element, the element of the row or cell specified by their arguments.

For rows: Since the default data provider for a table always returns 0 as the number of children for any row other than the root, the path to the row passed to these methods will always consist of a single number. In the prose below, this number is referred to as i.

If the table has tbody element children, the element for the ith row is the ith tr element that is a child of a tbody element that is a child of the table element. If the table does not have tbody element children, then the element for the ith real row is the ith tr element that is a child of the table element.

For cells: Given a row and its element, the row's ith cell's element is the ith td element child of the row element.

The colspan and rowspan attributes are ignored by this algorithm.

getRowImage(i): The URL of the row's image is the absolute URL obtained by resolving the value of the src attribute of the first img element child of the row's first cell's element, if there is one and resolving its attribute is successful. Otherwise, the URL of the row's image is the empty string.

getRowMenu(i): If the row's first cell's element has a menu element child, then the row's menu is the first menu element child of the row's first cell's element. Otherwise, the row has no menu.

getRowClasses(i, classes): The default data provider must never add a class to the row's classes.

toggleColumnSortState(i): If the data is already being sorted on the given column, then the user agent must change the current sort mapping to be the inverse of the current sort mapping; if the sort order was ascending before, it is now descending, otherwise it is now ascending. Otherwise, if the current sort column is another column, or the data model is currently not sorted, the user agent must create a new mapping, which maps rows in the data model to rows in the DOM so that the rows in the data model are sorted by the specified column, in ascending order. (Which sort comparison operator to use is left up to the UA to decide.)

When the sort mapping is changed, the values returned by the getChildAtPosition() method for the default data provider will change appropriately.

getCellData(i, j), getCellClasses(i, j, classes), getCellCheckedState(i, j, state), cycleCell(i, j), and editCell(i, j, data): See the common definitions below.

The data provider must call the datagrid's update methods appropriately whenever the descendants of the datagrid mutate. For example, if a tr is removed, then the updateRowsRemoved() methods would probably need to be invoked, and any change to a cell or its descendants must cause the cell to be updated. If the table element stops being the first child of the datagrid, then the data provider must call the updateEverything() method on the datagrid. Any change to a cell that is in the column that the data provider is currently using as its sort column must also cause the sort to be reperformed, with a call to updateEverything() if the change did affect the sort order.

While the first element child is a select or datalist element

The default data provider must return 1 for the column count, the empty string for the column's caption, and must not add any classes to the column's classes.

For the rows, assume the existence of a node filter view of the descendants of the first element child of the datagrid element (the select or datalist element), that skips all nodes other than optgroup and option elements, as well as any descendents of any option elements.

Given a path row, the corresponding element is the one obtained by drilling into the view, taking the child given by the path each time.

Given the following XML markup:

<datagrid>
 <select>
  <!-- the options and optgroups have had their labels and values removed
       to make the underlying structure clearer -->
  <optgroup>
   <option/>
   <option/>
  </optgroup>
  <optgroup>
   <option/>
   <optgroup id="a">
    <option/>
    <option/>
    <bogus/>
    <option id="b"/>
   </optgroup>
   <option/>
  </optgroup>
 </select>
</datagrid>

The path "1,1,2" would select the element with ID "b". In the filtered view, the text nodes, comment nodes, and bogus elements are ignored; so for instance, the element with ID "a" (path "1,1") has only 3 child nodes in the view.

getRowCount(row) must drill through the view to find the element corresponding to the method's argument, and return the number of child nodes in the filtered view that the corresponding element has. (If the row is empty, the corresponding element is the select element at the root of the filtered view.)

getChildAtPosition(row, position) must return position. (The select/datalist default data provider does not support sorting the data grid.)

getRowImage(i) must return the empty string, getRowMenu(i) must return null.

getRowClasses(row, classes) must add the classes from the following list to classes when their condition is met:

The getCellData(row, cell) method must return the value of the label attribute if the row's corresponding element is an optgroup element, otherwise, if the row's corresponding element is an optionelement, its label attribute if it has one, otherwise the value of its textContent DOM attribute.

The getCellClasses(row, cell, classes) method must add no classes.

autoselect some rows when initialized, reflect the selection in the select, reflect the multiple attribute somehow.

The data provider must call the datagrid's update methods appropriately whenever the descendants of the datagrid mutate.

While the first element child is another element

The default data provider must return 1 for the column count, the empty string for the column's caption, and must not add any classes to the column's classes.

For the rows, assume the existence of a node filter view of the descendants of the datagrid that skips all nodes other than li, h1h6, and hr elements, and skips any descendants of menu elements.

Given this view, each element in the view represents a row in the data model. The element corresponding to a path row is the one obtained by drilling into the view, taking the child given by the path each time. The element of the row of a particular method call is the element given by drilling into the view along the path given by the method's arguments.

getRowCount(row) must return the number of child elements in this view for the given row, or the number of elements at the root of the view if the row is empty.

In the following example, the elements are identified by the paths given by their child text nodes:

<datagrid>
 <ol>
  <li> row 0 </li>
  <li> row 1
   <ol>
    <li> row 1,0 </li>
   </ol>
  </li>
  <li> row 2 </li>
 </ol>
</datagrid>

In this example, only the li elements actually appear in the data grid; the ol element does not affect the data grid's processing model.

getChildAtPosition(row, position) must return position. (The generic default data provider does not support sorting the data grid.)

getRowImage(i) must return the absolute URL obtained from resolving the value of the src attribute of the first img element descendant (in the real DOM) of the row's element, that is not also a descendant of another element in the filtered view that is a descendant of the row's element, if such an element exists and resolving its attribute is successful. Otherwise, it must return the empty string.

In the following example, the row with path "1,0" returns "http://example.com/a" as its image URL, and the other rows (including the row with path "1") return the empty string:

<datagrid>
 <ol>
  <li> row 0 </li>
  <li> row 1
   <ol>
    <li> row 1,0 <img src="http://example.com/a" alt=""> </li>
   </ol>
  </li>
  <li> row 2 </li>
 </ol>
</datagrid>

getRowMenu(i) must return the first menu element descendant (in the real DOM) of the row's element, that is not also a descendant of another element in the filtered view that is a descendant of the row's element. (This is analogous to the image case above.)

getRowClasses(i, classes) must add the classes from the following list to classes when their condition is met:

The getCellData(i, j), getCellClasses(i, j, classes), getCellCheckedState(i, j, state), cycleCell(i, j), and editCell(i, j, data) methods must act as described in the common definitions below, treating the row's element as being the cell's element.

selection handling?

The data provider must call the datagrid's update methods appropriately whenever the descendants of the datagrid mutate.

Otherwise, while there is no element child

The data provider must return 0 for the number of rows, 1 for the number of columns, the empty string for the first column's caption, and must add no classes when asked for that column's classes. If the datagrid's child list changes such that there is a first element child, then the data provider must call the updateEverything() method on the datagrid.

4.11.2.4.1. Common default data provider method definitions for cells

These definitions are used for the cell-specific methods of the default data providers (other than in the select/datalist case). How they behave is based on the contents of an element that represents the cell given by their first two arguments. Which element that is is defined in the previous section.

Cyclable cells

If the first element child of a cell's element is a select element that has a no multiple attribute and has at least one option element descendent, then the cell acts as a cyclable cell.

The "current" option element is the selected option element, or the first option element if none is selected.

The getCellData() method must return the textContent of the current option element (the label attribute is ignored in this context as the optgroups are not displayed).

The getCellClasses() method must add the cyclable class and then all the classes of the current option element.

The cycleCell() method must change the selection of the select element such that the next option element after the current option element is the only one that is selected (in tree order). If the current option element is the last option element descendent of the select, then the first option element descendent must be selected instead.

The setCellCheckedState() and editCell() methods must do nothing.

Progress bar cells

If the first element child of a cell's element is a progress element, then the cell acts as a progress bar cell.

The getCellData() method must return the value returned by the progress element's position DOM attribute.

The getCellClasses() method must add the progress class.

The setCellCheckedState(), cycleCell(), and editCell() methods must do nothing.

Checkbox cells

If the first element child of a cell's element is an input element that has a type attribute with the value checkbox, then the cell acts as a check box cell.

The getCellData() method must return the textContent of the cell element.

The getCellClasses() method must add the checked class if the input element is checked, and the unchecked class otherwise.

The setCellCheckedState() method must set the input element's checkbox state to checked if the method's third argument is 1, and to unchecked otherwise.

The cycleCell() and editCell() methods must do nothing.

Editable cells

If the first element child of a cell's element is an input element that has a type attribute with the value text or that has no type attribute at all, then the cell acts as an editable cell.

The getCellData() method must return the value of the input element.

The getCellClasses() method must add the editable class.

The editCell() method must set the input element's value DOM attribute to the value of the third argument to the method.

The setCellCheckedState() and cycleCell() methods must do nothing.

4.11.2.5. Populating the datagrid element

A datagrid must be disabled until its end tag has been parsed (in the case of a datagrid element in the original document markup) or until it has been inserted into the document (in the case of a dynamically created element). After that point, the element must fire a single load event at itself, which doesn't bubble and cannot be canceled.

The end-tag parsing thing should be moved to the parsing section.

The datagrid must then populate itself using the data provided by the data provider assigned to the data DOM attribute. After the view is populated (using the methods described below), the datagrid must invoke the initialize() method on the data provider specified by the data attribute, passing itself (the HTMLDataGridElement object) as the only argument.

When the data attribute is null, the datagrid must use the default data provider described in the previous section.

To obtain data from the data provider, the element must invoke methods on the data provider object in the following ways:

To determine the total number of columns
Invoke the getColumnCount() method with no arguments. The return value is the number of columns. If the return value is zero or negative, not an integer, or simply not a numeric type, or if the method is not defined, then 1 must be used instead.
To get the captions to use for the columns
Invoke the getCaptionText() method with the index of the column in question. The index i must be in the range 0 ≤ i < N, where N is the total number of columns. The return value is the string to use when referring to that column. If the method returns null or the empty string, the column has no caption. If the method is not defined, then none of the columns have any captions.
To establish what classes apply to a column
Invoke the getCaptionClasses() method with the index of the column in question, and an object implementing the DOMTokenList interface, associated with an anonymous empty string. The index i must be in the range 0 ≤ i < N, where N is the total number of columns. The tokens contained in the string underlying DOMTokenList object when the method returns represent the classes that apply to the given column. If the method is not defined, no classes apply to the column.
To establish whether a column should be initially included in the visible columns
Check whether the initially-hidden class applies to the column. If it does, then the column should not be initially included; if it does not, then the column should be initially included.
To establish whether the data can be sorted relative to a particular column
Check whether the sortable class applies to the column. If it does, then the user should be able to ask the UA to display the data sorted by that column; if it does not, then the user agent must not allow the user to ask for the data to be sorted by that column.
To establish if a column is a sorted column
If the user agent can handle multiple columns being marked as sorted simultaneously: Check whether the sorted class applies to the column. If it does, then that column is the sorted column, otherwise it is not.
If the user agent can only handle one column being marked as sorted at a time: Check each column in turn, starting with the first one, to see whether the sorted class applies to that column. The first column that has that class, if any, is the sorted column. If none of the columns have that class, there is no sorted column.
To establish the sort direction of a sorted column
Check whether the reversed class applies to the column. If it does, then the sort direction is descending (down; first rows have the highest values), otherwise it is ascending (up; first rows have the lowest values).
To determine the total number of rows
Determine the number of rows for the root of the data grid, and determine the number of child rows for each open row. The total number of rows is the sum of all these numbers.
To determine the number of rows for the root of the data grid
Invoke the getRowCount() method with a RowSpecification object representing the empty path as its only argument. The return value is the number of rows at the top level of the data grid. If the return value of the method is negative, not an integer, or simply not a numeric type, or if the method is not defined, then zero must be used instead.
To determine the number of child rows for a row
Invoke the getRowCount() method with a RowSpecification object representing the path to the row in question. The return value is the number of child rows for the given row. If the return value of the method is negative, not an integer, or simply not a numeric type, or if the method is not defined, then zero must be used instead.
To determine what order to render rows in

Invoke the getChildAtPosition() method with a RowSpecification object representing the path to the parent of the rows that are being rendered as the first argument, and the position that is being rendered as the second argument. The return value is the index of the row to render in that position.

If the rows are:

  1. Row "0"
    1. Row "0,0"
    2. Row "0,1"
  2. Row "1"
    1. Row "1,0"
    2. Row "1,1"

...and the getChildAtPosition() method is implemented as follows:

function getChildAtPosition(parent, child) {
  // always return the reverse order
  return getRowCount(parent)-child-1;
}

...then the rendering would actually be:

  1. Row "1"
    1. Row "1,1"
    2. Row "1,0"
  2. Row "0"
    1. Row "0,1"
    2. Row "0,0"

If the return value of the method is negative, larger than the number of rows that the getRowCount() method reported for that parent, not an integer, or simply not a numeric type, then the entire data grid should be disabled. Similarly, if the method returns the same value for two or more different values for the second argument (with the same first argument, and assuming that the data grid hasn't had relevant update methods invoked in the meantime), then the data grid should be disabled. Instead of disabling the data grid, the user agent may act as if the getChildAtPosition() method was not defined on the data provider (thus disabling sorting for that data grid, but still letting the user interact with the data). If the method is not defined, then the return value must be assumed to be the same as the second argument (an identity transform; the data is rendered in its natural order).

To establish what classes apply to a row
Invoke the getRowClasses() method with a RowSpecification object representing the row in question, and a DOMTokenList associated with an empty string. The tokens contained in the DOMTokenList object's underlying string when the method returns represent the classes that apply to the row in question. If the method is not defined, no classes apply to the row.
To establish whether a row is a data row or a special row
Examine the classes that apply to the row. If the header class applies to the row, then it is not a data row, it is a subheading. The data from the first cell of the row is the text of the subheading, the rest of the cells must be ignored. Otherwise, if the separator class applies to the row, then in the place of the row, a separator should be shown. Otherwise, if the selectable-separator class applies to the row, then the row should be a data row, but represented as a separator. (The difference between a separator and a selectable-separator is that the former is not an item that can be actually selected, whereas the second can be selected and thus has a context menu that applies to it, and so forth.) For both kinds of separator rows, the data of the rows' cells must all be ignored. If none of those three classes apply then the row is a simple data row.
To establish whether a row is openable
Determine the number of child rows for that row. If there are one or more child rows, then the row is openable.
To establish whether a row should be initially open or closed
If the row is openable, examine the classes that apply to the row. If the initially-open class applies to the row, then it should be initially open. Otherwise, if the initially-closed class applies to the row, then it must be initially closed. Otherwise, if neither class applies to the row, or if the row is not openable, then the initial state of the row should be based on platform conventions.
To obtain a URL identifying an image representing a row
Invoke the getRowImage() method with a RowSpecification object representing the row in question. The return value is a URL. Immediately resolve that URL as if it came from an attribute of the datagrid element to obtain an absolute URL identifying the image that represents the row. If the method returns the empty string, null, or if the method is not defined, then the row has no associated image.
To obtain a context menu appropriate for a particular row
Invoke the getRowMenu() method with a RowSpecification object representing the row in question. The return value is a reference to an object implementing the HTMLMenuElement interface, i.e. a menu element DOM node. (This element must then be interpreted as described in the section on context menus to obtain the actual context menu to use.) If the method returns something that is not an HTMLMenuElement, or if the method is not defined, then the row has no associated context menu. User agents may provide their own default context menu, and may add items to the author-provided context menu. For example, such a menu could allow the user to change the presentation of the datagrid element.
To establish the value of a particular cell
Invoke the getCellData() method with the first argument being a RowSpecification object representing the row of the cell in question and the second argument being the index of the cell's column. The second argument must be a non-negative integer less than the total number of columns. The return value is the value of the cell. If the return value is null or the empty string, or if the method is not defined, then the cell has no data. (For progress bar cells, the cell's value must be further interpreted, as described below.)
To establish what classes apply to a cell
Invoke the getCellClasses() method with the first argument being a RowSpecification object representing the row of the cell in question, the second argument being the index of the cell's column, and the third being an object implementing the DOMTokenList interface, associated with an empty string. The second argument must be a non-negative integer less than the total number of columns. The tokens contained in the DOMTokenList object's underlying string when the method returns represent the classes that apply to that cell. If the method is not defined, no classes apply to the cell.
To establish the type of a cell
Examine the classes that apply to the cell. If the progress class applies to the cell, it is a progress bar. Otherwise, if the cyclable class applies to the cell, it is a cycling cell whose value can be cycled between multiple states. Otherwise, none of these classes apply, and the cell is a simple text cell.
To establish the value of a progress bar cell
If the value x of the cell is a string that can be converted to a floating-point number in the range 0.0 ≤ x ≤ 1.0, then the progress bar has that value (0.0 means no progress, 1.0 means complete). Otherwise, the progress bar is an indeterminate progress bar.
To establish how a simple text cell should be presented
Check whether one of the checked, unchecked, or indeterminate classes applies to the cell. If any of these are present, then the cell has a checkbox, otherwise none are present and the cell does not have a checkbox. If the cell has no checkbox, check whether the editable class applies to the cell. If it does, then the cell value is editable, otherwise the cell value is static.
To establish the state of a cell's checkbox, if it has one
Check whether the checked class applies to the cell. If it does, the cell is checked. Otherwise, check whether the unchecked class applies to the cell. If it does, the cell is unchecked. Otherwise, the indeterminate class applies to the cell and the cell's checkbox is in an indeterminate state. When the indeterminate class applies to the cell, the checkbox is a tristate checkbox, and the user can set it to the indeterminate state. Otherwise, only the checked and/or unchecked classes apply to the cell, and the cell can only be toggled between those two states.

If the data provider ever raises an exception while the datagrid is invoking one of its methods, the datagrid must act, for the purposes of that particular method call, as if the relevant method had not been defined.

A RowSpecification object p with n path components passed to a method of the data provider must fulfill the constraint 0 ≤ pi < m-1 for all integer values of i in the range 0 ≤ i < n-1, where m is the value that was last returned by the getRowCount() method when it was passed the RowSpecification object q with i-1 items, where pi = qi for all integer values of i in the range 0 ≤ i < n-1, with any changes implied by the update methods taken into account.

The data model is considered stable: user agents may assume that subsequent calls to the data provider methods will return the same data, until one of the update methods is called on the datagrid element. If a user agent is returned inconsistent data, for example if the number of rows returned by getRowCount() varies in ways that do not match the calls made to the update methods, the user agent may disable the datagrid. User agents that do not disable the datagrid in inconsistent cases must honor the most recently returned values.

User agents may cache returned values so that the data provider is never asked for data that could contradict earlier data. User agents must not cache the return value of the getRowMenu method.

The exact algorithm used to populate the data grid is not defined here, since it will differ based on the presentation used. However, the behavior of user agents must be consistent with the descriptions above. For example, it would be non-conformant for a user agent to make cells have both a checkbox and be editable, as the descriptions above state that cells that have a checkbox cannot be edited.

4.11.2.6. Updating the datagrid

Whenever the data attribute is set to a new value, the datagrid must clear the current selection, remove all the displayed rows, and plan to repopulate itself using the information from the new data provider at the earliest opportunity.

There are a number of update methods that can be invoked on the datagrid element to cause it to refresh itself in slightly less drastic ways:

When the updateEverything() method is called, the user agent must repopulate the entire datagrid. If the number of rows decreased, the selection must be updated appropriately. If the number of rows increased, the new rows should be left unselected.

When the updateRowsChanged(row, count) method is called, the user agent must refresh the rendering of the rows starting from the row specified by row, and including the count next siblings of the row (or as many next siblings as it has, if that is less than count), including all descendant rows.

When the updateRowsInserted(row, count) method is called, the user agent must assume that count new rows have been inserted, such that the first new row is identified by row. The user agent must update its rendering and the selection accordingly. The new rows should not be selected.

When the updateRowsRemoved(row, count) method is called, the user agent must assume that count rows have been removed starting from the row that used to be identifier by row. The user agent must update its rendering and the selection accordingly.

The updateRowChanged(row) method must be exactly equivalent to calling updateRowsChanged(row, 1).

When the updateColumnChanged(column) method is called, the user agent must refresh the rendering of the specified column column, for all rows.

When the updateCellChanged(row, column) method is called, the user agent must refresh the rendering of the cell on row row, in column column.

Any effects the update methods have on the datagrid's selection is not considered a change to the selection, and must therefore not fire the select event.

These update methods should be called only by the data provider, or code acting on behalf of the data provider. In particular, calling the updateRowsInserted() and updateRowsRemoved() methods without actually inserting or removing rows from the data provider is likely to result in inconsistent renderings, and the user agent is likely to disable the data grid.

4.11.2.7. 対話的利用者エージェントに対する要件

この節は対話的利用者エージェントにのみ適用されます。

If the datagrid element has a disabled attribute, then the user agent must disable the datagrid, preventing the user from interacting with it. The datagrid element should still continue to update itself when the data provider signals changes to the data, though. Obviously, conformance requirements stating that datagrid elements must react to users in particular ways do not apply when one is disabled.

If a row is openable, then the user should be able to toggle its open/closed state. When a row's open/closed state changes, the user agent must update the rendering to match the new state.

If a cell is a cell whose value can be cycled between multiple states, then the user must be able to activate the cell to cycle its value. When the user activates this "cycling" behavior of a cell, then the datagrid must invoke the data provider's cycleCell() method, with a RowSpecification object representing the cell's row as the first argument and the cell's column index as the second. The datagrid must then act as if the datagrid's updateCellChanged() method had been invoked with those same arguments.

When a cell has a checkbox, the user must be able to set the checkbox's state. When the user changes the state of a checkbox in such a cell, the datagrid must invoke the data provider's setCellCheckedState() method, with a RowSpecification object representing the cell's row as the first argument, the cell's column index as the second, and the checkbox's new state as the third. The state should be represented by the number 1 if the new state is checked, 0 if the new state is unchecked, and −1 if the new state is indeterminate (which must be possible only if the cell has the indeterminate class set). The datagrid must then act as if the datagrid's updateCellChanged() method had been invoked, specifying the same cell.

If a cell is editable, the user must be able to edit the data for that cell, and doing so must cause the user agent to invoke the editCell() method of the data provider with three arguments: a RowSpecification object representing the cell's row, the cell's column's index, and the new text entered by the user. The user agent must then act as if the updateCellChanged() method had been invoked, with the same row and column specified.

4.11.2.8. The selection

This section only applies to interactive user agents. For other user agents, the selection attribute must return null.

interface DataGridSelection {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] RowSpecification item(in unsigned long index);
  boolean isSelected(in RowSpecification row);
  void setSelected(in RowSpecification row, in boolean selected);

  void selectAll();
  void invert();
  void clear();
};

Each datagrid element must keep track of which rows are currently selected. Initially no rows are selected, but this can be changed via the methods described in this section.

The selection of a datagrid is represented by its selection DOM attribute, which must be a DataGridSelection object.

DataGridSelection objects represent the rows in the selection. In the selection the rows must be ordered in the natural order of the data provider (and not, e.g., the rendered order). Rows that are not rendered because one of their ancestors is closed must share the same selection state as their nearest rendered ancestor. Such rows are not considered part of the selection for the purposes of iterating over the selection.

This selection API doesn't allow for hidden rows to be selected because it is trivial to create a data provider that has infinite depth, which would then require the selection to be infinite if every row, including every hidden row, was selected.

The length attribute must return the number of rows currently present in the selection. The item(index) method must return the indexth row in the selection. If the argument is out of range (less than zero or greater than the number of selected rows minus one), then it must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception. [DOM3CORE]

The isSelected() method must return the selected state of the row specified by its argument. If the specified row exists and is selected, it must return true, otherwise it must return false.

The setSelected() method takes two arguments, row and selected. When invoked, it must set the selection state of row row to selected if selected is true, and unselected if it is false. If row is not a row in the data grid, the method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception. If the specified row is not rendered because one of its ancestors is closed, the method must do nothing.

The selectAll() method must mark all the rows in the data grid as selected. After a call to selectAll(), the length attribute will return the number of rows in the data grid, not counting children of closed rows.

The invert() method must cause all the rows in the selection that were marked as selected to now be marked as not selected, and vice versa.

The clear() method must mark all the rows in the data grid to be marked as not selected. After a call to clear(), the length attribute will return zero.

If the datagrid element has a multiple attribute, then the user must be able to select any number of rows (zero or more). If the attribute is not present, then the user must not be able to select more than a single row at a time, and selecting another one must unselect all the other rows.

This only applies to the user. Scripts can select multiple rows even when the multiple attribute is absent.

Whenever the selection of a datagrid changes, whether due to the user interacting with the element, or as a result of calls to methods of the selection object, a select event that bubbles but is not cancelable must be fired on the datagrid element. If changes are made to the selection via calls to the object's methods during the execution of a script, then the select events must be coalesced into one, which must then be fired when the script execution has completed.

DataGridSelection interface has no relation to the Selection 界面。

4.11.2.9. Columns and captions

この節は対話的利用者エージェントにのみ適用されます。

Each datagrid element must keep track of which columns are currently being rendered. User agents should initially show all the columns except those with the initially-hidden class, but may allow users to hide or show columns. User agents should initially display the columns in the order given by the data provider, but may allow this order to be changed by the user.

If columns are not being used, as might be the case if the data grid is being presented in an icon view, or if an overview of data is being read in an aural context, then the text of the first column of each row should be used to represent the row.

If none of the columns have any captions (i.e. if the data provider does not provide a getCaptionText() method), then user agents may avoid showing the column headers at all. This may prevent the user from performing actions on the columns (such as reordering them, changing the sort column, and so on).

Whatever the order used for rendering, and irrespective of what columns are being shown or hidden, the "first column" as referred to in this specification is always the column with index zero, and the "last column" is always the column with the index one less than the value returned by the getColumnCount() method of the data provider.

If a column is sortable, then the user must be able to invoke it to sort the data. When the user does so, then the datagrid must invoke the data provider's toggleColumnSortState() method, with the column's index as the only argument. The datagrid must then act as if the datagrid's updateEverything() method had been invoked.

4.11.3 command 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
語句付け内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
メタデータ内容が期待される場所。
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
type
label
icon
hidden
disabled
checked
radiogroup
default
Also, the title attribute has special semantics on this element.
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLCommandElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute DOMString label;
           attribute DOMString icon;
           attribute boolean hidden;
           attribute boolean disabled;
           attribute boolean checked;
           attribute DOMString radiogroup;
           attribute boolean default;
 void click(); // shadows HTMLElement.click()
};

Command 界面もこの要素に実装しなければなりません

The command element represents a command that the user can invoke.

The type attribute indicates the kind of command: either a normal command with an associated action, or a state or option that can be toggled, or a selection of one item from a list of items.

The attribute's value must be either "command", "checkbox", or "radio", denoting each of these three types of commands respectively. The attribute may also be omitted if the element is to represent the first of these types, a simple command.

The label attribute gives the name of the command, as shown to the user.

The title attribute gives a hint describing the command, which might be shown to the user to help him.

The icon attribute gives a picture that represents the command. If the attribute is specified, the attribute's value must contain a valid URL.

The hidden attribute is a boolean attribute that, if present, indicates that the command is not relevant and is to be hidden.

The disabled attribute is a boolean attribute that, if present, indicates that the command is not available in the current state.

The distinction between Disabled State and Hidden State is subtle. A command should be Disabled if, in the same context, it could be enabled if only certain aspects of the situation were changed. A command should be marked as Hidden if, in that situation, the command will never be enabled. For example, in the context menu for a water faucet, the command "open" might be Disabled if the faucet is already open, but the command "eat" would be marked Hidden since the faucet could never be eaten.

The checked attribute is a boolean attribute that, if present, indicates that the command is selected.

The radiogroup attribute gives the name of the group of commands that will be toggled when the command itself is toggled, for commands whose type attribute has the value "radio". The scope of the name is the child list of the parent element.

If the command element is used when generating a context menu, then the default attribute indicates, if present, that the command is the one that would have been invoked if the user had directly activated the menu's subject instead of using its context menu. The default attribute is a boolean attribute.

Need an example that shows an element that, if double-clicked, invokes an action, but that also has a context menu, showing the various command attributes off, and that has a default command.

DOM 属性 type, label, icon, hidden, disabled, checked, radiogroup, default は同じ名前の内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The click() method's behavior depends on the value of the type attribute of the element, as follows:

If the type attribute has the value checkbox

If the element has a checked attribute, the UA must remove that attribute. Otherwise, the UA must add a checked attribute, with the literal value checked. The UA must then fire a click event at the element.

If the type attribute has the value radio

If the element has a parent, then the UA must walk the list of child nodes of that parent element, and for each node that is a command element, if that element has a radiogroup attribute whose value exactly matches the current element's (treating missing radiogroup attributes as if they were the empty string), and has a checked attribute, must remove that attribute and fire a click event at the element.

Then, the element's checked attribute attribute must be set to the literal value checked and a click event must be fired at the element.

その他の場合

The UA must fire a click event at the element.

Firing a synthetic click event at the element does not cause any of the actions described above to happen.

should change all the above so it actually is just triggered by a click event, then we could remove the shadowing click() method and rely on actual events.

Need to define the command="" attribute

command elements are not rendered unless they form part of a menu.

4.11.4 bb 要素

分類
語句付け内容
対話的内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
語句付け内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容、ただし対話的内容な子孫があってはなりません
要素固有属性:
type
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLBrowserButtonElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString type;
  readonly attribute boolean supported;
  readonly attribute boolean disabled;
};

Command 界面もこの要素に実装しなければなりません

The bb element represents a user agent command that the user can invoke.

The type attribute indicates the kind of command. The type attribute is an enumerated attribute. The following table lists the keywords and states for the attribute — the keywords in the left column map to the states listed in the cell in the second column on the same row as the keyword.
Keyword State
makeapp make application

The missing value default state is the null state.

Each state has an action and a relevance, defined in the following sections.

When the attribute is in the null state, the action is to not do anything, and the relevance is unconditionally false.

A bb element whose type attribute is in a state whose relevance is true must be enabled. Conversely, a bb element whose type attribute is in a state whose relevance is false must be disabled.

If a bb element is enabled, it must match the :enabled pseudo-class; otherwise, it must match the :disabled pseudo-class.

User agents should allow users to invoke bb elements when they are enabled. When a user invokes a bb element, its type attribute's state's action must be invoked.

When the element has no descendant element children and has no descendant text node children of non-zero length, the element represents a browser button with a user-agent-defined icon or text representing the type attribute's state's action and relevance (enabled vs disabled). Otherwise, the element represents its descendants.

The type DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

The supported DOM attribute must return true if the type attribute is in a state other than the null state and the user agent supports that state's action (i.e. when the attribute's value is one that the user agent recognises and supports), and false otherwise.

The disabled DOM attribute must return true if the element is disabled, and false otherwise (i.e. it returns the opposite of the type attribute's state's relevance).

4.11.4.1. Browser button types
4.11.4.1.1. The make application state

Some user agents support making sites accessible as independent applications, as if they were not Web sites at all. The make application state exists to allow Web pages to offer themselves to the user as targets for this mode of operation.

The action of the make application state is to confirm the user's intent to use the current site in a standalone fashion, and, provided the user's intent is confirmed, offer the user a way to make the resource identified by the document's address available in such a fashion.

The confirmation is needed because it is relatively easy to trick users into activating buttons. The confirmation could, e.g. take the form of asking the user where to "save" the application, or non-modal information panel that is clearly from the user agent and gives the user the opportunity to drag an icon to their system's application launcher.

The relevance of the make application state is false if the user agent is already handling the site in such a fashion, or if the user agent doesn't support making the site available in that fashion, and true otherwise.

In the following example, a few links are listed on an application's page, to allow the user perform certain actions, including making the application standalone:

<menu>
 <li><a href="settings.html" onclick="panels.show('settings')">Settings</a>
 <li><bb type="makeapp">Download standalone application</a>
 <li><a href="help.html" onclick="panels.show('help')">Help</a>
 <li><a href="logout.html" onclick="panels.show('logout')">Sign out</a>
</menu>

With the following stylesheet, it could be make to look like a single line of text with vertical bars separating the options, with the "make app" option disappearing when it's not supported or relevant:

menu li { display: none; }
menu li:enabled { display: inline; }
menu li:not(:first-child)::before { content: ' | '; }

This could look like this:

"Settings | Download standalone application | Help | Sign out"

The following example shows another way to do the same thing as the previous one, this time not relying on CSS support to hide the "make app" link if it doesn't apply:

<menu>
 <a href="settings.html" onclick="panels.show('settings')">Settings</a> |
 <bb type="makeapp" id="makeapp"> </bb>
 <a href="help.html" onclick="panels.show('help')">Help</a> |
 <a href="logout.html" onclick="panels.show('logout')">Sign out</a>
</menu>
<script>
 var bb = document.getElementById('makeapp');
 if (bb.supported && bb.enabled) {
   bb.parentNode.nextSibling.textContent = ' | ';
   bb.textContent = 'Download standalone application';
 } else {
   bb.parentNode.removeChild(bb);
 }
</script>
分類
流れ内容
If the element's type attribute is in the tool bar state: Interactive content.
If there is a menu element ancestor: phrasing content.
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
If there is a menu element ancestor: where phrasing content is expected.
内容モデル:
Either: Zero or more li elements.
Or: Phrasing content.
要素固有属性:
type
label
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLMenuElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString type;
           attribute DOMString label;
};

The menu element represents a list of commands.

The type attribute is an enumerated attribute indicating the kind of menu being declared. The attribute has three states. The context keyword maps to the context menu state, in which the element is declaring a context menu. The toolbar keyword maps to the tool bar state, in which the element is declaring a tool bar. The attribute may also be omitted. The missing value default is the list state, which indicates that the element is merely a list of commands that is neither declaring a context menu nor defining a tool bar.

If a menu element's type attribute is in the context menu state, then the element represents the commands of a context menu, and the user can only interact with the commands if that context menu is activated.

If a menu element's type attribute is in the tool bar state, then the element represents a list of active commands that the user can immediately interact with.

If a menu element's type attribute is in the list state, then the element either represents an unordered list of items (each represented by an li element), each of which represents a command that the user may perform or activate, or, if the element has no li element children, flow content describing available commands.

The label attribute gives the label of the menu. It is used by user agents to display nested menus in the UI. For example, a context menu containing another menu would use the nested menu's label attribute for the submenu's menu label.

DOM 属性 type, label は同じ名前の内容属性を反映しなければなりません

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

...

4.11.5.2. メニューとツールバーの構築

メニュー (やツールバー) は、次の部品の零以上の並びで構成されます。

特定の menu 要素に対応する並びは、 その子供節点に対して反復 (iteration) を行うことで構築できます。 各子供節点について、木順で、 節点の種類によって次に示すような動作が要求されます

命令を定義する要素
Append the command to the menu. If the element is a command element with a default attribute, mark the command as being a default command.
hr 要素
value 属性が空文字列であり、 disabled 属性を有し、 その textContent が1文字以上のハイフン (U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS) から成る文字列で構成される option 要素
区切子をメニューの最後に追加します。
li 要素
li 要素の子供について反復 (iteration) します。
label 属性のない menu 要素
select 要素
区切子をメニューの最後に追加し、 menu 要素または select 要素の子供について反復 (iteration) し、更に区切子を最後に追加します。
label 属性のある menu 要素
optgroup 要素
部分メニューをメニューの最後に追加します。このとき、その要素の label 属性の値をメニューの名札として使います。 部分メニューは、その要素をもってこの節で説明した処理全体を用いて新たなメニューを作成することにより構築しなければなりません
その他の節点
その節点を無視します。

We should support label in the algorithm above -- just iterate through the contents like with li, to support input elements in label elements. Also, optgroup elements without labels should be ignored (maybe? or at least should say they have no label so that they are dropped below), and select elements inside label elements may need special processing.

利用者エージェントは、すべての節点が前述のように処理されたら、 メニューを次のように後処理しなければなりません

  1. 名札がないか名札が空文字列であるメニュー項目は削除しなければなりません
  2. 2つ以上の連続した区切子の列は1つの区切子に折り畳まなければなりません
  3. メニューの最初と最後の区切子は削除しなければなりません
4.11.5.3. Context menus

The contextmenu attribute gives the element's context menu. The value must be the ID of a menu element in the DOM. If the node that would be obtained by the invoking the getElementById() method using the attribute's value as the only argument is null or not a menu element, then the element has no assigned context menu. Otherwise, the element's assigned context menu is the element so identified.

When an element's context menu is requested (e.g. by the user right-clicking the element, or pressing a context menu key), the UA must fire a contextmenu event on the element for which the menu was requested.

Typically, therefore, the firing of the contextmenu event will be the default action of a mouseup or keyup event. The exact sequence of events is UA-dependent, as it will vary based on platform conventions.

The default action of the contextmenu event depends on whether the element has a context menu assigned (using the contextmenu attribute) or not. If it does not, the default action must be for the user agent to show its default context menu, if it has one.

Context menus should inherit (so clicking on a span in a paragraph with a context menu should show the menu).

If the element does have a context menu assigned, then the user agent must fire a show event on the relevant menu element.

The default action of this event is that the user agent must show a context menu built from the menu element.

The user agent may also provide access to its default context menu, if any, with the context menu shown. For example, it could merge the menu items from the two menus together, or provide the page's context menu as a submenu of the default menu.

If the user dismisses the menu without making a selection, nothing in particular happens.

If the user selects a menu item that represents a command, then the UA must invoke that command's Action.

Context menus must not, while being shown, reflect changes in the DOM; they are constructed as the default action of the show event and must remain like that until dismissed.

User agents may provide means for bypassing the context menu processing model, ensuring that the user can always access the UA's default context menus. For example, the user agent could handle right-clicks that have the Shift key depressed in such a way that it does not fire the contextmenu event and instead always shows the default context menu.

The contextMenu attribute must reflect the contextmenu content attribute.

4.11.5.4. Toolbars

Toolbars are a kind of menu that is always visible.

When a menu element has a type attribute with the value toolbar, then the user agent must build the menu for that menu element and render it in the document in a position appropriate for that menu element.

The user agent must reflect changes made to the menu's DOM immediately in the UI.

4.11.6 Commands

A command is the abstraction behind menu items, buttons, and links. Once a command is defined, other parts of the interface can refer to the same command, allowing many access points to a single feature to share aspects such as the disabled state.

Commands are defined to have the following facets:

Type
The kind of command: "command", meaning it is a normal command; "radio", meaning that triggering the command will, amongst other things, set the Checked State to true (and probably uncheck some other commands); or "checkbox", meaning that triggering the command will, amongst other things, toggle the value of the Checked State.
ID
The name of the command, for referring to the command from the markup or from script. If a command has no ID, it is an anonymous command.
Label
The name of the command as seen by the user.
Hint
A helpful or descriptive string that can be shown to the user.
Icon
An absolute URL identifying a graphical image that represents the action. A command might not have an Icon.
Hidden State
Whether the command is hidden or not (basically, whether it should be shown in menus).
Disabled State
Whether the command can be triggered or not. If the Hidden State is true (hidden) then the Disabled State will be true (disabled) regardless.
Checked State
Whether the command is checked or not.
Action
The actual effect that triggering the command will have. This could be a scripted event handler, a URL to which to navigate, or a form submission.
Triggers
The list of elements that can trigger the command. The element defining a command is always in the list of elements that can trigger the command. For anonymous commands, only the element defining the command is on the list, since other elements have no way to refer to it.

Commands are represented by elements in the DOM. Any element that can define a command also implements the Command interface:

Actually even better would be to just mix it straight into those interfaces somehow.

[NoInterfaceObject] interface Command {
  readonly attribute DOMString commandType;          
  readonly attribute DOMString id;
  readonly attribute DOMString label;
  readonly attribute DOMString title;
  readonly attribute DOMString icon;
  readonly attribute boolean hidden;
  readonly attribute boolean disabled;              
  readonly attribute boolean checked;              
  void click();
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection triggers;
  readonly attribute Command command;
};

Command interface is implemented by any element capable of defining a command. (If an element can define a command, its definition will list this interface explicitly.) All the attributes of the Command interface are read-only. Elements implementing this interface may implement other interfaces that have attributes with identical names but that are mutable; in bindings that flatten all supported interfaces on the object, the mutable attributes must shadow the readonly attributes defined in the Command 界面。

The commandType attribute must return a string whose value is either "command", "radio", or "checked", depending on whether the Type of the command defined by the element is "command", "radio", or "checked" respectively. If the element does not define a command, it must return null.

id attribute must return the command's ID, or null if the element does not define a command or defines an anonymous command. This attribute will be shadowed by the id DOM attribute on the HTMLElement 界面。

The label attribute must return the command's Label, or null if the element does not define a command or does not specify a Label. This attribute will be shadowed by the label DOM attribute on option and command elements.

title attribute must return the command's Hint, or null if the element does not define a command or does not specify a Hint. This attribute will be shadowed by the title DOM attribute on the HTMLElement 界面。

The icon attribute must return the absolute URL of the command's Icon. If the element does not specify an icon, or if the element does not define a command, then the attribute must return null. This attribute will be shadowed by the icon DOM attribute on command elements.

The hidden attribute must return true if the command's Hidden State is that the command is hidden, and false if it is that the command is not hidden. If the element does not define a command, the attribute must return false. This attribute will be shadowed by the hidden DOM attribute on command elements.

The disabled attribute must return true if the command's Disabled State is that the command is disabled, and false if the command is not disabled. This attribute is not affected by the command's Hidden State. If the element does not define a command, the attribute must return false. This attribute will be shadowed by the disabled attribute on button, input, option, and command elements.

The checked attribute must return true if the command's Checked State is that the command is checked, and false if it is that the command is not checked. If the element does not define a command, the attribute must return false. This attribute will be shadowed by the checked attribute on input and command elements.

The click() method must trigger the Action for the command. If the element does not define a command, this method must do nothing. This method will be shadowed by the click() method on HTML elements, and is included only for completeness.

The triggers attribute must return a list containing the elements that can trigger the command (the command's Triggers). The list must be live. While the element does not define a command, the list must be empty.

The commands attribute of the document's HTMLDocument interface must return an HTMLCollection rooted at the Document node, whose filter matches only elements that define commands and have IDs.

The following elements can define commands: a, button, input, option, command.

4.11.6.1. Using the a element to define a command

An a element with an href attribute defines a command.

The Type of the command is "command".

The ID of the command is the value of the id attribute of the element, if the attribute is present and not empty. Otherwise the command is an anonymous command.

The Label of the command is the string given by the element's textContent DOM attribute.

The Hint of the command is the value of the title attribute of the element. If the attribute is not present, the Hint is the empty string.

The Icon of the command is the absolute URL obtained from resolving the value of the src attribute of the first img element descendant of the element, if there is such an element and resolving its attribute is successful. Otherwise, there is no Icon for the command.

The Hidden State and Disabled State facets of the command are always false. (The command is always enabled.)

The Checked State of the command is always false. (The command is never checked.)

The Action of the command is to fire a click event at the element.

4.11.6.2. Using the button element to define a command

A button element always defines a command.

The Type, ID, Label, Hint, Icon, Hidden State, Checked State, and Action facets of the command are determined as for a elements (see the previous section).

The Disabled State of the command mirrors the disabled state of the button. Typically this is given by the element's disabled attribute, but certain button types become disabled at other times too (for example, the move-up button type is disabled when it would have no effect).

4.11.6.3. Using the input element to define a command

An input element whose type attribute is one of submit, reset, button, radio, checkbox, move-up, move-down, add, and remove defines a command.

The Type of the command is "radio" if the type attribute has the value radio, "checkbox" if the type attribute has the value checkbox, and "command" otherwise.

The ID of the command is the value of the id attribute of the element, if the attribute is present and not empty. Otherwise the command is an anonymous command.

The Label of the command depends on the Type of the command:

If the Type is "command", then it is the string given by the value attribute, if any, and a UA-dependent value that the UA uses to label the button itself if the attribute is absent.

Otherwise, the Type is "radio" or "checkbox". If the element has a label element associated with it, the textContent of the first such element is the Label (in DOM terms, this the string given by element.labels[0].textContent). Otherwise, the value of the value attribute, if present, is the Label. Otherwise, the Label is the empty string.

The Hint of the command is the value of the title attribute of the input element. If the attribute is not present, the Hint is the empty string.

There is no Icon for the command.

The Hidden State of the command is always false. (The command is never hidden.)

The Disabled State of the command mirrors the disabled state of the control. Typically this is given by the element's disabled attribute, but certain input types become disabled at other times too (for example, the move-up input type is disabled when it would have no effect).

The Checked State of the command is true if the command is of Type "radio" or "checkbox" and the element has a checked attribute, and false otherwise.

The Action of the command is to fire a click event at the element.

4.11.6.4. Using the option element to define a command

An option element with an ancestor select element and either no value attribute or a value attribute that is not the empty string defines a command.

The Type of the command is "radio" if the option's nearest ancestor select element has no multiple attribute, and "checkbox" if it does.

The ID of the command is the value of the id attribute of the element, if the attribute is present and not empty. Otherwise the command is an anonymous command.

The Label of the command is the value of the option element's label attribute, if there is one, or the value of the option element's textContent DOM attribute if it doesn't.

The Hint of the command is the string given by the element's title attribute, if any, and the empty string if the attribute is absent.

There is no Icon for the command.

The Hidden State of the command is always false. (The command is never hidden.)

The Disabled State of the command is true (disabled) if the element has a disabled attribute, and false otherwise.

The Checked State of the command is true (checked) if the element's selected DOM attribute is true, and false otherwise.

The Action of the command depends on its Type. If the command is of Type "radio" then this must set the selected DOM attribute of the option element to true, otherwise it must toggle the state of the selected DOM attribute (set it to true if it is false and vice versa). Then a change event must be fired on the option element's nearest ancestor select element (if there is one), as if the selection had been changed directly.

4.11.6.5. Using the command element to define a command

A command element defines a command.

The Type of the command is "radio" if the command's type attribute is "radio", "checkbox" if the attribute's value is "checkbox", and "command" otherwise.

The ID of the command is the value of the id attribute of the element, if the attribute is present and not empty. Otherwise the command is an anonymous command.

The Label of the command is the value of the element's label attribute, if there is one, or the empty string if it doesn't.

The Hint of the command is the string given by the element's title attribute, if any, and the empty string if the attribute is absent.

The Icon for the command is the absolute URL obtained from resolving the value of the element's icon attribute, if it has such an attribute and resolving it is successful. Otherwise, there is no Icon for the command.

The Hidden State of the command is true (hidden) if the element has a hidden attribute, and false otherwise.

The Disabled State of the command is true (disabled) if the element has either a disabled attribute or a hidden attribute (or both), and false otherwise.

The Checked State of the command is true (checked) if the element has a checked attribute, and false otherwise.

Action of the command is to invoke the behavior described in the definition of the click() method of the HTMLCommandElement 界面。

4.11.6.6. Using the bb element to define a command

A bb element always defines a command.

The Type of the command is "command".

The ID of the command is the value of the id attribute of the element, if the attribute is present and not empty. Otherwise the command is an anonymous command.

The Label of the command is the string given by the element's textContent DOM attribute, if that is not the empty string, or a user-agent-defined string appropriate for the bb element's type attribute's state.

The Hint of the command is the value of the title attribute of the element. If the attribute is not present, the Hint is a user-agent-defined string appropriate for the bb element's type attribute's state.

The Icon of the command is the absolute URL obtained from resolving the value of the src attribute of the first img element descendant of the element, if there is such an element and resolving its attribute is successful. Otherwise, the Icon is a user-agent-defined image appropriate for the bb element's type attribute's state.

The Hidden State facet of the command is true if the bb element's type attribute's state is not null.

The Disabled State facet of the command is true if the bb element's type attribute's state's relevance is false, and true otherwise.

The Checked State of the command is always false. (The command is never checked.)

The Action of the command is to perform the action of the bb element's type attribute's state.

4.12 Data Templates

4.12.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

...examples...

4.12.2 datatemplate 要素

分類
メタデータ内容
流れ内容
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As the root element of an XML document.
メタデータ内容が期待される場所。
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
Zero or more rule elements.
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

The datatemplate element brings together the various rules that form a data template. The element doesn't itself do anything exciting.

4.12.3 rule 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
datatemplate 要素の子供として。
内容モデル:
Anything, regardless of the children's required contexts (but see prose).
要素固有属性:
condition
mode
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLRuleElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString condition;
           attribute DOMString mode;
  readonly attribute DOMTokenString modeList;
};

The rule element represents a template of content that is to be used for elements when updating an element's generated content.

The condition attribute, if specified, must contain a valid selector. It specifies which nodes in the data tree will have the condition's template applied. [SELECTORS]

If the condition attribute is not specified, then the condition applies to all elements, text nodes, CDATASection nodes, and processing instructions.

The mode attribute, if specified, must have a value that is an unordered set of unique space-separated tokens representing the various modes for which the rule applies. When, and only when, the mode attribute is omitted, the rule applies if and only if the mode is the empty string. A mode is invoked by the nest element; for the first node (the root node) of the data tree, the mode is the empty string.

The contents of rule elements form a template, and may be anything that, when the parent datatemplate is applied to some conforming data, results in a conforming DOM tree.

condition DOM 属性は condition 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The mode and modeList DOM attributes must reflect the mode content attribute.

4.12.4 nest 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
As a child of a descendant of a rule element, regardless of the element's content model.
内容モデル:
空。
要素固有属性:
filter
mode
DOM 界面:
interface HTMLNestElement : HTMLElement {
           attribute DOMString filter;
           attribute DOMString mode;
};

The nest element represents a point in a template where the user agent should recurse and start inserting the children of the data node that matches the rule in which the nest element finds itself.

The filter attribute, if specified, must contain a valid selector. It specifies which of the child nodes in the data tree will be examined for further processing at this point. [SELECTORS]

If the filter attribute is not specified, then all elements, text nodes, CDATASection nodes, and processing instructions are processed.

The mode attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a word token consisting of one or more characters, none of which are space characters. It gives the mode which will be in effect when looking at the rules in the data template.

filter DOM 属性は filter 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

mode DOM 属性は mode 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

4.12.5 Global attributes for data templates

The template attribute may be added to an element to indicate that the template processing model is to be applied to that element.

The template attribute, when specified, must be a valid URL to an XML or HTML document, or a fragment identifier pointing at another part of the document. If there is a fragment identifier present, then the element with that ID in the target document must be a datatemplate element, otherwise, the root element must be a datatemplate element.

template DOM 属性は template 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The ref attribute may be specified on any element on which the template attribute is specified. If it is specified, it must be a valid URL to an XML or HTML document, or a fragment identifier pointing at another part of the document.

When an element has a template attribute but no ref attribute, the element may, instead of its usual content model, have a single element of any kind. That element is then used as the root node of the data for the template.

ref DOM 属性は ref 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

The registrationmark attribute may be specified on any element that is a descendant of a rule element, except nest elements. Its value may be any string, including the empty string (which is the value that is assumed if the attribute is omitted). This attribute performs a role similar to registration marks in printing presses: when the generated content is regenerated, elements with the same registrationmark are lined up. This allows the author to disambiguate how elements should be moved around when generated content is regenerated in the face of changes to the data tree.

registrationMark DOM 属性は registrationmark 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

4.12.6 処理モデル

The task source for all tasks queued by algorithms in this section and its subsections is the template task source.

4.12.6.1. originalContent DOM 属性

The originalContent is set to a DocumentFragment to hold the original children of an element that has been replaced by content generated for a data template. Initially, it must be null. Its value is set when the template attribute is set to a usable value, and is unset when the attribute is removed.

The originalContent DOM attribute can thus be used as an indicator of whether a template is currently being applied, just as the templateElement DOM attribute can.

4.12.6.2. template 属性

Setting: When an HTML element without a template attribute has its template attribute set, the user agent must fetch the specified file and parse it (without a browsing context) to obtain a DOM. If the URL, when resolved, is the same as the document's address, then the current document's DOM must be assumed to be that parsed DOM. While this loading and parsing is in progress, the element is said to be busy loading the template rules or data.

If the resource specified by the template attribute is not the current document and does not have an XML MIME type, or if an XML parse error is found while parsing the resource, then the resource cannot be successfully parsed, and the user agent must jump to the failed to parse steps below.

Once the DOM in question has been parsed, assuming that it indeed can be parsed and does so successfully, the user agent must queue a task to run the following algorithm:

  1. If the template attribute's value has a fragment identifier, and, in the DOM in question, it identifies a datatemplate element, then set the templateElement DOM attribute to that element.

    Otherwise, if the template attribute value does not have a fragment identifier, and the root element of the DOM in question is a datatemplate element, then set the templateElement DOM attribute to that element.

    Otherwise, jump to the failed to parse steps below.

  2. Create a new DocumentFragment and move all the nodes that are children of the element to that DocumentFragment object. Set the originalContent DOM attribute on the element to this new DocumentFragment object.

  3. Jump to the steps below for updating the generated content.

If the resource has failed to parse, the user agent must fire a simple event with the name error at the element on which the template attribute was found.

Unsetting: When an HTML element with a template attribute has its template attribute removed or dynamically changed from one value to another, the user agent must run the following algorithm:

  1. Set the templateElement DOM attribute to null.

  2. If the originalContent DOM attribute of the element is not null, run these substeps:

    1. Remove all the nodes that are children of the element.

    2. Append the nodes in the originalContent DocumentFragment to the element.

    3. Set originalContent to null.

    (If the originalContent DOM attribute of the element is null, then either there was an error loading or parsing the previous template, or the previous template never finished loading; in either case, there is nothing to undo.)

  3. If the template attribute was changed (as opposed to simply removed), then act as if it was now set to its new value (fetching the specified page, etc, as described above).

The templateElement DOM attribute is updated by the above algorithm to point to the currently active datatemplate element. Initially, the attribute must have the value null.

4.12.6.3. ref 属性

Setting: When an HTML element without a ref attribute has its ref attribute set, the user agent must fetch the specified file and parse it (without a browsing context) to obtain a DOM. If the URL, when resolved, is the same as the document's address, then the current document's DOM must be assumed to be that parsed DOM. While this loading and parsing is in progress, the element is said to be busy loading the template rules or data.

If the resource specified by the ref attribute is not the current document and does not have an XML MIME type, or if an XML parse error is found while parsing the resource, then the resource cannot be successfully parsed, and the user agent must jump to the failed to parse steps below.

Once the DOM in question has been parsed, assuming that it indeed can be parsed and does so successfully, the user agent must queue a task to run the following algorithm:

  1. If the ref attribute value does not have a fragment identifier, then set the refNode DOM attribute to the Document node of that DOM.

    Otherwise, if the ref attribute's value has a fragment identifier, and, in the DOM in question, that fragment identifier identifies an element, then set the refNode DOM attribute to that element.

    Otherwise, jump to the failed to parse steps below.

  2. Jump to the steps below for updating the generated content.

If the resource has failed to parse, the user agent must fire a simple event with the name error at the element on which the ref attribute was found, and must then jump to the steps below for updating the generated content (the contents of the element will be used instead of the specified resource).

Unsetting: When an HTML element with a ref attribute has its ref attribute removed or dynamically changed from one value to another, the user agent must run the following algorithm:

  1. Set the refNode DOM attribute to null.

  2. If the ref attribute was changed (as opposed to simply removed), then act as if it was now set to its new value (fetching the specified page, etc, as described above). Otherwise, jump to the steps below for updating the generated content.

The refNode DOM attribute is updated by the above algorithm to point to the current data tree, if one is specified explicitly. If it is null, then the data tree is given by the originalContent DOM attribute, unless that is also null, in which case no template is currently being applied. Initially, the attribute must have the value null.

4.12.6.4. NodeDataTemplate 界面

All objects that implement the Node interface must also implement the NodeDataTemplate interface, whose members must be accessible using binding-specific casting mechanisms.

interface NodeDataTemplate {
  readonly attribute Node dataNode;
};

The dataNode DOM attribute returns the node for which this node was generated. It must initially be null. It is set on the nodes that form the content generated during the algorithm for updating the generated content of elements that are using the data template feature.

4.12.6.5. Mutations

An element with a non-null templateElement is said to be a data tree user of the node identified by the element's refNode attribute, as well as all of that node's children, or, if that attribute is null, of the node identified by the element's originalContent, as well as all that node's children.

Nodes that have one or more data tree users associated with them (as per the previous paragraph) are themselves termed data tree component nodes.

Whenever a data tree component node changes its name or value, or has one of its attributes change name or value, or has an attribute added or removed, or has a child added or removed, the user agent must update the generated content of all of that node's data tree users.

An element with a non-null templateElement is also said to be a template tree user of the node identified by the element's templateElement attribute, as well as all of that node's children.

Nodes that have one or more template tree users associated with them (as per the previous paragraph) are themselves termed template tree component nodes.

Whenever a template tree component node changes its name or value, or has one of its attributes change name or value, or has an attribute added or removed, or has a child added or removed, the user agent must update the generated content of all of that node's template tree users.

In other words, user agents update the content generated from a template whenever either the backing data changes or the template itself changes.

4.12.6.6. Updating the generated content

When the user agent is to update the generated content of an element that uses a template, the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. Let destination be the element whose generated content is being updated.

  2. If the destination element is busy loading the template rules or data, then abort these steps. Either the steps will be invoked again once the loading has completed, or the loading will fail and the generated content will be removed at that point.

  3. Let template tree be the element given by destination's templateElement DOM attribute. If it is null, then abort these steps. There are no rules to apply.

  4. Let data tree be the node given by destination's refNode DOM attribute. If it is null, then let data tree be the node given by the originalContent DOM node.

  5. Let existing nodes be a set of ordered lists of nodes, each list being identified by a tuple consisting of a node, a node type and name, and a registration mark (a string).

  6. For each node node that is a descendant of destination, if any, add node to the list identified by the tuple given by: node's dataNode DOM attribute; the node's node type and, if it's an element, its qualified name (that is, its namespace and local name), or, if it's a processing instruction, its target name, and the value of the node's registrationmark attribute, if it has one, or the empty string otherwise.

  7. Remove all the child nodes of destination, so that its child node list is empty.

  8. Run the Levenberg data node algorithm (described below) using destination as the destination node, data tree as the source node, template tree as the rule container, the empty string as the mode, and the existing nodes lists as the lists of existing nodes.

The Levenberg algorithm consists of two algorithms that invoke each other recursively, the Levenberg data node algorithm and the Levenberg template node algorithm. These algorithms use the data structures initialized by the set of steps described above.

The Levenberg data node algorithm is as follows. It is always invoked with three DOM nodes, one string, and a set of lists as arguments: the destination node, the source node, the rule container, the mode string, and the existing nodes lists respectively.

  1. Let condition be the first rule element child of the rule container element, or null if there aren't any.

  2. If condition is null, follow these substeps:

    1. If the source node is an element, then, for each child child node of the source node element, in tree order, invoke the Levenberg data node algorithm recursively, with destination node, child node, rule container, the empty string, and existing nodes lists as the five arguments respectively.

    2. Abort the current instance of the Levenberg data node algorithm, returning to whatever algorithm invoked it.

  3. Let matches be a boolean with the value true.

  4. If the condition element has a mode attribute, but the value of that attribute is not a mode match for the current mode string, then let matches be false.

  5. If the condition element has a condition attribute, and the attribute's value, when evaluated as a selector, does not match the current source node, then let matches be false.

  6. If matches is true, then follow these substeps:

    1. For each child child node of the condition element, in tree order, invoke the Levenberg template node algorithm recursively, with the five arguments being destination node, source node, rule container, child node, and existing nodes lists respectively.

    2. Abort the current instance of the Levenberg data node algorithm, returning to whatever algorithm invoked it.

  7. Let condition be the next rule element that is a child of the rule container element, after the condition element itself, or null if there are no more rule elements.

  8. Jump to step 2 in this set of steps.

The Levenberg template node algorithm is as follows. It is always invoked with four DOM nodes and a set of lists as arguments: the destination node, the source node, the rule container, the template node, and the existing nodes lists respectively.

  1. If template node is a comment node, abort the current instance of the Levenberg template node algorithm, returning to whatever algorithm invoked it.

  2. If template node is a nest element, then run these substeps:

    1. If source node is not an element, then abort the current instance of the Levenberg template node algorithm, returning to whatever algorithm invoked it.

    2. If the template node has a mode attribute, then let mode be the value of that attribute; otherwise, let mode be the empty string.

    3. Let child node be the first child of the source node element, or null if source node has no children.

    4. If child node is null, abort the current instance of the Levenberg template node algorithm, returning to whatever algorithm invoked it.

    5. If the template node element has a filter attribute, and the attribute's value, when evaluated as a selector, matches child node, then invoke the Levenberg data node algorithm recursively, with destination node, child node, rule container, mode, and existing nodes lists as the five arguments respectively.

    6. Let child node be child node's next sibling, or null if child node was the last node of source node.

    7. 手順 4 in this set of substeps に戻ります。

  3. If template node is an element, and that element has a registrationmark attribute, then let registration mark have the value of that attribute. Otherwise, let registration mark be the empty string.

  4. If there is a list in the existing nodes lists corresponding to the tuple (source node, the node type and name of template node, registration mark), and that list is not empty, then run the following substeps. (For an element node, the name of the node is its qualified tag name, i.e. its namespace and local name. For a processing instruction, its name is the target. For other types of nodes, there is no name.)

    1. Let new node be the first node in that list.

    2. Remove new node from that list.

    3. If new node is an element, remove all the child nodes of new node, so that its child node list is empty.

    Otherwise, if there is no matching list, or there was, but it is now empty, then run these steps instead:

    1. Let new node be a shallow clone of template node.

    2. Let new node's dataNode DOM attribute be source node.

  5. If new node is an element, run these substeps:

    1. For each attribute on new node, if an attribute with the same qualified name is not present on template node, remove that attribute.

    2. For each attribute attribute on template node, run these substeps:

      1. Let expanded be the result of passing the value of attribute to the text expansion algorithm for templates along with source node.

      2. If an attribute with the same qualified name as attribute is already present on new node, then: if its value is different from expanded, replace its value with expanded.

      3. Otherwise, if there is no attribute with the same qualified name as attribute on new node, then add an attribute with the same namespace, prefix, and local name as attribute, with its value set to expanded's.

    Otherwise, the new node is a text node, CDATASection node, or processing instruction. Run these substeps instead:

    1. Let expanded be the result of passing the node value of template node (the content of the text node, CDATASection node, or processing instruction) to the text expansion algorithm for templates along with source node.

    2. If the value of the new node is different from expanded, then set the value of new node to expanded.

  6. Append new node to destination.

  7. If template node is an element, then, for each child child node of the template node element, in tree order, invoke the Levenberg template node algorithm recursively, with the five arguments being new child, source node, rule container, child node, and existing nodes lists respectively.

Define: evaluated as a selector

Define: text expansion algorithm for templates

4.13 Miscellaneous elements

4.13.1 legend 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
fieldset 要素の最初の子供として。
details 要素の最初の子供として。
figure 要素の子供として。 ただし、その要素に他に legend 要素の子供がない場合。
内容モデル:
語句付け内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

legend 要素は、 その親要素の内容の残りの部分に対する題名、説明的な見出しを表します。

4.13.2 div 要素

分類
なし。
この要素を使ってもよい文脈:
流れ内容が期待される場所。
内容モデル:
流れ内容
要素固有属性:
なし。
DOM 界面:
HTMLElement を使用。

div 要素はまったく何も表しません。 この要素は classlang/xml:langtitle 属性と併用することによって連続する要素群に共通な意味をマーク付けすることができます。

Allowing div elements to contain phrasing content makes it easy for authors to abuse div, using it with the class="" attribute to the point of not having any other elements in the markup. This is a disaster from an accessibility point of view, and it would be nice if we could somehow make such pages non-compliant without preventing people from using divs as the extension mechanism that they are, to handle things the spec can't otherwise do (like making new widgets).

5. Web ブラウザ

この章では、 Web ブラウザに最も直接的に適用される機能について説明します。 とはいえ、この章で定義する要件は、特に断らない限り、 Web ブラウザであるか否かを問わず全ての利用者エージェントに適用されます

5.1 閲覧文脈

閲覧文脈は1つ以上の Document オブジェクトと1つ以上の表示の集成です。

いかなる時点においても、ある 閲覧文脈の中の Document の1つは活性文書です。 Document の集成は閲覧文脈セッション履歴です。

表示は、何らかの媒体における Document オブジェクトの表現のために用いられる、特定の媒体に紐付けされた利用者エージェント界面です。 提示は対話的であっても構いません。各表示は AbstractView オブジェクトにより現れます。各表示は閲覧文脈に属します。 [DOM2VIEWS]

表示を表す AbstractView オブジェクトの document 属性は、その表示の閲覧文脈活性文書Document オブジェクトを与えます。 [DOM2VIEWS]

UIEvent 界面を用いる事象は特定の表示 (事象が発生した表示) に関係付けられています。その表示の AbstractView は事象オブジェクトの view 属性で与えられます。 [DOM3EVENTS]

一般的な Web ブラウザは閲覧文脈毎に1つの自明な表示、つまりブラウザの窓 (画面媒体) を持っています。 しかし、頁が印刷される場合、2つ目の、印刷媒体の表示が現れます。 2つの表示は常に同じ元の Document を共有していますが、 その文書の異なる提示を有しています。会話ブラウザも、 会話媒体での表示を有する閲覧文脈を確立します。

Document は必ずしも閲覧文脈に関連付けられているとは限りません。 特に、データ・マイニング・ツールは閲覧文脈を決して実現値化しないでしょう。

利用者が利用者エージェントと対話するために主に使用する表示既定表示です。

Document既定表示Document オブジェクトの DocumentView 界面の defaultView 属性により与えられます。 [DOM3VIEWS]

閲覧文脈が最初に作成されたとき、 閲覧文脈はセッション履歴に番地about:blank で、 HTML 文書として印付けされており、文字符号化が UTF-8 である Document が1つある状態で作成されなければなりません。この Documenthtml 節点1つだけを子供として持ち、その html 節点は body 節点だけを子供として持たなければなりません閲覧文脈が即座に操縦されるために特に作成された場合、 その最初の操縦は置換有効で行われます。

about:blank Document起源は、 その Document が作成されるときに、作成された閲覧文脈入れ子閲覧文脈であるかどうかにより、 次のように設定されます:

新しい閲覧文脈入れ子閲覧文脈である場合
about:blank Document起源は、 新しい閲覧文脈の作成の時点でのその親閲覧文脈活性文書起源です。
新しい閲覧文脈補助閲覧文脈である場合
about:blank Document起点は、 新しい閲覧文脈の作成の時点でのその開き元閲覧文脈活性文書起点です。
その他の場合
about:blank Document起点は、 その新しい閲覧文脈が作成されたときに割り当てられた大域的に固有な識別子です。

5.1.1 入れ子の閲覧文脈

要素によっては (例えば iframe 要素は)、更に閲覧文脈を実現値化することができます。このようなものを入れ子の閲覧文脈と呼びます。 閲覧文脈 P がその Document の1つ D 中に要素 E を持っていて、その要素の内側に別の閲覧文脈 C を入れ子にしている場合、 PC親閲覧文脈であるといい、 CP子閲覧文脈であるといい、 CD通じて入れ子であるといい、 EC閲覧文脈包含子であるといいます。

閲覧文脈 A が閲覧文脈 B の祖先であるというのは、 A子閲覧文脈である閲覧文脈 A' が存在して、それ自体が B の祖先である場合、または閲覧文脈 P があって、それが A子閲覧文脈であり、かつ B親閲覧文脈である場合です。

親閲覧文脈のない閲覧文脈は、 それに (直接的に、または他の入れ子閲覧文脈を通じて間接的に) 入れ子になっている閲覧文脈すべての最上位閲覧文脈です。

入れ子閲覧文脈親閲覧文脈の推移的閉包が祖先閲覧文脈の並びを与えます。

Document完全に活性であるというのは、 これがその閲覧文脈活性文書であり、かつその閲覧文脈が最上位閲覧文脈であるか、 またはその閲覧文脈がそれを通じて入れ子になっているような Document もそれ自体完全に活性であることをいいます。

子閲覧文脈は、要素を通じて入れ子になっているため、 常に親閲覧文脈中の特定の Document と紐付けされています。利用者エージェントは、完全に活性でない Document 中の要素の子閲覧文脈に対して利用者が対話することを認めてはなりません

入れ子閲覧文脈には、これが seamless 属性のある iframe 要素を通じて埋め込まれている場合、継ぎ目なし閲覧文脈旗が設定されることがあります。

閲覧文脈 bWindow オブジェクトの top DOM 属性は、その最上位閲覧文脈Window オブジェクト (その閲覧文脈自体が最上位閲覧文脈の場合、 その Window オブジェクト自体) を返さなければなりません

閲覧文脈 bWindow オブジェクトの parent DOM 属性は、その親閲覧文脈があれば (つまり b子閲覧文脈である場合) その親閲覧文脈Window オブジェクトを、そうでない場合 (つまりそれ自体が最上位閲覧文脈の場合) 閲覧文脈 b 自体の Window オブジェクトを返さなければなりません

閲覧文脈 bWindow オブジェクトの frameElement DOM 属性は、取得時、次の算法を走らせなければなりません

  1. b子閲覧文脈でない場合、 null を返し、これらの段階を停止します。

  2. If the parent browsing context's active document does not have the same effective script origin as the script that is accessing the frameElement attribute, then throw a security exception.

  3. そうでない場合、 b閲覧文脈包含子を返します。

5.1.2 補助閲覧文脈

ある最上位閲覧文脈に関係する新しい閲覧文脈を、 要素を通じて入れ子にせずに作成することができます。このような閲覧文脈を補助閲覧文脈と呼びます。 補助閲覧文脈は常に最上位閲覧文脈です。

補助閲覧文脈は、開闢器閲覧文脈を持ちます。これは、補助閲覧文脈を作成した閲覧文脈です。また、最遠祖先閲覧文脈も持ちます。 これは、補助閲覧文脈が作成された時の開闢器閲覧文脈最上位閲覧文脈です。

Window オブジェクトの opener DOM 属性は、 現在の閲覧文脈が作成された閲覧文脈 (開闢器閲覧文脈) の Window オブジェクトを、これがあって、まだ利用可能であれば、返さなければなりません

5.1.3 二次閲覧文脈

利用者エージェントは、二次閲覧文脈に対応しても構いません。これは、利用者エージェントの界面の一部を形成する、 主たる内容領域とは別の閲覧文脈です。

5.1.4 保安性

閲覧文脈 A が2つ目の閲覧文脈 B操縦することが認められているのは、 次の条件の1つが真である場合です。

5.1.5 Groupings of browsing contexts

閲覧文脈は、零以上の直接到達可能閲覧文脈の並びを持つと定義します。 これは、次の閲覧文脈を含みます。

直接到達可能閲覧文脈である閲覧文脈すべての推移的閉包は、関連閲覧文脈の単位を形成します。

Each unit of related browsing contexts is then further divided into the smallest number of groups such that every member of each group has an effective script origin that, through appropriate manipulation of the document.domain attribute, could be made to be the same as other members of the group, but could not be made the same as members of any other group. Each such group is a unit of related similar-origin browsing contexts.

5.1.6 閲覧文脈名

閲覧文脈は閲覧文脈名を持つことができます。 既定では閲覧文脈は名前を持ちません (名前は設定されません)。

妥当な閲覧文脈名は、最低1文字を含み、 U+005F LOW LINE からはじまらない文字列です。 (下線からはじまる文字列は特別なキーワードに予約されています。)

妥当な閲覧文脈の名前かキーワードは、 妥当な閲覧文脈名であるか、または ASCII 大文字・小文字不区別_blank_self_parent_top のいずれかと一致するかのどちらかである文字列です。

閲覧文脈名から閲覧文脈を選ぶ規則は次の通りです。 この規則はある閲覧文脈の文脈において適用されることを想定しています。

  1. 与えられた閲覧文脈名が空文字列であるか、_self である場合、選ばれる閲覧文脈は現在のものでなければなりません

  2. 与えられた閲覧文脈名が _parent である場合、 選ばれる閲覧文脈は現在の閲覧文脈の閲覧文脈があればそれでなければならず、 なければ現在の閲覧文脈でなければなりません

  3. 与えられた閲覧文脈名が _top である場合、 選ばれる閲覧文脈は現在の閲覧文脈の一番最上位閲覧文脈でなければなりません

  4. 与えられた閲覧文脈名が _blank ではなく、名前が与えられた閲覧文脈名と同じである閲覧文脈が存在する場合で、 現在の閲覧文脈がその閲覧文脈を操縦することが認められており、 利用者エージェントが2つの閲覧文脈は十分関係しているので互いに到達してもよいと判断した場合、 選ばれる閲覧文脈はその閲覧文脈でなければなりません。 一致する閲覧文脈が複数ある場合、利用者エージェントは何らかの一貫した方法、 例えば最も新しく開かれたもの、最も新しく焦点を当てられたもの、 最もよく関係しているものといった方法で1つを選ぶべきです

  5. それ以外の場合、新しい閲覧文脈が要求されており、 利用者エージェントの設定や能力、あるいはその両方によって動作が決まります。

    現在の閲覧文脈が砂箱化操縦閲覧文脈旗を設定されている場合。
    利用者エージェントは新しい最上位閲覧文脈を作成することや既存の最上位閲覧文脈を再利用することを提示して構いません。 利用者エージェントがこれらの選択肢の1つを選んだ場合、 指定された閲覧文脈を選ばれた閲覧文脈としなければなりません (閲覧文脈名は与えられた閲覧文脈名に設定しません)。 そうでない場合 (利用者エージェントが利用者に選択肢を提示しない場合、 あるいは利用者が閲覧文脈を使うことを認めないことにした場合)、 どの閲覧文脈も選んではなりません
    If the user agent has been configured such that in this instance it will create a new browsing context, and the browsing context is being requested as part of following a hyperlink whose link types include the noreferrer keyword
    A new top-level browsing context must be created. If the given browsing context name is not _blank, then the new top-level browsing context's name must be the given browsing context name (otherwise, it has no name). The chosen browsing context must be this new browsing context. If it is immediately navigated, then the navigation will be done with replacement enabled.
    If the user agent has been configured such that in this instance it will create a new browsing context, and the noreferrer keyword doesn't apply
    A new auxiliary browsing context must be created, with the opener browsing context being the current one. If the given browsing context name is not _blank, then the new auxiliary browsing context's name must be the given browsing context name (otherwise, it has no name). The chosen browsing context must be this new browsing context. If it is immediately navigated, then the navigation will be done with replacement enabled.
    If the user agent has been configured such that in this instance it will reuse the current browsing context
    The chosen browsing context is the current browsing context.
    If the user agent has been configured such that in this instance it will not find a browsing context
    There must not be a chosen browsing context.

    User agent implementors are encouraged to provide a way for users to configure the user agent to always reuse the current browsing context.

5.2 The default view

The AbstractView object of default views must also implement the Window and EventTarget interfaces.

[NoInterfaceObject] interface Window {
  // the current browsing context
  readonly attribute Window window;
  readonly attribute Window self;
           attribute DOMString name;
  [PutForwards=href] readonly attribute Location location;
  readonly attribute History history;
  readonly attribute UndoManager undoManager;
  Selection getSelection();

  // other browsing contexts
  readonly attribute Window frames;
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] Window XXX4(in unsigned long index); 
  readonly attribute Window top;
  readonly attribute Window opener;
  readonly attribute Window parent;
  readonly attribute Element frameElement;
  Window open();
  Window open(in DOMString url);
  Window open(in DOMString url, in DOMString target);
  Window open(in DOMString url, in DOMString target, in DOMString features);
  Window open(in DOMString url, in DOMString target, in DOMString features, in DOMString replace);

  // the user agent
  readonly attribute Navigator navigator; 
  readonly attribute Storage localStorage;
  readonly attribute Storage sessionStorage;
  Database openDatabase(in DOMString name, in DOMString version, in DOMString displayName, in unsigned long estimatedSize);

  // user prompts
  void alert(in DOMString message);
  boolean confirm(in DOMString message);
  DOMString prompt(in DOMString message);
  DOMString prompt(in DOMString message, in DOMString default);
  void print();
  any showModalDialog(in DOMString url);
  any showModalDialog(in DOMString url, in any arguments);
  void showNotification(in DOMString title, in DOMString subtitle, in DOMString description);
  void showNotification(in DOMString title, in DOMString subtitle, in DOMString description, in VoidCallback onclick);

  // cross-document messaging
  void postMessage(in DOMString message, in DOMString targetOrigin);
  void postMessage(in DOMString message, in MessagePort messagePort, in DOMString targetOrigin);

  // event handler DOM attributes
           attribute EventListener onabort;
           attribute EventListener onbeforeunload;
           attribute EventListener onblur;
           attribute EventListener onchange;
           attribute EventListener onclick;
           attribute EventListener oncontextmenu;
           attribute EventListener ondblclick;
           attribute EventListener ondrag;
           attribute EventListener ondragend;
           attribute EventListener ondragenter;
           attribute EventListener ondragleave;
           attribute EventListener ondragover;
           attribute EventListener ondragstart;
           attribute EventListener ondrop;
           attribute EventListener onerror;
           attribute EventListener onfocus;
           attribute EventListener onhashchange;
           attribute EventListener onkeydown;
           attribute EventListener onkeypress;
           attribute EventListener onkeyup;
           attribute EventListener onload;
           attribute EventListener onmessage;
           attribute EventListener onmousedown;
           attribute EventListener onmousemove;
           attribute EventListener onmouseout;
           attribute EventListener onmouseover;
           attribute EventListener onmouseup;
           attribute EventListener onmousewheel;
           attribute EventListener onresize;
           attribute EventListener onscroll;
           attribute EventListener onselect;
           attribute EventListener onstorage;
           attribute EventListener onsubmit;
           attribute EventListener onunload;
};

The window, frames, and self DOM attributes must all return the Window object itself.

The Window object also provides the scope for script execution. Each Document in a browsing context has an associated list of added properties that, when a document is active, are available on the Document's default view's Window object. A Document object's list of added properties must be empty when the Document object is created.

5.2.1 保安性

User agents must raise a security exception whenever any of the members of a Window object are accessed by scripts whose effective script origin is not the same as the Window object's browsing context's active document's effective script origin, with the following exceptions:

User agents must not allow scripts to override the location object's setter.

5.2.2 APIs for creating and navigating browsing contexts by name

The open() method on Window objects provides a mechanism for navigating an existing browsing context or opening and navigating an auxiliary browsing context.

The method has four arguments, though they are all optional.

The first argument, url, must be a valid URL for a page to load in the browsing context. If no arguments are provided, or if the first argument is the empty string, then the url argument defaults to "about:blank". The argument must be resolved to an absolute URL (or an error) when the method is invoked.

The second argument, target, specifies the name of the browsing context that is to be navigated. It must be a valid browsing context name or keyword. If fewer than two arguments are provided, then the name argument defaults to the value "_blank".

The third argument, features, has no effect and is supported for historical reasons only.

The fourth argument, replace, specifies whether or not the new page will replace the page currently loaded in the browsing context, when target identifies an existing browsing context (as opposed to leaving the current page in the browsing context's session history). When three or fewer arguments are provided, replace defaults to false.

When the method is invoked, the user agent must first select a browsing context to navigate by applying the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name using the target argument as the name and the browsing context of the script as the context in which the algorithm is executed, unless the user has indicated a preference, in which case the browsing context to navigate may instead be the one indicated by the user.

For example, suppose there is a user agent that supports control-clicking a link to open it in a new tab. If a user clicks in that user agent on an element whose onclick handler uses the window.open() API to open a page in an iframe, but, while doing so, holds the control key down, the user agent could override the selection of the target browsing context to instead target a new tab.

Then, the user agent must navigate the selected browsing context to the absolute URL (or error) obtained from resolving url. If the replace is true, then replacement must be enabled; otherwise, it must not be enabled unless the browsing context was just created as part of the the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name. The navigation must be done with the script browsing context of the script that invoked the method as the source browsing context.

The method must return the Window object of the default view of the browsing context that was navigated, or null if no browsing context was navigated.

The name attribute of the Window object must, on getting, return the current name of the browsing context, and, on setting, set the name of the browsing context to the new value.

The name gets reset when the browsing context is navigated to another domain.

5.2.3 Accessing other browsing contexts

The length DOM attribute on the Window interface must return the number of child browsing contexts of the active Document.

The XXX4(index) method must return the indexth child browsing context of the active Document, sorted in document order of the elements nesting those browsing contexts.

5.3 Origin

The origin of a resource and the effective script origin of a resource are both either opaque identifiers or tuples consisting of a scheme component, a host component, a port component, and optionally extra data.

The extra data could include the certificate of the site when using encrypted connections, to ensure that if the site's secure certificate changes, the origin is considered to change as well.

These characteristics are defined as follows:

For URLs

The origin and effective script origin of the URL is whatever is returned by the following algorithm:

  1. Let url be the URL for which the origin is being determined.

  2. Parse url.

  3. If url does not use a server-based naming authority, or if parsing url failed, or if url is not an absolute URL, then return a new globally unique identifier.

  4. Let scheme be the <scheme> component of the URI, converted to lowercase.

  5. If the UA doesn't support the protocol given by scheme, then return a new globally unique identifier.

  6. If scheme is "file", then the user agent may return a UA-specific value.

  7. Let host be the <host> component of url.

  8. Apply the IDNA ToASCII algorithm to host, with both the AllowUnassigned and UseSTD3ASCIIRules flags set. Let host be the result of the ToASCII algorithm.

    If ToASCII fails to convert one of the components of the string, e.g. because it is too long or because it contains invalid characters, then return a new globally unique identifier. [RFC3490]

  9. Let host be the result of converting host to lowercase.

  10. If there is no <port> component, then let port be the default port for the protocol given by scheme. Otherwise, let port be the <port> component of url.

  11. Return the tuple (scheme, host, port).

In addition, if the URL is in fact associated with a Document object that was created by parsing the resource obtained from fetching URL, and this was done over a secure connection, then the server's secure certificate may be added to the origin as additional data.

For scripts

The origin and effective script origin of a script are determined from another resource, called the owner:

If a script is in a script element
The owner is the Document to which the script element belongs.
If a script is in an event handler content attribute
The owner is the Document to which the attribute node belongs.
If a script is a function or other code reference created by another script
The owner is the script that created it.
If a script is a javascript: URL that was returned as the location of an HTTP redirect (or equivalent in other protocols)
The owner is the URL that redirected to the javascript: URL.
If a script is a javascript: URL in an attribute
The owner is the Document of the element on which the attribute is found.
If a script is a javascript: URL in a style sheet
The owner is the URL of the style sheet.
If a script is a javascript: URL to which a browsing context is being navigated, the URL having been provided by the user (e.g. by using a bookmarklet)
The owner is the Document of the browsing context's active document.
If a script is a javascript: URL to which a browsing context is being navigated, the URL having been declared in markup
The owner is the Document of the element (e.g. an a or area element) that declared the URL.
If a script is a javascript: URL to which a browsing context is being navigated, the URL having been provided by script
The owner is the script that provided the URL.

The origin of the script is then equal to the origin of the owner, and the effective script origin of the script is equal to the effective script origin of the owner.

For Document objects and images
If a Document is in a browsing context whose sandboxed origin browsing context flag is set
The origin is a globally unique identifier assigned when the Document is created.
If a Document or image was returned by the XMLHttpRequest API
The origin and effective script origin are equal to the origin and effective script origin of the Document object that was the active document of the browsing context of the Window object from which the XMLHttpRequest constructor was invoked. (That is, they track the Document to which the XMLHttpRequest object's Document pointer pointed when it was created.) [XHR]
If a Document or image was generated from a javascript: URL
The origin is equal to the origin of the script of that javascript: URL.
If a Document or image was served over the network and has an address that uses a URL scheme with a server-based naming authority
The origin is the origin of the address of the Document or image.
If a Document or image was generated from a data: URL that was returned as the location of an HTTP redirect (or equivalent in other protocols)
The origin is the origin of the URL that redirected to the data: URL.
If a Document or image was generated from a data: URL found in another Document or in a script
The origin is the origin of the Document or script in which the data: URL was found.
If a Document has the address "about:blank"
The origin of the Document is the origin it was assigned when its browsing context was created.
If a Document or image was obtained in some other manner (e.g. a data: URL typed in by the user, a Document created using the createDocument() API, a data: URL returned as the location of an HTTP redirect, etc)
The origin is a globally unique identifier assigned when the Document or image is created.

When a Document is created, unless stated otherwise above, its effective script origin is initialized to the origin of the Document. However, the document.domain attribute can be used to change it.

The Unicode serialization of an origin is the string obtained by applying the following algorithm to the given origin:

  1. If the origin in question is not a scheme/host/port tuple, then return the empty string and abort these steps.

  2. Otherwise, let result be the scheme part of the origin tuple.

  3. Append the string "://" to result.

  4. Apply the IDNA ToUnicode algorithm to each component of the host part of the origin tuple, and append the results — each component, in the same order, separated by U+002E FULL STOP characters (".") — to result.

  5. If the port part of the origin tuple gives a port that is different from the default port for the protocol given by the scheme part of the origin tuple, then append a U+003A COLON character (":") and the given port, in base ten, to result.

  6. result を返します。

The ASCII serialization of an origin is the string obtained by applying the following algorithm to the given origin:

  1. If the origin in question is not a scheme/host/port tuple, then return the empty string and abort these steps.

  2. Otherwise, let result be the scheme part of the origin tuple.

  3. Append the string "://" to result.

  4. Apply the IDNA ToASCII algorithm the host part of the origin tuple, with both the AllowUnassigned and UseSTD3ASCIIRules flags set, and append the results result.

    If ToASCII fails to convert one of the components of the string, e.g. because it is too long or because it contains invalid characters, then return the empty string and abort these steps. [RFC3490]

  5. If the port part of the origin tuple gives a port that is different from the default port for the protocol given by the scheme part of the origin tuple, then append a U+003A COLON character (":") and the given port, in base ten, to result.

  6. result を返します。

Two origins are said to be the same origin if the following algorithm returns true:

  1. Let A be the first origin being compared, and B be the second origin being compared.

  2. If A and B are both opaque identifiers, and their value is equal, then return true.

  3. Otherwise, if either A or B or both are opaque identifiers, return false.

  4. If A and B have scheme components that are not identical, return false.

  5. If A and B have host components that are not identical, return false.

  6. If A and B have port components that are not identical, return false.

  7. If either A or B have additional data, but that data is not identical for both, return false.

  8. Return true.

5.3.1 Relaxing the same-origin restriction

The domain attribute on Document objects must be initialized to the document's domain, if it has one, and the empty string otherwise. On getting, the attribute must return its current value, unless the document was created by XMLHttpRequest, in which case it must throw an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception. On setting, the user agent must run the following algorithm:

  1. If the document was created by XMLHttpRequest, throw an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception and abort these steps.

  2. Apply the IDNA ToASCII algorithm to the new value, with both the AllowUnassigned and UseSTD3ASCIIRules flags set. Let new value be the result of the ToASCII algorithm.

    If ToASCII fails to convert one of the components of the string, e.g. because it is too long or because it contains invalid characters, then throw a security exception and abort these steps. [RFC3490]

  3. If new value is not exactly equal to the current value of the document.domain attribute, then run these substeps:

    1. If the current value is an IP address, throw a security exception and abort these steps.

    2. If new value, prefixed by a U+002E FULL STOP ("."), does not exactly match the end of the current value, throw a security exception and abort these steps.

  4. Set the attribute's value to new value.

  5. Set the host part of the effective script origin tuple of the Document to new value.

  6. Set the port part of the effective script origin tuple of the Document to "manual override" (a value that, for the purposes of comparing origins, is identical to "manual override" but not identical to any other value).

The domain of a Document is the host part of the document's origin, if that is a scheme/host/port tuple. If it isn't, then the document does not have a domain.

The domain attribute is used to enable pages on different hosts of a domain to access each others' DOMs.

5.4 スクリプティング

Various mechanisms can cause author-provided executable code to run in the context of a document. These mechanisms include, but are probably not limited to:

When a script is created, it is associated with a script execution context, a script browsing context, and a script document context.

5.4.1 Script execution contexts

The script execution context of a script is defined when that script is created. In this specification, it is either a Window object or an empty object; other specifications might make the script execution context be some other object.

When the script execution context of a script is an empty object, it can't do anything that interacts with the environment.

A script execution context always has an associated browsing context, known as the script browsing context. If the script execution context is a Window object, then that object's browsing context is it. Otherwise, the script execution context is associated explicitly with a browsing context when it is created.

Every script whose script execution context is a Window object is also associated with a Document object, known as its script document context. It is used to resolve URLs. The document is assigned when the script is created, as with the script browsing context.


It is said that scripting is disabled in a script execution context when any of the following conditions are true:

A node is said to be without script if either the Document object of the node (the node itself, if it is itself a Document object) does not have an associated browsing context, or scripting is disabled in that browsing context.

A node is said to be with script if it is not without script.

If you can find a better pair of terms than "with script" and "without script" let me know. The only things I can find that are less confusing are also way, way longer.

When a script is to be executed in a script execution context in which scripting is disabled, the script must do nothing and return nothing (a void return value).

Thus, for instance, enabling designMode will disable any event handler attributes, event listeners, timeouts, etc, that were set by scripts in the document.

5.4.2 Event loops

To coordinate events, user interaction, scripts, rendering, networking, and so forth, user agents must use event loops as described in this section.

There must be at least one event loop per user agent, and at most one event loop per unit of related similar-origin browsing contexts.

An event loop always has at least one browsing context. If an event loop's browsing contexts all go away, then the event loop goes away as well. A browsing context always has an event loop coordinating its activities.

An event loop has one or more task queues. A task queue is an ordered list of tasks, which can be:

Events

Asynchronously dispatching an Event object at a particular EventTarget object is a task.

Not all events are dispatched using the task queue, many are dispatched synchronously during other tasks.

Parsing

The HTML parser tokenising a single byte, and then processing any resulting tokens, is a task.

Callbacks

Calling a callback asynchronously is a task.

Using a resource

When an algorithm fetches a resource, if the fetching occurs asynchronously then the processing of the resource once some or all of the resource is available is a task.

Reacting to DOM manipulation

Some elements have tasks that trigger in response to DOM manipulation, e.g. when that element is inserted into the document.

When a user agent is to queue a task, it must add the given task to one of the task queues of the relevant event loop. All the tasks from one particular task source (e.g. the callbacks generated by timers, the events dispatched for mouse movements, the tasks queued for the parser) must always be added to the same task queue, but tasks from different task sources may be placed in different task queues.

For example, a user agent could have one task queue for mouse and key events (the user interaction task source, not defined in this specification), and another for everything else. The user agent could then give keyboard and mouse events preference over other tasks three quarters of the time, keeping the interface responsive but not starving other task queues, and never processing events from any one task source out of order.

An event loop must continually run through the following steps for as long as it exists:

  1. Run the oldest task on one of the event loop's task queues. The user agent may pick any task queue.

  2. Remove that task from its task queue.

  3. If necessary, update the rendering or user interface of any Document or browsing context to reflect the current state.

  4. Return to the first step of the event loop.

5.4.3 Security exceptions

Define security exception.

5.4.4 The javascript: protocol

A URL using the javascript: protocol must, if and when dereferenced, be evaluated by executing the script obtained using the content retrieval operation defined for javascript: URLs. [JSURL]

When a browsing context is navigated to a javascript: URL, and the active document of that browsing context has the same origin as the script given by that URL, the script execution context must be the Window object of the browsing context being navigated, and the script document context must be that active document.

When a browsing context is navigated to a javascript: URL, and the active document of that browsing context has an origin that is not the same as that of the script given by the URL, the script execution context must be an empty object, and the script browsing context must be the browsing context being navigated.

Otherwise, if the Document object of the element, attribute, or style sheet from which the javascript: URL was reached has an associated browsing context, the script execution context must be an empty object, and the script execution context's associated browsing context must be that browsing context.

Otherwise, the script is not executed and its return value is void.

If the result of executing the script is void (there is no return value), then the URL must be treated in a manner equivalent to an HTTP resource with an HTTP 204 No Content response.

Otherwise, the URL must be treated in a manner equivalent to an HTTP resource with a 200 OK response whose Content-Type metadata is text/html and whose response body is the return value converted to a string value.

Certain contexts, in particular img elements, ignore the Content-Type metadata.

So for example a javascript: URL for a src attribute of an img element would be evaluated in the context of an empty object as soon as the attribute is set; it would then be sniffed to determine the image type and decoded as an image.

A javascript: URL in an href attribute of an a element would only be evaluated when the link was followed.

The src attribute of an iframe element would be evaluated in the context of the iframe's own browsing context; once evaluated, its return value (if it was not void) would replace that browsing context's document, thus changing the variables visible in that browsing context.

The rules for handling script execution in a script execution context include making the script not execute (and just return void) in certain cases, e.g. in a sandbox or when the user has disabled scripting altogether.

5.4.5 Events

We need to define how to handle events that are to be fired on a Document that is no longer the active document of its browsing context, and for Documents that have no browsing context. Do the events fire? Do the handlers in that document not fire? Do we just define scripting to be disabled when the document isn't active, with events still running as is? See also the script element section, which says scripts don't run when the document isn't active.

5.4.5.1. 事象取扱器属性

HTML elements can have event handler attributes specified. These act as bubbling event listeners for the element on which they are specified.

Each event handler attribute has two parts, an event handler content attribute and an event handler DOM attribute. Event handler attributes must initially be set to null. When their value changes (through the changing of their event handler content attribute or their event handler DOM attribute), they will either be null, or have an EventListener object assigned to them.

Objects other than Element objects, in particular Window, only have event handler DOM attribute (since they have no content attributes).

Event handler content attributes, when specified, must contain valid ECMAScript code matching the ECMAScript FunctionBody production. [ECMA262]

When an event handler content attribute is set, if the element is owned by a Document that is in a browsing context, its new value must be interpreted as the body of an anonymous function with a single argument called event, with the new function's scope chain being linked from the activation object of the handler, to the element, to the element's form element if it is a form control, to the Document object, to the Window object of the browsing context of that Document. The function's this parameter must be the Element object representing the element. The resulting function must then be set as the value of the corresponding event handler attribute, and the new value must be set as the value of the content attribute. If the given function body fails to compile, then the corresponding event handler attribute must be set to null instead (the content attribute must still be updated to the new value, though).

活性化オブジェクトの詳細については、 ECMA 262 第3版の 10.1.6 節と 10.2.3 節を参照してください。 [ECMA262]

事象取扱器のスクリプト実行文脈は、 適用範囲鎖の最後の Window オブジェクトでなければなりません。事象取扱器のスクリプト文書文脈は、 設定された事象取扱器内容属性を所有する Document オブジェクトでなければなりません

When an event handler content attribute is set on an element owned by a Document that is not in a browsing context, the corresponding event handler attribute is not changed.

Removing an event handler content attribute does not reset the corresponding event handler attribute either.

How do we allow non-JS event handlers?

Event handler DOM attributes, on setting, must set the corresponding event handler attribute to their new value, and on getting, must return whatever the current value of the corresponding event handler attribute is (possibly null).

次に示すのは、すべての HTML 要素で内容属性としても DOM 属性としても対応しなければならずWindow オブジェクトで DOM 属性として対応しなければならない事象取扱器属性です。

onabort

abort 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onbeforeunload

beforeunload 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onblur

blur 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onchange

change 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onclick

click 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

oncontextmenu

contextmenu 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondblclick

dblclick 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondrag

drag 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondragend

dragend 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondragenter

dragenter 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondragleave

dragleave 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondragover

dragover 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondragstart

dragstart 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

ondrop

drop 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onerror

error 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onerror 取扱器はスクリプト誤りの報告にも使われます。

onfocus

focus 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onhashchange

hashchange 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onkeydown

keydown 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onkeypress

keypress 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onkeyup

keyup 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onload

load 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onmessage

message 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onmousedown

mousedown 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onmousemove

mousemove 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onmouseout

mouseout 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onmouseover

mouseover 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onmouseup

mouseup 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onmousewheel

mousewheel 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onresize

resize 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onscroll

scroll 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onselect

select 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onstorage

storage 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onsubmit

submit 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

onunload

unload 事象が当該要素を対象としているか、泡立って当該要素を通過する時には、 常に呼び出されなければなりません

事象取扱器属性が呼び出される時、その引数には当該事象の Event オブジェクトを設定しなければなりません。関数がブール値の偽そのものを返した場合には、 事象の preventDefault() メソッドを呼び出さなければなりません。 例外: 歴史的理由により、 HTML mouseover 事象に関しては、 preventDefault() メソッドは、 代わりに関数が真を返した時に呼び出されなければなりません

要素のすべての事象取扱器属性は、 null に設定されている場合も関数が設定されている場合も、 要素が作成された時に Element オブジェクトの EventTarget 界面の addEventListenerNS() メソッドが事象型 (type 引数) は前述の並び中で当該事象取扱属性について示した型、 名前空間 (namespaceURI 引数) は null、聴取器は対象位相と泡立ち位相の聴取器として (useCapture 引数は偽)、 事象群は既定群として (evtGroup 引数は null)、 事象聴取器自体 (listener 引数) は事象取扱器属性が null の場合はなにもしないとして、それ以外の場合は事象取扱器属性に関連付けられた関数を呼び出すとして (listener 引数は事象取扱器属性自体ではないと強調しておきます。) 呼び出した場合のように要素の事象取扱器として登録されなければなりません

5.4.5.2. Event firing

maybe this should be moved higher up (terminology? conformance? DOM?) Also, the whole terminology thing should be changed so that we don't define any specific events here, we only define 'simple event', 'progress event', 'mouse event', 'key event', and the like, and have the actual dispatch use those generic terms when firing events.

Certain operations and methods are defined as firing events on elements. For example, the click() method on the HTMLElement interface is defined as firing a click event on the element. [DOM3EVENTS]

Firing a click event means that a click event with no namespace, which bubbles and is cancelable, and which uses the MouseEvent interface, must be dispatched at the given element. The event object must have its screenX, screenY, clientX, clientY, and button attributes set to 0, its ctrlKey, shiftKey, altKey, and metaKey attributes set according to the current state of the key input device, if any (false for any keys that are not available), its detail attribute set to 1, and its relatedTarget attribute set to null. The getModifierState() method on the object must return values appropriately describing the state of the key input device at the time the event is created.

Firing a change event means that a change event with no namespace, which bubbles but is not cancelable, and which uses the Event interface, must be dispatched at the given element.

Firing a contextmenu event means that a contextmenu event with no namespace, which bubbles and is cancelable, and which uses the Event interface, must be dispatched at the given element.

Firing a simple event called e means that an event with the name e, with no namespace, which does not bubble but is cancelable (unless otherwise stated), and which uses the Event interface, must be dispatched at the given element.

Firing a show event means firing a simple event called show. Actually this should fire an event that has modifier information (shift/ctrl etc), as well as having a pointer to the node on which the menu was fired, and with which the menu was associated (which could be an ancestor of the former).

Firing a load event means firing a simple event called load. Firing an error event means firing a simple event called error.

Firing a progress event called e means something that hasn't yet been defined, in the [PROGRESS] spec.

The default action of these event is to do nothing unless otherwise stated.

If you dispatch a custom "click" event at an element that would normally have default actions, should they get triggered? If so, we need to go through the entire spec and make sure that any default actions are defined in terms of any event of the right type on that element, not those that are dispatched in expected ways.

5.4.5.3. Events and the Window object

When an event is dispatched at a DOM node in a Document in a browsing context, if the event is not a load event, the user agent must also dispatch the event to the Window, as follows:

  1. In the capture phase, the event must be dispatched to the Window object before being dispatched to any of the nodes.
  2. In the bubble phase, the event must be dispatched to the Window object at the end of the phase, unless bubbling has been prevented.
5.4.5.4. Runtime script errors

This section only applies to user agents that support scripting in general and ECMAScript in particular.

Whenever a runtime script error occurs in one of the scripts associated with the document, the value of the onerror event handler DOM attribute of the Window object must be processed, as follows:

If the value is a function

The function referenced by the onerror attribute must be invoked with three arguments, before notifying the user of the error.

The three arguments passed to the function are all DOMStrings; the first must give the message that the UA is considering reporting, the second must give the absolute URL of the resource in which the error occurred, and the third must give the line number in that resource on which the error occurred.

If the function returns false, then the error should not be reported to the user. Otherwise, if the function returns another value (or does not return at all), the error should be reported to the user.

Any exceptions thrown or errors caused by this function must be reported to the user immediately after the error that the function was called for, without calling the function again.

If the value is null

The error should not reported to the user.

If the value is anything else

The error should be reported to the user.

The initial value of onerror must be undefined.

5.5 User prompts

5.5.1 Simple dialogs

The alert(message) method, when invoked, must show the given message to the user. The user agent may make the method wait for the user to acknowledge the message before returning; if so, the user agent must pause while the method is waiting.

The confirm(message) method, when invoked, must show the given message to the user, and ask the user to respond with a positive or negative response. The user agent must then pause as the method waits for the user's response. If the user responds positively, the method must return true, and if the user responds negatively, the method must return false.

The prompt(message, default) method, when invoked, must show the given message to the user, and ask the user to either respond with a string value or abort. The user agent must then pause as the method waits for the user's response. The second argument is optional. If the second argument (default) is present, then the response must be defaulted to the value given by default. If the user aborts, then the method must return null; otherwise, the method must return the string that the user responded with.

5.5.2 Printing

The print() method, when invoked, must run the printing steps.

User agents should also run the printing steps whenever the user attempts to obtain a physical form (e.g. printed copy), or the representation of a physical form (e.g. PDF copy), of a document.

The printing steps are as follows:

  1. The user agent may display a message to the user and/or may abort these steps.

    For instance, a kiosk browser could silently ignore any invocations of the print() method.

    For instance, a browser on a mobile device could detect that there are no printers in the vicinity and display a message saying so before continuing to offer a "save to PDF" option.

  2. The user agent must fire a simple event called beforeprint at the Window object of the browsing context of the Document that is being printed, as well as any nested browsing contexts in it.

    The beforeprint event can be used to annotate the printed copy, for instance adding the time at which the document was printed.

  3. The user agent should offer the user the opportunity to obtain a physical form (or the representation of a physical form) of the document. The user agent may wait for the user to either accept or decline before returning; if so, the user agent must pause while the method is waiting. Even if the user agent doesn't wait at this point, the user agent must use the state of the relevant documents as they are at this point in the algorithm if and when it eventually creates the alternate form.

  4. The user agent must fire a simple event called afterprint at the Window object of the browsing context of the Document that is being printed, as well as any nested browsing contexts in it.

    The afterprint event can be used to revert annotations added in the earlier event, as well as showing post-printing UI. For instance, if a page is walking the user through the steps of applying for a home loan, the script could automatically advance to the next step after having printed a form or other.

5.5.3 Dialogs implemented using separate documents

The showModalDialog(url, arguments) method, when invoked, must cause the user agent to run the following steps:

  1. If the user agent is configured such that this invocation of showModalDialog() is somehow disabled, then the method returns the empty string; abort these steps.

    User agents are expected to disable this method in certain cases to avoid user annoyance. For instance, a user agent could require that a site be white-listed before enabling this method, or the user agent could be configured to only allow one modal dialog at a time.

  2. Let the list of background browsing contexts be a list of all the browsing contexts that:

    ...as well as any browsing contexts that are nested inside any of the browsing contexts matching those conditions.

  3. Disable the user interface for all the browsing contexts in the list of background browsing contexts. This should prevent the user from navigating those browsing contexts, causing events to to be sent to those browsing context, or editing any content in those browsing contexts. However, it does not prevent those browsing contexts from receiving events from sources other than the user, from running scripts, from running animations, and so forth.

  4. Create a new auxiliary browsing context, with the opener browsing context being the browsing context of the Window object on which the showModalDialog() method was called. The new auxiliary browsing context has no name.

    This browsing context implements the ModalWindow interface.

  5. Let the dialog arguments of the new browsing context be set to the value of arguments.

  6. Let the dialog arguments' origin be the origin of the script that called the showModalDialog() method.

  7. Navigate the new browsing context to url, with replacement enabled, and with the script browsing context of the script that invoked the method as the source browsing context.

  8. Wait for the browsing context to be closed. (The user agent must allow the user to indicate that the browsing context is to be closed.)

  9. Reenable the user interface for all the browsing contexts in the list of background browsing contexts.

  10. Return the auxiliary browsing context's return value.

Browsing contexts created by the above algorithm must implement the ModalWindow interface:

[XXX] interface ModalWindow {
  readonly attribute any dialogArguments;
           attribute DOMString returnValue;
};

Such browsing contexts have associated dialog arguments, which are stored along with the dialog arguments' origin. These values are set by the showModalDialog() method in the algorithm above, when the browsing context is created, based on the arguments provided to the method.

The dialogArguments DOM attribute, on getting, must check whether its browsing context's active document's origin is the same as the dialog arguments' origin. If it is, then the browsing context's dialog arguments must be returned unchanged. Otherwise, if the dialog arguments are an object, then the empty string must be returned, and if the dialog arguments are not an object, then the stringification of the dialog arguments must be returned.

These browsing contexts also have an associated return value. The return value of a browsing context must be initialized to the empty string when the browsing context is created.

The returnValue DOM attribute, on getting, must return the return value of its browsing context, and on setting, must set the return value to the given new value.

5.5.4 Notifications

Notifications are short, transient messages that bring the user's attention to new information, or remind the user of scheduled events.

Since notifications can be annoying if abused, this specification defines a mechanism that scopes notifications to a site's existing rendering area unless the user explicitly indicates that the site can be trusted.

To this end, each origin can be flagged as being a trusted notification source. By default origins should not be flagged as such, but user agents may allow users to whitelist origins or groups of origins as being trusted notification sources. Only origins flagged as trusted in this way are allowed to show notification UI outside of their tab.

For example, a user agent could allow a user to mark all subdomains and ports of example.org as trusted notification sources. Then, mail.example.org and calendar.example.org would both be able to show notifications, without the user having to flag them individually.

The showNotification(title, subtitle, description, onclick) method, when invoked, must cause the user agent to show a notification.

If the method was invoked from a script whose script browsing context has the sandboxed annoyances browsing context flag set, then the notification must be shown within that browsing context. The notification is said to be a sandboxed notification.

Otherwise, if the origin of the script browsing context of the script that invoked the method is not flagged as being a trusted notification source, then the notification should be rendered within the top-level browsing context of the script browsing context of the script that invoked the method. The notification is said to be a normal notification. User agents should provide a way to set the origin's trusted notification source flag from the notification, so that the user can benefit from notifications even when the user agent is not the active application.

Otherwise, the origin is flagged as a trusted notification source, and the notification should be shown using the platform conventions for system-wide notifications. The notification is said to be a trusted notification. User agents may provide a way to unset the origin's trusted notification source flag from within the notification, so as to allow users to easily disable notifications from sites that abuse the privilege.

For example, if a site contains a gadget of a mail application in a sandboxed iframe and that frame triggers a notification upon the receipt of a new e-mail message, that notification would be displayed on top of the gadget only.

However, if the user then goes to the main site of that mail application, the notification would be displayed over the entire rendering area of the tab for the site.

The notification, in this case, would have a button on it to let the user indicate that he trusts the site. If the user clicked this button, the next notification would use the system-wide notification system, appearing even if the tab for the mail application was buried deep inside a minimised window.

The style of notifications varies from platform to platform. On some, it is typically displayed as a "toast" window that slides in from the bottom right corner. In others, notifications are shown as semi-transparent white-on-grey overlays centered over the screen. Other schemes could include simulated ticker tapes, and speech-synthesis playback.

When a normal notification (but not a sandboxed notification) is shown, the user agent may bring the user's attention to the top-level browsing context of the script browsing context of the script that invoked the method, if that would be useful; but user agents should not use system-wide notification mechanisms to do so.

When a trusted notification is shown, the user agent should bring the user's attention to the notification and the script browsing context of the script that invoked the method, as per the platform conventions for attracting the user's attention to applications.

In the case of normal notifications, typically the only attention-grabbing device that would be employed would be something like flashing the tab's caption, or making it bold, or some such.

In addition, in the case of a trusted notification, the entire window could flash, or the browser's application icon could bounce or flash briefly, or a short sound effect could be played.

Notifications should include the following content:

If a new notification from one browsing context has title, subtitle, and description strings that are identical to the title, subtitle, and description strings of an already-active notification from the same browsing context or another browsing context with the same origin, the user agent should not display the new notification, but should instead add an indicator to the already-active notification that another identical notification would otherwise have been shown.

For instance, if a user has his mail application open in three windows, and thus the same "New Mail" notification is fired three times each time a mail is received, instead of displaying three identical notifications each time, the user agent could just show one, with the title "New Mail x3".

Notifications should have a lifetime based on the platform conventions for notifications. However, the lifetime of a notification should not begin until the user has had the opportunity to see it, so if a notification is spawned for a browsing context that is hidden, it should be shown for its complete lifetime once the user brings that browsing context into view.

User agents should support multiple notifications at once.

User agents should support user interaction with notifications, if and as appropriate given the platform conventions. If a user activates a notification, and the onclick callback argument was present and is not null, then the script browsing context of the function given by onclick should be brought to the user's attention, and the onclick callback should then be invoked.

5.6 System state and capabilities

The navigator attribute of the Window interface must return an instance of the Navigator interface, which represents the identity and state of the user agent (the client), and allows Web pages to register themselves as potential protocol and content handlers:

interface Navigator {
  // client identification
  readonly attribute DOMString appName;
  readonly attribute DOMString appVersion;
  readonly attribute DOMString platform;
  readonly attribute DOMString userAgent;

  // system state
  readonly attribute boolean onLine;
  void registerProtocolHandler(in DOMString protocol, in DOMString url, in DOMString title);
  void registerContentHandler(in DOMString mimeType, in DOMString url, in DOMString title);
};

5.6.1 Client identification

In certain cases, despite the best efforts of the entire industry, Web browsers have bugs and limitations that Web authors are forced to work around.

This section defines a collection of attributes that can be used to determine, from script, the kind of user agent in use, in order to work around these issues.

Client detection should always be limited to detecting known current versions; future versions and unknown versions should always be assumed to be fully compliant.

appName

Must return either the string "Netscape" or the full name of the browser, e.g. "Mellblom Browsernator".

appVersion

Must return either the string "4.0" or a string representing the version of the browser in detail, e.g. "1.0 (VMS; en-US) Mellblomenator/9000".

platform

Must return either the empty string or a string representing the platform on which the browser is executing, e.g. "MacIntel", "Win32", "FreeBSD i386", "WebTV OS".

userAgent

Must return the string used for the value of the "User-Agent" header in HTTP requests, or the empty string if no such header is ever sent.

5.6.2 Custom protocol and content handlers

The registerProtocolHandler() method allows Web sites to register themselves as possible handlers for particular protocols. For example, an online fax service could register itself as a handler of the fax: protocol ([RFC2806]), so that if the user clicks on such a link, he is given the opportunity to use that Web site. Analogously, the registerContentHandler() method allows Web sites to register themselves as possible handlers for content in a particular MIME type. For example, the same online fax service could register itself as a handler for image/g3fax files ([RFC1494]), so that if the user has no native application capable of handling G3 Facsimile byte streams, his Web browser can instead suggest he use that site to view the image.

User agents may, within the constraints described in this section, do whatever they like when the methods are called. A UA could, for instance, prompt the user and offer the user the opportunity to add the site to a shortlist of handlers, or make the handlers his default, or cancel the request. UAs could provide such a UI through modal UI or through a non-modal transient notification interface. UAs could also simply silently collect the information, providing it only when relevant to the user.

There is an example of how these methods could be presented to the user below.

The arguments to the methods have the following meanings:

protocol (registerProtocolHandler() only)

A scheme, such as ftp or fax. The scheme must be compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner by user agents for the purposes of comparing with the scheme part of URLs that they consider against the list of registered handlers.

The protocol value, if it contains a colon (as in "ftp:"), will never match anything, since schemes don't contain colons.

mimeType (registerContentHandler() only)

A MIME type, such as model/vrml or text/richtext. The MIME type must be compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner by user agents for the purposes of comparing with MIME types of documents that they consider against the list of registered handlers.

User agents must compare the given values only to the MIME type/subtype parts of content types, not to the complete type including parameters. Thus, if mimeType values passed to this method include characters such as commas or whitespace, or include MIME parameters, then the handler being registered will never be used.

url

The URL of the page that will handle the requests. When the user agent uses this URL, it must replace the first occurrence of the exact literal string "%s" with an escaped version of the URL of the content in question (as defined below), then resolve the resulting URL (using the document base URL of the script document context of the script that originally invoked the registerContentHandler() or registerProtocolHandler() method), and then fetch the resulting URL using the GET method (or equivalent for non-HTTP URLs).

To get the escaped version of the URL of the content in question, the user agent must resolve the URL, and then every character in the URL that doesn't match the <query> production defined in RFC 3986 must be replaced by the percent-encoded form of the character. [RFC3986]

If the user had visited a site at http://example.com/ that made the following call:

navigator.registerContentHandler('application/x-soup', 'soup?url=%s', 'SoupWeb™')

...and then, much later, while visiting http://www.example.net/, clicked on a link such as:

<a href="chickenkïwi.soup">Download our Chicken Kiwi soup!</a>

...then, assuming this chickenkïwi.soup file was served with the MIME type application/x-soup, the UA might navigate to the following URL:

http://example.com/soup?url=http://www.example.net/chickenk%C3%AFwi.soup

This site could then fetch the chickenkïwi.soup file and do whatever it is that it does with soup (synthesize it and ship it to the user, or whatever).

title

A descriptive title of the handler, which the UA might use to remind the user what the site in question is.

User agents should raise security exceptions if the methods are called with protocol or mimeType values that the UA deems to be "privileged". For example, a site attempting to register a handler for http URLs or text/html content in a Web browser would likely cause an exception to be raised.

User agents must raise a SYNTAX_ERR exception if the url argument passed to one of these methods does not contain the exact literal string "%s".

User agents must not raise any other exceptions (other than binding-specific exceptions, such as for an incorrect number of arguments in an ECMAScript implementation).

This section does not define how the pages registered by these methods are used, beyond the requirements on how to process the url value (see above). To some extent, the processing model for navigating across documents defines some cases where these methods are relevant, but in general UAs may use this information wherever they would otherwise consider handing content to native plugins or helper applications.

UAs must not use registered content handlers to handle content that was returned as part of a non-GET transaction (or rather, as part of any non-idempotent transaction), as the remote site would not be able to fetch the same data.

5.6.2.1. Security and privacy

These mechanisms can introduce a number of concerns, in particular privacy concerns.

Hijacking all Web usage. User agents should not allow protocols that are key to its normal operation, such as http or https, to be rerouted through third-party sites. This would allow a user's activities to be trivially tracked, and would allow user information, even in secure connections, to be collected.

Hijacking defaults. It is strongly recommended that user agents do not automatically change any defaults, as this could lead the user to send data to remote hosts that the user is not expecting. New handlers registering themselves should never automatically cause those sites to be used.

Registration spamming. User agents should consider the possibility that a site will attempt to register a large number of handlers, possibly from multiple domains (e.g. by redirecting through a series of pages each on a different domain, and each registering a handler for video/mpeg — analogous practices abusing other Web browser features have been used by pornography Web sites for many years). User agents should gracefully handle such hostile attempts, protecting the user.

Misleading titles. User agents should not rely wholly on the title argument to the methods when presenting the registered handlers to the user, since sites could easily lie. For example, a site hostile.example.net could claim that it was registering the "Cuddly Bear Happy Content Handler". User agents should therefore use the handler's domain in any UI along with any title.

Hostile handler metadata. User agents should protect against typical attacks against strings embedded in their interface, for example ensuring that markup or escape characters in such strings are not executed, that null bytes are properly handled, that over-long strings do not cause crashes or buffer overruns, and so forth.

Leaking Intranet URLs. The mechanism described in this section can result in secret Intranet URLs being leaked, in the following manner:

  1. The user registers a third-party content handler as the default handler for a content type.
  2. The user then browses his corporate Intranet site and accesses a document that uses that content type.
  3. The user agent contacts the third party and hands the third party the URI to the Intranet content.

No actual confidential file data is leaked in this manner, but the URLs themselves could contain confidential information. For example, the URL could be http://www.corp.example.com/upcoming-aquisitions/the-sample-company.egf, which might tell the third party that Example Corporation is intending to merge with The Sample Company. Implementors might wish to consider allowing administrators to disable this feature for certain subdomains, content types, or protocols.

Leaking secure URLs. User agents should not send HTTPS URLs to third-party sites registered as content handlers, in the same way that user agents do not send Referer headers from secure sites to third-party sites.

Leaking credentials. User agents must never send username or password information in the URLs that are escaped and included sent to the handler sites. User agents may even avoid attempting to pass to Web-based handlers the URLs of resources that are known to require authentication to access, as such sites would be unable to access the resources in question without prompting the user for credentials themselves (a practice that would require the user to know whether to trust the third-party handler, a decision many users are unable to make or even understand).

5.6.2.2. Sample user interface

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

A simple implementation of this feature for a desktop Web browser might work as follows.

The registerProtocolHandler() method could display a modal dialog box:

||[ Protocol Handler Registration ]|||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|                                                            |
| This Web page:                                             |
|                                                            |
|    Kittens at work                                         |
|    http://kittens.example.org/                             |
|                                                            |
| ...would like permission to handle the protocol "x-meow:"  |
| using the following Web-based application:                 |
|                                                            |
|    Kittens-at-work displayer                               |
|    http://kittens.example.org/?show=%s                     |
|                                                            |
| Do you trust the administrators of the "kittens.example.   |
| org" domain?                                               |
|                                                            |
|              ( Trust kittens.example.org )  (( Cancel ))   |
|____________________________________________________________|

...where "Kittens at work" is the title of the page that invoked the method, "http://kittens.example.org/" is the URL of that page, "x-meow" is the string that was passed to the registerProtocolHandler() method as its first argument (protocol), "http://kittens.example.org/?show=%s" was the second argument (url), and "Kittens-at-work displayer" was the third argument (title).

If the user clicks the Cancel button, then nothing further happens. If the user clicks the "Trust" button, then the handler is remembered.

When the user then attempts to fetch a URL that uses the "x-meow:" scheme, then it might display a dialog as follows:

||[ Unknown Protocol ]||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|                                                            |
| You have attempted to access:                              |
|                                                            |
|    x-meow:S2l0dGVucyBhcmUgdGhlIGN1dGVzdCE%3D               |
|                                                            |
| How would you like FerretBrowser to handle this resource?  |
|                                                            |
|  (o) Contact the FerretBrowser plugin registry to see if   |
|      there is an official way to handle this resource.     |
|                                                            |
|  ( ) Pass this URL to a local application:                 |
|      [ /no application selected/             ] ( Choose )  |
|                                                            |
|  ( ) Pass this URL to the "Kittens-at-work displayer"      |
|      application at "kittens.example.org".                 |
|                                                            |
|  [ ] Always do this for resources using the "x-meow"       |
|      protocol in future.                                   |
|                                                            |
|                                     ( Ok )  (( Cancel ))   |
|____________________________________________________________|

...where the third option is the one that was primed by the site registering itself earlier.

If the user does select that option, then the browser, in accordance with the requirements described in the previous two sections, will redirect the user to "http://kittens.example.org/?show=x-meow%3AS2l0dGVucyBhcmUgdGhlIGN1dGVzdCE%253D".

The registerContentHandler() method would work equivalently, but for unknown MIME types instead of unknown protocols.

5.7 Offline Web applications

5.7.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

...

5.7.2 Application caches

An application cache is a collection of resources. An application cache is identified by the absolute URL of a resource manifest which is used to populate the cache.

Application caches are versioned, and there can be different instances of caches for the same manifest URL, each having a different version. A cache is newer than another if it was created after the other (in other words, caches in a group have a chronological order).

Each group of application caches for the same manifest URL have a common update status, which is one of the following: idle, checking, downloading.

A browsing context can be associated with an application cache. A child browsing context is always associated with the same application cache as its parent browsing context, if any. A top-level browsing context is associated with the application cache appropriate for its active document. (A browsing context's associated cache thus can change during session history traversal.)

A Document initially has no appropriate cache, but steps in the parser and in the navigation sections cause cache selection to occur early in the page load process.

An application cache consists of:

Multiple application caches can contain the same resource, e.g. if their manifests all reference that resource. If the user agent is to select an application cache from a list of caches that contain a resource, that the user agent must use the application cache that the user most likely wants to see the resource from, taking into account the following:

5.7.3 The cache manifest syntax

5.7.3.1. A sample manifest

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

This example manifest requires two images and a style sheet to be cached and whitelists a CGI script.

CACHE MANIFEST
# the above line is required

# this is a comment
# there can be as many of these anywhere in the file
# they are all ignored
  # comments can have spaces before them
  # but most be alone on the line

# blank lines are ignored too

# these are files that need to be cached they can either be listed
# first, or a "CACHE:" header could be put before them, as is done
# lower down.
images/sound-icon.png
images/background.png
# note that each file has to be put on its own line

# here is a file for the online whitelist -- it isn't cached, and 
# references to this file will bypass the cache, always hitting the
# network (or trying to, if the user is offline).
NETWORK:
comm.cgi

# here is another set of files to cache, this time just the CSS file.
CACHE:
style/default.css
5.7.3.2. Writing cache manifests

Manifests must be served using the text/cache-manifest MIME type. All resources served using the text/cache-manifest MIME type must follow the syntax of application cache manifests, as described in this section.

An application cache manifest is a text file, whose text is encoded using UTF-8. Data in application cache manifests is line-based. Newlines must be represented by U+000A LINE FEED (LF) characters, U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) characters, or U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) U+000A LINE FEED (LF) pairs.

This is a willful double violation of RFC2046. [RFC2046]

The first line of an application cache manifest must consist of the string "CACHE", a single U+0020 SPACE character, the string "MANIFEST", and zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters. The first line may optionally be preceded by a U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK (BOM) character. If any other text is found on the first line, the user agent will ignore the entire file.

Subsequent lines, if any, must all be one of the following:

A blank line

Blank lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters only.

A comment

Comment lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters, followed by a single U+0023 NUMBER SIGN (#) character, followed by zero or more characters other than U+000A LINE FEED (LF) and U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) characters.

Comments must be on a line on their own. If they were to be included on a line with a URL, the "#" would be mistaken for part of a fragment identifier.

A section header

Section headers change the current section. There are three possible section headers:

CACHE:
Switches to the explicit section.
FALLBACK:
Switches to the fallback section.
NETWORK:
Switches to the online whitelist section.

Section header lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters, followed by one of the names above (including the U+003A COLON (:) character) followed by zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters.

Ironically, by default, the current section is the explicit section.

Data for the current section

The format that data lines must take depends on the current section.

When the current section is the explicit section or the online whitelist section, data lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters, a valid URL identifying a resource other than the manifest itself, and then zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters.

When the current section is the fallback section, data lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters, a valid URL identifying a resource other than the manifest itself, one or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters, another valid URL identifying a resource other than the manifest itself, and then zero or more U+0020 SPACE and U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters.

The URLs in data lines can't be empty strings, since those would be relative URLs to the manifest itself. Such lines would be confused with blank or invalid lines, anyway.

Manifests may contain sections more than once. Sections may be empty.

URLs that are to be fallback pages associated with opportunistic caching namespaces, and those namespaces themselves, must be given in fallback sections, with the namespace being the first URL of the data line, and the corresponding fallback page being the second URL. All the other pages to be cached must be listed in explicit sections.

Opportunistic caching namespaces must have the same origin as the manifest itself.

An opportunistic caching namespace must not be listed more than once.

URLs that the user agent is to put into the online whitelist must all be specified in online whitelist sections. (This is needed for any URL that the page is intending to use to communicate back to the server.)

URLs in the online whitelist section must not also be listed in explicit section, and must not be listed as fallback entries in the fallback section. (URLs in the online whitelist section may match opportunistic caching namespaces, however.)

Relative URLs must be given relative to the manifest's own URL.

URLs in manifests must not have fragment identifiers (i.e. the U+0023 NUMBER SIGN character isn't allowed in URLs in manifests).

5.7.3.3. Parsing cache manifests

When a user agent is to parse a manifest, it means that the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. The user agent must decode the byte stream corresponding with the manifest to be parsed, treating it as UTF-8. Bytes or sequences of bytes that are not valid UTF-8 sequences must be interpreted as a U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER.

  2. Let explicit URLs be an initially empty list of explicit entries.

  3. Let fallback URLs be an initially empty mapping of opportunistic caching namespaces to fallback entries.

  4. Let online whitelist URLs be an initially empty list of URLs for a online whitelist.

  5. Let input be the decoded text of the manifest's byte stream.

  6. Let position be a pointer into input, initially pointing at the first character.

  7. If position is pointing at a U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK (BOM) character, then advance position to the next character.

  8. If the characters starting from position are "CACHE", followed by a U+0020 SPACE character, followed by "MANIFEST", then advance position to the next character after those. Otherwise, this isn't a cache manifest; abort this algorithm with a failure while checking for the magic signature.

  9. Collect a sequence of characters that are U+0020 SPACE or U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters.

  10. If position is not past the end of input and the character at position is neither a U+000A LINE FEED (LF) characters nor a U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) character, then this isn't a cache manifest; abort this algorithm with a failure while checking for the magic signature.

  11. This is a cache manifest. The algorithm cannot fail beyond this point (though bogus lines can get ignored).

  12. Let mode be "explicit".

  13. Start of line: If position is past the end of input, then jump to the last step. Otherwise, collect a sequence of characters that are U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR), U+0020 SPACE, or U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters.

  14. Now, collect a sequence of characters that are not U+000A LINE FEED (LF) or U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) characters, and let the result be line.

  15. Drop any trailing U+0020 SPACE, or U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) characters at the end of line.

  16. If line is the empty string, then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

  17. If the first character in line is a U+0023 NUMBER SIGN (#) character, then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

  18. If line equals "CACHE:" (the word "CACHE" followed by a U+003A COLON (:) character), then set mode to "explicit" and jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

  19. If line equals "FALLBACK:" (the word "FALLBACK" followed by a U+003A COLON (:) character), then set mode to "fallback" and jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

  20. If line equals "NETWORK:" (the word "NETWORK" followed by a U+003A COLON (:) character), then set mode to "online whitelist" and jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

  21. If line ends with a U+003A COLON (:) character, then set mode to "unknown" and jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

  22. This is either a data line or it is syntactically incorrect.

  23. Let position be a pointer into line, initially pointing at the start of the string.

  24. Let tokens be a list of strings, initially empty.

  25. While position doesn't point past the end of line and the character at position is either a U+0020 SPACE or a U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) character, advance position to the next character in input.

  26. While position doesn't point past the end of line:

    1. Let current token be an empty string.

    2. While position doesn't point past the end of line and the character at position is neither a U+0020 SPACE nor a U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) character, add the character at position to current token and advance position to the next character in input.

    3. Add current token to the tokens list.

    4. While position doesn't point past the end of line and the character at position is either a U+0020 SPACE or a U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION (tab) character, advance position to the next character in input.

  27. Process tokens as follows:

    If mode is "explicit"

    Resolve the first item in tokens; ignore the rest.

    If this fails, then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    If the resulting absolute URL has a different <scheme> component than the manifest's URL (compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner), then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    Drop the <fragment> component of the resulting absolute URL, if it has one.

    Add the resulting absolute URL to the explicit URLs.

    If mode is "fallback"

    Let part one be the first token in tokens, and let part two be the second token in tokens.

    Resolve part one and part two.

    If either fails, then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    If the absolute URL corresponding to part one does not have the same origin as the manifest's URL, then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    If the resulting absolute URL for part two has a different <scheme> component than the manifest's URL (compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner), then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    Drop any the <fragment> components of the resulting absolute URLs.

    If the absolute URL corresponding to part one is already in the fallback URIs mapping as an opportunistic caching namespace, then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    Otherwise, add the absolute URL corresponding to part one to the fallback URIs mapping as an opportunistic caching namespace, mapped to the absolute URL corresponding to part two as the fallback entry.

    If mode is "online whitelist"

    Resolve the first item in tokens; ignore the rest.

    If this fails, then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    If the resulting absolute URL has a different <scheme> component than the manifest's URL (compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner), then jump back to the step labeled "start of line".

    Drop the <fragment> component of the resulting absolute URL, if it has one.

    Add the resulting absolute URL to the online whitelist URLs.

    If mode is "unknown"

    Do nothing. The line is ignored.

  28. Jump back to the step labeled "start of line". (That step jumps to the next, and last, step when the end of the file is reached.)

  29. Return the explicit URLs list, the fallback URLs mapping, and the online whitelist URLs.

If a resource is listed in both the online whitelist and in the explicit section, then that resource will be fetched and cached, but when the page tries to use this resource, the user agent will ignore the cached copy and attempt to fetch the file from the network. Indeed, the cached copy will only be used if it is opened from a top-level browsing context.

5.7.4 Updating an application cache

When the user agent is required (by other parts of this specification) to start the application cache update process, the user agent must run the following steps:

the event stuff needs to be more consistent -- something about showing every step of the ui or no steps or something; and we need to deal with showing ui for browsing contexts that open when an update is already in progress, and we may need to give applications control over the ui the first time they cache themselves (right now the original cache is done without notifications to the browsing contexts)

  1. Let manifest URL be the URL of the manifest of the cache to be updated.

  2. Let cache group be the group of application caches identified by manifest URL.

  3. Let cache be the most recently updated application cache identified by manifest URL (that is, the newest version found in cache group).

  4. If the status of the cache group is either checking or downloading, then abort these steps, as an update is already in progress for them. Otherwise, set the status of this group of caches to checking. This entire step must be performed as one atomic operation so as to avoid race conditions.

  5. If there is already a resource with the URL of manifest URL in cache, and that resource is categorized as a manifest, then this is an upgrade attempt. Otherwise, this is a cache attempt.

    If this is a cache attempt, then cache is forcibly the only application cache in cache group, and it hasn't ever been populated from its manifest (i.e. this update is an attempt to download the application for the first time). It also can't have any browsing contexts associated with it.

  6. Fire a simple event called checking at the ApplicationCache singleton of each top-level browsing context that is associated with a cache in cache group. The default action of this event should be the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user that the user agent is checking for the availability of updates.

  7. Fetch the resource from manifest URL, and let manifest be that resource.

    If the resource is labeled with the MIME type text/cache-manifest, parse manifest according to the rules for parsing manifests, obtaining a list of explicit entries, fallback entries and the opportunistic caching namespaces that map to them, and entries for the online whitelist.

  8. If the previous step fails (e.g. the server returns a 4xx or 5xx response or equivalent, or there is a DNS error, or the connection times out, or the user cancels the download, or the parser for manifests fails when checking the magic signature), or if the resource is labeled with a MIME type other than text/cache-manifest, then run the cache failure steps.

  9. If this is an upgrade attempt and the newly downloaded manifest is byte-for-byte identical to the manifest found in cache, or if the server reported it as "304 Not Modified" or equivalent, then run these substeps:

    1. Fire a simple event called noupdate at the ApplicationCache singleton of each top-level browsing context that is associated with a cache in cache group. The default action of this event should be the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user that the application is up to date.

    2. If there are any pending downloads of implicit entries that are being stored in the cache, then wait for all of them to have completed. If any of these downloads fail (e.g. the server returns a 4xx or 5xx response or equivalent, or there is a DNS error, or the connection times out, or the user cancels the download), then run the cache failure steps.

    3. Let the status of the group of caches to which cache belongs be idle. If appropriate, remove any user interface indicating that an update for this cache is in progress.

    4. Abort the update process.

  10. Set the status of cache group to downloading.

  11. Fire a simple event called downloading at the ApplicationCache singleton of each top-level browsing context that is associated with a cache in cache group. The default action of this event should be the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user that a new version is being downloaded.

  12. If this is an upgrade attempt, then let new cache be a newly created application cache identified by manifest URL, being a new version in cache group. Otherwise, let new cache and cache be the same version of the application cache.

  13. Let file list be an empty list of URLs with flags.

  14. Add all the URLs in the list of explicit entries obtained by parsing manifest to file list, each flagged with "explicit entry".

  15. Add all the URLs in the list of fallback entries obtained by parsing manifest to file list, each flagged with "fallback entry".

  16. If this is an upgrade attempt, then add all the URLs of opportunistically cached entries in cache that match the opportunistic caching namespaces obtained by parsing manifest to file list, each flagged with "opportunistic entry".

  17. If this is an upgrade attempt, then add all the URLs of implicit entries in cache to file list, each flagged with "implicit entry".

  18. If this is an upgrade attempt, then add all the URLs of dynamic entries in cache to file list, each flagged with "dynamic entry".

  19. If any URL is in file list more than once, then merge the entries into one entry for that URL, that entry having all the flags that the original entries had.

  20. For each URL in file list, run the following steps. These steps may be run in parallel for two or more of the URLs at a time.

    1. Fire a simple event called progress at the ApplicationCache singleton of each top-level browsing context that is associated with a cache in cache group. The default action of this event should be the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user that a file is being downloaded in preparation for updating the application.

    2. Fetch the resource. If this is an upgrade attempt, then use cache as an HTTP cache, and honor HTTP caching semantics (such as expiration, ETags, and so forth) with respect to that cache. User agents may also have other caches in place that are also honored.

      If the resource in question is already being downloaded for other reasons then the existing download process can be used for the purposes of this step, as defined by the fetching algorithm.

      An example of a resource that might already be being downloaded is a large image on a Web page that is being seen for the first time. The image would get downloaded to satisfy the img element on the page, as well as being listed in the cache manifest. According to the rules for fetching that image only need be downloaded once, and it can be used both for the cache and for the rendered Web page.

    3. If the previous steps fails (e.g. the server returns a 4xx or 5xx response or equivalent, or there is a DNS error, or the connection times out, or the user cancels the download), then run the cache failure steps.

    4. Otherwise, the fetching succeeded. Store the resource in the new cache.

    5. If the URL being processed was flagged as an "explicit entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as an explicit entry.

    6. If the URL being processed was flagged as a "fallback entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as a fallback entry.

    7. If the URL being processed was flagged as a "opportunistic entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as an opportunistically cached entry.

    8. If the URL being processed was flagged as an "implicit entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as a implicit entry.

    9. If the URL being processed was flagged as an "dynamic entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as a dynamic entry.

  21. Store manifest in new cache, if it's not there already, and categorize this entry (whether newly added or not) as the manifest.

  22. Store the list of opportunistic caching namespaces, and the URLs of the fallback entries that they map to, in the new cache.

  23. Store the URLs that form the new online whitelist in the new cache.

  24. Wait for all pending downloads of implicit entries that are being stored in the cache to have completed.

    For example, if the top-level browsing context's active document isn't itself listed in the cache manifest, then it might still be being downloaded.

    If any of these downloads fail (e.g. the server returns a 4xx or 5xx response or equivalent, or there is a DNS error, or the connection times out, or the user cancels the download), then run the cache failure steps.

  25. If this is a cache attempt, then:

    Associate any Document objects that were flagged as candidates for this manifest URL's caches with cache.

    Fire a simple event called cached at the ApplicationCache singleton of each top-level browsing context that is associated with a cache in cache group. The default action of this event should be the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user that the application has been cached and that they can now use it offline.

    Set the status of cache group to idle.

  26. Otherwise, this is an upgrade attempt:

    Fire a simple event called updateready at the ApplicationCache singleton of each top-level browsing context that is associated with a cache in cache group. The default action of this event should be the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user that a new version is available and that they can activate it by reloading the page.

    Set the status of cache group to idle.

The cache failure steps are as follows:

  1. Fire a simple event called error at the ApplicationCache singleton of each top-level browsing context that is associated with a cache in cache group. The default action of this event should be the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user that the user agent failed to save the application for offline use.

  2. If this is a cache attempt, then discard cache and abort the update process.

  3. Otherwise, let the status of the group of caches to which cache belongs be idle. If appropriate, remove any user interface indicating that an update for this cache is in progress. Abort the update process.

5.7.5 処理モデル

The processing model of application caches for offline support in Web applications is part of the navigation model, but references the algorithms defined in this section.

A URL matches an opportunistic caching namespace if there exists an application cache whose manifest's URL has the same origin as the URL in question, and if that application cache has an opportunistic caching namespace with a <path> component that exactly matches the start of the <path> component of the URL being examined. If multiple opportunistic caching namespaces match the same URL, the one with the longest <path> component is the one that matches. A URL looking for an opportunistic caching namespace can match more than one application cache at a time, but only matches one namespace in each cache.

If a manifest http://example.com/app1/manifest declares that http://example.com/resources/images should be opportunistically cached, and the user navigates to http://example.com/resources/images/cat.png, then the user agent will decide that the application cache identified by http://example.com/app1/manifest contains a namespace with a match for that URL.

When the application cache selection algorithm algorithm is invoked with a manifest URL, the user agent must run the first applicable set of steps from the following list:

If the resource is not being loaded as part of navigation of a top-level browsing context

As an optimization, if the resource was loaded from an application cache, and the manifest URL of that cache doesn't match the manifest URL with which the algorithm was invoked, then the user agent should mark the entry in that application cache corresponding to the resource that was just loaded as being foreign.

Other than that, nothing special happens with respect to application caches.

If the resource being loaded was loaded from an application cache and the URL of that application cache's manifest is the same as the manifest URL with which the algorithm was invoked

Associate the Document with the cache from which it was loaded. Invoke the application cache update process.

If the resource being loaded was loaded from an application cache and the URL of that application cache's manifest is not the same as the manifest URL with which the algorithm was invoked

Mark the entry for this resource in the application cache from which it was loaded as foreign.

Restart the current navigation from the top of the navigation algorithm, undoing any changes that were made as part of the initial load (changes can be avoided by ensuring that the step to update the session history with the new page is only ever completed after the application cache selection algorithm is run, though this is not required).

The navigation will not result in the same resource being loaded, because "foreign" entries are never picked during navigation.

User agents may notify the user of the inconsistency between the cache manifest and the resource's own metadata, to aid in application development.

If the resource being loaded was not loaded from an application cache, but it was loaded using HTTP GET or equivalent
  1. If the manifest URL does not have the same origin as the resource's own URL, then invoke the application cache selection algorithm again, but without a manifest, and abort these steps.

  2. If there is already an application cache identified by this manifest URL, and the most up to date version of that application cache contains a resource with the URL of the manifest, and that resource is categorized as a manifest, then: store the resource in the matching cache, categorized as an implicit entry, associate the Document with that cache, invoke the application cache update process, and abort these steps.

  3. Flag the resource's Document as a candidate for this manifest URL's caches, so that it will be associated with an application cache identified by this manifest URL later, when such an application cache is ready.

  4. If there is already an application cache identified by this manifest URL, then the most up to date version of that application cache does not yet contain a resource with the URL of the manifest, or it does but that resource is not yet categorized as a manifest: store the resource in that cache, categorized as an implicit entry (replacing the file's previous contents if it was already in the cache, but not removing any other categories it might have), and abort these steps. (An application cache update process is already in progress.)

  5. Otherwise, there is no matching application cache: create a new application cache identified by this manifest URL, store the resource in that cache, categorized as an implicit entry, and then invoke the application cache update process.

その他の場合

Invoke the application cache selection algorithm again, but without a manifest.

When the application cache selection algorithm is invoked without a manifest, then: if the resource is being loaded as part of navigation of a top-level browsing context, and the resource was fetched from a particular application cache, then the user agent must associate the Document with that application cache and invoke the application cache update process for that cache; otherwise, nothing special happens with respect to application caches.

5.7.5.1. Changes to the networking model

When a browsing context is associated with an application cache, any and all resource loads must go through the following steps instead of immediately invoking the mechanisms appropriate to that resource's scheme:

  1. If the resource is not to be fetched using the HTTP GET mechanism or equivalent, then fetch the resource normally and abort these steps.

  2. If the resource's URL, ignoring its fragment identifier if any, is listed in the application cache's online whitelist, then fetch the resource normally and abort these steps.

  3. If the resource's URL is an implicit entry, the manifest, an explicit entry, a fallback entry, an opportunistically cached entry, or a dynamic entry in the application cache, then get the resource from the cache (instead of fetching it), and abort these steps.

  4. If the resource's URL has the same origin as the manifest's URL, and the start of the resource's URL's <path> component is exactly matched by the <path> component of an opportunistic caching namespace in the application cache, then:

    Fetch the resource normally. If this results 4xx or 5xx status codes or equivalent, or if there were network errors (but not if the user canceled the download), then instead get, from the cache, the resource of the fallback entry corresponding to the namespace with the longest matching <path> component. Abort these steps.

  5. Fail the resource load.

The above algorithm ensures that resources that are not present in the manifest will always fail to load (at least, after the cache has been primed the first time), making the testing of offline applications simpler.

5.7.6 Application cache API

interface ApplicationCache {

  // update status
  const unsigned short UNCACHED = 0;
  const unsigned short IDLE = 1;
  const unsigned short CHECKING = 2;
  const unsigned short DOWNLOADING = 3;
  const unsigned short UPDATEREADY = 4;
  readonly attribute unsigned short status;

  // updates
  void update();
  void swapCache();

  // dynamic entries
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  DOMString item(in unsigned long index);
  void add(in DOMString url);
  void remove(in DOMString url);

  // events
           attribute EventListener onchecking;
           attribute EventListener onerror;
           attribute EventListener onnoupdate;
           attribute EventListener ondownloading;
           attribute EventListener onprogress;
           attribute EventListener onupdateready;
           attribute EventListener oncached;

};

Objects implementing the ApplicationCache interface must also implement the EventTarget interface.

There is a one-to-one mapping from Document objects to ApplicationCache objects. The applicationCache attribute on Window objects must return the ApplicationCache object associated with the active document of the Window's browsing context.

An ApplicationCache object might be associated with an application cache. When the Document object that the ApplicationCache object maps to is associated with an application cache, then that is the application cache with which the ApplicationCache object is associated. Otherwise, the ApplicationCache object is associated with the application cache that the Document object's browsing context is associated with, if any.

The status attribute, on getting, must return the current state of the application cache ApplicationCache object is associated with, if any. This must be the appropriate value from the following list:

UNCACHED (数値 0)

The ApplicationCache object is not associated with an application cache at this time.

IDLE (数値 1)

The ApplicationCache object is associated with an application cache whose group is in the idle update status, and that application cache is the newest cache in its group that contains a resource categorized as a manifest.

CHECKING (数値 2)

The ApplicationCache object is associated with an application cache whose group is in the checking update status.

DOWNLOADING (数値 3)

The ApplicationCache object is associated with an application cache whose group is in the downloading update status.

UPDATEREADY (数値 4)

The ApplicationCache object is associated with an application cache whose group is in the idle update status, but that application cache is not the newest cache in its group that contains a resource categorized as a manifest.

The length attribute must return the number of dynamic entries in the application cache with which the ApplicationCache object is associated, if any, and zero if the object is not associated with any application cache.

The dynamic entries in the application cache are ordered in the same order as they were added to the cache by the add() method, with the oldest entry being the zeroth entry, and the most recently added entry having the index length-1.

The item(index) method must return the absolute URL of the dynamic entry with index index from the application cache, if one is associated with the ApplicationCache object. If the object is not associated with any application cache, or if the index argument is lower than zero or greater than length-1, the method must instead raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

The add(url) method must run the following steps:

  1. If the ApplicationCache object is not associated with any application cache, then raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception and abort these steps.

  2. Resolve the url argument. If this fails, raise a SYNTAX_ERR exception and abort these steps.

  3. If there is already a resource in in the application cache with which the ApplicationCache object is associated that has the address url, then ensure that entry is categorized as a dynamic entry and return and abort these steps.

  4. If url has a different <scheme> component than the manifest's URL, then raise a security exception.

  5. Return, but do not abort these steps.

  6. Fetch the resource referenced by url.

  7. If this results 4xx or 5xx status codes or equivalent, or if there were network errors, or if the user canceled the download, then abort these steps.

  8. Wait for there to be no running scripts, or at least no running scripts that can reach an ApplicationCache object associated with the application cache with which this ApplicationCache object is associated.

    Add the fetched resource to the application cache and categorize it as a dynamic entry before letting any such scripts resume.

We can make the add() API more usable (i.e. make it possible to detect progress and distinguish success from errors without polling and timeouts) if we have the method return an object that is a target of Progress Events, much like the XMLHttpRequestEventTarget interface. This would also make this far more complex to spec and implement.

The remove(url) method must resolve the url argument and, if that is successful, remove the dynamic entry categorization of any entry whose address is the resulting absolute URL in the application cache with which the ApplicationCache object is associated. If this removes the last categorization of an entry in that cache, then the entry must be removed entirely (such that if it is re-added, it will be loaded from the network again). If the ApplicationCache object is not associated with any application cache, then the method must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception instead.

If the update() method is invoked, the user agent must invoke the application cache update process, in the background, for the application cache with which the ApplicationCache object is associated. If there is no such application cache, then the method must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception instead.

If the swapCache() method is invoked, the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. Let document be the Document with which the ApplicationCache object is associated.

  2. Check that document is associated with an application cache. If it is not, then raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception and abort these steps.

    This is not the same thing as the ApplicationCache object being itself associated with an application cache! In particular, the Document with which the ApplicationCache object is associated can only itself be associated with an application cache if it is in a top-level browsing context.

  3. Let cache be the application cache with which the ApplicationCache object is associated. (By definition, this is the same as the one that was found in the previous step.)

  4. Check that there is an application cache in the same group as cache which has an entry categorized as a manifest that has is newer than cache. If there is not, then raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception and abort these steps.

  5. Let new cache be the newest application cache in the same group as cache which has an entry categorized as a manifest.

  6. Unassociate document from cache and instead associate it with new cache.

The following are the event handler DOM attributes that must be supported by objects implementing the ApplicationCache interface:

onchecking

Must be invoked whenever an checking event is targeted at or bubbles through the ApplicationCache object.

onerror

Must be invoked whenever an error event is targeted at or bubbles through the ApplicationCache object.

onnoupdate

Must be invoked whenever an noupdate event is targeted at or bubbles through the ApplicationCache object.

ondownloading

Must be invoked whenever an downloading event is targeted at or bubbles through the ApplicationCache object.

onprogress

Must be invoked whenever an progress event is targeted at or bubbles through the ApplicationCache object.

onupdateready

Must be invoked whenever an updateready event is targeted at or bubbles through the ApplicationCache object.

oncached

cached 事象が当該 ApplicationCache オブジェクトを対象としているか、泡立って当該オブジェクトを通過する時に、 呼び出されなければなりません。

5.7.7 Browser state

The navigator.onLine attribute must return false if the user agent will not contact the network when the user follows links or when a script requests a remote page (or knows that such an attempt would fail), and must return true otherwise.

When the value that would be returned by the navigator.onLine attribute of the Window changes from true to false, the user agent must fire a simple event called offline at the body element.

On the other hand, when the value that would be returned by the navigator.onLine attribute of the Window changes from false to true, the user agent must fire a simple event called online at the body element.

5.8 Session history and navigation

5.8.1 The session history of browsing contexts

The sequence of Documents in a browsing context is its session history.

History objects provide a representation of the pages in the session history of browsing contexts. Each browsing context has a distinct session history.

Each Document object in a browsing context's session history is associated with a unique instance of the History object, although they all must model the same underlying session history.

The history attribute of the Window interface must return the object implementing the History interface for that Window object's active document.

History objects represent their browsing context's session history as a flat list of session history entries. Each session history entry consists of either a URL or a state object, or both, and may in addition have a title, a Document object, form data, a scroll position, and other information associated with it.

This does not imply that the user interface need be linear. See the notes below.

URLs without associated state objects are added to the session history as the user (or script) navigates from page to page.

A state object is an object representing a user interface state.

Pages can add state objects between their entry in the session history and the next ("forward") entry. These are then returned to the script when the user (or script) goes back in the history, thus enabling authors to use the "navigation" metaphor even in one-page applications.

Every Document in the session history is defined to have a last activated entry, which is the state object entry associated with that Document which was most recently activated. Initially, the last activated entry of a Document must be the first entry for the Document, representing the fact that no state object entry has yet been activated.

At any point, one of the entries in the session history is the current entry. This is the entry representing the active document of the browsing context. The current entry is usually an entry for the location of the Document. However, it can also be one of the entries for state objects added to the history by that document.

Entries that consist of state objects share the same Document as the entry for the page that was active when they were added.

Contiguous entries that differ just by fragment identifier also share the same Document.

All entries that share the same Document (and that are therefore merely different states of one particular document) are contiguous by definition.

User agents may discard the Document objects of entries other than the current entry that are not referenced from any script, reloading the pages afresh when the user or script navigates back to such pages. This specification does not specify when user agents should discard Document objects and when they should cache them.

Entries that have had their Document objects discarded must, for the purposes of the algorithms given below, act as if they had not. When the user or script navigates back or forwards to a page which has no in-memory DOM objects, any other entries that shared the same Document object with it must share the new object as well.

When state object entries are added, a URL can be provided. This URL is used to replace the state object entry if the Document is evicted.

When a user agent discards the Document object from an entry in the session history, it must also discard all the entries that share that Document but do not have an associated URL (i.e. entries that only have a state object). Entries that shared that Document object but had a state object and have a different URL must then have their state objects removed. Removed entries are not recreated if the user or script navigates back to the page. If there are no state object entries for that Document object then no entries are removed.

5.8.2 History 界面

interface History {
  readonly attribute long length;
  void go(in long delta);
  void go();
  void back();
  void forward();
  void pushState(in DOMObject data, in DOMString title);
  void pushState(in DOMObject data, in DOMString title, in DOMString url);
  void clearState();
};

The length attribute of the History interface must return the number of entries in this session history.

The actual entries are not accessible from script.

The go(delta) method causes the UA to move the number of steps specified by delta in the session history.

If the index of the current entry plus delta is less than zero or greater than or equal to the number of items in the session history, then the user agent must do nothing.

If the delta is zero, then the user agent must act as if the location.reload() method was called instead.

Otherwise, the user agent must cause the current browsing context to traverse the history to the specified entry. The specified entry is the one whose index equals the index of the current entry plus delta.

When the user navigates through a browsing context, e.g. using a browser's back and forward buttons, the user agent must translate this action into the equivalent invocations of the history.go(delta) method on the various affected window objects.

Some of the other members of the History interface are defined in terms of the go() method, as follows:
Member Definition
go() Must do the same as go(0)
back() Must do the same as go(-1)
forward() Must do the same as go(1)

The pushState(data, title, url) method adds a state object to the history.

When this method is invoked, the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. If a third argument is specified, run these substeps:

    1. Resolve the value of the third argument.
    2. If that fails, raise a security exception and abort the pushState() steps.
    3. Compare the resulting absolute URL to the document's address. If any part of these two URLs differ other than the <path>, <query>, and <fragment> components, then raise a security exception and abort the pushState() steps.

    For the purposes of the comparison in the above substeps, the <path> and <query> components can only be the same if the URLs use a hierarchical <scheme>.

  2. Remove from the session history any entries for the Document from the entry after the current entry up to the last entry in the session history that references the same Document object, if any. If the current entry is the last entry in the session history, or if there are no entries after the current entry that reference the same Document object, then no entries are removed.

  3. Add a state object entry to the session history, after the current entry, with the specified data as the state object, the given title as the title, and, if the third argument is present, the absolute URL that was found in the first step as the URL of the entry.

  4. Set this new entry as being the last activated entry for the Document.

  5. Update the current entry to be the this newly added entry.

title is purely advisory. User agents might use the title in the user 界面。

User agents may limit the number of state objects added to the session history per page. If a page hits the UA-defined limit, user agents must remove the entry immediately after the first entry for that Document object in the session history after having added the new entry. (Thus the state history acts as a FIFO buffer for eviction, but as a LIFO buffer for navigation.)

The clearState() method removes all the state objects for the Document object from the session history.

When this method is invoked, the user agent must remove from the session history all the entries from the first state object entry for that Document object up to the last entry that references that same Document object, if any.

Then, if the current entry was removed in the previous step, the current entry must be set to the last entry for that Document object in the session history.

5.8.3 Activating state object entries

When an entry in the session history is activated (which happens during session traversal, as described above), the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. First, the user agent must set this new entry as being the last activated entry for the Document to which the entry belongs.

  2. If the entry is a state object entry, let state be that state object. Otherwise, the entry is the first entry for the Document; let state be null.

  3. The user agent must then fire a popstate event in no namespace on the body element using the PopStateEvent interface, with the state attribute set to the value of state. This event bubbles but is not cancelable and has no default action.

interface PopStateEvent : Event {
  readonly attribute DOMObject state;
  void initPopStateEvent(in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMObject stateArg);
  void initPopStateEventNS(in DOMString namespaceURIArg, in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMObject stateArg);
};

initPopStateEvent() メソッドと initMessageEventNS() メソッドは、 DOM3 事象界面の似たような名前のメソッドと同じような方法で事象を初期化しなければなりません[DOM3EVENTS]

The state attribute represents the context information for the event, or null, if the state represented is the initial state of the Document.

5.8.4 Location 界面

Each Document object in a browsing context's session history is associated with a unique instance of a Location object.

The location attribute of the HTMLDocument interface must return the Location object for that Document object, if it is in a browser context, and null otherwise.

The location attribute of the Window interface must return the Location object for that Window object's active document.

Location objects provide a representation of their document's address, and allow the current entry of the browsing context's session history to be changed, by adding or replacing entries in the history object.

interface Location {
  readonly attribute DOMString href;
  void assign(in DOMString url);
  void replace(in DOMString url);
  void reload();

    // URL decomposition attributes 
           attribute DOMString protocol;
           attribute DOMString host;
           attribute DOMString hostname;
           attribute DOMString port;
           attribute DOMString pathname;
           attribute DOMString search;
           attribute DOMString hash;
};

The href attribute must return the address of the page represented by the associated Document object, as an absolute URL.

On setting, the user agent must act as if the assign() method had been called with the new value as its argument.

When the assign(url) method is invoked, the UA must navigate the browsing context to the specified url.

When the replace(url) method is invoked, the UA must navigate the browsing context to the specified url with replacement enabled.

Navigation for the assign() and replace() methods must be done with the script browsing context of the script that invoked the method as the source browsing context.

The Location interface also has the complement of URL decomposition attributes, protocol, host, port, hostname, pathname, search, and hash. These must follow the rules given for URL decomposition attributes, with the input being the address of the page represented by the associated Document object, as an absolute URL (same as the href attribute), and the common setter action being the same as setting the href attribute to the new output value.

5.8.4.1. 保安性

User agents must raise a security exception whenever any of the members of a Location object are accessed by scripts whose effective script origin is not the same as the Location object's associated Document's effective script origin, with the following exceptions:

User agents must not allow scripts to override the href attribute's setter.

5.8.5 Implementation notes for session history

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

The History interface is not meant to place restrictions on how implementations represent the session history to the user.

For example, session history could be implemented in a tree-like manner, with each page having multiple "forward" pages. This specification doesn't define how the linear list of pages in the history object are derived from the actual session history as seen from the user's perspective.

Similarly, a page containing two iframes has a history object distinct from the iframes' history objects, despite the fact that typical Web browsers present the user with just one "Back" button, with a session history that interleaves the navigation of the two inner frames and the outer page.

Security: It is suggested that to avoid letting a page "hijack" the history navigation facilities of a UA by abusing pushState(), the UA provide the user with a way to jump back to the previous page (rather than just going back to the previous state). For example, the back button could have a drop down showing just the pages in the session history, and not showing any of the states. Similarly, an aural browser could have two "back" commands, one that goes back to the previous state, and one that jumps straight back to the previous page.

In addition, a user agent could ignore calls to pushState() that are invoked on a timer, or from event handlers that do not represent a clear user action, or that are invoked in rapid succession.

5.9 Browsing the Web

Certain actions cause the browsing context to navigate to a new resource. Navigation always involves source browsing context, which is the browsing context which was responsible for starting the navigation.

For example, following a hyperlink, form submission, and the window.open() and location.assign() methods can all cause a browsing context to navigate.

A user agent may provide various ways for the user to explicitly cause a browsing context to navigate, in addition to those defined in this specification.

When a browsing context is navigated to a new resource, the user agent must run the following steps:

  1. Cancel any preexisting attempt to navigate the browsing context.

  2. Resolve the URL of the new resource. If that fails, the user agent may abort these steps, or may treat the URL as identifying some sort of user-agent defined error resource, which could display some sort of inline content, or could be handled using a mechanism that does not affect the browsing context.
  3. If the new resource is to be handled by displaying some sort of inline content, e.g. an error message because the specified scheme is not one of the supported protocols, or an inline prompt to allow the user to select a registered handler for the given scheme, then display the inline content and abort these steps.

  4. If the new resource is to be handled using a mechanism that does not affect the browsing context, e.g. ignoring the navigation request altogether because the specified scheme is not one of the supported protocols, then abort these steps and proceed with that mechanism instead.

  5. If the new resource is to be fetched using HTTP GET or equivalent, and if the browsing context being navigated is a top-level browsing context, then check if there are any application caches that have a manifest with the same origin as the URL in question, and that have this URL as one of their entries (excluding entries marked as foreign), and that already contain their manifest, categorized as a manifest. If so, then the user agent must then get the resource from the most appropriate application cache of those that match.

    Otherwise, fetch the new resource. If this results in a redirect, return to the step labeled "fragment identifiers" with the new resource.

    For example, imagine an HTML page with an associated application cache displaying an image and a form, where the image is also used by several other application caches. If the user right-clicks on the image and chooses "View Image", then the user agent could decide to show the image from any of those caches, but it is likely that the most useful cache for the user would be the one that was used for the aforementioned HTML page. On the other hand, if the user submits the form, and the form does a POST submission, then the user agent will not use an application cache at all; the submission will be made to the network.

  6. If fetching the resource is synchronous (i.e. for javascript: URLs and about:blank), then this must be synchronous, but if fetching the resource depends on external resources, as it usually does for URLs that use HTTP or other networking protocols, then at this point the user agents must yield to whatever script invoked the navigation steps, if they were invoked by script.

  7. Wait for one or more bytes to be available or for the user agent to establish that the resource in question is empty. During this time, the user agent may allow the user to cancel this navigation attempt or start other navigation attempts.

  8. If the resource was not fetched from an application cache, and was to be fetched using HTTP GET or equivalent, and its URL matches the opportunistic caching namespace of one or more application caches, and the user didn't cancel the navigation attempt during the previous step, then:

    If the browsing context being navigated is a top-level browsing context, and the navigation attempt failed (e.g. the server returned a 4xx or 5xx status code or equivalent, or there was a DNS error)

    Let candidate be the fallback resource specified for the opportunistic caching namespace in question. If multiple application caches match, the user agent must use the fallback of the most appropriate application cache of those that match.

    If candidate is not marked as foreign, then the user agent must discard the failed load and instead continue along these steps using candidate as the resource.

    For the purposes of session history (and features that depend on session history, e.g. bookmarking) the user agent must use the URL of the resource that was requested (the one that matched the opportunistic caching namespace), not the fallback resource. However, the user agent may indicate to the user that the original page load failed, that the page used was a fallback resource, and what the URL of the fallback resource actually is.

    その他の場合

    Once the download is complete, if there were no errors and the user didn't cancel the request, the user agent must cache the resource in all the application caches that have a matching opportunistic caching namespace, categorized as opportunistically cached entries. Meanwhile, the user must continue along these steps.

  9. If the document's out-of-band metadata (e.g. HTTP headers), not counting any type information (such as the Content-Type HTTP header), requires some sort of processing that will not affect the browsing context, then perform that processing and abort these steps.

    Such processing might be triggered by, amongst other things, the following:

    • HTTP status codes (e.g. 204 No Content or 205 Reset Content)
    • HTTP Content-Disposition headers
    • Network errors
  10. Let type be the sniffed type of the resource.

  11. If the user agent has been configured to process resources of the given type using some mechanism other than rendering the content in a browsing context, then skip this step. Otherwise, if the type is one of the following types, jump to the appropriate entry in the following list, and process the resource as described there:

    "text/html"
    Follow the steps given in the HTML document section, and abort these steps.
    Any type ending in "+xml"
    "application/xml"
    "text/xml"
    Follow the steps given in the XML document section. If that section determines that the content is not to be displayed as a generic XML document, then proceed to the next step in this overall set of steps. Otherwise, abort these steps.
    "text/plain"
    Follow the steps given in the plain text file section, and abort these steps.
    A supported image type
    Follow the steps given in the image section, and abort these steps.
    A type that will use an external application to render the content in the browsing context
    Follow the steps given in the plugin section, and abort these steps.
  12. Otherwise, the document's type is such that the resource will not affect the browsing context, e.g. because the resource is to be handed to an external application. Process the resource appropriately.

Some of the sections below, to which the above algorithm defers in certain cases, require the user agent to update the session history with the new page. When a user agent is required to do this, it must follows the set of steps given below that is appropriate for the situation at hand. From the point of view of any script, these steps must occur atomically.

  1. pause for scripts -- but don't use the "pause" definition since that involves not running script!

  2. onbeforeunload, and if present set flag that we will kill document

  3. onunload, and if present set flag that we will kill document

  4. if flag is set: discard the Document

  5. If the navigation was initiated for entry update of an entry
    1. Replace the entry being updated with a new entry representing the new resource and its Document object and related state. The user agent may propagate state from the old entry to the new entry (e.g. scroll position).

    2. Traverse the history to the new entry.

    その他の場合
    1. Remove all the entries after the current entry in the browsing context's Document object's History object.

      This doesn't necessarily have to affect the user agent's user interface.

    2. Append a new entry at the end of the History object representing the new resource and its Document object and related state.

    3. Traverse the history to the new entry.

    4. If the navigation was initiated with replacement enabled, remove the entry immediately before the new current entry in the session history.

5.9.2 Page load processing model for HTML files

HTML 文書が閲覧文脈に読み込まれるとき、 利用者エージェントは、 Document オブジェクトを作成し、 それに HTML 文書であるとの印を付け、HTML 構文解析器を作成し、 これをその文書と関連付け、 その文書に対して提供されたバイト列を構文解析器の入力ストリームとして使い始めなければなりません

入力ストリームはバイト列を文字列に変換し、 字句化器で使用できるようにします。この過程は、部分的に、 資源の実際の Content-Type メタデータに現れる文字符号化情報に依存しています。 ここでは「探知型」は使用しません。

それ以上のバイトが存在しなくなると、暗黙の EOF 文字の存在が仮定され、 それによって load 事象が発火されることとなります。

Document オブジェクトが作成された後に、 頁が構文解析を完了される前でも構いませんが、 利用者エージェントは、新しい頁によりセッション履歴を更新しなければなりません

アプリケーション・キャッシュの選択HTML 構文解析器の中で起こります。

5.9.3 Page load processing model for XML files

利用者エージェントは、 XML ファイルを行内で表示することになったとき、 まず Document オブジェクトを XML と XML 名前空間の勧告、 RFC 3023、DOM3 中核、その他関連する仕様書に従って作成しなければなりません[XML] [XMLNS] [RFC3023] [DOM3CORE]

The actual HTTP headers and other metadata, not the headers as mutated or implied by the algorithms given in this specification, are the ones that must be used when determining the character encoding according to the rules given in the above specifications. Once the character encoding is established, the document's character encoding must be set to that character encoding.

If the root element, as parsed according to the XML specifications cited above, is found to be an html element with an attribute manifest, then, as soon as the element is inserted into the DOM, the user agent must resolve the value of that attribute, and if that is successful, must run the application cache selection algorithm with the resulting absolute URL as the manifest URL. Otherwise, if the attribute is absent or resolving it fails, then as soon as the root element is inserted into the DOM, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm with no manifest.

Because the processing of the manifest attribute happens only once the root element is parsed, any URLs referenced by processing instructions before the root element (such as <?xml-styleesheet?> and <?xbl?> PIs) will be fetched from the network and cannot be cached.

User agents may examine the namespace of the root Element node of this Document object to perform namespace-based dispatch to alternative processing tools, e.g. determining that the content is actually a syndication feed and passing it to a feed handler. If such processing is to take place, abort the steps in this section, and jump to the next step (labeled "non-document content") in the navigate steps above.

そうでない場合には、利用者エージェントは、新たに作成された Document によって、 新しい頁によりセッション履歴を更新しなければなりません。 利用者エージェントは、これを文書全体が構文解析される前に行って (逐次的レンダリングを実現して) も構いません

構文解析過程の誤りメッセージ (例えば名前空間整形式性誤り) は Document を変異させることによって行内で報告して構いません

5.9.4 Page load processing model for text files

When a plain text document is to be loaded in a browsing context, the user agent should create a Document object, mark it as being an HTML document, create an HTML parser, associate it with the document, act as if the tokeniser had emitted a start tag token with the tag name "pre", set the tokenization stage's content model flag to PLAINTEXT, and begin to pass the stream of characters in the plain text document to that tokeniser.

The rules for how to convert the bytes of the plain text document into actual characters are defined in RFC 2046, RFC 2646, and subsequent versions thereof. [RFC2046] [RFC2646]

The document's character encoding must be set to the character encoding used to decode the document.

Upon creation of the Document object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm with no manifest.

When no more character are available, an EOF character is implied, which eventually causes a load event to be fired.

Document オブジェクトが作成された後に、 頁が構文解析を完了される前でも構いませんが、 利用者エージェントは、新しい頁によりセッション履歴を更新しなければなりません

User agents may add content to the head element of the Document, e.g. linking to stylesheet or an XBL binding, providing script, giving the document a title, etc.

5.9.5 Page load processing model for images

When an image resource is to be loaded in a browsing context, the user agent should create a Document object, mark it as being an HTML document, append an html element to the Document, append a head element and a body element to the html element, append an img to the body element, and set the src attribute of the img element to the address of the image.

Then, the user agent must act as if it had stopped parsing.

Upon creation of the Document object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm with no manifest.

After creating the Document object, but potentially before the page has finished fully loading, the user agent must update the session history with the new page.

User agents may add content to the head element of the Document, or attributes to the img element, e.g. to link to stylesheet or an XBL binding, to provide a script, to give the document a title, etc.

5.9.6 Page load processing model for content that uses plugins

When a resource that requires an external resource to be rendered is to be loaded in a browsing context, the user agent should create a Document object, mark it as being an HTML document, append an html element to the Document, append a head element and a body element to the html element, append an embed to the body element, and set the src attribute of the embed element to the address of the resource.

Then, the user agent must act as if it had stopped parsing.

Upon creation of the Document object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm with no manifest.

After creating the Document object, but potentially before the page has finished fully loading, the user agent must update the session history with the new page.

User agents may add content to the head element of the Document, or attributes to the embed element, e.g. to link to stylesheet or an XBL binding, or to give the document a title.

If the sandboxed plugins browsing context flag is set on the browsing context, the synthesized embed element will fail to render the content.

5.9.7 Page load processing model for inline content that doesn't have a DOM

When the user agent is to display a user agent page inline in a browsing context, the user agent should create a Document object, mark it as being an HTML document, and then either associate that Document with a custom rendering that is not rendered using the normal Document rendering rules, or mutate that Document until it represents the content the user agent wants to render.

Once the page has been set up, the user agent must act as if it had stopped parsing.

Upon creation of the Document object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm with no manifest.

After creating the Document object, but potentially before the page has been completely set up, the user agent must update the session history with the new page.

5.9.8 Navigating to a fragment identifier

When a user agent is supposed to navigate to a fragment identifier, then the user agent must update the session history with the new page, where "the new page" has the same Document as before but with the URL having the newly specified fragment identifier.

Part of that algorithm involves the user agent having to scroll to the fragment identifier, which is the important part for this step.

When the user agent is required to scroll to the fragment identifier, it must change the scrolling position of the document, or perform some other action, such that the indicated part of the document is brought to the user's attention. If there is no indicated part, then the user agent must not scroll anywhere.

The indicated part of the document is the one that the fragment identifier, if any, identifies. The semantics of the fragment identifier in terms of mapping it to a specific DOM Node is defined by the MIME type specification of the document's MIME Type (for example, the processing of fragment identifiers for XML MIME types is the responsibility of RFC3023).

For HTML documents (and the text/html MIME type), the following processing model must be followed to determine what the indicated part of the document is.

  1. Parse the URL, and let fragid be the <fragment> component of the URL.

  2. If fragid is the empty string, then the indicated part of the document is the top of the document.

  3. If there is an element in the DOM that has an ID exactly equal to fragid, then the first such element in tree order is the indicated part of the document; stop the algorithm here.

  4. If there is an a element in the DOM that has a name attribute whose value is exactly equal to fragid, then the first such element in tree order is the indicated part of the document; stop the algorithm here.

  5. Otherwise, there is no indicated part of the document.

For the purposes of the interaction of HTML with Selectors' :target pseudo-class, the target element is the indicated part of the document, if that is an element; otherwise there is no target element. [SELECTORS]

5.9.9 History traversal

When a user agent is required to traverse the history to a specified entry, the user agent must act as follows:

  1. If there is no longer a Document object for the entry in question, the user agent must navigate the browsing context to the location for that entry to perform an entry update of that entry, and abort these steps. The "navigate" algorithm reinvokes this "traverse" algorithm to complete the traversal, at which point there is a Document object and so this step gets skipped. The navigation must be done using the same source browsing context as was used the first time this entry was created.

  2. If appropriate, update the current entry in the browsing context's Document object's History object to reflect any state that the user agent wishes to persist.

    For example, some user agents might want to persist the scroll position, or the values of form controls.

  3. If the specified entry has a different Document object than the current entry then the user agent must run the following substeps:

    1. freeze any timers, intervals, XMLHttpRequests, database transactions, etc
    2. The user agent must move any properties that have been added to the browsing context's default view's Window object to the active document's Document's list of added properties.
    3. If the browsing context is a top-level browsing context (and not an auxiliary browsing context), and the origin of the Document of the specified entry is not the same as the origin of the Document of the current entry, then the following sub-sub-steps must be run:
      1. The current browsing context name must be stored with all the entries in the history that are associated with Document objects with the same origin as the active document and that are contiguous with the current entry.
      2. The browsing context's browsing context name must be unset.
    4. The user agent must make the specified entry's Document object the active document of the browsing context. (If it is a top-level browsing context, this might change which application cache it is associated with.)
    5. If the specified entry has a browsing context name stored with it, then the following sub-sub-steps must be run:
      1. The browsing context's browsing context name must be set to the name stored with the specified entry.
      2. Any browsing context name stored with the entries in the history that are associated with Document objects with the same origin as the new active document, and that are contiguous with the specified entry, must be cleared.
    6. The user agent must move any properties that have been added to the active document's Document's list of added properties to browsing context's default view's Window object.
    7. unfreeze any timers, intervals, XMLHttpRequests, database transactions, etc
  4. If there are any entries with state objects between the last activated entry for the Document of the specified entry and the specified entry itself (not inclusive), then the user agent must iterate through every entry between that last activated entry and the specified entry, starting with the entry closest to the current entry, and ending with the one closest to the specified entry. For each entry, if the entry is a state object, the user agent must activate the state object.

  5. If the specified entry is a state object or the first entry for a Document, the user agent must activate that entry.

  6. If the specified entry has a URL that differs from the current entry's only by its fragment identifier, and the two share the same Document object, then fire a simple event with the name hashchange at the body element, and, if the new URL has a fragment identifier, scroll to the fragment identifier.

  7. User agents may also update other aspects of the document view when the location changes in this way, for instance the scroll position, values of form fields, etc.

  8. The current entry is now the specified entry.

how does the changing of the global attributes affect .watch() when seen from other Windows?

5.9.10 Closing a browsing context

Closing a browsing context and discarding it (vs closing it and keeping it around in memory).

when a browsing context is closed, all session history entries' Document objects must be discarded.

When a user agent is to discard a Document, any frozen timers, intervals, XMLHttpRequests, database transactions, etc, must be killed, and any MessagePorts owned by the Window object must be unentangled.

Also, unload events should fire.

5.10 Structured client-side storage

5.10.1 Storing name/value pairs

5.10.1.1. はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

This specification introduces two related mechanisms, similar to HTTP session cookies, for storing structured data on the client side. [RFC2109] [RFC2965]

The first is designed for scenarios where the user is carrying out a single transaction, but could be carrying out multiple transactions in different windows at the same time.

Cookies don't really handle this case well. For example, a user could be buying plane tickets in two different windows, using the same site. If the site used cookies to keep track of which ticket the user was buying, then as the user clicked from page to page in both windows, the ticket currently being purchased would "leak" from one window to the other, potentially causing the user to buy two tickets for the same flight without really noticing.

To address this, this specification introduces the sessionStorage DOM attribute. Sites can add data to the session storage, and it will be accessible to any page from the same site opened in that window.

For example, a page could have a checkbox that the user ticks to indicate that he wants insurance:

<label>
 <input type="checkbox" onchange="sessionStorage.insurance = checked">
 I want insurance on this trip.
</label>

A later page could then check, from script, whether the user had checked the checkbox or not:

if (sessionStorage.insurance) { ... }

If the user had multiple windows opened on the site, each one would have its own individual copy of the session storage object.

The second storage mechanism is designed for storage that spans multiple windows, and lasts beyond the current session. In particular, Web applications may wish to store megabytes of user data, such as entire user-authored documents or a user's mailbox, on the client side for performance reasons.

Again, cookies do not handle this case well, because they are transmitted with every request.

The localStorage DOM attribute is used to access a page's local storage area.

The site at example.com can display a count of how many times the user has loaded its page by putting the following at the bottom of its page:

<p>
  You have viewed this page
  <span id="count">an untold number of</span>
  time(s).
</p>
<script>
  if (!localStorage.pageLoadCount)
    localStorage.pageLoadCount = 0;
  localStorage.pageLoadCount = parseInt(localStorage.pageLoadCount, 10) + 1;
  document.getElementById('count').textContent = localStorage.pageLoadCount;
</script>

Each site has its own separate storage area.

Storage areas (both session storage and local storage) store strings. To store structured data in a storage area, you must first convert it to a string.

5.10.1.2. Storage 界面
interface Storage {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] DOMString key(in unsigned long index);
  [NameGetter] DOMString getItem(in DOMString key);
  [NameSetter] void setItem(in DOMString key, in DOMString data);
  [XXX] void removeItem(in DOMString key); 
  void clear();
};

Each Storage object provides access to a list of key/value pairs, which are sometimes called items. Keys and values are strings. Any string (including the empty string) is a valid key.

To store more structured data, authors may consider using the SQL interfaces instead.

Each Storage object is associated with a list of key/value pairs when it is created, as defined in the sections on the sessionStorage and localStorage attributes. Multiple separate objects implementing the Storage interface can all be associated with the same list of key/value pairs simultaneously.

The length attribute must return the number of key/value pairs currently present in the list associated with the object.

The key(n) method must return the name of the nth key in the list. The order of keys is user-agent defined, but must be consistent within an object between changes to the number of keys. (Thus, adding or removing a key may change the order of the keys, but merely changing the value of an existing key must not.) If n is less than zero or greater than or equal to the number of key/value pairs in the object, then this method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

The getItem(key) method must return the current value associated with the given key. If the given key does not exist in the list associated with the object then this method must return null.

The setItem(key, value) method must first check if a key/value pair with the given key already exists in the list associated with the object.

If it does not, then a new key/value pair must be added to the list, with the given key and value.

If the given key does exist in the list, then it must have its value updated to the value given in the value argument.

If it couldn't set the new value, the method must raise an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception. (Setting could fail if, e.g., the user has disabled storage for the domain, or if the quota has been exceeded.)

The removeItem(key) method must cause the key/value pair with the given key to be removed from the list associated with the object, if it exists. If no item with that key exists, the method must do nothing.

The setItem() and removeItem() methods must be atomic with respect to failure. That is, changes to the data storage area must either be successful, or the data storage area must not be changed at all.

The clear() method must atomically cause the list associated with the object to be emptied of all key/value pairs.

When the setItem(), removeItem(), and clear() methods are invoked, events are fired on other HTMLDocument objects that can access the newly stored or removed data, as defined in the sections on the sessionStorage and localStorage attributes.

5.10.1.3. sessionStorage 属性

The sessionStorage attribute represents the set of storage areas specific to the current top-level browsing context.

Each top-level browsing context has a unique set of session storage areas, one for each origin.

User agents should not expire data from a browsing context's session storage areas, but may do so when the user requests that such data be deleted, or when the UA detects that it has limited storage space, or for security reasons. User agents should always avoid deleting data while a script that could access that data is running. When a top-level browsing context is destroyed (and therefore permanently inaccessible to the user) the data stored in its session storage areas can be discarded with it, as the API described in this specification provides no way for that data to ever be subsequently retrieved.

The lifetime of a browsing context can be unrelated to the lifetime of the actual user agent process itself, as the user agent may support resuming sessions after a restart.

When a new HTMLDocument is created, the user agent must check to see if the document's top-level browsing context has allocated a session storage area for that document's origin. If it has not, a new storage area for that document's origin must be created.

The Storage object for the document's associated Window object's sessionStorage attribute must then be associated with that origin's session storage area for that top-level browsing context.

When a new top-level browsing context is created by cloning an existing browsing context, the new browsing context must start with the same session storage areas as the original, but the two sets must from that point on be considered separate, not affecting each other in any way.

When a new top-level browsing context is created by a script in an existing browsing context, or by the user following a link in an existing browsing context, or in some other way related to a specific HTMLDocument, then the session storage area of the origin of that HTMLDocument must be copied into the new browsing context when it is created. From that point on, however, the two session storage areas must be considered separate, not affecting each other in any way.

When the setItem(), removeItem(), and clear() methods are called on a Storage object x that is associated with a session storage area, then in every HTMLDocument object whose Window object's sessionStorage attribute's Storage object is associated with the same storage area, other than x, a storage event must be fired, as described below.

5.10.1.4. localStorage 属性

The localStorage object provides a Storage object for an origin.

User agents must have a set of local storage areas, one for each origin.

User agents should expire data from the local storage areas only for security reasons or when requested to do so by the user. User agents should always avoid deleting data while a script that could access that data is running. Data stored in local storage areas should be considered potentially user-critical. It is expected that Web applications will use the local storage areas for storing user-written documents.

When the localStorage attribute is accessed, the user agent must check to see if it has allocated local storage area for the for the origin of the active document of the browsing context of the Window object on which the method was invoked. If it has not, a new storage area for that origin must be created.

The user agent must then create a Storage object associated with that origin's local storage area, and return it.

When the setItem(), removeItem(), and clear() methods are called on a Storage object x that is associated with a local storage area, then in every HTMLDocument object whose Window object's localStorage attribute's Storage object is associated with the same storage area, other than x, a storage event must be fired, as described below.

5.10.1.5. storage 事象

storage 事象は、 HTMLDocument において、ストレージ領域が変化した時に。前の2つの節 (セッション・ストレージ対象局所ストレージ対象) で説明したように発火されます。

利用者エージェントは、これが起こる時、名前 storage、 名前空間なし、 泡立たず取消し可能で StorageEvent を使った事象を、関係する活性 HTMLDocument オブジェクトそれぞれの文書 body 要素に対して発送しなければなりません

If the event is being fired due to an invocation of the setItem() or removeItem() methods, the event must have its key attribute set to the name of the key in question, its oldValue attribute set to the old value of the key in question, or null if the key is newly added, and its newValue attribute set to the new value of the key in question, or null if the key was removed.

Otherwise, if the event is being fired due to an invocation of the clear() method, the event must have its key, oldValue, and newValue attributes set to null.

In addition, the event must have its url attribute set to the address of the page whose Storage object was affected, and its source attribute set to the Window object of the browsing context that that document is in, if the two documents are in the same unit of related browsing contexts, or null otherwise.

5.10.1.5.1. 事象定義
interface StorageEvent : Event {
  readonly attribute DOMString key;
  readonly attribute DOMString oldValue;
  readonly attribute DOMString newValue;
  readonly attribute DOMString url;
  readonly attribute Window source;
  void initStorageEvent(in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMString keyArg, in DOMString oldValueArg, in DOMString newValueArg, in DOMString urlArg, in Window sourceArg);
  void initStorageEventNS(in DOMString namespaceURI, in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMString keyArg, in DOMString oldValueArg, in DOMString newValueArg, in DOMString urlArg, in Window sourceArg);
};

initStorageEvent() メソッドと initMessageEventNS() メソッドは、 DOM3 事象界面の似たような名前のメソッドと同じような方法で事象を初期化しなければなりません[DOM3EVENTS]

key 属性は、変化する鍵を表します。

oldValue 属性は、変化する鍵の古い値を表します。

newValue 属性は、変化する鍵の新しい値を表します。

url 属性は、鍵を変更した文書の番地を表します。

source 属性は、 鍵を変更した Window を表します。

5.10.1.6. スレッド

複数の閲覧文脈は、局所ストレージ領域に同時に予測可能な方法でアクセスできなければなりません。 スクリプトが並行スクリプト実行を検知可能であってはなりません

これは Storage オブジェクトの length 属性があるスクリプトの実行中にスクリプト自体が予期可能な形以外で決して代わらないことを保証するために要求されます。

There are various ways of implementing this requirement. One is to just have one event loop for all browsing contexts. Another is that if a script running in one browsing context accesses a storage area, the user agent blocks scripts in other browsing contexts when they try to access the same storage area until the event loop running the first script has completed running the task that started that script. Another (potentially more efficient but certainly more complex) implementation strategy is to use optimistic transactional script execution. This specification does not require any particular implementation strategy, so long as the requirement above is met.

5.10.2 データベース・ストレージ

5.10.2.1. はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

...

5.10.2.2. データベース

起源は、それに関連付けられたデータベースの集合を持ちます。 各データベースは、名前と現在の版を持ちます。 この API を使ってあるドメインに利用可能なデータベースを列挙したり、 削除したりする方法はありません。

各データベースはある時点で1つの版を持ち、 1つのデータベースの複数の版が同時に存在することはできません。 版は著者がスキーマの変更を随時、非破壊的に、 かつ古い符号 (例えば他のブラウザ窓中のもの) が誤った仮定の下でデータベースに書き込もうとする危険なしで行えるようにすることを意図したものです。

openDatabase() メソッドは Database オブジェクトを返します。 このメソッドは、データベース名、データベース版、 表示名、データベース中に蓄積されるデータの大きさの見積もり (バイト単位) の4つの引数を取ります。

openDatabase() メソッドは、それが呼び出された Window オブジェクトの閲覧文脈活性文書起源からのデータベースを使用・作成しなければなりません

指定されたデータベースの版が空文字列でない場合で、 データベースが既に存在し、 異なる版を持つ場合、 メソッドは INVALID_STATE_ERR 例外を発生させなければなりません

利用者エージェントは、要求が方針決定に反する場合 (例えば、頁がデータベースを開くことを認めないように利用者エージェントが設定されている場合) 、 保安性例外を発生させても構いません

そうでない場合、指定されたデータベースの版が空文字列の場合、 またはデータベースがまだ存在しない場合、 またはデータベースが存在し、 openDatabase() メソッドに指定されて版がデータベースに関連付けられている現在の版と同じである場合には、 メソッドは、指定された名前を持つデータベースを表す Database オブジェクトを返さなければなりません。 そのようなデータベースが存在しない場合、 まずそれを作らなければなりません

空文字列を含むすべての文字列は妥当なデータベース名です。 データベース名は大文字・小文字を区別した形で比較しなければなりません

実装は、すべての文字列の部分集合をデータベース名として扱う環境であっても、 データベース名を対応している名前の集合に写像する (例えばハッシュ算法を使う) ことにより、これに対応することができます。

利用者エージェントに対しては、表示名とデータベースの大きさの見積もりを、 利用者の体験の最適化のために使うことを期待しています。 例えば、利用者エージェントは、利用者に対して最初の割当量を提示するために大きさの見積もりを使うことができます。 それによって、はじめから数百メガバイトを使うであろうことがわかっているサイトがそれを予め宣言しておけば、 利用者エージェントは5メガバイト毎に割当量を増やすかどうかを利用者に問わなくてもよくなります。

interface Database {
  void transaction(in SQLTransactionCallback callback);
  void transaction(in SQLTransactionCallback callback, in SQLTransactionErrorCallback errorCallback);
  void transaction(in SQLTransactionCallback callback, in SQLTransactionErrorCallback errorCallback, in VoidCallback successCallback);

  readonly attribute DOMString version;
  void changeVersion(in DOMString oldVersion, in DOMString newVersion, in SQLTransactionCallback callback, in SQLTransactionErrorCallback errorCallback, in VoidCallback successCallback);
};

interface SQLTransactionCallback {
  void handleEvent(in SQLTransaction transaction);
};

interface SQLTransactionErrorCallback {
  void handleEvent(in SQLError error);
};

transaction() メソッドは1つか2つの引数を取ります。 このメソッドは、呼び出された時、 すぐに返り、それから非同期に、 取引呼び戻しを最初の引数とし、 誤り呼び戻しを2つ目の引数があればそれとし、 成功呼び戻しを3つ目の引数があればそれとし、 飛行前操作飛行後操作はなしとして、 取引段階を走らせなければなりません

The version that the database was opened with is the expected version of this Database object. It can be the empty string, in which case there is no expected version — any version is fine.

On getting, the version attribute must return the current version of the database (as opposed to the expected version of the Database object).

The changeVersion() method allows scripts to atomically verify the version number and change it at the same time as doing a schema update. When the method is invoked, it must immediately return, and then asynchronously run the transaction steps with the transaction callback being the third argument, the error callback being the fourth argument, the success callback being the fifth argument, the preflight operation being the following:

  1. Check that the value of the first argument to the changeVersion() method exactly matches the database's actual version. If it does not, then the preflight operation fails.

...and the postflight operation being the following:

  1. Change the database's actual version to the value of the second argument to the changeVersion() method.
  2. Change the Database object's expected version to the value of the second argument to the changeVersion() method.
5.10.2.3. Executing SQL statements

The transaction() and changeVersion() methods invoke callbacks with SQLTransaction objects.

typedef sequence<Object> ObjectArray;

interface SQLTransaction {
  void executeSql(in DOMString sqlStatement);
  void executeSql(in DOMString sqlStatement, in ObjectArray arguments);
  void executeSql(in DOMString sqlStatement, in ObjectArray arguments, in SQLStatementCallback callback);
  void executeSql(in DOMString sqlStatement, in ObjectArray arguments, in SQLStatementCallback callback, in SQLStatementErrorCallback errorCallback);
};

interface SQLStatementCallback {
  void handleEvent(in SQLTransaction transaction, in SQLResultSet resultSet);
};

interface SQLStatementErrorCallback {
  boolean handleEvent(in SQLTransaction transaction, in SQLError error);Or should these arguments be the other way around? Either way we're inconsistent with _something_. What should we be consistent with?
};

When the executeSql(sqlStatement, arguments, callback, errorCallback) method is invoked, the user agent must run the following algorithm. (This algorithm is relatively simple and doesn't actually execute any SQL — the bulk of the work is actually done as part of the transaction steps.)

  1. If the method was not invoked during the execution of a SQLTransactionCallback, SQLStatementCallback, or SQLStatementErrorCallback then raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception. (Calls from inside a SQLTransactionErrorCallback thus raise an exception. The SQLTransactionErrorCallback handler is only called once a transaction has failed, and no SQL statements can be added to a failed transaction.)

  2. Parse the first argument to the method (sqlStatement) as an SQL statement, with the exception that ? characters can be used in place of literals in the statement. [SQL]

  3. Replace each ? placeholder with the value of the argument in the arguments array with the same position. (So the first ? placeholder gets replaced by the first value in the arguments array, and generally the nth ? placeholder gets replaced by the nth value in the arguments array.)

    If the second argument is omitted or null, then treat the arguments array as empty.

    The result is the statement.

    Implementation feedback is requested on what to do with arguments that are of types that are not supported by the underlying SQL backend. For example, SQLite doesn't support booleans, so what should the UA do if passed a boolean? The Gears team suggests failing, not silently converting types.

  4. If the syntax of sqlStatement is not valid (except for the use of ? characters in the place of literals), or the statement uses features that are not supported (e.g. due to security reasons), or the number of items in the arguments array is not equal to the number of ? placeholders in the statement, or the statement cannot be parsed for some other reason, then mark the statement as bogus.

  5. If the Database object that the SQLTransaction object was created from has an expected version that is neither the empty string nor the actual version of the database, then mark the statement as bogus. (Error code 2.)

  6. Queue up the statement in the transaction, along with the third argument (if any) as the statement's result set callback and the fourth argument (if any) as the error callback.

The user agent must act as if the database was hosted in an otherwise completely empty environment with no resources. For example, attempts to read from or write to the file system will fail.

SQL inherently supports multiple concurrent connections. Authors should make appropriate use of the transaction features to handle the case of multiple scripts interacting with the same database simultaneously (as could happen if the same page was opened in two different browsing contexts).

User agents must consider statements that use the BEGIN, COMMIT, and ROLLBACK SQL features as being unsupported (and thus will mark them as bogus), so as to not let these statements interfere with the explicit transactions managed by the database API itself.

A future version of this specification will probably define the exact SQL subset required in more detail.

5.10.2.4. Database query results

The executeSql() method invokes its callback with a SQLResultSet object as an argument.

interface SQLResultSet {
  readonly attribute int insertId;
  readonly attribute int rowsAffected;
  readonly attribute SQLResultSetRowList rows;
};

The insertId attribute must return the row ID of the row that the SQLResultSet object's SQL statement inserted into the database, if the statement inserted a row. If the statement inserted multiple rows, the ID of the last row must be the one returned. If the statement did not insert a row, then the attribute must instead raise an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception.

The rowsAffected attribute must return the number of rows that were affected by the SQL statement. If the statement did not affected any rows, then the attribute must return zero. For "SELECT" statements, this returns zero (querying the database doesn't affect any rows).

The rows attribute must return a SQLResultSetRowList representing the rows returned, in the order returned by the database. If no rows were returned, then the object will be empty (its length will be zero).

interface SQLResultSetRowList {
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  [IndexGetter] DOMObject item(in unsigned long index);
};

SQLResultSetRowList objects have a length attribute that must return the number of rows it represents (the number of rows returned by the database).

The item(index) attribute must return the row with the given index index. If there is no such row, then the method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception.

Each row must be represented by a native ordered dictionary data type. In the ECMAScript binding, this must be Object. Each row object must have one property (or dictionary entry) per column, with those properties enumerating in the order that these columns were returned by the database. Each property must have the name of the column and the value of the cell, as they were returned by the database.

5.10.2.5. Errors

Errors in the database API are reported using callbacks that have a SQLError object as one of their arguments.

interface SQLError {
  readonly attribute unsigned int code;
  readonly attribute DOMString message;
};

The code DOM attribute must return the most appropriate code from the following table:
Code Situation
0 The transaction failed for reasons unrelated to the database itself and not covered by any other error code.
1 The statement failed for database reasons not covered by any other error code.
2 The statement failed because the expected version of the database didn't match the actual database version.
3 The statement failed because the data returned from the database was too large. The SQL "LIMIT" modifier might be useful to reduce the size of the result set.
4 The statement failed because there was not enough remaining storage space, or the storage quota was reached and the user declined to give more space to the database.
5 The statement failed because the transaction's first statement was a read-only statement, and a subsequent statement in the same transaction tried to modify the database, but the transaction failed to obtain a write lock before another transaction obtained a write lock and changed a part of the database that the former transaction was depending upon.
6 An INSERT, UPDATE, or REPLACE statement failed due to a constraint failure. For example, because a row was being inserted and the value given for the primary key column duplicated the value of an existing row.

We should define a more thorough list of codes. Implementation feedback is requested to determine what codes are needed.

The message DOM attribute must return an error message describing the error encountered. The message should be localized to the user's language.

5.10.2.6. 処理モデル

The transaction steps are as follows. These steps must be run asynchronously. These steps are invoked with a transaction callback, optionally an error callback, optionally a success callback, optionally a preflight operation, and optionally a postflight operation.

  1. Open a new SQL transaction to the database, and create a SQLTransaction object that represents that transaction.

  2. If an error occurred in the opening of the transaction, jump to the last step.

  3. If a preflight operation was defined for this instance of the transaction steps, run that. If it fails, then jump to the last step. (This is basically a hook for the changeVersion() method.)

  4. Queue a task to invoke the transaction callback with the aforementioned SQLTransaction object as its only argument, and wait for that task to be run.

  5. If the callback couldn't be called (e.g. it was null), or if the callback was invoked and raised an exception, jump to the last step.

  6. While there are any statements queued up in the transaction, perform the following steps for each queued up statement in the transaction, oldest first. Each statement has a statement, optionally a result set callback, and optionally an error callback.

    1. If the statement is marked as bogus, jump to the "in case of error" steps below.

    2. Execute the statement in the context of the transaction. [SQL]

    3. If the statement failed, jump to the "in case of error" steps below.

    4. Create a SQLResultSet object that represents the result of the statement.

    5. If the statement has a result set callback, queue a task to invoke it with the SQLTransaction object as its first argument and the new SQLResultSet object as its second argument, and wait for that task to be run.

    6. If the callback was invoked and raised an exception, jump to the last step in the overall steps.

    7. Move on to the next statement, if any, or onto the next overall step otherwise.

    In case of error (or more specifically, if the above substeps say to jump to the "in case of error" steps), run the following substeps:

    1. If the statement had an associated error callback, then queue a task to invoke that error callback with the SQLTransaction object and a newly constructed SQLError object that represents the error that caused these substeps to be run as the two arguments, respectively, and wait for the task to be run.

    2. If the error callback returns false, then move on to the next statement, if any, or onto the next overall step otherwise.

    3. Otherwise, the error callback did not return false, or there was no error callback. Jump to the last step in the overall steps.

  7. If a postflight operation was defined for this instance of the transaction steps, run that. If it fails, then jump to the last step. (This is basically a hook for the changeVersion() method.)

  8. Commit the transaction.

  9. If an error occurred in the committing of the transaction, jump to the last step.

  10. Queue a task to invoke the success callback.

  11. End these steps. The next step is only used when something goes wrong.

  12. Queue a task to invoke the error callback with a newly constructed SQLError object that represents the last error to have occurred in this transaction. Rollback the transaction. Any still-pending statements in the transaction are discarded.

5.10.3 Disk space

User agents should limit the total amount of space allowed for storage areas and databases.

User agents should guard against sites storing data in the storage areas or databases of subdomains, e.g. storing up to the limit in a1.example.com, a2.example.com, a3.example.com, etc, circumventing the main example.com storage limit.

User agents may prompt the user when quotas are reached, allowing the user to grant a site more space. This enables sites to store many user-created documents on the user's computer, for instance.

User agents should allow users to see how much space each domain is using.

A mostly arbitrary limit of five megabytes per domain is recommended. Implementation feedback is welcome and will be used to update this suggestion in future.

5.10.4 Privacy

5.10.4.1. User tracking

A third-party advertiser (or any entity capable of getting content distributed to multiple sites) could use a unique identifier stored in its local storage area or in its client-side database to track a user across multiple sessions, building a profile of the user's interests to allow for highly targeted advertising. In conjunction with a site that is aware of the user's real identity (for example an e-commerce site that requires authenticated credentials), this could allow oppressive groups to target individuals with greater accuracy than in a world with purely anonymous Web usage.

There are a number of techniques that can be used to mitigate the risk of user tracking:

While these suggestions prevent trivial use of these APIs for user tracking, they do not block it altogether. Within a single domain, a site can continue to track the user during a session, and can then pass all this information to the third party along with any identifying information (names, credit card numbers, addresses) obtained by the site. If a third party cooperates with multiple sites to obtain such information, a profile can still be created.

However, user tracking is to some extent possible even with no cooperation from the user agent whatsoever, for instance by using session identifiers in URLs, a technique already commonly used for innocuous purposes but easily repurposed for user tracking (even retroactively). This information can then be shared with other sites, using using visitors' IP addresses and other user-specific data (e.g. user-agent headers and configuration settings) to combine separate sessions into coherent user profiles.

If the user interface for persistent storage presents data in the persistent storage features separately from data in HTTP session cookies, then users are likely to delete data in one and not the other. This would allow sites to use the two features as redundant backup for each other, defeating a user's attempts to protect his privacy.

5.10.5 保安性

5.10.5.1. DNS spoofing attacks

Because of the potential for DNS spoofing attacks, one cannot guarantee that a host claiming to be in a certain domain really is from that domain. To mitigate this, pages can use SSL. Pages using SSL can be sure that only pages using SSL that have certificates identifying them as being from the same domain can access their local storage areas and databases.

5.10.5.2. Cross-directory attacks

Different authors sharing one host name, for example users hosting content on geocities.com, all share one persistent storage object and one set of databases. There is no feature to restrict the access by pathname. Authors on shared hosts are therefore recommended to avoid using the persistent storage features, as it would be trivial for other authors to read from and write to the same storage area or database.

Even if a path-restriction feature was made available, the usual DOM scripting security model would make it trivial to bypass this protection and access the data from any path.

5.10.5.3. Implementation risks

The two primary risks when implementing these persistent storage features are letting hostile sites read information from other domains, and letting hostile sites write information that is then read from other domains.

Letting third-party sites read data that is not supposed to be read from their domain causes information leakage, For example, a user's shopping wishlist on one domain could be used by another domain for targeted advertising; or a user's work-in-progress confidential documents stored by a word-processing site could be examined by the site of a competing company.

Letting third-party sites write data to the storage areas of other domains can result in information spoofing, which is equally dangerous. For example, a hostile site could add items to a user's wishlist; or a hostile site could set a user's session identifier to a known ID that the hostile site can then use to track the user's actions on the victim site.

Thus, strictly following the origin model described in this specification is important for user security.

5.10.5.4. SQL and user agents

User agent implementors are strongly encouraged to audit all their supported SQL statements for security implications. For example, LOAD DATA INFILE is likely to pose security risks and there is little reason to support it.

In general, it is recommended that user agents not support features that control how databases are stored on disk. For example, there is little reason to allow Web authors to control the character encoding used in the disk representation of the data, as all data in ECMAScript is implicitly UTF-16.

5.10.5.5. SQL injection

Authors are strongly recommended to make use of the ? placeholder feature of the executeSql() method, and to never construct SQL statements on the fly.

The a, area, and link elements can, in certain situations described in the definitions of those elements, represent hyperlinks.

The href attribute on a hyperlink element must have a value that is a valid URL. This URL is the destination resource of the hyperlink.

The href attribute on a and area elements is not required; when those elements do not have href attributes they do not represent hyperlinks.

The href attribute on the link element is required, but whether a link element represents a hyperlink or not depends on the value of the rel attribute of that element.

The target attribute, if present, must be a valid browsing context name or keyword. User agents use this name when following hyperlinks.

The ping attribute, if present, gives the URLs of the resources that are interested in being notified if the user follows the hyperlink. The value must be a space separated list of one or more valid URLs. The value is used by the user agent when following hyperlinks.

For a and area elements that represent hyperlinks, the relationship between the document containing the hyperlink and the destination resource indicated by the hyperlink is given by the value of the element's rel attribute, which must be a set of space-separated tokens. The allowed values and their meanings are defined below. The rel attribute has no default value. If the attribute is omitted or if none of the values in the attribute are recognized by the UA, then the document has no particular relationship with the destination resource other than there being a hyperlink between the two.

The media attribute describes for which media the target document was designed. It is purely advisory. The value must be a valid media query. [MQ] The default, if the media attribute is omitted, is all.

The hreflang attribute on hyperlink elements, if present, gives the language of the linked resource. It is purely advisory. The value must be a valid RFC 3066 language code. [RFC3066] User agents must not consider this attribute authoritative — upon fetching the resource, user agents must use only language information associated with the resource to determine its language, not metadata included in the link to the resource.

The type attribute, if present, gives the MIME type of the linked resource. It is purely advisory. The value must be a valid MIME type, optionally with parameters. [RFC2046] User agents must not consider the type attribute authoritative — upon fetching the resource, user agents must not use metadata included in the link to the resource to determine its type.

5.11.2 Following hyperlinks

When a user follows a hyperlink, the user agent must navigate a browsing context to the URL given by the href attribute of that hyperlink. In the case of server-side image maps, the URL of the hyperlink must further have its hyperlink suffix appended to it.

If the user indicated a specific browsing context when following the hyperlink, or if the user agent is configured to follow hyperlinks by navigating a particular browsing context, then that must be the browsing context that is navigated.

Otherwise, if the hyperlink element is an a or area element that has a target attribute, then the browsing context that is navigated must be chosen by applying the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name, using the value of the target attribute as the browsing context name. If these rules result in the creation of a new browsing context, it must be navigated with replacement enabled.

Otherwise, if the hyperlink element is a sidebar hyperlink and the user agent implements a feature that can be considered a secondary browsing context, such a secondary browsing context may be selected as the browsing context to be navigated.

Otherwise, if the hyperlink element is an a or area element with no target attribute, but one of the child nodes of the head element is a base element with a target attribute, then the browsing context that is navigated must be chosen by applying the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name, using the value of the target attribute of the first such base element as the browsing context name. If these rules result in the creation of a new browsing context, it must be navigated with replacement enabled.

Otherwise, the browsing context that must be navigated is the same browsing context as the one which the hyperlink element itself is in.

The navigation must be done with the browsing context that contains the Document object with which the hyperlink's element in question is associated as the source browsing context.

5.11.2.1. Hyperlink auditing

利用者エージェントは、aarea のハイパーリンク要素が ping 属性を持つ場合で、 利用者が当該ハイパーリンクをたどった場合、ping 属性の値をもってこの文字列を間隔で分割し、 得られた字句のそれぞれを解決しなければならず、 その後、得られた絶対 URL のそれぞれについて要求 (後述) を送信するべきです。 (解決に失敗した字句は無視します。) これは主たる要求と並列に行っても構わず、 主たる要求の結果とは独立したものです。

利用者エージェントは、利用者にこの動作の調整、例えば HTTP Referer 頭部の送信を無効化する設定と組み合わせることを認めるべきです。 利用者エージェントは、利用者の設定に基づき、ping 属性全体を無視するか、または並び中の一部の URL を選択的に無視 (例えば第3者 URL を無視) するかのいずれかを行って構いません

For URLs that are HTTP URLs, the requests must be performed by fetching the specified URLs using the POST method, with an empty entity body in the request. All relevant cookie and HTTP authentication headers must be included in the request. Which other headers are required depends on the URLs involved.

監査されるハイパーリンクと ping URL を含む Document オブジェクトの番地同じ起源の場合
要求は Ping-From HTTP 頭部を、 含んでいる文書の番地を値として含めなければなりません。 要求は Referer HTTP 頭部を含んではなりません
それ以外の場合、起源が異なる場合で、監査されるハイパーリンクを含んでいる文書が暗号化された接続上で取り出された場合
要求は Referer HTTP 頭部 [ママ] をハイパーリンクを含んでいる文書の所在を値として、 Ping-From HTTP 頭部を同じ値として、 Ping-To HTTP 頭部をハイパーリンクの対象の番地を値として、 含めなければなりません
それ以外の場合、起源が異なっており監査されるハイパーリンクが含まれている文書が暗号化された接続上で取り出された場合
要求は Ping-To HTTP 頭部を、ハイパーリンクの対象の番地を値として含めなければなりません。 要求は、 Referer HTTP 頭部を含んでも、 Ping-From HTTP 頭部を含んでもなりません

実装者は、帯域を節約するため、 Accept などの省略可能な頭部をこれらの要求から省くことを検討するといいかもしれません。

User agents must, unless otherwise specified by the user, honor the HTTP headers (including, in particular, redirects and HTTP cookie headers), but must ignore any entity bodies returned in the responses. User agents may close the connection prematurely once they start receiving an entity body. [RFC2109] [RFC2965]

For URLs that are not HTTP URLs, the requests must be performed by fetching the specified URL normally, and discarding the results.

利用者エージェントは、ping 属性が存在する場合、ハイパーリンクをたどると二次要求も背景で送られることになることも、 例えば実際の対象 URL の一覧を含めることにより、明確に示すべきです

ping 属性は、 HTTP リダイレクトや JavaScript で Web 頁がサイト外のリンクのどれが人気が高いかを調べたり、 広告主がクリック通過率を追跡したりできるようにします。

しかし、 ping 属性はこれらの代替案に対して利用者に次のような利点を与えます。

ですから、この機能をなしに利用者を追跡することも可能ですが、 ping 属性を使い、 利用者エージェントが利用者の体験を向上させられるようにすることを著者にはお勧めします。

5.11.3 Link types

The following table summarizes the link types that are defined by this specification. This table is non-normative; the actual definitions for the link types are given in the next few sections.

In this section, the term referenced document refers to the resource identified by the element representing the link, and the term current document refers to the resource within which the element representing the link finds itself.

To determine which link types apply to a link, a, or area element, the element's rel attribute must be split on spaces. The resulting tokens are the link types that apply to that element.

Unless otherwise specified, a keyword must not be specified more than once per rel attribute.
Link type Effect on... Brief description
link a and area
alternate Hyperlink Hyperlink Gives alternate representations of the current document.
archives Hyperlink Hyperlink Provides a link to a collection of records, documents, or other materials of historical interest.
author Hyperlink Hyperlink Gives a link to the current document's author.
bookmark not allowed Hyperlink Gives the permalink for the nearest ancestor section.
external not allowed Hyperlink Indicates that the referenced document is not part of the same site as the current document.
feed Hyperlink Hyperlink Gives the address of a syndication feed for the current document.
first Hyperlink Hyperlink Indicates that the current document is a part of a series, and that the first document in the series is the referenced document.
help Hyperlink Hyperlink Provides a link to context-sensitive help.
icon External Resource not allowed Imports an icon to represent the current document.
index Hyperlink Hyperlink Gives a link to the document that provides a table of contents or index listing the current document.
last Hyperlink Hyperlink Indicates that the current document is a part of a series, and that the last document in the series is the referenced document.
license Hyperlink Hyperlink Indicates that the current document is covered by the copyright license described by the referenced document.
next Hyperlink Hyperlink Indicates that the current document is a part of a series, and that the next document in the series is the referenced document.
nofollow not allowed Hyperlink Indicates that the current document's original author or publisher does not endorse the referenced document.
noreferrer not allowed Hyperlink Requires that the user agent not send an HTTP Referer header if the user follows the hyperlink.
pingback External Resource not allowed Gives the address of the pingback server that handles pingbacks to the current document.
prefetch External Resource not allowed Specifies that the target resource should be preemptively cached.
prev Hyperlink Hyperlink Indicates that the current document is a part of a series, and that the previous document in the series is the referenced document.
search Hyperlink Hyperlink Gives a link to a resource that can be used to search through the current document and its related pages.
stylesheet External Resource not allowed Imports a stylesheet.
sidebar Hyperlink Hyperlink Specifies that the referenced document, if retrieved, is intended to be shown in the browser's sidebar (if it has one).
tag Hyperlink Hyperlink Gives a tag (identified by the given address) that applies to the current document.
up Hyperlink Hyperlink Provides a link to a document giving the context for the current document.

Some of the types described below list synonyms for these values. These are to be handled as specified by user agents, but must not be used in documents.

The alternate keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, if the rel attribute does not also contain the keyword stylesheet, it creates a hyperlink; but if it does also contain the keyword stylesheet, the alternate keyword instead modifies the meaning of the stylesheet keyword in the way described for that keyword, and the rest of this subsection doesn't apply.

The alternate keyword indicates that the referenced document is an alternate representation of the current document.

The nature of the referenced document is given by the media, hreflang, and type attributes.

If the alternate keyword is used with the media attribute, it indicates that the referenced document is intended for use with the media specified.

If the alternate keyword is used with the hreflang attribute, and that attribute's value differs from the root element's language, it indicates that the referenced document is a translation.

If the alternate keyword is used with the type attribute, it indicates that the referenced document is a reformulation of the current document in the specified format.

The media, hreflang, and type attributes can be combined when specified with the alternate keyword.

For example, the following link is a French translation that uses the PDF format:

<link rel=alternate type=application/pdf hreflang=fr href=manual-fr>

If the alternate keyword is used with the type attribute set to the value application/rss+xml or the value application/atom+xml, then the user agent must treat the link as it would if it had the feed keyword specified as well.

The alternate link relationship is transitive — that is, if a document links to two other documents with the link type "alternate", then, in addition to implying that those documents are alternative representations of the first document, it is also implying that those two documents are alternative representations of each other.

The archives keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The archives keyword indicates that the referenced document describes a collection of records, documents, or other materials of historical interest.

A blog's index page could link to an index of the blog's past posts with rel="archives".

Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must also treat the keyword "archive" like the archives keyword.

The author keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

For a and area elements, the author keyword indicates that the referenced document provides further information about the author of the section that the element defining the hyperlink applies to.

For link elements, the author keyword indicates that the referenced document provides further information about the author for the page as a whole.

The "referenced document" can be, and often is, a mailto: URL giving the e-mail address of the author. [MAILTO]

Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must also treat link, a, and area elements that have a rev attribute with the value "made" as having the author keyword specified as a link relationship.

The bookmark keyword may be used with a and area elements.

The bookmark keyword gives a permalink for the nearest ancestor article element of the linking element in question, or of the section the linking element is most closely associated with, if there are no ancestor article elements.

The following snippet has three permalinks. A user agent could determine which permalink applies to which part of the spec by looking at where the permalinks are given.

 ...
 <body>
  <h1>Example of permalinks</h1>
  <div id="a">
   <h2>First example</h2>
   <p><a href="a.html" rel="bookmark">This</a> permalink applies to
   only the content from the first H2 to the second H2. The DIV isn't
   exactly that section, but it roughly corresponds to it.</p>
  </div>
  <h2>Second example</h2>
  <article id="b">
   <p><a href="b.html" rel="bookmark">This</a> permalink applies to
   the outer ARTICLE element (which could be, e.g., a blog post).</p>
   <article id="c">
    <p><a href="c.html" rel="bookmark">This</a> permalink applies to
    the inner ARTICLE element (which could be, e.g., a blog comment).</p>
   </article>
  </article>
 </body>
 ...

The external keyword may be used with a and area elements.

The external keyword indicates that the link is leading to a document that is not part of the site that the current document forms a part of.

The feed keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The feed keyword indicates that the referenced document is a syndication feed. If the alternate link type is also specified, then the feed is specifically the feed for the current document; otherwise, the feed is just a syndication feed, not necessarily associated with a particular Web page.

The first link, a, or area element in the document (in tree order) that creates a hyperlink with the link type feed must be treated as the default syndication feed for the purposes of feed autodiscovery.

The feed keyword is implied by the alternate link type in certain cases (q.v.).

The following two link elements are equivalent: both give the syndication feed for the current page:

<link rel="alternate" type="application/atom+xml" href="data.xml">
<link rel="feed alternate" href="data.xml">

The following extract offers various different syndication feeds:

 <p>You can access the planets database using Atom feeds:</p>
 <ul>
  <li><a href="recently-visited-planets.xml" rel="feed">Recently Visited Planets</a></li>
  <li><a href="known-bad-planets.xml" rel="feed">Known Bad Planets</a></li>
  <li><a href="unexplored-planets.xml" rel="feed">Unexplored Planets</a></li>
 </ul>

The help keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

For a and area elements, the help keyword indicates that the referenced document provides further help information for the parent of the element defining the hyperlink, and its children.

In the following example, the form control has associated context-sensitive help. The user agent could use this information, for example, displaying the referenced document if the user presses the "Help" or "F1" key.

 <p><label> Topic: <input name=topic> <a href="help/topic.html" rel="help">(Help)</a></label></p>

For link elements, the help keyword indicates that the referenced document provides help for the page as a whole.

5.11.3.8. Link type "icon"

The icon keyword may be used with link elements, for which it creates an external resource link.

specified resource is an icon representing the page or site, and should be used by the user agent when representing the page in the user 界面。

Icons could be auditory icons, visual icons, or other kinds of icons. If multiple icons are provided, the user agent must select the most appropriate icon according to the type, media, and sizes attributes. If there are multiple equally appropriate icons, user agents must use the last one declared in tree order. If the user agent tries to use an icon but that icon is determined, upon closer examination, to in fact be inappropriate (e.g. because it uses an unsupported format), then the user agent must try the next-most-appropriate icon as determined by the attributes.

There is no default type for resources given by the icon keyword. However, for the purposes of determining the type of the resource, user agents must expect the resource to be an image.

The sizes attribute gives the sizes of icons for visual media.

If specified, the attribute must have a value that is an unordered set of unique space-separated tokens. The values must all be either any or a value that consists of two valid non-negative integers that do not have a leading U+0030 DIGIT ZERO (0) character and that are separated by a single U+0078 LATIN SMALL LETTER X character.

The keywords represent icon sizes.

To parse and process the attribute's value, the user agent must first split the attribute's value on spaces, and must then parse each resulting keyword to determine what it represents.

The any keyword represents that the resource contains a scalable icon, e.g. as provided by an SVG image.

Other keywords must be further parsed as follows to determine what they represent:

The keywords specified on the sizes attribute must not represent icon sizes that are not actually available in the linked resource.

If the attribute is not specified, then the user agent must assume that the given icon is appropriate, but less appropriate than an icon of a known and appropriate size.

The following snippet shows the top part of an application with several icons.

<!DOCTYPE HTML>
<html>
 <head>
  <title>lsForums — Inbox</title>
  <link rel=icon href=favicon.png sizes="16x16">
  <link rel=icon href=windows.ico sizes="32x32 48x48">
  <link rel=icon href=mac.icns sizes="128x128 512x512 8192x8192 32768x32768">
  <link rel=icon href=iphone.png sizes="59x60">
  <link rel=icon href=gnome.svg sizes="any">
  <link rel=stylesheet href=lsforums.css>
  <script src=lsforums.js></script>
  <meta name=application-name content="lsForums">
 </head>
 <body>
  ...

The license keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The license keyword indicates that the referenced document provides the copyright license terms under which the current document is provided.

Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must also treat the keyword "copyright" like the license keyword.

The nofollow keyword may be used with a and area elements.

The nofollow keyword indicates that the link is not endorsed by the original author or publisher of the page, or that the link to the referenced document was included primarily because of a commercial relationship between people affiliated with the two pages.

The noreferrer keyword may be used with a and area elements.

If a user agent follows a link defined by an a or area element that has the noreferrer keyword, the user agent must not include a Referer HTTP header (or equivalent for other protocols) in the request.

This keyword also causes the opener attribute to remain null if the hyperlink creates a new browsing context.

The pingback keyword may be used with link elements, for which it creates an external resource link.

For the semantics of the pingback keyword, see the Pingback 1.0 specification. [PINGBACK]

The prefetch keyword may be used with link elements, for which it creates an external resource link.

The prefetch keyword indicates that preemptively fetching and caching the specified resource is likely to be beneficial, as it is highly likely that the user will require this resource.

There is no default type for resources given by the prefetch keyword.

The search keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The search keyword indicates that the referenced document provides an interface specifically for searching the document and its related resources.

OpenSearch description documents can be used with link elements and the search link type to enable user agents to autodiscover search interfaces. [OPENSEARCH]

The stylesheet keyword may be used with link elements, for which it creates an external resource link that contributes to the styling processing model.

The specified resource is a resource that describes how to present the document. Exactly how the resource is to be processed depends on the actual type of the resource.

If the alternate keyword is also specified on the link element, then the link is an alternative stylesheet; in this case, the title attribute must be specified on the link element, with a non-empty value.

The default type for resources given by the stylesheet keyword is text/css.

Quirk: If the document has been set to quirks mode and the Content-Type metadata of the external resource is not a supported style sheet type, the user agent must instead assume it to be text/css.

The sidebar keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The sidebar keyword indicates that the referenced document, if retrieved, is intended to be shown in a secondary browsing context (if possible), instead of in the current browsing context.

A hyperlink element with with the sidebar keyword specified is a sidebar hyperlink.

The tag keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The tag keyword indicates that the tag that the referenced document represents applies to the current document.

5.11.3.18. Hierarchical link types

Some documents form part of a hierarchical structure of documents.

A hierarchical structure of documents is one where each document can have various subdocuments. The document of which a document is a subdocument is said to be the document's parent. A document with no parent forms the top of the hierarchy.

A document may be part of multiple hierarchies.

The index keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The index keyword indicates that the document is part of a hierarchical structure, and that the link is leading to the document that is the top of the hierarchy. It conveys more information when used with the up keyword (q.v.).

Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must also treat the keywords "top", "contents", and "toc" like the index keyword.

The up keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The up keyword indicates that the document is part of a hierarchical structure, and that the link is leading to the document that is the parent of the current document.

The up keyword may be repeated within a rel attribute to indicate the hierarchical distance from the current document to the referenced document. Each occurrence of the keyword represents one further level. If the index keyword is also present, then the number of up keywords is the depth of the current page relative to the top of the hierarchy. Only one link is created for the set of one or more up keywords and, if present, the index keyword.

If the page is part of multiple hierarchies, then they should be described in different paragraphs. User agents must scope any interpretation of the up and index keywords together indicating the depth of the hierarchy to the paragraph in which the link finds itself, if any, or to the document otherwise.

When two links have both the up and index keywords specified together in the same scope and contradict each other by having a different number of up keywords, the link with the greater number of up keywords must be taken as giving the depth of the document.

This can be used to mark up a navigation style sometimes known as bread crumbs. In the following example, the current page can be reached via two paths.

<nav>
 <p>
  <a href="/" rel="index up up up">Main</a> >
  <a href="/products/" rel="up up">Products</a> >
  <a href="/products/dishwashers/" rel="up">Dishwashers</a> >
  <a>Second hand</a>
 </p>
 <p>
  <a href="/" rel="index up up">Main</a> >
  <a href="/second-hand/" rel="up">Second hand</a> >
  <a>Dishwashers</a>
 </p>
</nav>

The relList DOM attribute (e.g. on the a element) does not currently represent multiple up keywords (the interface hides duplicates).

5.11.3.19. Sequential link types

Some documents form part of a sequence of documents.

A sequence of documents is one where each document can have a previous sibling and a next sibling. A document with no previous sibling is the start of its sequence, a document with no next sibling is the end of its sequence.

A document may be part of multiple sequences.

The first keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The first keyword indicates that the document is part of a sequence, and that the link is leading to the document that is the first logical document in the sequence.

Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must also treat the keywords "begin" and "start" like the first keyword.

The last keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The last keyword indicates that the document is part of a sequence, and that the link is leading to the document that is the last logical document in the sequence.

Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must also treat the keyword "end" like the last keyword.

The next keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The next keyword indicates that the document is part of a sequence, and that the link is leading to the document that is the next logical document in the sequence.

The prev keyword may be used with link, a, and area elements. For link elements, it creates a hyperlink.

The prev keyword indicates that the document is part of a sequence, and that the link is leading to the document that is the previous logical document in the sequence.

Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must also treat the keyword "previous" like the prev keyword.

5.11.3.20. Other link types

Other than the types defined above, only types defined as extensions in the WHATWG Wiki RelExtensions page may be used with the rel attribute on link, a, and area elements. [WHATWGWIKI]

Anyone is free to edit the WHATWG Wiki RelExtensions page at any time to add a type. Extension types must be specified with the following information:

Keyword

The actual value being defined. The value should not be confusingly similar to any other defined value (e.g. differing only in case).

Effect on... link

One of the following:

not allowed
The keyword is not allowed to be specified on link elements.
Hyperlink
The keyword may be specified on a link element; it creates a hyperlink link.
External Resource
The keyword may be specified on a link element; it creates a external resource link.
Effect on... a and area

One of the following:

not allowed
The keyword is not allowed to be specified on a and area elements.
Hyperlink
The keyword may be specified on a and area elements.
Brief description

A short description of what the keyword's meaning is.

Link to more details

A link to a more detailed description of the keyword's semantics and requirements. It could be another page on the Wiki, or a link to an external page.

Synonyms

A list of other keyword values that have exactly the same processing requirements. Authors must not use the values defined to be synonyms, they are only intended to allow user agents to support legacy content.

Status

One of the following:

Proposal
The keyword has not received wide peer review and approval. It is included for completeness because pages use the keyword. Pages should not use the keyword.
Accepted
The keyword has received wide peer review and approval. It has a specification that unambiguously defines how to handle pages that use the keyword, including when they use them in incorrect ways. Pages may use the keyword.
Rejected
The keyword has received wide peer review and it has been found to have significant problems. Pages must not use the keyword. When a keyword has this status, the "Effect on... link" and "Effect on... a and area" information should be set to "not allowed".

If a keyword is added with the "proposal" status and found to be redundant with existing values, it should be removed and listed as a synonym for the existing value. If a keyword is added with the "proposal" status and found to be harmful, then it should be changed to "rejected" status, and its "Effect on..." information should be changed accordingly.

Conformance checkers must use the information given on the WHATWG Wiki RelExtensions page to establish if a value not explicitly defined in this specification is allowed or not. When an author uses a new type not defined by either this specification or the Wiki page, conformance checkers should offer to add the value to the Wiki, with the details described above, with the "proposal" status.

This specification does not define how new values will get approved. It is expected that the Wiki will have a community that addresses this.

6. User Interaction

This section describes various features that allow authors to enable users to edit documents and parts of documents interactively.

6.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

Would be nice to explain how these features work together.

6.2 irrelevant 属性

All elements may have the irrelevant content attribute set. The irrelevant attribute is a boolean attribute. When specified on an element, it indicates that the element is not yet, or is no longer, relevant. User agents should not render elements that have the irrelevant attribute specified.

In the following skeletal example, the attribute is used to hide the Web game's main screen until the user logs in:

  <h1>The Example Game</h1>
  <section id="login">
   <h2>Login</h2>
   <form>
    ...
    <!-- calls login() once the user's credentials have been checked -->
   </form>
   <script>
    function login() {
      // switch screens
      document.getElementById('login').irrelevant = true;
      document.getElementById('game').irrelevant = false;
    }
   </script>
  </section>
  <section id="game" irrelevant>
   ...
  </section>

The irrelevant attribute must not be used to hide content that could legitimately be shown in another presentation. For example, it is incorrect to use irrelevant to hide panels in a tabbed dialog, because the tabbed interface is merely a kind of overflow presentation — showing all the form controls in one big page with a scrollbar would be equivalent, and no less correct.

Elements in a section hidden by the irrelevant attribute are still active, e.g. scripts and form controls in such sections still render execute and submit respectively. Only their presentation to the user changes.

The irrelevant DOM attribute must reflect the content attribute of the same name.

6.3 Activation

The click() method must fire a click event at the element, whose default action is the firing of a further DOMActivate event at the same element, whose own default action is to go through all the elements the DOMActivate event bubbled through (starting at the target node and going towards the Document node), looking for an element with an activation behavior; the first element, in reverse tree order, to have one, must have its activation behavior executed.

6.4 Scrolling elements into view

The scrollIntoView([top]) method, when called, must cause the element on which the method was called to have the attention of the user called to it.

In a speech browser, this could happen by having the current playback position move to the start of the given element.

In visual user agents, if the argument is present and has the value false, the user agent should scroll the element into view such that both the bottom and the top of the element are in the viewport, with the bottom of the element aligned with the bottom of the viewport. If it isn't possible to show the entire element in that way, or if the argument is omitted or is true, then the user agent should instead align the top of the element with the top of the viewport. If the entire scrollable part of the content is visible all at once (e.g. if a page is shorter than the viewport), then the user agent should not scroll anything. Visual user agents should further scroll horizontally as necessary to bring the element to the attention of the user.

Non-visual user agents may ignore the argument, or may treat it in some media-specific manner most useful to the user.

6.5 Focus

When an element is focused, key events received by the document must be targeted at that element. There may be no element focused; when no element is focused, key events received by the document must be targetted at the body element.

User agents may track focus for each browsing context or Document individually, or may support only one focused elment per top-level browsing context — user agents should follow platform conventions in this regard.

Which element(s) within a top-level browsing context currently has focus must be independent of whether or not the top-level browsing context itself has the system focus.

6.5.1 Focus management

The focusing steps are as follows:

  1. If focusing the element will remove the focus from another element, then run the unfocusing steps for that element.

  2. Make the element the currently focused element in its top-level browsing context.

    Some elements, most notably area, can correspond to more than one distinct focusable area. If a particular area was indicated when the element was focused, then that is the area that must get focus; otherwise, e.g. when using the focus() method, the first such region in tree order is the one that must be focused.

  3. Fire a simple event that doesn't bubble called focus at the element.

User agents must run the focusing steps for an element whenever the user moves the focus to a focusable element.

The unfocusing steps are as follows:

  1. Unfocus the element.

  2. Fire a simple event that doesn't bubble called blur at the element.

User agents should run the unfocusing steps for an element whenever the user moves the focus away from any focusable element.


The focus() method, when invoked, must run the following algorithm:

  1. If the element is marked as locked for focus, then abort these steps.

  2. If the element is not focusable, then abort these steps.

  3. Mark the element as locked for focus.

  4. If the element is not already focused, run the focusing steps for the element.

  5. Unmark the element as locked for focus.

The blur() method, when invoked, should run the unfocusing steps for the element. User agents may selectively or uniformly ignore calls to this method for usability reasons.


The activeElement attribute must return the element in the document that is focused. If no element in the Document is focused, this must return the body element.

The hasFocus() method must return true if the document, one of its nested browsing contexts, or any element in the document or its browsing contexts currently has the system focus.

6.5.2 Sequential focus navigation

The tabindex content attribute specifies whether the element is focusable, whether it can be reached using sequential focus navigation, and the relative order of the element for the purposes of sequential focus navigation. The name "tab index" comes from the common use of the "tab" key to navigate through the focusable elements. The term "tabbing" refers to moving forward through the focusable elements that can be reached using sequential focus navigation.

The tabindex attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid integer.

If the attribute is specified, it must be parsed using the rules for parsing integers. The attribute's values have the following meanings:

If the attribute is omitted or parsing the value returns an error

The user agent should follow platform conventions to determine if the element is to be focusable and, if so, whether the element can be reached using sequential focus navigation, and if so, what its relative order should be.

If the value is a negative integer

The user agent must allow the element to be focused, but should not allow the element to be reached using sequential focus navigation.

If the value is a zero

The user agent must allow the element to be focused, should allow the element to be reached using sequential focus navigation, and should follow platform conventions to determine the element's relative order.

If the value is greater than zero

The user agent must allow the element to be focused, should allow the element to be reached using sequential focus navigation, and should place the element in the sequential focus navigation order so that it is:

An element is focusable if the tabindex attribute's definition above defines the element to be focusable and the element is being rendered.

When an element is focused, the element matches the CSS :focus pseudo-class and key events are dispatched on that element in response to keyboard input.

The tabIndex DOM attribute must reflect the value of the tabindex content attribute. If the attribute is not present, or parsing its value returns an error, then the DOM attribute must return 0 for elements that are focusable and −1 for elements that are not focusable.

6.6 The text selection APIs

Every browsing context has a selection. The selection can be empty, and the selection can have more than one range (a disjointed selection). The user should be able to change the selection. User agents are not required to let the user select more than one range, and may collapse multiple ranges in the selection to a single range when the user interacts with the selection. (But, of course, the user agent may let the user create selections with multiple ranges.)

This one selection must be shared by all the content of the browsing context (though not by nested browsing contexts), including any editing hosts in the document. (Editing hosts that are not inside a document cannot have a selection.)

If the selection is empty (collapsed, so that it has only one segment and that segment's start and end points are the same) then the selection's position should equal the caret position. When the selection is not empty, this specification does not define the caret position; user agents should follow platform conventions in deciding whether the caret is at the start of the selection, the end of the selection, or somewhere else.

On some platforms (such as those using Wordstar editing conventions), the caret position is totally independent of the start and end of the selection, even when the selection is empty. On such platforms, user agents may ignore the requirement that the cursor position be linked to the position of the selection altogether.

Mostly for historical reasons, in addition to the browsing context's selection, each textarea and input element has an independent selection. These are the text field selections.

User agents may selectively ignore attempts to use the API to adjust the selection made after the user has modified the selection. For example, if the user has just selected part of a word, the user agent could ignore attempts to use the API call to immediately unselect the selection altogether, but could allow attempts to change the selection to select the entire word.

User agents may also allow the user to create selections that are not exposed to the API.

The datagrid and select elements also have selections, indicating which items have been picked by the user. These are not discussed in this section.

This specification does not specify how selections are presented to the user. The Selectors specification, in conjunction with CSS, can be used to style text selections using the ::selection pseudo-element. [SELECTORS] [CSS21]

6.6.1 APIs for the browsing context selection

The getSelection() method on the Window interface must return the Selection object representing the selection of that Window object's browsing context.

For historical reasons, the getSelection() method on the HTMLDocument interface must return the same Selection object.

[Stringifies] interface Selection {
  readonly attribute Node anchorNode;
  readonly attribute long anchorOffset;
  readonly attribute Node focusNode;
  readonly attribute long focusOffset;
  readonly attribute boolean isCollapsed;
  void collapse(in Node parentNode, in long offset);
  void collapseToStart();
  void collapseToEnd();
  void selectAllChildren(in Node parentNode);
  void deleteFromDocument();
  readonly attribute long rangeCount;
  Range getRangeAt(in long index);
  void addRange(in Range range);
  void removeRange(in Range range);
  void removeAllRanges();
};

The Selection interface is represents a list of Range objects. The first item in the list has index 0, and the last item has index count-1, where count is the number of ranges in the list. [DOM2RANGE]

All of the members of the Selection interface are defined in terms of operations on the Range objects represented by this object. These operations can raise exceptions, as defined for the Range interface; this can therefore result in the members of the Selection interface raising exceptions as well, in addition to any explicitly called out below.

The anchorNode attribute must return the value returned by the startContainer attribute of the last Range object in the list, or null if the list is empty.

The anchorOffset attribute must return the value returned by the startOffset attribute of the last Range object in the list, or 0 if the list is empty.

The focusNode attribute must return the value returned by the endContainer attribute of the last Range object in the list, or null if the list is empty.

The focusOffset attribute must return the value returned by the endOffset attribute of the last Range object in the list, or 0 if the list is empty.

The isCollapsed attribute must return true if there are zero ranges, or if there is exactly one range and its collapsed attribute is itself true. Otherwise it must return false.

The collapse(parentNode, offset) method must raise a WRONG_DOCUMENT_ERR DOM exception if parentNode's ownerDocument is not the HTMLDocument object with which the Selection object is associated. Otherwise it is, and the method must remove all the ranges in the Selection list, then create a new Range object, add it to the list, and invoke its setStart() and setEnd() methods with the parentNode and offset values as their arguments.

The collapseToStart() method must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR DOM exception if there are no ranges in the list. Otherwise, it must invoke the collapse() method with the startContainer and startOffset values of the first Range object in the list as the arguments.

The collapseToEnd() method must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR DOM exception if there are no ranges in the list. Otherwise, it must invoke the collapse() method with the endContainer and endOffset values of the last Range object in the list as the arguments.

The selectAllChildren(parentNode) method must invoke the collapse() method with the parentNode value as the first argument and 0 as the second argument, and must then invoke the selectNodeContents() method on the first (and only) range in the list with the parentNode value as the argument.

The deleteFromDocument() method must invoke the deleteContents() method on each range in the list, if any, from first to last.

The rangeCount attribute must return the number of ranges in the list.

The getRangeAt(index) method must return the indexth range in the list. If index is less than zero or greater or equal to the value returned by the rangeCount attribute, then the method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR DOM exception.

The addRange(range) method must add the given range Range object to the list of selections, at the end (so the newly added range is the new last range). Duplicates are not prevented; a range may be added more than once in which case it appears in the list more than once, which (for example) will cause stringification to return the range's text twice.

The removeRange(range) method must remove the first occurrence of range in the list of ranges, if it appears at all.

The removeAllRanges() method must remove all the ranges from the list of ranges, such that the rangeCount attribute returns 0 after the removeAllRanges() method is invoked (and until a new range is added to the list, either through this interface or via user interaction).

Objects implementing this interface must stringify to a concatenation of the results of invoking the toString() method of the Range object on each of the ranges of the selection, in the order they appear in the list (first to last).

In the following document fragment, the emphasised parts indicate the selection.

<p>The cute girl likes the <cite>Oxford English Dictionary</cite>.</p>

If a script invoked window.getSelection().toString(), the return value would be "the Oxford English".

Selection interface has no relation to the DataGridSelection 界面。

6.6.2 APIs for the text field selections

When we define HTMLTextAreaElement and HTMLInputElement we will have to add the IDL given below to both of their IDLs.

The input and textarea elements define four members in their DOM interfaces for handling their text selection:

  void select();
           attribute unsigned long selectionStart;
           attribute unsigned long selectionEnd;
  void setSelectionRange(in unsigned long start, in unsigned long end);

These methods and attributes expose and control the selection of input and textarea text fields.

The select() method must cause the contents of the text field to be fully selected.

The selectionStart attribute must, on getting, return the offset (in logical order) to the character that immediately follows the start of the selection. If there is no selection, then it must return the offset (in logical order) to the character that immediately follows the text entry cursor.

On setting, it must act as if the setSelectionRange() method had been called, with the new value as the first argument, and the current value of the selectionEnd attribute as the second argument, unless the current value of the selectionEnd is less than the new value, in which case the second argument must also be the new value.

The selectionEnd attribute must, on getting, return the offset (in logical order) to the character that immediately follows the end of the selection. If there is no selection, then it must return the offset (in logical order) to the character that immediately follows the text entry cursor.

On setting, it must act as if the setSelectionRange() method had been called, with the current value of the selectionStart attribute as the first argument, and new value as the second argument.

The setSelectionRange(start, end) method must set the selection of the text field to the sequence of characters starting with the character at the startth position (in logical order) and ending with the character at the (end-1)th position. Arguments greater than the length of the value in the text field must be treated as pointing at the end of the text field. If end is less than or equal to start then the start of the selection and the end of the selection must both be placed immediately before the character with offset end. In UAs where there is no concept of an empty selection, this must set the cursor to be just before the character with offset end.

To obtain the currently selected text, the following JavaScript suffices:

var selectionText = control.value.substring(control.selectionStart, control.selectionEnd);

...where control is the input or textarea element.

Characters with no visible rendering, such as U+200D ZERO WIDTH JOINER, still count as characters. Thus, for instance, the selection can include just an invisible character, and the text insertion cursor can be placed to one side or another of such a character.

When these methods and attributes are used with input elements that are not displaying simple text fields, they must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception.

6.7 contenteditable 属性

The contenteditable attribute is a common attribute. User agents must support this attribute on all HTML elements.

The contenteditable attribute is an enumerated attribute whose keywords are the empty string, true, and false. The empty string and the true keyword map to the true state. The false keyword maps to the false state. In addition, there is a third state, the inherit state, which is the missing value default (and the invalid value default).

If an HTML element has a contenteditable attribute set to the true state, or it has its contenteditable attribute set to the inherit state and if its nearest ancestor HTML element with the contenteditable attribute set to a state other than the inherit state has its attribute set to the true state, or if it and its ancestors all have their contenteditable attribute set to the inherit state but the Document has designMode enabled, then the UA must treat the element as editable (as described below).

Otherwise, either the HTML element has a contenteditable attribute set to the false state, or its contenteditable attribute is set to the inherit state and its nearest ancestor HTML element with the contenteditable attribute set to a state other than the inherit state has its attribute set to the false state, or all its ancestors have their contenteditable attribute set to the inherit state and the Document itself has designMode disabled; either way, the element is not editable.

The contentEditable DOM attribute, on getting, must return the string "true" if the content attribute is set to the true state, false" if the content attribute is set to the false state, and "inherit" otherwise. On setting, if the new value is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "inherit" then the content attribute must be removed, if the new value is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "true" then the content attribute must be set to the string "true", if the new value is an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "false" then the content attribute must be set to the string "false", and otherwise the attribute setter must raise a SYNTAX_ERR exception.

The isContentEditable DOM attribute, on getting, must return true if the element is editable, and false otherwise.

If an element is editable and its parent element is not, or if an element is editable and it has no parent element, then the element is an editing host. Editable elements can be nested. User agents must make editing hosts focusable (which typically means they enter the tab order). An editing host can contain non-editable sections, these are handled as described below. An editing host can contain non-editable sections that contain further editing hosts.

When an editing host has focus, it must have a caret position that specifies where the current editing position is. It may also have a selection.

How the caret and selection are represented depends entirely on the UA.

6.7.1 User editing actions

利用者が編集ホストと対話している間に利用者が実行することを利用者エージェントが認めるべきである作用がいくつかあります。 すべての作用について正確にどのように誘発するのかを定義しているわけではありませんが、 定義していない場合には、実装者に対する指針として、鍵の束縛の案を提示します。

脱字記号を移動する

利用者エージェントは、利用者が編集ホスト中の任意の位置 (入れ子になった編集可能要素の中を含みます。) に脱字記号を移動させることを認めなければなりません。これは、 各種の鍵識別子についての keydown 事象の既定作用として、および mousedown 事象の既定作用として誘発することができます。

選択を変更する

利用者エージェントは、利用者が編集ホスト中の選択を変更することを認めなければなりません (入れ子になった編集可能要素の中を含みます)。 利用者エージェントは、編集可能要素と非編集可能要素を選択がまたぐことを (例えば、非編集可能子孫がそれぞれ原子的に選択可能としながら、その中の文章を選択できないようにすることで) 拒んでも構いません。これは、各種の鍵識別子についての keydown 事象の既定作用として、および mousedown 事象の既定作用として誘発することができます。

文章を挿入する

この作用は、 textInput 事象の既定作用として誘発しなければならず、 他の命令によって誘発しても構いません。 これにより、利用者エージェントは指定された文章 (textInput 事象の場合には事象オブジェクトの data 属性で与えられるもの) を脱字記号の位置に挿入することにならなければなりません

利用者エージェントは、脱字記号が語句付け内容の認められていない場所に位置付けられている場合 (例えば空の ol 要素の内側の場合)、 脱字記号の位置に直接文章を挿入してはなりません。このような場合、 動作は利用者エージェント依存ですが、利用者エージェントは、 文章の挿入の要求に対して、要求以前の DOM よりも適合性の低い DOM を生成してはなりません

利用者エージェントは、利用者に、段落以外の内容だけを含む要素に新しい段落を挿入することを認めるべきです

例えば、次のマーク付けについて、

<section>
 <dl>
  <dt> Ben </dt>
  <dd> Goat </dd>
 </dl>
</section>

・・・利用者エージェントは、利用者が dl 要素の前後に p 要素を section 要素の子供として挿入することを認めるべきです。

Break block

UAs should offer a way for the user to request that the current paragraph be broken at the caret, e.g. as the default action of a keydown event whose identifier is the "Enter" key and that has no modifiers set.

The exact behavior is UA-dependent, but user agents must not, in response to a request to break a paragraph, generate a DOM that is less conformant than the DOM prior to the request.

Insert a line separator

UAs should offer a way for the user to request an explicit line break at the caret position without breaking the paragraph, e.g. as the default action of a keydown event whose identifier is the "Enter" key and that has a shift modifier set. Line separators are typically found within a poem verse or an address. To insert a line break, the user agent must insert a br element.

If the caret is positioned somewhere where phrasing content is not allowed (e.g. in an empty ol element), then the user agent must not insert the br element directly at the caret position. In such cases the behavior is UA-dependent, but user agents must not, in response to a request to insert a line separator, generate a DOM that is less conformant than the DOM prior to the request.

Delete

UAs should offer a way for the user to delete text and elements, including non-editable descendants, e.g. as the default action of keydown events whose identifiers are "U+0008" or "U+007F".

Five edge cases in particular need to be considered carefully when implementing this feature: backspacing at the start of an element, backspacing when the caret is immediately after an element, forward-deleting at the end of an element, forward-deleting when the caret is immediately before an element, and deleting a selection whose start and end points do not share a common parent node.

In any case, the exact behavior is UA-dependent, but user agents must not, in response to a request to delete text or an element, generate a DOM that is less conformant than the DOM prior to the request.

Insert, and wrap text in, semantic elements

UAs should offer the user the ability to mark text and paragraphs with semantics that HTML can express.

UAs should similarly offer a way for the user to insert empty semantic elements to subsequently fill by entering text manually.

UAs should also offer a way to remove those semantics from marked up text, and to remove empty semantic element that have been inserted.

In response to a request from a user to mark text up in italics, user agents should use the i element to represent the semantic. The em element should be used only if the user agent is sure that the user means to indicate stress emphasis.

In response to a request from a user to mark text up in bold, user agents should use the b element to represent the semantic. The strong element should be used only if the user agent is sure that the user means to indicate importance.

The exact behavior is UA-dependent, but user agents must not, in response to a request to wrap semantics around some text or to insert or remove a semantic element, generate a DOM that is less conformant than the DOM prior to the request.

Select and move non-editable elements nested inside editing hosts

UAs should offer a way for the user to move images and other non-editable parts around the content within an editing host. This may be done using the drag and drop mechanism. User agents must not, in response to a request to move non-editable elements nested inside editing hosts, generate a DOM that is less conformant than the DOM prior to the request.

Edit form controls nested inside editing hosts

When an editable form control is edited, the changes must be reflected in both its current value and its default value. For input elements this means updating the defaultValue DOM attribute as well as the value DOM attribute; for select elements it means updating the option elements' defaultSelected DOM attribute as well as the selected DOM attribute; for textarea elements this means updating the defaultValue DOM attribute as well as the value DOM attribute. (Updating the default* DOM attributes causes content attributes to be updated as well.)

User agents may perform several commands per user request; for example if the user selects a block of text and hits Enter, the UA might interpret that as a request to delete the content of the selection followed by a request to break the paragraph at that position.

6.7.2 Making entire documents editable

Documents have a designMode, which can be either enabled or disabled.

The designMode DOM attribute on the Document object takes two values, "on" and "off". When it is set, the new value must be compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner to these two values. If it matches the "on" value, then designMode must be enabled, and if it matches the "off" value, then designMode must be disabled. Other values must be ignored.

When designMode is enabled, the DOM attribute must return the value "on", and when it is disabled, it must return the value "off".

The last state set must persist until the document is destroyed or the state is changed. Initially, documents must have their designMode disabled.

Enabling designMode causes scripts in general to be disabled and the document to become editable.

6.8 Drag and drop

This section defines an event-based drag-and-drop mechanism.

This specification does not define exactly what a drag-and-drop operation actually is.

On a visual medium with a pointing device, a drag operation could be the default action of a mousedown event that is followed by a series of mousemove events, and the drop could be triggered by the mouse being released.

On media without a pointing device, the user would probably have to explicitly indicate his intention to perform a drag-and-drop operation, stating what he wishes to drag and what he wishes to drop, respectively.

However it is implemented, drag-and-drop operations must have a starting point (e.g. where the mouse was clicked, or the start of the selection or element that was selected for the drag), may have any number of intermediate steps (elements that the mouse moves over during a drag, or elements that the user picks as possible drop points as he cycles through possibilities), and must either have an end point (the element above which the mouse button was released, or the element that was finally selected), or be canceled. The end point must be the last element selected as a possible drop point before the drop occurs (so if the operation is not canceled, there must be at least one element in the middle step).

6.8.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

It's also currently non-existent.

6.8.2 The DragEvent and DataTransfer interfaces

drag-and-drop processing model involves several events. They all use the DragEvent 界面。

interface DragEvent : UIEvent {
  readonly attribute DataTransfer dataTransfer;
  void initDragEvent(in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in AbstractView viewArg, in long detailArg, in DataTransfer dataTransferArg);
  void initDragEventNS(in DOMString namespaceURIArg, in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in AbstractView viewArg, in long detailArg, in DataTransfer dataTransferArg);
};

We should have modifier key information in here too (shift/ctrl, etc), like with mouse events and like with the context menu event.

initDragEvent() メソッドと initMessageEventNS() メソッドは、 DOM3 事象界面の似たような名前のメソッドと同じような方法で事象を初期化しなければなりません[DOM3EVENTS]

The dataTransfer attribute of the DragEvent interface represents the context information for the event.

interface DataTransfer {
           attribute DOMString dropEffect;
           attribute DOMString effectAllowed;
  readonly attribute DOMStringList types;
  void clearData(in DOMString format);
  void setData(in DOMString format, in DOMString data);
  DOMString getData(in DOMString format);
  void setDragImage(in Element image, in long x, in long y);
  void addElement(in Element element);
};

DataTransfer objects can conceptually contain various kinds of data.

When a DataTransfer object is created, it must be initialized as follows:

The dropEffect attribute controls the drag-and-drop feedback that the user is given during a drag-and-drop operation.

The attribute must ignore any attempts to set it to a value other than none, copy, link, and move. On getting, the attribute must return the last of those four values that it was set to.

The effectAllowed attribute is used in the drag-and-drop processing model to initialise the dropEffect attribute during the dragenter and dragover events.

The attribute must ignore any attempts to set it to a value other than none, copy, copyLink, copyMove, link, linkMove, move, all, and uninitialized. On getting, the attribute must return the last of those values that it was set to.

DataTransfer objects can hold pieces of data, each associated with a unique format. Formats are generally given by MIME types, with some values special-cased for legacy reasons.

The clearData(format) method must clear the DataTransfer object of any data associated with the given format. If format is the value "Text", then it must be treated as "text/plain". If the format is "URL", then it must be treated as "text/uri-list".

The setData(format, data) method must add data to the data stored in the DataTransfer object, labeled as being of the type format. This must replace any previous data that had been set for that format. If format is the value "Text", then it must be treated as "text/plain". If the format is "URL", then it must be treated as "text/uri-list".

The getData(format) method must return the data that is associated with the type format, if any, and must return the empty string otherwise. If format is the value "Text", then it must be treated as "text/plain". If the format is "URL", then the data associated with the "text/uri-list" format must be parsed as appropriate for text/uri-list data, and the first URL from the list must be returned. If there is no data with that format, or if there is but it has no URLs, then the method must return the empty string. [RFC2483]

The types attribute must return a live DOMStringList that contains the list of formats that are stored in the DataTransfer object.

The setDragImage(element, x, y) method sets which element to use to generate the drag feedback. The element argument can be any Element; if it is an img element, then the user agent should use the element's image (at its intrinsic size) to generate the feedback, otherwise the user agent should base the feedback on the given element (but the exact mechanism for doing so is not specified).

The addElement(element) method is an alternative way of specifying how the user agent is to render the drag feedback. It adds an element to the DataTransfer object.

6.8.3 Events fired during a drag-and-drop action

The following events are involved in the drag-and-drop model. Whenever the processing model described below causes one of these events to be fired, the event fired must use the DragEvent interface defined above, must have the bubbling and cancelable behaviors given in the table below, and must have the context information set up as described after the table, with the view attribute set to the view with which the user interacted to trigger the drag-and-drop event, and the detail attribute set to zero.
Event Name Target Bubbles? Cancelable? dataTransfer effectAllowed dropEffect Default Action
dragstart Source node ✓ Bubbles ✓ Cancelable Contains source node unless a selection is being dragged, in which case it is empty uninitialized none Initiate the drag-and-drop operation
drag Source node ✓ Bubbles ✓ Cancelable Empty Same as last event none Continue the drag-and-drop operation
dragenter Immediate user selection or the body element ✓ Bubbles ✓ Cancelable Empty Same as last event Based on effectAllowed value Reject immediate user selection as potential target element
dragleave Previous target element ✓ Bubbles Empty Same as last event none None
dragover Current target element ✓ Bubbles ✓ Cancelable Empty Same as last event Based on effectAllowed value Reset the current drag operation to "none"
drop Current target element ✓ Bubbles ✓ Cancelable getData() returns data set in dragstart event Same as last event Current drag operation Varies
dragend Source node ✓ Bubbles Empty Same as last event Current drag operation Varies

The dataTransfer object's contents are empty except for dragstart events and drop events, for which the contents are set as described in the processing model, below.

The effectAllowed attribute must be set to "uninitialized" for dragstart events, and to whatever value the field had after the last drag-and-drop event was fired for all other events (only counting events fired by the user agent for the purposes of the drag-and-drop model described below).

The dropEffect attribute must be set to "none" for dragstart, drag, and dragleave events (except when stated otherwise in the algorithms given in the sections below), to the value corresponding to the current drag operation for drop and dragend events, and to a value based on the effectAllowed attribute's value and to the drag-and-drop source, as given by the following table, for the remaining events (dragenter and dragover):
effectAllowed dropEffect
none none
copy, copyLink, copyMove, all copy
link, linkMove link
move move
uninitialized when what is being dragged is a selection from a text field move
uninitialized when what is being dragged is a selection copy
uninitialized when what is being dragged is an a element with an href attribute link
Any other case copy

6.8.4 Drag-and-drop processing model

When the user attempts to begin a drag operation, the user agent must first determine what is being dragged. If the drag operation was invoked on a selection, then it is the selection that is being dragged. Otherwise, it is the first element, going up the ancestor chain, starting at the node that the user tried to drag, that has the DOM attribute draggable set to true. If there is no such element, then nothing is being dragged, the drag-and-drop operation is never started, and the user agent must not continue with this algorithm.

img elements and a elements with an href attribute have their draggable attribute set to true by default.

If the user agent determines that something can be dragged, a dragstart event must then be fired.

If it is a selection that is being dragged, then this event must be fired on the node that the user started the drag on (typically the text node that the user originally clicked). If the user did not specify a particular node, for example if the user just told the user agent to begin a drag of "the selection", then the event must be fired on the deepest node that is a common ancestor of all parts of the selection.

We should look into how browsers do other types (e.g. Firefox apparently also adds text/html for internal drag and drop of a selection).

If it is not a selection that is being dragged, then the event must be fired on the element that is being dragged.

The node on which the event is fired is the source node. Multiple events are fired on this node during the course of the drag-and-drop operation.

If it is a selection that is being dragged, the dataTransfer member of the event must be created with no nodes. Otherwise, it must be created containing just the source node. Script can use the addElement() method to add further elements to the list of what is being dragged.

If it is a selection that is being dragged, the dataTransfer member of the event must have the text of the selection added to it as the data associated with the text/plain format. Otherwise, if it is an img element being dragged, then the value of the element's src DOM attribute must be added, associated with the text/uri-list format. Otherwise, if it is an a element being dragged, then the value of the element's href DOM attribute must be added, associated with the text/uri-list format. Otherwise, no data is added to the object by the user agent.

If the event is canceled, then the drag-and-drop operation must not occur; the user agent must not continue with this algorithm.

If it is not canceled, then the drag-and-drop operation must be initiated.

Since events with no event handlers registered are, almost by definition, never canceled, drag-and-drop is always available to the user if the author does not specifically prevent it.

The drag-and-drop feedback must be generated from the first of the following sources that is available:

  1. The element specified in the last call to the setDragImage() method of the dataTransfer object of the dragstart event, if the method was called. In visual media, if this is used, the x and y arguments that were passed to that method should be used as hints for where to put the cursor relative to the resulting image. The values are expressed as distances in CSS pixels from the left side and from the top side of the image respectively. [CSS21]
  2. The elements that were added to the dataTransfer object, both before the event was fired, and during the handling of the event using the addElement() method, if any such elements were indeed added.
  3. The selection that the user is dragging.

The user agent must take a note of the data that was placed in the dataTransfer object. This data will be made available again when the drop event is fired.

From this point until the end of the drag-and-drop operation, device input events (e.g. mouse and keyboard events) must be suppressed. In addition, the user agent must track all DOM changes made during the drag-and-drop operation, and add them to its undo history as one atomic operation once the drag-and-drop operation has ended.

During the drag operation, the element directly indicated by the user as the drop target is called the immediate user selection. (Only elements can be selected by the user; other nodes must not be made available as drop targets.) However, the immediate user selection is not necessarily the current target element, which is the element currently selected for the drop part of the drag-and-drop operation. The immediate user selection changes as the user selects different elements (either by pointing at them with a pointing device, or by selecting them in some other way). The current target element changes when the immediate user selection changes, based on the results of event handlers in the document, as described below.

Both the current target element and the immediate user selection can be null, which means no target element is selected. They can also both be elements in other (DOM-based) documents, or other (non-Web) programs altogether. (For example, a user could drag text to a word-processor.) The current target element is initially null.

In addition, there is also a current drag operation, which can take on the values "none", "copy", "link", and "move". Initially it has the value "none". It is updated by the user agent as described in the steps below.

User agents must, every 350ms (±200ms), perform the following steps in sequence. (If the user agent is still performing the previous iteration of the sequence when the next iteration becomes due, the user agent must not execute the overdue iteration, effectively "skipping missed frames" of the drag-and-drop operation.)

  1. First, the user agent must fire a drag event at the source node. If this event is canceled, the user agent must set the current drag operation to none (no drag operation).

  2. Next, if the drag event was not canceled and the user has not ended the drag-and-drop operation, the user agent must check the state of the drag-and-drop operation, as follows:

    1. First, if the user is indicating a different immediate user selection than during the last iteration (or if this is the first iteration), and if this immediate user selection is not the same as the current target element, then the current target element must be updated, as follows:

      1. If the new immediate user selection is null, or is in a non-DOM document or application, then set the current target element to the same value.

      2. Otherwise, the user agent must fire a dragenter event at the immediate user selection.

      3. If the event is canceled, then the current target element must be set to the immediate user selection.

      4. Otherwise, if the current target element is not the body element, the user agent must fire a dragenter event at the body element, and the current target element must be set to the body element, regardless of whether that event was canceled or not. (If the body element is null, then the current target element would be set to null too in this case, it wouldn't be set to the Document object.)

    2. If the previous step caused the current target element to change, and if the previous target element was not null or a part of a non-DOM document, the user agent must fire a dragleave event at the previous target element.

    3. If the current target element is a DOM element, the user agent must fire a dragover event at this current target element.

      If the dragover event is not canceled, the current drag operation must be reset to "none".

      Otherwise, the current drag operation must be set based on the values the effectAllowed and dropEffect attributes of the dataTransfer object had after the event was handled, as per the following table:

      effectAllowed dropEffect Drag operation
      uninitialized, copy, copyLink, copyMove, or all copy "copy"
      uninitialized, link, copyLink, linkMove, or all link "link"
      uninitialized, move, copyMove, linkMove, or all move "move"
      Any other case "none"

      Then, regardless of whether the dragover event was canceled or not, the drag feedback (e.g. the mouse cursor) must be updated to match the current drag operation, as follows:

      Drag operation Feedback
      "copy" Data will be copied if dropped here.
      "link" Data will be linked if dropped here.
      "move" Data will be moved if dropped here.
      "none" No operation allowed, dropping here will cancel the drag-and-drop operation.
    4. Otherwise, if the current target element is not a DOM element, the user agent must use platform-specific mechanisms to determine what drag operation is being performed (none, copy, link, or move). This sets the current drag operation.

  3. Otherwise, if the user ended the drag-and-drop operation (e.g. by releasing the mouse button in a mouse-driven drag-and-drop interface), or if the drag event was canceled, then this will be the last iteration. The user agent must execute the following steps, then stop looping.

    1. If the current drag operation is none (no drag operation), or, if the user ended the drag-and-drop operation by canceling it (e.g. by hitting the Escape key), or if the current target element is null, then the drag operation failed. If the current target element is a DOM element, the user agent must fire a dragleave event at it; otherwise, if it is not null, it must use platform-specific conventions for drag cancellation.

    2. Otherwise, the drag operation was as success. If the current target element is a DOM element, the user agent must fire a drop event at it; otherwise, it must use platform-specific conventions for indicating a drop.

      When the target is a DOM element, the dropEffect attribute of the event's dataTransfer object must be given the value representing the current drag operation (copy, link, or move), and the object must be set up so that the getData() method will return the data that was added during the dragstart event.

      If the event is canceled, the current drag operation must be set to the value of the dropEffect attribute of the event's dataTransfer object as it stood after the event was handled.

      Otherwise, the event is not canceled, and the user agent must perform the event's default action, which depends on the exact target as follows:

      If the current target element is a text field (e.g. textarea, or an input element with type="text")
      The user agent must insert the data associated with the text/plain format, if any, into the text field in a manner consistent with platform-specific conventions (e.g. inserting it at the current mouse cursor position, or inserting it at the end of the field).
      その他の場合
      Reset the current drag operation to "none".
    3. Finally, the user agent must fire a dragend event at the source node, with the dropEffect attribute of the event's dataTransfer object being set to the value corresponding to the current drag operation.

      The current drag operation can change during the processing of the drop event, if one was fired.

      The event is not cancelable. After the event has been handled, the user agent must act as follows:

      If the current target element is a text field (e.g. textarea, or an input element with type="text"), and a drop event was fired in the previous step, and the current drag operation is "move", and the source of the drag-and-drop operation is a selection in the DOM
      The user agent should delete the range representing the dragged selection from the DOM.
      If the current target element is a text field (e.g. textarea, or an input element with type="text"), and a drop event was fired in the previous step, and the current drag operation is "move", and the source of the drag-and-drop operation is a selection in a text field
      The user agent should delete the dragged selection from the relevant text field.
      その他の場合
      The event has no default action.
6.8.4.1. When the drag-and-drop operation starts or ends in another document

The model described above is independent of which Document object the nodes involved are from; the events must be fired as described above and the rest of the processing model must be followed as described above, irrespective of how many documents are involved in the operation.

6.8.4.2. When the drag-and-drop operation starts or ends in another application

If the drag is initiated in another application, the source node is not a DOM node, and the user agent must use platform-specific conventions instead when the requirements above involve the source node. User agents in this situation must act as if the dragged data had been added to the DataTransfer object when the drag started, even though no dragstart event was actually fired; user agents must similarly use platform-specific conventions when deciding on what drag feedback to use.

If a drag is started in a document but ends in another application, then the user agent must instead replace the parts of the processing model relating to handling the target according to platform-specific conventions.

In any case, scripts running in the context of the document must not be able to distinguish the case of a drag-and-drop operation being started or ended in another application from the case of a drag-and-drop operation being started or ended in another document from another domain.

6.8.5 draggable 属性

All elements may have the draggable content attribute set. The draggable attribute is an enumerated attribute. It has three states. The first state is true and it has the keyword true. The second state is false and it has the keyword false. The third state is auto; it has no keywords but it is the missing value default.

The draggable DOM attribute, whose value depends on the content attribute's in the way described below, controls whether or not the element is draggable. Generally, only text selections are draggable, but elements whose draggable DOM attribute is true become draggable as well.

If an element's draggable content attribute has the state true, the draggable DOM attribute must return true.

Otherwise, if the element's draggable content attribute has the state false, the draggable DOM attribute must return false.

Otherwise, the element's draggable content attribute has the state auto. If the element is an img element, or, if the element is an a element with an href content attribute, the draggable DOM attribute must return true.

Otherwise, the draggable DOM must return false.

If the draggable DOM attribute is set to the value false, the draggable content attribute must be set to the literal value false. If the draggable DOM attribute is set to the value true, the draggable content attribute must be set to the literal value true.

6.8.6 Copy and paste

Copy-and-paste is a form of drag-and-drop: the "copy" part is equivalent to dragging content to another application (the "clipboard"), and the "paste" part is equivalent to dragging content from another application.

Select-and-paste (a model used by mouse operations in the X Window System) is equivalent to a drag-and-drop operation where the source is the selection.

6.8.6.1. Copy to clipboard

When the user invokes a copy operation, the user agent must act as if the user had invoked a drag on the current selection. If the drag-and-drop operation initiates, then the user agent must act as if the user had indicated (as the immediate user selection) a hypothetical application representing the clipboard. Then, the user agent must act as if the user had ended the drag-and-drop operation without canceling it. If the drag-and-drop operation didn't get canceled, the user agent should then follow the relevant platform-specific conventions for copy operations (e.g. updating the clipboard).

6.8.6.2. Cut to clipboard

When the user invokes a cut operation, the user agent must act as if the user had invoked a copy operation (see the previous section), followed, if the copy was completed successfully, by a selection delete operation.

6.8.6.3. Paste from clipboard

When the user invokes a clipboard paste operation, the user agent must act as if the user had invoked a drag on a hypothetical application representing the clipboard, setting the data associated with the drag as the content on the clipboard (in whatever formats are available).

Then, the user agent must act as if the user had indicated (as the immediate user selection) the element with the keyboard focus, and then ended the drag-and-drop operation without canceling it.

6.8.6.4. Paste from selection

When the user invokes a selection paste operation, the user agent must act as if the user had invoked a drag on the current selection, then indicated (as the immediate user selection) the element with the keyboard focus, and then ended the drag-and-drop operation without canceling it.

6.8.7 Security risks in the drag-and-drop model

User agents must not make the data added to the DataTransfer object during the dragstart event available to scripts until the drop event, because otherwise, if a user were to drag sensitive information from one document to a second document, crossing a hostile third document in the process, the hostile document could intercept the data.

For the same reason, user agents must consider a drop to be successful only if the user specifically ended the drag operation — if any scripts end the drag operation, it must be considered unsuccessful (canceled) and the drop event must not be fired.

User agents should take care to not start drag-and-drop operations in response to script actions. For example, in a mouse-and-window environment, if a script moves a window while the user has his mouse button depressed, the UA would not consider that to start a drag. This is important because otherwise UAs could cause data to be dragged from sensitive sources and dropped into hostile documents without the user's consent.

6.9 Undo history

There has got to be a better way of doing this, surely.

The user agent must associate an undo transaction history with each HTMLDocument object.

The undo transaction history is a list of entries. The entries are of two type: DOM changes and undo objects.

Each DOM changes entry in the undo transaction history consists of batches of one or more of the following:

Undo object entries consist of objects representing state that scripts running in the document are managing. For example, a Web mail application could use an undo object to keep track of the fact that a user has moved an e-mail to a particular folder, so that the user can undo the action and have the e-mail return to its former location.

Broadly speaking, DOM changes entries are handled by the UA in response to user edits of form controls and editing hosts on the page, and undo object entries are handled by script in response to higher-level user actions (such as interactions with server-side state, or in the implementation of a drawing tool).

6.9.1 UndoManager 界面

This API sucks. Seriously. It's a terrible API. Really bad. I hate it. Here are the requirements:

To manage undo object entries in the undo transaction history, the UndoManager interface can be used:

interface UndoManager {
  unsigned long add(in DOMObject data, in DOMString title);
  [XXX] void remove(in unsigned long index); 
  void clearUndo();
  void clearRedo();
  [IndexGetter] DOMObject item(in unsigned long index);
  readonly attribute unsigned long length;
  readonly attribute unsigned long position;
};

The undoManager attribute of the Window interface must return the object implementing the UndoManager interface for that Window object's associated HTMLDocument object.

UndoManager objects represent their document's undo transaction history. Only undo object entries are visible with this API, but this does not mean that DOM changes entries are absent from the undo transaction history.

The length attribute must return the number of undo object entries in the undo transaction history.

The item(n) method must return the nth undo object entry in the undo transaction history.

The undo transaction history has a current position. This is the position between two entries in the undo transaction history's list where the previous entry represents what needs to happen if the user invokes the "undo" command (the "undo" side, lower numbers), and the next entry represents what needs to happen if the user invokes the "redo" command (the "redo" side, higher numbers).

The position attribute must return the index of the undo object entry nearest to the undo position, on the "redo" side. If there are no undo object entries on the "redo" side, then the attribute must return the same as the length attribute. If there are no undo object entries on the "undo" side of the undo position, the position attribute returns zero.

Since the undo transaction history contains both undo object entries and DOM changes entries, but the position attribute only returns indices relative to undo object entries, it is possible for several "undo" or "redo" actions to be performed without the value of the position attribute changing.

The add(data, title) method's behavior depends on the current state. Normally, it must insert the data object passed as an argument into the undo transaction history immediately before the undo position, optionally remembering the given title to use in the UI. If the method is called during an undo operation, however, the object must instead be added immediately after the undo position.

If the method is called and there is neither an undo operation in progress nor a redo operation in progress then any entries in the undo transaction history after the undo position must be removed (as if clearRedo() had been called).

We could fire events when someone adds something to the undo history -- one event per undo object entry before the position (or after, during redo addition), allowing the script to decide if that entry should remain or not. Or something. Would make it potentially easier to expire server-held state when the server limitations come into play.

The remove(index) method must remove the undo object entry with the specified index. If the index is less than zero or greater than or equal to length then the method must raise an INDEX_SIZE_ERR exception. DOM changes entries are unaffected by this method.

The clearUndo() method must remove all entries in the undo transaction history before the undo position, be they DOM changes entries or undo object entries.

The clearRedo() method must remove all entries in the undo transaction history after the undo position, be they DOM changes entries or undo object entries.

Another idea is to have a way for scripts to say "startBatchingDOMChangesForUndo()" and after that the changes to the DOM go in as if the user had done them.

6.9.2 Undo: moving back in the undo transaction history

When the user invokes an undo operation, or when the execCommand() method is called with the undo command, the user agent must perform an undo operation.

If the undo position is at the start of the undo transaction history, then the user agent must do nothing.

If the entry immediately before the undo position is a DOM changes entry, then the user agent must remove that DOM changes entry, reverse the DOM changes that were listed in that entry, and, if the changes were reversed with no problems, add a new DOM changes entry (consisting of the opposite of those DOM changes) to the undo transaction history on the other side of the undo position.

If the DOM changes cannot be undone (e.g. because the DOM state is no longer consistent with the changes represented in the entry), then the user agent must simply remove the DOM changes entry, without doing anything else.

If the entry immediately before the undo position is an undo object entry, then the user agent must first remove that undo object entry from the undo transaction history, and then must fire an undo event on the Document object, using the undo object entry's associated undo object as the event's data.

Any calls to add() while the event is being handled will be used to populate the redo history, and will then be used if the user invokes the "redo" command to undo his undo.

6.9.3 Redo: moving forward in the undo transaction history

When the user invokes a redo operation, or when the execCommand() method is called with the redo command, the user agent must perform a redo operation.

This is mostly the opposite of an undo operation, but the full definition is included here for completeness.

If the undo position is at the end of the undo transaction history, then the user agent must do nothing.

If the entry immediately after the undo position is a DOM changes entry, then the user agent must remove that DOM changes entry, reverse the DOM changes that were listed in that entry, and, if the changes were reversed with no problems, add a new DOM changes entry (consisting of the opposite of those DOM changes) to the undo transaction history on the other side of the undo position.

If the DOM changes cannot be redone (e.g. because the DOM state is no longer consistent with the changes represented in the entry), then the user agent must simply remove the DOM changes entry, without doing anything else.

If the entry immediately after the undo position is an undo object entry, then the user agent must first remove that undo object entry from the undo transaction history, and then must fire a redo event on the Document object, using the undo object entry's associated undo object as the event's data.

6.9.4 The UndoManagerEvent interface and the undo and redo events

interface UndoManagerEvent : Event {
  readonly attribute DOMObject data;
  void initUndoManagerEvent(in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMObject dataArg);
  void initUndoManagerEventNS(in DOMString namespaceURIArg, in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMObject dataArg);
};

The initUndoManagerEvent() and initUndoManagerEventNS() methods must initialise the event in a manner analogous to the similarly-named methods in the DOM3 Events interfaces. [DOM3EVENTS]

The data attribute represents the undo object for the event.

The undo and redo events do not bubble, cannot be canceled, and have no default action. When the user agent fires one of these events it must use the UndoManagerEvent interface, with the data field containing the relevant undo object.

6.9.5 Implementation notes

How user agents present the above conceptual model to the user is not defined. The undo interface could be a filtered view of the undo transaction history, it could manipulate the undo transaction history in ways not described above, and so forth. For example, it is possible to design a UA that appears to have separate undo transaction histories for each form control; similarly, it is possible to design systems where the user has access to more undo information than is present in the official (as described above) undo transaction history (such as providing a tree-based approach to document state). Such UI models should be based upon the single undo transaction history described in this section, however, such that to a script there is no detectable difference.

6.10 Command APIs

The execCommand(commandId, showUI, value) method on the HTMLDocument interface allows scripts to perform actions on the current selection or at the current caret position. Generally, these commands would be used to implement editor UI, for example having a "delete" button on a toolbar.

There are three variants to this method, with one, two, and three arguments respectively. The showUI and value parameters, even if specified, are ignored unless otherwise stated.

When execCommand() is invoked, the user agent must follow the following steps:

  1. If the given commandId maps to an entry in the list below whose "Enabled When" entry has a condition that is currently false, do nothing; abort these steps.
  2. Otherwise, execute the "Action" listed below for the given commandId.

A document is ready for editing host commands if it has a selection that is entirely within an editing host, or if it has no selection but its caret is inside an editing host.

The queryCommandEnabled(commandId) method, when invoked, must return true if the condition listed below under "Enabled When" for the given commandId is true, and false otherwise.

The queryCommandIndeterm(commandId) method, when invoked, must return true if the condition listed below under "Indeterminate When" for the given commandId is true, and false otherwise.

The queryCommandState(commandId) method, when invoked, must return the value expressed below under "State" for the given commandId.

The queryCommandSupported(commandId) method, when invoked, must return true if the given commandId is in the list below, and false otherwise.

The queryCommandValue(commandId) method, when invoked, must return the value expressed below under "Value" for the given commandId.

The possible values for commandId, and their corresponding meanings, are as follows. These values must be compared to the argument in an ASCII case-insensitive manner.

bold
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the b element (or, again, unwrapped, or have that semantic inserted or removed, as defined by the UA).
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: True if the selection, or the caret, if there is no selection, is, or is contained within, a b element. False otherwise.
Value: The string "true" if the expression given for the "State" above is true, the string "false" otherwise.
createLink
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the a element (or, again, unwrapped, or have that semantic inserted or removed, as defined by the UA). If the user agent creates an a element or modifies an existing a element, then if the showUI argument is present and has the value false, then the value of the value argument must be used as the URL of the link. Otherwise, the user should be prompted for the URL of the link.
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
delete
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had performed a backspace operation.
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
formatBlock

Action: The user agent must run the following steps:

  1. If the value argument wasn't specified, abort these steps without doing anything.

  2. If the value argument has a leading U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN character ('<') and a trailing U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN character ('>'), then remove the first and last characters from value.

  3. If value is (now) an ASCII case-insensitive match for the tag name of an element defined by this specification that is defined to be a prose element but not a phrasing element, then, for every position in the selection, take the furthest flow content ancestor element of that position that contains only phrasing content, and, if that element is editable, and has a content model that allows it to contain prose content other than phrasing content, and has a parent element whose content model allows that parent to contain any prose content, rename the element (as if the Element.renameNode() method had been used) to value, using the HTML namespace.

    If there is no selection, then, where in the description above refers to the selection, the user agent must act as if the selection was an empty range (with just one position) at the caret position.

Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
forwardDelete
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had performed a forward delete operation.
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
insertImage
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the img element (or, again, unwrapped, or have that semantic inserted or removed, as defined by the UA). If the user agent creates an img element or modifies an existing img element, then if the showUI argument is present and has the value false, then the value of the value argument must be used as the URL of the image. Otherwise, the user should be prompted for the URL of the image.
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
insertHTML

Action: The user agent must run the following steps:

  1. If the document is an XML document, then throw an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception and abort these steps.

  2. If the value argument wasn't specified, abort these steps without doing anything.

  3. If there is a selection, act as if the user had requested that the selection be deleted.

  4. Invoke the HTML fragment parsing algorithm with an arbitrary orphan body element as the context element and with the value argument as input.

  5. Insert the nodes returned by the previous step into the document at the location of the caret.

Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
insertLineBreak
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested a line separator.
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
insertOrderedList
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the ol element (or unwrapped, or, if there is no selection, have that semantic inserted or removed — the exact behavior is UA-defined).
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
insertUnorderedList
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the ul element (or unwrapped, or, if there is no selection, have that semantic inserted or removed — the exact behavior is UA-defined).
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
insertParagraph
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had performed a break block editing action.
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
insertText
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had inserted text corresponding to the value parameter.
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
italic
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the i element (or, again, unwrapped, or have that semantic inserted or removed, as defined by the UA).
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: True if the selection, or the caret, if there is no selection, is, or is contained within, a i element. False otherwise.
Value: The string "true" if the expression given for the "State" above is true, the string "false" otherwise.
redo
Action: The user agent must move forward one step in its undo transaction history, restoring the associated state. If the undo position is at the end of the undo transaction history, the user agent must do nothing. See the undo history.
Enabled When: The undo position is not at the end of the undo transaction history.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
selectAll
Action: The user agent must change the selection so that all the content in the currently focused editing host is selected. If no editing host is focused, then the content of the entire document must be selected.
Enabled When: Always.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
subscript
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the sub element (or, again, unwrapped, or have that semantic inserted or removed, as defined by the UA).
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: True if the selection, or the caret, if there is no selection, is, or is contained within, a sub element. False otherwise.
Value: The string "true" if the expression given for the "State" above is true, the string "false" otherwise.
superscript
Action: The user agent must act as if the user had requested that the selection be wrapped in the semantics of the sup element (or unwrapped, or, if there is no selection, have that semantic inserted or removed — the exact behavior is UA-defined).
Enabled When: The document is ready for editing host commands.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: True if the selection, or the caret, if there is no selection, is, or is contained within, a sup element. False otherwise.
Value: The string "true" if the expression given for the "State" above is true, the string "false" otherwise.
undo
Action: The user agent must move back one step in its undo transaction history, restoring the associated state. If the undo position is at the start of the undo transaction history, the user agent must do nothing. See the undo history.
Enabled When: The undo position is not at the start of the undo transaction history.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
unlink
Action: The user agent must remove all a elements that have href attributes and that are partially or completely included in the current selection.
Enabled When: The document has a selection that is entirely within an editing host and that contains (either partially or completely) at least one a element that has an href attribute.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
unselect
Action: The user agent must change the selection so that nothing is selected.
Enabled When: Always.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".
vendorID-customCommandID
Action: User agents may implement vendor-specific extensions to this API. Vendor-specific extensions to the list of commands should use the syntax vendorID-customCommandID so as to prevent clashes between extensions from different vendors and future additions to this specification.
Enabled When: UA-defined.
Indeterminate When: UA-defined.
State: UA-defined.
Value: UA-defined.
その他のもの
Action: User agents must do nothing.
Enabled When: Never.
Indeterminate When: Never.
State: Always false.
Value: Always the string "false".

7. 通信

7.1 事象定義

鯖送信事象Web ソケット文書間メッセージ交換通信路メッセージ交換のメッセージはmessage 事象を使います。

次の界面はこの事象のために定義されています。

interface MessageEvent : Event {
  readonly attribute DOMString data;
  readonly attribute DOMString origin;
  readonly attribute DOMString lastEventId;
  readonly attribute Window source;
  readonly attribute MessagePort messagePort;
  void initMessageEvent(in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMString dataArg, in DOMString originArg, in DOMString lastEventIdArg, in Window sourceArg, in MessagePort messagePortArg);
  void initMessageEventNS(in DOMString namespaceURI, in DOMString typeArg, in boolean canBubbleArg, in boolean cancelableArg, in DOMString dataArg, in DOMString originArg, in DOMString lastEventIdArg, in Window sourceArg, in MessagePort messagePortArg);
};

initMessageEvent() メソッドと initMessageEventNS() メソッドは、 DOM3 事象界面の似たような名前のメソッドと同じような方法で事象を初期化しなければなりません[DOM3EVENTS]

data 属性は送信されたメッセージを表します。

origin 属性は、 鯖送信事象文書間メッセージ交換において、メッセージを送信した文書の起源 (普通は当該文書の scheme と hostname と port で、 path や素片識別子は含みません。) を表します。

lastEventId 属性は、鯖送信事象において、 事象源の最終事象識別子文字列を表します。

source 属性は、 文書間メッセージ交換において、 メッセージが送られて来た元の Window を表します。

messagePort 属性は、文書間メッセージ交換通信路メッセージ交換において、 送信された MessagePort があれば、 それを表します。

特に規定がない場合、利用者エージェントが以後の節で説明する算法の中で message 事象を作成して発送する時に、 lastEventId 属性は空文字列でなければならずorigin 属性は空文字列でなければならずsource 属性は null でなければならずmessagePort 属性は null でなければなりません


Tasks in server-sent events and Web Sockets use their own task sources, but the task source for the tasks in cross-document messaging and channel messaging is the posted message task source.

7.2 鯖送信事象

この節は、鯖が事象を待ち受けている文書の中に DOM 事象を発送できるようにする仕組みを説明します。 eventsource 要素はこの仕組みに対する単純な界面を提供しています。

7.2.1 RemoteEventTarget 界面

EventTarget 界面を実装するオブジェクトは、 RemoteEventTarget 界面も実装しなければなりません

interface RemoteEventTarget {
  void addEventSource(in DOMString src);
  void removeEventSource(in DOMString src);
};

addEventSource(src) メソッドが呼び出された時、利用者エージェントは src に指定された URL解決し、 それが成功した場合、得られた絶対 URL をそのオブジェクトの事象源のリストに追加しなければなりません。 同じ URL を何度も登録することができます。 URL の解決に失敗した場合は、利用者エージェントは SYNTAX_ERR 例外を発生させなければなりません

removeEventSource(src) メソッドが呼び出された時、利用者エージェントは src に指定された URL解決し、 それが成功した場合、得られた絶対 URL をそのオブジェクトの事象源のリストからさ駆除しなければなりません。 同じ URI が複数回登録されている場合、 removeEventSource() メソッドを呼び出す時に削除するのはその URI の1つの実現値だけを削除しなければなりません。 URL の解決に失敗した場合は、利用者エージェントは何もしません。

7.2.2 事象ストリームへの接続

Each object implementing the EventTarget and RemoteEventTarget interfaces has a list of event sources that are registered for that object.

When a new absolute URL is added to this list, the user agent should queue a task to run the following steps with the new absolute URL:

  1. If the entry for the new absolute URL has been removed from the list, then abort these steps.

  2. Fetch the resource identified by that absolute URL.

    As data is received, the tasks queued by the networking task source to handle the data must consist of following the rules given in the following sections.

When an event source is removed from the list of event sources for an object, if that resource is still being fetched, then the relevant connection must be closed.

Since connections established to remote servers for such resources are expected to be long-lived, UAs should ensure that appropriate buffering is used. In particular, while line buffering may be safe if lines are defined to end with a single U+000A LINE FEED character, block buffering or line buffering with different expected line endings can cause delays in event dispatch.

Each event source in the list must have associated with it the following:

In general, the semantics of the transport protocol specified by the URLs for the event sources must be followed, including HTTP caching rules.

For HTTP connections, the Accept header may be included; if included, it must contain only formats of event framing that are supported by the user agent (one of which must be text/event-stream, as described below).

Other formats of event framing may also be supported in addition to text/event-stream, but this specification does not define how they are to be parsed or processed.

Such formats could include systems like SMS-push; for example servers could use Accept headers and HTTP redirects to an SMS-push mechanism as a kind of protocol negotiation to reduce network load in GSM environments.

User agents should use the Cache-Control: no-cache header in requests to bypass any caches for requests of event sources.

If the event source's last event ID string is not the empty string, then a Last-Event-ID HTTP header must be included with the request, whose value is the value of the event source's last event ID string.

For connections to domains other than the document's domain, the semantics of the Access-Control HTTP header must be followed. [ACCESSCONTROL]

HTTP 200 OK responses with a Content-Type header specifying the type text/event-stream that are either from the document's domain or explicitly allowed by the Access-Control HTTP headers must be processed line by line as described below.

For the purposes of such successfully opened event streams only, user agents should ignore HTTP cache headers, and instead assume that the resource indicates that it does not wish to be cached.

If such a resource completes loading (i.e. the entire HTTP response body is received or the connection itself closes), the user agent should request the event source resource again after a delay equal to the reconnection time of the event source.

HTTP 200 OK responses that have a Content-Type other than text/event-stream (or some other supported type), and HTTP responses whose Access-Control headers indicate that the resource are not to be used, must be ignored and must prevent the user agent from refetching the resource for that event source.

HTTP 201 Created, 202 Accepted, 203 Non-Authoritative Information, and 206 Partial Content responses must be treated like HTTP 200 OK responses for the purposes of reopening event source resources. They are, however, likely to indicate an error has occurred somewhere and may cause the user agent to emit a warning.

HTTP 204 No Content, and 205 Reset Content responses must be treated as if they were 200 OK responses with the right MIME type but no content, and should therefore cause the user agent to refetch the resource after a delay equal to the reconnection time of the event source.

HTTP 300 Multiple Choices responses should be handled automatically if possible (treating the responses as if they were 302 Found responses pointing to the appropriate resource), and otherwise must be treated as HTTP 404 responses.

HTTP 301 Moved Permanently responses must cause the user agent to reconnect using the new server specified URL instead of the previously specified URL for all subsequent requests for this event source. (It doesn't affect other event sources with the same URL unless they also receive 301 responses, and it doesn't affect future sessions, e.g. if the page is reloaded.)

HTTP 302 Found, 303 See Other, and 307 Temporary Redirect responses must cause the user agent to connect to the new server-specified URL, but if the user agent needs to again request the resource at a later point, it must return to the previously specified URL for this event source.

HTTP 304 Not Modified responses should be handled like HTTP 200 OK responses, with the content coming from the user agent cache. A new request should then be made after a delay equal to the reconnection time of the event source.

HTTP 305 Use Proxy, HTTP 401 Unauthorized, and 407 Proxy Authentication Required should be treated transparently as for any other subresource.

Any other HTTP response code not listed here should cause the user agent to stop trying to process this event source.

DNS errors must be considered fatal, and cause the user agent to not open any connection for that event source.

For non-HTTP protocols, UAs should act in equivalent ways.

7.2.3 Parsing an event stream

This event stream format's MIME type is text/event-stream.

The event stream format is (in pseudo-BNF):

<stream>          ::= <bom>? <event>*
<event>           ::= [ <comment> | <field> ]* <newline>
<comment>         ::= <colon> <any-char>* <newline>
<field>           ::= <name-char>+ [ <colon> <space>? <any-char>* ]? <newline>

# characters:
<bom>             ::= a single U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK character
<space>           ::= a single U+0020 SPACE character (' ')
<newline>         ::= a U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN character
                      followed by a U+000A LINE FEED character
                      | a single U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN character
                      | a single U+000A LINE FEED character
                      | the end of the file
<colon>           ::= a single U+003A COLON character (':')
<name-char>       ::= a single Unicode character other than
                      U+003A COLON, U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN and U+000A LINE FEED
<any-char>        ::= a single Unicode character other than
                      U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN and U+000A LINE FEED

Event streams in this format must always be encoded as UTF-8.

Lines must be separated by either a U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN U+000A LINE FEED (CRLF) character pair, a single U+000A LINE FEED (LF) character, or a single U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) character.

7.2.4 Interpreting an event stream

Bytes or sequences of bytes that are not valid UTF-8 sequences must be interpreted as the U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER.

One leading U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK character must be ignored if any are present.

The stream must then be parsed by reading everything line by line, with a U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN U+000A LINE FEED (CRLF) character pair, a single U+000A LINE FEED (LF) character, a single U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) character, and the end of the file being the four ways in which a line can end.

When a stream is parsed, a data buffer and an event name buffer must be associated with it. They must be initialized to the empty string

Lines must be processed, in the order they are received, as follows:

If the line is empty (a blank line)

Dispatch the event, as defined below.

If the line starts with a U+003A COLON character (':')

Ignore the line.

If the line contains a U+003A COLON character (':') character

Collect the characters on the line before the first U+003A COLON character (':'), and let field be that string.

Collect the characters on the line after the first U+003A COLON character (':'), and let value be that string. If value starts with a single U+0020 SPACE character, remove it from value.

Process the field using the steps described below, using field as the field name and value as the field value.

Otherwise, the string is not empty but does not contain a U+003A COLON character (':') character

Process the field using the steps described below, using the whole line as the field name, and the empty string as the field value.

Once the end of the file is reached, the user agent must dispatch the event one final time, as defined below.

The steps to process the field given a field name and a field value depend on the field name, as given in the following list. Field names must be compared literally, with no case folding performed.

If the field name is "event"

Set the event name buffer the to field value.

If the field name is "data"

If the data buffer is not the empty string, then append a single U+000A LINE FEED character to the data buffer. Append the field value to the data buffer.

If the field name is "id"

Set the event stream's last event ID to the field value.

If the field name is "retry"

If the field value consists of only characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ('0') U+0039 DIGIT NINE ('9'), then interpret the field value as an integer in base ten, and set the event stream's reconnection time to that integer. Otherwise, ignore the field.

その他の場合

The field is ignored.

When the user agent is required to dispatch the event, then the user agent must act as follows:

  1. If the data buffer is an empty string, set the data buffer and the event name buffer to the empty string and abort these steps.

  2. If the event name buffer is not the empty string but is also not a valid NCName, set the data buffer and the event name buffer to the empty string and abort these steps.

  3. Otherwise, create an event that uses the MessageEvent interface, with the event name message, which does not bubble, is cancelable, and has no default action. The data attribute must be set to the value of the data buffer, the origin attribute must be set to the Unicode serialization of the origin of the event stream's URL, and the lastEventId attribute must be set to the last event ID string of the event source.

  4. If the event name buffer has a value other than the empty string, change the type of the newly created event to equal the value of the event name buffer.

  5. Set the data buffer and the event name buffer to the empty string.

  6. Queue a task to dispatch the newly created event at the RemoteEventTarget object to which the event stream is registered. The task source for this task is the remote event task source.

If an event doesn't have an "id" field, but an earlier event did set the event source's last event ID string, then the event's lastEventId field will be set to the value of whatever the last seen "id" field was.

The following event stream, once followed by a blank line:

data: YHOO
data: -2
data: 10

...would cause an event message with the interface MessageEvent to be dispatched on the eventsource element, whose data attribute would contain the string YHOO\n-2\n10 (where \n represents a newline).

This could be used as follows:

<eventsource src="http://stocks.example.com/ticker.php"
              onmessage="var data = event.data.split('\n'); updateStocks(data[0], data[1], data[2]);">

...where updateStocks() is a function defined as:

function updateStocks(symbol, delta, value) { ... }

...or some such.

The following stream contains four blocks. The first block has just a comment, and will fire nothing. The second block has two fields with names "data" and "id" respectively; an event will be fired for this block, with the data "first event", and will then set the last event ID to "1" so that if the connection died between this block and the next, the server would be sent a Last-Event-ID header with the value "1". The third block fires an event with data "second event", and also has an "id" field, this time with no value, which resets the last event ID to the empty string (meaning no Last-Event-ID header will now be sent in the event of a reconnection being attempted). Finally the last block just fires an event with the data "third event". Note that the last block doesn't have to end with a blank line, the end of the stream is enough to trigger the dispatch of the last event.

: test stream

data: first event
id: 1

data: second event
id

data: third event

The following stream fires just one event:

data

data
data

data:

The first and last blocks do nothing, since they do not contain any actual data (the data buffer remains at the empty string, and so nothing gets dispatched). The middle block fires an event with the data set to a single newline character.

The following stream fires two identical events:

data:test

data: test

This is because the space after the colon is ignored if present.

7.2.5 Notes

Legacy proxy servers are known to, in certain cases, drop HTTP connections after a short timeout. To protect against such proxy servers, authors can include a comment line (one starting with a ':' character) every 15 seconds or so.

Authors wishing to relate event source connections to each other or to specific documents previously served might find that relying on IP addresses doesn't work, as individual clients can have multiple IP addresses (due to having multiple proxy servers) and individual IP addresses can have multiple clients (due to sharing a proxy server). It is better to include a unique identifier in the document when it is served and then pass that identifier as part of the URL in the src attribute of the eventsource element.

Implementations that support HTTP's per-server connection limitation might run into trouble when opening multiple pages from a site if each page has an eventsource to the same domain. Authors can avoid this using the relatively complex mechanism of using unique domain names per connection, or by allowing the user to enable or disable the eventsource functionality on a per-page basis.

7.3 Web sockets

To enable Web applications to maintain bidirectional communications with their originating server, this specification introduces the WebSocket interface.

This interface does not allow for raw access to the underlying network. For example, this interface could not be used to implement an IRC client without proxying messages through a custom server.

7.3.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

An introduction to the client-side and server-side of using the direct connection APIs.

7.3.2 WebSocket 界面

[Constructor(in DOMString url)]
interface WebSocket {
  readonly attribute DOMString URL;

  // ready state
  const unsigned short CONNECTING = 0;
  const unsigned short OPEN = 1;
  const unsigned short CLOSED = 2;
  readonly attribute int readyState;

  // networking
           attribute EventListener onopen;
           attribute EventListener onmessage;
           attribute EventListener onclosed;
  void postMessage(in DOMString data);
  void disconnect();
};

WebSocket objects must also implement the EventTarget interface. [DOM3EVENTS]

The WebSocket(url) constructor takes one argument, url, which specifies the URL to which to connect. When a WebSocket object is created, the UA must parse this argument and verify that the URL parses without failure and has a <scheme> component whose value is either "ws" or "wss", when compared in an ASCII case-insensitive manner. If it does, it has, and it is, then the user agent must asynchronously establish a Web Socket connection to url. Otherwise, the constructor must raise a SYNTAX_ERR exception.

The URL attribute must return the value that was passed to the constructor.

The readyState attribute represents the state of the connection. It can have the following values:

CONNECTING (数値 0)
The connection has not yet been established.
OPEN (数値 1)
The Web Socket connection is established and communication is possible.
CLOSED (数値 2)
The connection has been closed or could not be opened.

When the object is created its readyState must be set to CONNECTING (0).

The postMessage(data) method transmits data using the connection. If the connection is not established (readyState is not OPEN), it must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception. If the connection is established, then the user agent must send data using the Web Socket.

The disconnect() method must close the Web Socket connection or connection attempt, if any. If the connection is already closed, it must do nothing. Closing the connection causes a close event to be fired and the readyState attribute's value to change, as described below.

7.3.3 WebSocket Events

The open event is fired when the Web Socket connection is established.

The close event is fired when the connection is closed (whether by the author, calling the disconnect() method, or by the server, or by a network error).

No information regarding why the connection was closed is passed to the application in this version of this specification.

The message event is fired when when data is received for a connection.


The following are the event handler DOM attributes that must be supported by objects implementing the WebSocket interface:

onopen

Must be invoked whenever an open event is targeted at or bubbles through the WebSocket object.

onmessage

message 事象が当該 WebSocket オブジェクトを対象としているか、泡立って当該オブジェクトを通過する時に、 呼び出されなければなりません。

onclosed

Must be invoked whenever an closed event is targeted at or bubbles through the WebSocket object.

7.3.4 The Web Socket protocol

The task source for all tasks queued by algorithms in this section and its subsections is the Web Socket task source.

7.3.4.1. Client-side requirements

This section only applies to user agents.

7.3.4.1.1. Handshake

When the user agent is to establish a Web Socket connection to url, it must run the following steps, in the background (without blocking scripts or anything like that):

  1. Resolve the URL url.

  2. If the <scheme> component of the resulting absolute URL is "ws", set secure to false; otherwise, the <scheme> component is "wss", set secure to true.

  3. Let host be the value of the <host> component in the resulting absolute URL.

  4. If the resulting absolute URL has a <port> component, then let port be that component's value; otherwise, if secure is false, let port be 81, otherwise let port be 815.

  5. Let resource name be the value of the <path> component (which might be empty) in the resulting absolute URL.

  6. If resource name is the empty string, set it to a single character U+002F SOLIDUS (/).

  7. If the resulting absolute URL has a <query> component, then append a single 003F QUESTION MARK (?) character to resource name, followed by the value of the <query> component.

  8. If the user agent is configured to use a proxy to connect to port port, then connect to that proxy and ask it to open a TCP/IP connection to the host given by host and the port given by port.

    For example, if the user agent uses an HTTP proxy, then if it was to try to connect to port 80 on server example.com, it might send the following lines to the proxy server:

    CONNECT example.com HTTP/1.1

    If there was a password, the connection might look like:

    CONNECT example.com HTTP/1.1
    Proxy-authorization: Basic ZWRuYW1vZGU6bm9jYXBlcyE=

    Otherwise, if the user agent is not configured to use a proxy, then open a TCP/IP connection to the host given by host and the port given by port.

  9. If the connection could not be opened, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.

  10. If secure is true, perform a TLS handshake over the connection. If this fails (e.g. the server's certificate could not be verified), then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps. Otherwise, all further communication on this channel must run through the encrypted tunnel. [RFC2246]

  11. Send the following bytes to the remote side (the server):

    47 45 54 20

    Send the resource name value, encoded as US-ASCII.

    Send the following bytes:

    20 48 54 54 50 2f 31 2e  31 0d 0a 55 70 67 72 61
    64 65 3a 20 57 65 62 53  6f 63 6b 65 74 0d 0a 43
    6f 6e 6e 65 63 74 69 6f  6e 3a 20 55 70 67 72 61
    64 65 0d 0a

    The string "GET ", the path, " HTTP/1.1", CRLF, the string "Upgrade: WebSocket", CRLF, and the string "Connection: Upgrade", CRLF.

  12. Send the following bytes:

    48 6f 73 74 3a 20

    Send the host value, encoded as US-ASCII, if it represents a host name (and not an IP address).

    Send the following bytes:

    0d 0a

    The string "Host: ", the host, and CRLF.

  13. Send the following bytes:

    4f 72 69 67 69 6e 3a 20

    Send the ASCII serialization of the origin of the script that invoked the WebSocket() constructor.

    Send the following bytes:

    0d 0a

    The string "Origin: ", the origin, and CRLF.

  14. If the client has any authentication information or cookies that would be relevant to a resource with a URL that has a scheme of http if secure is false and https if secure is true and is otherwise identical to url, then HTTP headers that would be appropriate for that information should be sent at this point. [RFC2616] [RFC2109] [RFC2965]

    Each header must be on a line of its own (each ending with a CR LF sequence). For the purposes of this step, each header must not be split into multiple lines (despite HTTP otherwise allowing this with continuation lines).

    For example, if the server had a username and password that applied to that URL, it could send:

    Authorization: Basic d2FsbGU6ZXZl
  15. Send the following bytes:

    0d 0a

    Just a CRLF (a blank line).

  16. Read the first 85 bytes from the server. If the connection closes before 85 bytes are received, or if the first 85 bytes aren't exactly equal to the following bytes, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.

    48 54 54 50 2f 31 2e 31  20 31 30 31 20 57 65 62
    20 53 6f 63 6b 65 74 20  50 72 6f 74 6f 63 6f 6c
    20 48 61 6e 64 73 68 61  6b 65 0d 0a 55 70 67 72
    61 64 65 3a 20 57 65 62  53 6f 63 6b 65 74 0d 0a
    43 6f 6e 6e 65 63 74 69  6f 6e 3a 20 55 70 67 72
    61 64 65 0d 0a

    The string "HTTP/1.1 101 Web Socket Protocol Handshake", CRLF, the string "Upgrade: WebSocket", CRLF, the string "Connection: Upgrade", CRLF.

    What if the response is a 401 asking for credentials?

  17. Let headers be a list of name-value pairs, initially empty.

  18. Header: Let name and value be empty byte arrays.

  19. Read a byte from the server.

    If the connection closes before this byte is received, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.

    Otherwise, handle the byte as described in the appropriate entry below:

    If the byte is 0x0d (ASCII CR)
    If the name byte array is empty, then jump to the headers processing step. Otherwise, fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.
    If the byte is 0x0a (ASCII LF)
    Fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.
    If the byte is 0x3a (ASCII ":")
    Move on to the next step.
    If the byte is in the range 0x41 .. 0x5a (ASCII "A" .. "Z")
    Append a byte whose value is the byte's value plus 0x20 to the name byte array and redo this step for the next byte.
    その他の場合
    Append the byte to the name byte array and redo this step for the next byte.

    This reads a header name, terminated by a colon, converting upper-case ASCII letters to lowercase, and aborting if a stray CR or LF is found.

  20. Read a byte from the server.

    If the connection closes before this byte is received, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.

    Otherwise, handle the byte as described in the appropriate entry below:

    If the byte is 0x20 (ASCII space)
    Ignore the byte and move on to the next step.
    その他の場合
    Treat the byte as described by the list in the next step, then move on to that next step for real.

    This skips past a space character after the colon, if necessary.

  21. Read a byte from the server.

    If the connection closes before this byte is received, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.

    Otherwise, handle the byte as described in the appropriate entry below:

    If the byte is 0x0d (ASCII CR)
    Move on to the next step.
    If the byte is 0x0a (ASCII LF)
    Fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.
    その他の場合
    Append the byte to the name byte array and redo this step for the next byte.

    This reads a header value, terminated by a CRLF.

  22. Read a byte from the server.

    If the connection closes before this byte is received, or if the byte is not a 0x0a byte (ASCII LF), then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.

    This skips past the LF byte of the CRLF after the header.

  23. Append an entry to the headers list that has the name given by the string obtained by interpreting the name byte array as a UTF-8 byte stream and the value given by the string obtained by interpreting the value byte array as a UTF-8 byte stream.

  24. Return to the header step above.

  25. Headers processing: If there is not exactly one entry in the headers list whose name is "websocket-origin", or if there is not exactly one entry in the headers list whose name is "websocket-location", or if there are any entries in the headers list whose names are the empty string, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.

  26. Handle each entry in the headers list as follows:

    If the entry's name is "websocket-origin"
    If the value is not exactly equal to the ASCII serialization of the origin of the script that invoked the WebSocket() constructor, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.
    If the entry's name is "websocket-location"
    If the value is not exactly equal to the absolute URL that resulted from the first step of ths algorithm, then fail the Web Socket connection and abort these steps.
    If the entry's name is "set-cookie" or "set-cookie2" or another cookie-related header name
    Handle the cookie as defined by the appropriate spec, except pretend that the resource's URL actually has a scheme of http if secure is false and https if secure is true and is otherwise identical to url. [RFC2109] [RFC2965]
    Any other name
    Ignore it.
  27. Change the readyState attribute's value to OPEN (1).

  28. Queue a task to fire a simple event named open at the WebSocket object.

  29. The Web Socket connection is established. Now the user agent must send and receive to and from the connection as described in the next section.

To fail the Web Socket connection, the user agent must close the Web Socket connection, and may report the problem to the user (which would be especially useful for developers). However, user agents must not convey the failure information to the script in a way distinguishable from the Web Socket being closed normally.

7.3.4.1.2. Data framing

Once a Web Socket connection is established, the user agent must run through the following state machine for the bytes sent by the server.

  1. Try to read a byte from the server. Let frame type be that byte.

    If no byte could be read because the Web Socket connection is closed, then abort.

  2. Handle the frame type byte as follows:

    If the high-order bit of the frame type byte is set (i.e. if frame type anded with 0x80 returns 0x80)

    Run these steps. If at any point during these steps a read is attempted but fails because the Web Socket connection is closed, then abort.

    1. Let length be zero.

    2. Length: Read a byte, let b be that byte.

    3. Let bv be integer corresponding to the low 7 bits of b (the value you would get by anding b with 0x7f).

    4. Multiply length by 128, add bv to that result, and store the final result in length.

    5. If the high-order bit of b is set (i.e. if b anded with 0x80 returns 0x80), then return to the step above labeled length.

    6. Read length bytes.

    7. Discard the read bytes.

    If the high-order bit of the frame type byte is not set (i.e. if frame type anded with 0x80 returns 0x00)

    Run these steps. If at any point during these steps a read is attempted but fails because the Web Socket connection is closed, then abort.

    1. Let raw data be an empty byte array.

    2. Data: Read a byte, let b be that byte.

    3. If b is not 0xff, then append b to raw data and return to the previous step (labeled data).

    4. Interpret raw data as a UTF-8 string, and store that string in data.

    5. If frame type is 0x00, create an event that uses the MessageEvent interface, with the event name message, which does not bubble, is cancelable, has no default action, and whose data attribute is set to data, and queue a task to dispatch it at the WebSocket object. Otherwise, discard the data.

  3. Return to the first step to read the next byte.

If the user agent is faced with content that is too large to be handled appropriately, then it must fail the Web Socket connection.


Once a Web Socket connection is established, the user agent must use the following steps to send data using the Web Socket:

  1. Send a 0x00 byte to the server.

  2. Encode data using UTF-8 and send the resulting byte stream to the server.

  3. Send a 0xff byte to the server.

People often request the ability to send binary blobs over this API; also, once the other postMessage() methods support it, we should look into allowing name/value pairs, arrays, and numbers using postMessage() instead of just strings and binary data.

7.3.4.2. Server-side requirements

This section only applies to servers.

7.3.4.2.1. Minimal handshake

This section describes the minimal requirements for a server-side implementation of Web Sockets.

Listen on a port for TCP/IP. Upon receiving a connection request, open a connection and send the following bytes back to the client:

48 54 54 50 2f 31 2e 31  20 31 30 31 20 57 65 62
20 53 6f 63 6b 65 74 20  50 72 6f 74 6f 63 6f 6c
20 48 61 6e 64 73 68 61  6b 65 0d 0a 55 70 67 72
61 64 65 3a 20 57 65 62  53 6f 63 6b 65 74 0d 0a
43 6f 6e 6e 65 63 74 69  6f 6e 3a 20 55 70 67 72
61 64 65 0d 0a

Send the string "WebSocket-Origin" followed by a U+003A COLON (":") followed by the ASCII serialization of the origin from which the server is willing to accept connections, followed by a CRLF pair (0x0d 0x0a).

For instance:

WebSocket-Origin: http://example.com

Send the string "WebSocket-Location" followed by a U+003A COLON (":") followed by the URL of the Web Socket script, followed by a CRLF pair (0x0d 0x0a).

For instance:

WebSocket-Location: ws://example.com:80/demo

Send another CRLF pair (0x0d 0x0a).

Read (and discard) data from the client until four bytes 0x0d 0x0a 0x0d 0x0a are read.

If the connection isn't dropped at this point, go to the data framing section.

7.3.4.2.2. Handshake details

The previous section ignores the data that is transmitted by the client during the handshake.

The data sent by the client consists of a number of fields separated by CR LF pairs (bytes 0x0d 0x0a).

The first field consists of three tokens separated by space characters (byte 0x20). The middle token is the path being opened. If the server supports multiple paths, then the server should echo the value of this field in the initial handshake, as part of the URL given on the WebSocket-Location line (after the appropriate scheme and host).

The remaining fields consist of name-value pairs, with the name part separated from the value part by a colon and a space (bytes 0x3a 0x20). Of these, several are interesting:

Host (bytes 48 6f 73 74)

The value gives the hostname that the client intended to use when opening the Web Socket. It would be of interest in particular to virtual hosting environments, where one server might serve multiple hosts, and might therefore want to return different data.

The right host has to be output as part of the URL given on the WebSocket-Location line of the handshake described above, to verify that the server knows that it is really representing that host.

Origin (bytes 4f 72 69 67 69 6e)

The value gives the scheme, hostname, and port (if it's not the default port for the given scheme) of the page that asked the client to open the Web Socket. It would be interesting if the server's operator had deals with operators of other sites, since the server could then decide how to respond (or indeed, whether to respond) based on which site was requesting a connection.

If the server supports connections from more than one origin, then the server should echo the value of this field in the initial handshake, on the WebSocket-Origin line.

Other fields

Other fields can be used, such as "Cookie" or "Authorization", for authentication purposes.

7.3.4.2.3. Data framing

This section only describes how to handle content that this specification allows user agents to send (text). It doesn't handle any arbitrary content in the same way that the requirements on user agents defined earlier handle any content including possible future extensions to the protocols.

The server should run through the following steps to process the bytes sent by the client:

  1. Read a byte from the client. Assuming everything is going according to plan, it will be a 0x00 byte. Behaviour for the server is undefined if the byte is not 0x00.

  2. Let raw data be an empty byte array.

  3. Data: Read a byte, let b be that byte.

  4. If b is not 0xff, then append b to raw data and return to the previous step (labeled data).

  5. Interpret raw data as a UTF-8 string, and apply whatever server-specific processing should occur for the resulting string.

  6. Return to the first step to read the next byte.


The server should run through the followin steps to send strings to the client:

  1. Send a 0x00 byte to the client to indicate the start of a string.

  2. Encode data using UTF-8 and send the resulting byte stream to the client.

  3. Send a 0xff byte to the client to indicate the end of the message.

7.3.4.3. Closing the connection

To close the Web Socket connection, either the user agent or the server closes the TCP/IP connection. There is no closing handshake. Whether the user agent or the server closes the connection, it is said that the Web Socket connection is closed.

Servers may close the Web Socket connection whenever desired.

User agents should not close the Web Socket connection arbitrarily.

When the Web Socket connection is closed, the readyState attribute's value must be changed to CLOSED (2), and the user agent must queue a task to fire a simple event named close at the WebSocket object.

7.4 Cross-document messaging

Web browsers, for security and privacy reasons, prevent documents in different domains from affecting each other; that is, cross-site scripting is disallowed.

While this is an important security feature, it prevents pages from different domains from communicating even when those pages are not hostile. This section introduces a messaging system that allows documents to communicate with each other regardless of their source domain, in a way designed to not enable cross-site scripting attacks.

7.4.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

For example, if document A contains an iframe element that contains document B, and script in document A calls postMessage() on the Window object of document B, then a message event will be fired on that object, marked as originating from the Window of document A. The script in document A might look like:

var o = document.getElementsByTagName('iframe')[0];
o.contentWindow.postMessage('Hello world', 'http://b.example.org/');

To register an event handler for incoming events, the script would use addEventListener() (or similar mechanisms). For example, the script in document B might look like:

window.addEventListener('message', receiver, false);
function receiver(e) {
  if (e.origin == 'http://example.com') {
    if (e.data == 'Hello world') {
      e.source.postMessage('Hello', e.origin);
    } else {
      alert(e.data);
    }
  }
}

This script first checks the domain is the expected domain, and then looks at the message, which it either displays to the user, or responds to by sending a message back to the document which sent the message in the first place.

7.4.2 保安性

7.4.2.1. Authors

Use of this API requires extra care to protect users from hostile entities abusing a site for their own purposes.

Authors should check the origin attribute to ensure that messages are only accepted from domains that they expect to receive messages from. Otherwise, bugs in the author's message handling code could be exploited by hostile sites.

Authors should not use the wildcard keyword ("*") in the targetOrigin argument in messages that contain any confidential information, as otherwise there is no way to guarantee that the message is only delivered to the recipient to which it was intended.

7.4.2.2. User agents

The integrity of this API is based on the inability for scripts of one origin to post arbitrary events (using dispatchEvent() or otherwise) to objects in other origins (those that are not the same).

Implementors are urged to take extra care in the implementation of this feature. It allows authors to transmit information from one domain to another domain, which is normally disallowed for security reasons. It also requires that UAs be careful to allow access to certain properties but not others.

7.4.3 Posting text

When a script invokes the postMessage(message, targetOrigin) method (with only two arguments) on a Window object, the user agent must follow these steps:

  1. If the value of the targetOrigin argument is not a single U+002A ASTERISK character ("*"), and parsing it as a URL fails, then throw a SYNTAX_ERR exception and abort the overall set of steps.

  2. Return from the postMessage() method, but asynchronously continue running these steps.

  3. If the targetOrigin argument has a value other than a single literal U+002A ASTERISK character ("*"), and the active document of the browsing context of the Window object on which the method was invoked does not have the same origin as targetOrigin, then abort these steps silently.

  4. Create an event that uses the MessageEvent interface, with the event name message, which does not bubble, is cancelable, and has no default action. The data attribute must be set to the value passed as the message argument to the postMessage() method, the origin attribute must be set to the Unicode serialization of the origin of the script that invoked the method, and the source attribute must be set to the Window object of the default view of the browsing context for which the Document object with which the script is associated is the active document.

  5. Queue a task to dispatch the event created in the previous step at the Window object on which the method was invoked. The task source for this task is the posted message task source.

7.4.4 Posting message ports

When a script invokes the postMessage(message, messagePort, targetOrigin) method (with three arguments) on a Window object, the user agent must follow these steps:

  1. If the value of the targetOrigin argument is not a single U+002A ASTERISK character ("*"), and parsing it as a URL fails, then throw a SYNTAX_ERR exception and abort the overall set of steps.

  2. If the messagePort argument is null, then act as if the method had just been called with two arguments, message and targetOrigin.

  3. Try to obtain a new port by cloning the messagePort argument with the Window object on which the method was invoked as the owner of the clone. If this returns an exception, then throw that exception and abort these steps.

  4. Return from the postMessage() method, but asynchronously continue running these steps.

  5. If the targetOrigin argument has a value other than a single literal U+002A ASTERISK character ("*"), and the active document of the browsing context of the Window object on which the method was invoked does not have the same origin as targetOrigin, then abort these steps silently.

  6. Create an event that uses the MessageEvent interface, with the event name message, which does not bubble, is cancelable, and has no default action. The data attribute must be set to the value passed as the message argument to the postMessage() method, the origin attribute must be set to the Unicode serialization of the origin of the script that invoked the method, and the source attribute must be set to the Window object of the default view of the browsing context for which the Document object with which the script is associated is the active document.

  7. Let the messagePort attribute of the event be the new port.

  8. Queue a task to dispatch the event created in the previous step at the Window object on which the method was invoked. The task source for this task is the posted message task source.

These steps, with the exception of the second and third steps and the penultimate step, are identical to those in the previous section.

7.4.5 Posting structured data

People often request the ability to send name/value pairs, arrays, and numbers using postMessage() instead of just strings.

7.5 Channel messaging

7.5.1 はじめに

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

An introduction to the channel and port APIs.

7.5.2 Message channels

[Constructor]
interface MessageChannel {
  readonly attribute MessagePort port1;
  readonly attribute MessagePort port2;
};

When the MessageChannel() constructor is called, it must run the following algorithm:

  1. Create a new MessagePort object owned by the script execution context, and let port1 be that object.

  2. Create a new MessagePort object owned by the script execution context, and let port2 be that object.

  3. Entangle the port1 and port2 objects.

  4. Instantiate a new MessageChannel object, and let channel be that object.

  5. Let the port1 attribute of the channel object be port1.

  6. Let the port2 attribute of the channel object be port2.

  7. Return channel.

The port1 and port2 attributes must return the values they were assigned when the MessageChannel object was created.

7.5.3 Message ports

Each channel has two message ports. Data sent through one port is received by the other port, and vice versa.

interface MessagePort {
  readonly attribute boolean active;
  boolean postMessage(in DOMString message);
  boolean postMessage(in DOMString message, in MessagePort messagePort);
  MessagePort startConversation(in DOMString message);
  void start();
  void close();

  // event handler attributes
           attribute EventListener onmessage;
           attribute EventListener onunload;
};

Objects implementing the MessagePort interface must also implement the EventTarget interface.

Each MessagePort object can be entangled with another (a symmetric relationship). Each MessagePort object also has a port message queue, initial empty. A port message queue can be open or closed, and is initially closed.

When the user agent is to create a new MessagePort object owned by a script execution context object owner, it must instantiate a new MessagePort object, and let its owner be owner.


When the user agent is to entangle two MessagePort objects, it must run the following steps:

  1. If one of the ports is already entangled, then unentangle it and the port that it was entangled with.

    If those two previously entangled ports were the two ports of a MessageChannel object, then that MessageChannel object no longer represents an actual channel: the two ports in that object are no longer entangled.

  2. Associate the two ports to be entangled, so that they form the two parts of a new channel. (There is no MessageChannel object that represents this channel.)


When the user agent is to clone a port original port, with the clone being owned by owner, it must run the following steps, which return either a new MessagePort object or an exception for the caller to raise:

  1. If the original port is not entangled without another port, then return an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception and abort all these steps.

  2. Let the remote port be the port with which the original port is entangled.

  3. Create a new MessagePort object owned by owner, and let new port be that object.

  4. Move all the events in the port message queue of original port to the port message queue of new port, if any, leaving the new port's port message queue in its initial closed state.

  5. Entangle the remote port and new port objects. The original port object will be unentangled by this process.

  6. Return new port. It is the clone.


The active attribute must return true if the port is entangled, and false otherwise.


The postMessage() method, when called on a port source port, must cause the user agent to run the following steps:

  1. Let message be the method's first argument.

  2. Let data port be the method's second argument, if any.

  3. If the source port is not entangled with another port, then return false and abort these steps.

  4. Let target port be the port with which source port is entangled.

  5. Create an event that uses the MessageEvent interface, with the name message, which does not bubble, is cancelable, and has no default action.

  6. Let the data attribute of the event have the value of message, the method's first argument.

  7. If the method was called with a second argument data port and that argument isn't null, then run the following substeps:

    1. If the data port is the source port or the target port, then throw an INVALID_ACCESS_ERR exception and abort all these steps.

    2. Try to obtain a new data port by cloning the data port with the owner of the target port as the owner of the clone. If this returns an exception, then throw that exception and abort these steps.

    3. Let the messagePort attribute of the event be the new data port.

  8. Return true from the method, but continue with these steps.

  9. Add the event to the port message queue of target port.

People often request the ability to send name/value pairs, arrays, and numbers using postMessage() instead of just strings.


The startConversation(message) method is a convenience method that simplifies create a new MessageChannel and invoking postMessage() with one of the new ports. When invoked on a port source port, it must run the following steps:

  1. Let message be the method's first argument.

  2. If the source port is not entangled with another port, then return null and abort these steps.

  3. Let target port be the port with which source port is entangled.

  4. Create an event that uses the MessageEvent interface, with the name message, which does not bubble, is cancelable, and has no default action.

  5. Let the data attribute of the event have the value of message, the method's first argument.

  6. Create a new MessagePort object owned by the script execution context, and let port1 be that object.

  7. Create a new MessagePort object owned by the owner of the target port, and let port2 be that object.

  8. Entangle the port1 and port2 objects.

  9. Let the messagePort attribute of the event be port2.

  10. Return port1 from the method, but continue with these steps.

  11. Add the event to the port message queue of target port.


The start() method must open its port's port message queue, if it is not already open.

When a port's port message queue is open, contains an event, and its owner is available, the user agent must queue a task in the event loop to dispatch the first event in the queue on the MessagePort object, and remove the event from the queue. The task source for this task is the posted message task source.

A MessagePort's owner is available if the MessagePort is owned by an object other than a Window object, or if it is owned by a Window object and the Document that was the active document in that browsing context when the MessagePort was created is fully active. If that Document is discarded before the port's owner becomes available, then the events are lost.


The close() method, when called on a port local port that is entangled with another port, must cause the user agents to run the following steps:

  1. 2つのポートをほどきます。

  2. Queue a task to fire a simple event called unload at the port on which the method was called.

  3. Queue a task to fire a simple event called unload at the other port.

The task source for the two tasks above is the posted message task source.

If the method is called on a port that is not entangled, then the method must do nothing.


The following are the event handler DOM attributes that must be supported by objects implementing the MessagePort interface:

onmessage

message 事象が当該 MessagePort オブジェクトを対象としているか、泡立って当該オブジェクトを通過する時に、 呼び出されなければなりません。

The first time a MessagePort object's onmessage attribute is set, the port's port message queue must be opened, as if the start() method had been called.

onunload

Must be invoked whenever an unload event is targeted at or bubbles through the MessagePort object.

7.5.3.1. Ports and browsing contexts

When a Document is discarded, if there are any MessagePort objects that:

...then the user agent must run the following steps for each such port:

  1. Let surviving port be the port with which the MessagePort object in question is entangled.

  2. 2つのポートをほどきます。

  3. Queue a task to fire a simple event called unload at surviving port. The task source for this task is the posted message task source.

7.5.3.2. Ports and garbage collection

User agents must act as if MessagePort objects have a strong reference to their entangled MessagePort object.

Thus, a message port can be received, given an event listener, and then forgotten, and so long as that event listener could receive a message, the channel will be maintained.

Of course, if this was to occur on both sides of the channel, then both ports would be garbage collected, since they would not be reachable from live code, despite having a strong reference to each other.

8. HTML 構文

8.1 HTML 文書を書く

この節は文書、著述ツール、マーク付け生成器にのみ適用されます。 特に、適合性検査器には適用されません。 適合性検査器は次の節 (「HTML 文書の構文解析」) で与えられる要件を用いなければなりません

文書は、次に示す部分により、次の順序で構成されなければなりません

  1. 任意選択で、1つの U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK (BOM) 文字。
  2. 任意の個数の注釈間隔文字
  3. DOCTYPE
  4. 任意の個数の注釈間隔文字
  5. 根要素を html 要素の形で。
  6. 任意の個数の注釈間隔文字

前述の各種の内容は、次の数個の節で説明します。

加えて、文字符号化宣言をどう直列化するかについても、 それに関する節で説明した通り、いくつかの制限があります。

html 要素の前の間隔文字や、 html 要素のはじめで head 要素の前の間隔文字は、 文書が構文解析される時に除去されます。根 html 要素のの間隔文字は、 body 要素の終わりにあったものとして構文解析されます。 従って、根要素の近辺の間隔文字は往復しません。

DOCTYPE の後、 根要素の前の注釈がある場合はその後、 html 要素の開始タグの後 (省略しない場合)、 html 要素中で head 要素の前に注釈がある場合にはその後には、 改行を挿入することをおすすめします。

HTML 構文中の多くの文字列 (例えば要素や属性の名前) は大文字と小文字を区別しませんが、 区別しないのは範囲 U+0041 ~ U+005A (LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A ~ LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z) と 範囲 U+0061 ~ U+007A (LATIN SMALL LETTER A ~ LATIN SMALL LETTER Z) の文字についてのみです。便宜上、この節ではこれを単に「大文字・小文字を区別しない」と呼びます。

8.1.1 DOCTYPE

DOCTYPE はほとんど無意味ですが、 必須の頭部です。

DOCTYPE は遺物的な理由で必須です。 省略すると、ブラウザはいくつかの仕様書と非互換な異なるレンダリング・モードを使おうとします。 DOCTYPE を文書に含めることによってブラウザに関係する仕様書に従うよう最善の努力を試みさせるようにします。

DOCTYPE は、次の文字により次の順序で構成されなければなりません

  1. U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<) 文字。
  2. U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK (!) 文字。
  3. U+0044 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D 文字か U+0064 LATIN SMALL LETTER D 文字。
  4. U+004F LATIN CAPITAL LETTER O 文字か U+006F LATIN SMALL LETTER O 文字。
  5. U+0043 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER C 文字か U+0063 LATIN SMALL LETTER C 文字。
  6. U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T 文字か U+0074 LATIN SMALL LETTER T 文字。
  7. U+0059 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Y 文字か U+0079 LATIN SMALL LETTER Y 文字。
  8. U+0050 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER P 文字か U+0070 LATIN SMALL LETTER P 文字。
  9. U+0045 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E 文字か U+0065 LATIN SMALL LETTER E 文字。
  10. 1つ以上の間隔文字
  11. U+0048 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER H 文字か U+0068 LATIN SMALL LETTER H 文字。
  12. U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T 文字か U+0074 LATIN SMALL LETTER T 文字。
  13. U+004D LATIN CAPITAL LETTER M 文字か U+006D LATIN SMALL LETTER M 文字。
  14. U+004C LATIN CAPITAL LETTER L 文字か U+006C LATIN SMALL LETTER L 文字。
  15. 零個以上の間隔文字
  16. U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>) 文字。

つまり、大文字または小文字の <!DOCTYPE HTML> です。

8.1.2 要素

要素には5種類あります。 空隙要素、 CDATA 要素、 RCDATA 要素、外来要素、通常要素です。

空隙要素
base, command, eventsource, link, meta, hr, br, img, embed, param, area, col, input, source
CDATA 要素
style, script
RCDATA 要素
title, textarea
外来要素
MathML 名前空間からの要素。
通常要素
他の全ての認められているHTML 要素は通常要素です。

Tags are used to delimit the start and end of elements in the markup. CDATA, RCDATA, and normal elements have a start tag to indicate where they begin, and an end tag to indicate where they end. The start and end tags of certain normal elements can be omitted, as described later. Those that cannot be omitted must not be omitted. Void elements only have a start tag; end tags must not be specified for void elements. Foreign elements must either have a start tag and an end tag, or a start tag that is marked as self-closing, in which case they must not have an end tag.

The contents of the element must be placed between just after the start tag (which might be implied, in certain cases) and just before the end tag (which again, might be implied in certain cases). The exact allowed contents of each individual element depends on the content model of that element, as described earlier in this specification. Elements must not contain content that their content model disallows. In addition to the restrictions placed on the contents by those content models, however, the five types of elements have additional syntactic requirements.

Void elements can't have any contents (since there's no end tag, no content can be put between the start tag and the end tag).

CDATA elements can have text, though it has restrictions described below.

RCDATA elements can have text and character references, but the text must not contain an ambiguous ampersand. There are also further restrictions described below.

Foreign elements whose start tag is marked as self-closing can't have any contents (since, again, as there's no end tag, no content can be put between the start tag and the end tag). Foreign elements whose start tag is not marked as self-closing can have text, character references, CDATA sections, other elements, and comments, but the text must not contain the character U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<) or an ambiguous ampersand.

Normal elements can have text, character references, other elements, and comments, but the text must not contain the character U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<) or an ambiguous ampersand. Some normal elements also have yet more restrictions on what content they are allowed to hold, beyond the restrictions imposed by the content model and those described in this paragraph. Those restrictions are described below.

Tags contain a tag name, giving the element's name. HTML elements all have names that only use characters in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO .. U+0039 DIGIT NINE, U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A .. U+007A LATIN SMALL LETTER Z, U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A .. U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z, and U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-). In the HTML syntax, tag names may be written with any mix of lower- and uppercase letters that, when converted to all-lowercase, matches the element's tag name; tag names are case-insensitive.

8.1.2.1. Start tags

Start tags must have the following format:

  1. The first character of a start tag must be a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<).
  2. The next few characters of a start tag must be the element's tag name.
  3. If there are to be any attributes in the next step, there must first be one or more space characters.
  4. Then, the start tag may have a number of attributes, the syntax for which is described below. Attributes may be separated from each other by one or more space characters.
  5. After the attributes, there may be one or more space characters. (Some attributes are required to be followed by a space. See the attributes section below.)
  6. Then, if the element is one of the void elements, or if the element is a foreign element, then there may be a single U+002F SOLIDUS (/) character. This character has no effect on void elements, but on foreign elements it marks the start tag as self-closing.
  7. Finally, start tags must be closed by a U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>) character.
8.1.2.2. End tags

End tags must have the following format:

  1. The first character of an end tag must be a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<).
  2. The second character of an end tag must be a U+002F SOLIDUS (/).
  3. The next few characters of an end tag must be the element's tag name.
  4. After the tag name, there may be one or more space characters.
  5. Finally, end tags must be closed by a U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>) character.
8.1.2.3. Attributes

Attributes for an element are expressed inside the element's start tag.

Attributes have a name and a value. Attribute names must consist of one or more characters other than the space characters, U+0000 NULL, U+0022 QUOTATION MARK ("), U+0027 APOSTROPHE ('), U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>), U+002F SOLIDUS (/), and U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=) characters, the control characters, and any characters that are not defined by Unicode. In the HTML syntax, attribute names may be written with any mix of lower- and uppercase letters that, when converted to all-lowercase, matches the attribute's name; attribute names are case-insensitive.

Attribute values are a mixture of text and character references, except with the additional restriction that the text cannot contain an ambiguous ampersand.

Attributes can be specified in four different ways:

Empty attribute syntax

Just the attribute name.

In the following example, the disabled attribute is given with the empty attribute syntax:

<input disabled>

If an attribute using the empty attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute, then there must be a space character separating the two.

Unquoted attribute value syntax

The attribute name, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+003D EQUALS SIGN character, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by the attribute value, which, in addition to the requirements given above for attribute values, must not contain any literal space characters, a U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (") characters, U+0027 APOSTROPHE (') characters, U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=) characters, or U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>) characters.

In the following example, the value attribute is given with the unquoted attribute value syntax:

<input value=yes>

If an attribute using the unquoted attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute or by one of the optional U+002F SOLIDUS (/) characters allowed in step 6 of the start tag syntax above, then there must be a space character separating the two.

Single-quoted attribute value syntax

The attribute name, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+003D EQUALS SIGN character, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+0027 APOSTROPHE (') character, followed by the attribute value, which, in addition to the requirements given above for attribute values, must not contain any literal U+0027 APOSTROPHE (') characters, and finally followed by a second single U+0027 APOSTROPHE (') character.

In the following example, the type attribute is given with the single-quoted attribute value syntax:

<input type='checkbox'>

If an attribute using the single-quoted attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute, then there must be a space character separating the two.

Double-quoted attribute value syntax

The attribute name, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+003D EQUALS SIGN character, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (") character, followed by the attribute value, which, in addition to the requirements given above for attribute values, must not contain any literal U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (") characters, and finally followed by a second single U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (") character.

In the following example, the name attribute is given with the double-quoted attribute value syntax:

<input name="be evil">

If an attribute using the double-quoted attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute, then there must be a space character separating the two.

8.1.2.4. Optional tags

Certain tags can be omitted.

An html element's start tag may be omitted if the first thing inside the html element is not a comment.

An html element's end tag may be omitted if the html element is not immediately followed by a comment and the element contains a body element that is either not empty or whose start tag has not been omitted.

A head element's start tag may be omitted if the first thing inside the head element is an element.

A head element's end tag may be omitted if the head element is not immediately followed by a space character or a comment.

A body element's start tag may be omitted if the first thing inside the body element is not a space character or a comment, except if the first thing inside the body element is a script or style element.

A body element's end tag may be omitted if the body element is not immediately followed by a comment and the element is either not empty or its start tag has not been omitted.

A li element's end tag may be omitted if the li element is immediately followed by another li element or if there is no more content in the parent element.

A dt element's end tag may be omitted if the dt element is immediately followed by another dt element or a dd element.

A dd element's end tag may be omitted if the dd element is immediately followed by another dd element or a dt element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

A p element's end tag may be omitted if the p element is immediately followed by an address, article, aside, blockquote, datagrid, dialog, dir, div, dl, fieldset, footer, form, h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6, header, hr, menu, nav, ol, p, pre, section, table, or ul, element, or if there is no more content in the parent element and the parent element is not an a element.

An rt element's end tag may be omitted if the rt element is immediately followed by an rt or rp element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

An rp element's end tag may be omitted if the rp element is immediately followed by an rt or rp element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

An optgroup element's end tag may be omitted if the optgroup element is immediately followed by another optgroup element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

An option element's end tag may be omitted if the option element is immediately followed by another option element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

A colgroup element's start tag may be omitted if the first thing inside the colgroup element is a col element, and if the element is not immediately preceded by another colgroup element whose end tag has been omitted.

A colgroup element's end tag may be omitted if the colgroup element is not immediately followed by a space character or a comment.

A thead element's end tag may be omitted if the thead element is immediately followed by a tbody or tfoot element.

A tbody element's start tag may be omitted if the first thing inside the tbody element is a tr element, and if the element is not immediately preceded by a tbody, thead, or tfoot element whose end tag has been omitted.

A tbody element's end tag may be omitted if the tbody element is immediately followed by a tbody or tfoot element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

A tfoot element's end tag may be omitted if the tfoot element is immediately followed by a tbody element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

A tr element's end tag may be omitted if the tr element is immediately followed by another tr element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

A td element's end tag may be omitted if the td element is immediately followed by a td or th element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

A th element's end tag may be omitted if the th element is immediately followed by a td or th element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.

However, a start tag must never be omitted if it has any attributes.

8.1.2.5. Restrictions on content models

For historical reasons, certain elements have extra restrictions beyond even the restrictions given by their content model.

An optgroup element must not contain optgroup elements, even though these elements are technically allowed to be nested according to the content models described in this specification. (If an optgroup element is put inside another in the markup, it will in fact imply an optgroup end tag before it.)

A table element must not contain tr elements, even though these elements are technically allowed inside table elements according to the content models described in this specification. (If a tr element is put inside a table in the markup, it will in fact imply a tbody start tag before it.)

A single U+000A LINE FEED (LF) character may be placed immediately after the start tag of pre and textarea elements. This does not affect the processing of the element. The otherwise optional U+000A LINE FEED (LF) character must be included if the element's contents start with that character (because otherwise the leading newline in the contents would be treated like the optional newline, and ignored).

The following two pre blocks are equivalent:

<pre>Hello</pre>
<pre>
Hello</pre>
8.1.2.6. Restrictions on the contents of CDATA and RCDATA elements

The text in CDATA and RCDATA elements must not contain any occurrences of the string "</" (U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+002F SOLIDUS) followed by characters that case-insensitively match the tag name of the element followed by one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), U+0020 SPACE, U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>), or U+002F SOLIDUS (/), unless that string is part of an escaping text span.

An escaping text span is a span of text that starts with an escaping text span start that is not itself in an escaping text span, and ends at the next escaping text span end. There cannot be any character references inside an escaping text span.

An escaping text span start is a part of text that consists of the four character sequence "<!--" (U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS).

An escaping text span end is a part of text that consists of the three character sequence "-->" (U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN) whose U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>).

An escaping text span start may share its U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS characters with its corresponding escaping text span end.

The text in CDATA and RCDATA elements must not have an escaping text span start that is not followed by an escaping text span end.

8.1.3 Text

Text is allowed inside elements, attributes, and comments. Text must consist of Unicode characters. Text must not contain U+0000 characters. Text must not contain permanently undefined Unicode characters. Text must not contain control characters other than space characters. Extra constraints are placed on what is and what is not allowed in text based on where the text is to be put, as described in the other sections.

8.1.3.1. Newlines

Newlines in HTML may be represented either as U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) characters, U+000A LINE FEED (LF) characters, or pairs of U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR), U+000A LINE FEED (LF) characters in that order.

8.1.4 Character references

In certain cases described in other sections, text may be mixed with character references. These can be used to escape characters that couldn't otherwise legally be included in text.

Character references must start with a U+0026 AMPERSAND (&). Following this, there are three possible kinds of character references:

Named character references
The ampersand must be followed by one of the names given in the named character references section, using the same case. The name must be one that is terminated by a U+003B SEMICOLON (;) character.
Decimal numeric character reference
The ampersand must be followed by a U+0023 NUMBER SIGN (#) character, followed by one or more digits in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO .. U+0039 DIGIT NINE, representing a base-ten integer that itself is a Unicode code point that is not U+0000, U+000D, in the range U+0080 .. U+009F, or in the range 0xD800 .. 0xDFFF (surrogates). The digits must then be followed by a U+003B SEMICOLON character (;).
Hexadecimal numeric character reference
The ampersand must be followed by a U+0023 NUMBER SIGN (#) character, which must be followed by either a U+0078 LATIN SMALL LETTER X or a U+0058 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER X character, which must then be followed by one or more digits in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO .. U+0039 DIGIT NINE, U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A .. U+0066 LATIN SMALL LETTER F, and U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A .. U+0046 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER F, representing a base-sixteen integer that itself is a Unicode code point that is not U+0000, U+000D, in the range U+0080 .. U+009F, or in the range 0xD800 .. 0xDFFF (surrogates). The digits must then be followed by a U+003B SEMICOLON character (;).

An ambiguous ampersand is a U+0026 AMPERSAND (&) character that is followed by some text other than a space character, a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN character ('<'), or another U+0026 AMPERSAND (&) character.

8.1.5 CDATA sections

CDATA sections must start with the character sequence U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+005B LEFT SQUARE BRACKET, U+0043 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER C, U+0044 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D, U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A, U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T, U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A, U+005B LEFT SQUARE BRACKET (<![CDATA[). Following this sequence, the CDATA section may have text, with the additional restriction that the text must not contain the three character sequence U+005D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET, U+005D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET, U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (]]>). Finally, the CDATA section must be ended by the three character sequence U+005D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET, U+005D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET, U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (]]>).

8.1.6 Comments

Comments must start with the four character sequence U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (<!--). Following this sequence, the comment may have text, with the additional restriction that the text must not start with a single U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN ('>') character, nor start with a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) character followed by a U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN ('>') character, nor contain two consecutive U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) characters, nor end with a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) character. Finally, the comment must be ended by the three character sequence U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (-->).

8.2 HTML 文書の構文解析

この節は利用者エージェント、データ・マイニング・ツール、 適合性検査器のみに適用されます。

XML 文書 (や XHTML 文書) を構文解析して DOM 木を得るための規則は XML や XML 名前空間の仕様書で扱われており、 この仕様書の適用範囲外です。 [XML]

HTML 文書については、利用者エージェントは、 DOM 木を生成するためにこの節で説明する構文解析規則を使用しなければなりません。 また、この規則はHTML 構文解析器と呼ばれるものを定義します。

HTML5 の HTML 形式は SGML や XML によく似ていますが、 独自の構文解析規則を持つ別の言語です。

以前のいくつかの版の HTML (特に HTML2 から HTML4 まで) は SGML に基づき、 SGML の構文解析規則を用いていました。しかし、 HTML 文書用に真の SGML 構文解析を実装していたウェブ・ブラウザは (あったとしても) 皆無に近い数でした。 HTML を厳密に SGML 応用として扱う唯一の利用者エージェントは歴史的に妥当性検証器だけでした。 その結果、妥当性検査器は文書がある形式であることを要求し、 一方で広く実用されている Web ブラウザはそれとは異なる形式を相互運用可能な形で実装するという混乱が生じ、 生産性を大きく低下させています。 ですので、この版の HTML は非 SGML ベースに回帰します。

文書準備の過程で SGML ツールを使いたいと考える著者には、 XML ツールと HTML5 の XML 直列化を用いることをお勧めします。

この仕様書は、構文的に正しいか否かに関わらず HTML 文書を構文解析する規則を定義します。構文解析算法中のいくつかの箇所は構文解析誤りであるとしています。 構文解析誤りの処理は明確に定義します。利用者エージェントは、 そのような問題に遭遇したときに後述のように動作するか、または後述の規則を適用することを望まないような誤りにはじめて遭遇した箇所で処理を停止しなければなりません

適合性検査器は、文書中に1つ以上の構文解析誤り条件が存在する場合、利用者に最低1つの構文解析誤り条件を報告しなければならず、 文書に誤りが存在しない場合、構文解析誤り条件を報告してはなりません。 適合性検査器は、文書中に複数の構文解析誤り条件が存在する場合、 複数の構文解析誤り条件を報告して構いません。 適合性検査器は構文解析誤りから回復することを要求されません。

構文解析誤りは、 HTML の構文の誤りに過ぎません。 適合性検査器は、構文解析誤りの検査に加え、 文書がこの仕様書で説明されている他の適合性要件に従っているかも検査することになります。

8.2.1 Overview of the parsing model

The input to the HTML parsing process consists of a stream of Unicode characters, which is passed through a tokenization stage (lexical analysis) followed by a tree construction stage (semantic analysis). The output is a Document object.

Implementations that do not support scripting do not have to actually create a DOM Document object, but the DOM tree in such cases is still used as the model for the rest of the specification.

In the common case, the data handled by the tokenization stage comes from the network, but it can also come from script, e.g. using the document.write() API.

There is only one set of state for the tokeniser stage and the tree construction stage, but the tree construction stage is reentrant, meaning that while the tree construction stage is handling one token, the tokeniser might be resumed, causing further tokens to be emitted and processed before the first token's processing is complete.

In the following example, the tree construction stage will be called upon to handle a "p" start tag token while handling the "script" start tag token:

...
<script>
 document.write('<p>');
</script>
...

8.2.2 The input stream

The stream of Unicode characters that consists the input to the tokenization stage will be initially seen by the user agent as a stream of bytes (typically coming over the network or from the local file system). The bytes encode the actual characters according to a particular character encoding, which the user agent must use to decode the bytes into characters.

For XML documents, the algorithm user agents must use to determine the character encoding is given by the XML specification. This section does not apply to XML documents. [XML]

8.2.2.1. Determining the character encoding

In some cases, it might be impractical to unambiguously determine the encoding before parsing the document. Because of this, this specification provides for a two-pass mechanism with an optional pre-scan. Implementations are allowed, as described below, to apply a simplified parsing algorithm to whatever bytes they have available before beginning to parse the document. Then, the real parser is started, using a tentative encoding derived from this pre-parse and other out-of-band metadata. If, while the document is being loaded, the user agent discovers an encoding declaration that conflicts with this information, then the parser can get reinvoked to perform a parse of the document with the real encoding.

User agents must use the following algorithm (the encoding sniffing algorithm) to determine the character encoding to use when decoding a document in the first pass. This algorithm takes as input any out-of-band metadata available to the user agent (e.g. the Content-Type metadata of the document) and all the bytes available so far, and returns an encoding and a confidence. The confidence is either tentative or certain. The encoding used, and whether the confidence in that encoding is tentative or confident, is used during the parsing to determine whether to change the encoding.

  1. If the transport layer specifies an encoding, return that encoding with the confidence certain, and abort these steps.

  2. The user agent may wait for more bytes of the resource to be available, either in this step or at any later step in this algorithm. For instance, a user agent might wait 500ms or 512 bytes, whichever came first. In general preparsing the source to find the encoding improves performance, as it reduces the need to throw away the data structures used when parsing upon finding the encoding information. However, if the user agent delays too long to obtain data to determine the encoding, then the cost of the delay could outweigh any performance improvements from the preparse.

  3. For each of the rows in the following table, starting with the first one and going down, if there are as many or more bytes available than the number of bytes in the first column, and the first bytes of the file match the bytes given in the first column, then return the encoding given in the cell in the second column of that row, with the confidence certain, and abort these steps:

    Bytes in Hexadecimal Encoding
    FE FF UTF-16BE
    FF FE UTF-16LE
    EF BB BF UTF-8

    This step looks for Unicode Byte Order Marks (BOMs).

  4. Otherwise, the user agent will have to search for explicit character encoding information in the file itself. This should proceed as follows:

    Let position be a pointer to a byte in the input stream, initially pointing at the first byte. If at any point during these substeps the user agent either runs out of bytes or decides that scanning further bytes would not be efficient, then skip to the next step of the overall character encoding detection algorithm. User agents may decide that scanning any bytes is not efficient, in which case these substeps are entirely skipped.

    Now, repeat the following "two" steps until the algorithm aborts (either because user agent aborts, as described above, or because a character encoding is found):

    1. If position points to:

      0x3C 0x21 0x2D 0x2D (ASCII '<!--') で始まるバイト列

      Advance the position pointer so that it points at the first 0x3E byte which is preceded by two 0x2D bytes (i.e. at the end of an ASCII '-->' sequence) and comes after the 0x3C byte that was found. (The two 0x2D bytes can be the same as the those in the '<!--' sequence.)

      0x3C, 0x4D or 0x6D, 0x45 or 0x65, 0x54 or 0x74, 0x41 or 0x61, and finally one of 0x09, 0x0A, 0x0C, 0x0D, 0x20, 0x2F (case-insensitive ASCII '<meta' followed by a space or slash) で始まるバイト列
      1. Advance the position pointer so that it points at the next 0x09, 0x0A, 0x0C, 0x0D, 0x20, or 0x2F byte (the one in sequence of characters matched above).

      2. Get an attribute and its value. If no attribute was sniffed, then skip this inner set of steps, and jump to the second step in the overall "two step" algorithm.

      3. If the attribute's name is neither "charset" nor "content", then return to step 2 in these inner steps.

      4. If the attribute's name is "charset", let charset be the attribute's value, interpreted as a character encoding.

      5. Otherwise, the attribute's name is "content": apply the algorithm for extracting an encoding from a Content-Type, giving the attribute's value as the string to parse. If an encoding is returned, let charset be that encoding. Otherwise, return to step 2 in these inner steps.

      6. If charset is a UTF-16 encoding, change it to UTF-8.

      7. If charset is a supported character encoding, then return the given encoding, with confidence tentative, and abort all these steps.

      8. Otherwise, return to step 2 in these inner steps.

      A sequence of bytes starting with a 0x3C byte (ASCII '<'), optionally a 0x2F byte (ASCII '/'), and finally a byte in the range 0x41-0x5A or 0x61-0x7A (an ASCII letter)
      1. Advance the position pointer so that it points at the next 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), 0x20 (ASCII space), or 0x3E (ASCII '>') byte.

      2. Repeatedly get an attribute until no further attributes can be found, then jump to the second step in the overall "two step" algorithm.

      0x3C 0x21 (ASCII '<!') で始まるバイト列
      0x3C 0x2F (ASCII '</') で始まるバイト列
      0x3C 0x3F (ASCII '<?') で始まるバイト列

      Advance the position pointer so that it points at the first 0x3E byte (ASCII '>') that comes after the 0x3C byte that was found.

      その他のバイト

      Do nothing with that byte.

    2. Move position so it points at the next byte in the input stream, and return to the first step of this "two step" algorithm.

    When the above "two step" algorithm says to get an attribute, it means doing this:

    1. If the byte at position is one of 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), 0x20 (ASCII space), or 0x2F (ASCII '/') then advance position to the next byte and redo this substep.

    2. If the byte at position is 0x3E (ASCII '>'), then abort the "get an attribute" algorithm. There isn't one.

    3. Otherwise, the byte at position is the start of the attribute name. Let attribute name and attribute value be the empty string.

    4. Attribute name: Process the byte at position as follows:

      If it is 0x3D (ASCII '='), and the attribute name is longer than the empty string
      Advance position to the next byte and jump to the step below labeled value.
      If it is 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), or 0x20 (ASCII space)
      Jump to the step below labeled spaces.
      If it is 0x2F (ASCII '/') or 0x3E (ASCII '>')
      Abort the "get an attribute" algorithm. The attribute's name is the value of attribute name, its value is the empty string.
      If it is in the range 0x41 (ASCII 'A') to 0x5A (ASCII 'Z')
      Append the Unicode character with codepoint b+0x20 to attribute name (where b is the value of the byte at position).
      その他のもの
      Append the Unicode character with the same codepoint as the value of the byte at position) to attribute name. (It doesn't actually matter how bytes outside the ASCII range are handled here, since only ASCII characters can contribute to the detection of a character encoding.)
    5. Advance position to the next byte and return to the previous step.

    6. Spaces. If the byte at position is one of 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), or 0x20 (ASCII space) then advance position to the next byte, then, repeat this step.

    7. If the byte at position is not 0x3D (ASCII '='), abort the "get an attribute" algorithm. The attribute's name is the value of attribute name, its value is the empty string.

    8. Advance position past the 0x3D (ASCII '=') byte.

    9. Value. If the byte at position is one of 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), or 0x20 (ASCII space) then advance position to the next byte, then, repeat this step.

    10. Process the byte at position as follows:

      If it is 0x22 (ASCII '"') or 0x27 ("'")
      1. Let b be the value of the byte at position.
      2. Advance position to the next byte.
      3. If the value of the byte at position is the value of b, then advance position to the next byte and abort the "get an attribute" algorithm. The attribute's name is the value of attribute name, and its value is the value of attribute value.
      4. Otherwise, if the value of the byte at position is in the range 0x41 (ASCII 'A') to 0x5A (ASCII 'Z'), then append a Unicode character to attribute value whose codepoint is 0x20 more than the value of the byte at position.
      5. Otherwise, append a Unicode character to attribute value whose codepoint is the same as the value of the byte at position.
      6. Return to the second step in these substeps.
      If it is 0x3E (ASCII '>')
      Abort the "get an attribute" algorithm. The attribute's name is the value of attribute name, its value is the empty string.
      If it is in the range 0x41 (ASCII 'A') to 0x5A (ASCII 'Z')
      Append the Unicode character with codepoint b+0x20 to attribute value (where b is the value of the byte at position). Advance position to the next byte.
      その他のもの
      Append the Unicode character with the same codepoint as the value of the byte at position) to attribute value. Advance position to the next byte.
    11. Process the byte at position as follows:

      If it is 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), 0x20 (ASCII space), or 0x3E (ASCII '>')
      Abort the "get an attribute" algorithm. The attribute's name is the value of attribute name and its value is the value of attribute value.
      If it is in the range 0x41 (ASCII 'A') to 0x5A (ASCII 'Z')
      Append the Unicode character with codepoint b+0x20 to attribute value (where b is the value of the byte at position).
      その他のもの
      Append the Unicode character with the same codepoint as the value of the byte at position) to attribute value.
    12. Advance position to the next byte and return to the previous step.

    For the sake of interoperability, user agents should not use a pre-scan algorithm that returns different results than the one described above. (But, if you do, please at least let us know, so that we can improve this algorithm and benefit everyone...)

  5. If the user agent has information on the likely encoding for this page, e.g. based on the encoding of the page when it was last visited, then return that encoding, with the confidence tentative, and abort these steps.

  6. The user agent may attempt to autodetect the character encoding from applying frequency analysis or other algorithms to the data stream. If autodetection succeeds in determining a character encoding, then return that encoding, with the confidence tentative, and abort these steps. [UNIVCHARDET]

  7. Otherwise, return an implementation-defined or user-specified default character encoding, with the confidence tentative. In non-legacy environments, the more comprehensive UTF-8 encoding is recommended. Due to its use in legacy content, windows-1252 is recommended as a default in predominantly Western demographics instead. Since these encodings can in many cases be distinguished by inspection, a user agent may heuristically decide which to use as a default.

The document's character encoding must immediately be set to the value returned from this algorithm, at the same time as the user agent uses the returned value to select the decoder to use for the input stream.

8.2.2.2. Character encoding requirements

User agents must at a minimum support the UTF-8 and Windows-1252 encodings, but may support more.

It is not unusual for Web browsers to support dozens if not upwards of a hundred distinct character encodings.

User agents must support the preferred MIME name of every character encoding they support that has a preferred MIME name, and should support all the IANA-registered aliases. [IANACHARSET]

When comparing a string specifying a character encoding with the name or alias of a character encoding to determine if they are equal, user agents must ignore all characters in the ranges U+0009 to U+000D, U+0020 to U+002F, U+003A to U+0040, U+005B to U+0060, and U+007B to U+007E (all whitespace and punctuation characters in ASCII) in both names, and then perform the comparison in an ASCII case-insensitive manner.

For instance, "GB_2312-80" and "g.b.2312(80)" are considered equivalent names.

When a user agent would otherwise use an encoding given in the first column of the following table, it must instead use the encoding given in the cell in the second column of the same row. Any bytes that are treated differently due to this encoding aliasing must be considered parse errors.
Character encoding overrides
Input encoding Replacement encoding 参考文献
EUC-KR Windows-949 [EUCKR] [WIN949]
GB2312 GBK [GB2312] [GBK]
GB_2312-80 GBK [RFC1345] [GBK]
ISO-8859-1 Windows-1252 [RFC1345] [WIN1252]
ISO-8859-9 Windows-1254 [RFC1345] [WIN1254]
ISO-8859-11 Windows-874 [ISO885911] [WIN874]
KS_C_5601-1987 Windows-949 [RFC1345] [WIN949]
TIS-620 Windows-874 [TIS620] [WIN874]
x-x-big5 Big5 [BIG5]

The requirement to treat certain encodings as other encodings according to the table above is a willful violation of the W3C Character Model specification. [CHARMOD]

User agents must not support the CESU-8, UTF-7, BOCU-1 and SCSU encodings. [CESU8] [UTF7] [BOCU1] [SCSU]

Support for UTF-32 is not recommended. This encoding is rarely used, and frequently misimplemented.

This specification does not make any attempt to support UTF-32 in its algorithms; support and use of UTF-32 can thus lead to unexpected behavior in implementations of this specification.

8.2.2.3. Preprocessing the input stream

Given an encoding, the bytes in the input stream must be converted to Unicode characters for the tokeniser, as described by the rules for that encoding, except that the leading U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK character, if any, must not be stripped by the encoding layer (it is stripped by the rule below).

Bytes or sequences of bytes in the original byte stream that could not be converted to Unicode characters must be converted to U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER code points.

Bytes or sequences of bytes in the original byte stream that did not conform to the encoding specification (e.g. invalid UTF-8 byte sequences in a UTF-8 input stream) are errors that conformance checkers are expected to report.

One leading U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK character must be ignored if any are present.

All U+0000 NULL characters in the input must be replaced by U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTERs. Any occurrences of such characters is a parse error.

Any occurrences of any characters in the ranges U+0001 to U+0008, U+000E to U+001F, U+007F to U+009F, U+D800 to U+DFFF , U+FDD0 to U+FDDF, and characters U+FFFE, U+FFFF, U+1FFFE, U+1FFFF, U+2FFFE, U+2FFFF, U+3FFFE, U+3FFFF, U+4FFFE, U+4FFFF, U+5FFFE, U+5FFFF, U+6FFFE, U+6FFFF, U+7FFFE, U+7FFFF, U+8FFFE, U+8FFFF, U+9FFFE, U+9FFFF, U+AFFFE, U+AFFFF, U+BFFFE, U+BFFFF, U+CFFFE, U+CFFFF, U+DFFFE, U+DFFFF, U+EFFFE, U+EFFFF, U+FFFFE, U+FFFFF, U+10FFFE, and U+10FFFF are parse errors. (These are all control characters or permanently undefined Unicode characters.)

U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN (CR) characters, and U+000A LINE FEED (LF) characters, are treated specially. Any CR characters that are followed by LF characters must be removed, and any CR characters not followed by LF characters must be converted to LF characters. Thus, newlines in HTML DOMs are represented by LF characters, and there are never any CR characters in the input to the tokenization stage.

The next input character is the first character in the input stream that has not yet been consumed. Initially, the next input character is the first character in the input.

The insertion point is the position (just before a character or just before the end of the input stream) where content inserted using document.write() is actually inserted. The insertion point is relative to the position of the character immediately after it, it is not an absolute offset into the input stream. Initially, the insertion point is uninitialized.

The "EOF" character in the tables below is a conceptual character representing the end of the input stream. If the parser is a script-created parser, then the end of the input stream is reached when an explicit "EOF" character (inserted by the document.close() method) is consumed. Otherwise, the "EOF" character is not a real character in the stream, but rather the lack of any further characters.

8.2.2.4. Changing the encoding while parsing

When the parser requires the user agent to change the encoding, it must run the following steps. This might happen if the encoding sniffing algorithm described above failed to find an encoding, or if it found an encoding that was not the actual encoding of the file.

  1. If the new encoding is a UTF-16 encoding, change it to UTF-8.
  2. If the new encoding is identical or equivalent to the encoding that is already being used to interpret the input stream, then set the confidence to confident and abort these steps. This happens when the encoding information found in the file matches what the encoding sniffing algorithm determined to be the encoding, and in the second pass through the parser if the first pass found that the encoding sniffing algorithm described in the earlier section failed to find the right encoding.
  3. If all the bytes up to the last byte converted by the current decoder have the same Unicode interpretations in both the current encoding and the new encoding, and if the user agent supports changing the converter on the fly, then the user agent may change to the new converter for the encoding on the fly. Set the document's character encoding and the encoding used to convert the input stream to the new encoding, set the confidence to confident, and abort these steps.
  4. Otherwise, navigate to the document again, with replacement enabled, and using the same source browsing context, but this time skip the encoding sniffing algorithm and instead just set the encoding to the new encoding and the confidence to confident. Whenever possible, this should be done without actually contacting the network layer (the bytes should be re-parsed from memory), even if, e.g., the document is marked as not being cacheable.

8.2.3 構文解析状態

8.2.3.1. 挿入モード

Initially the insertion mode is "initial". It can change to "before html", "before head", "in head", "in head noscript", "after head", "in body", "in table", "in caption", "in column group", "in table body", "in row", "in cell", "in select", "in select in table", "in foreign content", "after body", "in frameset", "after frameset", "after after body", and "after after frameset" during the course of the parsing, as described in the tree construction stage. The insertion mode affects how tokens are processed and whether CDATA sections are supported.

Seven of these modes, namely "in head", "in body", "in table", "in table body", "in row", "in cell", and "in select", are special, in that the other modes defer to them at various times. When the algorithm below says that the user agent is to do something "using the rules for the m insertion mode", where m is one of these modes, the user agent must use the rules described under the m insertion mode's section, but must leave the insertion mode unchanged unless the rules in m themselves switch the insertion mode to a new value.

挿入モードが "in foreign content" に切り替えられる時には、二次挿入モードも設定されます。 この二次モードは、 "in foreign content" モードの規則の中で HTML (つまり、異言語でない) 内容を取り扱う際に使用します。

後述の段階が利用者エージェントに挿入モードを適切に再設定することを要求する場合、 利用者エージェントは次の段階に従わなければならないことを意味しています。

  1. last を偽とします。
  2. node開いている要素のスタックの最後の節点とします。
  3. node が開いている要素のスタックの最初の節点の場合、 last を真に設定し、 nodecontext 要素に設定します。 (素片の場合)
  4. nodeselect 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in select" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。 (素片の場合)
  5. nodetd 要素か th 要素の場合で last が偽の場合、挿入モードを "in cell" に切り替え、これらの段階を停止します。
  6. nodetr 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in row" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。
  7. nodetbody, thead, or tfoot 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in table body" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。
  8. nodecaption 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in caption" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。
  9. nodecolgroup 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in column group" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。 (素片の場合)
  10. nodetable 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in table" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。
  11. nodeMathML 名前空間の要素の場合、挿入モードを "in foreign content" に切り替え、二次挿入モードを "in body" とし、これらの段階を停止します。
  12. nodehead 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in body" ("in body"! "in head" ではなく!) に切り替え、これらの段階を停止します。 (素片の場合)
  13. nodebody 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in body" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。
  14. nodeframeset 要素の場合、挿入モードを "in frameset" に切り替え、 これらの段階を停止します。 (素片の場合)
  15. If node is an html element, then: if the head element pointer is null, switch the insertion mode to "before head", otherwise, switch the insertion mode to "after head". In either case, abort these steps. (fragment case)
  16. last が真であれば、挿入モードを "in body" に切り替え、これらの段階を停止します。 (素片の場合)
  17. 新たな node開いている要素のスタックnode の前にある節点とします。
  18. 手順 3 に戻ります。
8.2.3.2. The stack of open elements

Initially the stack of open elements is empty. The stack grows downwards; the topmost node on the stack is the first one added to the stack, and the bottommost node of the stack is the most recently added node in the stack (notwithstanding when the stack is manipulated in a random access fashion as part of the handling for misnested tags).

The "before html" insertion mode creates the html root element node, which is then added to the stack.

In the fragment case, the stack of open elements is initialized to contain an html element that is created as part of that algorithm. (The fragment case skips the "before html" insertion mode.)

The html node, however it is created, is the topmost node of the stack. It never gets popped off the stack.

The current node is the bottommost node in this stack.

The current table is the last table element in the stack of open elements, if there is one. If there is no table element in the stack of open elements (fragment case), then the current table is the first element in the stack of open elements (the html element).

Elements in the stack fall into the following categories:

Special

The following HTML elements have varying levels of special parsing rules: address, area, article, aside, base, basefont, bgsound, blockquote, body, br, center, col, colgroup, command, datagrid, dd, details, dialog, dir, div, dl, dt, embed, eventsource fieldset, figure, footer, form, frame, frameset, h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6, head, header, hr, iframe, img, input, isindex, li, link, listing, menu, meta, nav, noembed, noframes, noscript, ol, optgroup, option, p, param, plaintext, pre, script, section, select, spacer, style, tbody, textarea, tfoot, thead, title, tr, ul, and wbr.

Scoping

The following HTML elements introduce new scopes for various parts of the parsing: applet, button, caption, html, marquee, object, table, td, th.

Formatting

The following HTML elements are those that end up in the list of active formatting elements: a, b, big, em, font, i, nobr, s, small, strike, strong, tt, and u.

Phrasing

All other elements found while parsing an HTML document.

Still need to add these new elements to the lists: eventsource, section, nav, article, aside, header, footer, datagrid, command

The stack of open elements is said to have an element in scope when the following algorithm terminates in a match state:

  1. Initialise node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).

  2. If node is the target node, terminate in a match state.

  3. Otherwise, if node is one of the following elements, terminate in a failure state:

  4. Otherwise, set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements and return to step 2. (This will never fail, since the loop will always terminate in the previous step if the top of the stack — an html element — is reached.)

The stack of open elements is said to have an element in table scope when the following algorithm terminates in a match state:

  1. Initialise node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).

  2. If node is the target node, terminate in a match state.

  3. Otherwise, if node is one of the following elements, terminate in a failure state:

  4. Otherwise, set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements and return to step 2. (This will never fail, since the loop will always terminate in the previous step if the top of the stack — an html element — is reached.)

Nothing happens if at any time any of the elements in the stack of open elements are moved to a new location in, or removed from, the Document tree. In particular, the stack is not changed in this situation. This can cause, amongst other strange effects, content to be appended to nodes that are no longer in the DOM.

In some cases (namely, when closing misnested formatting elements), the stack is manipulated in a random-access fashion.

8.2.3.3. The list of active formatting elements

Initially the list of active formatting elements is empty. It is used to handle mis-nested formatting element tags.

The list contains elements in the formatting category, and scope markers. The scope markers are inserted when entering applet elements, buttons, object elements, marquees, table cells, and table captions, and are used to prevent formatting from "leaking" into applet elements, buttons, object elements, marquees, and tables.

When the steps below require the UA to reconstruct the active formatting elements, the UA must perform the following steps:

  1. If there are no entries in the list of active formatting elements, then there is nothing to reconstruct; stop this algorithm.
  2. If the last (most recently added) entry in the list of active formatting elements is a marker, or if it is an element that is in the stack of open elements, then there is nothing to reconstruct; stop this algorithm.
  3. Let entry be the last (most recently added) element in the list of active formatting elements.
  4. If there are no entries before entry in the list of active formatting elements, then jump to step 8.
  5. Let entry be the entry one earlier than entry in the list of active formatting elements.
  6. If entry is neither a marker nor an element that is also in the stack of open elements, go to step 4.
  7. Let entry be the element one later than entry in the list of active formatting elements.
  8. Perform a shallow clone of the element entry to obtain clone. [DOM3CORE]
  9. Append clone to the current node and push it onto the stack of open elements so that it is the new current node.
  10. Replace the entry for entry in the list with an entry for clone.
  11. If the entry for clone in the list of active formatting elements is not the last entry in the list, return to step 7.

This has the effect of reopening all the formatting elements that were opened in the current body, cell, or caption (whichever is youngest) that haven't been explicitly closed.

The way this specification is written, the list of active formatting elements always consists of elements in chronological order with the least recently added element first and the most recently added element last (except for while steps 8 to 11 of the above algorithm are being executed, of course).

When the steps below require the UA to clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker, the UA must perform the following steps:

  1. Let entry be the last (most recently added) entry in the list of active formatting elements.
  2. Remove entry from the list of active formatting elements.
  3. If entry was a marker, then stop the algorithm at this point. The list has been cleared up to the last marker.
  4. Go to step 1.
8.2.3.4. The element pointers

Initially the head element pointer and the form element pointer are both null.

Once a head element has been parsed (whether implicitly or explicitly) the head element pointer gets set to point to this node.

The form element pointer points to the last form element that was opened and whose end tag has not yet been seen. It is used to make form controls associate with forms in the face of dramatically bad markup, for historical reasons.

8.2.3.5. スクリプティング状態

The scripting flag is set to "enabled" if the Document with which the parser is associated was with script when the parser was created, and "disabled" otherwise.

8.2.4 字句化

Implementations must act as if they used the following state machine to tokenise HTML. The state machine must start in the data state. Most states consume a single character, which may have various side-effects, and either switches the state machine to a new state to reconsume the same character, or switches it to a new state (to consume the next character), or repeats the same state (to consume the next character). Some states have more complicated behavior and can consume several characters before switching to another state.

The exact behavior of certain states depends on a content model flag that is set after certain tokens are emitted. The flag has several states: PCDATA, RCDATA, CDATA, and PLAINTEXT. Initially it must be in the PCDATA state. In the RCDATA and CDATA states, a further escape flag is used to control the behavior of the tokeniser. It is either true or false, and initially must be set to the false state. The insertion mode and the stack of open elements also affects tokenization.

字句化期の出力は、 DOCTYPE、開始タグ、終了タグ、注釈、文字、ファイル末のいずれかの字句の零個以上の系列です。 DOCTYPE 字句は名前、公開識別子、システム識別子、奇癖強制旗を持ちます。 When a DOCTYPE token is created, its name, public identifier, and system identifier must be marked as missing (which is a distinct state from the empty string), and the force-quirks flag must be set to off (its other state is on). Start and end tag tokens have a tag name, a self-closing flag, and a list of attributes, each of which has a name and a value. When a start or end tag token is created, its self-closing flag must be unset (its other state is that it be set), and its attributes list must be empty. Comment and character tokens have data.

When a token is emitted, it must immediately be handled by the tree construction stage. The tree construction stage can affect the state of the content model flag, and can insert additional characters into the stream. (For example, the script element can result in scripts executing and using the dynamic markup insertion APIs to insert characters into the stream being tokenised.)

When a start tag token is emitted with its self-closing flag set, if the flag is not acknowledged when it is processed by the tree construction stage, that is a parse error.

When an end tag token is emitted, the content model flag must be switched to the PCDATA state.

When an end tag token is emitted with attributes, that is a parse error.

When an end tag token is emitted with its self-closing flag set, that is a parse error.

Before each step of the tokeniser, the user agent may check to see if either one of the scripts in the list of scripts that will execute as soon as possible or the first script in the list of scripts that will execute asynchronously, has completed loading. If one has, then it must be executed and removed from its list.

The tokeniser state machine consists of the states defined in the following subsections.

8.2.4.1. Data state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0026 AMPERSAND (&)
When the content model flag is set to one of the PCDATA or RCDATA states and the escape flag is false: switch to the character reference data state.
Otherwise: treat it as per the "anything else" entry below.
U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-)

If the content model flag is set to either the RCDATA state or the CDATA state, and the escape flag is false, and there are at least three characters before this one in the input stream, and the last four characters in the input stream, including this one, are U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, and U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS ("<!--"), then set the escape flag to true.

In any case, emit the input character as a character token. Stay in the data state.

U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<)
When the content model flag is set to the PCDATA state: switch to the tag open state.
When the content model flag is set to either the RCDATA state or the CDATA state and the escape flag is false: switch to the tag open state.
Otherwise: treat it as per the "anything else" entry below.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)

If the content model flag is set to either the RCDATA state or the CDATA state, and the escape flag is true, and the last three characters in the input stream including this one are U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN ("-->"), set the escape flag to false.

In any case, emit the input character as a character token. Stay in the data state.

EOF
Emit an end-of-file token.
その他のもの
Emit the input character as a character token. Stay in the data state.
8.2.4.2. Character reference data state

(This cannot happen if the content model flag is set to the CDATA state.)

Attempt to consume a character reference, with no additional allowed character.

If nothing is returned, emit a U+0026 AMPERSAND character token.

Otherwise, emit the character token that was returned.

Finally, switch to the data state.

8.2.4.3. Tag open state

The behavior of this state depends on the content model flag.

If the content model flag is set to the RCDATA or CDATA states

Consume the next input character. If it is a U+002F SOLIDUS (/) character, switch to the close tag open state. Otherwise, emit a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN character token and reconsume the current input character in the data state.

If the content model flag is set to the PCDATA state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK (!)
Switch to the markup declaration open state.
U+002F SOLIDUS (/)
Switch to the close tag open state.
U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A through to U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z
Create a new start tag token, set its tag name to the lowercase version of the input character (add 0x0020 to the character's code point), then switch to the tag name state. (Don't emit the token yet; further details will be filled in before it is emitted.)
U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A through to U+007A LATIN SMALL LETTER Z
Create a new start tag token, set its tag name to the input character, then switch to the tag name state. (Don't emit the token yet; further details will be filled in before it is emitted.)
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Emit a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN character token and a U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN character token. Switch to the data state.
U+003F QUESTION MARK (?)
Parse error. Switch to the bogus comment state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Emit a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN character token and reconsume the current input character in the data state.
8.2.4.4. Close tag open state

If the content model flag is set to the RCDATA or CDATA states but no start tag token has ever been emitted by this instance of the tokeniser (fragment case), or, if the content model flag is set to the RCDATA or CDATA states and the next few characters do not match the tag name of the last start tag token emitted (compared in an ASCII case insensitive manner), or if they do but they are not immediately followed by one of the following characters:

...then emit a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN character token, a U+002F SOLIDUS character token, and switch to the data state to process the next input character.

Otherwise, if the content model flag is set to the PCDATA state, or if the next few characters do match that tag name, consume the next input character:

U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A through to U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z
Create a new end tag token, set its tag name to the lowercase version of the input character (add 0x0020 to the character's code point), then switch to the tag name state. (Don't emit the token yet; further details will be filled in before it is emitted.)
U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A through to U+007A LATIN SMALL LETTER Z
Create a new end tag token, set its tag name to the input character, then switch to the tag name state. (Don't emit the token yet; further details will be filled in before it is emitted.)
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN character token and a U+002F SOLIDUS character token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Switch to the bogus comment state.
8.2.4.5. Tag name state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Switch to the before attribute name state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A through to U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z
Append the lowercase version of the current input character (add 0x0020 to the character's code point) to the current tag token's tag name. Stay in the tag name state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
U+002F SOLIDUS (/)
Switch to the self-closing start tag state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current tag token's tag name. Stay in the tag name state.
8.2.4.6. Before attribute name state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the before attribute name state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A through to U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z
Start a new attribute in the current tag token. Set that attribute's name to the lowercase version of the current input character (add 0x0020 to the character's code point), and its value to the empty string. Switch to the attribute name state.
U+002F SOLIDUS (/)
Switch to the self-closing start tag state.
U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=)
Parse error. Treat it as per the "anything else" entry below.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Start a new attribute in the current tag token. Set that attribute's name to the current input character, and its value to the empty string. Switch to the attribute name state.
8.2.4.7. Attribute name state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Switch to the after attribute name state.
U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=)
Switch to the before attribute value state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A through to U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z
Append the lowercase version of the current input character (add 0x0020 to the character's code point) to the current attribute's name. Stay in the attribute name state.
U+002F SOLIDUS (/)
Switch to the self-closing start tag state.
U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Parse error. Treat it as per the "anything else" entry below.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current attribute's name. Stay in the attribute name state.

When the user agent leaves the attribute name state (and before emitting the tag token, if appropriate), the complete attribute's name must be compared to the other attributes on the same token; if there is already an attribute on the token with the exact same name, then this is a parse error and the new attribute must be dropped, along with the value that gets associated with it (if any).

8.2.4.8. After attribute name state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the after attribute name state.
U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=)
Switch to the before attribute value state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A through to U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z
Start a new attribute in the current tag token. Set that attribute's name to the lowercase version of the current input character (add 0x0020 to the character's code point), and its value to the empty string. Switch to the attribute name state.
U+002F SOLIDUS (/)
Switch to the self-closing start tag state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Start a new attribute in the current tag token. Set that attribute's name to the current input character, and its value to the empty string. Switch to the attribute name state.
8.2.4.9. Before attribute value state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the before attribute value state.
U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
Switch to the attribute value (double-quoted) state.
U+0026 AMPERSAND (&)
Switch to the attribute value (unquoted) state and reconsume this input character.
U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Switch to the attribute value (single-quoted) state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=)
Parse error. Treat it as per the "anything else" entry below.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current attribute's value. Switch to the attribute value (unquoted) state.
8.2.4.10. Attribute value (double-quoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
Switch to the after attribute value (quoted) state.
U+0026 AMPERSAND (&)
Switch to the character reference in attribute value state, with the additional allowed character being U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (").
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current attribute's value. Stay in the attribute value (double-quoted) state.
8.2.4.11. Attribute value (single-quoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Switch to the after attribute value (quoted) state.
U+0026 AMPERSAND (&)
Switch to the character reference in attribute value state, with the additional allowed character being U+0027 APOSTROPHE (').
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current attribute's value. Stay in the attribute value (single-quoted) state.
8.2.4.12. Attribute value (unquoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Switch to the before attribute name state.
U+0026 AMPERSAND (&)
Switch to the character reference in attribute value state, with no additional allowed character.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=)
Parse error. Treat it as per the "anything else" entry below.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current attribute's value. Stay in the attribute value (unquoted) state.
8.2.4.13. Character reference in attribute value state

Attempt to consume a character reference.

If nothing is returned, append a U+0026 AMPERSAND character to the current attribute's value.

Otherwise, append the returned character token to the current attribute's value.

Finally, switch back to the attribute value state that you were in when were switched into this state.

8.2.4.14. After attribute value (quoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Switch to the before attribute name state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
U+002F SOLIDUS (/)
Switch to the self-closing start tag state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Reconsume the character in the before attribute name state.
8.2.4.15. Self-closing start tag state

次入力文字を消費:

U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Set the self-closing flag of the current tag token. Emit the current tag token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the current tag token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Reconsume the character in the before attribute name state.
8.2.4.16. Bogus comment state

(This can only happen if the content model flag is set to the PCDATA state.)

Consume every character up to and including the first U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN character (>) or the end of the file (EOF), whichever comes first. Emit a comment token whose data is the concatenation of all the characters starting from and including the character that caused the state machine to switch into the bogus comment state, up to and including the character immediately before the last consumed character (i.e. up to the character just before the U+003E or EOF character). (If the comment was started by the end of the file (EOF), the token is empty.)

Switch to the data state.

If the end of the file was reached, reconsume the EOF character.

8.2.4.17. Markup declaration open state

(This can only happen if the content model flag is set to the PCDATA state.)

If the next two characters are both U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) characters, consume those two characters, create a comment token whose data is the empty string, and switch to the comment start state.

Otherwise, if the next seven characters are an ASCII case-insensitive match for the word "DOCTYPE", then consume those characters and switch to the DOCTYPE state.

Otherwise, if the insertion mode is "in foreign content" and the current node is not an element in the HTML namespace and the next seven characters are an ASCII case-sensitive match for the string "[CDATA[" (the five uppercase letters "CDATA" with a U+005B LEFT SQUARE BRACKET character before and after), then consume those characters and switch to the CDATA section state (which is unrelated to the content model flag's CDATA state).

Otherwise, this is a parse error. Switch to the bogus comment state. The next character that is consumed, if any, is the first character that will be in the comment.

8.2.4.18. Comment start state

次入力文字を消費:

U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-)
Switch to the comment start dash state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Emit the comment token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the comment token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the input character to the comment token's data. Switch to the comment state.
8.2.4.19. Comment start dash state

次入力文字を消費:

U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-)
Switch to the comment end state
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Emit the comment token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the comment token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) character and the input character to the comment token's data. Switch to the comment state.
8.2.4.20. Comment state

次入力文字を消費:

U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-)
Switch to the comment end dash state
EOF
Parse error. Emit the comment token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the input character to the comment token's data. Stay in the comment state.
8.2.4.21. Comment end dash state

次入力文字を消費:

U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-)
Switch to the comment end state
EOF
Parse error. Emit the comment token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) character and the input character to the comment token's data. Switch to the comment state.
8.2.4.22. Comment end state

次入力文字を消費:

U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the comment token. Switch to the data state.
U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-)
Parse error. Append a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) character to the comment token's data. Stay in the comment end state.
EOF
Parse error. Emit the comment token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Append two U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-) characters and the input character to the comment token's data. Switch to the comment state.
8.2.4.23. DOCTYPE state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Switch to the before DOCTYPE name state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Reconsume the current character in the before DOCTYPE name state.
8.2.4.24. Before DOCTYPE name state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the before DOCTYPE name state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Create a new DOCTYPE token. Set its force-quirks flag to on. Emit the token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Create a new DOCTYPE token. Set its force-quirks flag to on. Emit the token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Create a new DOCTYPE token. Set the token's name to the current input character. Switch to the DOCTYPE name state.
8.2.4.25. DOCTYPE name state

First, consume the next input character:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Switch to the after DOCTYPE name state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current DOCTYPE token's name. Stay in the DOCTYPE name state.
8.2.4.26. After DOCTYPE name state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the after DOCTYPE name state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの

If the next six characters are an ASCII case-insensitive match for the word "PUBLIC", then consume those characters and switch to the before DOCTYPE public identifier state.

Otherwise, if the next six characters are an ASCII case-insensitive match for the word "SYSTEM", then consume those characters and switch to the before DOCTYPE system identifier state.

Otherwise, this is the parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Switch to the bogus DOCTYPE state.

8.2.4.27. Before DOCTYPE public identifier state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the before DOCTYPE public identifier state.
U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
Set the DOCTYPE token's public identifier to the empty string (not missing), then switch to the DOCTYPE public identifier (double-quoted) state.
U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Set the DOCTYPE token's public identifier to the empty string (not missing), then switch to the DOCTYPE public identifier (single-quoted) state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Switch to the bogus DOCTYPE state.
8.2.4.28. DOCTYPE public identifier (double-quoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
Switch to the after DOCTYPE public identifier state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current DOCTYPE token's public identifier. Stay in the DOCTYPE public identifier (double-quoted) state.
8.2.4.29. DOCTYPE public identifier (single-quoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Switch to the after DOCTYPE public identifier state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current DOCTYPE token's public identifier. Stay in the DOCTYPE public identifier (single-quoted) state.
8.2.4.30. After DOCTYPE public identifier state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the after DOCTYPE public identifier state.
U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
Set the DOCTYPE token's system identifier to the empty string (not missing), then switch to the DOCTYPE system identifier (double-quoted) state.
U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Set the DOCTYPE token's system identifier to the empty string (not missing), then switch to the DOCTYPE system identifier (single-quoted) state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Switch to the bogus DOCTYPE state.
8.2.4.31. Before DOCTYPE system identifier state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the before DOCTYPE system identifier state.
U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
Set the DOCTYPE token's system identifier to the empty string (not missing), then switch to the DOCTYPE system identifier (double-quoted) state.
U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Set the DOCTYPE token's system identifier to the empty string (not missing), then switch to the DOCTYPE system identifier (single-quoted) state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Switch to the bogus DOCTYPE state.
8.2.4.32. DOCTYPE system identifier (double-quoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (")
Switch to the after DOCTYPE system identifier state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current DOCTYPE token's system identifier. Stay in the DOCTYPE system identifier (double-quoted) state.
8.2.4.33. DOCTYPE system identifier (single-quoted) state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0027 APOSTROPHE (')
Switch to the after DOCTYPE system identifier state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Append the current input character to the current DOCTYPE token's system identifier. Stay in the DOCTYPE system identifier (single-quoted) state.
8.2.4.34. After DOCTYPE system identifier state

次入力文字を消費:

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
Stay in the after DOCTYPE system identifier state.
U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the current DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Emit that DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Parse error. Switch to the bogus DOCTYPE state. (This does not set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on.)
8.2.4.35. Bogus DOCTYPE state

次入力文字を消費:

U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>)
Emit the DOCTYPE token. Switch to the data state.
EOF
Emit the DOCTYPE token. Reconsume the EOF character in the data state.
その他のもの
Stay in the bogus DOCTYPE state.
8.2.4.36. CDATA section state

(This can only happen if the content model flag is set to the PCDATA state, and is unrelated to the content model flag's CDATA state.)

Consume every character up to the next occurrence of the three character sequence U+005D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET U+005D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (]]>), or the end of the file (EOF), whichever comes first. Emit a series of text tokens consisting of all the characters consumed except the matching three character sequence at the end (if one was found before the end of the file).

Switch to the data state.

If the end of the file was reached, reconsume the EOF character.

8.2.4.37. Tokenizing character references

This section defines how to consume a character reference. This definition is used when parsing character references in text and in attributes.

The behavior depends on the identity of the next character (the one immediately after the U+0026 AMPERSAND character):

U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION
U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
U+000C FORM FEED (FF)
U+0020 SPACE
U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN
U+0026 AMPERSAND
EOF
The additional allowed character, if there is one
Not a character reference. No characters are consumed, and nothing is returned. (This is not an error, either.)
U+0023 NUMBER SIGN (#)

U+0023 NUMBER SIGN を消費します。

動作は更に U+0023 NUMBER SIGN の次の文字によって決まります。

U+0078 LATIN SMALL LETTER X
U+0058 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER X

X を消費します。

次の段階に従いますが、文字の範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE、U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A ~ U+0066 LATIN SMALL LETTER F、 U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A ~ U+0046 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER F (つまり 0-9、A-F、a-f) を使います。

数を解釈する折には、十六進数として解釈します。

その他のもの

次の段階に従いますが、文字の範囲 U+0030 DIGIT ZERO ~ U+0039 DIGIT NINE (つまり 0-9 だけ) を使います。

数を解釈する折には、十進数として解釈します。

前述の文字の範囲に一致する文字を、一致するだけすべて消費します。

範囲に一致する文字がない場合は、文字を消費しません (更に、 U+0023 NUMBER SIGN 文字と、必要であれば X 文字をも消費しなかったこととします)。 これは構文解析誤りです。何も返しません。

そうでない場合、次の文字が U+003B SEMICOLON であれば、これも消費します。そうでない場合は、構文解析誤りです。

1文字以上が一致した場合は、それらすべてによる文字列を数 (十六進数または十進数の適切な方) として解釈します。

その数が次の表の最初の列の数のいずれかである場合は、 構文解析誤りです。 その数が最初の列に現れる行を探し、 その行の2つ目の列に示された Unicode 文字の文字字句を返します。

Unicode 文字
0x0D U+000A LINE FEED (LF)
0x80 U+20AC EURO SIGN ('€')
0x81 U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER
0x82 U+201A SINGLE LOW-9 QUOTATION MARK ('‚')
0x83 U+0192 LATIN SMALL LETTER F WITH HOOK ('ƒ')
0x84 U+201E DOUBLE LOW-9 QUOTATION MARK ('„')
0x85 U+2026 HORIZONTAL ELLIPSIS ('…')
0x86 U+2020 DAGGER ('†')
0x87 U+2021 DOUBLE DAGGER ('‡')
0x88 U+02C6 MODIFIER LETTER CIRCUMFLEX ACCENT ('ˆ')
0x89 U+2030 PER MILLE SIGN ('‰')
0x8A U+0160 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER S WITH CARON ('Š')
0x8B U+2039 SINGLE LEFT-POINTING ANGLE QUOTATION MARK ('‹')
0x8C U+0152 LATIN CAPITAL LIGATURE OE ('Œ')
0x8D U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER
0x8E U+017D LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z WITH CARON ('Ž')
0x8F U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER
0x90 U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER
0x91 U+2018 LEFT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK ('‘')
0x92 U+2019 RIGHT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK ('’')
0x93 U+201C LEFT DOUBLE QUOTATION MARK ('“')
0x94 U+201D RIGHT DOUBLE QUOTATION MARK ('”')
0x95 U+2022 BULLET ('•')
0x96 U+2013 EN DASH ('–')
0x97 U+2014 EM DASH ('—')
0x98 U+02DC SMALL TILDE ('˜')
0x99 U+2122 TRADE MARK SIGN ('™')
0x9A U+0161 LATIN SMALL LETTER S WITH CARON ('š')
0x9B U+203A SINGLE RIGHT-POINTING ANGLE QUOTATION MARK ('›')
0x9C U+0153 LATIN SMALL LIGATURE OE ('œ')
0x9D U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER
0x9E U+017E LATIN SMALL LETTER Z WITH CARON ('ž')
0x9F U+0178 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Y WITH DIAERESIS ('Ÿ')

それ以外の場合、数が範囲 0x0000 ~ 0x0008、 0x000E、 0x001F、 0x007F ~ 0x009F、 0xD800 ~ 0xDFFF 、0xFDD0 ~ 0xFDDF のいずれかにあるか、 0xFFFE、0xFFFF、0x1FFFE、0x1FFFF、0x2FFFE、0x2FFFF、0x3FFFE、0x3FFFF、 0x4FFFE、0x4FFFF、0x5FFFE、0x5FFFF、0x6FFFE、0x6FFFF、 0x7FFFE、0x7FFFF、 0x8FFFE、0x8FFFF、0x9FFFE、0x9FFFF、0xAFFFE、0xAFFFF、0xBFFFE、0xBFFFF、 0xCFFFE、0xCFFFF、0xDFFFE、0xDFFFF、0xEFFFE、0xEFFFF、0xFFFFE、0xFFFFF、 0x10FFFE、0x10FFFF のいずれかであるか、 0x10FFFF より大きい場合、構文解析誤りです。 代わりに U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER 文字の文字字句を返します。

それ以外の場合、符号位置がその数である Unicode 文字の文字字句を返します。

その他のもの

名前付き文字参照の表の最初の列にある識別子のいずれかと一致するような、 可能な最大数の文字を消費します。

If no match can be made, then this is a parse error. No characters are consumed, and nothing is returned.

If the last character matched is not a U+003B SEMICOLON (;), there is a parse error.

If the character reference is being consumed as part of an attribute, and the last character matched is not a U+003B SEMICOLON (;), and the next character is in the range U+0030 DIGIT ZERO to U+0039 DIGIT NINE, U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A to U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z, or U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A to U+007A LATIN SMALL LETTER Z, then, for historical reasons, all the characters that were matched after the U+0026 AMPERSAND (&) must be unconsumed, and nothing is returned.

Otherwise, return a character token for the character corresponding to the character reference name (as given by the second column of the named character references table).

If the markup contains I'm &notit; I tell you, the character reference is parsed as "not", as in, I'm ¬it; I tell you. But if the markup was I'm &notin; I tell you, the character reference would be parsed as "notin;", resulting in I'm ∉ I tell you.

8.2.5 Tree construction

The input to the tree construction stage is a sequence of tokens from the tokenization stage. The tree construction stage is associated with a DOM Document object when a parser is created. The "output" of this stage consists of dynamically modifying or extending that document's DOM tree.

This specification does not define when an interactive user agent has to render the Document so that it is available to the user, or when it has to begin accepting user input.

As each token is emitted from the tokeniser, the user agent must process the token according to the rules given in the section corresponding to the current insertion mode.

When the steps below require the UA to insert a character into a node, if that node has a child immediately before where the character is to be inserted, and that child is a Text node, then the character must be appended to that Text node; otherwise, a new Text node whose data is just that character must be inserted in the appropriate place.

DOM mutation events must not fire for changes caused by the UA parsing the document. (Conceptually, the parser is not mutating the DOM, it is constructing it.) This includes the parsing of any content inserted using document.write() and document.writeln() calls. [DOM3EVENTS]

Not all of the tag names mentioned below are conformant tag names in this specification; many are included to handle legacy content. They still form part of the algorithm that implementations are required to implement to claim conformance.

The algorithm described below places no limit on the depth of the DOM tree generated, or on the length of tag names, attribute names, attribute values, text nodes, etc. While implementors are encouraged to avoid arbitrary limits, it is recognized that practical concerns will likely force user agents to impose nesting depths.

8.2.5.1. Creating and inserting elements

When the steps below require the UA to create an element for a token in a particular namespace, the UA must create a node implementing the interface appropriate for the element type corresponding to the tag name of the token in the given namespace (as given in the specification that defines that element, e.g. for an a element in the HTML namespace, this specification defines it to be the HTMLAnchorElement interface), with the tag name being the name of that element, with the node being in the given namespace, and with the attributes on the node being those given in the given token.

The interface appropriate for an element in the HTML namespace that is not defined in this specification is HTMLElement. The interface appropriate for an element in another namespace that is not defined by that namespace's specification is Element.

When the steps below require the UA to insert an HTML element for a token, the UA must first create an element for the token in the HTML namespace, and then append this node to the current node, and push it onto the stack of open elements so that it is the new current node.

The steps below may also require that the UA insert an HTML element in a particular place, in which case the UA must follow the same steps except that it must insert or append the new node in the location specified instead of appending it to the current node. (This happens in particular during the parsing of tables with invalid content.)

When the steps below require the UA to insert a foreign element for a token, the UA must first create an element for the token in the given namespace, and then append this node to the current node, and push it onto the stack of open elements so that it is the new current node. If the newly created element has an xmlns attribute in the XMLNS namespace whose value is not exactly the same as the element's namespace, that is a parse error.

When the steps below require the user agent to adjust foreign attributes for a token, then, if any of the attributes on the token match the strings given in the first column of the following table, let the attribute be a namespaced attribute, with the prefix being the string given in the corresponding cell in the second column, the local name being the string given in the corresponding cell in the third column, and the namespace being the namespace given in the corresponding cell in the fourth column. (This fixes the use of namespaced attributes, in particular xml:lang.)
Attribute name 接頭辞 Local name Namespace
xlink:actuate xlink actuate XLink namespace
xlink:arcrole xlink arcrole XLink namespace
xlink:href xlink href XLink namespace
xlink:role xlink role XLink namespace
xlink:show xlink show XLink namespace
xlink:title xlink title XLink namespace
xlink:type xlink type XLink namespace
xml:base xml base XML namespace
xml:lang xml lang XML namespace
xml:space xml space XML namespace
xmlns (none) xmlns XMLNS namespace
xmlns:xlink xmlns xlink XMLNS namespace

The generic CDATA element parsing algorithm and the generic RCDATA element parsing algorithm consist of the following steps. These algorithms are always invoked in response to a start tag token.

  1. Create an element for the token in the HTML namespace.

  2. Append the new element to the current node.

  3. If the algorithm that was invoked is the generic CDATA element parsing algorithm, switch the tokeniser's content model flag to the CDATA state; otherwise the algorithm invoked was the generic RCDATA element parsing algorithm, switch the tokeniser's content model flag to the RCDATA state.

  4. Then, collect all the character tokens that the tokeniser returns until it returns a token that is not a character token, or until it stops tokenizing.

  5. If this process resulted in a collection of character tokens, append a single Text node, whose contents is the concatenation of all those tokens' characters, to the new element node.

  6. The tokeniser's content model flag will have switched back to the PCDATA state.

  7. If the next token is an end tag token with the same tag name as the start tag token, ignore it. Otherwise, it's an end-of-file token, and this is a parse error.

8.2.5.2. Closing elements that have implied end tags

When the steps below require the UA to generate implied end tags, then, while the current node is a dd element, a dt element, an li element, an option element, an optgroup element, a p element, an rp element, or an rt element, the UA must pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

If a step requires the UA to generate implied end tags but lists an element to exclude from the process, then the UA must perform the above steps as if that element was not in the above list.

8.2.5.3. Foster parenting

Foster parenting happens when content is misnested in tables.

When a node node is to be foster parented, the node node must be inserted into the foster parent element, and the current table must be marked as tainted. (Once the current table has been tainted, whitespace characters are inserted into the foster parent element instead of the current node.)

The foster parent element is the parent element of the last table element in the stack of open elements, if there is a table element and it has such a parent element. If there is no table element in the stack of open elements (fragment case), then the foster parent element is the first element in the stack of open elements (the html element). Otherwise, if there is a table element in the stack of open elements, but the last table element in the stack of open elements has no parent, or its parent node is not an element, then the foster parent element is the element before the last table element in the stack of open elements.

If the foster parent element is the parent element of the last table element in the stack of open elements, then node must be inserted immediately before the last table element in the stack of open elements in the foster parent element; otherwise, node must be appended to the foster parent element.

8.2.5.4. "initial" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "initial" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

Ignore the token.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the Document object with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

If the DOCTYPE token's name is not an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "HTML", or if the token's public identifier is not missing, or if the token's system identifier is not missing, then there is a parse error. Conformance checkers may, instead of reporting this error, switch to a conformance checking mode for another language (e.g. based on the DOCTYPE token a conformance checker could recognize that the document is an HTML4-era document, and defer to an HTML4 conformance checker.)

Append a DocumentType node to the Document node, with the name attribute set to the name given in the DOCTYPE token; the publicId attribute set to the public identifier given in the DOCTYPE token, or the empty string if the public identifier was missing; the systemId attribute set to the system identifier given in the DOCTYPE token, or the empty string if the system identifier was missing; and the other attributes specific to DocumentType objects set to null and empty lists as appropriate. Associate the DocumentType node with the Document object so that it is returned as the value of the doctype attribute of the Document object.

Then, if the DOCTYPE token matches one of the conditions in the following list, then set the document to quirks mode:

Otherwise, if the DOCTYPE token matches one of the conditions in the following list, then set the document to limited quirks mode:

The name, system identifier, and public identifier strings must be compared to the values given in the lists above in an ASCII case-insensitive manner. A system identifier whose value is the empty string is not considered missing for the purposes of the conditions above.

Then, switch the insertion mode to "before html".

その他のもの

Parse error.

Set the document to quirks mode.

Switch the insertion mode to "before html", then reprocess the current token.

8.2.5.5. "before html" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "before html" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the Document object with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Create an element for the token in the HTML namespace. Append it to the Document object. Put this element in the stack of open elements.

If the token has an attribute "manifest", then resolve the value of that attribute to an absolute URL, and if that is successful, run the application cache selection algorithm with the resulting absolute URL. Otherwise, if there is no such attribute or resolving it fails, run the application cache selection algorithm with no manifest.

Switch the insertion mode to "before head".

その他のもの

Create an HTMLElement node with the tag name html, in the HTML namespace. Append it to the Document object. Put this element in the stack of open elements.

Run the application cache selection algorithm with no manifest.

Switch the insertion mode to "before head", then reprocess the current token.

Should probably make end tags be ignored, so that "</head><!-- --><html>" puts the comment before the root node (or should we?)

The root element can end up being removed from the Document object, e.g. by scripts; nothing in particular happens in such cases, content continues being appended to the nodes as described in the next section.

8.2.5.6. "before head" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "before head" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

Ignore the token.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "head" の開始タグ

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

head 要素指示子を新たに作られた head 要素に設定します。

挿入モードを "in head" に切り替えます。

タグ名が "head", "br" のいずれかの終了タグ

タグ名 "head" で属性のない開始タグ字句を見たかのように作用した後、 現在の字句を再処理します。

その他の終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他のもの

タグ名 "head" で属性のない開始タグ字句を見たかのように作用した後、 現在の字句を再処理します。

この結果空の head 要素が生成され、 現在の字句は "after head" 挿入モードで再処理されることとなります。

8.2.5.7. "in head" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in head" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

現在節点文字を挿入します。

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "base", "command", "eventsource", "link" のいずれかの開始タグ

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

タグ名が "meta" の開始タグ

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

If the element has a charset attribute, and its value is a supported encoding, and the confidence is currently tentative, then change the encoding to the encoding given by the value of the charset attribute.

Otherwise, if the element has a content attribute, and applying the algorithm for extracting an encoding from a Content-Type to its value returns a supported encoding encoding, and the confidence is currently tentative, then change the encoding to the encoding encoding.

タグ名が "title" の開始タグ

Follow the generic RCDATA element parsing algorithm.

A start tag whose tag name is "noscript", if the scripting flag is enabled
タグ名が "noframes", "style" のいずれかの開始タグ

Follow the generic CDATA element parsing algorithm.

A start tag whose tag name is "noscript", if the scripting flag is disabled

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

Switch the insertion mode to "in head noscript".

タグ名が "script" の開始タグ

Create an element for the token in the HTML namespace.

Mark the element as being "parser-inserted". This ensures that, if the script is external, any document.write() calls in the script will execute in-line, instead of blowing the document away, as would happen in most other cases.

Switch the tokeniser's content model flag to the CDATA state.

Then, collect all the character tokens that the tokeniser returns until it returns a token that is not a character token, or until it stops tokenizing.

If this process resulted in a collection of character tokens, append a single Text node to the script element node whose contents is the concatenation of all those tokens' characters.

The tokeniser's content model flag will have switched back to the PCDATA state.

If the next token is not an end tag token with the tag name "script", then this is a parse error; mark the script element as "already executed". Otherwise, the token is the script element's end tag, so ignore it.

If the parser was originally created for the HTML fragment parsing algorithm, then mark the script element as "already executed", and skip the rest of the processing described for this token (including the part below where "pending external scripts" are executed). (fragment case)

Marking the script element as "already executed" prevents it from executing when it is inserted into the document a few paragraphs below. Thus, scripts missing their end tags and scripts that were inserted using innerHTML, outerHTML, or insertAdjacentHTML() aren't executed.

Let the old insertion point have the same value as the current insertion point. Let the insertion point be just before the next input character.

Append the new element to the current node. Special processing occurs when a script element is inserted into a document that might cause some script to execute, which might cause new characters to be inserted into the tokeniser.

Let the insertion point have the value of the old insertion point. (In other words, restore the insertion point to the value it had before the previous paragraph. This value might be the "undefined" value.)

At this stage, if there is a pending external script, then:

If the tree construction stage is being called reentrantly, say from a call to document.write():

Abort the processing of any nested invocations of the tokeniser, yielding control back to the caller. (Tokenization will resume when the caller returns to the "outer" tree construction stage.)

それ以外の場合:

Follow these steps:

  1. Let the script be the pending external script. There is no longer a pending external script.

  2. Pause until the script has completed loading.

  3. Let the insertion point be just before the next input character.

  4. Execute the script.

  5. Let the insertion point be undefined again.

  6. If there is once again a pending external script, then repeat these steps from step 1.

タグ名が "head" の終了タグ

Pop the current node (which will be the head element) off the stack of open elements.

Switch the insertion mode to "after head".

タグ名が "br" の終了タグ

Act as described in the "anything else" entry below.

タグ名が "head" の開始タグ
その他の終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他のもの

Act as if an end tag token with the tag name "head" had been seen, and reprocess the current token.

In certain UAs, some elements don't trigger the "in body" mode straight away, but instead get put into the head. Do we want to copy that?

8.2.5.8. "in head noscript" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in head noscript" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "noscript" の終了タグ

Pop the current node (which will be a noscript element) from the stack of open elements; the new current node will be a head element.

挿入モードを "in head" に切り替えます。

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE
注釈字句
タグ名が "link", "meta", "noframes", "style" のいずれかの開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.

タグ名が "br" のいずれかの終了タグ

Act as described in the "anything else" entry below.

タグ名が "head", "noscript" のいずれかの開始タグ
その他の終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他のもの

Parse error. Act as if an end tag with the tag name "noscript" had been seen and reprocess the current token.

8.2.5.9. "after head" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "after head" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

現在節点文字を挿入します。

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "body" の開始タグ

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

Switch the insertion mode to "in body".

タグ名が "frameset" の開始タグ

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

Switch the insertion mode to "in frameset".

A start tag token whose tag name is one of: "base", "link", "meta", "noframes", "script", "style", "title"

Parse error.

Push the node pointed to by the head element pointer onto the stack of open elements.

Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.

Pop the current node (which will be the node pointed to by the head element pointer) off the stack of open elements.

タグ名が "head" の開始タグ
その他の終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他のもの

Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "body" and no attributes had been seen, and then reprocess the current token.

8.2.5.10. "in body" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in body" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

Insert the token's character into the current node.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Parse error. For each attribute on the token, check to see if the attribute is already present on the top element of the stack of open elements. If it is not, add the attribute and its corresponding value to that element.

A start tag token whose tag name is one of: "base", "command", "eventsource", "link", "meta", "noframes", "script", "style", "title"

Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.

タグ名が "body" の開始タグ

Parse error.

If the second element on the stack of open elements is not a body element, or, if the stack of open elements has only one node on it, then ignore the token. (fragment case)

Otherwise, for each attribute on the token, check to see if the attribute is already present on the body element (the second element) on the stack of open elements. If it is not, add the attribute and its corresponding value to that element.

An end-of-file token

If there is a node in the stack of open elements that is not either a dd element, a dt element, an li element, a p element, a tbody element, a td element, a tfoot element, a th element, a thead element, a tr element, the body element, or the html element, then this is a parse error.

Stop parsing.

タグ名が "body" の終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have a body element in scope, this is a parse error; ignore the token.

Otherwise, if there is a node in the stack of open elements that is not either a dd element, a dt element, an li element, a p element, a tbody element, a td element, a tfoot element, a th element, a thead element, a tr element, the body element, or the html element, then this is a parse error.

Switch the insertion mode to "after body". Otherwise, ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の終了タグ

Act as if an end tag with tag name "body" had been seen, then, if that token wasn't ignored, reprocess the current token.

The fake end tag token here can only be ignored in the fragment case.

タグ名が "address", "article", "aside", "blockquote", "center", "datagrid", "details", "dialog", "dir", "div", "dl", "fieldset", "figure", "footer", "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", "h6", "header", "menu", "nav", "ol", "p", "section", "ul" のいずれかの開始タグ

If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

タグ名が "pre", "listing" のいずれかの開始タグ

If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

If the next token is a U+000A LINE FEED (LF) character token, then ignore that token and move on to the next one. (Newlines at the start of pre blocks are ignored as an authoring convenience.)

タグ名が "form" の開始タグ

If the form element pointer is not null, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.

それ以外の場合:

If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

Insert an HTML element for the token, and set the form element pointer to point to the element created.

タグ名が "li" の開始タグ

次の算法を実行します:

  1. Initialise node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).

  2. If node is an li element, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "li" had been seen, then jump to the last step.

  3. If node is not in the formatting category, and is not in the phrasing category, and is not an address, div, or p element, then jump to the last step.

  4. Otherwise, set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements and return to step 2.

  5. If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

    Finally, insert an HTML element for the token.

タグ名が "dd", "dt" のいずれかの開始タグ

次の算法を実行します:

  1. Initialise node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).

  2. If node is a dd or dt element, then act as if an end tag with the same tag name as node had been seen, then jump to the last step.

  3. If node is not in the formatting category, and is not in the phrasing category, and is not an address, div, or p element, then jump to the last step.

  4. Otherwise, set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements and return to step 2.

  5. If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

    Finally, insert an HTML element for the token.

タグ名が "plaintext" の開始タグ

If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

Switch the content model flag to the PLAINTEXT state.

Once a start tag with the tag name "plaintext" has been seen, that will be the last token ever seen other than character tokens (and the end-of-file token), because there is no way to switch the content model flag out of the PLAINTEXT state.

タグ名が "address", "article", "aside", "blockquote", "center", "datagrid", "details", "dialog", "dir", "div", "dl", "fieldset", "figure", "footer", "header", "listing", "menu", "nav", "ol", "pre", "section", "ul" のいずれかの終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.

Otherwise, run these steps:

  1. Generate implied end tags.

  2. If the current node is not an element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.

  3. Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.

タグ名が "form" の終了タグ

Set the form element pointer to null.

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.

Otherwise, run these steps:

  1. Generate implied end tags.

  2. If the current node is not an element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.

  3. Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.

タグ名が "p" の終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; act as if a start tag with the tag name p had been seen, then reprocess the current token.

Otherwise, run these steps:

  1. Generate implied end tags, except for elements with the same tag name as the token.

  2. If the current node is not an element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.

  3. Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.

タグ名が "dd", "dt", "li" のいずれかの終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.

Otherwise, run these steps:

  1. Generate implied end tags, except for elements with the same tag name as the token.

  2. If the current node is not an element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.

  3. Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.

タグ名が "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", "h6" のいずれかの終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope whose tag name is one of "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", or "h6", then this is a parse error; ignore the token.

Otherwise, run these steps:

  1. Generate implied end tags.

  2. If the current node is not an element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.

  3. Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an element whose tag name is one of "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", or "h6" has been popped from the stack.

タグ名が "sarcasm" の終了タグ

深呼吸をして、後述の「その他の終了タグ」の項で説明されているように作用します。

タグ名が "a" の開始タグ

If the list of active formatting elements contains an element whose tag name is "a" between the end of the list and the last marker on the list (or the start of the list if there is no marker on the list), then this is a parse error; act as if an end tag with the tag name "a" had been seen, then remove that element from the list of active formatting elements and the stack of open elements if the end tag didn't already remove it (it might not have if the element is not in table scope).

不適合ストリーム <a href="a">a<table><a href="b">b</table>x において、最初の a 要素は2つ目のを見たときに閉じられ、 「x」文字は「a」へのリンクではなく、「b」へのリンクの内側に入ります。 これは、外側の a 要素が表範囲中にないためです (つまり、表の最初に普通の </a> 終了タグがあったとしても、 外側の a 要素を閉じないということになります)。

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

Insert an HTML element for the token. Add that element to the list of active formatting elements.

タグ名が "b", "big", "em", "font", "i", "s", "small", "strike", "strong", "tt", "u" のいずれかの開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

Insert an HTML element for the token. Add that element to the list of active formatting elements.

タグ名が "nobr" の開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

If the stack of open elements has a nobr element in scope, then this is a parse error; act as if an end tag with the tag name "nobr" had been seen, then once again reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.

Insert an HTML element for the token. Add that element to the list of active formatting elements.

タグ名が "a", "b", "big", "em", "font", "i", "nobr", "s", "small", "strike", "strong", "tt", "u" のいずれかの終了タグ

Follow these steps:

  1. Let the formatting element be the last element in the list of active formatting elements that:

    • is between the end of the list and the last scope marker in the list, if any, or the start of the list otherwise, and
    • has the same tag name as the token.

    If there is no such node, or, if that node is also in the stack of open elements but the element is not in scope, then this is a parse error; ignore the token, and abort these steps.

    Otherwise, if there is such a node, but that node is not in the stack of open elements, then this is a parse error; remove the element from the list, and abort these steps.

    Otherwise, there is a formatting element and that element is in the stack and is in scope. If the element is not the current node, this is a parse error. In any case, proceed with the algorithm as written in the following steps.

  2. Let the furthest block be the topmost node in the stack of open elements that is lower in the stack than the formatting element, and is not an element in the phrasing or formatting categories. There might not be one.

  3. If there is no furthest block, then the UA must skip the subsequent steps and instead just pop all the nodes from the bottom of the stack of open elements, from the current node up to and including the formatting element, and remove the formatting element from the list of active formatting elements.

  4. Let the common ancestor be the element immediately above the formatting element in the stack of open elements.

  5. If the furthest block has a parent node, then remove the furthest block from its parent node.

  6. Let a bookmark note the position of the formatting element in the list of active formatting elements relative to the elements on either side of it in the list.

  7. Let node and last node be the furthest block. Follow these steps:

    1. Let node be the element immediately above node in the stack of open elements.
    2. If node is not in the list of active formatting elements, then remove node from the stack of open elements and then go back to step 1.
    3. Otherwise, if node is the formatting element, then go to the next step in the overall algorithm.
    4. Otherwise, if last node is the furthest block, then move the aforementioned bookmark to be immediately after the node in the list of active formatting elements.
    5. If node has any children, perform a shallow clone of node, replace the entry for node in the list of active formatting elements with an entry for the clone, replace the entry for node in the stack of open elements with an entry for the clone, and let node be the clone.
    6. Insert last node into node, first removing it from its previous parent node if any.
    7. Let last node be node.
    8. 手順 1 of this inner set of steps に戻ります。
  8. If the common ancestor node is a table, tbody, tfoot, thead, or tr element, then, foster parent whatever last node ended up being in the previous step.

    Otherwise, append whatever last node ended up being in the previous step to the common ancestor node, first removing it from its previous parent node if any.

  9. Perform a shallow clone of the formatting element.

  10. Take all of the child nodes of the furthest block and append them to the clone created in the last step.

  11. Append that clone to the furthest block.

  12. Remove the formatting element from the list of active formatting elements, and insert the clone into the list of active formatting elements at the position of the aforementioned bookmark.

  13. Remove the formatting element from the stack of open elements, and insert the clone into the stack of open elements immediately below the position of the furthest block in that stack.

  14. Jump back to step 1 in this series of steps.

The way these steps are defined, only elements in the formatting category ever get cloned by this algorithm.

Because of the way this algorithm causes elements to change parents, it has been dubbed the "adoption agency algorithm" (in contrast with other possibly algorithms for dealing with misnested content, which included the "incest algorithm", the "secret affair algorithm", and the "Heisenberg algorithm").

タグ名が "button" の開始タグ

If the stack of open elements has a button element in scope, then this is a parse error; act as if an end tag with the tag name "button" had been seen, then reprocess the token.

それ以外の場合:

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

If the form element pointer is not null, then associate the button element with the form element pointed to by the form element pointer.

Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.

A start tag token whose tag name is one of: "applet", "marquee", "object"

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.

An end tag token whose tag name is one of: "applet", "button", "marquee", "object"

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.

Otherwise, run these steps:

  1. Generate implied end tags.

  2. If the current node is not an element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.

  3. Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.

  4. Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.
タグ名が "xmp" の開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

Follow the generic CDATA element parsing algorithm.

タグ名が "table" の開始タグ

If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

Switch the insertion mode to "in table".

タグ名が "area", "basefont", "bgsound", "br", "embed", "img", "spacer", "wbr" のいずれかの開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

タグ名が "param", "source" のいずれかの開始タグ

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

タグ名が "hr" の開始タグ

If the stack of open elements has a p element in scope, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "p" had been seen.

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

タグ名が "image" の開始タグ

Parse error. Change the token's tag name to "img" and reprocess it. (Don't ask.)

タグ名が "input" の開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

If the form element pointer is not null, then associate the newly created input element with the form element pointed to by the form element pointer.

タグ名が "isindex" の開始タグ

Parse error.

If the form element pointer is not null, then ignore the token.

それ以外の場合:

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "form" had been seen.

If the token has an attribute called "action", set the action attribute on the resulting form element to the value of the "action" attribute of the token.

Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "hr" had been seen.

Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "p" had been seen.

Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "label" had been seen.

Act as if a stream of character tokens had been seen (see below for what they should say).

Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "input" had been seen, with all the attributes from the "isindex" token except "name", "action", and "prompt". Set the name attribute of the resulting input element to the value "isindex".

Act as if a stream of character tokens had been seen (see below for what they should say).

Act as if an end tag token with the tag name "label" had been seen.

Act as if an end tag token with the tag name "p" had been seen.

Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "hr" had been seen.

Act as if an end tag token with the tag name "form" had been seen.

If the token has an attribute with the name "prompt", then the first stream of characters must be the same string as given in that attribute, and the second stream of characters must be empty. Otherwise, the two streams of character tokens together should, together with the input element, express the equivalent of "This is a searchable index. Insert your search keywords here: (input field)" in the user's preferred language.

Then need to specify that if the form submission causes just a single form control, whose name is "isindex", to be submitted, then we submit just the value part, not the "isindex=" part.

タグ名が "textarea" の開始タグ

Create an element for the token in the HTML namespace. Append the new element to the current node.

If the form element pointer is not null, then associate the newly created textarea element with the form element pointed to by the form element pointer.

Switch the tokeniser's content model flag to the RCDATA state.

If the next token is a U+000A LINE FEED (LF) character token, then ignore that token and move on to the next one. (Newlines at the start of textarea elements are ignored as an authoring convenience.)

Then, collect all the character tokens that the tokeniser returns until it returns a token that is not a character token, or until it stops tokenizing.

If this process resulted in a collection of character tokens, append a single Text node, whose contents is the concatenation of all those tokens' characters, to the new element node.

The tokeniser's content model flag will have switched back to the PCDATA state.

If the next token is an end tag token with the tag name "textarea", ignore it. Otherwise, this is a parse error.

タグ名が "iframe", "noembed" のいずれかの開始タグ
A start tag whose tag name is "noscript", if the scripting flag is enabled

Follow the generic CDATA element parsing algorithm.

タグ名が "select" の開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

If the form element pointer is not null, then associate the select element with the form element pointed to by the form element pointer.

If the insertion mode is one of in table", "in caption", "in column group", "in table body", "in row", or "in cell", then switch the insertion mode to "in select in table". Otherwise, switch the insertion mode to "in select".

タグ名が "rp", "rt" のいずれかの開始タグ

If the stack of open elements has a ruby element in scope, then generate implied end tags. If the current node is not then a ruby element, this is a parse error; pop all the nodes from the current node up to the node immediately before the bottommost ruby element on the stack of open elements.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

タグ名が "br" の終了タグ

Parse error. Act as if a start tag token with the tag name "br" had been seen. Ignore the end tag token.

タグ名が "math" の開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

Adjust foreign attributes for the token. (This fixes the use of namespaced attributes, in particular XLink.)

Insert a foreign element for the token, in the MathML namespace.

If the token has its self-closing flag set, pop the current node off the stack of open elements and acknowledge the token's self-closing flag.

Otherwise, let the secondary insertion mode be the current insertion mode, and then switch the insertion mode to "in foreign content".

A start tag whose tag name is one of: "caption", "col", "colgroup", "frame", "frameset", "head", "tbody", "td", "tfoot", "th", "thead", "tr"

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他の開始タグ

活性書式付け要素を再構築できれば、します。

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

This element will be a phrasing element.

その他の終了タグ

Run the following steps:

  1. Initialise node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).

  2. If node has the same tag name as the end tag token, then:

    1. Generate implied end tags.

    2. If the tag name of the end tag token does not match the tag name of the current node, this is a parse error.

    3. Pop all the nodes from the current node up to node, including node, then stop these steps.

  3. Otherwise, if node is in neither the formatting category nor the phrasing category, then this is a parse error; ignore the token, and abort these steps.

  4. Set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements.

  5. 手順 2 に戻ります。

8.2.5.11. "in table" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in table" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

If the current table is tainted, then act as described in the "anything else" entry below.

Otherwise, insert the character into the current node.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "caption" の開始タグ

Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)

Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.

Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in caption".

タグ名が "colgroup" の開始タグ

Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)

Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in column group".

タグ名が "col" の開始タグ

タグ名が "colgroup" の開始タグ字句を見たかのように動作してから、 現在字句を再処理します。

タグ名が "tbody", "tfoot", "thead" のいずれかの開始タグ

Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)

Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in table body".

タグ名が "td", "th", "tr" のいずれかの開始タグ

タグ名が "tbody" の開始タグ字句を見たかのように動作してから、 現在字句を再処理します。

タグ名が "table" の開始タグ

Parse error. Act as if an end tag token with the tag name "table" had been seen, then, if that token wasn't ignored, reprocess the current token.

The fake end tag token here can only be ignored in the fragment case.

タグ名が "table" の終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error. Ignore the token. (fragment case)

それ以外の場合:

Pop elements from this stack until a table element has been popped from the stack.

Reset the insertion mode appropriately.

タグ名が "body", "caption", "col", "colgroup", "html", "tbody", "td", "tfoot", "th", "thead", "tr" のいずれかの終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "style", "script" のいずれかの開始タグ

If the current table is tainted then act as described in the "anything else" entry below.

Otherwise, process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.

タグ名が "input" の開始タグ

If the token does not have an attribute with the name "type", or if it does, but that attribute's value is not an ASCII case-insensitive match for the string "hidden", or, if the current table is tainted, then: act as described in the "anything else" entry below.

それ以外の場合:

Parse error.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

If the form element pointer is not null, then associate the input element with the form element pointed to by the form element pointer.

Pop that input element off the stack of open elements.

An end-of-file token

If the current node is not the root html element, then this is a parse error.

It can only be the current node in the fragment case.

Stop parsing.

その他のもの

Parse error. Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode, except that if the current node is a table, tbody, tfoot, thead, or tr element, then, whenever a node would be inserted into the current node, it must instead be foster parented.

When the steps above require the UA to clear the stack back to a table context, it means that the UA must, while the current node is not a table element or an html element, pop elements from the stack of open elements.

The current node being an html element after this process is a fragment case.

8.2.5.12. "in caption" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in caption" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

タグ名が "caption" の終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error. Ignore the token. (fragment case)

それ以外の場合:

Generate implied end tags.

Now, if the current node is not a caption element, then this is a parse error.

Pop elements from this stack until a caption element has been popped from the stack.

Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.

Switch the insertion mode to "in table".

タグ名が "caption", "col", "colgroup", "tbody", "td", "tfoot", "th", "thead", "tr" のいずれかの開始タグ
タグ名が "table" の終了タグ

Parse error. Act as if an end tag with the tag name "caption" had been seen, then, if that token wasn't ignored, reprocess the current token.

The fake end tag token here can only be ignored in the fragment case.

タグ名が "body", "col", "colgroup", "html", "tbody", "td", "tfoot", "th", "thead", "tr" のいずれかの終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他のもの

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

8.2.5.13. "in column group" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in column group" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

現在節点文字を挿入します。

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "col" の開始タグ

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

タグ名が "colgroup" の終了タグ

If the current node is the root html element, then this is a parse error; ignore the token. (fragment case)

Otherwise, pop the current node (which will be a colgroup element) from the stack of open elements. Switch the insertion mode to "in table".

タグ名が "col" の終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

An end-of-file token

If the current node is the root html element, then stop parsing. (fragment case)

Otherwise, act as described in the "anything else" entry below.

その他のもの

Act as if an end tag with the tag name "colgroup" had been seen, and then, if that token wasn't ignored, reprocess the current token.

The fake end tag token here can only be ignored in the fragment case.

8.2.5.14. "in table body" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in table body" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

タグ名が "tr" の開始タグ

Clear the stack back to a table body context. (See below.)

Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in row".

タグ名が "th", "td" のいずれかの開始タグ

Parse error. Act as if a start tag with the tag name "tr" had been seen, then reprocess the current token.

タグ名が "tbody", "tfoot", "thead" のいずれかの終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error. Ignore the token.

それ以外の場合:

Clear the stack back to a table body context. (See below.)

Pop the current node from the stack of open elements. Switch the insertion mode to "in table".

タグ名が "caption", "col", "colgroup", "tbody", "tfoot", "thead" のいずれかの開始タグ
タグ名が "table" の終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have a tbody, thead, or tfoot element in table scope, this is a parse error. Ignore the token. (fragment case)

それ以外の場合:

Clear the stack back to a table body context. (See below.)

Act as if an end tag with the same tag name as the current node ("tbody", "tfoot", or "thead") had been seen, then reprocess the current token.

タグ名が "body", "caption", "col", "colgroup", "html", "td", "th", "tr" のいずれかの終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他のもの

Process the token using the rules for the "in table" insertion mode.

When the steps above require the UA to clear the stack back to a table body context, it means that the UA must, while the current node is not a tbody, tfoot, thead, or html element, pop elements from the stack of open elements.

The current node being an html element after this process is a fragment case.

8.2.5.15. "in row" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in row" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

タグ名が "th", "td" のいずれかの開始タグ

Clear the stack back to a table row context. (See below.)

Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in cell".

Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.

タグ名が "tr" の終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error. Ignore the token. (fragment case)

それ以外の場合:

Clear the stack back to a table row context. (See below.)

Pop the current node (which will be a tr element) from the stack of open elements. Switch the insertion mode to "in table body".

タグ名が "caption", "col", "colgroup", "tbody", "tfoot", "thead", "tr" のいずれかの開始タグ
タグ名が "table" の終了タグ

Act as if an end tag with the tag name "tr" had been seen, then, if that token wasn't ignored, reprocess the current token.

The fake end tag token here can only be ignored in the fragment case.

タグ名が "tbody", "tfoot", "thead" のいずれかの終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error. Ignore the token.

Otherwise, act as if an end tag with the tag name "tr" had been seen, then reprocess the current token.

タグ名が "body", "caption", "col", "colgroup", "html", "td", "th" のいずれかの終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

その他のもの

Process the token using the rules for the "in table" insertion mode.

When the steps above require the UA to clear the stack back to a table row context, it means that the UA must, while the current node is not a tr element or an html element, pop elements from the stack of open elements.

The current node being an html element after this process is a fragment case.

8.2.5.16. "in cell" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in cell" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

タグ名が "td", "th" のいずれかの終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error and the token must be ignored.

それ以外の場合:

Generate implied end tags.

Now, if the current node is not an element with the same tag name as the token, then this is a parse error.

Pop elements from this stack until an element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.

Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.

Switch the insertion mode to "in row". (The current node will be a tr element at this point.)

タグ名が "caption", "col", "colgroup", "tbody", "td", "tfoot", "th", "thead", "tr" のいずれかの開始タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have a td or th element in table scope, then this is a parse error; ignore the token. (fragment case)

Otherwise, close the cell (see below) and reprocess the current token.

タグ名が "body", "caption", "col", "colgroup", "html" のいずれかの終了タグ

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "table", "tbody", "tfoot", "thead", "tr" のいずれかの終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as that of the token (which can only happen for "tbody", "tfoot" and "thead", or, in the fragment case), then this is a parse error and the token must be ignored.

Otherwise, close the cell (see below) and reprocess the current token.

その他のもの

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

Where the steps above say to close the cell, they mean to run the following algorithm:

  1. If the stack of open elements has a td element in table scope, then act as if an end tag token with the tag name "td" had been seen.

  2. Otherwise, the stack of open elements will have a th element in table scope; act as if an end tag token with the tag name "th" had been seen.

The stack of open elements cannot have both a td and a th element in table scope at the same time, nor can it have neither when the insertion mode is "in cell".

8.2.5.17. "in select" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in select" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token

Insert the token's character into the current node.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "option" の開始タグ

If the current node is an option element, act as if an end tag with the tag name "option" had been seen.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

タグ名が "optgroup" の開始タグ

If the current node is an option element, act as if an end tag with the tag name "option" had been seen.

If the current node is an optgroup element, act as if an end tag with the tag name "optgroup" had been seen.

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

タグ名が "optgroup" の終了タグ

First, if the current node is an option element, and the node immediately before it in the stack of open elements is an optgroup element, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "option" had been seen.

If the current node is an optgroup element, then pop that node from the stack of open elements. Otherwise, this is a parse error; ignore the token.

タグ名が "option" の終了タグ

If the current node is an option element, then pop that node from the stack of open elements. Otherwise, this is a parse error; ignore the token.

タグ名が "select" の終了タグ

If the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error. Ignore the token. (fragment case)

それ以外の場合:

Pop elements from the stack of open elements until a select element has been popped from the stack.

Reset the insertion mode appropriately.

タグ名が "select" の開始タグ

Parse error. Act as if the token had been an end tag with the tag name "select" instead.

タグ名が "input", "textarea" のいずれかの開始タグ

Parse error. Act as if an end tag with the tag name "select" had been seen, and reprocess the token.

An end-of-file token

If the current node is not the root html element, then this is a parse error.

It can only be the current node in the fragment case.

Stop parsing.

その他のもの

Parse error. Ignore the token.

8.2.5.18. "in select in table" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in select in table" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

タグ名が "caption", "table", "tbody", "tfoot", "thead", "tr", "td", "th" のいずれかの開始タグ

Parse error. Act as if an end tag with the tag name "select" had been seen, and reprocess the token.

タグ名が "caption", "table", "tbody", "tfoot", "thead", "tr", "td", "th" のいずれかの終了タグ

Parse error.

If the stack of open elements has an element in table scope with the same tag name as that of the token, then act as if an end tag with the tag name "select" had been seen, and reprocess the token. Otherwise, ignore the token.

その他のもの

Process the token using the rules for the "in select" insertion mode.

8.2.5.19. "in foreign content" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in foreign content" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token

Insert the token's character into the current node.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

A start tag whose tag name is neither "mglyph" nor "malignmark", if the current node is an mi element in the MathML namespace.
A start tag whose tag name is neither "mglyph" nor "malignmark", if the current node is an mo element in the MathML namespace.
A start tag whose tag name is neither "mglyph" nor "malignmark", if the current node is an mn element in the MathML namespace.
A start tag whose tag name is neither "mglyph" nor "malignmark", if the current node is an ms element in the MathML namespace.
A start tag whose tag name is neither "mglyph" nor "malignmark", if the current node is an mtext element in the MathML namespace.
A start tag, if the current node is an element in the HTML namespace.
An end tag

Process the token using the rules for the secondary insertion mode.

If, after doing so, the insertion mode is still "in foreign content", but there is no element in scope that has a namespace other than the HTML namespace, switch the insertion mode to the secondary insertion mode.

タグ名が "b", "big", "blockquote", "body", "br", "center", "code", "dd", "div", "dl", "dt", "em", "embed", "font", "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", "h6", "head", "hr", "i", "img", "li", "listing", "menu", "meta", "nobr", "ol", "p", "pre", "ruby", "s", "small", "span", "strong", "strike", "sub", "sup", "table", "tt", "u", "ul", "var" のいずれかの開始タグ
An end-of-file token

Parse error.

Pop elements from the stack of open elements until the current node is in the HTML namespace.

Switch the insertion mode to the secondary insertion mode, and reprocess the token.

その他の開始タグ

Adjust foreign attributes for the token. (This fixes the use of namespaced attributes, in particular XLink in SVG.)

Insert a foreign element for the token, in the same namespace as the current node.

If the token has its self-closing flag set, pop the current node off the stack of open elements and acknowledge the token's self-closing flag.

8.2.5.20. "after body" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "after body" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the first element in the stack of open elements (the html element), with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "html" の終了タグ

If the parser was originally created as part of the HTML fragment parsing algorithm, this is a parse error; ignore the token. (fragment case)

Otherwise, switch the insertion mode to "after after body".

An end-of-file token

Stop parsing.

その他のもの

Parse error. Switch the insertion mode to "in body" and reprocess the token.

8.2.5.21. "in frameset" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "in frameset" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

現在節点文字を挿入します。

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "frameset" の開始タグ

当該字句について HTML 要素を挿入します。

タグ名が "frameset" の終了タグ

If the current node is the root html element, then this is a parse error; ignore the token. (fragment case)

Otherwise, pop the current node from the stack of open elements.

If the parser was not originally created as part of the HTML fragment parsing algorithm (fragment case), and the current node is no longer a frameset element, then switch the insertion mode to "after frameset".

タグ名が "frame" の開始タグ

Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.

Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.

タグ名が "noframes" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.

An end-of-file token

If the current node is not the root html element, then this is a parse error.

It can only be the current node in the fragment case.

Stop parsing.

その他のもの

Parse error. Ignore the token.

8.2.5.22. "after frameset" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "after frameset" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE

現在節点文字を挿入します。

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the current node with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句

Parse error. Ignore the token.

タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

タグ名が "html" の終了タグ

Switch the insertion mode to "after after frameset".

タグ名が "noframes" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.

An end-of-file token

Stop parsing.

その他のもの

Parse error. Ignore the token.

This doesn't handle UAs that don't support frames, or that do support frames but want to show the NOFRAMES content. Supporting the former is easy; supporting the latter is harder.

8.2.5.23. "after after body" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "after after body" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the Document object with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句
A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE
タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

An end-of-file token

Stop parsing.

その他のもの

Parse error. Switch the insertion mode to "in body" and reprocess the token.

8.2.5.24. "after after frameset" 挿入モード

挿入モードが "after after frameset" の時、 字句は次のように取り扱わなければなりません

注釈字句

Append a Comment node to the Document object with the data attribute set to the data given in the comment token.

DOCTYPE 字句
A character token that is one of one of U+0009 CHARACTER TABULATION, U+000A LINE FEED (LF), U+000C FORM FEED (FF), or U+0020 SPACE
タグ名が "html" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.

An end-of-file token

Stop parsing.

タグ名が "noframes" の開始タグ

Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.

その他のもの

Parse error. Ignore the token.

8.2.6 The end

Once the user agent stops parsing the document, the user agent must follow the steps in this section.

First, the current document readiness must be set to "interactive".

Then, the rules for when a script completes loading start applying (script execution is no longer managed by the parser).

If any of the scripts in the list of scripts that will execute as soon as possible have completed loading, or if the list of scripts that will execute asynchronously is not empty and the first script in that list has completed loading, then the user agent must act as if those scripts just completed loading, following the rules given for that in the script element definition.

Then, if the list of scripts that will execute when the document has finished parsing is not empty, and the first item in this list has already completed loading, then the user agent must act as if that script just finished loading.

By this point, there will be no scripts that have loaded but have not yet been executed.

The user agent must then fire a simple event called DOMContentLoaded at the Document.

Once everything that delays the load event has completed, the user agent must set the current document readiness to "complete", and then fire a load event at the body element.

delaying the load event for things like image loads allows for intranet port scans (even without javascript!). Should we really encode that into the spec?

8.2.7 Coercing an HTML DOM into an infoset

When an application uses an HTML parser in conjunction with an XML pipeline, it is possible that the constructed DOM is not compatible with the XML tool chain in certain subtle ways. For example, an XML toolchain might not be able to represent attributes with the name xmlns, since they conflict with the Namespaces in XML syntax. There is also some data that the HTML parser generates that isn't included in the DOM itself. This section specifies some rules for handling these issues.

If the XML API being used doesn't support DOCTYPEs, tools may drop DOCTYPEs altogether.

If the XML API doesn't support attributes in no namespace that are named "xmlns", attributes whose names start with "xmlns:", or attributes in the XMLNS namespace, then the tool may drop such attributes.

The tool may annotate the output with any namespace declarations required for proper operation.

If the XML API being used restricts the allowable characters in the local names of elements and attributes, then the tool may map all element and attribute local names that the API wouldn't support to a set of names that are allowed, by replacing any character that isn't supported with the uppercase letter U and the five digits of the character's Unicode codepoint when expressed in hexadecimal, using digits 0-9 and capital letters A-F as the symbols, in increasing numeric order.

For example, the element name foo<bar, which can be output by the HTML parser, though it is neither a legal HTML element name nor a well-formed XML element name, would be converted into fooU0003Cbar, which is a well-formed XML element name (though it's still not legal in HTML by any means).

As another example, consider the attribute xlink:href. Used on a MathML element, it becomes, after being adjusted, an attribute with a prefix "xlink" and a local name "href". However, used on an HTML element, it becomes an attribute with no prefix and the local name "xlink:href", which is not a valid NCName, and thus might not be accepted by an XML API. It could thus get converted, becoming "xlinkU0003Ahref".

The resulting names from this conversion conveniently can't clash with any attribute generated by the HTML parser, since those are all either lowercase or those listed in the adjust foreign attributes algorithm's table.

If the XML API restricts comments from having two consecutive U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS characters (--), the tool may insert a single U+0020 SPACE character between any such offending characters.

If the XML API restricts comments from ending in a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS character (-), the tool may insert a single U+0020 SPACE character at the end of such comments.

If the XML API restricts allowed characters in character data, the tool may replace any U+000C FORM FEED (FF) character with a U+0020 SPACE character, and any other literal non-XML character with a U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER.

If the tool has no way to convey out-of-band information, then the tool may drop the following information:

The mutatiosn allowed by this section apply after the HTML parser's rules have been applied. For example, a <a::> start tag will be closed by a </a::> end tag, and never by a </aU0003AU0003A> end tag, even if the user agent is using the rules above to then generate an actual element in the DOM with the name aU0003AU0003A for that start tag.

8.3 Namespaces

The HTML namespace is: http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml

The MathML namespace is: http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML

The SVG namespace is: http://www.w3.org/2000/svg

The XLink namespace is: http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink

The XML namespace is: http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace

The XMLNS namespace is: http://www.w3.org/2000/xmlns/

8.4 Serializing HTML fragments

The following steps form the HTML fragment serialization algorithm. The algorithm takes as input a DOM Element or Document, referred to as the node, and either returns a string or raises an exception.

This algorithm serializes the children of the node being serialized, not the node itself.

  1. Let s be a string, and initialise it to the empty string.

  2. For each child node of the node, in tree order, run the following steps:

    1. Let current node be the child node being processed.

    2. Append the appropriate string from the following list to s:

      If current node is an Element

      Append a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<) character, followed by the element's tag name. (For nodes created by the HTML parser, Document.createElement(), or Document.renameNode(), the tag name will be lowercase.)

      For each attribute that the element has, append a U+0020 SPACE character, the attribute's name (which, for attributes set by the HTML parser or by Element.setAttributeNode() or Element.setAttribute(), will be lowercase), a U+003D EQUALS SIGN (=) character, a U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (") character, the attribute's value, escaped as described below in attribute mode, and a second U+0022 QUOTATION MARK (") character.

      While the exact order of attributes is UA-defined, and may depend on factors such as the order that the attributes were given in the original markup, the sort order must be stable, such that consecutive invocations of this algorithm serialize an element's attributes in the same order.

      Append a U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>) character.

      If current node is an area, base, basefont, bgsound, br, col, embed, frame, hr, img, input, link, meta, param, spacer, or wbr element, then continue on to the next child node at this point.

      If current node is a pre textarea, or listing element, append a U+000A LINE FEED (LF) character.

      Append the value of running the HTML fragment serialization algorithm on the current node element (thus recursing into this algorithm for that element), followed by a U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN (<) character, a U+002F SOLIDUS (/) character, the element's tag name again, and finally a U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (>) character.

      If current node is a Text or CDATASection node

      If one of the ancestors of current node is a style, script, xmp, iframe, noembed, noframes, noscript, or plaintext element, then append the value of current node's data DOM attribute literally.

      Otherwise, append the value of current node's data DOM attribute, escaped as described below.

      If current node is a Comment

      Append the literal string <!-- (U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS), followed by the value of current node's data DOM attribute, followed by the literal string --> (U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN).

      If current node is a ProcessingInstruction

      Append the literal string <? (U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+003F QUESTION MARK), followed by the value of current node's target DOM attribute, followed by a single U+0020 SPACE character, followed by the value of current node's data DOM attribute, followed by a single U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN character ('>').

      If current node is a DocumentType

      Append the literal string <!DOCTYPE (U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+0044 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D, U+004F LATIN CAPITAL LETTER O, U+0043 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER C, U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T, U+0059 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Y, U+0050 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER P, U+0045 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E), followed by a space (U+0020 SPACE), followed by the value of current node's name DOM attribute, followed by the literal string > (U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN).

      Other node types (e.g. Attr) cannot occur as children of elements. If, despite this, they somehow do occur, this algorithm must raise an INVALID_STATE_ERR exception.

  3. The result of the algorithm is the string s.

Escaping a string (for the purposes of the algorithm above) consists of replacing any occurrences of the "&" character by the string "&amp;", any occurrences of the "<" character by the string "&lt;", any occurrences of the ">" character by the string "&gt;", any occurrences of the U+00A0 NO-BREAK SPACE character by the string "&nbsp;", and, if the algorithm was invoked in the attribute mode, any occurrences of the """ character by the string "&quot;".

Entity reference nodes are assumed to be expanded by the user agent, and are therefore not covered in the algorithm above.

It is possible that the output of this algorithm, if parsed with an HTML parser, will not return the original tree structure. For instance, if a textarea element to which a Comment node has been appended is serialized and the output is then reparsed, the comment will end up being displayed in the text field. Similarly, if, as a result of DOM manipulation, an element contains a comment that contains the literal string "-->", then when the result of serializing the element is parsed, the comment will be truncated at that point and the rest of the comment will be interpreted as markup. More examples would be making a script element contain a text node with the text string "</script>", or having a p element that contains a ul element (as the ul element's start tag would imply the end tag for the p).

8.5 Parsing HTML fragments

The following steps form the HTML fragment parsing algorithm. The algorithm takes as input a DOM Element, referred to as the context element, which gives the context for the parser, as well as input, a string to parse, and returns a list of zero or more nodes.

Parts marked fragment case in algorithms in the parser section are parts that only occur if the parser was created for the purposes of this algorithm. The algorithms have been annotated with such markings for informational purposes only; such markings have no normative weight. If it is possible for a condition described as a fragment case to occur even when the parser wasn't created for the purposes of handling this algorithm, then that is an error in the specification.

  1. Create a new Document node, and mark it as being an HTML document.

  2. Create a new HTML parser, and associate it with the just created Document node.

  3. Set the HTML parser's tokenization stage's content model flag according to the context element, as follows:

    If it is a title or textarea element
    Set the content model flag to the RCDATA state.
    If it is a style, script, xmp, iframe, noembed, or noframes element
    Set the content model flag to the CDATA state.
    If it is a noscript element
    If the scripting flag is enabled, set the content model flag to the CDATA state. Otherwise, set the content model flag to the PCDATA state.
    If it is a plaintext element
    Set the content model flag to PLAINTEXT.
    その他の場合
    Set the content model flag to the PCDATA state.
  4. Let root be a new html element with no attributes.

  5. Append the element root to the Document node created above.

  6. Set up the parser's stack of open elements so that it contains just the single element root.

  7. Reset the parser's insertion mode appropriately.

    The parser will reference the context element as part of that algorithm.

  8. Set the parser's form element pointer to the nearest node to the context element that is a form element (going straight up the ancestor chain, and including the element itself, if it is a form element), or, if there is no such form element, to null.

  9. Place into the input stream for the HTML parser just created the input.

  10. Start the parser and let it run until it has consumed all the characters just inserted into the input stream.

  11. Return all the child nodes of root, preserving the document order.

8.6 Named character references

This table lists the character reference names that are supported by HTML, and the code points to which they refer. It is referenced by the previous sections.

Name Character
AElig; U+000C6
AElig U+000C6
AMP; U+00026
AMP U+00026
Aacute; U+000C1
Aacute U+000C1
Abreve; U+00102
Acirc; U+000C2
Acirc U+000C2
Acy; U+00410
Afr; U+1D504
Agrave; U+000C0
Agrave U+000C0
Alpha; U+00391
Amacr; U+00100
And; U+02A53
Aogon; U+00104
Aopf; U+1D538
ApplyFunction; U+02061
Aring; U+000C5
Aring U+000C5
Ascr; U+1D49C
Assign; U+02254
Atilde; U+000C3
Atilde U+000C3
Auml; U+000C4
Auml U+000C4
Backslash; U+02216
Barv; U+02AE7
Barwed; U+02306
Bcy; U+00411
Because; U+02235
Bernoullis; U+0212C
Beta; U+00392
Bfr; U+1D505
Bopf; U+1D539
Breve; U+002D8
Bscr; U+0212C
Bumpeq; U+0224E
CHcy; U+00427
COPY; U+000A9
COPY U+000A9
Cacute; U+00106
Cap; U+022D2
CapitalDifferentialD; U+02145
Cayleys; U+0212D
Ccaron; U+0010C
Ccedil; U+000C7
Ccedil U+000C7
Ccirc; U+00108
Cconint; U+02230
Cdot; U+0010A
Cedilla; U+000B8
CenterDot; U+000B7
Cfr; U+0212D
Chi; U+003A7
CircleDot; U+02299
CircleMinus; U+02296
CirclePlus; U+02295
CircleTimes; U+02297
ClockwiseContourIntegral; U+02232
CloseCurlyDoubleQuote; U+0201D
CloseCurlyQuote; U+02019
Colon; U+02237
Colone; U+02A74
Congruent; U+02261
Conint; U+0222F
ContourIntegral; U+0222E
Copf; U+02102
Coproduct; U+02210
CounterClockwiseContourIntegral; U+02233
Cross; U+02A2F
Cscr; U+1D49E
Cup; U+022D3
CupCap; U+0224D
DD; U+02145
DDotrahd; U+02911
DJcy; U+00402
DScy; U+00405
DZcy; U+0040F
Dagger; U+02021
Darr; U+021A1
Dashv; U+02AE4
Dcaron; U+0010E
Dcy; U+00414
Del; U+02207
Delta; U+00394
Dfr; U+1D507
DiacriticalAcute; U+000B4
DiacriticalDot; U+002D9
DiacriticalDoubleAcute; U+002DD
DiacriticalGrave; U+00060
DiacriticalTilde; U+002DC
Diamond; U+022C4
DifferentialD; U+02146
Dopf; U+1D53B
Dot; U+000A8
DotDot; U+020DC
DotEqual; U+02250
DoubleContourIntegral; U+0222F
DoubleDot; U+000A8
DoubleDownArrow; U+021D3
DoubleLeftArrow; U+021D0
DoubleLeftRightArrow; U+021D4
DoubleLeftTee; U+02AE4
DoubleLongLeftArrow; U+027F8
DoubleLongLeftRightArrow; U+027FA
DoubleLongRightArrow; U+027F9
DoubleRightArrow; U+021D2
DoubleRightTee; U+022A8
DoubleUpArrow; U+021D1
DoubleUpDownArrow; U+021D5
DoubleVerticalBar; U+02225
DownArrow; U+02193
DownArrowBar; U+02913
DownArrowUpArrow; U+021F5
DownBreve; U+00311
DownLeftRightVector; U+02950
DownLeftTeeVector; U+0295E
DownLeftVector; U+021BD
DownLeftVectorBar; U+02956
DownRightTeeVector; U+0295F
DownRightVector; U+021C1
DownRightVectorBar; U+02957
DownTee; U+022A4
DownTeeArrow; U+021A7
Downarrow; U+021D3
Dscr; U+1D49F
Dstrok; U+00110
ENG; U+0014A
ETH; U+000D0
ETH U+000D0
Eacute; U+000C9
Eacute U+000C9
Ecaron; U+0011A
Ecirc; U+000CA
Ecirc U+000CA
Ecy; U+0042D
Edot; U+00116
Efr; U+1D508
Egrave; U+000C8
Egrave U+000C8
Element; U+02208
Emacr; U+00112
EmptySmallSquare; U+025FB
EmptyVerySmallSquare; U+025AB
Eogon; U+00118
Eopf; U+1D53C
Epsilon; U+00395
Equal; U+02A75
EqualTilde; U+02242
Equilibrium; U+021CC
Escr; U+02130
Esim; U+02A73
Eta; U+00397
Euml; U+000CB
Euml U+000CB
Exists; U+02203
ExponentialE; U+02147
Fcy; U+00424
Ffr; U+1D509
FilledSmallSquare; U+025FC
FilledVerySmallSquare; U+025AA
Fopf; U+1D53D
ForAll; U+02200
Fouriertrf; U+02131
Fscr; U+02131
GJcy; U+00403
GT; U+0003E
GT U+0003E
Gamma; U+00393
Gammad; U+003DC
Gbreve; U+0011E
Gcedil; U+00122
Gcirc; U+0011C
Gcy; U+00413
Gdot; U+00120
Gfr; U+1D50A
Gg; U+022D9
Gopf; U+1D53E
GreaterEqual; U+02265
GreaterEqualLess; U+022DB
GreaterFullEqual; U+02267
GreaterGreater; U+02AA2
GreaterLess; U+02277
GreaterSlantEqual; U+02A7E
GreaterTilde; U+02273
Gscr; U+1D4A2
Gt; U+0226B
HARDcy; U+0042A
Hacek; U+002C7
Hat; U+0005E
Hcirc; U+00124
Hfr; U+0210C
HilbertSpace; U+0210B
Hopf; U+0210D
HorizontalLine; U+02500
Hscr; U+0210B
Hstrok; U+00126
HumpDownHump; U+0224E
HumpEqual; U+0224F
IEcy; U+00415
IJlig; U+00132
IOcy; U+00401
Iacute; U+000CD
Iacute U+000CD
Icirc; U+000CE
Icirc U+000CE
Icy; U+00418
Idot; U+00130
Ifr; U+02111
Igrave; U+000CC
Igrave U+000CC
Im; U+02111
Imacr; U+0012A
ImaginaryI; U+02148
Implies; U+021D2
Int; U+0222C
Integral; U+0222B
Intersection; U+022C2
InvisibleComma; U+02063
InvisibleTimes; U+02062
Iogon; U+0012E
Iopf; U+1D540
Iota; U+00399
Iscr; U+02110
Itilde; U+00128
Iukcy; U+00406
Iuml; U+000CF
Iuml U+000CF
Jcirc; U+00134
Jcy; U+00419
Jfr; U+1D50D
Jopf; U+1D541
Jscr; U+1D4A5
Jsercy; U+00408
Jukcy; U+00404
KHcy; U+00425
KJcy; U+0040C
Kappa; U+0039A
Kcedil; U+00136
Kcy; U+0041A
Kfr; U+1D50E
Kopf; U+1D542
Kscr; U+1D4A6
LJcy; U+00409
LT; U+0003C
LT U+0003C
Lacute; U+00139
Lambda; U+0039B
Lang; U+027EA
Laplacetrf; U+02112
Larr; U+0219E
Lcaron; U+0013D
Lcedil; U+0013B
Lcy; U+0041B
LeftAngleBracket; U+027E8
LeftArrow; U+02190
LeftArrowBar; U+021E4
LeftArrowRightArrow; U+021C6
LeftCeiling; U+02308
LeftDoubleBracket; U+027E6
LeftDownTeeVector; U+02961
LeftDownVector; U+021C3
LeftDownVectorBar; U+02959
LeftFloor; U+0230A
LeftRightArrow; U+02194
LeftRightVector; U+0294E
LeftTee; U+022A3
LeftTeeArrow; U+021A4
LeftTeeVector; U+0295A
LeftTriangle; U+022B2
LeftTriangleBar; U+029CF
LeftTriangleEqual; U+022B4
LeftUpDownVector; U+02951
LeftUpTeeVector; U+02960
LeftUpVector; U+021BF
LeftUpVectorBar; U+02958
LeftVector; U+021BC
LeftVectorBar; U+02952
Leftarrow; U+021D0
Leftrightarrow; U+021D4
LessEqualGreater; U+022DA
LessFullEqual; U+02266
LessGreater; U+02276
LessLess; U+02AA1
LessSlantEqual; U+02A7D
LessTilde; U+02272
Lfr; U+1D50F
Ll; U+022D8
Lleftarrow; U+021DA
Lmidot; U+0013F
LongLeftArrow; U+027F5
LongLeftRightArrow; U+027F7
LongRightArrow; U+027F6
Longleftarrow; U+027F8
Longleftrightarrow; U+027FA
Longrightarrow; U+027F9
Lopf; U+1D543
LowerLeftArrow; U+02199
LowerRightArrow; U+02198
Lscr; U+02112
Lsh; U+021B0
Lstrok; U+00141
Lt; U+0226A
Map; U+02905
Mcy; U+0041C
MediumSpace; U+0205F
Mellintrf; U+02133
Mfr; U+1D510
MinusPlus; U+02213
Mopf; U+1D544
Mscr; U+02133
Mu; U+0039C
NJcy; U+0040A
Nacute; U+00143
Ncaron; U+00147
Ncedil; U+00145
Ncy; U+0041D
NegativeMediumSpace; U+0200B
NegativeThickSpace; U+0200B
NegativeThinSpace; U+0200B
NegativeVeryThinSpace; U+0200B
NestedGreaterGreater; U+0226B
NestedLessLess; U+0226A
NewLine; U+0000A
Nfr; U+1D511
NoBreak; U+02060
NonBreakingSpace; U+000A0
Nopf; U+02115
Not; U+02AEC
NotCongruent; U+02262
NotCupCap; U+0226D
NotDoubleVerticalBar; U+02226
NotElement; U+02209
NotEqual; U+02260
NotExists; U+02204
NotGreater; U+0226F
NotGreaterEqual; U+02271
NotGreaterLess; U+02279
NotGreaterTilde; U+02275
NotLeftTriangle; U+022EA
NotLeftTriangleEqual; U+022EC
NotLess; U+0226E
NotLessEqual; U+02270
NotLessGreater; U+02278
NotLessTilde; U+02274
NotPrecedes; U+02280
NotPrecedesSlantEqual; U+022E0
NotReverseElement; U+0220C
NotRightTriangle; U+022EB
NotRightTriangleEqual; U+022ED
NotSquareSubsetEqual; U+022E2
NotSquareSupersetEqual; U+022E3
NotSubsetEqual; U+02288
NotSucceeds; U+02281
NotSucceedsSlantEqual; U+022E1
NotSupersetEqual; U+02289
NotTilde; U+02241
NotTildeEqual; U+02244
NotTildeFullEqual; U+02247
NotTildeTilde; U+02249
NotVerticalBar; U+02224
Nscr; U+1D4A9
Ntilde; U+000D1
Ntilde U+000D1
Nu; U+0039D
OElig; U+00152
Oacute; U+000D3
Oacute U+000D3
Ocirc; U+000D4
Ocirc U+000D4
Ocy; U+0041E
Odblac; U+00150
Ofr; U+1D512
Ograve; U+000D2
Ograve U+000D2
Omacr; U+0014C
Omega; U+003A9
Omicron; U+0039F
Oopf; U+1D546
OpenCurlyDoubleQuote; U+0201C
OpenCurlyQuote; U+02018
Or; U+02A54
Oscr; U+1D4AA
Oslash; U+000D8
Oslash U+000D8
Otilde; U+000D5
Otilde U+000D5
Otimes; U+02A37
Ouml; U+000D6
Ouml U+000D6
OverBar; U+000AF
OverBrace; U+023DE
OverBracket; U+023B4
OverParenthesis; U+023DC
PartialD; U+02202
Pcy; U+0041F
Pfr; U+1D513
Phi; U+003A6
Pi; U+003A0
PlusMinus; U+000B1
Poincareplane; U+0210C
Popf; U+02119
Pr; U+02ABB
Precedes; U+0227A
PrecedesEqual; U+02AAF
PrecedesSlantEqual; U+0227C
PrecedesTilde; U+0227E
Prime; U+02033
Product; U+0220F
Proportion; U+02237
Proportional; U+0221D
Pscr; U+1D4AB
Psi; U+003A8
QUOT; U+00022
QUOT U+00022
Qfr; U+1D514
Qopf; U+0211A
Qscr; U+1D4AC
RBarr; U+02910
REG; U+000AE
REG U+000AE
Racute; U+00154
Rang; U+027EB
Rarr; U+021A0
Rarrtl; U+02916
Rcaron; U+00158
Rcedil; U+00156
Rcy; U+00420
Re; U+0211C
ReverseElement; U+0220B
ReverseEquilibrium; U+021CB
ReverseUpEquilibrium; U+0296F
Rfr; U+0211C
Rho; U+003A1
RightAngleBracket; U+027E9
RightArrow; U+02192
RightArrowBar; U+021E5
RightArrowLeftArrow; U+021C4
RightCeiling; U+02309
RightDoubleBracket; U+027E7
RightDownTeeVector; U+0295D
RightDownVector; U+021C2
RightDownVectorBar; U+02955
RightFloor; U+0230B
RightTee; U+022A2
RightTeeArrow; U+021A6
RightTeeVector; U+0295B
RightTriangle; U+022B3
RightTriangleBar; U+029D0
RightTriangleEqual; U+022B5
RightUpDownVector; U+0294F
RightUpTeeVector; U+0295C
RightUpVector; U+021BE
RightUpVectorBar; U+02954
RightVector; U+021C0
RightVectorBar; U+02953
Rightarrow; U+021D2
Ropf; U+0211D
RoundImplies; U+02970
Rrightarrow; U+021DB
Rscr; U+0211B
Rsh; U+021B1
RuleDelayed; U+029F4
SHCHcy; U+00429
SHcy; U+00428
SOFTcy; U+0042C
Sacute; U+0015A
Sc; U+02ABC
Scaron; U+00160
Scedil; U+0015E
Scirc; U+0015C
Scy; U+00421
Sfr; U+1D516
ShortDownArrow; U+02193
ShortLeftArrow; U+02190
ShortRightArrow; U+02192
ShortUpArrow; U+02191
Sigma; U+003A3
SmallCircle; U+02218
Sopf; U+1D54A
Sqrt; U+0221A
Square; U+025A1
SquareIntersection; U+02293
SquareSubset; U+0228F
SquareSubsetEqual; U+02291
SquareSuperset; U+02290
SquareSupersetEqual; U+02292
SquareUnion; U+02294
Sscr; U+1D4AE
Star; U+022C6
Sub; U+022D0
Subset; U+022D0
SubsetEqual; U+02286
Succeeds; U+0227B
SucceedsEqual; U+02AB0
SucceedsSlantEqual; U+0227D
SucceedsTilde; U+0227F
SuchThat; U+0220B
Sum; U+02211
Sup; U+022D1
Superset; U+02283
SupersetEqual; U+02287
Supset; U+022D1
THORN; U+000DE
THORN U+000DE
TRADE; U+02122
TSHcy; U+0040B
TScy; U+00426
Tab; U+00009
Tau; U+003A4
Tcaron; U+00164
Tcedil; U+00162
Tcy; U+00422
Tfr; U+1D517
Therefore; U+02234
Theta; U+00398
ThinSpace; U+02009
Tilde; U+0223C
TildeEqual; U+02243
TildeFullEqual; U+02245
TildeTilde; U+02248
Topf; U+1D54B
TripleDot; U+020DB
Tscr; U+1D4AF
Tstrok; U+00166
Uacute; U+000DA
Uacute U+000DA
Uarr; U+0219F
Uarrocir; U+02949
Ubrcy; U+0040E
Ubreve; U+0016C
Ucirc; U+000DB
Ucirc U+000DB
Ucy; U+00423
Udblac; U+00170
Ufr; U+1D518
Ugrave; U+000D9
Ugrave U+000D9
Umacr; U+0016A
UnderBar; U+00332
UnderBrace; U+023DF
UnderBracket; U+023B5
UnderParenthesis; U+023DD
Union; U+022C3
UnionPlus; U+0228E
Uogon; U+00172
Uopf; U+1D54C
UpArrow; U+02191
UpArrowBar; U+02912
UpArrowDownArrow; U+021C5
UpDownArrow; U+02195
UpEquilibrium; U+0296E
UpTee; U+022A5
UpTeeArrow; U+021A5
Uparrow; U+021D1
Updownarrow; U+021D5
UpperLeftArrow; U+02196
UpperRightArrow; U+02197
Upsi; U+003D2
Upsilon; U+003A5
Uring; U+0016E
Uscr; U+1D4B0
Utilde; U+00168
Uuml; U+000DC
Uuml U+000DC
VDash; U+022AB
Vbar; U+02AEB
Vcy; U+00412
Vdash; U+022A9
Vdashl; U+02AE6
Vee; U+022C1
Verbar; U+02016
Vert; U+02016
VerticalBar; U+02223
VerticalLine; U+0007C
VerticalSeparator; U+02758
VerticalTilde; U+02240
VeryThinSpace; U+0200A
Vfr; U+1D519
Vopf; U+1D54D
Vscr; U+1D4B1
Vvdash; U+022AA
Wcirc; U+00174
Wedge; U+022C0
Wfr; U+1D51A
Wopf; U+1D54E
Wscr; U+1D4B2
Xfr; U+1D51B
Xi; U+0039E
Xopf; U+1D54F
Xscr; U+1D4B3
YAcy; U+0042F
YIcy; U+00407
YUcy; U+0042E
Yacute; U+000DD
Yacute U+000DD
Ycirc; U+00176
Ycy; U+0042B
Yfr; U+1D51C
Yopf; U+1D550
Yscr; U+1D4B4
Yuml; U+00178
ZHcy; U+00416
Zacute; U+00179
Zcaron; U+0017D
Zcy; U+00417
Zdot; U+0017B
ZeroWidthSpace; U+0200B
Zeta; U+00396
Zfr; U+02128
Zopf; U+02124
Zscr; U+1D4B5
aacute; U+000E1
aacute U+000E1
abreve; U+00103
ac; U+0223E
acd; U+0223F
acirc; U+000E2
acirc U+000E2
acute; U+000B4
acute U+000B4
acy; U+00430
aelig; U+000E6
aelig U+000E6
af; U+02061
afr; U+1D51E
agrave; U+000E0
agrave U+000E0
alefsym; U+02135
aleph; U+02135
alpha; U+003B1
amacr; U+00101
amalg; U+02A3F
amp; U+00026
amp U+00026
and; U+02227
andand; U+02A55
andd; U+02A5C
andslope; U+02A58
andv; U+02A5A
ang; U+02220
ange; U+029A4
angle; U+02220
angmsd; U+02221
angmsdaa; U+029A8
angmsdab; U+029A9
angmsdac; U+029AA
angmsdad; U+029AB
angmsdae; U+029AC
angmsdaf; U+029AD
angmsdag; U+029AE
angmsdah; U+029AF
angrt; U+0221F
angrtvb; U+022BE
angrtvbd; U+0299D
angsph; U+02222
angst; U+0212B
angzarr; U+0237C
aogon; U+00105
aopf; U+1D552
ap; U+02248
apE; U+02A70
apacir; U+02A6F
ape; U+0224A
apid; U+0224B
apos; U+00027
approx; U+02248
approxeq; U+0224A
aring; U+000E5
aring U+000E5
ascr; U+1D4B6
ast; U+0002A
asymp; U+02248
asympeq; U+0224D
atilde; U+000E3
atilde U+000E3
auml; U+000E4
auml U+000E4
awconint; U+02233
awint; U+02A11
bNot; U+02AED
backcong; U+0224C
backepsilon; U+003F6
backprime; U+02035
backsim; U+0223D
backsimeq; U+022CD
barvee; U+022BD
barwed; U+02305
barwedge; U+02305
bbrk; U+023B5
bbrktbrk; U+023B6
bcong; U+0224C
bcy; U+00431
bdquo; U+0201E
becaus; U+02235
because; U+02235
bemptyv; U+029B0
bepsi; U+003F6
bernou; U+0212C
beta; U+003B2
beth; U+02136
between; U+0226C
bfr; U+1D51F
bigcap; U+022C2
bigcirc; U+025EF
bigcup; U+022C3
bigodot; U+02A00
bigoplus; U+02A01
bigotimes; U+02A02
bigsqcup; U+02A06
bigstar; U+02605
bigtriangledown; U+025BD
bigtriangleup; U+025B3
biguplus; U+02A04
bigvee; U+022C1
bigwedge; U+022C0
bkarow; U+0290D
blacklozenge; U+029EB
blacksquare; U+025AA
blacktriangle; U+025B4
blacktriangledown; U+025BE
blacktriangleleft; U+025C2
blacktriangleright; U+025B8
blank; U+02423
blk12; U+02592
blk14; U+02591
blk34; U+02593
block; U+02588
bnot; U+02310
bopf; U+1D553
bot; U+022A5
bottom; U+022A5
bowtie; U+022C8
boxDL; U+02557
boxDR; U+02554
boxDl; U+02556
boxDr; U+02553
boxH; U+02550
boxHD; U+02566
boxHU; U+02569
boxHd; U+02564
boxHu; U+02567
boxUL; U+0255D
boxUR; U+0255A
boxUl; U+0255C
boxUr; U+02559
boxV; U+02551
boxVH; U+0256C
boxVL; U+02563
boxVR; U+02560
boxVh; U+0256B
boxVl; U+02562
boxVr; U+0255F
boxbox; U+029C9
boxdL; U+02555
boxdR; U+02552
boxdl; U+02510
boxdr; U+0250C
boxh; U+02500
boxhD; U+02565
boxhU; U+02568
boxhd; U+0252C
boxhu; U+02534
boxminus; U+0229F
boxplus; U+0229E
boxtimes; U+022A0
boxuL; U+0255B
boxuR; U+02558
boxul; U+02518
boxur; U+02514
boxv; U+02502
boxvH; U+0256A
boxvL; U+02561
boxvR; U+0255E
boxvh; U+0253C
boxvl; U+02524
boxvr; U+0251C
bprime; U+02035
breve; U+002D8
brvbar; U+000A6
brvbar U+000A6
bscr; U+1D4B7
bsemi; U+0204F
bsim; U+0223D
bsime; U+022CD
bsol; U+0005C
bsolb; U+029C5
bull; U+02022
bullet; U+02022
bump; U+0224E
bumpE; U+02AAE
bumpe; U+0224F
bumpeq; U+0224F
cacute; U+00107
cap; U+02229
capand; U+02A44
capbrcup; U+02A49
capcap; U+02A4B
capcup; U+02A47
capdot; U+02A40
caret; U+02041
caron; U+002C7
ccaps; U+02A4D
ccaron; U+0010D
ccedil; U+000E7
ccedil U+000E7
ccirc; U+00109
ccups; U+02A4C
ccupssm; U+02A50
cdot; U+0010B
cedil; U+000B8
cedil U+000B8
cemptyv; U+029B2
cent; U+000A2
cent U+000A2
centerdot; U+000B7
cfr; U+1D520
chcy; U+00447
check; U+02713
checkmark; U+02713
chi; U+003C7
cir; U+025CB
cirE; U+029C3
circ; U+002C6
circeq; U+02257
circlearrowleft; U+021BA
circlearrowright; U+021BB
circledR; U+000AE
circledS; U+024C8
circledast; U+0229B
circledcirc; U+0229A
circleddash; U+0229D
cire; U+02257
cirfnint; U+02A10
cirmid; U+02AEF
cirscir; U+029C2
clubs; U+02663
clubsuit; U+02663
colon; U+0003A
colone; U+02254
coloneq; U+02254
comma; U+0002C
commat; U+00040
comp; U+02201
compfn; U+02218
complement; U+02201
complexes; U+02102
cong; U+02245
congdot; U+02A6D
conint; U+0222E
copf; U+1D554
coprod; U+02210
copy; U+000A9
copy U+000A9
copysr; U+02117
crarr; U+021B5
cross; U+02717
cscr; U+1D4B8
csub; U+02ACF
csube; U+02AD1
csup; U+02AD0
csupe; U+02AD2
ctdot; U+022EF
cudarrl; U+02938
cudarrr; U+02935
cuepr; U+022DE
cuesc; U+022DF
cularr; U+021B6
cularrp; U+0293D
cup; U+0222A
cupbrcap; U+02A48
cupcap; U+02A46
cupcup; U+02A4A
cupdot; U+0228D
cupor; U+02A45
curarr; U+021B7
curarrm; U+0293C
curlyeqprec; U+022DE
curlyeqsucc; U+022DF
curlyvee; U+022CE
curlywedge; U+022CF
curren; U+000A4
curren U+000A4
curvearrowleft; U+021B6
curvearrowright; U+021B7
cuvee; U+022CE
cuwed; U+022CF
cwconint; U+02232
cwint; U+02231
cylcty; U+0232D
dArr; U+021D3
dHar; U+02965
dagger; U+02020
daleth; U+02138
darr; U+02193
dash; U+02010
dashv; U+022A3
dbkarow; U+0290F
dblac; U+002DD
dcaron; U+0010F
dcy; U+00434
dd; U+02146
ddagger; U+02021
ddarr; U+021CA
ddotseq; U+02A77
deg; U+000B0
deg U+000B0
delta; U+003B4
demptyv; U+029B1
dfisht; U+0297F
dfr; U+1D521
dharl; U+021C3
dharr; U+021C2
diam; U+022C4
diamond; U+022C4
diamondsuit; U+02666
diams; U+02666
die; U+000A8
digamma; U+003DD
disin; U+022F2
div; U+000F7
divide; U+000F7
divide U+000F7
divideontimes; U+022C7
divonx; U+022C7
djcy; U+00452
dlcorn; U+0231E
dlcrop; U+0230D
dollar; U+00024
dopf; U+1D555
dot; U+002D9
doteq; U+02250
doteqdot; U+02251
dotminus; U+02238
dotplus; U+02214
dotsquare; U+022A1
doublebarwedge; U+02306
downarrow; U+02193
downdownarrows; U+021CA
downharpoonleft; U+021C3
downharpoonright; U+021C2
drbkarow; U+02910
drcorn; U+0231F
drcrop; U+0230C
dscr; U+1D4B9
dscy; U+00455
dsol; U+029F6
dstrok; U+00111
dtdot; U+022F1
dtri; U+025BF
dtrif; U+025BE
duarr; U+021F5
duhar; U+0296F
dwangle; U+029A6
dzcy; U+0045F
dzigrarr; U+027FF
eDDot; U+02A77
eDot; U+02251
eacute; U+000E9
eacute U+000E9
easter; U+02A6E
ecaron; U+0011B
ecir; U+02256
ecirc; U+000EA
ecirc U+000EA
ecolon; U+02255
ecy; U+0044D
edot; U+00117
ee; U+02147
efDot; U+02252
efr; U+1D522
eg; U+02A9A
egrave; U+000E8
egrave U+000E8
egs; U+02A96
egsdot; U+02A98
el; U+02A99
elinters; U+023E7
ell; U+02113
els; U+02A95
elsdot; U+02A97
emacr; U+00113
empty; U+02205
emptyset; U+02205
emptyv; U+02205
emsp13; U+02004
emsp14; U+02005
emsp; U+02003
eng; U+0014B
ensp; U+02002
eogon; U+00119
eopf; U+1D556
epar; U+022D5
eparsl; U+029E3
eplus; U+02A71
epsi; U+003F5
epsilon; U+003B5
epsiv; U+003B5
eqcirc; U+02256
eqcolon; U+02255
eqsim; U+02242
eqslantgtr; U+02A96
eqslantless; U+02A95
equals; U+0003D
equest; U+0225F
equiv; U+02261
equivDD; U+02A78
eqvparsl; U+029E5
erDot; U+02253
erarr; U+02971
escr; U+0212F
esdot; U+02250
esim; U+02242
eta; U+003B7
eth; U+000F0
eth U+000F0
euml; U+000EB
euml U+000EB
euro; U+020AC
excl; U+00021
exist; U+02203
expectation; U+02130
exponentiale; U+02147
fallingdotseq; U+02252
fcy; U+00444
female; U+02640
ffilig; U+0FB03
fflig; U+0FB00
ffllig; U+0FB04
ffr; U+1D523
filig; U+0FB01
flat; U+0266D
fllig; U+0FB02
fltns; U+025B1
fnof; U+00192
fopf; U+1D557
forall; U+02200
fork; U+022D4
forkv; U+02AD9
fpartint; U+02A0D
frac12; U+000BD
frac12 U+000BD
frac13; U+02153
frac14; U+000BC
frac14 U+000BC
frac15; U+02155
frac16; U+02159
frac18; U+0215B
frac23; U+02154
frac25; U+02156
frac34; U+000BE
frac34 U+000BE
frac35; U+02157
frac38; U+0215C
frac45; U+02158
frac56; U+0215A
frac58; U+0215D
frac78; U+0215E
frasl; U+02044
frown; U+02322
fscr; U+1D4BB
gE; U+02267
gEl; U+02A8C
gacute; U+001F5
gamma; U+003B3
gammad; U+003DD
gap; U+02A86
gbreve; U+0011F
gcirc; U+0011D
gcy; U+00433
gdot; U+00121
ge; U+02265
gel; U+022DB
geq; U+02265
geqq; U+02267
geqslant; U+02A7E
ges; U+02A7E
gescc; U+02AA9
gesdot; U+02A80
gesdoto; U+02A82
gesdotol; U+02A84
gesles; U+02A94
gfr; U+1D524
gg; U+0226B
ggg; U+022D9
gimel; U+02137
gjcy; U+00453
gl; U+02277
glE; U+02A92
gla; U+02AA5
glj; U+02AA4
gnE; U+02269
gnap; U+02A8A
gnapprox; U+02A8A
gne; U+02A88
gneq; U+02A88
gneqq; U+02269
gnsim; U+022E7
gopf; U+1D558
grave; U+00060
gscr; U+0210A
gsim; U+02273
gsime; U+02A8E
gsiml; U+02A90
gt; U+0003E
gt U+0003E
gtcc; U+02AA7
gtcir; U+02A7A
gtdot; U+022D7
gtlPar; U+02995
gtquest; U+02A7C
gtrapprox; U+02A86
gtrarr; U+02978
gtrdot; U+022D7
gtreqless; U+022DB
gtreqqless; U+02A8C
gtrless; U+02277
gtrsim; U+02273
hArr; U+021D4
hairsp; U+0200A
half; U+000BD
hamilt; U+0210B
hardcy; U+0044A
harr; U+02194
harrcir; U+02948
harrw; U+021AD
hbar; U+0210F
hcirc; U+00125
hearts; U+02665
heartsuit; U+02665
hellip; U+02026
hercon; U+022B9
hfr; U+1D525
hksearow; U+02925
hkswarow; U+02926
hoarr; U+021FF
homtht; U+0223B
hookleftarrow; U+021A9
hookrightarrow; U+021AA
hopf; U+1D559
horbar; U+02015
hscr; U+1D4BD
hslash; U+0210F
hstrok; U+00127
hybull; U+02043
hyphen; U+02010
iacute; U+000ED
iacute U+000ED
ic; U+02063
icirc; U+000EE
icirc U+000EE
icy; U+00438
iecy; U+00435
iexcl; U+000A1
iexcl U+000A1
iff; U+021D4
ifr; U+1D526
igrave; U+000EC
igrave U+000EC
ii; U+02148
iiiint; U+02A0C
iiint; U+0222D
iinfin; U+029DC
iiota; U+02129
ijlig; U+00133
imacr; U+0012B
image; U+02111
imagline; U+02110
imagpart; U+02111
imath; U+00131
imof; U+022B7
imped; U+001B5
in; U+02208
incare; U+02105
infin; U+0221E
infintie; U+029DD
inodot; U+00131
int; U+0222B
intcal; U+022BA
integers; U+02124
intercal; U+022BA
intlarhk; U+02A17
intprod; U+02A3C
iocy; U+00451
iogon; U+0012F
iopf; U+1D55A
iota; U+003B9
iprod; U+02A3C
iquest; U+000BF
iquest U+000BF
iscr; U+1D4BE
isin; U+02208
isinE; U+022F9
isindot; U+022F5
isins; U+022F4
isinsv; U+022F3
isinv; U+02208
it; U+02062
itilde; U+00129
iukcy; U+00456
iuml; U+000EF
iuml U+000EF
jcirc; U+00135
jcy; U+00439
jfr; U+1D527
jmath; U+00237
jopf; U+1D55B
jscr; U+1D4BF
jsercy; U+00458
jukcy; U+00454
kappa; U+003BA
kappav; U+003F0
kcedil; U+00137
kcy; U+0043A
kfr; U+1D528
kgreen; U+00138
khcy; U+00445
kjcy; U+0045C
kopf; U+1D55C
kscr; U+1D4C0
lAarr; U+021DA
lArr; U+021D0
lAtail; U+0291B
lBarr; U+0290E
lE; U+02266
lEg; U+02A8B
lHar; U+02962
lacute; U+0013A
laemptyv; U+029B4
lagran; U+02112
lambda; U+003BB
lang; U+027E8
langd; U+02991
langle; U+027E8
lap; U+02A85
laquo; U+000AB
laquo U+000AB
larr; U+02190
larrb; U+021E4
larrbfs; U+0291F
larrfs; U+0291D
larrhk; U+021A9
larrlp; U+021AB
larrpl; U+02939
larrsim; U+02973
larrtl; U+021A2
lat; U+02AAB
latail; U+02919
late; U+02AAD
lbarr; U+0290C
lbbrk; U+02772
lbrace; U+0007B
lbrack; U+0005B
lbrke; U+0298B
lbrksld; U+0298F
lbrkslu; U+0298D
lcaron; U+0013E
lcedil; U+0013C
lceil; U+02308
lcub; U+0007B
lcy; U+0043B
ldca; U+02936
ldquo; U+0201C
ldquor; U+0201E
ldrdhar; U+02967
ldrushar; U+0294B
ldsh; U+021B2
le; U+02264
leftarrow; U+02190
leftarrowtail; U+021A2
leftharpoondown; U+021BD
leftharpoonup; U+021BC
leftleftarrows; U+021C7
leftrightarrow; U+02194
leftrightarrows; U+021C6
leftrightharpoons; U+021CB
leftrightsquigarrow; U+021AD
leftthreetimes; U+022CB
leg; U+022DA
leq; U+02264
leqq; U+02266
leqslant; U+02A7D
les; U+02A7D
lescc; U+02AA8
lesdot; U+02A7F
lesdoto; U+02A81
lesdotor; U+02A83
lesges; U+02A93
lessapprox; U+02A85
lessdot; U+022D6
lesseqgtr; U+022DA
lesseqqgtr; U+02A8B
lessgtr; U+02276
lesssim; U+02272
lfisht; U+0297C
lfloor; U+0230A
lfr; U+1D529
lg; U+02276
lgE; U+02A91
lhard; U+021BD
lharu; U+021BC
lharul; U+0296A
lhblk; U+02584
ljcy; U+00459
ll; U+0226A
llarr; U+021C7
llcorner; U+0231E
llhard; U+0296B
lltri; U+025FA
lmidot; U+00140
lmoust; U+023B0
lmoustache; U+023B0
lnE; U+02268
lnap; U+02A89
lnapprox; U+02A89
lne; U+02A87
lneq; U+02A87
lneqq; U+02268
lnsim; U+022E6
loang; U+027EC
loarr; U+021FD
lobrk; U+027E6
longleftarrow; U+027F5
longleftrightarrow; U+027F7
longmapsto; U+027FC
longrightarrow; U+027F6
looparrowleft; U+021AB
looparrowright; U+021AC
lopar; U+02985
lopf; U+1D55D
loplus; U+02A2D
lotimes; U+02A34
lowast; U+02217
lowbar; U+0005F
loz; U+025CA
lozenge; U+025CA
lozf; U+029EB
lpar; U+00028
lparlt; U+02993
lrarr; U+021C6
lrcorner; U+0231F
lrhar; U+021CB
lrhard; U+0296D
lrm; U+0200E
lrtri; U+022BF
lsaquo; U+02039
lscr; U+1D4C1
lsh; U+021B0
lsim; U+02272
lsime; U+02A8D
lsimg; U+02A8F
lsqb; U+0005B
lsquo; U+02018
lsquor; U+0201A
lstrok; U+00142
lt; U+0003C
lt U+0003C
ltcc; U+02AA6
ltcir; U+02A79
ltdot; U+022D6
lthree; U+022CB
ltimes; U+022C9
ltlarr; U+02976
ltquest; U+02A7B
ltrPar; U+02996
ltri; U+025C3
ltrie; U+022B4
ltrif; U+025C2
lurdshar; U+0294A
luruhar; U+02966
mDDot; U+0223A
macr; U+000AF
macr U+000AF
male; U+02642
malt; U+02720
maltese; U+02720
map; U+021A6
mapsto; U+021A6
mapstodown; U+021A7
mapstoleft; U+021A4
mapstoup; U+021A5
marker; U+025AE
mcomma; U+02A29
mcy; U+0043C
mdash; U+02014
measuredangle; U+02221
mfr; U+1D52A
mho; U+02127
micro; U+000B5
micro U+000B5
mid; U+02223
midast; U+0002A
midcir; U+02AF0
middot; U+000B7
middot U+000B7
minus; U+02212
minusb; U+0229F
minusd; U+02238
minusdu; U+02A2A
mlcp; U+02ADB
mldr; U+02026
mnplus; U+02213
models; U+022A7
mopf; U+1D55E
mp; U+02213
mscr; U+1D4C2
mstpos; U+0223E
mu; U+003BC
multimap; U+022B8
mumap; U+022B8
nLeftarrow; U+021CD
nLeftrightarrow; U+021CE
nRightarrow; U+021CF
nVDash; U+022AF
nVdash; U+022AE
nabla; U+02207
nacute; U+00144
nap; U+02249
napos; U+00149
napprox; U+02249
natur; U+0266E
natural; U+0266E
naturals; U+02115
nbsp; U+000A0
nbsp U+000A0
ncap; U+02A43
ncaron; U+00148
ncedil; U+00146
ncong; U+02247
ncup; U+02A42
ncy; U+0043D
ndash; U+02013
ne; U+02260
neArr; U+021D7
nearhk; U+02924
nearr; U+02197
nearrow; U+02197
nequiv; U+02262
nesear; U+02928
nexist; U+02204
nexists; U+02204
nfr; U+1D52B
nge; U+02271
ngeq; U+02271
ngsim; U+02275
ngt; U+0226F
ngtr; U+0226F
nhArr; U+021CE
nharr; U+021AE
nhpar; U+02AF2
ni; U+0220B
nis; U+022FC
nisd; U+022FA
niv; U+0220B
njcy; U+0045A
nlArr; U+021CD
nlarr; U+0219A
nldr; U+02025
nle; U+02270
nleftarrow; U+0219A
nleftrightarrow; U+021AE
nleq; U+02270
nless; U+0226E
nlsim; U+02274
nlt; U+0226E
nltri; U+022EA
nltrie; U+022EC
nmid; U+02224
nopf; U+1D55F
not; U+000AC
not U+000AC
notin; U+02209
notinva; U+02209
notinvb; U+022F7
notinvc; U+022F6
notni; U+0220C
notniva; U+0220C
notnivb; U+022FE
notnivc; U+022FD
npar; U+02226
nparallel; U+02226
npolint; U+02A14
npr; U+02280
nprcue; U+022E0
nprec; U+02280
nrArr; U+021CF
nrarr; U+0219B
nrightarrow; U+0219B
nrtri; U+022EB
nrtrie; U+022ED
nsc; U+02281
nsccue; U+022E1
nscr; U+1D4C3
nshortmid; U+02224
nshortparallel; U+02226
nsim; U+02241
nsime; U+02244
nsimeq; U+02244
nsmid; U+02224
nspar; U+02226
nsqsube; U+022E2
nsqsupe; U+022E3
nsub; U+02284
nsube; U+02288
nsubseteq; U+02288
nsucc; U+02281
nsup; U+02285
nsupe; U+02289
nsupseteq; U+02289
ntgl; U+02279
ntilde; U+000F1
ntilde U+000F1
ntlg; U+02278
ntriangleleft; U+022EA
ntrianglelefteq; U+022EC
ntriangleright; U+022EB
ntrianglerighteq; U+022ED
nu; U+003BD
num; U+00023
numero; U+02116
numsp; U+02007
nvDash; U+022AD
nvHarr; U+02904
nvdash; U+022AC
nvinfin; U+029DE
nvlArr; U+02902
nvrArr; U+02903
nwArr; U+021D6
nwarhk; U+02923
nwarr; U+02196
nwarrow; U+02196
nwnear; U+02927
oS; U+024C8
oacute; U+000F3
oacute U+000F3
oast; U+0229B
ocir; U+0229A
ocirc; U+000F4
ocirc U+000F4
ocy; U+0043E
odash; U+0229D
odblac; U+00151
odiv; U+02A38
odot; U+02299
odsold; U+029BC
oelig; U+00153
ofcir; U+029BF
ofr; U+1D52C
ogon; U+002DB
ograve; U+000F2
ograve U+000F2
ogt; U+029C1
ohbar; U+029B5
ohm; U+02126
oint; U+0222E
olarr; U+021BA
olcir; U+029BE
olcross; U+029BB
oline; U+0203E
olt; U+029C0
omacr; U+0014D
omega; U+003C9
omicron; U+003BF
omid; U+029B6
ominus; U+02296
oopf; U+1D560
opar; U+029B7
operp; U+029B9
oplus; U+02295
or; U+02228
orarr; U+021BB
ord; U+02A5D
order; U+02134
orderof; U+02134
ordf; U+000AA
ordf U+000AA
ordm; U+000BA
ordm U+000BA
origof; U+022B6
oror; U+02A56
orslope; U+02A57
orv; U+02A5B
oscr; U+02134
oslash; U+000F8
oslash U+000F8
osol; U+02298
otilde; U+000F5
otilde U+000F5
otimes; U+02297
otimesas; U+02A36
ouml; U+000F6
ouml U+000F6
ovbar; U+0233D
par; U+02225
para; U+000B6
para U+000B6
parallel; U+02225
parsim; U+02AF3
parsl; U+02AFD
part; U+02202
pcy; U+0043F
percnt; U+00025
period; U+0002E
permil; U+02030
perp; U+022A5
pertenk; U+02031
pfr; U+1D52D
phi; U+003C6
phiv; U+003C6
phmmat; U+02133
phone; U+0260E
pi; U+003C0
pitchfork; U+022D4
piv; U+003D6
planck; U+0210F
planckh; U+0210E
plankv; U+0210F
plus; U+0002B
plusacir; U+02A23
plusb; U+0229E
pluscir; U+02A22
plusdo; U+02214
plusdu; U+02A25
pluse; U+02A72
plusmn; U+000B1
plusmn U+000B1
plussim; U+02A26
plustwo; U+02A27
pm; U+000B1
pointint; U+02A15
popf; U+1D561
pound; U+000A3
pound U+000A3
pr; U+0227A
prE; U+02AB3
prap; U+02AB7
prcue; U+0227C
pre; U+02AAF
prec; U+0227A
precapprox; U+02AB7
preccurlyeq; U+0227C
preceq; U+02AAF
precnapprox; U+02AB9
precneqq; U+02AB5
precnsim; U+022E8
precsim; U+0227E
prime; U+02032
primes; U+02119
prnE; U+02AB5
prnap; U+02AB9
prnsim; U+022E8
prod; U+0220F
profalar; U+0232E
profline; U+02312
profsurf; U+02313
prop; U+0221D
propto; U+0221D
prsim; U+0227E
prurel; U+022B0
pscr; U+1D4C5
psi; U+003C8
puncsp; U+02008
qfr; U+1D52E
qint; U+02A0C
qopf; U+1D562
qprime; U+02057
qscr; U+1D4C6
quaternions; U+0210D
quatint; U+02A16
quest; U+0003F
questeq; U+0225F
quot; U+00022
quot U+00022
rAarr; U+021DB
rArr; U+021D2
rAtail; U+0291C
rBarr; U+0290F
rHar; U+02964
race; U+029DA
racute; U+00155
radic; U+0221A
raemptyv; U+029B3
rang; U+027E9
rangd; U+02992
range; U+029A5
rangle; U+027E9
raquo; U+000BB
raquo U+000BB
rarr; U+02192
rarrap; U+02975
rarrb; U+021E5
rarrbfs; U+02920
rarrc; U+02933
rarrfs; U+0291E
rarrhk; U+021AA
rarrlp; U+021AC
rarrpl; U+02945
rarrsim; U+02974
rarrtl; U+021A3
rarrw; U+0219D
ratail; U+0291A
ratio; U+02236
rationals; U+0211A
rbarr; U+0290D
rbbrk; U+02773
rbrace; U+0007D
rbrack; U+0005D
rbrke; U+0298C
rbrksld; U+0298E
rbrkslu; U+02990
rcaron; U+00159
rcedil; U+00157
rceil; U+02309
rcub; U+0007D
rcy; U+00440
rdca; U+02937
rdldhar; U+02969
rdquo; U+0201D
rdquor; U+0201D
rdsh; U+021B3
real; U+0211C
realine; U+0211B
realpart; U+0211C
reals; U+0211D
rect; U+025AD
reg; U+000AE
reg U+000AE
rfisht; U+0297D
rfloor; U+0230B
rfr; U+1D52F
rhard; U+021C1
rharu; U+021C0
rharul; U+0296C
rho; U+003C1
rhov; U+003F1
rightarrow; U+02192
rightarrowtail; U+021A3
rightharpoondown; U+021C1
rightharpoonup; U+021C0
rightleftarrows; U+021C4
rightleftharpoons; U+021CC
rightrightarrows; U+021C9
rightsquigarrow; U+0219D
rightthreetimes; U+022CC
ring; U+002DA
risingdotseq; U+02253
rlarr; U+021C4
rlhar; U+021CC
rlm; U+0200F
rmoust; U+023B1
rmoustache; U+023B1
rnmid; U+02AEE
roang; U+027ED
roarr; U+021FE
robrk; U+027E7
ropar; U+02986
ropf; U+1D563
roplus; U+02A2E
rotimes; U+02A35
rpar; U+00029
rpargt; U+02994
rppolint; U+02A12
rrarr; U+021C9
rsaquo; U+0203A
rscr; U+1D4C7
rsh; U+021B1
rsqb; U+0005D
rsquo; U+02019
rsquor; U+02019
rthree; U+022CC
rtimes; U+022CA
rtri; U+025B9
rtrie; U+022B5
rtrif; U+025B8
rtriltri; U+029CE
ruluhar; U+02968
rx; U+0211E
sacute; U+0015B
sbquo; U+0201A
sc; U+0227B
scE; U+02AB4
scap; U+02AB8
scaron; U+00161
sccue; U+0227D
sce; U+02AB0
scedil; U+0015F
scirc; U+0015D
scnE; U+02AB6
scnap; U+02ABA
scnsim; U+022E9
scpolint; U+02A13
scsim; U+0227F
scy; U+00441
sdot; U+022C5
sdotb; U+022A1
sdote; U+02A66
seArr; U+021D8
searhk; U+02925
searr; U+02198
searrow; U+02198
sect; U+000A7
sect U+000A7
semi; U+0003B
seswar; U+02929
setminus; U+02216
setmn; U+02216
sext; U+02736
sfr; U+1D530
sfrown; U+02322
sharp; U+0266F
shchcy; U+00449
shcy; U+00448
shortmid; U+02223
shortparallel; U+02225
shy; U+000AD
shy U+000AD
sigma; U+003C3
sigmaf; U+003C2
sigmav; U+003C2
sim; U+0223C
simdot; U+02A6A
sime; U+02243
simeq; U+02243
simg; U+02A9E
simgE; U+02AA0
siml; U+02A9D
simlE; U+02A9F
simne; U+02246
simplus; U+02A24
simrarr; U+02972
slarr; U+02190
smallsetminus; U+02216
smashp; U+02A33
smeparsl; U+029E4
smid; U+02223
smile; U+02323
smt; U+02AAA
smte; U+02AAC
softcy; U+0044C
sol; U+0002F
solb; U+029C4
solbar; U+0233F
sopf; U+1D564
spades; U+02660
spadesuit; U+02660
spar; U+02225
sqcap; U+02293
sqcup; U+02294
sqsub; U+0228F
sqsube; U+02291
sqsubset; U+0228F
sqsubseteq; U+02291
sqsup; U+02290
sqsupe; U+02292
sqsupset; U+02290
sqsupseteq; U+02292
squ; U+025A1
square; U+025A1
squarf; U+025AA
squf; U+025AA
srarr; U+02192
sscr; U+1D4C8
ssetmn; U+02216
ssmile; U+02323
sstarf; U+022C6
star; U+02606
starf; U+02605
straightepsilon; U+003F5
straightphi; U+003D5
strns; U+000AF
sub; U+02282
subE; U+02AC5
subdot; U+02ABD
sube; U+02286
subedot; U+02AC3
submult; U+02AC1
subnE; U+02ACB
subne; U+0228A
subplus; U+02ABF
subrarr; U+02979
subset; U+02282
subseteq; U+02286
subseteqq; U+02AC5
subsetneq; U+0228A
subsetneqq; U+02ACB
subsim; U+02AC7
subsub; U+02AD5
subsup; U+02AD3
succ; U+0227B
succapprox; U+02AB8
succcurlyeq; U+0227D
succeq; U+02AB0
succnapprox; U+02ABA
succneqq; U+02AB6
succnsim; U+022E9
succsim; U+0227F
sum; U+02211
sung; U+0266A
sup1; U+000B9
sup1 U+000B9
sup2; U+000B2
sup2 U+000B2
sup3; U+000B3
sup3 U+000B3
sup; U+02283
supE; U+02AC6
supdot; U+02ABE
supdsub; U+02AD8
supe; U+02287
supedot; U+02AC4
suphsub; U+02AD7
suplarr; U+0297B
supmult; U+02AC2
supnE; U+02ACC
supne; U+0228B
supplus; U+02AC0
supset; U+02283
supseteq; U+02287
supseteqq; U+02AC6
supsetneq; U+0228B
supsetneqq; U+02ACC
supsim; U+02AC8
supsub; U+02AD4
supsup; U+02AD6
swArr; U+021D9
swarhk; U+02926
swarr; U+02199
swarrow; U+02199
swnwar; U+0292A
szlig; U+000DF
szlig U+000DF
target; U+02316
tau; U+003C4
tbrk; U+023B4
tcaron; U+00165
tcedil; U+00163
tcy; U+00442
tdot; U+020DB
telrec; U+02315
tfr; U+1D531
there4; U+02234
therefore; U+02234
theta; U+003B8
thetasym; U+003D1
thetav; U+003D1
thickapprox; U+02248
thicksim; U+0223C
thinsp; U+02009
thkap; U+02248
thksim; U+0223C
thorn; U+000FE
thorn U+000FE
tilde; U+002DC
times; U+000D7
times U+000D7
timesb; U+022A0
timesbar; U+02A31
timesd; U+02A30
tint; U+0222D
toea; U+02928
top; U+022A4
topbot; U+02336
topcir; U+02AF1
topf; U+1D565
topfork; U+02ADA
tosa; U+02929
tprime; U+02034
trade; U+02122
triangle; U+025B5
triangledown; U+025BF
triangleleft; U+025C3
trianglelefteq; U+022B4
triangleq; U+0225C
triangleright; U+025B9
trianglerighteq; U+022B5
tridot; U+025EC
trie; U+0225C
triminus; U+02A3A
triplus; U+02A39
trisb; U+029CD
tritime; U+02A3B
trpezium; U+023E2
tscr; U+1D4C9
tscy; U+00446
tshcy; U+0045B
tstrok; U+00167
twixt; U+0226C
twoheadleftarrow; U+0219E
twoheadrightarrow; U+021A0
uArr; U+021D1
uHar; U+02963
uacute; U+000FA
uacute U+000FA
uarr; U+02191
ubrcy; U+0045E
ubreve; U+0016D
ucirc; U+000FB
ucirc U+000FB
ucy; U+00443
udarr; U+021C5
udblac; U+00171
udhar; U+0296E
ufisht; U+0297E
ufr; U+1D532
ugrave; U+000F9
ugrave U+000F9
uharl; U+021BF
uharr; U+021BE
uhblk; U+02580
ulcorn; U+0231C
ulcorner; U+0231C
ulcrop; U+0230F
ultri; U+025F8
umacr; U+0016B
uml; U+000A8
uml U+000A8
uogon; U+00173
uopf; U+1D566
uparrow; U+02191
updownarrow; U+02195
upharpoonleft; U+021BF
upharpoonright; U+021BE
uplus; U+0228E
upsi; U+003C5
upsih; U+003D2
upsilon; U+003C5
upuparrows; U+021C8
urcorn; U+0231D
urcorner; U+0231D
urcrop; U+0230E
uring; U+0016F
urtri; U+025F9
uscr; U+1D4CA
utdot; U+022F0
utilde; U+00169
utri; U+025B5
utrif; U+025B4
uuarr; U+021C8
uuml; U+000FC
uuml U+000FC
uwangle; U+029A7
vArr; U+021D5
vBar; U+02AE8
vBarv; U+02AE9
vDash; U+022A8
vangrt; U+0299C
varepsilon; U+003B5
varkappa; U+003F0
varnothing; U+02205
varphi; U+003C6
varpi; U+003D6
varpropto; U+0221D
varr; U+02195
varrho; U+003F1
varsigma; U+003C2
vartheta; U+003D1
vartriangleleft; U+022B2
vartriangleright; U+022B3
vcy; U+00432
vdash; U+022A2
vee; U+02228
veebar; U+022BB
veeeq; U+0225A
vellip; U+022EE
verbar; U+0007C
vert; U+0007C
vfr; U+1D533
vltri; U+022B2
vopf; U+1D567
vprop; U+0221D
vrtri; U+022B3
vscr; U+1D4CB
vzigzag; U+0299A
wcirc; U+00175
wedbar; U+02A5F
wedge; U+02227
wedgeq; U+02259
weierp; U+02118
wfr; U+1D534
wopf; U+1D568
wp; U+02118
wr; U+02240
wreath; U+02240
wscr; U+1D4CC
xcap; U+022C2
xcirc; U+025EF
xcup; U+022C3
xdtri; U+025BD
xfr; U+1D535
xhArr; U+027FA
xharr; U+027F7
xi; U+003BE
xlArr; U+027F8
xlarr; U+027F5
xmap; U+027FC
xnis; U+022FB
xodot; U+02A00
xopf; U+1D569
xoplus; U+02A01
xotime; U+02A02
xrArr; U+027F9
xrarr; U+027F6
xscr; U+1D4CD
xsqcup; U+02A06
xuplus; U+02A04
xutri; U+025B3
xvee; U+022C1
xwedge; U+022C0
yacute; U+000FD
yacute U+000FD
yacy; U+0044F
ycirc; U+00177
ycy; U+0044B
yen; U+000A5
yen U+000A5
yfr; U+1D536
yicy; U+00457
yopf; U+1D56A
yscr; U+1D4CE
yucy; U+0044E
yuml; U+000FF
yuml U+000FF
zacute; U+0017A
zcaron; U+0017E
zcy; U+00437
zdot; U+0017C
zeetrf; U+02128
zeta; U+003B6
zfr; U+1D537
zhcy; U+00436
zigrarr; U+021DD
zopf; U+1D56B
zscr; U+1D4CF
zwj; U+0200D
zwnj; U+0200C

9. レンダリングと利用者エージェントの動作

This section will probably include details on how to render DATAGRID (including its pseudo-elements), drag-and-drop, etc, in a visual medium, in concert with CSS. Terms that need to be defined include: sizing of embedded content

CSS UAs in visual media must, when scrolling a page to a fragment identifier, align the top of the viewport with the target element's top border edge.

must define letting the user "obtain a physical form (or a representation of a physical form)" of a document (printing) and what this means for the UA, in particular creating a new view for the print media.

Must define that in CSS, tag and attribute names in HTML documents, and class names in quirks mode documents, are case-insensitive, as well as saying which attribute values must be compared case-insensitively.

9.1 Rendering and the DOM

This section is wrong. mediaMode will end up on Window, I think. All views implement Window.

Any object implement the AbstractView interface must also implement the MediaModeAbstractView interface.

interface MediaModeAbstractView {
  readonly attribute DOMString mediaMode;
};

The mediaMode attribute on objects implementing the MediaModeAbstractView interface must return the string that represents the canvas' current rendering mode (screen, print, etc). This is a lowercase string, as defined by the CSS specification. [CSS21]

Some user agents may support multiple media, in which case there will exist multiple objects implementing the AbstractView interface. Only the default view implements the Window interface. The other views can be reached using the view attribute of the UIEvent interface, during event propagation. There is no way currently to enumerate all the views.

9.2 Rendering and menus/toolbars

9.2.1 The 'icon' property

UAs should use the command's Icon as the default generic icon provided by the user agent when the 'icon' property computes to 'auto' on an element that either defines a command or refers to one using the command attribute, but when the property computes to an actual image, it should use that image instead.

9.3 廃止要素・属性・API

9.3.1 body 要素

Need to define the content attributes in terms of CSS or something.

[XXX] interface HTMLDocument {
           attribute DOMString fgColor;
           attribute DOMString bgColor;
           attribute DOMString linkColor;
           attribute DOMString vlinkColor;
           attribute DOMString alinkColor;
};

Document オブジェクトの fgColor 属性は、文書 body 要素text 属性を反映しなければなりません

Document オブジェクトの bgColor 属性は、文書 body 要素bgcolor 属性を反映しなければなりません

Document オブジェクトの linkColor 属性は、文書 body 要素link 属性を反映しなければなりません

Document オブジェクトの vLinkColor 属性は、文書 body 要素vlink 属性を反映しなければなりません

Document オブジェクトの aLinkColor 属性は、文書 body 要素alink 属性を反映しなければなりません

[XXX] interface HTMLBodyElement {
           attribute DOMString text;
           attribute DOMString bgColor;
           attribute DOMString background;
           attribute DOMString link;
           attribute DOMString vLink;
           attribute DOMString aLink;
};

body 要素の text DOM 属性は、 その要素の text 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

body 要素の bgColor DOM 属性は、 その要素の bgcolor 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

body 要素の background DOM 属性は、 その要素の background 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

body 要素の link DOM 属性は、 その要素の link 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

body 要素の aLink DOM 属性は、 その要素の alink 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

body 要素の vLink DOM 属性は、 その要素の vlink 内容属性を反映しなければなりません

9.3.2 applet 要素

applet 要素は、 embed 要素の Java 専用の異形です。 HTML5 では applet 要素は廃止されており、 すべての拡張の枠組み (Java、.NET、Flash など) は一貫した方法で扱われます。

applet 要素の文書が活性文書である閲覧文脈において砂箱化プラグイン閲覧文脈旗が設定されている場合、 要素は無視されなければなりません (何も表しません)。

Otherwise, define how the element works, if supported.

[XXX] interface HTMLDocument {
  readonly attribute HTMLCollection applets;
};

applets 属性は、 Document 節点を根とし、濾過器が applet 要素にのみ一致するような HTMLCollection を返さなければなりません

10. ここで詳しく説明する他の技術を使う方がよりうまく取り扱えるのでこの仕様書では行うことができない事柄

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

この仕様書では、 クライアント側マーク付け言語が適当な水準ではないため、 あるいはこの言語と統合できる別の言語に機能が存在するため、 取り扱わない機能があります。この章ではとてもよくある要求のいくつかに触れます。

10.1 局所化

HTML アプリケーションの局所化した版を作成したいという場合、 ファイルを鯖で前処理した上で、 HTTP 内容折衝を使って適当な言語で供給するのが最も良い解決策です。

10.2 宣言的2次元ベクトル画像・アニメーション

ベクトル画像の XHTML 文書への埋め込みは SVG の範囲です。

10.3 宣言的3次元場面

3次元画像の XHTML 文書への埋め込みは X3D や、 X3D に基づく名前空間に対応した技術の範囲です。

10.4 タイマー

This section is expected to be moved to its own specification in due course. It needs a lot of work to actually make it into a semi-decent spec.

Window 界面を実装するオブジェクトは、 WindowTimers 界面も実装しなければなりません

[NoInterfaceObject] interface WindowTimers {
  // timers
  long setTimeout(in TimeoutHandler handler, in long timeout);
  long setTimeout(in TimeoutHandler handler, in long timeout, arguments...);
  long setTimeout(in DOMString code, in long timeout);
  long setTimeout(in DOMString code, in long timeout, in DOMString language);
  void clearTimeout(in long handle);
  long setInterval(in TimeoutHandler handler, in long timeout);
  long setInterval(in TimeoutHandler handler, in long timeout, arguments...);
  long setInterval(in DOMString code, in long timeout);
  long setInterval(in DOMString code, in long timeout, in DOMString language);
  void clearInterval(in long handle);
};

interface TimeoutHandler {
  void handleEvent([Variadic] in any args);
};

The setTimeout and setInterval methods allow authors to schedule timer-based events.

The setTimeout(handler, timeout[, arguments...]) method takes a reference to a TimeoutHandler object and a length of time in milliseconds. It must return a handle to the timeout created, and then asynchronously wait timeout milliseconds and then queue a task to invoke handleEvent() on the handler object. If any arguments... were provided, they must be passed to the handler as arguments to the handleEvent() function.

Alternatively, setTimeout(code, timeout[, language]) may be used. This variant takes a string instead of a TimeoutHandler object. define the actual requirements for this method, as with the previous one. That string must be parsed using the specified language (defaulting to ECMAScript if the third argument is omitted) and executed in the scope of the browsing context associated with the Window object on which the setTimeout() method was invoked.

Need to define language values.

The setInterval(...) variants must work in the same way as the setTimeout variants except that if timeout is a value greater than zero, the task that invokes the handler or code must be queued again every timeout milliseconds, not just the once.

The clearTimeout() and clearInterval() methods take one integer (the value returned by setTimeout() and setInterval() respectively) and must cancel the specified timeout. When called with a value that does not correspond to an active timeout or interval, the methods must return without doing anything.

索引

この節は規定の一部ではありません。

List of elements

List of attributes

List of interfaces

List of events

参考文献

この章は将来の仕様案で執筆します。

謝辞

Aankhen, Aaron Boodman, Aaron Leventhal, Adam Barth, Adam Roben, Addison Phillips, Adele Peterson, Adrian Sutton, Agustín Fernández, Alastair Campbell, Alexey Feldgendler, Anders Carlsson, Andrew Gove, Andrew Sidwell, Anne van Kesteren, Anthony Hickson, Anthony Ricaud, Antti Koivisto, Arphen Lin, Asbjørn Ulsberg, Ashley Sheridan, Aurelien Levy, Ben Boyle, Ben Godfrey, Ben Meadowcroft, Ben Millard, Benjamin Hawkes-Lewis, Bert Bos, Bill Mason, Billy Wong, Bjoern Hoehrmann, Boris Zbarsky, Brad Fults, Brad Neuberg, Brady Eidson, Brendan Eich, Brett Wilson, Brian Campbell, Brian Smith, Bruce Miller, Cameron McCormack, Carlos Perelló Marín, Chao Cai, 윤석찬 (Channy Yun), Charl van Niekerk, Charles Iliya Krempeaux, Charles McCathieNevile, Christian Biesinger, Christian Johansen, Chriswa, Cole Robison, Collin Jackson, Daniel Barclay, Daniel Brumbaugh Keeney, Daniel Glazman, Daniel Peng, Daniel Spång, Daniel Steinberg, Danny Sullivan, Darin Adler, Darin Fisher, Dave Camp, Dave Singer, Dave Townsend, David Baron, David Bloom, David Carlisle, David Flanagan, David Håsäther, David Hyatt, David Smith, Dean Edridge, Debi Orton, Derek Featherstone, DeWitt Clinton, Dimitri Glazkov, dolphinling, Doron Rosenberg, Doug Kramer, Edward O'Connor, Eira Monstad, Elliotte Harold, Eric Law, Erik Arvidsson, Evan Martin, Evan Prodromou, fantasai, Felix Sasaki, Franck 'Shift' Quélain, Garrett Smith, Geoffrey Garen, Geoffrey Sneddon, Håkon Wium Lie, Henri Sivonen, Henrik Lied, Henry Mason, Hugh Winkler, Ignacio Javier, Ivo Emanuel Gonçalves, J. King, Jacques Distler, James Graham, James Justin Harrell, James M Snell, James Perrett, Jan-Klaas Kollhof, Jason White, Jasper Bryant-Greene, Jeff Cutsinger, Jeff Schiller, Jeff Walden, Jens Bannmann, Jens Fendler, Jeroen van der Meer, Jim Jewett, Jim Meehan, Joe Clark, Joseph Kesselman, Jjgod Jiang, Joel Spolsky, Johan Herland, John Boyer, John Bussjaeger, John Harding, Johnny Stenback, Jon Perlow, Jonathan Worent, Jorgen Horstink, Josh Levenberg, Joshua Randall, Jukka K. Korpela, Julian Reschke, Kai Hendry, Kornel Lesinski, 黒澤剛志 (KUROSAWA Takeshi), Kristof Zelechovski, Lachlan Hunt, Larry Page, Lars Gunther, Laura L. Carlson, Laura Wisewell, Laurens Holst, Lee Kowalkowski, Leif Halvard Silli, Lenny Domnitser, Léonard Bouchet, Leons Petrazickis, Logan, Loune, Maciej Stachowiak, Magnus Kristiansen, Malcolm Rowe, Mark Nottingham, Mark Rowe, Mark Schenk, Martijn Wargers, Martin Atkins, Martin Dürst, Martin Honnen, Masataka Yakura, Mathieu Henri, Matthew Mastracci, Matthew Raymond, Matthew Thomas, Mattias Waldau, Max Romantschuk, Michael 'Ratt' Iannarelli, Michael A. Nachbaur, Michael A. Puls II, Michael Carter, Michael Gratton, Michael Powers, Michael(tm) Smith, Michel Fortin, Michiel van der Blonk, Mihai Şucan, Mike Brown, Mike Dierken, Mike Dixon, Mike Schinkel, Mike Shaver, Mikko Rantalainen, Neil Deakin, Neil Soiffer, Olaf Hoffmann, Olav Junker Kjær, Oliver Hunt, Peter Karlsson, Peter Kasting, Philip Jägenstedt, Philip Taylor, Philip TAYLOR, Rachid Finge, Rajas Moonka, Ralf Stoltze, Ralph Giles, Raphael Champeimont, Rene Saarsoo, Richard Ishida, Rimantas Liubertas, Robert Blaut, Robert O'Callahan, Robert Sayre, Roman Ivanov, Ryan King, S. Mike Dierken, Sam Ruby, Sam Weinig, Scott Hess, Sean Knapp, Shaun Inman, Silvia Pfeiffer, Simon Pieters, Stefan Haustein, Steffen Meschkat, Stephen Ma, Steve Faulkner, Steve Runyon, Steven Garrity, Stewart Brodie, Stuart Parmenter, Sunava Dutta, Tantek Çelik, Terrence Wood, Thomas Broyer, Thomas O'Connor, Tim Altman, Tim Johansson, Travis Leithead, Tyler Close, Vladimir Vukićević, Wakaba, Wayne Pollock, William Swanson, Yi-An Huang, Øistein E. Andersen の有用かつ重要なコメントに感謝します。

HTML5 についてブログや公開メイリング・リストや掲示板 (W3C public-html メイリング・リストWHATWG 各種メイリング・リストなど) に投稿したすべての方々にも感謝します。

Safari に最初に canvas を実装した Richard Williamson に特に感謝します。画布機能はこれをもとに設計しました。

事象に基づくドラッグ・アンド・ドロップ機構、contenteditable、 その他 Windows Internet Explorer ブラウザではじめて広く採用された機能を最初に実装した Microsoft の従業員のみなさんにも特に感謝します。

構文解析の章に採用するために編集者が逆行分析して不具合を修正せざるを得なかった、養子代理人算法の壊れた実装を考案した David Hyatt に特に感謝し、賞金100万円を贈ります。

この仕様書中で使用した例文の着想を得た多くの出典に感謝します。

いくつかのアイディアについて Microsoft ブログ社会、 着想の元となった Web アプリケーションおよび複合文書に関する W3C 研究会の参加者の方々、 そしてアイディアを提供していただき支援してくださった #mrt の中の人達、 #mrt.no の中の人達、 #whatwg の中の人達、秘密結社にも感謝します。